diff --git a/inventory/sample/group_vars/k8s_cluster/addons.yml b/inventory/sample/group_vars/k8s_cluster/addons.yml
index d1c369ce2..f3afed324 100644
--- a/inventory/sample/group_vars/k8s_cluster/addons.yml
+++ b/inventory/sample/group_vars/k8s_cluster/addons.yml
@@ -96,6 +96,10 @@ rbd_provisioner_enabled: false
# rbd_provisioner_storage_class: rbd
# rbd_provisioner_reclaim_policy: Delete
+# Gateway API CRDs
+gateway_api_enabled: false
+# gateway_api_experimental_channel: false
+
# Nginx ingress controller deployment
ingress_nginx_enabled: false
# ingress_nginx_host_network: false
diff --git a/roles/kubernetes-apps/gateway_api/defaults/main.yml b/roles/kubernetes-apps/gateway_api/defaults/main.yml
new file mode 100644
index 000000000..9896bbf0f
--- /dev/null
+++ b/roles/kubernetes-apps/gateway_api/defaults/main.yml
@@ -0,0 +1,4 @@
+---
+gateway_api_enabled: false
+gateway_api_version: v1.1.0
+gateway_api_experimental_channel: false
diff --git a/roles/kubernetes-apps/gateway_api/tasks/main.yml b/roles/kubernetes-apps/gateway_api/tasks/main.yml
new file mode 100644
index 000000000..107fa70e1
--- /dev/null
+++ b/roles/kubernetes-apps/gateway_api/tasks/main.yml
@@ -0,0 +1,33 @@
+---
+- name: Gateway API | Create addon dir
+ file:
+ path: "{{ kube_config_dir }}/addons/gateway_api"
+ state: directory
+ owner: root
+ group: root
+ mode: "0755"
+ when:
+ - inventory_hostname == groups['kube_control_plane'][0]
+
+- name: Gateway API | Set channel
+ set_fact:
+ gateway_api_channel: "{{ 'experimental' if gateway_api_experimental_channel else 'standard' }}"
+ when:
+ - "inventory_hostname == groups['kube_control_plane'][0]"
+
+- name: Gateway API | Copy Gateway API manifests to remote
+ template:
+ src: "{{ gateway_api_channel }}-install.yaml.j2"
+ dest: "{{ kube_config_dir }}/addons/gateway_api/{{ gateway_api_channel }}-install.yaml"
+ mode: "0644"
+ when:
+ - "inventory_hostname == groups['kube_control_plane'][0]"
+
+- name: Gateway API | Install Gateway API
+ kube:
+ name: Gateway API
+ kubectl: "{{ bin_dir }}/kubectl"
+ filename: "{{ kube_config_dir }}/addons/gateway_api/{{ gateway_api_channel }}-install.yaml"
+ state: latest
+ when:
+ - "inventory_hostname == groups['kube_control_plane'][0]"
diff --git a/roles/kubernetes-apps/gateway_api/templates/experimental-install.yaml.j2 b/roles/kubernetes-apps/gateway_api/templates/experimental-install.yaml.j2
new file mode 100644
index 000000000..8a50a1fa2
--- /dev/null
+++ b/roles/kubernetes-apps/gateway_api/templates/experimental-install.yaml.j2
@@ -0,0 +1,18317 @@
+# Copyright 2024 The Kubernetes Authors.
+#
+# Licensed under the Apache License, Version 2.0 (the "License");
+# you may not use this file except in compliance with the License.
+# You may obtain a copy of the License at
+#
+# http://www.apache.org/licenses/LICENSE-2.0
+#
+# Unless required by applicable law or agreed to in writing, software
+# distributed under the License is distributed on an "AS IS" BASIS,
+# WITHOUT WARRANTIES OR CONDITIONS OF ANY KIND, either express or implied.
+# See the License for the specific language governing permissions and
+# limitations under the License.
+
+#
+# Gateway API Experimental channel install
+#
+---
+#
+# config/crd/experimental/gateway.networking.k8s.io_backendlbpolicies.yaml
+#
+apiVersion: apiextensions.k8s.io/v1
+kind: CustomResourceDefinition
+metadata:
+ annotations:
+ api-approved.kubernetes.io: https://github.com/kubernetes-sigs/gateway-api/pull/2997
+ gateway.networking.k8s.io/bundle-version: v1.1.0
+ gateway.networking.k8s.io/channel: experimental
+ creationTimestamp: null
+ name: backendlbpolicies.gateway.networking.k8s.io
+spec:
+ group: gateway.networking.k8s.io
+ names:
+ categories:
+ - gateway-api
+ kind: BackendLBPolicy
+ listKind: BackendLBPolicyList
+ plural: backendlbpolicies
+ shortNames:
+ - blbpolicy
+ singular: backendlbpolicy
+ scope: Namespaced
+ versions:
+ - additionalPrinterColumns:
+ - jsonPath: .metadata.creationTimestamp
+ name: Age
+ type: date
+ name: v1alpha2
+ schema:
+ openAPIV3Schema:
+ description: |-
+ BackendLBPolicy provides a way to define load balancing rules
+ for a backend.
+ properties:
+ apiVersion:
+ description: |-
+ APIVersion defines the versioned schema of this representation of an object.
+ Servers should convert recognized schemas to the latest internal value, and
+ may reject unrecognized values.
+ More info: https://git.k8s.io/community/contributors/devel/sig-architecture/api-conventions.md#resources
+ type: string
+ kind:
+ description: |-
+ Kind is a string value representing the REST resource this object represents.
+ Servers may infer this from the endpoint the client submits requests to.
+ Cannot be updated.
+ In CamelCase.
+ More info: https://git.k8s.io/community/contributors/devel/sig-architecture/api-conventions.md#types-kinds
+ type: string
+ metadata:
+ type: object
+ spec:
+ description: Spec defines the desired state of BackendLBPolicy.
+ properties:
+ sessionPersistence:
+ description: |-
+ SessionPersistence defines and configures session persistence
+ for the backend.
+
+
+ Support: Extended
+ properties:
+ absoluteTimeout:
+ description: |-
+ AbsoluteTimeout defines the absolute timeout of the persistent
+ session. Once the AbsoluteTimeout duration has elapsed, the
+ session becomes invalid.
+
+
+ Support: Extended
+ pattern: ^([0-9]{1,5}(h|m|s|ms)){1,4}$
+ type: string
+ cookieConfig:
+ description: |-
+ CookieConfig provides configuration settings that are specific
+ to cookie-based session persistence.
+
+
+ Support: Core
+ properties:
+ lifetimeType:
+ default: Session
+ description: |-
+ LifetimeType specifies whether the cookie has a permanent or
+ session-based lifetime. A permanent cookie persists until its
+ specified expiry time, defined by the Expires or Max-Age cookie
+ attributes, while a session cookie is deleted when the current
+ session ends.
+
+
+ When set to "Permanent", AbsoluteTimeout indicates the
+ cookie's lifetime via the Expires or Max-Age cookie attributes
+ and is required.
+
+
+ When set to "Session", AbsoluteTimeout indicates the
+ absolute lifetime of the cookie tracked by the gateway and
+ is optional.
+
+
+ Support: Core for "Session" type
+
+
+ Support: Extended for "Permanent" type
+ enum:
+ - Permanent
+ - Session
+ type: string
+ type: object
+ idleTimeout:
+ description: |-
+ IdleTimeout defines the idle timeout of the persistent session.
+ Once the session has been idle for more than the specified
+ IdleTimeout duration, the session becomes invalid.
+
+
+ Support: Extended
+ pattern: ^([0-9]{1,5}(h|m|s|ms)){1,4}$
+ type: string
+ sessionName:
+ description: |-
+ SessionName defines the name of the persistent session token
+ which may be reflected in the cookie or the header. Users
+ should avoid reusing session names to prevent unintended
+ consequences, such as rejection or unpredictable behavior.
+
+
+ Support: Implementation-specific
+ maxLength: 128
+ type: string
+ type:
+ default: Cookie
+ description: |-
+ Type defines the type of session persistence such as through
+ the use a header or cookie. Defaults to cookie based session
+ persistence.
+
+
+ Support: Core for "Cookie" type
+
+
+ Support: Extended for "Header" type
+ enum:
+ - Cookie
+ - Header
+ type: string
+ type: object
+ x-kubernetes-validations:
+ - message: AbsoluteTimeout must be specified when cookie lifetimeType
+ is Permanent
+ rule: '!has(self.cookieConfig.lifetimeType) || self.cookieConfig.lifetimeType
+ != ''Permanent'' || has(self.absoluteTimeout)'
+ targetRefs:
+ description: |-
+ TargetRef identifies an API object to apply policy to.
+ Currently, Backends (i.e. Service, ServiceImport, or any
+ implementation-specific backendRef) are the only valid API
+ target references.
+ items:
+ description: |-
+ LocalPolicyTargetReference identifies an API object to apply a direct or
+ inherited policy to. This should be used as part of Policy resources
+ that can target Gateway API resources. For more information on how this
+ policy attachment model works, and a sample Policy resource, refer to
+ the policy attachment documentation for Gateway API.
+ properties:
+ group:
+ description: Group is the group of the target resource.
+ maxLength: 253
+ pattern: ^$|^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$
+ type: string
+ kind:
+ description: Kind is kind of the target resource.
+ maxLength: 63
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[a-zA-Z]([-a-zA-Z0-9]*[a-zA-Z0-9])?$
+ type: string
+ name:
+ description: Name is the name of the target resource.
+ maxLength: 253
+ minLength: 1
+ type: string
+ required:
+ - group
+ - kind
+ - name
+ type: object
+ maxItems: 16
+ minItems: 1
+ type: array
+ x-kubernetes-list-map-keys:
+ - group
+ - kind
+ - name
+ x-kubernetes-list-type: map
+ required:
+ - targetRefs
+ type: object
+ status:
+ description: Status defines the current state of BackendLBPolicy.
+ properties:
+ ancestors:
+ description: |-
+ Ancestors is a list of ancestor resources (usually Gateways) that are
+ associated with the policy, and the status of the policy with respect to
+ each ancestor. When this policy attaches to a parent, the controller that
+ manages the parent and the ancestors MUST add an entry to this list when
+ the controller first sees the policy and SHOULD update the entry as
+ appropriate when the relevant ancestor is modified.
+
+
+ Note that choosing the relevant ancestor is left to the Policy designers;
+ an important part of Policy design is designing the right object level at
+ which to namespace this status.
+
+
+ Note also that implementations MUST ONLY populate ancestor status for
+ the Ancestor resources they are responsible for. Implementations MUST
+ use the ControllerName field to uniquely identify the entries in this list
+ that they are responsible for.
+
+
+ Note that to achieve this, the list of PolicyAncestorStatus structs
+ MUST be treated as a map with a composite key, made up of the AncestorRef
+ and ControllerName fields combined.
+
+
+ A maximum of 16 ancestors will be represented in this list. An empty list
+ means the Policy is not relevant for any ancestors.
+
+
+ If this slice is full, implementations MUST NOT add further entries.
+ Instead they MUST consider the policy unimplementable and signal that
+ on any related resources such as the ancestor that would be referenced
+ here. For example, if this list was full on BackendTLSPolicy, no
+ additional Gateways would be able to reference the Service targeted by
+ the BackendTLSPolicy.
+ items:
+ description: |-
+ PolicyAncestorStatus describes the status of a route with respect to an
+ associated Ancestor.
+
+
+ Ancestors refer to objects that are either the Target of a policy or above it
+ in terms of object hierarchy. For example, if a policy targets a Service, the
+ Policy's Ancestors are, in order, the Service, the HTTPRoute, the Gateway, and
+ the GatewayClass. Almost always, in this hierarchy, the Gateway will be the most
+ useful object to place Policy status on, so we recommend that implementations
+ SHOULD use Gateway as the PolicyAncestorStatus object unless the designers
+ have a _very_ good reason otherwise.
+
+
+ In the context of policy attachment, the Ancestor is used to distinguish which
+ resource results in a distinct application of this policy. For example, if a policy
+ targets a Service, it may have a distinct result per attached Gateway.
+
+
+ Policies targeting the same resource may have different effects depending on the
+ ancestors of those resources. For example, different Gateways targeting the same
+ Service may have different capabilities, especially if they have different underlying
+ implementations.
+
+
+ For example, in BackendTLSPolicy, the Policy attaches to a Service that is
+ used as a backend in a HTTPRoute that is itself attached to a Gateway.
+ In this case, the relevant object for status is the Gateway, and that is the
+ ancestor object referred to in this status.
+
+
+ Note that a parent is also an ancestor, so for objects where the parent is the
+ relevant object for status, this struct SHOULD still be used.
+
+
+ This struct is intended to be used in a slice that's effectively a map,
+ with a composite key made up of the AncestorRef and the ControllerName.
+ properties:
+ ancestorRef:
+ description: |-
+ AncestorRef corresponds with a ParentRef in the spec that this
+ PolicyAncestorStatus struct describes the status of.
+ properties:
+ group:
+ default: gateway.networking.k8s.io
+ description: |-
+ Group is the group of the referent.
+ When unspecified, "gateway.networking.k8s.io" is inferred.
+ To set the core API group (such as for a "Service" kind referent),
+ Group must be explicitly set to "" (empty string).
+
+
+ Support: Core
+ maxLength: 253
+ pattern: ^$|^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$
+ type: string
+ kind:
+ default: Gateway
+ description: |-
+ Kind is kind of the referent.
+
+
+ There are two kinds of parent resources with "Core" support:
+
+
+ * Gateway (Gateway conformance profile)
+ * Service (Mesh conformance profile, ClusterIP Services only)
+
+
+ Support for other resources is Implementation-Specific.
+ maxLength: 63
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[a-zA-Z]([-a-zA-Z0-9]*[a-zA-Z0-9])?$
+ type: string
+ name:
+ description: |-
+ Name is the name of the referent.
+
+
+ Support: Core
+ maxLength: 253
+ minLength: 1
+ type: string
+ namespace:
+ description: |-
+ Namespace is the namespace of the referent. When unspecified, this refers
+ to the local namespace of the Route.
+
+
+ Note that there are specific rules for ParentRefs which cross namespace
+ boundaries. Cross-namespace references are only valid if they are explicitly
+ allowed by something in the namespace they are referring to. For example:
+ Gateway has the AllowedRoutes field, and ReferenceGrant provides a
+ generic way to enable any other kind of cross-namespace reference.
+
+
+
+ ParentRefs from a Route to a Service in the same namespace are "producer"
+ routes, which apply default routing rules to inbound connections from
+ any namespace to the Service.
+
+
+ ParentRefs from a Route to a Service in a different namespace are
+ "consumer" routes, and these routing rules are only applied to outbound
+ connections originating from the same namespace as the Route, for which
+ the intended destination of the connections are a Service targeted as a
+ ParentRef of the Route.
+
+
+
+ Support: Core
+ maxLength: 63
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?$
+ type: string
+ port:
+ description: |-
+ Port is the network port this Route targets. It can be interpreted
+ differently based on the type of parent resource.
+
+
+ When the parent resource is a Gateway, this targets all listeners
+ listening on the specified port that also support this kind of Route(and
+ select this Route). It's not recommended to set `Port` unless the
+ networking behaviors specified in a Route must apply to a specific port
+ as opposed to a listener(s) whose port(s) may be changed. When both Port
+ and SectionName are specified, the name and port of the selected listener
+ must match both specified values.
+
+
+
+ When the parent resource is a Service, this targets a specific port in the
+ Service spec. When both Port (experimental) and SectionName are specified,
+ the name and port of the selected port must match both specified values.
+
+
+
+ Implementations MAY choose to support other parent resources.
+ Implementations supporting other types of parent resources MUST clearly
+ document how/if Port is interpreted.
+
+
+ For the purpose of status, an attachment is considered successful as
+ long as the parent resource accepts it partially. For example, Gateway
+ listeners can restrict which Routes can attach to them by Route kind,
+ namespace, or hostname. If 1 of 2 Gateway listeners accept attachment
+ from the referencing Route, the Route MUST be considered successfully
+ attached. If no Gateway listeners accept attachment from this Route,
+ the Route MUST be considered detached from the Gateway.
+
+
+ Support: Extended
+ format: int32
+ maximum: 65535
+ minimum: 1
+ type: integer
+ sectionName:
+ description: |-
+ SectionName is the name of a section within the target resource. In the
+ following resources, SectionName is interpreted as the following:
+
+
+ * Gateway: Listener name. When both Port (experimental) and SectionName
+ are specified, the name and port of the selected listener must match
+ both specified values.
+ * Service: Port name. When both Port (experimental) and SectionName
+ are specified, the name and port of the selected listener must match
+ both specified values.
+
+
+ Implementations MAY choose to support attaching Routes to other resources.
+ If that is the case, they MUST clearly document how SectionName is
+ interpreted.
+
+
+ When unspecified (empty string), this will reference the entire resource.
+ For the purpose of status, an attachment is considered successful if at
+ least one section in the parent resource accepts it. For example, Gateway
+ listeners can restrict which Routes can attach to them by Route kind,
+ namespace, or hostname. If 1 of 2 Gateway listeners accept attachment from
+ the referencing Route, the Route MUST be considered successfully
+ attached. If no Gateway listeners accept attachment from this Route, the
+ Route MUST be considered detached from the Gateway.
+
+
+ Support: Core
+ maxLength: 253
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$
+ type: string
+ required:
+ - name
+ type: object
+ conditions:
+ description: Conditions describes the status of the Policy with
+ respect to the given Ancestor.
+ items:
+ description: "Condition contains details for one aspect of
+ the current state of this API Resource.\n---\nThis struct
+ is intended for direct use as an array at the field path
+ .status.conditions. For example,\n\n\n\ttype FooStatus
+ struct{\n\t // Represents the observations of a foo's
+ current state.\n\t // Known .status.conditions.type are:
+ \"Available\", \"Progressing\", and \"Degraded\"\n\t //
+ +patchMergeKey=type\n\t // +patchStrategy=merge\n\t //
+ +listType=map\n\t // +listMapKey=type\n\t Conditions
+ []metav1.Condition `json:\"conditions,omitempty\" patchStrategy:\"merge\"
+ patchMergeKey:\"type\" protobuf:\"bytes,1,rep,name=conditions\"`\n\n\n\t
+ \ // other fields\n\t}"
+ properties:
+ lastTransitionTime:
+ description: |-
+ lastTransitionTime is the last time the condition transitioned from one status to another.
+ This should be when the underlying condition changed. If that is not known, then using the time when the API field changed is acceptable.
+ format: date-time
+ type: string
+ message:
+ description: |-
+ message is a human readable message indicating details about the transition.
+ This may be an empty string.
+ maxLength: 32768
+ type: string
+ observedGeneration:
+ description: |-
+ observedGeneration represents the .metadata.generation that the condition was set based upon.
+ For instance, if .metadata.generation is currently 12, but the .status.conditions[x].observedGeneration is 9, the condition is out of date
+ with respect to the current state of the instance.
+ format: int64
+ minimum: 0
+ type: integer
+ reason:
+ description: |-
+ reason contains a programmatic identifier indicating the reason for the condition's last transition.
+ Producers of specific condition types may define expected values and meanings for this field,
+ and whether the values are considered a guaranteed API.
+ The value should be a CamelCase string.
+ This field may not be empty.
+ maxLength: 1024
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[A-Za-z]([A-Za-z0-9_,:]*[A-Za-z0-9_])?$
+ type: string
+ status:
+ description: status of the condition, one of True, False,
+ Unknown.
+ enum:
+ - "True"
+ - "False"
+ - Unknown
+ type: string
+ type:
+ description: |-
+ type of condition in CamelCase or in foo.example.com/CamelCase.
+ ---
+ Many .condition.type values are consistent across resources like Available, but because arbitrary conditions can be
+ useful (see .node.status.conditions), the ability to deconflict is important.
+ The regex it matches is (dns1123SubdomainFmt/)?(qualifiedNameFmt)
+ maxLength: 316
+ pattern: ^([a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*/)?(([A-Za-z0-9][-A-Za-z0-9_.]*)?[A-Za-z0-9])$
+ type: string
+ required:
+ - lastTransitionTime
+ - message
+ - reason
+ - status
+ - type
+ type: object
+ maxItems: 8
+ minItems: 1
+ type: array
+ x-kubernetes-list-map-keys:
+ - type
+ x-kubernetes-list-type: map
+ controllerName:
+ description: |-
+ ControllerName is a domain/path string that indicates the name of the
+ controller that wrote this status. This corresponds with the
+ controllerName field on GatewayClass.
+
+
+ Example: "example.net/gateway-controller".
+
+
+ The format of this field is DOMAIN "/" PATH, where DOMAIN and PATH are
+ valid Kubernetes names
+ (https://kubernetes.io/docs/concepts/overview/working-with-objects/names/#names).
+
+
+ Controllers MUST populate this field when writing status. Controllers should ensure that
+ entries to status populated with their ControllerName are cleaned up when they are no
+ longer necessary.
+ maxLength: 253
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*\/[A-Za-z0-9\/\-._~%!$&'()*+,;=:]+$
+ type: string
+ required:
+ - ancestorRef
+ - controllerName
+ type: object
+ maxItems: 16
+ type: array
+ required:
+ - ancestors
+ type: object
+ required:
+ - spec
+ type: object
+ served: true
+ storage: true
+ subresources:
+ status: {}
+status:
+ acceptedNames:
+ kind: ""
+ plural: ""
+ conditions: null
+ storedVersions: null
+---
+#
+# config/crd/experimental/gateway.networking.k8s.io_backendtlspolicies.yaml
+#
+apiVersion: apiextensions.k8s.io/v1
+kind: CustomResourceDefinition
+metadata:
+ annotations:
+ api-approved.kubernetes.io: https://github.com/kubernetes-sigs/gateway-api/pull/2997
+ gateway.networking.k8s.io/bundle-version: v1.1.0
+ gateway.networking.k8s.io/channel: experimental
+ creationTimestamp: null
+ labels:
+ gateway.networking.k8s.io/policy: Direct
+ name: backendtlspolicies.gateway.networking.k8s.io
+spec:
+ group: gateway.networking.k8s.io
+ names:
+ categories:
+ - gateway-api
+ kind: BackendTLSPolicy
+ listKind: BackendTLSPolicyList
+ plural: backendtlspolicies
+ shortNames:
+ - btlspolicy
+ singular: backendtlspolicy
+ scope: Namespaced
+ versions:
+ - additionalPrinterColumns:
+ - jsonPath: .metadata.creationTimestamp
+ name: Age
+ type: date
+ name: v1alpha3
+ schema:
+ openAPIV3Schema:
+ description: |-
+ BackendTLSPolicy provides a way to configure how a Gateway
+ connects to a Backend via TLS.
+ properties:
+ apiVersion:
+ description: |-
+ APIVersion defines the versioned schema of this representation of an object.
+ Servers should convert recognized schemas to the latest internal value, and
+ may reject unrecognized values.
+ More info: https://git.k8s.io/community/contributors/devel/sig-architecture/api-conventions.md#resources
+ type: string
+ kind:
+ description: |-
+ Kind is a string value representing the REST resource this object represents.
+ Servers may infer this from the endpoint the client submits requests to.
+ Cannot be updated.
+ In CamelCase.
+ More info: https://git.k8s.io/community/contributors/devel/sig-architecture/api-conventions.md#types-kinds
+ type: string
+ metadata:
+ type: object
+ spec:
+ description: Spec defines the desired state of BackendTLSPolicy.
+ properties:
+ targetRefs:
+ description: |-
+ TargetRefs identifies an API object to apply the policy to.
+ Only Services have Extended support. Implementations MAY support
+ additional objects, with Implementation Specific support.
+ Note that this config applies to the entire referenced resource
+ by default, but this default may change in the future to provide
+ a more granular application of the policy.
+
+
+ Support: Extended for Kubernetes Service
+
+
+ Support: Implementation-specific for any other resource
+ items:
+ description: |-
+ LocalPolicyTargetReferenceWithSectionName identifies an API object to apply a
+ direct policy to. This should be used as part of Policy resources that can
+ target single resources. For more information on how this policy attachment
+ mode works, and a sample Policy resource, refer to the policy attachment
+ documentation for Gateway API.
+
+
+ Note: This should only be used for direct policy attachment when references
+ to SectionName are actually needed. In all other cases,
+ LocalPolicyTargetReference should be used.
+ properties:
+ group:
+ description: Group is the group of the target resource.
+ maxLength: 253
+ pattern: ^$|^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$
+ type: string
+ kind:
+ description: Kind is kind of the target resource.
+ maxLength: 63
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[a-zA-Z]([-a-zA-Z0-9]*[a-zA-Z0-9])?$
+ type: string
+ name:
+ description: Name is the name of the target resource.
+ maxLength: 253
+ minLength: 1
+ type: string
+ sectionName:
+ description: |-
+ SectionName is the name of a section within the target resource. When
+ unspecified, this targetRef targets the entire resource. In the following
+ resources, SectionName is interpreted as the following:
+
+
+ * Gateway: Listener name
+ * HTTPRoute: HTTPRouteRule name
+ * Service: Port name
+
+
+ If a SectionName is specified, but does not exist on the targeted object,
+ the Policy must fail to attach, and the policy implementation should record
+ a `ResolvedRefs` or similar Condition in the Policy's status.
+ maxLength: 253
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$
+ type: string
+ required:
+ - group
+ - kind
+ - name
+ type: object
+ maxItems: 16
+ minItems: 1
+ type: array
+ validation:
+ description: Validation contains backend TLS validation configuration.
+ properties:
+ caCertificateRefs:
+ description: |-
+ CACertificateRefs contains one or more references to Kubernetes objects that
+ contain a PEM-encoded TLS CA certificate bundle, which is used to
+ validate a TLS handshake between the Gateway and backend Pod.
+
+
+ If CACertificateRefs is empty or unspecified, then WellKnownCACertificates must be
+ specified. Only one of CACertificateRefs or WellKnownCACertificates may be specified,
+ not both. If CACertifcateRefs is empty or unspecified, the configuration for
+ WellKnownCACertificates MUST be honored instead if supported by the implementation.
+
+
+ References to a resource in a different namespace are invalid for the
+ moment, although we will revisit this in the future.
+
+
+ A single CACertificateRef to a Kubernetes ConfigMap kind has "Core" support.
+ Implementations MAY choose to support attaching multiple certificates to
+ a backend, but this behavior is implementation-specific.
+
+
+ Support: Core - An optional single reference to a Kubernetes ConfigMap,
+ with the CA certificate in a key named `ca.crt`.
+
+
+ Support: Implementation-specific (More than one reference, or other kinds
+ of resources).
+ items:
+ description: |-
+ LocalObjectReference identifies an API object within the namespace of the
+ referrer.
+ The API object must be valid in the cluster; the Group and Kind must
+ be registered in the cluster for this reference to be valid.
+
+
+ References to objects with invalid Group and Kind are not valid, and must
+ be rejected by the implementation, with appropriate Conditions set
+ on the containing object.
+ properties:
+ group:
+ description: |-
+ Group is the group of the referent. For example, "gateway.networking.k8s.io".
+ When unspecified or empty string, core API group is inferred.
+ maxLength: 253
+ pattern: ^$|^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$
+ type: string
+ kind:
+ description: Kind is kind of the referent. For example "HTTPRoute"
+ or "Service".
+ maxLength: 63
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[a-zA-Z]([-a-zA-Z0-9]*[a-zA-Z0-9])?$
+ type: string
+ name:
+ description: Name is the name of the referent.
+ maxLength: 253
+ minLength: 1
+ type: string
+ required:
+ - group
+ - kind
+ - name
+ type: object
+ maxItems: 8
+ type: array
+ hostname:
+ description: |-
+ Hostname is used for two purposes in the connection between Gateways and
+ backends:
+
+
+ 1. Hostname MUST be used as the SNI to connect to the backend (RFC 6066).
+ 2. Hostname MUST be used for authentication and MUST match the certificate
+ served by the matching backend.
+
+
+ Support: Core
+ maxLength: 253
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$
+ type: string
+ wellKnownCACertificates:
+ description: |-
+ WellKnownCACertificates specifies whether system CA certificates may be used in
+ the TLS handshake between the gateway and backend pod.
+
+
+ If WellKnownCACertificates is unspecified or empty (""), then CACertificateRefs
+ must be specified with at least one entry for a valid configuration. Only one of
+ CACertificateRefs or WellKnownCACertificates may be specified, not both. If an
+ implementation does not support the WellKnownCACertificates field or the value
+ supplied is not supported, the Status Conditions on the Policy MUST be
+ updated to include an Accepted: False Condition with Reason: Invalid.
+
+
+ Support: Implementation-specific
+ enum:
+ - System
+ type: string
+ required:
+ - hostname
+ type: object
+ x-kubernetes-validations:
+ - message: must not contain both CACertificateRefs and WellKnownCACertificates
+ rule: '!(has(self.caCertificateRefs) && size(self.caCertificateRefs)
+ > 0 && has(self.wellKnownCACertificates) && self.wellKnownCACertificates
+ != "")'
+ - message: must specify either CACertificateRefs or WellKnownCACertificates
+ rule: (has(self.caCertificateRefs) && size(self.caCertificateRefs)
+ > 0 || has(self.wellKnownCACertificates) && self.wellKnownCACertificates
+ != "")
+ required:
+ - targetRefs
+ - validation
+ type: object
+ status:
+ description: Status defines the current state of BackendTLSPolicy.
+ properties:
+ ancestors:
+ description: |-
+ Ancestors is a list of ancestor resources (usually Gateways) that are
+ associated with the policy, and the status of the policy with respect to
+ each ancestor. When this policy attaches to a parent, the controller that
+ manages the parent and the ancestors MUST add an entry to this list when
+ the controller first sees the policy and SHOULD update the entry as
+ appropriate when the relevant ancestor is modified.
+
+
+ Note that choosing the relevant ancestor is left to the Policy designers;
+ an important part of Policy design is designing the right object level at
+ which to namespace this status.
+
+
+ Note also that implementations MUST ONLY populate ancestor status for
+ the Ancestor resources they are responsible for. Implementations MUST
+ use the ControllerName field to uniquely identify the entries in this list
+ that they are responsible for.
+
+
+ Note that to achieve this, the list of PolicyAncestorStatus structs
+ MUST be treated as a map with a composite key, made up of the AncestorRef
+ and ControllerName fields combined.
+
+
+ A maximum of 16 ancestors will be represented in this list. An empty list
+ means the Policy is not relevant for any ancestors.
+
+
+ If this slice is full, implementations MUST NOT add further entries.
+ Instead they MUST consider the policy unimplementable and signal that
+ on any related resources such as the ancestor that would be referenced
+ here. For example, if this list was full on BackendTLSPolicy, no
+ additional Gateways would be able to reference the Service targeted by
+ the BackendTLSPolicy.
+ items:
+ description: |-
+ PolicyAncestorStatus describes the status of a route with respect to an
+ associated Ancestor.
+
+
+ Ancestors refer to objects that are either the Target of a policy or above it
+ in terms of object hierarchy. For example, if a policy targets a Service, the
+ Policy's Ancestors are, in order, the Service, the HTTPRoute, the Gateway, and
+ the GatewayClass. Almost always, in this hierarchy, the Gateway will be the most
+ useful object to place Policy status on, so we recommend that implementations
+ SHOULD use Gateway as the PolicyAncestorStatus object unless the designers
+ have a _very_ good reason otherwise.
+
+
+ In the context of policy attachment, the Ancestor is used to distinguish which
+ resource results in a distinct application of this policy. For example, if a policy
+ targets a Service, it may have a distinct result per attached Gateway.
+
+
+ Policies targeting the same resource may have different effects depending on the
+ ancestors of those resources. For example, different Gateways targeting the same
+ Service may have different capabilities, especially if they have different underlying
+ implementations.
+
+
+ For example, in BackendTLSPolicy, the Policy attaches to a Service that is
+ used as a backend in a HTTPRoute that is itself attached to a Gateway.
+ In this case, the relevant object for status is the Gateway, and that is the
+ ancestor object referred to in this status.
+
+
+ Note that a parent is also an ancestor, so for objects where the parent is the
+ relevant object for status, this struct SHOULD still be used.
+
+
+ This struct is intended to be used in a slice that's effectively a map,
+ with a composite key made up of the AncestorRef and the ControllerName.
+ properties:
+ ancestorRef:
+ description: |-
+ AncestorRef corresponds with a ParentRef in the spec that this
+ PolicyAncestorStatus struct describes the status of.
+ properties:
+ group:
+ default: gateway.networking.k8s.io
+ description: |-
+ Group is the group of the referent.
+ When unspecified, "gateway.networking.k8s.io" is inferred.
+ To set the core API group (such as for a "Service" kind referent),
+ Group must be explicitly set to "" (empty string).
+
+
+ Support: Core
+ maxLength: 253
+ pattern: ^$|^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$
+ type: string
+ kind:
+ default: Gateway
+ description: |-
+ Kind is kind of the referent.
+
+
+ There are two kinds of parent resources with "Core" support:
+
+
+ * Gateway (Gateway conformance profile)
+ * Service (Mesh conformance profile, ClusterIP Services only)
+
+
+ Support for other resources is Implementation-Specific.
+ maxLength: 63
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[a-zA-Z]([-a-zA-Z0-9]*[a-zA-Z0-9])?$
+ type: string
+ name:
+ description: |-
+ Name is the name of the referent.
+
+
+ Support: Core
+ maxLength: 253
+ minLength: 1
+ type: string
+ namespace:
+ description: |-
+ Namespace is the namespace of the referent. When unspecified, this refers
+ to the local namespace of the Route.
+
+
+ Note that there are specific rules for ParentRefs which cross namespace
+ boundaries. Cross-namespace references are only valid if they are explicitly
+ allowed by something in the namespace they are referring to. For example:
+ Gateway has the AllowedRoutes field, and ReferenceGrant provides a
+ generic way to enable any other kind of cross-namespace reference.
+
+
+
+ ParentRefs from a Route to a Service in the same namespace are "producer"
+ routes, which apply default routing rules to inbound connections from
+ any namespace to the Service.
+
+
+ ParentRefs from a Route to a Service in a different namespace are
+ "consumer" routes, and these routing rules are only applied to outbound
+ connections originating from the same namespace as the Route, for which
+ the intended destination of the connections are a Service targeted as a
+ ParentRef of the Route.
+
+
+
+ Support: Core
+ maxLength: 63
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?$
+ type: string
+ port:
+ description: |-
+ Port is the network port this Route targets. It can be interpreted
+ differently based on the type of parent resource.
+
+
+ When the parent resource is a Gateway, this targets all listeners
+ listening on the specified port that also support this kind of Route(and
+ select this Route). It's not recommended to set `Port` unless the
+ networking behaviors specified in a Route must apply to a specific port
+ as opposed to a listener(s) whose port(s) may be changed. When both Port
+ and SectionName are specified, the name and port of the selected listener
+ must match both specified values.
+
+
+
+ When the parent resource is a Service, this targets a specific port in the
+ Service spec. When both Port (experimental) and SectionName are specified,
+ the name and port of the selected port must match both specified values.
+
+
+
+ Implementations MAY choose to support other parent resources.
+ Implementations supporting other types of parent resources MUST clearly
+ document how/if Port is interpreted.
+
+
+ For the purpose of status, an attachment is considered successful as
+ long as the parent resource accepts it partially. For example, Gateway
+ listeners can restrict which Routes can attach to them by Route kind,
+ namespace, or hostname. If 1 of 2 Gateway listeners accept attachment
+ from the referencing Route, the Route MUST be considered successfully
+ attached. If no Gateway listeners accept attachment from this Route,
+ the Route MUST be considered detached from the Gateway.
+
+
+ Support: Extended
+ format: int32
+ maximum: 65535
+ minimum: 1
+ type: integer
+ sectionName:
+ description: |-
+ SectionName is the name of a section within the target resource. In the
+ following resources, SectionName is interpreted as the following:
+
+
+ * Gateway: Listener name. When both Port (experimental) and SectionName
+ are specified, the name and port of the selected listener must match
+ both specified values.
+ * Service: Port name. When both Port (experimental) and SectionName
+ are specified, the name and port of the selected listener must match
+ both specified values.
+
+
+ Implementations MAY choose to support attaching Routes to other resources.
+ If that is the case, they MUST clearly document how SectionName is
+ interpreted.
+
+
+ When unspecified (empty string), this will reference the entire resource.
+ For the purpose of status, an attachment is considered successful if at
+ least one section in the parent resource accepts it. For example, Gateway
+ listeners can restrict which Routes can attach to them by Route kind,
+ namespace, or hostname. If 1 of 2 Gateway listeners accept attachment from
+ the referencing Route, the Route MUST be considered successfully
+ attached. If no Gateway listeners accept attachment from this Route, the
+ Route MUST be considered detached from the Gateway.
+
+
+ Support: Core
+ maxLength: 253
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$
+ type: string
+ required:
+ - name
+ type: object
+ conditions:
+ description: Conditions describes the status of the Policy with
+ respect to the given Ancestor.
+ items:
+ description: "Condition contains details for one aspect of
+ the current state of this API Resource.\n---\nThis struct
+ is intended for direct use as an array at the field path
+ .status.conditions. For example,\n\n\n\ttype FooStatus
+ struct{\n\t // Represents the observations of a foo's
+ current state.\n\t // Known .status.conditions.type are:
+ \"Available\", \"Progressing\", and \"Degraded\"\n\t //
+ +patchMergeKey=type\n\t // +patchStrategy=merge\n\t //
+ +listType=map\n\t // +listMapKey=type\n\t Conditions
+ []metav1.Condition `json:\"conditions,omitempty\" patchStrategy:\"merge\"
+ patchMergeKey:\"type\" protobuf:\"bytes,1,rep,name=conditions\"`\n\n\n\t
+ \ // other fields\n\t}"
+ properties:
+ lastTransitionTime:
+ description: |-
+ lastTransitionTime is the last time the condition transitioned from one status to another.
+ This should be when the underlying condition changed. If that is not known, then using the time when the API field changed is acceptable.
+ format: date-time
+ type: string
+ message:
+ description: |-
+ message is a human readable message indicating details about the transition.
+ This may be an empty string.
+ maxLength: 32768
+ type: string
+ observedGeneration:
+ description: |-
+ observedGeneration represents the .metadata.generation that the condition was set based upon.
+ For instance, if .metadata.generation is currently 12, but the .status.conditions[x].observedGeneration is 9, the condition is out of date
+ with respect to the current state of the instance.
+ format: int64
+ minimum: 0
+ type: integer
+ reason:
+ description: |-
+ reason contains a programmatic identifier indicating the reason for the condition's last transition.
+ Producers of specific condition types may define expected values and meanings for this field,
+ and whether the values are considered a guaranteed API.
+ The value should be a CamelCase string.
+ This field may not be empty.
+ maxLength: 1024
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[A-Za-z]([A-Za-z0-9_,:]*[A-Za-z0-9_])?$
+ type: string
+ status:
+ description: status of the condition, one of True, False,
+ Unknown.
+ enum:
+ - "True"
+ - "False"
+ - Unknown
+ type: string
+ type:
+ description: |-
+ type of condition in CamelCase or in foo.example.com/CamelCase.
+ ---
+ Many .condition.type values are consistent across resources like Available, but because arbitrary conditions can be
+ useful (see .node.status.conditions), the ability to deconflict is important.
+ The regex it matches is (dns1123SubdomainFmt/)?(qualifiedNameFmt)
+ maxLength: 316
+ pattern: ^([a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*/)?(([A-Za-z0-9][-A-Za-z0-9_.]*)?[A-Za-z0-9])$
+ type: string
+ required:
+ - lastTransitionTime
+ - message
+ - reason
+ - status
+ - type
+ type: object
+ maxItems: 8
+ minItems: 1
+ type: array
+ x-kubernetes-list-map-keys:
+ - type
+ x-kubernetes-list-type: map
+ controllerName:
+ description: |-
+ ControllerName is a domain/path string that indicates the name of the
+ controller that wrote this status. This corresponds with the
+ controllerName field on GatewayClass.
+
+
+ Example: "example.net/gateway-controller".
+
+
+ The format of this field is DOMAIN "/" PATH, where DOMAIN and PATH are
+ valid Kubernetes names
+ (https://kubernetes.io/docs/concepts/overview/working-with-objects/names/#names).
+
+
+ Controllers MUST populate this field when writing status. Controllers should ensure that
+ entries to status populated with their ControllerName are cleaned up when they are no
+ longer necessary.
+ maxLength: 253
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*\/[A-Za-z0-9\/\-._~%!$&'()*+,;=:]+$
+ type: string
+ required:
+ - ancestorRef
+ - controllerName
+ type: object
+ maxItems: 16
+ type: array
+ required:
+ - ancestors
+ type: object
+ required:
+ - spec
+ type: object
+ served: true
+ storage: true
+ subresources:
+ status: {}
+status:
+ acceptedNames:
+ kind: ""
+ plural: ""
+ conditions: null
+ storedVersions: null
+---
+#
+# config/crd/experimental/gateway.networking.k8s.io_gatewayclasses.yaml
+#
+apiVersion: apiextensions.k8s.io/v1
+kind: CustomResourceDefinition
+metadata:
+ annotations:
+ api-approved.kubernetes.io: https://github.com/kubernetes-sigs/gateway-api/pull/2997
+ gateway.networking.k8s.io/bundle-version: v1.1.0
+ gateway.networking.k8s.io/channel: experimental
+ creationTimestamp: null
+ name: gatewayclasses.gateway.networking.k8s.io
+spec:
+ group: gateway.networking.k8s.io
+ names:
+ categories:
+ - gateway-api
+ kind: GatewayClass
+ listKind: GatewayClassList
+ plural: gatewayclasses
+ shortNames:
+ - gc
+ singular: gatewayclass
+ scope: Cluster
+ versions:
+ - additionalPrinterColumns:
+ - jsonPath: .spec.controllerName
+ name: Controller
+ type: string
+ - jsonPath: .status.conditions[?(@.type=="Accepted")].status
+ name: Accepted
+ type: string
+ - jsonPath: .metadata.creationTimestamp
+ name: Age
+ type: date
+ - jsonPath: .spec.description
+ name: Description
+ priority: 1
+ type: string
+ name: v1
+ schema:
+ openAPIV3Schema:
+ description: |-
+ GatewayClass describes a class of Gateways available to the user for creating
+ Gateway resources.
+
+
+ It is recommended that this resource be used as a template for Gateways. This
+ means that a Gateway is based on the state of the GatewayClass at the time it
+ was created and changes to the GatewayClass or associated parameters are not
+ propagated down to existing Gateways. This recommendation is intended to
+ limit the blast radius of changes to GatewayClass or associated parameters.
+ If implementations choose to propagate GatewayClass changes to existing
+ Gateways, that MUST be clearly documented by the implementation.
+
+
+ Whenever one or more Gateways are using a GatewayClass, implementations SHOULD
+ add the `gateway-exists-finalizer.gateway.networking.k8s.io` finalizer on the
+ associated GatewayClass. This ensures that a GatewayClass associated with a
+ Gateway is not deleted while in use.
+
+
+ GatewayClass is a Cluster level resource.
+ properties:
+ apiVersion:
+ description: |-
+ APIVersion defines the versioned schema of this representation of an object.
+ Servers should convert recognized schemas to the latest internal value, and
+ may reject unrecognized values.
+ More info: https://git.k8s.io/community/contributors/devel/sig-architecture/api-conventions.md#resources
+ type: string
+ kind:
+ description: |-
+ Kind is a string value representing the REST resource this object represents.
+ Servers may infer this from the endpoint the client submits requests to.
+ Cannot be updated.
+ In CamelCase.
+ More info: https://git.k8s.io/community/contributors/devel/sig-architecture/api-conventions.md#types-kinds
+ type: string
+ metadata:
+ type: object
+ spec:
+ description: Spec defines the desired state of GatewayClass.
+ properties:
+ controllerName:
+ description: |-
+ ControllerName is the name of the controller that is managing Gateways of
+ this class. The value of this field MUST be a domain prefixed path.
+
+
+ Example: "example.net/gateway-controller".
+
+
+ This field is not mutable and cannot be empty.
+
+
+ Support: Core
+ maxLength: 253
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*\/[A-Za-z0-9\/\-._~%!$&'()*+,;=:]+$
+ type: string
+ x-kubernetes-validations:
+ - message: Value is immutable
+ rule: self == oldSelf
+ description:
+ description: Description helps describe a GatewayClass with more details.
+ maxLength: 64
+ type: string
+ parametersRef:
+ description: |-
+ ParametersRef is a reference to a resource that contains the configuration
+ parameters corresponding to the GatewayClass. This is optional if the
+ controller does not require any additional configuration.
+
+
+ ParametersRef can reference a standard Kubernetes resource, i.e. ConfigMap,
+ or an implementation-specific custom resource. The resource can be
+ cluster-scoped or namespace-scoped.
+
+
+ If the referent cannot be found, the GatewayClass's "InvalidParameters"
+ status condition will be true.
+
+
+ A Gateway for this GatewayClass may provide its own `parametersRef`. When both are specified,
+ the merging behavior is implementation specific.
+ It is generally recommended that GatewayClass provides defaults that can be overridden by a Gateway.
+
+
+ Support: Implementation-specific
+ properties:
+ group:
+ description: Group is the group of the referent.
+ maxLength: 253
+ pattern: ^$|^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$
+ type: string
+ kind:
+ description: Kind is kind of the referent.
+ maxLength: 63
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[a-zA-Z]([-a-zA-Z0-9]*[a-zA-Z0-9])?$
+ type: string
+ name:
+ description: Name is the name of the referent.
+ maxLength: 253
+ minLength: 1
+ type: string
+ namespace:
+ description: |-
+ Namespace is the namespace of the referent.
+ This field is required when referring to a Namespace-scoped resource and
+ MUST be unset when referring to a Cluster-scoped resource.
+ maxLength: 63
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?$
+ type: string
+ required:
+ - group
+ - kind
+ - name
+ type: object
+ required:
+ - controllerName
+ type: object
+ status:
+ default:
+ conditions:
+ - lastTransitionTime: "1970-01-01T00:00:00Z"
+ message: Waiting for controller
+ reason: Waiting
+ status: Unknown
+ type: Accepted
+ description: |-
+ Status defines the current state of GatewayClass.
+
+
+ Implementations MUST populate status on all GatewayClass resources which
+ specify their controller name.
+ properties:
+ conditions:
+ default:
+ - lastTransitionTime: "1970-01-01T00:00:00Z"
+ message: Waiting for controller
+ reason: Pending
+ status: Unknown
+ type: Accepted
+ description: |-
+ Conditions is the current status from the controller for
+ this GatewayClass.
+
+
+ Controllers should prefer to publish conditions using values
+ of GatewayClassConditionType for the type of each Condition.
+ items:
+ description: "Condition contains details for one aspect of the current
+ state of this API Resource.\n---\nThis struct is intended for
+ direct use as an array at the field path .status.conditions. For
+ example,\n\n\n\ttype FooStatus struct{\n\t // Represents the
+ observations of a foo's current state.\n\t // Known .status.conditions.type
+ are: \"Available\", \"Progressing\", and \"Degraded\"\n\t //
+ +patchMergeKey=type\n\t // +patchStrategy=merge\n\t // +listType=map\n\t
+ \ // +listMapKey=type\n\t Conditions []metav1.Condition `json:\"conditions,omitempty\"
+ patchStrategy:\"merge\" patchMergeKey:\"type\" protobuf:\"bytes,1,rep,name=conditions\"`\n\n\n\t
+ \ // other fields\n\t}"
+ properties:
+ lastTransitionTime:
+ description: |-
+ lastTransitionTime is the last time the condition transitioned from one status to another.
+ This should be when the underlying condition changed. If that is not known, then using the time when the API field changed is acceptable.
+ format: date-time
+ type: string
+ message:
+ description: |-
+ message is a human readable message indicating details about the transition.
+ This may be an empty string.
+ maxLength: 32768
+ type: string
+ observedGeneration:
+ description: |-
+ observedGeneration represents the .metadata.generation that the condition was set based upon.
+ For instance, if .metadata.generation is currently 12, but the .status.conditions[x].observedGeneration is 9, the condition is out of date
+ with respect to the current state of the instance.
+ format: int64
+ minimum: 0
+ type: integer
+ reason:
+ description: |-
+ reason contains a programmatic identifier indicating the reason for the condition's last transition.
+ Producers of specific condition types may define expected values and meanings for this field,
+ and whether the values are considered a guaranteed API.
+ The value should be a CamelCase string.
+ This field may not be empty.
+ maxLength: 1024
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[A-Za-z]([A-Za-z0-9_,:]*[A-Za-z0-9_])?$
+ type: string
+ status:
+ description: status of the condition, one of True, False, Unknown.
+ enum:
+ - "True"
+ - "False"
+ - Unknown
+ type: string
+ type:
+ description: |-
+ type of condition in CamelCase or in foo.example.com/CamelCase.
+ ---
+ Many .condition.type values are consistent across resources like Available, but because arbitrary conditions can be
+ useful (see .node.status.conditions), the ability to deconflict is important.
+ The regex it matches is (dns1123SubdomainFmt/)?(qualifiedNameFmt)
+ maxLength: 316
+ pattern: ^([a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*/)?(([A-Za-z0-9][-A-Za-z0-9_.]*)?[A-Za-z0-9])$
+ type: string
+ required:
+ - lastTransitionTime
+ - message
+ - reason
+ - status
+ - type
+ type: object
+ maxItems: 8
+ type: array
+ x-kubernetes-list-map-keys:
+ - type
+ x-kubernetes-list-type: map
+ supportedFeatures:
+ description: |
+ SupportedFeatures is the set of features the GatewayClass support.
+ It MUST be sorted in ascending alphabetical order.
+ items:
+ description: |-
+ SupportedFeature is used to describe distinct features that are covered by
+ conformance tests.
+ type: string
+ maxItems: 64
+ type: array
+ x-kubernetes-list-type: set
+ type: object
+ required:
+ - spec
+ type: object
+ served: true
+ storage: true
+ subresources:
+ status: {}
+ - additionalPrinterColumns:
+ - jsonPath: .spec.controllerName
+ name: Controller
+ type: string
+ - jsonPath: .status.conditions[?(@.type=="Accepted")].status
+ name: Accepted
+ type: string
+ - jsonPath: .metadata.creationTimestamp
+ name: Age
+ type: date
+ - jsonPath: .spec.description
+ name: Description
+ priority: 1
+ type: string
+ name: v1beta1
+ schema:
+ openAPIV3Schema:
+ description: |-
+ GatewayClass describes a class of Gateways available to the user for creating
+ Gateway resources.
+
+
+ It is recommended that this resource be used as a template for Gateways. This
+ means that a Gateway is based on the state of the GatewayClass at the time it
+ was created and changes to the GatewayClass or associated parameters are not
+ propagated down to existing Gateways. This recommendation is intended to
+ limit the blast radius of changes to GatewayClass or associated parameters.
+ If implementations choose to propagate GatewayClass changes to existing
+ Gateways, that MUST be clearly documented by the implementation.
+
+
+ Whenever one or more Gateways are using a GatewayClass, implementations SHOULD
+ add the `gateway-exists-finalizer.gateway.networking.k8s.io` finalizer on the
+ associated GatewayClass. This ensures that a GatewayClass associated with a
+ Gateway is not deleted while in use.
+
+
+ GatewayClass is a Cluster level resource.
+ properties:
+ apiVersion:
+ description: |-
+ APIVersion defines the versioned schema of this representation of an object.
+ Servers should convert recognized schemas to the latest internal value, and
+ may reject unrecognized values.
+ More info: https://git.k8s.io/community/contributors/devel/sig-architecture/api-conventions.md#resources
+ type: string
+ kind:
+ description: |-
+ Kind is a string value representing the REST resource this object represents.
+ Servers may infer this from the endpoint the client submits requests to.
+ Cannot be updated.
+ In CamelCase.
+ More info: https://git.k8s.io/community/contributors/devel/sig-architecture/api-conventions.md#types-kinds
+ type: string
+ metadata:
+ type: object
+ spec:
+ description: Spec defines the desired state of GatewayClass.
+ properties:
+ controllerName:
+ description: |-
+ ControllerName is the name of the controller that is managing Gateways of
+ this class. The value of this field MUST be a domain prefixed path.
+
+
+ Example: "example.net/gateway-controller".
+
+
+ This field is not mutable and cannot be empty.
+
+
+ Support: Core
+ maxLength: 253
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*\/[A-Za-z0-9\/\-._~%!$&'()*+,;=:]+$
+ type: string
+ x-kubernetes-validations:
+ - message: Value is immutable
+ rule: self == oldSelf
+ description:
+ description: Description helps describe a GatewayClass with more details.
+ maxLength: 64
+ type: string
+ parametersRef:
+ description: |-
+ ParametersRef is a reference to a resource that contains the configuration
+ parameters corresponding to the GatewayClass. This is optional if the
+ controller does not require any additional configuration.
+
+
+ ParametersRef can reference a standard Kubernetes resource, i.e. ConfigMap,
+ or an implementation-specific custom resource. The resource can be
+ cluster-scoped or namespace-scoped.
+
+
+ If the referent cannot be found, the GatewayClass's "InvalidParameters"
+ status condition will be true.
+
+
+ A Gateway for this GatewayClass may provide its own `parametersRef`. When both are specified,
+ the merging behavior is implementation specific.
+ It is generally recommended that GatewayClass provides defaults that can be overridden by a Gateway.
+
+
+ Support: Implementation-specific
+ properties:
+ group:
+ description: Group is the group of the referent.
+ maxLength: 253
+ pattern: ^$|^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$
+ type: string
+ kind:
+ description: Kind is kind of the referent.
+ maxLength: 63
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[a-zA-Z]([-a-zA-Z0-9]*[a-zA-Z0-9])?$
+ type: string
+ name:
+ description: Name is the name of the referent.
+ maxLength: 253
+ minLength: 1
+ type: string
+ namespace:
+ description: |-
+ Namespace is the namespace of the referent.
+ This field is required when referring to a Namespace-scoped resource and
+ MUST be unset when referring to a Cluster-scoped resource.
+ maxLength: 63
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?$
+ type: string
+ required:
+ - group
+ - kind
+ - name
+ type: object
+ required:
+ - controllerName
+ type: object
+ status:
+ default:
+ conditions:
+ - lastTransitionTime: "1970-01-01T00:00:00Z"
+ message: Waiting for controller
+ reason: Waiting
+ status: Unknown
+ type: Accepted
+ description: |-
+ Status defines the current state of GatewayClass.
+
+
+ Implementations MUST populate status on all GatewayClass resources which
+ specify their controller name.
+ properties:
+ conditions:
+ default:
+ - lastTransitionTime: "1970-01-01T00:00:00Z"
+ message: Waiting for controller
+ reason: Pending
+ status: Unknown
+ type: Accepted
+ description: |-
+ Conditions is the current status from the controller for
+ this GatewayClass.
+
+
+ Controllers should prefer to publish conditions using values
+ of GatewayClassConditionType for the type of each Condition.
+ items:
+ description: "Condition contains details for one aspect of the current
+ state of this API Resource.\n---\nThis struct is intended for
+ direct use as an array at the field path .status.conditions. For
+ example,\n\n\n\ttype FooStatus struct{\n\t // Represents the
+ observations of a foo's current state.\n\t // Known .status.conditions.type
+ are: \"Available\", \"Progressing\", and \"Degraded\"\n\t //
+ +patchMergeKey=type\n\t // +patchStrategy=merge\n\t // +listType=map\n\t
+ \ // +listMapKey=type\n\t Conditions []metav1.Condition `json:\"conditions,omitempty\"
+ patchStrategy:\"merge\" patchMergeKey:\"type\" protobuf:\"bytes,1,rep,name=conditions\"`\n\n\n\t
+ \ // other fields\n\t}"
+ properties:
+ lastTransitionTime:
+ description: |-
+ lastTransitionTime is the last time the condition transitioned from one status to another.
+ This should be when the underlying condition changed. If that is not known, then using the time when the API field changed is acceptable.
+ format: date-time
+ type: string
+ message:
+ description: |-
+ message is a human readable message indicating details about the transition.
+ This may be an empty string.
+ maxLength: 32768
+ type: string
+ observedGeneration:
+ description: |-
+ observedGeneration represents the .metadata.generation that the condition was set based upon.
+ For instance, if .metadata.generation is currently 12, but the .status.conditions[x].observedGeneration is 9, the condition is out of date
+ with respect to the current state of the instance.
+ format: int64
+ minimum: 0
+ type: integer
+ reason:
+ description: |-
+ reason contains a programmatic identifier indicating the reason for the condition's last transition.
+ Producers of specific condition types may define expected values and meanings for this field,
+ and whether the values are considered a guaranteed API.
+ The value should be a CamelCase string.
+ This field may not be empty.
+ maxLength: 1024
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[A-Za-z]([A-Za-z0-9_,:]*[A-Za-z0-9_])?$
+ type: string
+ status:
+ description: status of the condition, one of True, False, Unknown.
+ enum:
+ - "True"
+ - "False"
+ - Unknown
+ type: string
+ type:
+ description: |-
+ type of condition in CamelCase or in foo.example.com/CamelCase.
+ ---
+ Many .condition.type values are consistent across resources like Available, but because arbitrary conditions can be
+ useful (see .node.status.conditions), the ability to deconflict is important.
+ The regex it matches is (dns1123SubdomainFmt/)?(qualifiedNameFmt)
+ maxLength: 316
+ pattern: ^([a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*/)?(([A-Za-z0-9][-A-Za-z0-9_.]*)?[A-Za-z0-9])$
+ type: string
+ required:
+ - lastTransitionTime
+ - message
+ - reason
+ - status
+ - type
+ type: object
+ maxItems: 8
+ type: array
+ x-kubernetes-list-map-keys:
+ - type
+ x-kubernetes-list-type: map
+ supportedFeatures:
+ description: |
+ SupportedFeatures is the set of features the GatewayClass support.
+ It MUST be sorted in ascending alphabetical order.
+ items:
+ description: |-
+ SupportedFeature is used to describe distinct features that are covered by
+ conformance tests.
+ type: string
+ maxItems: 64
+ type: array
+ x-kubernetes-list-type: set
+ type: object
+ required:
+ - spec
+ type: object
+ served: true
+ storage: false
+ subresources:
+ status: {}
+status:
+ acceptedNames:
+ kind: ""
+ plural: ""
+ conditions: null
+ storedVersions: null
+---
+#
+# config/crd/experimental/gateway.networking.k8s.io_gateways.yaml
+#
+apiVersion: apiextensions.k8s.io/v1
+kind: CustomResourceDefinition
+metadata:
+ annotations:
+ api-approved.kubernetes.io: https://github.com/kubernetes-sigs/gateway-api/pull/2997
+ gateway.networking.k8s.io/bundle-version: v1.1.0
+ gateway.networking.k8s.io/channel: experimental
+ creationTimestamp: null
+ name: gateways.gateway.networking.k8s.io
+spec:
+ group: gateway.networking.k8s.io
+ names:
+ categories:
+ - gateway-api
+ kind: Gateway
+ listKind: GatewayList
+ plural: gateways
+ shortNames:
+ - gtw
+ singular: gateway
+ scope: Namespaced
+ versions:
+ - additionalPrinterColumns:
+ - jsonPath: .spec.gatewayClassName
+ name: Class
+ type: string
+ - jsonPath: .status.addresses[*].value
+ name: Address
+ type: string
+ - jsonPath: .status.conditions[?(@.type=="Programmed")].status
+ name: Programmed
+ type: string
+ - jsonPath: .metadata.creationTimestamp
+ name: Age
+ type: date
+ name: v1
+ schema:
+ openAPIV3Schema:
+ description: |-
+ Gateway represents an instance of a service-traffic handling infrastructure
+ by binding Listeners to a set of IP addresses.
+ properties:
+ apiVersion:
+ description: |-
+ APIVersion defines the versioned schema of this representation of an object.
+ Servers should convert recognized schemas to the latest internal value, and
+ may reject unrecognized values.
+ More info: https://git.k8s.io/community/contributors/devel/sig-architecture/api-conventions.md#resources
+ type: string
+ kind:
+ description: |-
+ Kind is a string value representing the REST resource this object represents.
+ Servers may infer this from the endpoint the client submits requests to.
+ Cannot be updated.
+ In CamelCase.
+ More info: https://git.k8s.io/community/contributors/devel/sig-architecture/api-conventions.md#types-kinds
+ type: string
+ metadata:
+ type: object
+ spec:
+ description: Spec defines the desired state of Gateway.
+ properties:
+ addresses:
+ description: |+
+ Addresses requested for this Gateway. This is optional and behavior can
+ depend on the implementation. If a value is set in the spec and the
+ requested address is invalid or unavailable, the implementation MUST
+ indicate this in the associated entry in GatewayStatus.Addresses.
+
+
+ The Addresses field represents a request for the address(es) on the
+ "outside of the Gateway", that traffic bound for this Gateway will use.
+ This could be the IP address or hostname of an external load balancer or
+ other networking infrastructure, or some other address that traffic will
+ be sent to.
+
+
+ If no Addresses are specified, the implementation MAY schedule the
+ Gateway in an implementation-specific manner, assigning an appropriate
+ set of Addresses.
+
+
+ The implementation MUST bind all Listeners to every GatewayAddress that
+ it assigns to the Gateway and add a corresponding entry in
+ GatewayStatus.Addresses.
+
+
+ Support: Extended
+
+
+ items:
+ description: GatewayAddress describes an address that can be bound
+ to a Gateway.
+ oneOf:
+ - properties:
+ type:
+ enum:
+ - IPAddress
+ value:
+ anyOf:
+ - format: ipv4
+ - format: ipv6
+ - properties:
+ type:
+ not:
+ enum:
+ - IPAddress
+ properties:
+ type:
+ default: IPAddress
+ description: Type of the address.
+ maxLength: 253
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^Hostname|IPAddress|NamedAddress|[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*\/[A-Za-z0-9\/\-._~%!$&'()*+,;=:]+$
+ type: string
+ value:
+ description: |-
+ Value of the address. The validity of the values will depend
+ on the type and support by the controller.
+
+
+ Examples: `1.2.3.4`, `128::1`, `my-ip-address`.
+ maxLength: 253
+ minLength: 1
+ type: string
+ required:
+ - value
+ type: object
+ x-kubernetes-validations:
+ - message: Hostname value must only contain valid characters (matching
+ ^(\*\.)?[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$)
+ rule: 'self.type == ''Hostname'' ? self.value.matches(r"""^(\*\.)?[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$"""):
+ true'
+ maxItems: 16
+ type: array
+ x-kubernetes-validations:
+ - message: IPAddress values must be unique
+ rule: 'self.all(a1, a1.type == ''IPAddress'' ? self.exists_one(a2,
+ a2.type == a1.type && a2.value == a1.value) : true )'
+ - message: Hostname values must be unique
+ rule: 'self.all(a1, a1.type == ''Hostname'' ? self.exists_one(a2,
+ a2.type == a1.type && a2.value == a1.value) : true )'
+ gatewayClassName:
+ description: |-
+ GatewayClassName used for this Gateway. This is the name of a
+ GatewayClass resource.
+ maxLength: 253
+ minLength: 1
+ type: string
+ infrastructure:
+ description: |+
+ Infrastructure defines infrastructure level attributes about this Gateway instance.
+
+
+ Support: Core
+
+
+ properties:
+ annotations:
+ additionalProperties:
+ description: |-
+ AnnotationValue is the value of an annotation in Gateway API. This is used
+ for validation of maps such as TLS options. This roughly matches Kubernetes
+ annotation validation, although the length validation in that case is based
+ on the entire size of the annotations struct.
+ maxLength: 4096
+ minLength: 0
+ type: string
+ description: |-
+ Annotations that SHOULD be applied to any resources created in response to this Gateway.
+
+
+ For implementations creating other Kubernetes objects, this should be the `metadata.annotations` field on resources.
+ For other implementations, this refers to any relevant (implementation specific) "annotations" concepts.
+
+
+ An implementation may chose to add additional implementation-specific annotations as they see fit.
+
+
+ Support: Extended
+ maxProperties: 8
+ type: object
+ labels:
+ additionalProperties:
+ description: |-
+ AnnotationValue is the value of an annotation in Gateway API. This is used
+ for validation of maps such as TLS options. This roughly matches Kubernetes
+ annotation validation, although the length validation in that case is based
+ on the entire size of the annotations struct.
+ maxLength: 4096
+ minLength: 0
+ type: string
+ description: |-
+ Labels that SHOULD be applied to any resources created in response to this Gateway.
+
+
+ For implementations creating other Kubernetes objects, this should be the `metadata.labels` field on resources.
+ For other implementations, this refers to any relevant (implementation specific) "labels" concepts.
+
+
+ An implementation may chose to add additional implementation-specific labels as they see fit.
+
+
+ Support: Extended
+ maxProperties: 8
+ type: object
+ parametersRef:
+ description: |-
+ ParametersRef is a reference to a resource that contains the configuration
+ parameters corresponding to the Gateway. This is optional if the
+ controller does not require any additional configuration.
+
+
+ This follows the same semantics as GatewayClass's `parametersRef`, but on a per-Gateway basis
+
+
+ The Gateway's GatewayClass may provide its own `parametersRef`. When both are specified,
+ the merging behavior is implementation specific.
+ It is generally recommended that GatewayClass provides defaults that can be overridden by a Gateway.
+
+
+ Support: Implementation-specific
+ properties:
+ group:
+ description: Group is the group of the referent.
+ maxLength: 253
+ pattern: ^$|^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$
+ type: string
+ kind:
+ description: Kind is kind of the referent.
+ maxLength: 63
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[a-zA-Z]([-a-zA-Z0-9]*[a-zA-Z0-9])?$
+ type: string
+ name:
+ description: Name is the name of the referent.
+ maxLength: 253
+ minLength: 1
+ type: string
+ required:
+ - group
+ - kind
+ - name
+ type: object
+ type: object
+ listeners:
+ description: |-
+ Listeners associated with this Gateway. Listeners define
+ logical endpoints that are bound on this Gateway's addresses.
+ At least one Listener MUST be specified.
+
+
+ Each Listener in a set of Listeners (for example, in a single Gateway)
+ MUST be _distinct_, in that a traffic flow MUST be able to be assigned to
+ exactly one listener. (This section uses "set of Listeners" rather than
+ "Listeners in a single Gateway" because implementations MAY merge configuration
+ from multiple Gateways onto a single data plane, and these rules _also_
+ apply in that case).
+
+
+ Practically, this means that each listener in a set MUST have a unique
+ combination of Port, Protocol, and, if supported by the protocol, Hostname.
+
+
+ Some combinations of port, protocol, and TLS settings are considered
+ Core support and MUST be supported by implementations based on their
+ targeted conformance profile:
+
+
+ HTTP Profile
+
+
+ 1. HTTPRoute, Port: 80, Protocol: HTTP
+ 2. HTTPRoute, Port: 443, Protocol: HTTPS, TLS Mode: Terminate, TLS keypair provided
+
+
+ TLS Profile
+
+
+ 1. TLSRoute, Port: 443, Protocol: TLS, TLS Mode: Passthrough
+
+
+ "Distinct" Listeners have the following property:
+
+
+ The implementation can match inbound requests to a single distinct
+ Listener. When multiple Listeners share values for fields (for
+ example, two Listeners with the same Port value), the implementation
+ can match requests to only one of the Listeners using other
+ Listener fields.
+
+
+ For example, the following Listener scenarios are distinct:
+
+
+ 1. Multiple Listeners with the same Port that all use the "HTTP"
+ Protocol that all have unique Hostname values.
+ 2. Multiple Listeners with the same Port that use either the "HTTPS" or
+ "TLS" Protocol that all have unique Hostname values.
+ 3. A mixture of "TCP" and "UDP" Protocol Listeners, where no Listener
+ with the same Protocol has the same Port value.
+
+
+ Some fields in the Listener struct have possible values that affect
+ whether the Listener is distinct. Hostname is particularly relevant
+ for HTTP or HTTPS protocols.
+
+
+ When using the Hostname value to select between same-Port, same-Protocol
+ Listeners, the Hostname value must be different on each Listener for the
+ Listener to be distinct.
+
+
+ When the Listeners are distinct based on Hostname, inbound request
+ hostnames MUST match from the most specific to least specific Hostname
+ values to choose the correct Listener and its associated set of Routes.
+
+
+ Exact matches must be processed before wildcard matches, and wildcard
+ matches must be processed before fallback (empty Hostname value)
+ matches. For example, `"foo.example.com"` takes precedence over
+ `"*.example.com"`, and `"*.example.com"` takes precedence over `""`.
+
+
+ Additionally, if there are multiple wildcard entries, more specific
+ wildcard entries must be processed before less specific wildcard entries.
+ For example, `"*.foo.example.com"` takes precedence over `"*.example.com"`.
+ The precise definition here is that the higher the number of dots in the
+ hostname to the right of the wildcard character, the higher the precedence.
+
+
+ The wildcard character will match any number of characters _and dots_ to
+ the left, however, so `"*.example.com"` will match both
+ `"foo.bar.example.com"` _and_ `"bar.example.com"`.
+
+
+ If a set of Listeners contains Listeners that are not distinct, then those
+ Listeners are Conflicted, and the implementation MUST set the "Conflicted"
+ condition in the Listener Status to "True".
+
+
+ Implementations MAY choose to accept a Gateway with some Conflicted
+ Listeners only if they only accept the partial Listener set that contains
+ no Conflicted Listeners. To put this another way, implementations may
+ accept a partial Listener set only if they throw out *all* the conflicting
+ Listeners. No picking one of the conflicting listeners as the winner.
+ This also means that the Gateway must have at least one non-conflicting
+ Listener in this case, otherwise it violates the requirement that at
+ least one Listener must be present.
+
+
+ The implementation MUST set a "ListenersNotValid" condition on the
+ Gateway Status when the Gateway contains Conflicted Listeners whether or
+ not they accept the Gateway. That Condition SHOULD clearly
+ indicate in the Message which Listeners are conflicted, and which are
+ Accepted. Additionally, the Listener status for those listeners SHOULD
+ indicate which Listeners are conflicted and not Accepted.
+
+
+ A Gateway's Listeners are considered "compatible" if:
+
+
+ 1. They are distinct.
+ 2. The implementation can serve them in compliance with the Addresses
+ requirement that all Listeners are available on all assigned
+ addresses.
+
+
+ Compatible combinations in Extended support are expected to vary across
+ implementations. A combination that is compatible for one implementation
+ may not be compatible for another.
+
+
+ For example, an implementation that cannot serve both TCP and UDP listeners
+ on the same address, or cannot mix HTTPS and generic TLS listens on the same port
+ would not consider those cases compatible, even though they are distinct.
+
+
+ Note that requests SHOULD match at most one Listener. For example, if
+ Listeners are defined for "foo.example.com" and "*.example.com", a
+ request to "foo.example.com" SHOULD only be routed using routes attached
+ to the "foo.example.com" Listener (and not the "*.example.com" Listener).
+ This concept is known as "Listener Isolation". Implementations that do
+ not support Listener Isolation MUST clearly document this.
+
+
+ Implementations MAY merge separate Gateways onto a single set of
+ Addresses if all Listeners across all Gateways are compatible.
+
+
+ Support: Core
+ items:
+ description: |-
+ Listener embodies the concept of a logical endpoint where a Gateway accepts
+ network connections.
+ properties:
+ allowedRoutes:
+ default:
+ namespaces:
+ from: Same
+ description: |-
+ AllowedRoutes defines the types of routes that MAY be attached to a
+ Listener and the trusted namespaces where those Route resources MAY be
+ present.
+
+
+ Although a client request may match multiple route rules, only one rule
+ may ultimately receive the request. Matching precedence MUST be
+ determined in order of the following criteria:
+
+
+ * The most specific match as defined by the Route type.
+ * The oldest Route based on creation timestamp. For example, a Route with
+ a creation timestamp of "2020-09-08 01:02:03" is given precedence over
+ a Route with a creation timestamp of "2020-09-08 01:02:04".
+ * If everything else is equivalent, the Route appearing first in
+ alphabetical order (namespace/name) should be given precedence. For
+ example, foo/bar is given precedence over foo/baz.
+
+
+ All valid rules within a Route attached to this Listener should be
+ implemented. Invalid Route rules can be ignored (sometimes that will mean
+ the full Route). If a Route rule transitions from valid to invalid,
+ support for that Route rule should be dropped to ensure consistency. For
+ example, even if a filter specified by a Route rule is invalid, the rest
+ of the rules within that Route should still be supported.
+
+
+ Support: Core
+ properties:
+ kinds:
+ description: |-
+ Kinds specifies the groups and kinds of Routes that are allowed to bind
+ to this Gateway Listener. When unspecified or empty, the kinds of Routes
+ selected are determined using the Listener protocol.
+
+
+ A RouteGroupKind MUST correspond to kinds of Routes that are compatible
+ with the application protocol specified in the Listener's Protocol field.
+ If an implementation does not support or recognize this resource type, it
+ MUST set the "ResolvedRefs" condition to False for this Listener with the
+ "InvalidRouteKinds" reason.
+
+
+ Support: Core
+ items:
+ description: RouteGroupKind indicates the group and kind
+ of a Route resource.
+ properties:
+ group:
+ default: gateway.networking.k8s.io
+ description: Group is the group of the Route.
+ maxLength: 253
+ pattern: ^$|^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$
+ type: string
+ kind:
+ description: Kind is the kind of the Route.
+ maxLength: 63
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[a-zA-Z]([-a-zA-Z0-9]*[a-zA-Z0-9])?$
+ type: string
+ required:
+ - kind
+ type: object
+ maxItems: 8
+ type: array
+ namespaces:
+ default:
+ from: Same
+ description: |-
+ Namespaces indicates namespaces from which Routes may be attached to this
+ Listener. This is restricted to the namespace of this Gateway by default.
+
+
+ Support: Core
+ properties:
+ from:
+ default: Same
+ description: |-
+ From indicates where Routes will be selected for this Gateway. Possible
+ values are:
+
+
+ * All: Routes in all namespaces may be used by this Gateway.
+ * Selector: Routes in namespaces selected by the selector may be used by
+ this Gateway.
+ * Same: Only Routes in the same namespace may be used by this Gateway.
+
+
+ Support: Core
+ enum:
+ - All
+ - Selector
+ - Same
+ type: string
+ selector:
+ description: |-
+ Selector must be specified when From is set to "Selector". In that case,
+ only Routes in Namespaces matching this Selector will be selected by this
+ Gateway. This field is ignored for other values of "From".
+
+
+ Support: Core
+ properties:
+ matchExpressions:
+ description: matchExpressions is a list of label
+ selector requirements. The requirements are ANDed.
+ items:
+ description: |-
+ A label selector requirement is a selector that contains values, a key, and an operator that
+ relates the key and values.
+ properties:
+ key:
+ description: key is the label key that the
+ selector applies to.
+ type: string
+ operator:
+ description: |-
+ operator represents a key's relationship to a set of values.
+ Valid operators are In, NotIn, Exists and DoesNotExist.
+ type: string
+ values:
+ description: |-
+ values is an array of string values. If the operator is In or NotIn,
+ the values array must be non-empty. If the operator is Exists or DoesNotExist,
+ the values array must be empty. This array is replaced during a strategic
+ merge patch.
+ items:
+ type: string
+ type: array
+ x-kubernetes-list-type: atomic
+ required:
+ - key
+ - operator
+ type: object
+ type: array
+ x-kubernetes-list-type: atomic
+ matchLabels:
+ additionalProperties:
+ type: string
+ description: |-
+ matchLabels is a map of {key,value} pairs. A single {key,value} in the matchLabels
+ map is equivalent to an element of matchExpressions, whose key field is "key", the
+ operator is "In", and the values array contains only "value". The requirements are ANDed.
+ type: object
+ type: object
+ x-kubernetes-map-type: atomic
+ type: object
+ type: object
+ hostname:
+ description: |-
+ Hostname specifies the virtual hostname to match for protocol types that
+ define this concept. When unspecified, all hostnames are matched. This
+ field is ignored for protocols that don't require hostname based
+ matching.
+
+
+ Implementations MUST apply Hostname matching appropriately for each of
+ the following protocols:
+
+
+ * TLS: The Listener Hostname MUST match the SNI.
+ * HTTP: The Listener Hostname MUST match the Host header of the request.
+ * HTTPS: The Listener Hostname SHOULD match at both the TLS and HTTP
+ protocol layers as described above. If an implementation does not
+ ensure that both the SNI and Host header match the Listener hostname,
+ it MUST clearly document that.
+
+
+ For HTTPRoute and TLSRoute resources, there is an interaction with the
+ `spec.hostnames` array. When both listener and route specify hostnames,
+ there MUST be an intersection between the values for a Route to be
+ accepted. For more information, refer to the Route specific Hostnames
+ documentation.
+
+
+ Hostnames that are prefixed with a wildcard label (`*.`) are interpreted
+ as a suffix match. That means that a match for `*.example.com` would match
+ both `test.example.com`, and `foo.test.example.com`, but not `example.com`.
+
+
+ Support: Core
+ maxLength: 253
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^(\*\.)?[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$
+ type: string
+ name:
+ description: |-
+ Name is the name of the Listener. This name MUST be unique within a
+ Gateway.
+
+
+ Support: Core
+ maxLength: 253
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$
+ type: string
+ port:
+ description: |-
+ Port is the network port. Multiple listeners may use the
+ same port, subject to the Listener compatibility rules.
+
+
+ Support: Core
+ format: int32
+ maximum: 65535
+ minimum: 1
+ type: integer
+ protocol:
+ description: |-
+ Protocol specifies the network protocol this listener expects to receive.
+
+
+ Support: Core
+ maxLength: 255
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[a-zA-Z0-9]([-a-zSA-Z0-9]*[a-zA-Z0-9])?$|[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*\/[A-Za-z0-9]+$
+ type: string
+ tls:
+ description: |-
+ TLS is the TLS configuration for the Listener. This field is required if
+ the Protocol field is "HTTPS" or "TLS". It is invalid to set this field
+ if the Protocol field is "HTTP", "TCP", or "UDP".
+
+
+ The association of SNIs to Certificate defined in GatewayTLSConfig is
+ defined based on the Hostname field for this listener.
+
+
+ The GatewayClass MUST use the longest matching SNI out of all
+ available certificates for any TLS handshake.
+
+
+ Support: Core
+ properties:
+ certificateRefs:
+ description: |-
+ CertificateRefs contains a series of references to Kubernetes objects that
+ contains TLS certificates and private keys. These certificates are used to
+ establish a TLS handshake for requests that match the hostname of the
+ associated listener.
+
+
+ A single CertificateRef to a Kubernetes Secret has "Core" support.
+ Implementations MAY choose to support attaching multiple certificates to
+ a Listener, but this behavior is implementation-specific.
+
+
+ References to a resource in different namespace are invalid UNLESS there
+ is a ReferenceGrant in the target namespace that allows the certificate
+ to be attached. If a ReferenceGrant does not allow this reference, the
+ "ResolvedRefs" condition MUST be set to False for this listener with the
+ "RefNotPermitted" reason.
+
+
+ This field is required to have at least one element when the mode is set
+ to "Terminate" (default) and is optional otherwise.
+
+
+ CertificateRefs can reference to standard Kubernetes resources, i.e.
+ Secret, or implementation-specific custom resources.
+
+
+ Support: Core - A single reference to a Kubernetes Secret of type kubernetes.io/tls
+
+
+ Support: Implementation-specific (More than one reference or other resource types)
+ items:
+ description: |-
+ SecretObjectReference identifies an API object including its namespace,
+ defaulting to Secret.
+
+
+ The API object must be valid in the cluster; the Group and Kind must
+ be registered in the cluster for this reference to be valid.
+
+
+ References to objects with invalid Group and Kind are not valid, and must
+ be rejected by the implementation, with appropriate Conditions set
+ on the containing object.
+ properties:
+ group:
+ default: ""
+ description: |-
+ Group is the group of the referent. For example, "gateway.networking.k8s.io".
+ When unspecified or empty string, core API group is inferred.
+ maxLength: 253
+ pattern: ^$|^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$
+ type: string
+ kind:
+ default: Secret
+ description: Kind is kind of the referent. For example
+ "Secret".
+ maxLength: 63
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[a-zA-Z]([-a-zA-Z0-9]*[a-zA-Z0-9])?$
+ type: string
+ name:
+ description: Name is the name of the referent.
+ maxLength: 253
+ minLength: 1
+ type: string
+ namespace:
+ description: |-
+ Namespace is the namespace of the referenced object. When unspecified, the local
+ namespace is inferred.
+
+
+ Note that when a namespace different than the local namespace is specified,
+ a ReferenceGrant object is required in the referent namespace to allow that
+ namespace's owner to accept the reference. See the ReferenceGrant
+ documentation for details.
+
+
+ Support: Core
+ maxLength: 63
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?$
+ type: string
+ required:
+ - name
+ type: object
+ maxItems: 64
+ type: array
+ frontendValidation:
+ description: |+
+ FrontendValidation holds configuration information for validating the frontend (client).
+ Setting this field will require clients to send a client certificate
+ required for validation during the TLS handshake. In browsers this may result in a dialog appearing
+ that requests a user to specify the client certificate.
+ The maximum depth of a certificate chain accepted in verification is Implementation specific.
+
+
+ Support: Extended
+
+
+ properties:
+ caCertificateRefs:
+ description: |-
+ CACertificateRefs contains one or more references to
+ Kubernetes objects that contain TLS certificates of
+ the Certificate Authorities that can be used
+ as a trust anchor to validate the certificates presented by the client.
+
+
+ A single CA certificate reference to a Kubernetes ConfigMap
+ has "Core" support.
+ Implementations MAY choose to support attaching multiple CA certificates to
+ a Listener, but this behavior is implementation-specific.
+
+
+ Support: Core - A single reference to a Kubernetes ConfigMap
+ with the CA certificate in a key named `ca.crt`.
+
+
+ Support: Implementation-specific (More than one reference, or other kinds
+ of resources).
+
+
+ References to a resource in a different namespace are invalid UNLESS there
+ is a ReferenceGrant in the target namespace that allows the certificate
+ to be attached. If a ReferenceGrant does not allow this reference, the
+ "ResolvedRefs" condition MUST be set to False for this listener with the
+ "RefNotPermitted" reason.
+ items:
+ description: |-
+ ObjectReference identifies an API object including its namespace.
+
+
+ The API object must be valid in the cluster; the Group and Kind must
+ be registered in the cluster for this reference to be valid.
+
+
+ References to objects with invalid Group and Kind are not valid, and must
+ be rejected by the implementation, with appropriate Conditions set
+ on the containing object.
+ properties:
+ group:
+ description: |-
+ Group is the group of the referent. For example, "gateway.networking.k8s.io".
+ When unspecified or empty string, core API group is inferred.
+ maxLength: 253
+ pattern: ^$|^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$
+ type: string
+ kind:
+ description: Kind is kind of the referent. For
+ example "ConfigMap" or "Service".
+ maxLength: 63
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[a-zA-Z]([-a-zA-Z0-9]*[a-zA-Z0-9])?$
+ type: string
+ name:
+ description: Name is the name of the referent.
+ maxLength: 253
+ minLength: 1
+ type: string
+ namespace:
+ description: |-
+ Namespace is the namespace of the referenced object. When unspecified, the local
+ namespace is inferred.
+
+
+ Note that when a namespace different than the local namespace is specified,
+ a ReferenceGrant object is required in the referent namespace to allow that
+ namespace's owner to accept the reference. See the ReferenceGrant
+ documentation for details.
+
+
+ Support: Core
+ maxLength: 63
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?$
+ type: string
+ required:
+ - group
+ - kind
+ - name
+ type: object
+ maxItems: 8
+ minItems: 1
+ type: array
+ type: object
+ mode:
+ default: Terminate
+ description: |-
+ Mode defines the TLS behavior for the TLS session initiated by the client.
+ There are two possible modes:
+
+
+ - Terminate: The TLS session between the downstream client and the
+ Gateway is terminated at the Gateway. This mode requires certificates
+ to be specified in some way, such as populating the certificateRefs
+ field.
+ - Passthrough: The TLS session is NOT terminated by the Gateway. This
+ implies that the Gateway can't decipher the TLS stream except for
+ the ClientHello message of the TLS protocol. The certificateRefs field
+ is ignored in this mode.
+
+
+ Support: Core
+ enum:
+ - Terminate
+ - Passthrough
+ type: string
+ options:
+ additionalProperties:
+ description: |-
+ AnnotationValue is the value of an annotation in Gateway API. This is used
+ for validation of maps such as TLS options. This roughly matches Kubernetes
+ annotation validation, although the length validation in that case is based
+ on the entire size of the annotations struct.
+ maxLength: 4096
+ minLength: 0
+ type: string
+ description: |-
+ Options are a list of key/value pairs to enable extended TLS
+ configuration for each implementation. For example, configuring the
+ minimum TLS version or supported cipher suites.
+
+
+ A set of common keys MAY be defined by the API in the future. To avoid
+ any ambiguity, implementation-specific definitions MUST use
+ domain-prefixed names, such as `example.com/my-custom-option`.
+ Un-prefixed names are reserved for key names defined by Gateway API.
+
+
+ Support: Implementation-specific
+ maxProperties: 16
+ type: object
+ type: object
+ x-kubernetes-validations:
+ - message: certificateRefs or options must be specified when
+ mode is Terminate
+ rule: 'self.mode == ''Terminate'' ? size(self.certificateRefs)
+ > 0 || size(self.options) > 0 : true'
+ required:
+ - name
+ - port
+ - protocol
+ type: object
+ maxItems: 64
+ minItems: 1
+ type: array
+ x-kubernetes-list-map-keys:
+ - name
+ x-kubernetes-list-type: map
+ x-kubernetes-validations:
+ - message: tls must not be specified for protocols ['HTTP', 'TCP',
+ 'UDP']
+ rule: 'self.all(l, l.protocol in [''HTTP'', ''TCP'', ''UDP''] ?
+ !has(l.tls) : true)'
+ - message: tls mode must be Terminate for protocol HTTPS
+ rule: 'self.all(l, (l.protocol == ''HTTPS'' && has(l.tls)) ? (l.tls.mode
+ == '''' || l.tls.mode == ''Terminate'') : true)'
+ - message: hostname must not be specified for protocols ['TCP', 'UDP']
+ rule: 'self.all(l, l.protocol in [''TCP'', ''UDP''] ? (!has(l.hostname)
+ || l.hostname == '''') : true)'
+ - message: Listener name must be unique within the Gateway
+ rule: self.all(l1, self.exists_one(l2, l1.name == l2.name))
+ - message: Combination of port, protocol and hostname must be unique
+ for each listener
+ rule: 'self.all(l1, self.exists_one(l2, l1.port == l2.port && l1.protocol
+ == l2.protocol && (has(l1.hostname) && has(l2.hostname) ? l1.hostname
+ == l2.hostname : !has(l1.hostname) && !has(l2.hostname))))'
+ required:
+ - gatewayClassName
+ - listeners
+ type: object
+ status:
+ default:
+ conditions:
+ - lastTransitionTime: "1970-01-01T00:00:00Z"
+ message: Waiting for controller
+ reason: Pending
+ status: Unknown
+ type: Accepted
+ - lastTransitionTime: "1970-01-01T00:00:00Z"
+ message: Waiting for controller
+ reason: Pending
+ status: Unknown
+ type: Programmed
+ description: Status defines the current state of Gateway.
+ properties:
+ addresses:
+ description: |+
+ Addresses lists the network addresses that have been bound to the
+ Gateway.
+
+
+ This list may differ from the addresses provided in the spec under some
+ conditions:
+
+
+ * no addresses are specified, all addresses are dynamically assigned
+ * a combination of specified and dynamic addresses are assigned
+ * a specified address was unusable (e.g. already in use)
+
+
+ items:
+ description: GatewayStatusAddress describes a network address that
+ is bound to a Gateway.
+ oneOf:
+ - properties:
+ type:
+ enum:
+ - IPAddress
+ value:
+ anyOf:
+ - format: ipv4
+ - format: ipv6
+ - properties:
+ type:
+ not:
+ enum:
+ - IPAddress
+ properties:
+ type:
+ default: IPAddress
+ description: Type of the address.
+ maxLength: 253
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^Hostname|IPAddress|NamedAddress|[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*\/[A-Za-z0-9\/\-._~%!$&'()*+,;=:]+$
+ type: string
+ value:
+ description: |-
+ Value of the address. The validity of the values will depend
+ on the type and support by the controller.
+
+
+ Examples: `1.2.3.4`, `128::1`, `my-ip-address`.
+ maxLength: 253
+ minLength: 1
+ type: string
+ required:
+ - value
+ type: object
+ x-kubernetes-validations:
+ - message: Hostname value must only contain valid characters (matching
+ ^(\*\.)?[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$)
+ rule: 'self.type == ''Hostname'' ? self.value.matches(r"""^(\*\.)?[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$"""):
+ true'
+ maxItems: 16
+ type: array
+ conditions:
+ default:
+ - lastTransitionTime: "1970-01-01T00:00:00Z"
+ message: Waiting for controller
+ reason: Pending
+ status: Unknown
+ type: Accepted
+ - lastTransitionTime: "1970-01-01T00:00:00Z"
+ message: Waiting for controller
+ reason: Pending
+ status: Unknown
+ type: Programmed
+ description: |-
+ Conditions describe the current conditions of the Gateway.
+
+
+ Implementations should prefer to express Gateway conditions
+ using the `GatewayConditionType` and `GatewayConditionReason`
+ constants so that operators and tools can converge on a common
+ vocabulary to describe Gateway state.
+
+
+ Known condition types are:
+
+
+ * "Accepted"
+ * "Programmed"
+ * "Ready"
+ items:
+ description: "Condition contains details for one aspect of the current
+ state of this API Resource.\n---\nThis struct is intended for
+ direct use as an array at the field path .status.conditions. For
+ example,\n\n\n\ttype FooStatus struct{\n\t // Represents the
+ observations of a foo's current state.\n\t // Known .status.conditions.type
+ are: \"Available\", \"Progressing\", and \"Degraded\"\n\t //
+ +patchMergeKey=type\n\t // +patchStrategy=merge\n\t // +listType=map\n\t
+ \ // +listMapKey=type\n\t Conditions []metav1.Condition `json:\"conditions,omitempty\"
+ patchStrategy:\"merge\" patchMergeKey:\"type\" protobuf:\"bytes,1,rep,name=conditions\"`\n\n\n\t
+ \ // other fields\n\t}"
+ properties:
+ lastTransitionTime:
+ description: |-
+ lastTransitionTime is the last time the condition transitioned from one status to another.
+ This should be when the underlying condition changed. If that is not known, then using the time when the API field changed is acceptable.
+ format: date-time
+ type: string
+ message:
+ description: |-
+ message is a human readable message indicating details about the transition.
+ This may be an empty string.
+ maxLength: 32768
+ type: string
+ observedGeneration:
+ description: |-
+ observedGeneration represents the .metadata.generation that the condition was set based upon.
+ For instance, if .metadata.generation is currently 12, but the .status.conditions[x].observedGeneration is 9, the condition is out of date
+ with respect to the current state of the instance.
+ format: int64
+ minimum: 0
+ type: integer
+ reason:
+ description: |-
+ reason contains a programmatic identifier indicating the reason for the condition's last transition.
+ Producers of specific condition types may define expected values and meanings for this field,
+ and whether the values are considered a guaranteed API.
+ The value should be a CamelCase string.
+ This field may not be empty.
+ maxLength: 1024
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[A-Za-z]([A-Za-z0-9_,:]*[A-Za-z0-9_])?$
+ type: string
+ status:
+ description: status of the condition, one of True, False, Unknown.
+ enum:
+ - "True"
+ - "False"
+ - Unknown
+ type: string
+ type:
+ description: |-
+ type of condition in CamelCase or in foo.example.com/CamelCase.
+ ---
+ Many .condition.type values are consistent across resources like Available, but because arbitrary conditions can be
+ useful (see .node.status.conditions), the ability to deconflict is important.
+ The regex it matches is (dns1123SubdomainFmt/)?(qualifiedNameFmt)
+ maxLength: 316
+ pattern: ^([a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*/)?(([A-Za-z0-9][-A-Za-z0-9_.]*)?[A-Za-z0-9])$
+ type: string
+ required:
+ - lastTransitionTime
+ - message
+ - reason
+ - status
+ - type
+ type: object
+ maxItems: 8
+ type: array
+ x-kubernetes-list-map-keys:
+ - type
+ x-kubernetes-list-type: map
+ listeners:
+ description: Listeners provide status for each unique listener port
+ defined in the Spec.
+ items:
+ description: ListenerStatus is the status associated with a Listener.
+ properties:
+ attachedRoutes:
+ description: |-
+ AttachedRoutes represents the total number of Routes that have been
+ successfully attached to this Listener.
+
+
+ Successful attachment of a Route to a Listener is based solely on the
+ combination of the AllowedRoutes field on the corresponding Listener
+ and the Route's ParentRefs field. A Route is successfully attached to
+ a Listener when it is selected by the Listener's AllowedRoutes field
+ AND the Route has a valid ParentRef selecting the whole Gateway
+ resource or a specific Listener as a parent resource (more detail on
+ attachment semantics can be found in the documentation on the various
+ Route kinds ParentRefs fields). Listener or Route status does not impact
+ successful attachment, i.e. the AttachedRoutes field count MUST be set
+ for Listeners with condition Accepted: false and MUST count successfully
+ attached Routes that may themselves have Accepted: false conditions.
+
+
+ Uses for this field include troubleshooting Route attachment and
+ measuring blast radius/impact of changes to a Listener.
+ format: int32
+ type: integer
+ conditions:
+ description: Conditions describe the current condition of this
+ listener.
+ items:
+ description: "Condition contains details for one aspect of
+ the current state of this API Resource.\n---\nThis struct
+ is intended for direct use as an array at the field path
+ .status.conditions. For example,\n\n\n\ttype FooStatus
+ struct{\n\t // Represents the observations of a foo's
+ current state.\n\t // Known .status.conditions.type are:
+ \"Available\", \"Progressing\", and \"Degraded\"\n\t //
+ +patchMergeKey=type\n\t // +patchStrategy=merge\n\t //
+ +listType=map\n\t // +listMapKey=type\n\t Conditions
+ []metav1.Condition `json:\"conditions,omitempty\" patchStrategy:\"merge\"
+ patchMergeKey:\"type\" protobuf:\"bytes,1,rep,name=conditions\"`\n\n\n\t
+ \ // other fields\n\t}"
+ properties:
+ lastTransitionTime:
+ description: |-
+ lastTransitionTime is the last time the condition transitioned from one status to another.
+ This should be when the underlying condition changed. If that is not known, then using the time when the API field changed is acceptable.
+ format: date-time
+ type: string
+ message:
+ description: |-
+ message is a human readable message indicating details about the transition.
+ This may be an empty string.
+ maxLength: 32768
+ type: string
+ observedGeneration:
+ description: |-
+ observedGeneration represents the .metadata.generation that the condition was set based upon.
+ For instance, if .metadata.generation is currently 12, but the .status.conditions[x].observedGeneration is 9, the condition is out of date
+ with respect to the current state of the instance.
+ format: int64
+ minimum: 0
+ type: integer
+ reason:
+ description: |-
+ reason contains a programmatic identifier indicating the reason for the condition's last transition.
+ Producers of specific condition types may define expected values and meanings for this field,
+ and whether the values are considered a guaranteed API.
+ The value should be a CamelCase string.
+ This field may not be empty.
+ maxLength: 1024
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[A-Za-z]([A-Za-z0-9_,:]*[A-Za-z0-9_])?$
+ type: string
+ status:
+ description: status of the condition, one of True, False,
+ Unknown.
+ enum:
+ - "True"
+ - "False"
+ - Unknown
+ type: string
+ type:
+ description: |-
+ type of condition in CamelCase or in foo.example.com/CamelCase.
+ ---
+ Many .condition.type values are consistent across resources like Available, but because arbitrary conditions can be
+ useful (see .node.status.conditions), the ability to deconflict is important.
+ The regex it matches is (dns1123SubdomainFmt/)?(qualifiedNameFmt)
+ maxLength: 316
+ pattern: ^([a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*/)?(([A-Za-z0-9][-A-Za-z0-9_.]*)?[A-Za-z0-9])$
+ type: string
+ required:
+ - lastTransitionTime
+ - message
+ - reason
+ - status
+ - type
+ type: object
+ maxItems: 8
+ type: array
+ x-kubernetes-list-map-keys:
+ - type
+ x-kubernetes-list-type: map
+ name:
+ description: Name is the name of the Listener that this status
+ corresponds to.
+ maxLength: 253
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$
+ type: string
+ supportedKinds:
+ description: |-
+ SupportedKinds is the list indicating the Kinds supported by this
+ listener. This MUST represent the kinds an implementation supports for
+ that Listener configuration.
+
+
+ If kinds are specified in Spec that are not supported, they MUST NOT
+ appear in this list and an implementation MUST set the "ResolvedRefs"
+ condition to "False" with the "InvalidRouteKinds" reason. If both valid
+ and invalid Route kinds are specified, the implementation MUST
+ reference the valid Route kinds that have been specified.
+ items:
+ description: RouteGroupKind indicates the group and kind of
+ a Route resource.
+ properties:
+ group:
+ default: gateway.networking.k8s.io
+ description: Group is the group of the Route.
+ maxLength: 253
+ pattern: ^$|^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$
+ type: string
+ kind:
+ description: Kind is the kind of the Route.
+ maxLength: 63
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[a-zA-Z]([-a-zA-Z0-9]*[a-zA-Z0-9])?$
+ type: string
+ required:
+ - kind
+ type: object
+ maxItems: 8
+ type: array
+ required:
+ - attachedRoutes
+ - conditions
+ - name
+ - supportedKinds
+ type: object
+ maxItems: 64
+ type: array
+ x-kubernetes-list-map-keys:
+ - name
+ x-kubernetes-list-type: map
+ type: object
+ required:
+ - spec
+ type: object
+ served: true
+ storage: true
+ subresources:
+ status: {}
+ - additionalPrinterColumns:
+ - jsonPath: .spec.gatewayClassName
+ name: Class
+ type: string
+ - jsonPath: .status.addresses[*].value
+ name: Address
+ type: string
+ - jsonPath: .status.conditions[?(@.type=="Programmed")].status
+ name: Programmed
+ type: string
+ - jsonPath: .metadata.creationTimestamp
+ name: Age
+ type: date
+ name: v1beta1
+ schema:
+ openAPIV3Schema:
+ description: |-
+ Gateway represents an instance of a service-traffic handling infrastructure
+ by binding Listeners to a set of IP addresses.
+ properties:
+ apiVersion:
+ description: |-
+ APIVersion defines the versioned schema of this representation of an object.
+ Servers should convert recognized schemas to the latest internal value, and
+ may reject unrecognized values.
+ More info: https://git.k8s.io/community/contributors/devel/sig-architecture/api-conventions.md#resources
+ type: string
+ kind:
+ description: |-
+ Kind is a string value representing the REST resource this object represents.
+ Servers may infer this from the endpoint the client submits requests to.
+ Cannot be updated.
+ In CamelCase.
+ More info: https://git.k8s.io/community/contributors/devel/sig-architecture/api-conventions.md#types-kinds
+ type: string
+ metadata:
+ type: object
+ spec:
+ description: Spec defines the desired state of Gateway.
+ properties:
+ addresses:
+ description: |+
+ Addresses requested for this Gateway. This is optional and behavior can
+ depend on the implementation. If a value is set in the spec and the
+ requested address is invalid or unavailable, the implementation MUST
+ indicate this in the associated entry in GatewayStatus.Addresses.
+
+
+ The Addresses field represents a request for the address(es) on the
+ "outside of the Gateway", that traffic bound for this Gateway will use.
+ This could be the IP address or hostname of an external load balancer or
+ other networking infrastructure, or some other address that traffic will
+ be sent to.
+
+
+ If no Addresses are specified, the implementation MAY schedule the
+ Gateway in an implementation-specific manner, assigning an appropriate
+ set of Addresses.
+
+
+ The implementation MUST bind all Listeners to every GatewayAddress that
+ it assigns to the Gateway and add a corresponding entry in
+ GatewayStatus.Addresses.
+
+
+ Support: Extended
+
+
+ items:
+ description: GatewayAddress describes an address that can be bound
+ to a Gateway.
+ oneOf:
+ - properties:
+ type:
+ enum:
+ - IPAddress
+ value:
+ anyOf:
+ - format: ipv4
+ - format: ipv6
+ - properties:
+ type:
+ not:
+ enum:
+ - IPAddress
+ properties:
+ type:
+ default: IPAddress
+ description: Type of the address.
+ maxLength: 253
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^Hostname|IPAddress|NamedAddress|[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*\/[A-Za-z0-9\/\-._~%!$&'()*+,;=:]+$
+ type: string
+ value:
+ description: |-
+ Value of the address. The validity of the values will depend
+ on the type and support by the controller.
+
+
+ Examples: `1.2.3.4`, `128::1`, `my-ip-address`.
+ maxLength: 253
+ minLength: 1
+ type: string
+ required:
+ - value
+ type: object
+ x-kubernetes-validations:
+ - message: Hostname value must only contain valid characters (matching
+ ^(\*\.)?[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$)
+ rule: 'self.type == ''Hostname'' ? self.value.matches(r"""^(\*\.)?[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$"""):
+ true'
+ maxItems: 16
+ type: array
+ x-kubernetes-validations:
+ - message: IPAddress values must be unique
+ rule: 'self.all(a1, a1.type == ''IPAddress'' ? self.exists_one(a2,
+ a2.type == a1.type && a2.value == a1.value) : true )'
+ - message: Hostname values must be unique
+ rule: 'self.all(a1, a1.type == ''Hostname'' ? self.exists_one(a2,
+ a2.type == a1.type && a2.value == a1.value) : true )'
+ gatewayClassName:
+ description: |-
+ GatewayClassName used for this Gateway. This is the name of a
+ GatewayClass resource.
+ maxLength: 253
+ minLength: 1
+ type: string
+ infrastructure:
+ description: |+
+ Infrastructure defines infrastructure level attributes about this Gateway instance.
+
+
+ Support: Core
+
+
+ properties:
+ annotations:
+ additionalProperties:
+ description: |-
+ AnnotationValue is the value of an annotation in Gateway API. This is used
+ for validation of maps such as TLS options. This roughly matches Kubernetes
+ annotation validation, although the length validation in that case is based
+ on the entire size of the annotations struct.
+ maxLength: 4096
+ minLength: 0
+ type: string
+ description: |-
+ Annotations that SHOULD be applied to any resources created in response to this Gateway.
+
+
+ For implementations creating other Kubernetes objects, this should be the `metadata.annotations` field on resources.
+ For other implementations, this refers to any relevant (implementation specific) "annotations" concepts.
+
+
+ An implementation may chose to add additional implementation-specific annotations as they see fit.
+
+
+ Support: Extended
+ maxProperties: 8
+ type: object
+ labels:
+ additionalProperties:
+ description: |-
+ AnnotationValue is the value of an annotation in Gateway API. This is used
+ for validation of maps such as TLS options. This roughly matches Kubernetes
+ annotation validation, although the length validation in that case is based
+ on the entire size of the annotations struct.
+ maxLength: 4096
+ minLength: 0
+ type: string
+ description: |-
+ Labels that SHOULD be applied to any resources created in response to this Gateway.
+
+
+ For implementations creating other Kubernetes objects, this should be the `metadata.labels` field on resources.
+ For other implementations, this refers to any relevant (implementation specific) "labels" concepts.
+
+
+ An implementation may chose to add additional implementation-specific labels as they see fit.
+
+
+ Support: Extended
+ maxProperties: 8
+ type: object
+ parametersRef:
+ description: |-
+ ParametersRef is a reference to a resource that contains the configuration
+ parameters corresponding to the Gateway. This is optional if the
+ controller does not require any additional configuration.
+
+
+ This follows the same semantics as GatewayClass's `parametersRef`, but on a per-Gateway basis
+
+
+ The Gateway's GatewayClass may provide its own `parametersRef`. When both are specified,
+ the merging behavior is implementation specific.
+ It is generally recommended that GatewayClass provides defaults that can be overridden by a Gateway.
+
+
+ Support: Implementation-specific
+ properties:
+ group:
+ description: Group is the group of the referent.
+ maxLength: 253
+ pattern: ^$|^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$
+ type: string
+ kind:
+ description: Kind is kind of the referent.
+ maxLength: 63
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[a-zA-Z]([-a-zA-Z0-9]*[a-zA-Z0-9])?$
+ type: string
+ name:
+ description: Name is the name of the referent.
+ maxLength: 253
+ minLength: 1
+ type: string
+ required:
+ - group
+ - kind
+ - name
+ type: object
+ type: object
+ listeners:
+ description: |-
+ Listeners associated with this Gateway. Listeners define
+ logical endpoints that are bound on this Gateway's addresses.
+ At least one Listener MUST be specified.
+
+
+ Each Listener in a set of Listeners (for example, in a single Gateway)
+ MUST be _distinct_, in that a traffic flow MUST be able to be assigned to
+ exactly one listener. (This section uses "set of Listeners" rather than
+ "Listeners in a single Gateway" because implementations MAY merge configuration
+ from multiple Gateways onto a single data plane, and these rules _also_
+ apply in that case).
+
+
+ Practically, this means that each listener in a set MUST have a unique
+ combination of Port, Protocol, and, if supported by the protocol, Hostname.
+
+
+ Some combinations of port, protocol, and TLS settings are considered
+ Core support and MUST be supported by implementations based on their
+ targeted conformance profile:
+
+
+ HTTP Profile
+
+
+ 1. HTTPRoute, Port: 80, Protocol: HTTP
+ 2. HTTPRoute, Port: 443, Protocol: HTTPS, TLS Mode: Terminate, TLS keypair provided
+
+
+ TLS Profile
+
+
+ 1. TLSRoute, Port: 443, Protocol: TLS, TLS Mode: Passthrough
+
+
+ "Distinct" Listeners have the following property:
+
+
+ The implementation can match inbound requests to a single distinct
+ Listener. When multiple Listeners share values for fields (for
+ example, two Listeners with the same Port value), the implementation
+ can match requests to only one of the Listeners using other
+ Listener fields.
+
+
+ For example, the following Listener scenarios are distinct:
+
+
+ 1. Multiple Listeners with the same Port that all use the "HTTP"
+ Protocol that all have unique Hostname values.
+ 2. Multiple Listeners with the same Port that use either the "HTTPS" or
+ "TLS" Protocol that all have unique Hostname values.
+ 3. A mixture of "TCP" and "UDP" Protocol Listeners, where no Listener
+ with the same Protocol has the same Port value.
+
+
+ Some fields in the Listener struct have possible values that affect
+ whether the Listener is distinct. Hostname is particularly relevant
+ for HTTP or HTTPS protocols.
+
+
+ When using the Hostname value to select between same-Port, same-Protocol
+ Listeners, the Hostname value must be different on each Listener for the
+ Listener to be distinct.
+
+
+ When the Listeners are distinct based on Hostname, inbound request
+ hostnames MUST match from the most specific to least specific Hostname
+ values to choose the correct Listener and its associated set of Routes.
+
+
+ Exact matches must be processed before wildcard matches, and wildcard
+ matches must be processed before fallback (empty Hostname value)
+ matches. For example, `"foo.example.com"` takes precedence over
+ `"*.example.com"`, and `"*.example.com"` takes precedence over `""`.
+
+
+ Additionally, if there are multiple wildcard entries, more specific
+ wildcard entries must be processed before less specific wildcard entries.
+ For example, `"*.foo.example.com"` takes precedence over `"*.example.com"`.
+ The precise definition here is that the higher the number of dots in the
+ hostname to the right of the wildcard character, the higher the precedence.
+
+
+ The wildcard character will match any number of characters _and dots_ to
+ the left, however, so `"*.example.com"` will match both
+ `"foo.bar.example.com"` _and_ `"bar.example.com"`.
+
+
+ If a set of Listeners contains Listeners that are not distinct, then those
+ Listeners are Conflicted, and the implementation MUST set the "Conflicted"
+ condition in the Listener Status to "True".
+
+
+ Implementations MAY choose to accept a Gateway with some Conflicted
+ Listeners only if they only accept the partial Listener set that contains
+ no Conflicted Listeners. To put this another way, implementations may
+ accept a partial Listener set only if they throw out *all* the conflicting
+ Listeners. No picking one of the conflicting listeners as the winner.
+ This also means that the Gateway must have at least one non-conflicting
+ Listener in this case, otherwise it violates the requirement that at
+ least one Listener must be present.
+
+
+ The implementation MUST set a "ListenersNotValid" condition on the
+ Gateway Status when the Gateway contains Conflicted Listeners whether or
+ not they accept the Gateway. That Condition SHOULD clearly
+ indicate in the Message which Listeners are conflicted, and which are
+ Accepted. Additionally, the Listener status for those listeners SHOULD
+ indicate which Listeners are conflicted and not Accepted.
+
+
+ A Gateway's Listeners are considered "compatible" if:
+
+
+ 1. They are distinct.
+ 2. The implementation can serve them in compliance with the Addresses
+ requirement that all Listeners are available on all assigned
+ addresses.
+
+
+ Compatible combinations in Extended support are expected to vary across
+ implementations. A combination that is compatible for one implementation
+ may not be compatible for another.
+
+
+ For example, an implementation that cannot serve both TCP and UDP listeners
+ on the same address, or cannot mix HTTPS and generic TLS listens on the same port
+ would not consider those cases compatible, even though they are distinct.
+
+
+ Note that requests SHOULD match at most one Listener. For example, if
+ Listeners are defined for "foo.example.com" and "*.example.com", a
+ request to "foo.example.com" SHOULD only be routed using routes attached
+ to the "foo.example.com" Listener (and not the "*.example.com" Listener).
+ This concept is known as "Listener Isolation". Implementations that do
+ not support Listener Isolation MUST clearly document this.
+
+
+ Implementations MAY merge separate Gateways onto a single set of
+ Addresses if all Listeners across all Gateways are compatible.
+
+
+ Support: Core
+ items:
+ description: |-
+ Listener embodies the concept of a logical endpoint where a Gateway accepts
+ network connections.
+ properties:
+ allowedRoutes:
+ default:
+ namespaces:
+ from: Same
+ description: |-
+ AllowedRoutes defines the types of routes that MAY be attached to a
+ Listener and the trusted namespaces where those Route resources MAY be
+ present.
+
+
+ Although a client request may match multiple route rules, only one rule
+ may ultimately receive the request. Matching precedence MUST be
+ determined in order of the following criteria:
+
+
+ * The most specific match as defined by the Route type.
+ * The oldest Route based on creation timestamp. For example, a Route with
+ a creation timestamp of "2020-09-08 01:02:03" is given precedence over
+ a Route with a creation timestamp of "2020-09-08 01:02:04".
+ * If everything else is equivalent, the Route appearing first in
+ alphabetical order (namespace/name) should be given precedence. For
+ example, foo/bar is given precedence over foo/baz.
+
+
+ All valid rules within a Route attached to this Listener should be
+ implemented. Invalid Route rules can be ignored (sometimes that will mean
+ the full Route). If a Route rule transitions from valid to invalid,
+ support for that Route rule should be dropped to ensure consistency. For
+ example, even if a filter specified by a Route rule is invalid, the rest
+ of the rules within that Route should still be supported.
+
+
+ Support: Core
+ properties:
+ kinds:
+ description: |-
+ Kinds specifies the groups and kinds of Routes that are allowed to bind
+ to this Gateway Listener. When unspecified or empty, the kinds of Routes
+ selected are determined using the Listener protocol.
+
+
+ A RouteGroupKind MUST correspond to kinds of Routes that are compatible
+ with the application protocol specified in the Listener's Protocol field.
+ If an implementation does not support or recognize this resource type, it
+ MUST set the "ResolvedRefs" condition to False for this Listener with the
+ "InvalidRouteKinds" reason.
+
+
+ Support: Core
+ items:
+ description: RouteGroupKind indicates the group and kind
+ of a Route resource.
+ properties:
+ group:
+ default: gateway.networking.k8s.io
+ description: Group is the group of the Route.
+ maxLength: 253
+ pattern: ^$|^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$
+ type: string
+ kind:
+ description: Kind is the kind of the Route.
+ maxLength: 63
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[a-zA-Z]([-a-zA-Z0-9]*[a-zA-Z0-9])?$
+ type: string
+ required:
+ - kind
+ type: object
+ maxItems: 8
+ type: array
+ namespaces:
+ default:
+ from: Same
+ description: |-
+ Namespaces indicates namespaces from which Routes may be attached to this
+ Listener. This is restricted to the namespace of this Gateway by default.
+
+
+ Support: Core
+ properties:
+ from:
+ default: Same
+ description: |-
+ From indicates where Routes will be selected for this Gateway. Possible
+ values are:
+
+
+ * All: Routes in all namespaces may be used by this Gateway.
+ * Selector: Routes in namespaces selected by the selector may be used by
+ this Gateway.
+ * Same: Only Routes in the same namespace may be used by this Gateway.
+
+
+ Support: Core
+ enum:
+ - All
+ - Selector
+ - Same
+ type: string
+ selector:
+ description: |-
+ Selector must be specified when From is set to "Selector". In that case,
+ only Routes in Namespaces matching this Selector will be selected by this
+ Gateway. This field is ignored for other values of "From".
+
+
+ Support: Core
+ properties:
+ matchExpressions:
+ description: matchExpressions is a list of label
+ selector requirements. The requirements are ANDed.
+ items:
+ description: |-
+ A label selector requirement is a selector that contains values, a key, and an operator that
+ relates the key and values.
+ properties:
+ key:
+ description: key is the label key that the
+ selector applies to.
+ type: string
+ operator:
+ description: |-
+ operator represents a key's relationship to a set of values.
+ Valid operators are In, NotIn, Exists and DoesNotExist.
+ type: string
+ values:
+ description: |-
+ values is an array of string values. If the operator is In or NotIn,
+ the values array must be non-empty. If the operator is Exists or DoesNotExist,
+ the values array must be empty. This array is replaced during a strategic
+ merge patch.
+ items:
+ type: string
+ type: array
+ x-kubernetes-list-type: atomic
+ required:
+ - key
+ - operator
+ type: object
+ type: array
+ x-kubernetes-list-type: atomic
+ matchLabels:
+ additionalProperties:
+ type: string
+ description: |-
+ matchLabels is a map of {key,value} pairs. A single {key,value} in the matchLabels
+ map is equivalent to an element of matchExpressions, whose key field is "key", the
+ operator is "In", and the values array contains only "value". The requirements are ANDed.
+ type: object
+ type: object
+ x-kubernetes-map-type: atomic
+ type: object
+ type: object
+ hostname:
+ description: |-
+ Hostname specifies the virtual hostname to match for protocol types that
+ define this concept. When unspecified, all hostnames are matched. This
+ field is ignored for protocols that don't require hostname based
+ matching.
+
+
+ Implementations MUST apply Hostname matching appropriately for each of
+ the following protocols:
+
+
+ * TLS: The Listener Hostname MUST match the SNI.
+ * HTTP: The Listener Hostname MUST match the Host header of the request.
+ * HTTPS: The Listener Hostname SHOULD match at both the TLS and HTTP
+ protocol layers as described above. If an implementation does not
+ ensure that both the SNI and Host header match the Listener hostname,
+ it MUST clearly document that.
+
+
+ For HTTPRoute and TLSRoute resources, there is an interaction with the
+ `spec.hostnames` array. When both listener and route specify hostnames,
+ there MUST be an intersection between the values for a Route to be
+ accepted. For more information, refer to the Route specific Hostnames
+ documentation.
+
+
+ Hostnames that are prefixed with a wildcard label (`*.`) are interpreted
+ as a suffix match. That means that a match for `*.example.com` would match
+ both `test.example.com`, and `foo.test.example.com`, but not `example.com`.
+
+
+ Support: Core
+ maxLength: 253
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^(\*\.)?[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$
+ type: string
+ name:
+ description: |-
+ Name is the name of the Listener. This name MUST be unique within a
+ Gateway.
+
+
+ Support: Core
+ maxLength: 253
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$
+ type: string
+ port:
+ description: |-
+ Port is the network port. Multiple listeners may use the
+ same port, subject to the Listener compatibility rules.
+
+
+ Support: Core
+ format: int32
+ maximum: 65535
+ minimum: 1
+ type: integer
+ protocol:
+ description: |-
+ Protocol specifies the network protocol this listener expects to receive.
+
+
+ Support: Core
+ maxLength: 255
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[a-zA-Z0-9]([-a-zSA-Z0-9]*[a-zA-Z0-9])?$|[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*\/[A-Za-z0-9]+$
+ type: string
+ tls:
+ description: |-
+ TLS is the TLS configuration for the Listener. This field is required if
+ the Protocol field is "HTTPS" or "TLS". It is invalid to set this field
+ if the Protocol field is "HTTP", "TCP", or "UDP".
+
+
+ The association of SNIs to Certificate defined in GatewayTLSConfig is
+ defined based on the Hostname field for this listener.
+
+
+ The GatewayClass MUST use the longest matching SNI out of all
+ available certificates for any TLS handshake.
+
+
+ Support: Core
+ properties:
+ certificateRefs:
+ description: |-
+ CertificateRefs contains a series of references to Kubernetes objects that
+ contains TLS certificates and private keys. These certificates are used to
+ establish a TLS handshake for requests that match the hostname of the
+ associated listener.
+
+
+ A single CertificateRef to a Kubernetes Secret has "Core" support.
+ Implementations MAY choose to support attaching multiple certificates to
+ a Listener, but this behavior is implementation-specific.
+
+
+ References to a resource in different namespace are invalid UNLESS there
+ is a ReferenceGrant in the target namespace that allows the certificate
+ to be attached. If a ReferenceGrant does not allow this reference, the
+ "ResolvedRefs" condition MUST be set to False for this listener with the
+ "RefNotPermitted" reason.
+
+
+ This field is required to have at least one element when the mode is set
+ to "Terminate" (default) and is optional otherwise.
+
+
+ CertificateRefs can reference to standard Kubernetes resources, i.e.
+ Secret, or implementation-specific custom resources.
+
+
+ Support: Core - A single reference to a Kubernetes Secret of type kubernetes.io/tls
+
+
+ Support: Implementation-specific (More than one reference or other resource types)
+ items:
+ description: |-
+ SecretObjectReference identifies an API object including its namespace,
+ defaulting to Secret.
+
+
+ The API object must be valid in the cluster; the Group and Kind must
+ be registered in the cluster for this reference to be valid.
+
+
+ References to objects with invalid Group and Kind are not valid, and must
+ be rejected by the implementation, with appropriate Conditions set
+ on the containing object.
+ properties:
+ group:
+ default: ""
+ description: |-
+ Group is the group of the referent. For example, "gateway.networking.k8s.io".
+ When unspecified or empty string, core API group is inferred.
+ maxLength: 253
+ pattern: ^$|^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$
+ type: string
+ kind:
+ default: Secret
+ description: Kind is kind of the referent. For example
+ "Secret".
+ maxLength: 63
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[a-zA-Z]([-a-zA-Z0-9]*[a-zA-Z0-9])?$
+ type: string
+ name:
+ description: Name is the name of the referent.
+ maxLength: 253
+ minLength: 1
+ type: string
+ namespace:
+ description: |-
+ Namespace is the namespace of the referenced object. When unspecified, the local
+ namespace is inferred.
+
+
+ Note that when a namespace different than the local namespace is specified,
+ a ReferenceGrant object is required in the referent namespace to allow that
+ namespace's owner to accept the reference. See the ReferenceGrant
+ documentation for details.
+
+
+ Support: Core
+ maxLength: 63
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?$
+ type: string
+ required:
+ - name
+ type: object
+ maxItems: 64
+ type: array
+ frontendValidation:
+ description: |+
+ FrontendValidation holds configuration information for validating the frontend (client).
+ Setting this field will require clients to send a client certificate
+ required for validation during the TLS handshake. In browsers this may result in a dialog appearing
+ that requests a user to specify the client certificate.
+ The maximum depth of a certificate chain accepted in verification is Implementation specific.
+
+
+ Support: Extended
+
+
+ properties:
+ caCertificateRefs:
+ description: |-
+ CACertificateRefs contains one or more references to
+ Kubernetes objects that contain TLS certificates of
+ the Certificate Authorities that can be used
+ as a trust anchor to validate the certificates presented by the client.
+
+
+ A single CA certificate reference to a Kubernetes ConfigMap
+ has "Core" support.
+ Implementations MAY choose to support attaching multiple CA certificates to
+ a Listener, but this behavior is implementation-specific.
+
+
+ Support: Core - A single reference to a Kubernetes ConfigMap
+ with the CA certificate in a key named `ca.crt`.
+
+
+ Support: Implementation-specific (More than one reference, or other kinds
+ of resources).
+
+
+ References to a resource in a different namespace are invalid UNLESS there
+ is a ReferenceGrant in the target namespace that allows the certificate
+ to be attached. If a ReferenceGrant does not allow this reference, the
+ "ResolvedRefs" condition MUST be set to False for this listener with the
+ "RefNotPermitted" reason.
+ items:
+ description: |-
+ ObjectReference identifies an API object including its namespace.
+
+
+ The API object must be valid in the cluster; the Group and Kind must
+ be registered in the cluster for this reference to be valid.
+
+
+ References to objects with invalid Group and Kind are not valid, and must
+ be rejected by the implementation, with appropriate Conditions set
+ on the containing object.
+ properties:
+ group:
+ description: |-
+ Group is the group of the referent. For example, "gateway.networking.k8s.io".
+ When unspecified or empty string, core API group is inferred.
+ maxLength: 253
+ pattern: ^$|^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$
+ type: string
+ kind:
+ description: Kind is kind of the referent. For
+ example "ConfigMap" or "Service".
+ maxLength: 63
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[a-zA-Z]([-a-zA-Z0-9]*[a-zA-Z0-9])?$
+ type: string
+ name:
+ description: Name is the name of the referent.
+ maxLength: 253
+ minLength: 1
+ type: string
+ namespace:
+ description: |-
+ Namespace is the namespace of the referenced object. When unspecified, the local
+ namespace is inferred.
+
+
+ Note that when a namespace different than the local namespace is specified,
+ a ReferenceGrant object is required in the referent namespace to allow that
+ namespace's owner to accept the reference. See the ReferenceGrant
+ documentation for details.
+
+
+ Support: Core
+ maxLength: 63
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?$
+ type: string
+ required:
+ - group
+ - kind
+ - name
+ type: object
+ maxItems: 8
+ minItems: 1
+ type: array
+ type: object
+ mode:
+ default: Terminate
+ description: |-
+ Mode defines the TLS behavior for the TLS session initiated by the client.
+ There are two possible modes:
+
+
+ - Terminate: The TLS session between the downstream client and the
+ Gateway is terminated at the Gateway. This mode requires certificates
+ to be specified in some way, such as populating the certificateRefs
+ field.
+ - Passthrough: The TLS session is NOT terminated by the Gateway. This
+ implies that the Gateway can't decipher the TLS stream except for
+ the ClientHello message of the TLS protocol. The certificateRefs field
+ is ignored in this mode.
+
+
+ Support: Core
+ enum:
+ - Terminate
+ - Passthrough
+ type: string
+ options:
+ additionalProperties:
+ description: |-
+ AnnotationValue is the value of an annotation in Gateway API. This is used
+ for validation of maps such as TLS options. This roughly matches Kubernetes
+ annotation validation, although the length validation in that case is based
+ on the entire size of the annotations struct.
+ maxLength: 4096
+ minLength: 0
+ type: string
+ description: |-
+ Options are a list of key/value pairs to enable extended TLS
+ configuration for each implementation. For example, configuring the
+ minimum TLS version or supported cipher suites.
+
+
+ A set of common keys MAY be defined by the API in the future. To avoid
+ any ambiguity, implementation-specific definitions MUST use
+ domain-prefixed names, such as `example.com/my-custom-option`.
+ Un-prefixed names are reserved for key names defined by Gateway API.
+
+
+ Support: Implementation-specific
+ maxProperties: 16
+ type: object
+ type: object
+ x-kubernetes-validations:
+ - message: certificateRefs or options must be specified when
+ mode is Terminate
+ rule: 'self.mode == ''Terminate'' ? size(self.certificateRefs)
+ > 0 || size(self.options) > 0 : true'
+ required:
+ - name
+ - port
+ - protocol
+ type: object
+ maxItems: 64
+ minItems: 1
+ type: array
+ x-kubernetes-list-map-keys:
+ - name
+ x-kubernetes-list-type: map
+ x-kubernetes-validations:
+ - message: tls must not be specified for protocols ['HTTP', 'TCP',
+ 'UDP']
+ rule: 'self.all(l, l.protocol in [''HTTP'', ''TCP'', ''UDP''] ?
+ !has(l.tls) : true)'
+ - message: tls mode must be Terminate for protocol HTTPS
+ rule: 'self.all(l, (l.protocol == ''HTTPS'' && has(l.tls)) ? (l.tls.mode
+ == '''' || l.tls.mode == ''Terminate'') : true)'
+ - message: hostname must not be specified for protocols ['TCP', 'UDP']
+ rule: 'self.all(l, l.protocol in [''TCP'', ''UDP''] ? (!has(l.hostname)
+ || l.hostname == '''') : true)'
+ - message: Listener name must be unique within the Gateway
+ rule: self.all(l1, self.exists_one(l2, l1.name == l2.name))
+ - message: Combination of port, protocol and hostname must be unique
+ for each listener
+ rule: 'self.all(l1, self.exists_one(l2, l1.port == l2.port && l1.protocol
+ == l2.protocol && (has(l1.hostname) && has(l2.hostname) ? l1.hostname
+ == l2.hostname : !has(l1.hostname) && !has(l2.hostname))))'
+ required:
+ - gatewayClassName
+ - listeners
+ type: object
+ status:
+ default:
+ conditions:
+ - lastTransitionTime: "1970-01-01T00:00:00Z"
+ message: Waiting for controller
+ reason: Pending
+ status: Unknown
+ type: Accepted
+ - lastTransitionTime: "1970-01-01T00:00:00Z"
+ message: Waiting for controller
+ reason: Pending
+ status: Unknown
+ type: Programmed
+ description: Status defines the current state of Gateway.
+ properties:
+ addresses:
+ description: |+
+ Addresses lists the network addresses that have been bound to the
+ Gateway.
+
+
+ This list may differ from the addresses provided in the spec under some
+ conditions:
+
+
+ * no addresses are specified, all addresses are dynamically assigned
+ * a combination of specified and dynamic addresses are assigned
+ * a specified address was unusable (e.g. already in use)
+
+
+ items:
+ description: GatewayStatusAddress describes a network address that
+ is bound to a Gateway.
+ oneOf:
+ - properties:
+ type:
+ enum:
+ - IPAddress
+ value:
+ anyOf:
+ - format: ipv4
+ - format: ipv6
+ - properties:
+ type:
+ not:
+ enum:
+ - IPAddress
+ properties:
+ type:
+ default: IPAddress
+ description: Type of the address.
+ maxLength: 253
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^Hostname|IPAddress|NamedAddress|[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*\/[A-Za-z0-9\/\-._~%!$&'()*+,;=:]+$
+ type: string
+ value:
+ description: |-
+ Value of the address. The validity of the values will depend
+ on the type and support by the controller.
+
+
+ Examples: `1.2.3.4`, `128::1`, `my-ip-address`.
+ maxLength: 253
+ minLength: 1
+ type: string
+ required:
+ - value
+ type: object
+ x-kubernetes-validations:
+ - message: Hostname value must only contain valid characters (matching
+ ^(\*\.)?[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$)
+ rule: 'self.type == ''Hostname'' ? self.value.matches(r"""^(\*\.)?[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$"""):
+ true'
+ maxItems: 16
+ type: array
+ conditions:
+ default:
+ - lastTransitionTime: "1970-01-01T00:00:00Z"
+ message: Waiting for controller
+ reason: Pending
+ status: Unknown
+ type: Accepted
+ - lastTransitionTime: "1970-01-01T00:00:00Z"
+ message: Waiting for controller
+ reason: Pending
+ status: Unknown
+ type: Programmed
+ description: |-
+ Conditions describe the current conditions of the Gateway.
+
+
+ Implementations should prefer to express Gateway conditions
+ using the `GatewayConditionType` and `GatewayConditionReason`
+ constants so that operators and tools can converge on a common
+ vocabulary to describe Gateway state.
+
+
+ Known condition types are:
+
+
+ * "Accepted"
+ * "Programmed"
+ * "Ready"
+ items:
+ description: "Condition contains details for one aspect of the current
+ state of this API Resource.\n---\nThis struct is intended for
+ direct use as an array at the field path .status.conditions. For
+ example,\n\n\n\ttype FooStatus struct{\n\t // Represents the
+ observations of a foo's current state.\n\t // Known .status.conditions.type
+ are: \"Available\", \"Progressing\", and \"Degraded\"\n\t //
+ +patchMergeKey=type\n\t // +patchStrategy=merge\n\t // +listType=map\n\t
+ \ // +listMapKey=type\n\t Conditions []metav1.Condition `json:\"conditions,omitempty\"
+ patchStrategy:\"merge\" patchMergeKey:\"type\" protobuf:\"bytes,1,rep,name=conditions\"`\n\n\n\t
+ \ // other fields\n\t}"
+ properties:
+ lastTransitionTime:
+ description: |-
+ lastTransitionTime is the last time the condition transitioned from one status to another.
+ This should be when the underlying condition changed. If that is not known, then using the time when the API field changed is acceptable.
+ format: date-time
+ type: string
+ message:
+ description: |-
+ message is a human readable message indicating details about the transition.
+ This may be an empty string.
+ maxLength: 32768
+ type: string
+ observedGeneration:
+ description: |-
+ observedGeneration represents the .metadata.generation that the condition was set based upon.
+ For instance, if .metadata.generation is currently 12, but the .status.conditions[x].observedGeneration is 9, the condition is out of date
+ with respect to the current state of the instance.
+ format: int64
+ minimum: 0
+ type: integer
+ reason:
+ description: |-
+ reason contains a programmatic identifier indicating the reason for the condition's last transition.
+ Producers of specific condition types may define expected values and meanings for this field,
+ and whether the values are considered a guaranteed API.
+ The value should be a CamelCase string.
+ This field may not be empty.
+ maxLength: 1024
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[A-Za-z]([A-Za-z0-9_,:]*[A-Za-z0-9_])?$
+ type: string
+ status:
+ description: status of the condition, one of True, False, Unknown.
+ enum:
+ - "True"
+ - "False"
+ - Unknown
+ type: string
+ type:
+ description: |-
+ type of condition in CamelCase or in foo.example.com/CamelCase.
+ ---
+ Many .condition.type values are consistent across resources like Available, but because arbitrary conditions can be
+ useful (see .node.status.conditions), the ability to deconflict is important.
+ The regex it matches is (dns1123SubdomainFmt/)?(qualifiedNameFmt)
+ maxLength: 316
+ pattern: ^([a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*/)?(([A-Za-z0-9][-A-Za-z0-9_.]*)?[A-Za-z0-9])$
+ type: string
+ required:
+ - lastTransitionTime
+ - message
+ - reason
+ - status
+ - type
+ type: object
+ maxItems: 8
+ type: array
+ x-kubernetes-list-map-keys:
+ - type
+ x-kubernetes-list-type: map
+ listeners:
+ description: Listeners provide status for each unique listener port
+ defined in the Spec.
+ items:
+ description: ListenerStatus is the status associated with a Listener.
+ properties:
+ attachedRoutes:
+ description: |-
+ AttachedRoutes represents the total number of Routes that have been
+ successfully attached to this Listener.
+
+
+ Successful attachment of a Route to a Listener is based solely on the
+ combination of the AllowedRoutes field on the corresponding Listener
+ and the Route's ParentRefs field. A Route is successfully attached to
+ a Listener when it is selected by the Listener's AllowedRoutes field
+ AND the Route has a valid ParentRef selecting the whole Gateway
+ resource or a specific Listener as a parent resource (more detail on
+ attachment semantics can be found in the documentation on the various
+ Route kinds ParentRefs fields). Listener or Route status does not impact
+ successful attachment, i.e. the AttachedRoutes field count MUST be set
+ for Listeners with condition Accepted: false and MUST count successfully
+ attached Routes that may themselves have Accepted: false conditions.
+
+
+ Uses for this field include troubleshooting Route attachment and
+ measuring blast radius/impact of changes to a Listener.
+ format: int32
+ type: integer
+ conditions:
+ description: Conditions describe the current condition of this
+ listener.
+ items:
+ description: "Condition contains details for one aspect of
+ the current state of this API Resource.\n---\nThis struct
+ is intended for direct use as an array at the field path
+ .status.conditions. For example,\n\n\n\ttype FooStatus
+ struct{\n\t // Represents the observations of a foo's
+ current state.\n\t // Known .status.conditions.type are:
+ \"Available\", \"Progressing\", and \"Degraded\"\n\t //
+ +patchMergeKey=type\n\t // +patchStrategy=merge\n\t //
+ +listType=map\n\t // +listMapKey=type\n\t Conditions
+ []metav1.Condition `json:\"conditions,omitempty\" patchStrategy:\"merge\"
+ patchMergeKey:\"type\" protobuf:\"bytes,1,rep,name=conditions\"`\n\n\n\t
+ \ // other fields\n\t}"
+ properties:
+ lastTransitionTime:
+ description: |-
+ lastTransitionTime is the last time the condition transitioned from one status to another.
+ This should be when the underlying condition changed. If that is not known, then using the time when the API field changed is acceptable.
+ format: date-time
+ type: string
+ message:
+ description: |-
+ message is a human readable message indicating details about the transition.
+ This may be an empty string.
+ maxLength: 32768
+ type: string
+ observedGeneration:
+ description: |-
+ observedGeneration represents the .metadata.generation that the condition was set based upon.
+ For instance, if .metadata.generation is currently 12, but the .status.conditions[x].observedGeneration is 9, the condition is out of date
+ with respect to the current state of the instance.
+ format: int64
+ minimum: 0
+ type: integer
+ reason:
+ description: |-
+ reason contains a programmatic identifier indicating the reason for the condition's last transition.
+ Producers of specific condition types may define expected values and meanings for this field,
+ and whether the values are considered a guaranteed API.
+ The value should be a CamelCase string.
+ This field may not be empty.
+ maxLength: 1024
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[A-Za-z]([A-Za-z0-9_,:]*[A-Za-z0-9_])?$
+ type: string
+ status:
+ description: status of the condition, one of True, False,
+ Unknown.
+ enum:
+ - "True"
+ - "False"
+ - Unknown
+ type: string
+ type:
+ description: |-
+ type of condition in CamelCase or in foo.example.com/CamelCase.
+ ---
+ Many .condition.type values are consistent across resources like Available, but because arbitrary conditions can be
+ useful (see .node.status.conditions), the ability to deconflict is important.
+ The regex it matches is (dns1123SubdomainFmt/)?(qualifiedNameFmt)
+ maxLength: 316
+ pattern: ^([a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*/)?(([A-Za-z0-9][-A-Za-z0-9_.]*)?[A-Za-z0-9])$
+ type: string
+ required:
+ - lastTransitionTime
+ - message
+ - reason
+ - status
+ - type
+ type: object
+ maxItems: 8
+ type: array
+ x-kubernetes-list-map-keys:
+ - type
+ x-kubernetes-list-type: map
+ name:
+ description: Name is the name of the Listener that this status
+ corresponds to.
+ maxLength: 253
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$
+ type: string
+ supportedKinds:
+ description: |-
+ SupportedKinds is the list indicating the Kinds supported by this
+ listener. This MUST represent the kinds an implementation supports for
+ that Listener configuration.
+
+
+ If kinds are specified in Spec that are not supported, they MUST NOT
+ appear in this list and an implementation MUST set the "ResolvedRefs"
+ condition to "False" with the "InvalidRouteKinds" reason. If both valid
+ and invalid Route kinds are specified, the implementation MUST
+ reference the valid Route kinds that have been specified.
+ items:
+ description: RouteGroupKind indicates the group and kind of
+ a Route resource.
+ properties:
+ group:
+ default: gateway.networking.k8s.io
+ description: Group is the group of the Route.
+ maxLength: 253
+ pattern: ^$|^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$
+ type: string
+ kind:
+ description: Kind is the kind of the Route.
+ maxLength: 63
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[a-zA-Z]([-a-zA-Z0-9]*[a-zA-Z0-9])?$
+ type: string
+ required:
+ - kind
+ type: object
+ maxItems: 8
+ type: array
+ required:
+ - attachedRoutes
+ - conditions
+ - name
+ - supportedKinds
+ type: object
+ maxItems: 64
+ type: array
+ x-kubernetes-list-map-keys:
+ - name
+ x-kubernetes-list-type: map
+ type: object
+ required:
+ - spec
+ type: object
+ served: true
+ storage: false
+ subresources:
+ status: {}
+status:
+ acceptedNames:
+ kind: ""
+ plural: ""
+ conditions: null
+ storedVersions: null
+---
+#
+# config/crd/experimental/gateway.networking.k8s.io_grpcroutes.yaml
+#
+apiVersion: apiextensions.k8s.io/v1
+kind: CustomResourceDefinition
+metadata:
+ annotations:
+ api-approved.kubernetes.io: https://github.com/kubernetes-sigs/gateway-api/pull/2997
+ gateway.networking.k8s.io/bundle-version: v1.1.0
+ gateway.networking.k8s.io/channel: experimental
+ creationTimestamp: null
+ name: grpcroutes.gateway.networking.k8s.io
+spec:
+ group: gateway.networking.k8s.io
+ names:
+ categories:
+ - gateway-api
+ kind: GRPCRoute
+ listKind: GRPCRouteList
+ plural: grpcroutes
+ singular: grpcroute
+ scope: Namespaced
+ versions:
+ - additionalPrinterColumns:
+ - jsonPath: .spec.hostnames
+ name: Hostnames
+ type: string
+ - jsonPath: .metadata.creationTimestamp
+ name: Age
+ type: date
+ name: v1
+ schema:
+ openAPIV3Schema:
+ description: |-
+ GRPCRoute provides a way to route gRPC requests. This includes the capability
+ to match requests by hostname, gRPC service, gRPC method, or HTTP/2 header.
+ Filters can be used to specify additional processing steps. Backends specify
+ where matching requests will be routed.
+
+
+ GRPCRoute falls under extended support within the Gateway API. Within the
+ following specification, the word "MUST" indicates that an implementation
+ supporting GRPCRoute must conform to the indicated requirement, but an
+ implementation not supporting this route type need not follow the requirement
+ unless explicitly indicated.
+
+
+ Implementations supporting `GRPCRoute` with the `HTTPS` `ProtocolType` MUST
+ accept HTTP/2 connections without an initial upgrade from HTTP/1.1, i.e. via
+ ALPN. If the implementation does not support this, then it MUST set the
+ "Accepted" condition to "False" for the affected listener with a reason of
+ "UnsupportedProtocol". Implementations MAY also accept HTTP/2 connections
+ with an upgrade from HTTP/1.
+
+
+ Implementations supporting `GRPCRoute` with the `HTTP` `ProtocolType` MUST
+ support HTTP/2 over cleartext TCP (h2c,
+ https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc7540#section-3.1) without an initial
+ upgrade from HTTP/1.1, i.e. with prior knowledge
+ (https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc7540#section-3.4). If the implementation
+ does not support this, then it MUST set the "Accepted" condition to "False"
+ for the affected listener with a reason of "UnsupportedProtocol".
+ Implementations MAY also accept HTTP/2 connections with an upgrade from
+ HTTP/1, i.e. without prior knowledge.
+ properties:
+ apiVersion:
+ description: |-
+ APIVersion defines the versioned schema of this representation of an object.
+ Servers should convert recognized schemas to the latest internal value, and
+ may reject unrecognized values.
+ More info: https://git.k8s.io/community/contributors/devel/sig-architecture/api-conventions.md#resources
+ type: string
+ kind:
+ description: |-
+ Kind is a string value representing the REST resource this object represents.
+ Servers may infer this from the endpoint the client submits requests to.
+ Cannot be updated.
+ In CamelCase.
+ More info: https://git.k8s.io/community/contributors/devel/sig-architecture/api-conventions.md#types-kinds
+ type: string
+ metadata:
+ type: object
+ spec:
+ description: Spec defines the desired state of GRPCRoute.
+ properties:
+ hostnames:
+ description: |-
+ Hostnames defines a set of hostnames to match against the GRPC
+ Host header to select a GRPCRoute to process the request. This matches
+ the RFC 1123 definition of a hostname with 2 notable exceptions:
+
+
+ 1. IPs are not allowed.
+ 2. A hostname may be prefixed with a wildcard label (`*.`). The wildcard
+ label MUST appear by itself as the first label.
+
+
+ If a hostname is specified by both the Listener and GRPCRoute, there
+ MUST be at least one intersecting hostname for the GRPCRoute to be
+ attached to the Listener. For example:
+
+
+ * A Listener with `test.example.com` as the hostname matches GRPCRoutes
+ that have either not specified any hostnames, or have specified at
+ least one of `test.example.com` or `*.example.com`.
+ * A Listener with `*.example.com` as the hostname matches GRPCRoutes
+ that have either not specified any hostnames or have specified at least
+ one hostname that matches the Listener hostname. For example,
+ `test.example.com` and `*.example.com` would both match. On the other
+ hand, `example.com` and `test.example.net` would not match.
+
+
+ Hostnames that are prefixed with a wildcard label (`*.`) are interpreted
+ as a suffix match. That means that a match for `*.example.com` would match
+ both `test.example.com`, and `foo.test.example.com`, but not `example.com`.
+
+
+ If both the Listener and GRPCRoute have specified hostnames, any
+ GRPCRoute hostnames that do not match the Listener hostname MUST be
+ ignored. For example, if a Listener specified `*.example.com`, and the
+ GRPCRoute specified `test.example.com` and `test.example.net`,
+ `test.example.net` MUST NOT be considered for a match.
+
+
+ If both the Listener and GRPCRoute have specified hostnames, and none
+ match with the criteria above, then the GRPCRoute MUST NOT be accepted by
+ the implementation. The implementation MUST raise an 'Accepted' Condition
+ with a status of `False` in the corresponding RouteParentStatus.
+
+
+ If a Route (A) of type HTTPRoute or GRPCRoute is attached to a
+ Listener and that listener already has another Route (B) of the other
+ type attached and the intersection of the hostnames of A and B is
+ non-empty, then the implementation MUST accept exactly one of these two
+ routes, determined by the following criteria, in order:
+
+
+ * The oldest Route based on creation timestamp.
+ * The Route appearing first in alphabetical order by
+ "{namespace}/{name}".
+
+
+ The rejected Route MUST raise an 'Accepted' condition with a status of
+ 'False' in the corresponding RouteParentStatus.
+
+
+ Support: Core
+ items:
+ description: |-
+ Hostname is the fully qualified domain name of a network host. This matches
+ the RFC 1123 definition of a hostname with 2 notable exceptions:
+
+
+ 1. IPs are not allowed.
+ 2. A hostname may be prefixed with a wildcard label (`*.`). The wildcard
+ label must appear by itself as the first label.
+
+
+ Hostname can be "precise" which is a domain name without the terminating
+ dot of a network host (e.g. "foo.example.com") or "wildcard", which is a
+ domain name prefixed with a single wildcard label (e.g. `*.example.com`).
+
+
+ Note that as per RFC1035 and RFC1123, a *label* must consist of lower case
+ alphanumeric characters or '-', and must start and end with an alphanumeric
+ character. No other punctuation is allowed.
+ maxLength: 253
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^(\*\.)?[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$
+ type: string
+ maxItems: 16
+ type: array
+ parentRefs:
+ description: |+
+ ParentRefs references the resources (usually Gateways) that a Route wants
+ to be attached to. Note that the referenced parent resource needs to
+ allow this for the attachment to be complete. For Gateways, that means
+ the Gateway needs to allow attachment from Routes of this kind and
+ namespace. For Services, that means the Service must either be in the same
+ namespace for a "producer" route, or the mesh implementation must support
+ and allow "consumer" routes for the referenced Service. ReferenceGrant is
+ not applicable for governing ParentRefs to Services - it is not possible to
+ create a "producer" route for a Service in a different namespace from the
+ Route.
+
+
+ There are two kinds of parent resources with "Core" support:
+
+
+ * Gateway (Gateway conformance profile)
+ * Service (Mesh conformance profile, ClusterIP Services only)
+
+
+ This API may be extended in the future to support additional kinds of parent
+ resources.
+
+
+ ParentRefs must be _distinct_. This means either that:
+
+
+ * They select different objects. If this is the case, then parentRef
+ entries are distinct. In terms of fields, this means that the
+ multi-part key defined by `group`, `kind`, `namespace`, and `name` must
+ be unique across all parentRef entries in the Route.
+ * They do not select different objects, but for each optional field used,
+ each ParentRef that selects the same object must set the same set of
+ optional fields to different values. If one ParentRef sets a
+ combination of optional fields, all must set the same combination.
+
+
+ Some examples:
+
+
+ * If one ParentRef sets `sectionName`, all ParentRefs referencing the
+ same object must also set `sectionName`.
+ * If one ParentRef sets `port`, all ParentRefs referencing the same
+ object must also set `port`.
+ * If one ParentRef sets `sectionName` and `port`, all ParentRefs
+ referencing the same object must also set `sectionName` and `port`.
+
+
+ It is possible to separately reference multiple distinct objects that may
+ be collapsed by an implementation. For example, some implementations may
+ choose to merge compatible Gateway Listeners together. If that is the
+ case, the list of routes attached to those resources should also be
+ merged.
+
+
+ Note that for ParentRefs that cross namespace boundaries, there are specific
+ rules. Cross-namespace references are only valid if they are explicitly
+ allowed by something in the namespace they are referring to. For example,
+ Gateway has the AllowedRoutes field, and ReferenceGrant provides a
+ generic way to enable other kinds of cross-namespace reference.
+
+
+
+ ParentRefs from a Route to a Service in the same namespace are "producer"
+ routes, which apply default routing rules to inbound connections from
+ any namespace to the Service.
+
+
+ ParentRefs from a Route to a Service in a different namespace are
+ "consumer" routes, and these routing rules are only applied to outbound
+ connections originating from the same namespace as the Route, for which
+ the intended destination of the connections are a Service targeted as a
+ ParentRef of the Route.
+
+
+
+
+
+
+ items:
+ description: |-
+ ParentReference identifies an API object (usually a Gateway) that can be considered
+ a parent of this resource (usually a route). There are two kinds of parent resources
+ with "Core" support:
+
+
+ * Gateway (Gateway conformance profile)
+ * Service (Mesh conformance profile, ClusterIP Services only)
+
+
+ This API may be extended in the future to support additional kinds of parent
+ resources.
+
+
+ The API object must be valid in the cluster; the Group and Kind must
+ be registered in the cluster for this reference to be valid.
+ properties:
+ group:
+ default: gateway.networking.k8s.io
+ description: |-
+ Group is the group of the referent.
+ When unspecified, "gateway.networking.k8s.io" is inferred.
+ To set the core API group (such as for a "Service" kind referent),
+ Group must be explicitly set to "" (empty string).
+
+
+ Support: Core
+ maxLength: 253
+ pattern: ^$|^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$
+ type: string
+ kind:
+ default: Gateway
+ description: |-
+ Kind is kind of the referent.
+
+
+ There are two kinds of parent resources with "Core" support:
+
+
+ * Gateway (Gateway conformance profile)
+ * Service (Mesh conformance profile, ClusterIP Services only)
+
+
+ Support for other resources is Implementation-Specific.
+ maxLength: 63
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[a-zA-Z]([-a-zA-Z0-9]*[a-zA-Z0-9])?$
+ type: string
+ name:
+ description: |-
+ Name is the name of the referent.
+
+
+ Support: Core
+ maxLength: 253
+ minLength: 1
+ type: string
+ namespace:
+ description: |-
+ Namespace is the namespace of the referent. When unspecified, this refers
+ to the local namespace of the Route.
+
+
+ Note that there are specific rules for ParentRefs which cross namespace
+ boundaries. Cross-namespace references are only valid if they are explicitly
+ allowed by something in the namespace they are referring to. For example:
+ Gateway has the AllowedRoutes field, and ReferenceGrant provides a
+ generic way to enable any other kind of cross-namespace reference.
+
+
+
+ ParentRefs from a Route to a Service in the same namespace are "producer"
+ routes, which apply default routing rules to inbound connections from
+ any namespace to the Service.
+
+
+ ParentRefs from a Route to a Service in a different namespace are
+ "consumer" routes, and these routing rules are only applied to outbound
+ connections originating from the same namespace as the Route, for which
+ the intended destination of the connections are a Service targeted as a
+ ParentRef of the Route.
+
+
+
+ Support: Core
+ maxLength: 63
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?$
+ type: string
+ port:
+ description: |-
+ Port is the network port this Route targets. It can be interpreted
+ differently based on the type of parent resource.
+
+
+ When the parent resource is a Gateway, this targets all listeners
+ listening on the specified port that also support this kind of Route(and
+ select this Route). It's not recommended to set `Port` unless the
+ networking behaviors specified in a Route must apply to a specific port
+ as opposed to a listener(s) whose port(s) may be changed. When both Port
+ and SectionName are specified, the name and port of the selected listener
+ must match both specified values.
+
+
+
+ When the parent resource is a Service, this targets a specific port in the
+ Service spec. When both Port (experimental) and SectionName are specified,
+ the name and port of the selected port must match both specified values.
+
+
+
+ Implementations MAY choose to support other parent resources.
+ Implementations supporting other types of parent resources MUST clearly
+ document how/if Port is interpreted.
+
+
+ For the purpose of status, an attachment is considered successful as
+ long as the parent resource accepts it partially. For example, Gateway
+ listeners can restrict which Routes can attach to them by Route kind,
+ namespace, or hostname. If 1 of 2 Gateway listeners accept attachment
+ from the referencing Route, the Route MUST be considered successfully
+ attached. If no Gateway listeners accept attachment from this Route,
+ the Route MUST be considered detached from the Gateway.
+
+
+ Support: Extended
+ format: int32
+ maximum: 65535
+ minimum: 1
+ type: integer
+ sectionName:
+ description: |-
+ SectionName is the name of a section within the target resource. In the
+ following resources, SectionName is interpreted as the following:
+
+
+ * Gateway: Listener name. When both Port (experimental) and SectionName
+ are specified, the name and port of the selected listener must match
+ both specified values.
+ * Service: Port name. When both Port (experimental) and SectionName
+ are specified, the name and port of the selected listener must match
+ both specified values.
+
+
+ Implementations MAY choose to support attaching Routes to other resources.
+ If that is the case, they MUST clearly document how SectionName is
+ interpreted.
+
+
+ When unspecified (empty string), this will reference the entire resource.
+ For the purpose of status, an attachment is considered successful if at
+ least one section in the parent resource accepts it. For example, Gateway
+ listeners can restrict which Routes can attach to them by Route kind,
+ namespace, or hostname. If 1 of 2 Gateway listeners accept attachment from
+ the referencing Route, the Route MUST be considered successfully
+ attached. If no Gateway listeners accept attachment from this Route, the
+ Route MUST be considered detached from the Gateway.
+
+
+ Support: Core
+ maxLength: 253
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$
+ type: string
+ required:
+ - name
+ type: object
+ maxItems: 32
+ type: array
+ x-kubernetes-validations:
+ - message: sectionName or port must be specified when parentRefs includes
+ 2 or more references to the same parent
+ rule: 'self.all(p1, self.all(p2, p1.group == p2.group && p1.kind
+ == p2.kind && p1.name == p2.name && (((!has(p1.__namespace__)
+ || p1.__namespace__ == '''') && (!has(p2.__namespace__) || p2.__namespace__
+ == '''')) || (has(p1.__namespace__) && has(p2.__namespace__) &&
+ p1.__namespace__ == p2.__namespace__)) ? ((!has(p1.sectionName)
+ || p1.sectionName == '''') == (!has(p2.sectionName) || p2.sectionName
+ == '''') && (!has(p1.port) || p1.port == 0) == (!has(p2.port)
+ || p2.port == 0)): true))'
+ - message: sectionName or port must be unique when parentRefs includes
+ 2 or more references to the same parent
+ rule: self.all(p1, self.exists_one(p2, p1.group == p2.group && p1.kind
+ == p2.kind && p1.name == p2.name && (((!has(p1.__namespace__)
+ || p1.__namespace__ == '') && (!has(p2.__namespace__) || p2.__namespace__
+ == '')) || (has(p1.__namespace__) && has(p2.__namespace__) &&
+ p1.__namespace__ == p2.__namespace__ )) && (((!has(p1.sectionName)
+ || p1.sectionName == '') && (!has(p2.sectionName) || p2.sectionName
+ == '')) || ( has(p1.sectionName) && has(p2.sectionName) && p1.sectionName
+ == p2.sectionName)) && (((!has(p1.port) || p1.port == 0) && (!has(p2.port)
+ || p2.port == 0)) || (has(p1.port) && has(p2.port) && p1.port
+ == p2.port))))
+ rules:
+ description: Rules are a list of GRPC matchers, filters and actions.
+ items:
+ description: |-
+ GRPCRouteRule defines the semantics for matching a gRPC request based on
+ conditions (matches), processing it (filters), and forwarding the request to
+ an API object (backendRefs).
+ properties:
+ backendRefs:
+ description: |-
+ BackendRefs defines the backend(s) where matching requests should be
+ sent.
+
+
+ Failure behavior here depends on how many BackendRefs are specified and
+ how many are invalid.
+
+
+ If *all* entries in BackendRefs are invalid, and there are also no filters
+ specified in this route rule, *all* traffic which matches this rule MUST
+ receive an `UNAVAILABLE` status.
+
+
+ See the GRPCBackendRef definition for the rules about what makes a single
+ GRPCBackendRef invalid.
+
+
+ When a GRPCBackendRef is invalid, `UNAVAILABLE` statuses MUST be returned for
+ requests that would have otherwise been routed to an invalid backend. If
+ multiple backends are specified, and some are invalid, the proportion of
+ requests that would otherwise have been routed to an invalid backend
+ MUST receive an `UNAVAILABLE` status.
+
+
+ For example, if two backends are specified with equal weights, and one is
+ invalid, 50 percent of traffic MUST receive an `UNAVAILABLE` status.
+ Implementations may choose how that 50 percent is determined.
+
+
+ Support: Core for Kubernetes Service
+
+
+ Support: Implementation-specific for any other resource
+
+
+ Support for weight: Core
+ items:
+ description: |-
+ GRPCBackendRef defines how a GRPCRoute forwards a gRPC request.
+
+
+ Note that when a namespace different than the local namespace is specified, a
+ ReferenceGrant object is required in the referent namespace to allow that
+ namespace's owner to accept the reference. See the ReferenceGrant
+ documentation for details.
+
+
+
+
+
+ When the BackendRef points to a Kubernetes Service, implementations SHOULD
+ honor the appProtocol field if it is set for the target Service Port.
+
+
+ Implementations supporting appProtocol SHOULD recognize the Kubernetes
+ Standard Application Protocols defined in KEP-3726.
+
+
+ If a Service appProtocol isn't specified, an implementation MAY infer the
+ backend protocol through its own means. Implementations MAY infer the
+ protocol from the Route type referring to the backend Service.
+
+
+ If a Route is not able to send traffic to the backend using the specified
+ protocol then the backend is considered invalid. Implementations MUST set the
+ "ResolvedRefs" condition to "False" with the "UnsupportedProtocol" reason.
+
+
+
+ properties:
+ filters:
+ description: |-
+ Filters defined at this level MUST be executed if and only if the
+ request is being forwarded to the backend defined here.
+
+
+ Support: Implementation-specific (For broader support of filters, use the
+ Filters field in GRPCRouteRule.)
+ items:
+ description: |-
+ GRPCRouteFilter defines processing steps that must be completed during the
+ request or response lifecycle. GRPCRouteFilters are meant as an extension
+ point to express processing that may be done in Gateway implementations. Some
+ examples include request or response modification, implementing
+ authentication strategies, rate-limiting, and traffic shaping. API
+ guarantee/conformance is defined based on the type of the filter.
+ properties:
+ extensionRef:
+ description: |-
+ ExtensionRef is an optional, implementation-specific extension to the
+ "filter" behavior. For example, resource "myroutefilter" in group
+ "networking.example.net"). ExtensionRef MUST NOT be used for core and
+ extended filters.
+
+
+ Support: Implementation-specific
+
+
+ This filter can be used multiple times within the same rule.
+ properties:
+ group:
+ description: |-
+ Group is the group of the referent. For example, "gateway.networking.k8s.io".
+ When unspecified or empty string, core API group is inferred.
+ maxLength: 253
+ pattern: ^$|^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$
+ type: string
+ kind:
+ description: Kind is kind of the referent. For
+ example "HTTPRoute" or "Service".
+ maxLength: 63
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[a-zA-Z]([-a-zA-Z0-9]*[a-zA-Z0-9])?$
+ type: string
+ name:
+ description: Name is the name of the referent.
+ maxLength: 253
+ minLength: 1
+ type: string
+ required:
+ - group
+ - kind
+ - name
+ type: object
+ requestHeaderModifier:
+ description: |-
+ RequestHeaderModifier defines a schema for a filter that modifies request
+ headers.
+
+
+ Support: Core
+ properties:
+ add:
+ description: |-
+ Add adds the given header(s) (name, value) to the request
+ before the action. It appends to any existing values associated
+ with the header name.
+
+
+ Input:
+ GET /foo HTTP/1.1
+ my-header: foo
+
+
+ Config:
+ add:
+ - name: "my-header"
+ value: "bar,baz"
+
+
+ Output:
+ GET /foo HTTP/1.1
+ my-header: foo,bar,baz
+ items:
+ description: HTTPHeader represents an HTTP
+ Header name and value as defined by RFC
+ 7230.
+ properties:
+ name:
+ description: |-
+ Name is the name of the HTTP Header to be matched. Name matching MUST be
+ case insensitive. (See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc7230#section-3.2).
+
+
+ If multiple entries specify equivalent header names, the first entry with
+ an equivalent name MUST be considered for a match. Subsequent entries
+ with an equivalent header name MUST be ignored. Due to the
+ case-insensitivity of header names, "foo" and "Foo" are considered
+ equivalent.
+ maxLength: 256
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[A-Za-z0-9!#$%&'*+\-.^_\x60|~]+$
+ type: string
+ value:
+ description: Value is the value of HTTP
+ Header to be matched.
+ maxLength: 4096
+ minLength: 1
+ type: string
+ required:
+ - name
+ - value
+ type: object
+ maxItems: 16
+ type: array
+ x-kubernetes-list-map-keys:
+ - name
+ x-kubernetes-list-type: map
+ remove:
+ description: |-
+ Remove the given header(s) from the HTTP request before the action. The
+ value of Remove is a list of HTTP header names. Note that the header
+ names are case-insensitive (see
+ https://datatracker.ietf.org/doc/html/rfc2616#section-4.2).
+
+
+ Input:
+ GET /foo HTTP/1.1
+ my-header1: foo
+ my-header2: bar
+ my-header3: baz
+
+
+ Config:
+ remove: ["my-header1", "my-header3"]
+
+
+ Output:
+ GET /foo HTTP/1.1
+ my-header2: bar
+ items:
+ type: string
+ maxItems: 16
+ type: array
+ x-kubernetes-list-type: set
+ set:
+ description: |-
+ Set overwrites the request with the given header (name, value)
+ before the action.
+
+
+ Input:
+ GET /foo HTTP/1.1
+ my-header: foo
+
+
+ Config:
+ set:
+ - name: "my-header"
+ value: "bar"
+
+
+ Output:
+ GET /foo HTTP/1.1
+ my-header: bar
+ items:
+ description: HTTPHeader represents an HTTP
+ Header name and value as defined by RFC
+ 7230.
+ properties:
+ name:
+ description: |-
+ Name is the name of the HTTP Header to be matched. Name matching MUST be
+ case insensitive. (See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc7230#section-3.2).
+
+
+ If multiple entries specify equivalent header names, the first entry with
+ an equivalent name MUST be considered for a match. Subsequent entries
+ with an equivalent header name MUST be ignored. Due to the
+ case-insensitivity of header names, "foo" and "Foo" are considered
+ equivalent.
+ maxLength: 256
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[A-Za-z0-9!#$%&'*+\-.^_\x60|~]+$
+ type: string
+ value:
+ description: Value is the value of HTTP
+ Header to be matched.
+ maxLength: 4096
+ minLength: 1
+ type: string
+ required:
+ - name
+ - value
+ type: object
+ maxItems: 16
+ type: array
+ x-kubernetes-list-map-keys:
+ - name
+ x-kubernetes-list-type: map
+ type: object
+ requestMirror:
+ description: |-
+ RequestMirror defines a schema for a filter that mirrors requests.
+ Requests are sent to the specified destination, but responses from
+ that destination are ignored.
+
+
+ This filter can be used multiple times within the same rule. Note that
+ not all implementations will be able to support mirroring to multiple
+ backends.
+
+
+ Support: Extended
+ properties:
+ backendRef:
+ description: |-
+ BackendRef references a resource where mirrored requests are sent.
+
+
+ Mirrored requests must be sent only to a single destination endpoint
+ within this BackendRef, irrespective of how many endpoints are present
+ within this BackendRef.
+
+
+ If the referent cannot be found, this BackendRef is invalid and must be
+ dropped from the Gateway. The controller must ensure the "ResolvedRefs"
+ condition on the Route status is set to `status: False` and not configure
+ this backend in the underlying implementation.
+
+
+ If there is a cross-namespace reference to an *existing* object
+ that is not allowed by a ReferenceGrant, the controller must ensure the
+ "ResolvedRefs" condition on the Route is set to `status: False`,
+ with the "RefNotPermitted" reason and not configure this backend in the
+ underlying implementation.
+
+
+ In either error case, the Message of the `ResolvedRefs` Condition
+ should be used to provide more detail about the problem.
+
+
+ Support: Extended for Kubernetes Service
+
+
+ Support: Implementation-specific for any other resource
+ properties:
+ group:
+ default: ""
+ description: |-
+ Group is the group of the referent. For example, "gateway.networking.k8s.io".
+ When unspecified or empty string, core API group is inferred.
+ maxLength: 253
+ pattern: ^$|^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$
+ type: string
+ kind:
+ default: Service
+ description: |-
+ Kind is the Kubernetes resource kind of the referent. For example
+ "Service".
+
+
+ Defaults to "Service" when not specified.
+
+
+ ExternalName services can refer to CNAME DNS records that may live
+ outside of the cluster and as such are difficult to reason about in
+ terms of conformance. They also may not be safe to forward to (see
+ CVE-2021-25740 for more information). Implementations SHOULD NOT
+ support ExternalName Services.
+
+
+ Support: Core (Services with a type other than ExternalName)
+
+
+ Support: Implementation-specific (Services with type ExternalName)
+ maxLength: 63
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[a-zA-Z]([-a-zA-Z0-9]*[a-zA-Z0-9])?$
+ type: string
+ name:
+ description: Name is the name of the referent.
+ maxLength: 253
+ minLength: 1
+ type: string
+ namespace:
+ description: |-
+ Namespace is the namespace of the backend. When unspecified, the local
+ namespace is inferred.
+
+
+ Note that when a namespace different than the local namespace is specified,
+ a ReferenceGrant object is required in the referent namespace to allow that
+ namespace's owner to accept the reference. See the ReferenceGrant
+ documentation for details.
+
+
+ Support: Core
+ maxLength: 63
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?$
+ type: string
+ port:
+ description: |-
+ Port specifies the destination port number to use for this resource.
+ Port is required when the referent is a Kubernetes Service. In this
+ case, the port number is the service port number, not the target port.
+ For other resources, destination port might be derived from the referent
+ resource or this field.
+ format: int32
+ maximum: 65535
+ minimum: 1
+ type: integer
+ required:
+ - name
+ type: object
+ x-kubernetes-validations:
+ - message: Must have port for Service reference
+ rule: '(size(self.group) == 0 && self.kind
+ == ''Service'') ? has(self.port) : true'
+ required:
+ - backendRef
+ type: object
+ responseHeaderModifier:
+ description: |-
+ ResponseHeaderModifier defines a schema for a filter that modifies response
+ headers.
+
+
+ Support: Extended
+ properties:
+ add:
+ description: |-
+ Add adds the given header(s) (name, value) to the request
+ before the action. It appends to any existing values associated
+ with the header name.
+
+
+ Input:
+ GET /foo HTTP/1.1
+ my-header: foo
+
+
+ Config:
+ add:
+ - name: "my-header"
+ value: "bar,baz"
+
+
+ Output:
+ GET /foo HTTP/1.1
+ my-header: foo,bar,baz
+ items:
+ description: HTTPHeader represents an HTTP
+ Header name and value as defined by RFC
+ 7230.
+ properties:
+ name:
+ description: |-
+ Name is the name of the HTTP Header to be matched. Name matching MUST be
+ case insensitive. (See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc7230#section-3.2).
+
+
+ If multiple entries specify equivalent header names, the first entry with
+ an equivalent name MUST be considered for a match. Subsequent entries
+ with an equivalent header name MUST be ignored. Due to the
+ case-insensitivity of header names, "foo" and "Foo" are considered
+ equivalent.
+ maxLength: 256
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[A-Za-z0-9!#$%&'*+\-.^_\x60|~]+$
+ type: string
+ value:
+ description: Value is the value of HTTP
+ Header to be matched.
+ maxLength: 4096
+ minLength: 1
+ type: string
+ required:
+ - name
+ - value
+ type: object
+ maxItems: 16
+ type: array
+ x-kubernetes-list-map-keys:
+ - name
+ x-kubernetes-list-type: map
+ remove:
+ description: |-
+ Remove the given header(s) from the HTTP request before the action. The
+ value of Remove is a list of HTTP header names. Note that the header
+ names are case-insensitive (see
+ https://datatracker.ietf.org/doc/html/rfc2616#section-4.2).
+
+
+ Input:
+ GET /foo HTTP/1.1
+ my-header1: foo
+ my-header2: bar
+ my-header3: baz
+
+
+ Config:
+ remove: ["my-header1", "my-header3"]
+
+
+ Output:
+ GET /foo HTTP/1.1
+ my-header2: bar
+ items:
+ type: string
+ maxItems: 16
+ type: array
+ x-kubernetes-list-type: set
+ set:
+ description: |-
+ Set overwrites the request with the given header (name, value)
+ before the action.
+
+
+ Input:
+ GET /foo HTTP/1.1
+ my-header: foo
+
+
+ Config:
+ set:
+ - name: "my-header"
+ value: "bar"
+
+
+ Output:
+ GET /foo HTTP/1.1
+ my-header: bar
+ items:
+ description: HTTPHeader represents an HTTP
+ Header name and value as defined by RFC
+ 7230.
+ properties:
+ name:
+ description: |-
+ Name is the name of the HTTP Header to be matched. Name matching MUST be
+ case insensitive. (See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc7230#section-3.2).
+
+
+ If multiple entries specify equivalent header names, the first entry with
+ an equivalent name MUST be considered for a match. Subsequent entries
+ with an equivalent header name MUST be ignored. Due to the
+ case-insensitivity of header names, "foo" and "Foo" are considered
+ equivalent.
+ maxLength: 256
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[A-Za-z0-9!#$%&'*+\-.^_\x60|~]+$
+ type: string
+ value:
+ description: Value is the value of HTTP
+ Header to be matched.
+ maxLength: 4096
+ minLength: 1
+ type: string
+ required:
+ - name
+ - value
+ type: object
+ maxItems: 16
+ type: array
+ x-kubernetes-list-map-keys:
+ - name
+ x-kubernetes-list-type: map
+ type: object
+ type:
+ description: |+
+ Type identifies the type of filter to apply. As with other API fields,
+ types are classified into three conformance levels:
+
+
+ - Core: Filter types and their corresponding configuration defined by
+ "Support: Core" in this package, e.g. "RequestHeaderModifier". All
+ implementations supporting GRPCRoute MUST support core filters.
+
+
+ - Extended: Filter types and their corresponding configuration defined by
+ "Support: Extended" in this package, e.g. "RequestMirror". Implementers
+ are encouraged to support extended filters.
+
+
+ - Implementation-specific: Filters that are defined and supported by specific vendors.
+ In the future, filters showing convergence in behavior across multiple
+ implementations will be considered for inclusion in extended or core
+ conformance levels. Filter-specific configuration for such filters
+ is specified using the ExtensionRef field. `Type` MUST be set to
+ "ExtensionRef" for custom filters.
+
+
+ Implementers are encouraged to define custom implementation types to
+ extend the core API with implementation-specific behavior.
+
+
+ If a reference to a custom filter type cannot be resolved, the filter
+ MUST NOT be skipped. Instead, requests that would have been processed by
+ that filter MUST receive a HTTP error response.
+
+
+ enum:
+ - ResponseHeaderModifier
+ - RequestHeaderModifier
+ - RequestMirror
+ - ExtensionRef
+ type: string
+ required:
+ - type
+ type: object
+ x-kubernetes-validations:
+ - message: filter.requestHeaderModifier must be nil
+ if the filter.type is not RequestHeaderModifier
+ rule: '!(has(self.requestHeaderModifier) && self.type
+ != ''RequestHeaderModifier'')'
+ - message: filter.requestHeaderModifier must be specified
+ for RequestHeaderModifier filter.type
+ rule: '!(!has(self.requestHeaderModifier) && self.type
+ == ''RequestHeaderModifier'')'
+ - message: filter.responseHeaderModifier must be nil
+ if the filter.type is not ResponseHeaderModifier
+ rule: '!(has(self.responseHeaderModifier) && self.type
+ != ''ResponseHeaderModifier'')'
+ - message: filter.responseHeaderModifier must be specified
+ for ResponseHeaderModifier filter.type
+ rule: '!(!has(self.responseHeaderModifier) && self.type
+ == ''ResponseHeaderModifier'')'
+ - message: filter.requestMirror must be nil if the filter.type
+ is not RequestMirror
+ rule: '!(has(self.requestMirror) && self.type != ''RequestMirror'')'
+ - message: filter.requestMirror must be specified for
+ RequestMirror filter.type
+ rule: '!(!has(self.requestMirror) && self.type ==
+ ''RequestMirror'')'
+ - message: filter.extensionRef must be nil if the filter.type
+ is not ExtensionRef
+ rule: '!(has(self.extensionRef) && self.type != ''ExtensionRef'')'
+ - message: filter.extensionRef must be specified for
+ ExtensionRef filter.type
+ rule: '!(!has(self.extensionRef) && self.type == ''ExtensionRef'')'
+ maxItems: 16
+ type: array
+ x-kubernetes-validations:
+ - message: RequestHeaderModifier filter cannot be repeated
+ rule: self.filter(f, f.type == 'RequestHeaderModifier').size()
+ <= 1
+ - message: ResponseHeaderModifier filter cannot be repeated
+ rule: self.filter(f, f.type == 'ResponseHeaderModifier').size()
+ <= 1
+ group:
+ default: ""
+ description: |-
+ Group is the group of the referent. For example, "gateway.networking.k8s.io".
+ When unspecified or empty string, core API group is inferred.
+ maxLength: 253
+ pattern: ^$|^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$
+ type: string
+ kind:
+ default: Service
+ description: |-
+ Kind is the Kubernetes resource kind of the referent. For example
+ "Service".
+
+
+ Defaults to "Service" when not specified.
+
+
+ ExternalName services can refer to CNAME DNS records that may live
+ outside of the cluster and as such are difficult to reason about in
+ terms of conformance. They also may not be safe to forward to (see
+ CVE-2021-25740 for more information). Implementations SHOULD NOT
+ support ExternalName Services.
+
+
+ Support: Core (Services with a type other than ExternalName)
+
+
+ Support: Implementation-specific (Services with type ExternalName)
+ maxLength: 63
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[a-zA-Z]([-a-zA-Z0-9]*[a-zA-Z0-9])?$
+ type: string
+ name:
+ description: Name is the name of the referent.
+ maxLength: 253
+ minLength: 1
+ type: string
+ namespace:
+ description: |-
+ Namespace is the namespace of the backend. When unspecified, the local
+ namespace is inferred.
+
+
+ Note that when a namespace different than the local namespace is specified,
+ a ReferenceGrant object is required in the referent namespace to allow that
+ namespace's owner to accept the reference. See the ReferenceGrant
+ documentation for details.
+
+
+ Support: Core
+ maxLength: 63
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?$
+ type: string
+ port:
+ description: |-
+ Port specifies the destination port number to use for this resource.
+ Port is required when the referent is a Kubernetes Service. In this
+ case, the port number is the service port number, not the target port.
+ For other resources, destination port might be derived from the referent
+ resource or this field.
+ format: int32
+ maximum: 65535
+ minimum: 1
+ type: integer
+ weight:
+ default: 1
+ description: |-
+ Weight specifies the proportion of requests forwarded to the referenced
+ backend. This is computed as weight/(sum of all weights in this
+ BackendRefs list). For non-zero values, there may be some epsilon from
+ the exact proportion defined here depending on the precision an
+ implementation supports. Weight is not a percentage and the sum of
+ weights does not need to equal 100.
+
+
+ If only one backend is specified and it has a weight greater than 0, 100%
+ of the traffic is forwarded to that backend. If weight is set to 0, no
+ traffic should be forwarded for this entry. If unspecified, weight
+ defaults to 1.
+
+
+ Support for this field varies based on the context where used.
+ format: int32
+ maximum: 1000000
+ minimum: 0
+ type: integer
+ required:
+ - name
+ type: object
+ x-kubernetes-validations:
+ - message: Must have port for Service reference
+ rule: '(size(self.group) == 0 && self.kind == ''Service'')
+ ? has(self.port) : true'
+ maxItems: 16
+ type: array
+ filters:
+ description: |-
+ Filters define the filters that are applied to requests that match
+ this rule.
+
+
+ The effects of ordering of multiple behaviors are currently unspecified.
+ This can change in the future based on feedback during the alpha stage.
+
+
+ Conformance-levels at this level are defined based on the type of filter:
+
+
+ - ALL core filters MUST be supported by all implementations that support
+ GRPCRoute.
+ - Implementers are encouraged to support extended filters.
+ - Implementation-specific custom filters have no API guarantees across
+ implementations.
+
+
+ Specifying the same filter multiple times is not supported unless explicitly
+ indicated in the filter.
+
+
+ If an implementation can not support a combination of filters, it must clearly
+ document that limitation. In cases where incompatible or unsupported
+ filters are specified and cause the `Accepted` condition to be set to status
+ `False`, implementations may use the `IncompatibleFilters` reason to specify
+ this configuration error.
+
+
+ Support: Core
+ items:
+ description: |-
+ GRPCRouteFilter defines processing steps that must be completed during the
+ request or response lifecycle. GRPCRouteFilters are meant as an extension
+ point to express processing that may be done in Gateway implementations. Some
+ examples include request or response modification, implementing
+ authentication strategies, rate-limiting, and traffic shaping. API
+ guarantee/conformance is defined based on the type of the filter.
+ properties:
+ extensionRef:
+ description: |-
+ ExtensionRef is an optional, implementation-specific extension to the
+ "filter" behavior. For example, resource "myroutefilter" in group
+ "networking.example.net"). ExtensionRef MUST NOT be used for core and
+ extended filters.
+
+
+ Support: Implementation-specific
+
+
+ This filter can be used multiple times within the same rule.
+ properties:
+ group:
+ description: |-
+ Group is the group of the referent. For example, "gateway.networking.k8s.io".
+ When unspecified or empty string, core API group is inferred.
+ maxLength: 253
+ pattern: ^$|^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$
+ type: string
+ kind:
+ description: Kind is kind of the referent. For example
+ "HTTPRoute" or "Service".
+ maxLength: 63
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[a-zA-Z]([-a-zA-Z0-9]*[a-zA-Z0-9])?$
+ type: string
+ name:
+ description: Name is the name of the referent.
+ maxLength: 253
+ minLength: 1
+ type: string
+ required:
+ - group
+ - kind
+ - name
+ type: object
+ requestHeaderModifier:
+ description: |-
+ RequestHeaderModifier defines a schema for a filter that modifies request
+ headers.
+
+
+ Support: Core
+ properties:
+ add:
+ description: |-
+ Add adds the given header(s) (name, value) to the request
+ before the action. It appends to any existing values associated
+ with the header name.
+
+
+ Input:
+ GET /foo HTTP/1.1
+ my-header: foo
+
+
+ Config:
+ add:
+ - name: "my-header"
+ value: "bar,baz"
+
+
+ Output:
+ GET /foo HTTP/1.1
+ my-header: foo,bar,baz
+ items:
+ description: HTTPHeader represents an HTTP Header
+ name and value as defined by RFC 7230.
+ properties:
+ name:
+ description: |-
+ Name is the name of the HTTP Header to be matched. Name matching MUST be
+ case insensitive. (See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc7230#section-3.2).
+
+
+ If multiple entries specify equivalent header names, the first entry with
+ an equivalent name MUST be considered for a match. Subsequent entries
+ with an equivalent header name MUST be ignored. Due to the
+ case-insensitivity of header names, "foo" and "Foo" are considered
+ equivalent.
+ maxLength: 256
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[A-Za-z0-9!#$%&'*+\-.^_\x60|~]+$
+ type: string
+ value:
+ description: Value is the value of HTTP Header
+ to be matched.
+ maxLength: 4096
+ minLength: 1
+ type: string
+ required:
+ - name
+ - value
+ type: object
+ maxItems: 16
+ type: array
+ x-kubernetes-list-map-keys:
+ - name
+ x-kubernetes-list-type: map
+ remove:
+ description: |-
+ Remove the given header(s) from the HTTP request before the action. The
+ value of Remove is a list of HTTP header names. Note that the header
+ names are case-insensitive (see
+ https://datatracker.ietf.org/doc/html/rfc2616#section-4.2).
+
+
+ Input:
+ GET /foo HTTP/1.1
+ my-header1: foo
+ my-header2: bar
+ my-header3: baz
+
+
+ Config:
+ remove: ["my-header1", "my-header3"]
+
+
+ Output:
+ GET /foo HTTP/1.1
+ my-header2: bar
+ items:
+ type: string
+ maxItems: 16
+ type: array
+ x-kubernetes-list-type: set
+ set:
+ description: |-
+ Set overwrites the request with the given header (name, value)
+ before the action.
+
+
+ Input:
+ GET /foo HTTP/1.1
+ my-header: foo
+
+
+ Config:
+ set:
+ - name: "my-header"
+ value: "bar"
+
+
+ Output:
+ GET /foo HTTP/1.1
+ my-header: bar
+ items:
+ description: HTTPHeader represents an HTTP Header
+ name and value as defined by RFC 7230.
+ properties:
+ name:
+ description: |-
+ Name is the name of the HTTP Header to be matched. Name matching MUST be
+ case insensitive. (See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc7230#section-3.2).
+
+
+ If multiple entries specify equivalent header names, the first entry with
+ an equivalent name MUST be considered for a match. Subsequent entries
+ with an equivalent header name MUST be ignored. Due to the
+ case-insensitivity of header names, "foo" and "Foo" are considered
+ equivalent.
+ maxLength: 256
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[A-Za-z0-9!#$%&'*+\-.^_\x60|~]+$
+ type: string
+ value:
+ description: Value is the value of HTTP Header
+ to be matched.
+ maxLength: 4096
+ minLength: 1
+ type: string
+ required:
+ - name
+ - value
+ type: object
+ maxItems: 16
+ type: array
+ x-kubernetes-list-map-keys:
+ - name
+ x-kubernetes-list-type: map
+ type: object
+ requestMirror:
+ description: |-
+ RequestMirror defines a schema for a filter that mirrors requests.
+ Requests are sent to the specified destination, but responses from
+ that destination are ignored.
+
+
+ This filter can be used multiple times within the same rule. Note that
+ not all implementations will be able to support mirroring to multiple
+ backends.
+
+
+ Support: Extended
+ properties:
+ backendRef:
+ description: |-
+ BackendRef references a resource where mirrored requests are sent.
+
+
+ Mirrored requests must be sent only to a single destination endpoint
+ within this BackendRef, irrespective of how many endpoints are present
+ within this BackendRef.
+
+
+ If the referent cannot be found, this BackendRef is invalid and must be
+ dropped from the Gateway. The controller must ensure the "ResolvedRefs"
+ condition on the Route status is set to `status: False` and not configure
+ this backend in the underlying implementation.
+
+
+ If there is a cross-namespace reference to an *existing* object
+ that is not allowed by a ReferenceGrant, the controller must ensure the
+ "ResolvedRefs" condition on the Route is set to `status: False`,
+ with the "RefNotPermitted" reason and not configure this backend in the
+ underlying implementation.
+
+
+ In either error case, the Message of the `ResolvedRefs` Condition
+ should be used to provide more detail about the problem.
+
+
+ Support: Extended for Kubernetes Service
+
+
+ Support: Implementation-specific for any other resource
+ properties:
+ group:
+ default: ""
+ description: |-
+ Group is the group of the referent. For example, "gateway.networking.k8s.io".
+ When unspecified or empty string, core API group is inferred.
+ maxLength: 253
+ pattern: ^$|^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$
+ type: string
+ kind:
+ default: Service
+ description: |-
+ Kind is the Kubernetes resource kind of the referent. For example
+ "Service".
+
+
+ Defaults to "Service" when not specified.
+
+
+ ExternalName services can refer to CNAME DNS records that may live
+ outside of the cluster and as such are difficult to reason about in
+ terms of conformance. They also may not be safe to forward to (see
+ CVE-2021-25740 for more information). Implementations SHOULD NOT
+ support ExternalName Services.
+
+
+ Support: Core (Services with a type other than ExternalName)
+
+
+ Support: Implementation-specific (Services with type ExternalName)
+ maxLength: 63
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[a-zA-Z]([-a-zA-Z0-9]*[a-zA-Z0-9])?$
+ type: string
+ name:
+ description: Name is the name of the referent.
+ maxLength: 253
+ minLength: 1
+ type: string
+ namespace:
+ description: |-
+ Namespace is the namespace of the backend. When unspecified, the local
+ namespace is inferred.
+
+
+ Note that when a namespace different than the local namespace is specified,
+ a ReferenceGrant object is required in the referent namespace to allow that
+ namespace's owner to accept the reference. See the ReferenceGrant
+ documentation for details.
+
+
+ Support: Core
+ maxLength: 63
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?$
+ type: string
+ port:
+ description: |-
+ Port specifies the destination port number to use for this resource.
+ Port is required when the referent is a Kubernetes Service. In this
+ case, the port number is the service port number, not the target port.
+ For other resources, destination port might be derived from the referent
+ resource or this field.
+ format: int32
+ maximum: 65535
+ minimum: 1
+ type: integer
+ required:
+ - name
+ type: object
+ x-kubernetes-validations:
+ - message: Must have port for Service reference
+ rule: '(size(self.group) == 0 && self.kind == ''Service'')
+ ? has(self.port) : true'
+ required:
+ - backendRef
+ type: object
+ responseHeaderModifier:
+ description: |-
+ ResponseHeaderModifier defines a schema for a filter that modifies response
+ headers.
+
+
+ Support: Extended
+ properties:
+ add:
+ description: |-
+ Add adds the given header(s) (name, value) to the request
+ before the action. It appends to any existing values associated
+ with the header name.
+
+
+ Input:
+ GET /foo HTTP/1.1
+ my-header: foo
+
+
+ Config:
+ add:
+ - name: "my-header"
+ value: "bar,baz"
+
+
+ Output:
+ GET /foo HTTP/1.1
+ my-header: foo,bar,baz
+ items:
+ description: HTTPHeader represents an HTTP Header
+ name and value as defined by RFC 7230.
+ properties:
+ name:
+ description: |-
+ Name is the name of the HTTP Header to be matched. Name matching MUST be
+ case insensitive. (See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc7230#section-3.2).
+
+
+ If multiple entries specify equivalent header names, the first entry with
+ an equivalent name MUST be considered for a match. Subsequent entries
+ with an equivalent header name MUST be ignored. Due to the
+ case-insensitivity of header names, "foo" and "Foo" are considered
+ equivalent.
+ maxLength: 256
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[A-Za-z0-9!#$%&'*+\-.^_\x60|~]+$
+ type: string
+ value:
+ description: Value is the value of HTTP Header
+ to be matched.
+ maxLength: 4096
+ minLength: 1
+ type: string
+ required:
+ - name
+ - value
+ type: object
+ maxItems: 16
+ type: array
+ x-kubernetes-list-map-keys:
+ - name
+ x-kubernetes-list-type: map
+ remove:
+ description: |-
+ Remove the given header(s) from the HTTP request before the action. The
+ value of Remove is a list of HTTP header names. Note that the header
+ names are case-insensitive (see
+ https://datatracker.ietf.org/doc/html/rfc2616#section-4.2).
+
+
+ Input:
+ GET /foo HTTP/1.1
+ my-header1: foo
+ my-header2: bar
+ my-header3: baz
+
+
+ Config:
+ remove: ["my-header1", "my-header3"]
+
+
+ Output:
+ GET /foo HTTP/1.1
+ my-header2: bar
+ items:
+ type: string
+ maxItems: 16
+ type: array
+ x-kubernetes-list-type: set
+ set:
+ description: |-
+ Set overwrites the request with the given header (name, value)
+ before the action.
+
+
+ Input:
+ GET /foo HTTP/1.1
+ my-header: foo
+
+
+ Config:
+ set:
+ - name: "my-header"
+ value: "bar"
+
+
+ Output:
+ GET /foo HTTP/1.1
+ my-header: bar
+ items:
+ description: HTTPHeader represents an HTTP Header
+ name and value as defined by RFC 7230.
+ properties:
+ name:
+ description: |-
+ Name is the name of the HTTP Header to be matched. Name matching MUST be
+ case insensitive. (See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc7230#section-3.2).
+
+
+ If multiple entries specify equivalent header names, the first entry with
+ an equivalent name MUST be considered for a match. Subsequent entries
+ with an equivalent header name MUST be ignored. Due to the
+ case-insensitivity of header names, "foo" and "Foo" are considered
+ equivalent.
+ maxLength: 256
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[A-Za-z0-9!#$%&'*+\-.^_\x60|~]+$
+ type: string
+ value:
+ description: Value is the value of HTTP Header
+ to be matched.
+ maxLength: 4096
+ minLength: 1
+ type: string
+ required:
+ - name
+ - value
+ type: object
+ maxItems: 16
+ type: array
+ x-kubernetes-list-map-keys:
+ - name
+ x-kubernetes-list-type: map
+ type: object
+ type:
+ description: |+
+ Type identifies the type of filter to apply. As with other API fields,
+ types are classified into three conformance levels:
+
+
+ - Core: Filter types and their corresponding configuration defined by
+ "Support: Core" in this package, e.g. "RequestHeaderModifier". All
+ implementations supporting GRPCRoute MUST support core filters.
+
+
+ - Extended: Filter types and their corresponding configuration defined by
+ "Support: Extended" in this package, e.g. "RequestMirror". Implementers
+ are encouraged to support extended filters.
+
+
+ - Implementation-specific: Filters that are defined and supported by specific vendors.
+ In the future, filters showing convergence in behavior across multiple
+ implementations will be considered for inclusion in extended or core
+ conformance levels. Filter-specific configuration for such filters
+ is specified using the ExtensionRef field. `Type` MUST be set to
+ "ExtensionRef" for custom filters.
+
+
+ Implementers are encouraged to define custom implementation types to
+ extend the core API with implementation-specific behavior.
+
+
+ If a reference to a custom filter type cannot be resolved, the filter
+ MUST NOT be skipped. Instead, requests that would have been processed by
+ that filter MUST receive a HTTP error response.
+
+
+ enum:
+ - ResponseHeaderModifier
+ - RequestHeaderModifier
+ - RequestMirror
+ - ExtensionRef
+ type: string
+ required:
+ - type
+ type: object
+ x-kubernetes-validations:
+ - message: filter.requestHeaderModifier must be nil if the
+ filter.type is not RequestHeaderModifier
+ rule: '!(has(self.requestHeaderModifier) && self.type !=
+ ''RequestHeaderModifier'')'
+ - message: filter.requestHeaderModifier must be specified
+ for RequestHeaderModifier filter.type
+ rule: '!(!has(self.requestHeaderModifier) && self.type ==
+ ''RequestHeaderModifier'')'
+ - message: filter.responseHeaderModifier must be nil if the
+ filter.type is not ResponseHeaderModifier
+ rule: '!(has(self.responseHeaderModifier) && self.type !=
+ ''ResponseHeaderModifier'')'
+ - message: filter.responseHeaderModifier must be specified
+ for ResponseHeaderModifier filter.type
+ rule: '!(!has(self.responseHeaderModifier) && self.type
+ == ''ResponseHeaderModifier'')'
+ - message: filter.requestMirror must be nil if the filter.type
+ is not RequestMirror
+ rule: '!(has(self.requestMirror) && self.type != ''RequestMirror'')'
+ - message: filter.requestMirror must be specified for RequestMirror
+ filter.type
+ rule: '!(!has(self.requestMirror) && self.type == ''RequestMirror'')'
+ - message: filter.extensionRef must be nil if the filter.type
+ is not ExtensionRef
+ rule: '!(has(self.extensionRef) && self.type != ''ExtensionRef'')'
+ - message: filter.extensionRef must be specified for ExtensionRef
+ filter.type
+ rule: '!(!has(self.extensionRef) && self.type == ''ExtensionRef'')'
+ maxItems: 16
+ type: array
+ x-kubernetes-validations:
+ - message: RequestHeaderModifier filter cannot be repeated
+ rule: self.filter(f, f.type == 'RequestHeaderModifier').size()
+ <= 1
+ - message: ResponseHeaderModifier filter cannot be repeated
+ rule: self.filter(f, f.type == 'ResponseHeaderModifier').size()
+ <= 1
+ matches:
+ description: |-
+ Matches define conditions used for matching the rule against incoming
+ gRPC requests. Each match is independent, i.e. this rule will be matched
+ if **any** one of the matches is satisfied.
+
+
+ For example, take the following matches configuration:
+
+
+ ```
+ matches:
+ - method:
+ service: foo.bar
+ headers:
+ values:
+ version: 2
+ - method:
+ service: foo.bar.v2
+ ```
+
+
+ For a request to match against this rule, it MUST satisfy
+ EITHER of the two conditions:
+
+
+ - service of foo.bar AND contains the header `version: 2`
+ - service of foo.bar.v2
+
+
+ See the documentation for GRPCRouteMatch on how to specify multiple
+ match conditions to be ANDed together.
+
+
+ If no matches are specified, the implementation MUST match every gRPC request.
+
+
+ Proxy or Load Balancer routing configuration generated from GRPCRoutes
+ MUST prioritize rules based on the following criteria, continuing on
+ ties. Merging MUST not be done between GRPCRoutes and HTTPRoutes.
+ Precedence MUST be given to the rule with the largest number of:
+
+
+ * Characters in a matching non-wildcard hostname.
+ * Characters in a matching hostname.
+ * Characters in a matching service.
+ * Characters in a matching method.
+ * Header matches.
+
+
+ If ties still exist across multiple Routes, matching precedence MUST be
+ determined in order of the following criteria, continuing on ties:
+
+
+ * The oldest Route based on creation timestamp.
+ * The Route appearing first in alphabetical order by
+ "{namespace}/{name}".
+
+
+ If ties still exist within the Route that has been given precedence,
+ matching precedence MUST be granted to the first matching rule meeting
+ the above criteria.
+ items:
+ description: |-
+ GRPCRouteMatch defines the predicate used to match requests to a given
+ action. Multiple match types are ANDed together, i.e. the match will
+ evaluate to true only if all conditions are satisfied.
+
+
+ For example, the match below will match a gRPC request only if its service
+ is `foo` AND it contains the `version: v1` header:
+
+
+ ```
+ matches:
+ - method:
+ type: Exact
+ service: "foo"
+ headers:
+ - name: "version"
+ value "v1"
+
+
+ ```
+ properties:
+ headers:
+ description: |-
+ Headers specifies gRPC request header matchers. Multiple match values are
+ ANDed together, meaning, a request MUST match all the specified headers
+ to select the route.
+ items:
+ description: |-
+ GRPCHeaderMatch describes how to select a gRPC route by matching gRPC request
+ headers.
+ properties:
+ name:
+ description: |-
+ Name is the name of the gRPC Header to be matched.
+
+
+ If multiple entries specify equivalent header names, only the first
+ entry with an equivalent name MUST be considered for a match. Subsequent
+ entries with an equivalent header name MUST be ignored. Due to the
+ case-insensitivity of header names, "foo" and "Foo" are considered
+ equivalent.
+ maxLength: 256
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[A-Za-z0-9!#$%&'*+\-.^_\x60|~]+$
+ type: string
+ type:
+ default: Exact
+ description: Type specifies how to match against
+ the value of the header.
+ enum:
+ - Exact
+ - RegularExpression
+ type: string
+ value:
+ description: Value is the value of the gRPC Header
+ to be matched.
+ maxLength: 4096
+ minLength: 1
+ type: string
+ required:
+ - name
+ - value
+ type: object
+ maxItems: 16
+ type: array
+ x-kubernetes-list-map-keys:
+ - name
+ x-kubernetes-list-type: map
+ method:
+ description: |-
+ Method specifies a gRPC request service/method matcher. If this field is
+ not specified, all services and methods will match.
+ properties:
+ method:
+ description: |-
+ Value of the method to match against. If left empty or omitted, will
+ match all services.
+
+
+ At least one of Service and Method MUST be a non-empty string.
+ maxLength: 1024
+ type: string
+ service:
+ description: |-
+ Value of the service to match against. If left empty or omitted, will
+ match any service.
+
+
+ At least one of Service and Method MUST be a non-empty string.
+ maxLength: 1024
+ type: string
+ type:
+ default: Exact
+ description: |-
+ Type specifies how to match against the service and/or method.
+ Support: Core (Exact with service and method specified)
+
+
+ Support: Implementation-specific (Exact with method specified but no service specified)
+
+
+ Support: Implementation-specific (RegularExpression)
+ enum:
+ - Exact
+ - RegularExpression
+ type: string
+ type: object
+ x-kubernetes-validations:
+ - message: One or both of 'service' or 'method' must be
+ specified
+ rule: 'has(self.type) ? has(self.service) || has(self.method)
+ : true'
+ - message: service must only contain valid characters
+ (matching ^(?i)\.?[a-z_][a-z_0-9]*(\.[a-z_][a-z_0-9]*)*$)
+ rule: '(!has(self.type) || self.type == ''Exact'') &&
+ has(self.service) ? self.service.matches(r"""^(?i)\.?[a-z_][a-z_0-9]*(\.[a-z_][a-z_0-9]*)*$"""):
+ true'
+ - message: method must only contain valid characters (matching
+ ^[A-Za-z_][A-Za-z_0-9]*$)
+ rule: '(!has(self.type) || self.type == ''Exact'') &&
+ has(self.method) ? self.method.matches(r"""^[A-Za-z_][A-Za-z_0-9]*$"""):
+ true'
+ type: object
+ maxItems: 8
+ type: array
+ sessionPersistence:
+ description: |+
+ SessionPersistence defines and configures session persistence
+ for the route rule.
+
+
+ Support: Extended
+
+
+ properties:
+ absoluteTimeout:
+ description: |-
+ AbsoluteTimeout defines the absolute timeout of the persistent
+ session. Once the AbsoluteTimeout duration has elapsed, the
+ session becomes invalid.
+
+
+ Support: Extended
+ pattern: ^([0-9]{1,5}(h|m|s|ms)){1,4}$
+ type: string
+ cookieConfig:
+ description: |-
+ CookieConfig provides configuration settings that are specific
+ to cookie-based session persistence.
+
+
+ Support: Core
+ properties:
+ lifetimeType:
+ default: Session
+ description: |-
+ LifetimeType specifies whether the cookie has a permanent or
+ session-based lifetime. A permanent cookie persists until its
+ specified expiry time, defined by the Expires or Max-Age cookie
+ attributes, while a session cookie is deleted when the current
+ session ends.
+
+
+ When set to "Permanent", AbsoluteTimeout indicates the
+ cookie's lifetime via the Expires or Max-Age cookie attributes
+ and is required.
+
+
+ When set to "Session", AbsoluteTimeout indicates the
+ absolute lifetime of the cookie tracked by the gateway and
+ is optional.
+
+
+ Support: Core for "Session" type
+
+
+ Support: Extended for "Permanent" type
+ enum:
+ - Permanent
+ - Session
+ type: string
+ type: object
+ idleTimeout:
+ description: |-
+ IdleTimeout defines the idle timeout of the persistent session.
+ Once the session has been idle for more than the specified
+ IdleTimeout duration, the session becomes invalid.
+
+
+ Support: Extended
+ pattern: ^([0-9]{1,5}(h|m|s|ms)){1,4}$
+ type: string
+ sessionName:
+ description: |-
+ SessionName defines the name of the persistent session token
+ which may be reflected in the cookie or the header. Users
+ should avoid reusing session names to prevent unintended
+ consequences, such as rejection or unpredictable behavior.
+
+
+ Support: Implementation-specific
+ maxLength: 128
+ type: string
+ type:
+ default: Cookie
+ description: |-
+ Type defines the type of session persistence such as through
+ the use a header or cookie. Defaults to cookie based session
+ persistence.
+
+
+ Support: Core for "Cookie" type
+
+
+ Support: Extended for "Header" type
+ enum:
+ - Cookie
+ - Header
+ type: string
+ type: object
+ x-kubernetes-validations:
+ - message: AbsoluteTimeout must be specified when cookie lifetimeType
+ is Permanent
+ rule: '!has(self.cookieConfig.lifetimeType) || self.cookieConfig.lifetimeType
+ != ''Permanent'' || has(self.absoluteTimeout)'
+ type: object
+ maxItems: 16
+ type: array
+ type: object
+ status:
+ description: Status defines the current state of GRPCRoute.
+ properties:
+ parents:
+ description: |-
+ Parents is a list of parent resources (usually Gateways) that are
+ associated with the route, and the status of the route with respect to
+ each parent. When this route attaches to a parent, the controller that
+ manages the parent must add an entry to this list when the controller
+ first sees the route and should update the entry as appropriate when the
+ route or gateway is modified.
+
+
+ Note that parent references that cannot be resolved by an implementation
+ of this API will not be added to this list. Implementations of this API
+ can only populate Route status for the Gateways/parent resources they are
+ responsible for.
+
+
+ A maximum of 32 Gateways will be represented in this list. An empty list
+ means the route has not been attached to any Gateway.
+ items:
+ description: |-
+ RouteParentStatus describes the status of a route with respect to an
+ associated Parent.
+ properties:
+ conditions:
+ description: |-
+ Conditions describes the status of the route with respect to the Gateway.
+ Note that the route's availability is also subject to the Gateway's own
+ status conditions and listener status.
+
+
+ If the Route's ParentRef specifies an existing Gateway that supports
+ Routes of this kind AND that Gateway's controller has sufficient access,
+ then that Gateway's controller MUST set the "Accepted" condition on the
+ Route, to indicate whether the route has been accepted or rejected by the
+ Gateway, and why.
+
+
+ A Route MUST be considered "Accepted" if at least one of the Route's
+ rules is implemented by the Gateway.
+
+
+ There are a number of cases where the "Accepted" condition may not be set
+ due to lack of controller visibility, that includes when:
+
+
+ * The Route refers to a non-existent parent.
+ * The Route is of a type that the controller does not support.
+ * The Route is in a namespace the controller does not have access to.
+ items:
+ description: "Condition contains details for one aspect of
+ the current state of this API Resource.\n---\nThis struct
+ is intended for direct use as an array at the field path
+ .status.conditions. For example,\n\n\n\ttype FooStatus
+ struct{\n\t // Represents the observations of a foo's
+ current state.\n\t // Known .status.conditions.type are:
+ \"Available\", \"Progressing\", and \"Degraded\"\n\t //
+ +patchMergeKey=type\n\t // +patchStrategy=merge\n\t //
+ +listType=map\n\t // +listMapKey=type\n\t Conditions
+ []metav1.Condition `json:\"conditions,omitempty\" patchStrategy:\"merge\"
+ patchMergeKey:\"type\" protobuf:\"bytes,1,rep,name=conditions\"`\n\n\n\t
+ \ // other fields\n\t}"
+ properties:
+ lastTransitionTime:
+ description: |-
+ lastTransitionTime is the last time the condition transitioned from one status to another.
+ This should be when the underlying condition changed. If that is not known, then using the time when the API field changed is acceptable.
+ format: date-time
+ type: string
+ message:
+ description: |-
+ message is a human readable message indicating details about the transition.
+ This may be an empty string.
+ maxLength: 32768
+ type: string
+ observedGeneration:
+ description: |-
+ observedGeneration represents the .metadata.generation that the condition was set based upon.
+ For instance, if .metadata.generation is currently 12, but the .status.conditions[x].observedGeneration is 9, the condition is out of date
+ with respect to the current state of the instance.
+ format: int64
+ minimum: 0
+ type: integer
+ reason:
+ description: |-
+ reason contains a programmatic identifier indicating the reason for the condition's last transition.
+ Producers of specific condition types may define expected values and meanings for this field,
+ and whether the values are considered a guaranteed API.
+ The value should be a CamelCase string.
+ This field may not be empty.
+ maxLength: 1024
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[A-Za-z]([A-Za-z0-9_,:]*[A-Za-z0-9_])?$
+ type: string
+ status:
+ description: status of the condition, one of True, False,
+ Unknown.
+ enum:
+ - "True"
+ - "False"
+ - Unknown
+ type: string
+ type:
+ description: |-
+ type of condition in CamelCase or in foo.example.com/CamelCase.
+ ---
+ Many .condition.type values are consistent across resources like Available, but because arbitrary conditions can be
+ useful (see .node.status.conditions), the ability to deconflict is important.
+ The regex it matches is (dns1123SubdomainFmt/)?(qualifiedNameFmt)
+ maxLength: 316
+ pattern: ^([a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*/)?(([A-Za-z0-9][-A-Za-z0-9_.]*)?[A-Za-z0-9])$
+ type: string
+ required:
+ - lastTransitionTime
+ - message
+ - reason
+ - status
+ - type
+ type: object
+ maxItems: 8
+ minItems: 1
+ type: array
+ x-kubernetes-list-map-keys:
+ - type
+ x-kubernetes-list-type: map
+ controllerName:
+ description: |-
+ ControllerName is a domain/path string that indicates the name of the
+ controller that wrote this status. This corresponds with the
+ controllerName field on GatewayClass.
+
+
+ Example: "example.net/gateway-controller".
+
+
+ The format of this field is DOMAIN "/" PATH, where DOMAIN and PATH are
+ valid Kubernetes names
+ (https://kubernetes.io/docs/concepts/overview/working-with-objects/names/#names).
+
+
+ Controllers MUST populate this field when writing status. Controllers should ensure that
+ entries to status populated with their ControllerName are cleaned up when they are no
+ longer necessary.
+ maxLength: 253
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*\/[A-Za-z0-9\/\-._~%!$&'()*+,;=:]+$
+ type: string
+ parentRef:
+ description: |-
+ ParentRef corresponds with a ParentRef in the spec that this
+ RouteParentStatus struct describes the status of.
+ properties:
+ group:
+ default: gateway.networking.k8s.io
+ description: |-
+ Group is the group of the referent.
+ When unspecified, "gateway.networking.k8s.io" is inferred.
+ To set the core API group (such as for a "Service" kind referent),
+ Group must be explicitly set to "" (empty string).
+
+
+ Support: Core
+ maxLength: 253
+ pattern: ^$|^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$
+ type: string
+ kind:
+ default: Gateway
+ description: |-
+ Kind is kind of the referent.
+
+
+ There are two kinds of parent resources with "Core" support:
+
+
+ * Gateway (Gateway conformance profile)
+ * Service (Mesh conformance profile, ClusterIP Services only)
+
+
+ Support for other resources is Implementation-Specific.
+ maxLength: 63
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[a-zA-Z]([-a-zA-Z0-9]*[a-zA-Z0-9])?$
+ type: string
+ name:
+ description: |-
+ Name is the name of the referent.
+
+
+ Support: Core
+ maxLength: 253
+ minLength: 1
+ type: string
+ namespace:
+ description: |-
+ Namespace is the namespace of the referent. When unspecified, this refers
+ to the local namespace of the Route.
+
+
+ Note that there are specific rules for ParentRefs which cross namespace
+ boundaries. Cross-namespace references are only valid if they are explicitly
+ allowed by something in the namespace they are referring to. For example:
+ Gateway has the AllowedRoutes field, and ReferenceGrant provides a
+ generic way to enable any other kind of cross-namespace reference.
+
+
+
+ ParentRefs from a Route to a Service in the same namespace are "producer"
+ routes, which apply default routing rules to inbound connections from
+ any namespace to the Service.
+
+
+ ParentRefs from a Route to a Service in a different namespace are
+ "consumer" routes, and these routing rules are only applied to outbound
+ connections originating from the same namespace as the Route, for which
+ the intended destination of the connections are a Service targeted as a
+ ParentRef of the Route.
+
+
+
+ Support: Core
+ maxLength: 63
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?$
+ type: string
+ port:
+ description: |-
+ Port is the network port this Route targets. It can be interpreted
+ differently based on the type of parent resource.
+
+
+ When the parent resource is a Gateway, this targets all listeners
+ listening on the specified port that also support this kind of Route(and
+ select this Route). It's not recommended to set `Port` unless the
+ networking behaviors specified in a Route must apply to a specific port
+ as opposed to a listener(s) whose port(s) may be changed. When both Port
+ and SectionName are specified, the name and port of the selected listener
+ must match both specified values.
+
+
+
+ When the parent resource is a Service, this targets a specific port in the
+ Service spec. When both Port (experimental) and SectionName are specified,
+ the name and port of the selected port must match both specified values.
+
+
+
+ Implementations MAY choose to support other parent resources.
+ Implementations supporting other types of parent resources MUST clearly
+ document how/if Port is interpreted.
+
+
+ For the purpose of status, an attachment is considered successful as
+ long as the parent resource accepts it partially. For example, Gateway
+ listeners can restrict which Routes can attach to them by Route kind,
+ namespace, or hostname. If 1 of 2 Gateway listeners accept attachment
+ from the referencing Route, the Route MUST be considered successfully
+ attached. If no Gateway listeners accept attachment from this Route,
+ the Route MUST be considered detached from the Gateway.
+
+
+ Support: Extended
+ format: int32
+ maximum: 65535
+ minimum: 1
+ type: integer
+ sectionName:
+ description: |-
+ SectionName is the name of a section within the target resource. In the
+ following resources, SectionName is interpreted as the following:
+
+
+ * Gateway: Listener name. When both Port (experimental) and SectionName
+ are specified, the name and port of the selected listener must match
+ both specified values.
+ * Service: Port name. When both Port (experimental) and SectionName
+ are specified, the name and port of the selected listener must match
+ both specified values.
+
+
+ Implementations MAY choose to support attaching Routes to other resources.
+ If that is the case, they MUST clearly document how SectionName is
+ interpreted.
+
+
+ When unspecified (empty string), this will reference the entire resource.
+ For the purpose of status, an attachment is considered successful if at
+ least one section in the parent resource accepts it. For example, Gateway
+ listeners can restrict which Routes can attach to them by Route kind,
+ namespace, or hostname. If 1 of 2 Gateway listeners accept attachment from
+ the referencing Route, the Route MUST be considered successfully
+ attached. If no Gateway listeners accept attachment from this Route, the
+ Route MUST be considered detached from the Gateway.
+
+
+ Support: Core
+ maxLength: 253
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$
+ type: string
+ required:
+ - name
+ type: object
+ required:
+ - controllerName
+ - parentRef
+ type: object
+ maxItems: 32
+ type: array
+ required:
+ - parents
+ type: object
+ type: object
+ served: true
+ storage: true
+ subresources:
+ status: {}
+ - deprecated: true
+ deprecationWarning: The v1alpha2 version of GRPCRoute has been deprecated and
+ will be removed in a future release of the API. Please upgrade to v1.
+ name: v1alpha2
+ schema:
+ openAPIV3Schema:
+ description: |-
+ GRPCRoute provides a way to route gRPC requests. This includes the capability
+ to match requests by hostname, gRPC service, gRPC method, or HTTP/2 header.
+ Filters can be used to specify additional processing steps. Backends specify
+ where matching requests will be routed.
+
+
+ GRPCRoute falls under extended support within the Gateway API. Within the
+ following specification, the word "MUST" indicates that an implementation
+ supporting GRPCRoute must conform to the indicated requirement, but an
+ implementation not supporting this route type need not follow the requirement
+ unless explicitly indicated.
+
+
+ Implementations supporting `GRPCRoute` with the `HTTPS` `ProtocolType` MUST
+ accept HTTP/2 connections without an initial upgrade from HTTP/1.1, i.e. via
+ ALPN. If the implementation does not support this, then it MUST set the
+ "Accepted" condition to "False" for the affected listener with a reason of
+ "UnsupportedProtocol". Implementations MAY also accept HTTP/2 connections
+ with an upgrade from HTTP/1.
+
+
+ Implementations supporting `GRPCRoute` with the `HTTP` `ProtocolType` MUST
+ support HTTP/2 over cleartext TCP (h2c,
+ https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc7540#section-3.1) without an initial
+ upgrade from HTTP/1.1, i.e. with prior knowledge
+ (https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc7540#section-3.4). If the implementation
+ does not support this, then it MUST set the "Accepted" condition to "False"
+ for the affected listener with a reason of "UnsupportedProtocol".
+ Implementations MAY also accept HTTP/2 connections with an upgrade from
+ HTTP/1, i.e. without prior knowledge.
+ properties:
+ apiVersion:
+ description: |-
+ APIVersion defines the versioned schema of this representation of an object.
+ Servers should convert recognized schemas to the latest internal value, and
+ may reject unrecognized values.
+ More info: https://git.k8s.io/community/contributors/devel/sig-architecture/api-conventions.md#resources
+ type: string
+ kind:
+ description: |-
+ Kind is a string value representing the REST resource this object represents.
+ Servers may infer this from the endpoint the client submits requests to.
+ Cannot be updated.
+ In CamelCase.
+ More info: https://git.k8s.io/community/contributors/devel/sig-architecture/api-conventions.md#types-kinds
+ type: string
+ metadata:
+ type: object
+ spec:
+ description: Spec defines the desired state of GRPCRoute.
+ properties:
+ hostnames:
+ description: |-
+ Hostnames defines a set of hostnames to match against the GRPC
+ Host header to select a GRPCRoute to process the request. This matches
+ the RFC 1123 definition of a hostname with 2 notable exceptions:
+
+
+ 1. IPs are not allowed.
+ 2. A hostname may be prefixed with a wildcard label (`*.`). The wildcard
+ label MUST appear by itself as the first label.
+
+
+ If a hostname is specified by both the Listener and GRPCRoute, there
+ MUST be at least one intersecting hostname for the GRPCRoute to be
+ attached to the Listener. For example:
+
+
+ * A Listener with `test.example.com` as the hostname matches GRPCRoutes
+ that have either not specified any hostnames, or have specified at
+ least one of `test.example.com` or `*.example.com`.
+ * A Listener with `*.example.com` as the hostname matches GRPCRoutes
+ that have either not specified any hostnames or have specified at least
+ one hostname that matches the Listener hostname. For example,
+ `test.example.com` and `*.example.com` would both match. On the other
+ hand, `example.com` and `test.example.net` would not match.
+
+
+ Hostnames that are prefixed with a wildcard label (`*.`) are interpreted
+ as a suffix match. That means that a match for `*.example.com` would match
+ both `test.example.com`, and `foo.test.example.com`, but not `example.com`.
+
+
+ If both the Listener and GRPCRoute have specified hostnames, any
+ GRPCRoute hostnames that do not match the Listener hostname MUST be
+ ignored. For example, if a Listener specified `*.example.com`, and the
+ GRPCRoute specified `test.example.com` and `test.example.net`,
+ `test.example.net` MUST NOT be considered for a match.
+
+
+ If both the Listener and GRPCRoute have specified hostnames, and none
+ match with the criteria above, then the GRPCRoute MUST NOT be accepted by
+ the implementation. The implementation MUST raise an 'Accepted' Condition
+ with a status of `False` in the corresponding RouteParentStatus.
+
+
+ If a Route (A) of type HTTPRoute or GRPCRoute is attached to a
+ Listener and that listener already has another Route (B) of the other
+ type attached and the intersection of the hostnames of A and B is
+ non-empty, then the implementation MUST accept exactly one of these two
+ routes, determined by the following criteria, in order:
+
+
+ * The oldest Route based on creation timestamp.
+ * The Route appearing first in alphabetical order by
+ "{namespace}/{name}".
+
+
+ The rejected Route MUST raise an 'Accepted' condition with a status of
+ 'False' in the corresponding RouteParentStatus.
+
+
+ Support: Core
+ items:
+ description: |-
+ Hostname is the fully qualified domain name of a network host. This matches
+ the RFC 1123 definition of a hostname with 2 notable exceptions:
+
+
+ 1. IPs are not allowed.
+ 2. A hostname may be prefixed with a wildcard label (`*.`). The wildcard
+ label must appear by itself as the first label.
+
+
+ Hostname can be "precise" which is a domain name without the terminating
+ dot of a network host (e.g. "foo.example.com") or "wildcard", which is a
+ domain name prefixed with a single wildcard label (e.g. `*.example.com`).
+
+
+ Note that as per RFC1035 and RFC1123, a *label* must consist of lower case
+ alphanumeric characters or '-', and must start and end with an alphanumeric
+ character. No other punctuation is allowed.
+ maxLength: 253
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^(\*\.)?[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$
+ type: string
+ maxItems: 16
+ type: array
+ parentRefs:
+ description: |+
+ ParentRefs references the resources (usually Gateways) that a Route wants
+ to be attached to. Note that the referenced parent resource needs to
+ allow this for the attachment to be complete. For Gateways, that means
+ the Gateway needs to allow attachment from Routes of this kind and
+ namespace. For Services, that means the Service must either be in the same
+ namespace for a "producer" route, or the mesh implementation must support
+ and allow "consumer" routes for the referenced Service. ReferenceGrant is
+ not applicable for governing ParentRefs to Services - it is not possible to
+ create a "producer" route for a Service in a different namespace from the
+ Route.
+
+
+ There are two kinds of parent resources with "Core" support:
+
+
+ * Gateway (Gateway conformance profile)
+ * Service (Mesh conformance profile, ClusterIP Services only)
+
+
+ This API may be extended in the future to support additional kinds of parent
+ resources.
+
+
+ ParentRefs must be _distinct_. This means either that:
+
+
+ * They select different objects. If this is the case, then parentRef
+ entries are distinct. In terms of fields, this means that the
+ multi-part key defined by `group`, `kind`, `namespace`, and `name` must
+ be unique across all parentRef entries in the Route.
+ * They do not select different objects, but for each optional field used,
+ each ParentRef that selects the same object must set the same set of
+ optional fields to different values. If one ParentRef sets a
+ combination of optional fields, all must set the same combination.
+
+
+ Some examples:
+
+
+ * If one ParentRef sets `sectionName`, all ParentRefs referencing the
+ same object must also set `sectionName`.
+ * If one ParentRef sets `port`, all ParentRefs referencing the same
+ object must also set `port`.
+ * If one ParentRef sets `sectionName` and `port`, all ParentRefs
+ referencing the same object must also set `sectionName` and `port`.
+
+
+ It is possible to separately reference multiple distinct objects that may
+ be collapsed by an implementation. For example, some implementations may
+ choose to merge compatible Gateway Listeners together. If that is the
+ case, the list of routes attached to those resources should also be
+ merged.
+
+
+ Note that for ParentRefs that cross namespace boundaries, there are specific
+ rules. Cross-namespace references are only valid if they are explicitly
+ allowed by something in the namespace they are referring to. For example,
+ Gateway has the AllowedRoutes field, and ReferenceGrant provides a
+ generic way to enable other kinds of cross-namespace reference.
+
+
+
+ ParentRefs from a Route to a Service in the same namespace are "producer"
+ routes, which apply default routing rules to inbound connections from
+ any namespace to the Service.
+
+
+ ParentRefs from a Route to a Service in a different namespace are
+ "consumer" routes, and these routing rules are only applied to outbound
+ connections originating from the same namespace as the Route, for which
+ the intended destination of the connections are a Service targeted as a
+ ParentRef of the Route.
+
+
+
+
+
+
+ items:
+ description: |-
+ ParentReference identifies an API object (usually a Gateway) that can be considered
+ a parent of this resource (usually a route). There are two kinds of parent resources
+ with "Core" support:
+
+
+ * Gateway (Gateway conformance profile)
+ * Service (Mesh conformance profile, ClusterIP Services only)
+
+
+ This API may be extended in the future to support additional kinds of parent
+ resources.
+
+
+ The API object must be valid in the cluster; the Group and Kind must
+ be registered in the cluster for this reference to be valid.
+ properties:
+ group:
+ default: gateway.networking.k8s.io
+ description: |-
+ Group is the group of the referent.
+ When unspecified, "gateway.networking.k8s.io" is inferred.
+ To set the core API group (such as for a "Service" kind referent),
+ Group must be explicitly set to "" (empty string).
+
+
+ Support: Core
+ maxLength: 253
+ pattern: ^$|^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$
+ type: string
+ kind:
+ default: Gateway
+ description: |-
+ Kind is kind of the referent.
+
+
+ There are two kinds of parent resources with "Core" support:
+
+
+ * Gateway (Gateway conformance profile)
+ * Service (Mesh conformance profile, ClusterIP Services only)
+
+
+ Support for other resources is Implementation-Specific.
+ maxLength: 63
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[a-zA-Z]([-a-zA-Z0-9]*[a-zA-Z0-9])?$
+ type: string
+ name:
+ description: |-
+ Name is the name of the referent.
+
+
+ Support: Core
+ maxLength: 253
+ minLength: 1
+ type: string
+ namespace:
+ description: |-
+ Namespace is the namespace of the referent. When unspecified, this refers
+ to the local namespace of the Route.
+
+
+ Note that there are specific rules for ParentRefs which cross namespace
+ boundaries. Cross-namespace references are only valid if they are explicitly
+ allowed by something in the namespace they are referring to. For example:
+ Gateway has the AllowedRoutes field, and ReferenceGrant provides a
+ generic way to enable any other kind of cross-namespace reference.
+
+
+
+ ParentRefs from a Route to a Service in the same namespace are "producer"
+ routes, which apply default routing rules to inbound connections from
+ any namespace to the Service.
+
+
+ ParentRefs from a Route to a Service in a different namespace are
+ "consumer" routes, and these routing rules are only applied to outbound
+ connections originating from the same namespace as the Route, for which
+ the intended destination of the connections are a Service targeted as a
+ ParentRef of the Route.
+
+
+
+ Support: Core
+ maxLength: 63
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?$
+ type: string
+ port:
+ description: |-
+ Port is the network port this Route targets. It can be interpreted
+ differently based on the type of parent resource.
+
+
+ When the parent resource is a Gateway, this targets all listeners
+ listening on the specified port that also support this kind of Route(and
+ select this Route). It's not recommended to set `Port` unless the
+ networking behaviors specified in a Route must apply to a specific port
+ as opposed to a listener(s) whose port(s) may be changed. When both Port
+ and SectionName are specified, the name and port of the selected listener
+ must match both specified values.
+
+
+
+ When the parent resource is a Service, this targets a specific port in the
+ Service spec. When both Port (experimental) and SectionName are specified,
+ the name and port of the selected port must match both specified values.
+
+
+
+ Implementations MAY choose to support other parent resources.
+ Implementations supporting other types of parent resources MUST clearly
+ document how/if Port is interpreted.
+
+
+ For the purpose of status, an attachment is considered successful as
+ long as the parent resource accepts it partially. For example, Gateway
+ listeners can restrict which Routes can attach to them by Route kind,
+ namespace, or hostname. If 1 of 2 Gateway listeners accept attachment
+ from the referencing Route, the Route MUST be considered successfully
+ attached. If no Gateway listeners accept attachment from this Route,
+ the Route MUST be considered detached from the Gateway.
+
+
+ Support: Extended
+ format: int32
+ maximum: 65535
+ minimum: 1
+ type: integer
+ sectionName:
+ description: |-
+ SectionName is the name of a section within the target resource. In the
+ following resources, SectionName is interpreted as the following:
+
+
+ * Gateway: Listener name. When both Port (experimental) and SectionName
+ are specified, the name and port of the selected listener must match
+ both specified values.
+ * Service: Port name. When both Port (experimental) and SectionName
+ are specified, the name and port of the selected listener must match
+ both specified values.
+
+
+ Implementations MAY choose to support attaching Routes to other resources.
+ If that is the case, they MUST clearly document how SectionName is
+ interpreted.
+
+
+ When unspecified (empty string), this will reference the entire resource.
+ For the purpose of status, an attachment is considered successful if at
+ least one section in the parent resource accepts it. For example, Gateway
+ listeners can restrict which Routes can attach to them by Route kind,
+ namespace, or hostname. If 1 of 2 Gateway listeners accept attachment from
+ the referencing Route, the Route MUST be considered successfully
+ attached. If no Gateway listeners accept attachment from this Route, the
+ Route MUST be considered detached from the Gateway.
+
+
+ Support: Core
+ maxLength: 253
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$
+ type: string
+ required:
+ - name
+ type: object
+ maxItems: 32
+ type: array
+ x-kubernetes-validations:
+ - message: sectionName or port must be specified when parentRefs includes
+ 2 or more references to the same parent
+ rule: 'self.all(p1, self.all(p2, p1.group == p2.group && p1.kind
+ == p2.kind && p1.name == p2.name && (((!has(p1.__namespace__)
+ || p1.__namespace__ == '''') && (!has(p2.__namespace__) || p2.__namespace__
+ == '''')) || (has(p1.__namespace__) && has(p2.__namespace__) &&
+ p1.__namespace__ == p2.__namespace__)) ? ((!has(p1.sectionName)
+ || p1.sectionName == '''') == (!has(p2.sectionName) || p2.sectionName
+ == '''') && (!has(p1.port) || p1.port == 0) == (!has(p2.port)
+ || p2.port == 0)): true))'
+ - message: sectionName or port must be unique when parentRefs includes
+ 2 or more references to the same parent
+ rule: self.all(p1, self.exists_one(p2, p1.group == p2.group && p1.kind
+ == p2.kind && p1.name == p2.name && (((!has(p1.__namespace__)
+ || p1.__namespace__ == '') && (!has(p2.__namespace__) || p2.__namespace__
+ == '')) || (has(p1.__namespace__) && has(p2.__namespace__) &&
+ p1.__namespace__ == p2.__namespace__ )) && (((!has(p1.sectionName)
+ || p1.sectionName == '') && (!has(p2.sectionName) || p2.sectionName
+ == '')) || ( has(p1.sectionName) && has(p2.sectionName) && p1.sectionName
+ == p2.sectionName)) && (((!has(p1.port) || p1.port == 0) && (!has(p2.port)
+ || p2.port == 0)) || (has(p1.port) && has(p2.port) && p1.port
+ == p2.port))))
+ rules:
+ description: Rules are a list of GRPC matchers, filters and actions.
+ items:
+ description: |-
+ GRPCRouteRule defines the semantics for matching a gRPC request based on
+ conditions (matches), processing it (filters), and forwarding the request to
+ an API object (backendRefs).
+ properties:
+ backendRefs:
+ description: |-
+ BackendRefs defines the backend(s) where matching requests should be
+ sent.
+
+
+ Failure behavior here depends on how many BackendRefs are specified and
+ how many are invalid.
+
+
+ If *all* entries in BackendRefs are invalid, and there are also no filters
+ specified in this route rule, *all* traffic which matches this rule MUST
+ receive an `UNAVAILABLE` status.
+
+
+ See the GRPCBackendRef definition for the rules about what makes a single
+ GRPCBackendRef invalid.
+
+
+ When a GRPCBackendRef is invalid, `UNAVAILABLE` statuses MUST be returned for
+ requests that would have otherwise been routed to an invalid backend. If
+ multiple backends are specified, and some are invalid, the proportion of
+ requests that would otherwise have been routed to an invalid backend
+ MUST receive an `UNAVAILABLE` status.
+
+
+ For example, if two backends are specified with equal weights, and one is
+ invalid, 50 percent of traffic MUST receive an `UNAVAILABLE` status.
+ Implementations may choose how that 50 percent is determined.
+
+
+ Support: Core for Kubernetes Service
+
+
+ Support: Implementation-specific for any other resource
+
+
+ Support for weight: Core
+ items:
+ description: |-
+ GRPCBackendRef defines how a GRPCRoute forwards a gRPC request.
+
+
+ Note that when a namespace different than the local namespace is specified, a
+ ReferenceGrant object is required in the referent namespace to allow that
+ namespace's owner to accept the reference. See the ReferenceGrant
+ documentation for details.
+
+
+
+
+
+ When the BackendRef points to a Kubernetes Service, implementations SHOULD
+ honor the appProtocol field if it is set for the target Service Port.
+
+
+ Implementations supporting appProtocol SHOULD recognize the Kubernetes
+ Standard Application Protocols defined in KEP-3726.
+
+
+ If a Service appProtocol isn't specified, an implementation MAY infer the
+ backend protocol through its own means. Implementations MAY infer the
+ protocol from the Route type referring to the backend Service.
+
+
+ If a Route is not able to send traffic to the backend using the specified
+ protocol then the backend is considered invalid. Implementations MUST set the
+ "ResolvedRefs" condition to "False" with the "UnsupportedProtocol" reason.
+
+
+
+ properties:
+ filters:
+ description: |-
+ Filters defined at this level MUST be executed if and only if the
+ request is being forwarded to the backend defined here.
+
+
+ Support: Implementation-specific (For broader support of filters, use the
+ Filters field in GRPCRouteRule.)
+ items:
+ description: |-
+ GRPCRouteFilter defines processing steps that must be completed during the
+ request or response lifecycle. GRPCRouteFilters are meant as an extension
+ point to express processing that may be done in Gateway implementations. Some
+ examples include request or response modification, implementing
+ authentication strategies, rate-limiting, and traffic shaping. API
+ guarantee/conformance is defined based on the type of the filter.
+ properties:
+ extensionRef:
+ description: |-
+ ExtensionRef is an optional, implementation-specific extension to the
+ "filter" behavior. For example, resource "myroutefilter" in group
+ "networking.example.net"). ExtensionRef MUST NOT be used for core and
+ extended filters.
+
+
+ Support: Implementation-specific
+
+
+ This filter can be used multiple times within the same rule.
+ properties:
+ group:
+ description: |-
+ Group is the group of the referent. For example, "gateway.networking.k8s.io".
+ When unspecified or empty string, core API group is inferred.
+ maxLength: 253
+ pattern: ^$|^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$
+ type: string
+ kind:
+ description: Kind is kind of the referent. For
+ example "HTTPRoute" or "Service".
+ maxLength: 63
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[a-zA-Z]([-a-zA-Z0-9]*[a-zA-Z0-9])?$
+ type: string
+ name:
+ description: Name is the name of the referent.
+ maxLength: 253
+ minLength: 1
+ type: string
+ required:
+ - group
+ - kind
+ - name
+ type: object
+ requestHeaderModifier:
+ description: |-
+ RequestHeaderModifier defines a schema for a filter that modifies request
+ headers.
+
+
+ Support: Core
+ properties:
+ add:
+ description: |-
+ Add adds the given header(s) (name, value) to the request
+ before the action. It appends to any existing values associated
+ with the header name.
+
+
+ Input:
+ GET /foo HTTP/1.1
+ my-header: foo
+
+
+ Config:
+ add:
+ - name: "my-header"
+ value: "bar,baz"
+
+
+ Output:
+ GET /foo HTTP/1.1
+ my-header: foo,bar,baz
+ items:
+ description: HTTPHeader represents an HTTP
+ Header name and value as defined by RFC
+ 7230.
+ properties:
+ name:
+ description: |-
+ Name is the name of the HTTP Header to be matched. Name matching MUST be
+ case insensitive. (See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc7230#section-3.2).
+
+
+ If multiple entries specify equivalent header names, the first entry with
+ an equivalent name MUST be considered for a match. Subsequent entries
+ with an equivalent header name MUST be ignored. Due to the
+ case-insensitivity of header names, "foo" and "Foo" are considered
+ equivalent.
+ maxLength: 256
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[A-Za-z0-9!#$%&'*+\-.^_\x60|~]+$
+ type: string
+ value:
+ description: Value is the value of HTTP
+ Header to be matched.
+ maxLength: 4096
+ minLength: 1
+ type: string
+ required:
+ - name
+ - value
+ type: object
+ maxItems: 16
+ type: array
+ x-kubernetes-list-map-keys:
+ - name
+ x-kubernetes-list-type: map
+ remove:
+ description: |-
+ Remove the given header(s) from the HTTP request before the action. The
+ value of Remove is a list of HTTP header names. Note that the header
+ names are case-insensitive (see
+ https://datatracker.ietf.org/doc/html/rfc2616#section-4.2).
+
+
+ Input:
+ GET /foo HTTP/1.1
+ my-header1: foo
+ my-header2: bar
+ my-header3: baz
+
+
+ Config:
+ remove: ["my-header1", "my-header3"]
+
+
+ Output:
+ GET /foo HTTP/1.1
+ my-header2: bar
+ items:
+ type: string
+ maxItems: 16
+ type: array
+ x-kubernetes-list-type: set
+ set:
+ description: |-
+ Set overwrites the request with the given header (name, value)
+ before the action.
+
+
+ Input:
+ GET /foo HTTP/1.1
+ my-header: foo
+
+
+ Config:
+ set:
+ - name: "my-header"
+ value: "bar"
+
+
+ Output:
+ GET /foo HTTP/1.1
+ my-header: bar
+ items:
+ description: HTTPHeader represents an HTTP
+ Header name and value as defined by RFC
+ 7230.
+ properties:
+ name:
+ description: |-
+ Name is the name of the HTTP Header to be matched. Name matching MUST be
+ case insensitive. (See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc7230#section-3.2).
+
+
+ If multiple entries specify equivalent header names, the first entry with
+ an equivalent name MUST be considered for a match. Subsequent entries
+ with an equivalent header name MUST be ignored. Due to the
+ case-insensitivity of header names, "foo" and "Foo" are considered
+ equivalent.
+ maxLength: 256
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[A-Za-z0-9!#$%&'*+\-.^_\x60|~]+$
+ type: string
+ value:
+ description: Value is the value of HTTP
+ Header to be matched.
+ maxLength: 4096
+ minLength: 1
+ type: string
+ required:
+ - name
+ - value
+ type: object
+ maxItems: 16
+ type: array
+ x-kubernetes-list-map-keys:
+ - name
+ x-kubernetes-list-type: map
+ type: object
+ requestMirror:
+ description: |-
+ RequestMirror defines a schema for a filter that mirrors requests.
+ Requests are sent to the specified destination, but responses from
+ that destination are ignored.
+
+
+ This filter can be used multiple times within the same rule. Note that
+ not all implementations will be able to support mirroring to multiple
+ backends.
+
+
+ Support: Extended
+ properties:
+ backendRef:
+ description: |-
+ BackendRef references a resource where mirrored requests are sent.
+
+
+ Mirrored requests must be sent only to a single destination endpoint
+ within this BackendRef, irrespective of how many endpoints are present
+ within this BackendRef.
+
+
+ If the referent cannot be found, this BackendRef is invalid and must be
+ dropped from the Gateway. The controller must ensure the "ResolvedRefs"
+ condition on the Route status is set to `status: False` and not configure
+ this backend in the underlying implementation.
+
+
+ If there is a cross-namespace reference to an *existing* object
+ that is not allowed by a ReferenceGrant, the controller must ensure the
+ "ResolvedRefs" condition on the Route is set to `status: False`,
+ with the "RefNotPermitted" reason and not configure this backend in the
+ underlying implementation.
+
+
+ In either error case, the Message of the `ResolvedRefs` Condition
+ should be used to provide more detail about the problem.
+
+
+ Support: Extended for Kubernetes Service
+
+
+ Support: Implementation-specific for any other resource
+ properties:
+ group:
+ default: ""
+ description: |-
+ Group is the group of the referent. For example, "gateway.networking.k8s.io".
+ When unspecified or empty string, core API group is inferred.
+ maxLength: 253
+ pattern: ^$|^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$
+ type: string
+ kind:
+ default: Service
+ description: |-
+ Kind is the Kubernetes resource kind of the referent. For example
+ "Service".
+
+
+ Defaults to "Service" when not specified.
+
+
+ ExternalName services can refer to CNAME DNS records that may live
+ outside of the cluster and as such are difficult to reason about in
+ terms of conformance. They also may not be safe to forward to (see
+ CVE-2021-25740 for more information). Implementations SHOULD NOT
+ support ExternalName Services.
+
+
+ Support: Core (Services with a type other than ExternalName)
+
+
+ Support: Implementation-specific (Services with type ExternalName)
+ maxLength: 63
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[a-zA-Z]([-a-zA-Z0-9]*[a-zA-Z0-9])?$
+ type: string
+ name:
+ description: Name is the name of the referent.
+ maxLength: 253
+ minLength: 1
+ type: string
+ namespace:
+ description: |-
+ Namespace is the namespace of the backend. When unspecified, the local
+ namespace is inferred.
+
+
+ Note that when a namespace different than the local namespace is specified,
+ a ReferenceGrant object is required in the referent namespace to allow that
+ namespace's owner to accept the reference. See the ReferenceGrant
+ documentation for details.
+
+
+ Support: Core
+ maxLength: 63
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?$
+ type: string
+ port:
+ description: |-
+ Port specifies the destination port number to use for this resource.
+ Port is required when the referent is a Kubernetes Service. In this
+ case, the port number is the service port number, not the target port.
+ For other resources, destination port might be derived from the referent
+ resource or this field.
+ format: int32
+ maximum: 65535
+ minimum: 1
+ type: integer
+ required:
+ - name
+ type: object
+ x-kubernetes-validations:
+ - message: Must have port for Service reference
+ rule: '(size(self.group) == 0 && self.kind
+ == ''Service'') ? has(self.port) : true'
+ required:
+ - backendRef
+ type: object
+ responseHeaderModifier:
+ description: |-
+ ResponseHeaderModifier defines a schema for a filter that modifies response
+ headers.
+
+
+ Support: Extended
+ properties:
+ add:
+ description: |-
+ Add adds the given header(s) (name, value) to the request
+ before the action. It appends to any existing values associated
+ with the header name.
+
+
+ Input:
+ GET /foo HTTP/1.1
+ my-header: foo
+
+
+ Config:
+ add:
+ - name: "my-header"
+ value: "bar,baz"
+
+
+ Output:
+ GET /foo HTTP/1.1
+ my-header: foo,bar,baz
+ items:
+ description: HTTPHeader represents an HTTP
+ Header name and value as defined by RFC
+ 7230.
+ properties:
+ name:
+ description: |-
+ Name is the name of the HTTP Header to be matched. Name matching MUST be
+ case insensitive. (See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc7230#section-3.2).
+
+
+ If multiple entries specify equivalent header names, the first entry with
+ an equivalent name MUST be considered for a match. Subsequent entries
+ with an equivalent header name MUST be ignored. Due to the
+ case-insensitivity of header names, "foo" and "Foo" are considered
+ equivalent.
+ maxLength: 256
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[A-Za-z0-9!#$%&'*+\-.^_\x60|~]+$
+ type: string
+ value:
+ description: Value is the value of HTTP
+ Header to be matched.
+ maxLength: 4096
+ minLength: 1
+ type: string
+ required:
+ - name
+ - value
+ type: object
+ maxItems: 16
+ type: array
+ x-kubernetes-list-map-keys:
+ - name
+ x-kubernetes-list-type: map
+ remove:
+ description: |-
+ Remove the given header(s) from the HTTP request before the action. The
+ value of Remove is a list of HTTP header names. Note that the header
+ names are case-insensitive (see
+ https://datatracker.ietf.org/doc/html/rfc2616#section-4.2).
+
+
+ Input:
+ GET /foo HTTP/1.1
+ my-header1: foo
+ my-header2: bar
+ my-header3: baz
+
+
+ Config:
+ remove: ["my-header1", "my-header3"]
+
+
+ Output:
+ GET /foo HTTP/1.1
+ my-header2: bar
+ items:
+ type: string
+ maxItems: 16
+ type: array
+ x-kubernetes-list-type: set
+ set:
+ description: |-
+ Set overwrites the request with the given header (name, value)
+ before the action.
+
+
+ Input:
+ GET /foo HTTP/1.1
+ my-header: foo
+
+
+ Config:
+ set:
+ - name: "my-header"
+ value: "bar"
+
+
+ Output:
+ GET /foo HTTP/1.1
+ my-header: bar
+ items:
+ description: HTTPHeader represents an HTTP
+ Header name and value as defined by RFC
+ 7230.
+ properties:
+ name:
+ description: |-
+ Name is the name of the HTTP Header to be matched. Name matching MUST be
+ case insensitive. (See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc7230#section-3.2).
+
+
+ If multiple entries specify equivalent header names, the first entry with
+ an equivalent name MUST be considered for a match. Subsequent entries
+ with an equivalent header name MUST be ignored. Due to the
+ case-insensitivity of header names, "foo" and "Foo" are considered
+ equivalent.
+ maxLength: 256
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[A-Za-z0-9!#$%&'*+\-.^_\x60|~]+$
+ type: string
+ value:
+ description: Value is the value of HTTP
+ Header to be matched.
+ maxLength: 4096
+ minLength: 1
+ type: string
+ required:
+ - name
+ - value
+ type: object
+ maxItems: 16
+ type: array
+ x-kubernetes-list-map-keys:
+ - name
+ x-kubernetes-list-type: map
+ type: object
+ type:
+ description: |+
+ Type identifies the type of filter to apply. As with other API fields,
+ types are classified into three conformance levels:
+
+
+ - Core: Filter types and their corresponding configuration defined by
+ "Support: Core" in this package, e.g. "RequestHeaderModifier". All
+ implementations supporting GRPCRoute MUST support core filters.
+
+
+ - Extended: Filter types and their corresponding configuration defined by
+ "Support: Extended" in this package, e.g. "RequestMirror". Implementers
+ are encouraged to support extended filters.
+
+
+ - Implementation-specific: Filters that are defined and supported by specific vendors.
+ In the future, filters showing convergence in behavior across multiple
+ implementations will be considered for inclusion in extended or core
+ conformance levels. Filter-specific configuration for such filters
+ is specified using the ExtensionRef field. `Type` MUST be set to
+ "ExtensionRef" for custom filters.
+
+
+ Implementers are encouraged to define custom implementation types to
+ extend the core API with implementation-specific behavior.
+
+
+ If a reference to a custom filter type cannot be resolved, the filter
+ MUST NOT be skipped. Instead, requests that would have been processed by
+ that filter MUST receive a HTTP error response.
+
+
+ enum:
+ - ResponseHeaderModifier
+ - RequestHeaderModifier
+ - RequestMirror
+ - ExtensionRef
+ type: string
+ required:
+ - type
+ type: object
+ x-kubernetes-validations:
+ - message: filter.requestHeaderModifier must be nil
+ if the filter.type is not RequestHeaderModifier
+ rule: '!(has(self.requestHeaderModifier) && self.type
+ != ''RequestHeaderModifier'')'
+ - message: filter.requestHeaderModifier must be specified
+ for RequestHeaderModifier filter.type
+ rule: '!(!has(self.requestHeaderModifier) && self.type
+ == ''RequestHeaderModifier'')'
+ - message: filter.responseHeaderModifier must be nil
+ if the filter.type is not ResponseHeaderModifier
+ rule: '!(has(self.responseHeaderModifier) && self.type
+ != ''ResponseHeaderModifier'')'
+ - message: filter.responseHeaderModifier must be specified
+ for ResponseHeaderModifier filter.type
+ rule: '!(!has(self.responseHeaderModifier) && self.type
+ == ''ResponseHeaderModifier'')'
+ - message: filter.requestMirror must be nil if the filter.type
+ is not RequestMirror
+ rule: '!(has(self.requestMirror) && self.type != ''RequestMirror'')'
+ - message: filter.requestMirror must be specified for
+ RequestMirror filter.type
+ rule: '!(!has(self.requestMirror) && self.type ==
+ ''RequestMirror'')'
+ - message: filter.extensionRef must be nil if the filter.type
+ is not ExtensionRef
+ rule: '!(has(self.extensionRef) && self.type != ''ExtensionRef'')'
+ - message: filter.extensionRef must be specified for
+ ExtensionRef filter.type
+ rule: '!(!has(self.extensionRef) && self.type == ''ExtensionRef'')'
+ maxItems: 16
+ type: array
+ x-kubernetes-validations:
+ - message: RequestHeaderModifier filter cannot be repeated
+ rule: self.filter(f, f.type == 'RequestHeaderModifier').size()
+ <= 1
+ - message: ResponseHeaderModifier filter cannot be repeated
+ rule: self.filter(f, f.type == 'ResponseHeaderModifier').size()
+ <= 1
+ group:
+ default: ""
+ description: |-
+ Group is the group of the referent. For example, "gateway.networking.k8s.io".
+ When unspecified or empty string, core API group is inferred.
+ maxLength: 253
+ pattern: ^$|^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$
+ type: string
+ kind:
+ default: Service
+ description: |-
+ Kind is the Kubernetes resource kind of the referent. For example
+ "Service".
+
+
+ Defaults to "Service" when not specified.
+
+
+ ExternalName services can refer to CNAME DNS records that may live
+ outside of the cluster and as such are difficult to reason about in
+ terms of conformance. They also may not be safe to forward to (see
+ CVE-2021-25740 for more information). Implementations SHOULD NOT
+ support ExternalName Services.
+
+
+ Support: Core (Services with a type other than ExternalName)
+
+
+ Support: Implementation-specific (Services with type ExternalName)
+ maxLength: 63
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[a-zA-Z]([-a-zA-Z0-9]*[a-zA-Z0-9])?$
+ type: string
+ name:
+ description: Name is the name of the referent.
+ maxLength: 253
+ minLength: 1
+ type: string
+ namespace:
+ description: |-
+ Namespace is the namespace of the backend. When unspecified, the local
+ namespace is inferred.
+
+
+ Note that when a namespace different than the local namespace is specified,
+ a ReferenceGrant object is required in the referent namespace to allow that
+ namespace's owner to accept the reference. See the ReferenceGrant
+ documentation for details.
+
+
+ Support: Core
+ maxLength: 63
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?$
+ type: string
+ port:
+ description: |-
+ Port specifies the destination port number to use for this resource.
+ Port is required when the referent is a Kubernetes Service. In this
+ case, the port number is the service port number, not the target port.
+ For other resources, destination port might be derived from the referent
+ resource or this field.
+ format: int32
+ maximum: 65535
+ minimum: 1
+ type: integer
+ weight:
+ default: 1
+ description: |-
+ Weight specifies the proportion of requests forwarded to the referenced
+ backend. This is computed as weight/(sum of all weights in this
+ BackendRefs list). For non-zero values, there may be some epsilon from
+ the exact proportion defined here depending on the precision an
+ implementation supports. Weight is not a percentage and the sum of
+ weights does not need to equal 100.
+
+
+ If only one backend is specified and it has a weight greater than 0, 100%
+ of the traffic is forwarded to that backend. If weight is set to 0, no
+ traffic should be forwarded for this entry. If unspecified, weight
+ defaults to 1.
+
+
+ Support for this field varies based on the context where used.
+ format: int32
+ maximum: 1000000
+ minimum: 0
+ type: integer
+ required:
+ - name
+ type: object
+ x-kubernetes-validations:
+ - message: Must have port for Service reference
+ rule: '(size(self.group) == 0 && self.kind == ''Service'')
+ ? has(self.port) : true'
+ maxItems: 16
+ type: array
+ filters:
+ description: |-
+ Filters define the filters that are applied to requests that match
+ this rule.
+
+
+ The effects of ordering of multiple behaviors are currently unspecified.
+ This can change in the future based on feedback during the alpha stage.
+
+
+ Conformance-levels at this level are defined based on the type of filter:
+
+
+ - ALL core filters MUST be supported by all implementations that support
+ GRPCRoute.
+ - Implementers are encouraged to support extended filters.
+ - Implementation-specific custom filters have no API guarantees across
+ implementations.
+
+
+ Specifying the same filter multiple times is not supported unless explicitly
+ indicated in the filter.
+
+
+ If an implementation can not support a combination of filters, it must clearly
+ document that limitation. In cases where incompatible or unsupported
+ filters are specified and cause the `Accepted` condition to be set to status
+ `False`, implementations may use the `IncompatibleFilters` reason to specify
+ this configuration error.
+
+
+ Support: Core
+ items:
+ description: |-
+ GRPCRouteFilter defines processing steps that must be completed during the
+ request or response lifecycle. GRPCRouteFilters are meant as an extension
+ point to express processing that may be done in Gateway implementations. Some
+ examples include request or response modification, implementing
+ authentication strategies, rate-limiting, and traffic shaping. API
+ guarantee/conformance is defined based on the type of the filter.
+ properties:
+ extensionRef:
+ description: |-
+ ExtensionRef is an optional, implementation-specific extension to the
+ "filter" behavior. For example, resource "myroutefilter" in group
+ "networking.example.net"). ExtensionRef MUST NOT be used for core and
+ extended filters.
+
+
+ Support: Implementation-specific
+
+
+ This filter can be used multiple times within the same rule.
+ properties:
+ group:
+ description: |-
+ Group is the group of the referent. For example, "gateway.networking.k8s.io".
+ When unspecified or empty string, core API group is inferred.
+ maxLength: 253
+ pattern: ^$|^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$
+ type: string
+ kind:
+ description: Kind is kind of the referent. For example
+ "HTTPRoute" or "Service".
+ maxLength: 63
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[a-zA-Z]([-a-zA-Z0-9]*[a-zA-Z0-9])?$
+ type: string
+ name:
+ description: Name is the name of the referent.
+ maxLength: 253
+ minLength: 1
+ type: string
+ required:
+ - group
+ - kind
+ - name
+ type: object
+ requestHeaderModifier:
+ description: |-
+ RequestHeaderModifier defines a schema for a filter that modifies request
+ headers.
+
+
+ Support: Core
+ properties:
+ add:
+ description: |-
+ Add adds the given header(s) (name, value) to the request
+ before the action. It appends to any existing values associated
+ with the header name.
+
+
+ Input:
+ GET /foo HTTP/1.1
+ my-header: foo
+
+
+ Config:
+ add:
+ - name: "my-header"
+ value: "bar,baz"
+
+
+ Output:
+ GET /foo HTTP/1.1
+ my-header: foo,bar,baz
+ items:
+ description: HTTPHeader represents an HTTP Header
+ name and value as defined by RFC 7230.
+ properties:
+ name:
+ description: |-
+ Name is the name of the HTTP Header to be matched. Name matching MUST be
+ case insensitive. (See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc7230#section-3.2).
+
+
+ If multiple entries specify equivalent header names, the first entry with
+ an equivalent name MUST be considered for a match. Subsequent entries
+ with an equivalent header name MUST be ignored. Due to the
+ case-insensitivity of header names, "foo" and "Foo" are considered
+ equivalent.
+ maxLength: 256
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[A-Za-z0-9!#$%&'*+\-.^_\x60|~]+$
+ type: string
+ value:
+ description: Value is the value of HTTP Header
+ to be matched.
+ maxLength: 4096
+ minLength: 1
+ type: string
+ required:
+ - name
+ - value
+ type: object
+ maxItems: 16
+ type: array
+ x-kubernetes-list-map-keys:
+ - name
+ x-kubernetes-list-type: map
+ remove:
+ description: |-
+ Remove the given header(s) from the HTTP request before the action. The
+ value of Remove is a list of HTTP header names. Note that the header
+ names are case-insensitive (see
+ https://datatracker.ietf.org/doc/html/rfc2616#section-4.2).
+
+
+ Input:
+ GET /foo HTTP/1.1
+ my-header1: foo
+ my-header2: bar
+ my-header3: baz
+
+
+ Config:
+ remove: ["my-header1", "my-header3"]
+
+
+ Output:
+ GET /foo HTTP/1.1
+ my-header2: bar
+ items:
+ type: string
+ maxItems: 16
+ type: array
+ x-kubernetes-list-type: set
+ set:
+ description: |-
+ Set overwrites the request with the given header (name, value)
+ before the action.
+
+
+ Input:
+ GET /foo HTTP/1.1
+ my-header: foo
+
+
+ Config:
+ set:
+ - name: "my-header"
+ value: "bar"
+
+
+ Output:
+ GET /foo HTTP/1.1
+ my-header: bar
+ items:
+ description: HTTPHeader represents an HTTP Header
+ name and value as defined by RFC 7230.
+ properties:
+ name:
+ description: |-
+ Name is the name of the HTTP Header to be matched. Name matching MUST be
+ case insensitive. (See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc7230#section-3.2).
+
+
+ If multiple entries specify equivalent header names, the first entry with
+ an equivalent name MUST be considered for a match. Subsequent entries
+ with an equivalent header name MUST be ignored. Due to the
+ case-insensitivity of header names, "foo" and "Foo" are considered
+ equivalent.
+ maxLength: 256
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[A-Za-z0-9!#$%&'*+\-.^_\x60|~]+$
+ type: string
+ value:
+ description: Value is the value of HTTP Header
+ to be matched.
+ maxLength: 4096
+ minLength: 1
+ type: string
+ required:
+ - name
+ - value
+ type: object
+ maxItems: 16
+ type: array
+ x-kubernetes-list-map-keys:
+ - name
+ x-kubernetes-list-type: map
+ type: object
+ requestMirror:
+ description: |-
+ RequestMirror defines a schema for a filter that mirrors requests.
+ Requests are sent to the specified destination, but responses from
+ that destination are ignored.
+
+
+ This filter can be used multiple times within the same rule. Note that
+ not all implementations will be able to support mirroring to multiple
+ backends.
+
+
+ Support: Extended
+ properties:
+ backendRef:
+ description: |-
+ BackendRef references a resource where mirrored requests are sent.
+
+
+ Mirrored requests must be sent only to a single destination endpoint
+ within this BackendRef, irrespective of how many endpoints are present
+ within this BackendRef.
+
+
+ If the referent cannot be found, this BackendRef is invalid and must be
+ dropped from the Gateway. The controller must ensure the "ResolvedRefs"
+ condition on the Route status is set to `status: False` and not configure
+ this backend in the underlying implementation.
+
+
+ If there is a cross-namespace reference to an *existing* object
+ that is not allowed by a ReferenceGrant, the controller must ensure the
+ "ResolvedRefs" condition on the Route is set to `status: False`,
+ with the "RefNotPermitted" reason and not configure this backend in the
+ underlying implementation.
+
+
+ In either error case, the Message of the `ResolvedRefs` Condition
+ should be used to provide more detail about the problem.
+
+
+ Support: Extended for Kubernetes Service
+
+
+ Support: Implementation-specific for any other resource
+ properties:
+ group:
+ default: ""
+ description: |-
+ Group is the group of the referent. For example, "gateway.networking.k8s.io".
+ When unspecified or empty string, core API group is inferred.
+ maxLength: 253
+ pattern: ^$|^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$
+ type: string
+ kind:
+ default: Service
+ description: |-
+ Kind is the Kubernetes resource kind of the referent. For example
+ "Service".
+
+
+ Defaults to "Service" when not specified.
+
+
+ ExternalName services can refer to CNAME DNS records that may live
+ outside of the cluster and as such are difficult to reason about in
+ terms of conformance. They also may not be safe to forward to (see
+ CVE-2021-25740 for more information). Implementations SHOULD NOT
+ support ExternalName Services.
+
+
+ Support: Core (Services with a type other than ExternalName)
+
+
+ Support: Implementation-specific (Services with type ExternalName)
+ maxLength: 63
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[a-zA-Z]([-a-zA-Z0-9]*[a-zA-Z0-9])?$
+ type: string
+ name:
+ description: Name is the name of the referent.
+ maxLength: 253
+ minLength: 1
+ type: string
+ namespace:
+ description: |-
+ Namespace is the namespace of the backend. When unspecified, the local
+ namespace is inferred.
+
+
+ Note that when a namespace different than the local namespace is specified,
+ a ReferenceGrant object is required in the referent namespace to allow that
+ namespace's owner to accept the reference. See the ReferenceGrant
+ documentation for details.
+
+
+ Support: Core
+ maxLength: 63
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?$
+ type: string
+ port:
+ description: |-
+ Port specifies the destination port number to use for this resource.
+ Port is required when the referent is a Kubernetes Service. In this
+ case, the port number is the service port number, not the target port.
+ For other resources, destination port might be derived from the referent
+ resource or this field.
+ format: int32
+ maximum: 65535
+ minimum: 1
+ type: integer
+ required:
+ - name
+ type: object
+ x-kubernetes-validations:
+ - message: Must have port for Service reference
+ rule: '(size(self.group) == 0 && self.kind == ''Service'')
+ ? has(self.port) : true'
+ required:
+ - backendRef
+ type: object
+ responseHeaderModifier:
+ description: |-
+ ResponseHeaderModifier defines a schema for a filter that modifies response
+ headers.
+
+
+ Support: Extended
+ properties:
+ add:
+ description: |-
+ Add adds the given header(s) (name, value) to the request
+ before the action. It appends to any existing values associated
+ with the header name.
+
+
+ Input:
+ GET /foo HTTP/1.1
+ my-header: foo
+
+
+ Config:
+ add:
+ - name: "my-header"
+ value: "bar,baz"
+
+
+ Output:
+ GET /foo HTTP/1.1
+ my-header: foo,bar,baz
+ items:
+ description: HTTPHeader represents an HTTP Header
+ name and value as defined by RFC 7230.
+ properties:
+ name:
+ description: |-
+ Name is the name of the HTTP Header to be matched. Name matching MUST be
+ case insensitive. (See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc7230#section-3.2).
+
+
+ If multiple entries specify equivalent header names, the first entry with
+ an equivalent name MUST be considered for a match. Subsequent entries
+ with an equivalent header name MUST be ignored. Due to the
+ case-insensitivity of header names, "foo" and "Foo" are considered
+ equivalent.
+ maxLength: 256
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[A-Za-z0-9!#$%&'*+\-.^_\x60|~]+$
+ type: string
+ value:
+ description: Value is the value of HTTP Header
+ to be matched.
+ maxLength: 4096
+ minLength: 1
+ type: string
+ required:
+ - name
+ - value
+ type: object
+ maxItems: 16
+ type: array
+ x-kubernetes-list-map-keys:
+ - name
+ x-kubernetes-list-type: map
+ remove:
+ description: |-
+ Remove the given header(s) from the HTTP request before the action. The
+ value of Remove is a list of HTTP header names. Note that the header
+ names are case-insensitive (see
+ https://datatracker.ietf.org/doc/html/rfc2616#section-4.2).
+
+
+ Input:
+ GET /foo HTTP/1.1
+ my-header1: foo
+ my-header2: bar
+ my-header3: baz
+
+
+ Config:
+ remove: ["my-header1", "my-header3"]
+
+
+ Output:
+ GET /foo HTTP/1.1
+ my-header2: bar
+ items:
+ type: string
+ maxItems: 16
+ type: array
+ x-kubernetes-list-type: set
+ set:
+ description: |-
+ Set overwrites the request with the given header (name, value)
+ before the action.
+
+
+ Input:
+ GET /foo HTTP/1.1
+ my-header: foo
+
+
+ Config:
+ set:
+ - name: "my-header"
+ value: "bar"
+
+
+ Output:
+ GET /foo HTTP/1.1
+ my-header: bar
+ items:
+ description: HTTPHeader represents an HTTP Header
+ name and value as defined by RFC 7230.
+ properties:
+ name:
+ description: |-
+ Name is the name of the HTTP Header to be matched. Name matching MUST be
+ case insensitive. (See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc7230#section-3.2).
+
+
+ If multiple entries specify equivalent header names, the first entry with
+ an equivalent name MUST be considered for a match. Subsequent entries
+ with an equivalent header name MUST be ignored. Due to the
+ case-insensitivity of header names, "foo" and "Foo" are considered
+ equivalent.
+ maxLength: 256
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[A-Za-z0-9!#$%&'*+\-.^_\x60|~]+$
+ type: string
+ value:
+ description: Value is the value of HTTP Header
+ to be matched.
+ maxLength: 4096
+ minLength: 1
+ type: string
+ required:
+ - name
+ - value
+ type: object
+ maxItems: 16
+ type: array
+ x-kubernetes-list-map-keys:
+ - name
+ x-kubernetes-list-type: map
+ type: object
+ type:
+ description: |+
+ Type identifies the type of filter to apply. As with other API fields,
+ types are classified into three conformance levels:
+
+
+ - Core: Filter types and their corresponding configuration defined by
+ "Support: Core" in this package, e.g. "RequestHeaderModifier". All
+ implementations supporting GRPCRoute MUST support core filters.
+
+
+ - Extended: Filter types and their corresponding configuration defined by
+ "Support: Extended" in this package, e.g. "RequestMirror". Implementers
+ are encouraged to support extended filters.
+
+
+ - Implementation-specific: Filters that are defined and supported by specific vendors.
+ In the future, filters showing convergence in behavior across multiple
+ implementations will be considered for inclusion in extended or core
+ conformance levels. Filter-specific configuration for such filters
+ is specified using the ExtensionRef field. `Type` MUST be set to
+ "ExtensionRef" for custom filters.
+
+
+ Implementers are encouraged to define custom implementation types to
+ extend the core API with implementation-specific behavior.
+
+
+ If a reference to a custom filter type cannot be resolved, the filter
+ MUST NOT be skipped. Instead, requests that would have been processed by
+ that filter MUST receive a HTTP error response.
+
+
+ enum:
+ - ResponseHeaderModifier
+ - RequestHeaderModifier
+ - RequestMirror
+ - ExtensionRef
+ type: string
+ required:
+ - type
+ type: object
+ x-kubernetes-validations:
+ - message: filter.requestHeaderModifier must be nil if the
+ filter.type is not RequestHeaderModifier
+ rule: '!(has(self.requestHeaderModifier) && self.type !=
+ ''RequestHeaderModifier'')'
+ - message: filter.requestHeaderModifier must be specified
+ for RequestHeaderModifier filter.type
+ rule: '!(!has(self.requestHeaderModifier) && self.type ==
+ ''RequestHeaderModifier'')'
+ - message: filter.responseHeaderModifier must be nil if the
+ filter.type is not ResponseHeaderModifier
+ rule: '!(has(self.responseHeaderModifier) && self.type !=
+ ''ResponseHeaderModifier'')'
+ - message: filter.responseHeaderModifier must be specified
+ for ResponseHeaderModifier filter.type
+ rule: '!(!has(self.responseHeaderModifier) && self.type
+ == ''ResponseHeaderModifier'')'
+ - message: filter.requestMirror must be nil if the filter.type
+ is not RequestMirror
+ rule: '!(has(self.requestMirror) && self.type != ''RequestMirror'')'
+ - message: filter.requestMirror must be specified for RequestMirror
+ filter.type
+ rule: '!(!has(self.requestMirror) && self.type == ''RequestMirror'')'
+ - message: filter.extensionRef must be nil if the filter.type
+ is not ExtensionRef
+ rule: '!(has(self.extensionRef) && self.type != ''ExtensionRef'')'
+ - message: filter.extensionRef must be specified for ExtensionRef
+ filter.type
+ rule: '!(!has(self.extensionRef) && self.type == ''ExtensionRef'')'
+ maxItems: 16
+ type: array
+ x-kubernetes-validations:
+ - message: RequestHeaderModifier filter cannot be repeated
+ rule: self.filter(f, f.type == 'RequestHeaderModifier').size()
+ <= 1
+ - message: ResponseHeaderModifier filter cannot be repeated
+ rule: self.filter(f, f.type == 'ResponseHeaderModifier').size()
+ <= 1
+ matches:
+ description: |-
+ Matches define conditions used for matching the rule against incoming
+ gRPC requests. Each match is independent, i.e. this rule will be matched
+ if **any** one of the matches is satisfied.
+
+
+ For example, take the following matches configuration:
+
+
+ ```
+ matches:
+ - method:
+ service: foo.bar
+ headers:
+ values:
+ version: 2
+ - method:
+ service: foo.bar.v2
+ ```
+
+
+ For a request to match against this rule, it MUST satisfy
+ EITHER of the two conditions:
+
+
+ - service of foo.bar AND contains the header `version: 2`
+ - service of foo.bar.v2
+
+
+ See the documentation for GRPCRouteMatch on how to specify multiple
+ match conditions to be ANDed together.
+
+
+ If no matches are specified, the implementation MUST match every gRPC request.
+
+
+ Proxy or Load Balancer routing configuration generated from GRPCRoutes
+ MUST prioritize rules based on the following criteria, continuing on
+ ties. Merging MUST not be done between GRPCRoutes and HTTPRoutes.
+ Precedence MUST be given to the rule with the largest number of:
+
+
+ * Characters in a matching non-wildcard hostname.
+ * Characters in a matching hostname.
+ * Characters in a matching service.
+ * Characters in a matching method.
+ * Header matches.
+
+
+ If ties still exist across multiple Routes, matching precedence MUST be
+ determined in order of the following criteria, continuing on ties:
+
+
+ * The oldest Route based on creation timestamp.
+ * The Route appearing first in alphabetical order by
+ "{namespace}/{name}".
+
+
+ If ties still exist within the Route that has been given precedence,
+ matching precedence MUST be granted to the first matching rule meeting
+ the above criteria.
+ items:
+ description: |-
+ GRPCRouteMatch defines the predicate used to match requests to a given
+ action. Multiple match types are ANDed together, i.e. the match will
+ evaluate to true only if all conditions are satisfied.
+
+
+ For example, the match below will match a gRPC request only if its service
+ is `foo` AND it contains the `version: v1` header:
+
+
+ ```
+ matches:
+ - method:
+ type: Exact
+ service: "foo"
+ headers:
+ - name: "version"
+ value "v1"
+
+
+ ```
+ properties:
+ headers:
+ description: |-
+ Headers specifies gRPC request header matchers. Multiple match values are
+ ANDed together, meaning, a request MUST match all the specified headers
+ to select the route.
+ items:
+ description: |-
+ GRPCHeaderMatch describes how to select a gRPC route by matching gRPC request
+ headers.
+ properties:
+ name:
+ description: |-
+ Name is the name of the gRPC Header to be matched.
+
+
+ If multiple entries specify equivalent header names, only the first
+ entry with an equivalent name MUST be considered for a match. Subsequent
+ entries with an equivalent header name MUST be ignored. Due to the
+ case-insensitivity of header names, "foo" and "Foo" are considered
+ equivalent.
+ maxLength: 256
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[A-Za-z0-9!#$%&'*+\-.^_\x60|~]+$
+ type: string
+ type:
+ default: Exact
+ description: Type specifies how to match against
+ the value of the header.
+ enum:
+ - Exact
+ - RegularExpression
+ type: string
+ value:
+ description: Value is the value of the gRPC Header
+ to be matched.
+ maxLength: 4096
+ minLength: 1
+ type: string
+ required:
+ - name
+ - value
+ type: object
+ maxItems: 16
+ type: array
+ x-kubernetes-list-map-keys:
+ - name
+ x-kubernetes-list-type: map
+ method:
+ description: |-
+ Method specifies a gRPC request service/method matcher. If this field is
+ not specified, all services and methods will match.
+ properties:
+ method:
+ description: |-
+ Value of the method to match against. If left empty or omitted, will
+ match all services.
+
+
+ At least one of Service and Method MUST be a non-empty string.
+ maxLength: 1024
+ type: string
+ service:
+ description: |-
+ Value of the service to match against. If left empty or omitted, will
+ match any service.
+
+
+ At least one of Service and Method MUST be a non-empty string.
+ maxLength: 1024
+ type: string
+ type:
+ default: Exact
+ description: |-
+ Type specifies how to match against the service and/or method.
+ Support: Core (Exact with service and method specified)
+
+
+ Support: Implementation-specific (Exact with method specified but no service specified)
+
+
+ Support: Implementation-specific (RegularExpression)
+ enum:
+ - Exact
+ - RegularExpression
+ type: string
+ type: object
+ x-kubernetes-validations:
+ - message: One or both of 'service' or 'method' must be
+ specified
+ rule: 'has(self.type) ? has(self.service) || has(self.method)
+ : true'
+ - message: service must only contain valid characters
+ (matching ^(?i)\.?[a-z_][a-z_0-9]*(\.[a-z_][a-z_0-9]*)*$)
+ rule: '(!has(self.type) || self.type == ''Exact'') &&
+ has(self.service) ? self.service.matches(r"""^(?i)\.?[a-z_][a-z_0-9]*(\.[a-z_][a-z_0-9]*)*$"""):
+ true'
+ - message: method must only contain valid characters (matching
+ ^[A-Za-z_][A-Za-z_0-9]*$)
+ rule: '(!has(self.type) || self.type == ''Exact'') &&
+ has(self.method) ? self.method.matches(r"""^[A-Za-z_][A-Za-z_0-9]*$"""):
+ true'
+ type: object
+ maxItems: 8
+ type: array
+ sessionPersistence:
+ description: |+
+ SessionPersistence defines and configures session persistence
+ for the route rule.
+
+
+ Support: Extended
+
+
+ properties:
+ absoluteTimeout:
+ description: |-
+ AbsoluteTimeout defines the absolute timeout of the persistent
+ session. Once the AbsoluteTimeout duration has elapsed, the
+ session becomes invalid.
+
+
+ Support: Extended
+ pattern: ^([0-9]{1,5}(h|m|s|ms)){1,4}$
+ type: string
+ cookieConfig:
+ description: |-
+ CookieConfig provides configuration settings that are specific
+ to cookie-based session persistence.
+
+
+ Support: Core
+ properties:
+ lifetimeType:
+ default: Session
+ description: |-
+ LifetimeType specifies whether the cookie has a permanent or
+ session-based lifetime. A permanent cookie persists until its
+ specified expiry time, defined by the Expires or Max-Age cookie
+ attributes, while a session cookie is deleted when the current
+ session ends.
+
+
+ When set to "Permanent", AbsoluteTimeout indicates the
+ cookie's lifetime via the Expires or Max-Age cookie attributes
+ and is required.
+
+
+ When set to "Session", AbsoluteTimeout indicates the
+ absolute lifetime of the cookie tracked by the gateway and
+ is optional.
+
+
+ Support: Core for "Session" type
+
+
+ Support: Extended for "Permanent" type
+ enum:
+ - Permanent
+ - Session
+ type: string
+ type: object
+ idleTimeout:
+ description: |-
+ IdleTimeout defines the idle timeout of the persistent session.
+ Once the session has been idle for more than the specified
+ IdleTimeout duration, the session becomes invalid.
+
+
+ Support: Extended
+ pattern: ^([0-9]{1,5}(h|m|s|ms)){1,4}$
+ type: string
+ sessionName:
+ description: |-
+ SessionName defines the name of the persistent session token
+ which may be reflected in the cookie or the header. Users
+ should avoid reusing session names to prevent unintended
+ consequences, such as rejection or unpredictable behavior.
+
+
+ Support: Implementation-specific
+ maxLength: 128
+ type: string
+ type:
+ default: Cookie
+ description: |-
+ Type defines the type of session persistence such as through
+ the use a header or cookie. Defaults to cookie based session
+ persistence.
+
+
+ Support: Core for "Cookie" type
+
+
+ Support: Extended for "Header" type
+ enum:
+ - Cookie
+ - Header
+ type: string
+ type: object
+ x-kubernetes-validations:
+ - message: AbsoluteTimeout must be specified when cookie lifetimeType
+ is Permanent
+ rule: '!has(self.cookieConfig.lifetimeType) || self.cookieConfig.lifetimeType
+ != ''Permanent'' || has(self.absoluteTimeout)'
+ type: object
+ maxItems: 16
+ type: array
+ type: object
+ status:
+ description: Status defines the current state of GRPCRoute.
+ properties:
+ parents:
+ description: |-
+ Parents is a list of parent resources (usually Gateways) that are
+ associated with the route, and the status of the route with respect to
+ each parent. When this route attaches to a parent, the controller that
+ manages the parent must add an entry to this list when the controller
+ first sees the route and should update the entry as appropriate when the
+ route or gateway is modified.
+
+
+ Note that parent references that cannot be resolved by an implementation
+ of this API will not be added to this list. Implementations of this API
+ can only populate Route status for the Gateways/parent resources they are
+ responsible for.
+
+
+ A maximum of 32 Gateways will be represented in this list. An empty list
+ means the route has not been attached to any Gateway.
+ items:
+ description: |-
+ RouteParentStatus describes the status of a route with respect to an
+ associated Parent.
+ properties:
+ conditions:
+ description: |-
+ Conditions describes the status of the route with respect to the Gateway.
+ Note that the route's availability is also subject to the Gateway's own
+ status conditions and listener status.
+
+
+ If the Route's ParentRef specifies an existing Gateway that supports
+ Routes of this kind AND that Gateway's controller has sufficient access,
+ then that Gateway's controller MUST set the "Accepted" condition on the
+ Route, to indicate whether the route has been accepted or rejected by the
+ Gateway, and why.
+
+
+ A Route MUST be considered "Accepted" if at least one of the Route's
+ rules is implemented by the Gateway.
+
+
+ There are a number of cases where the "Accepted" condition may not be set
+ due to lack of controller visibility, that includes when:
+
+
+ * The Route refers to a non-existent parent.
+ * The Route is of a type that the controller does not support.
+ * The Route is in a namespace the controller does not have access to.
+ items:
+ description: "Condition contains details for one aspect of
+ the current state of this API Resource.\n---\nThis struct
+ is intended for direct use as an array at the field path
+ .status.conditions. For example,\n\n\n\ttype FooStatus
+ struct{\n\t // Represents the observations of a foo's
+ current state.\n\t // Known .status.conditions.type are:
+ \"Available\", \"Progressing\", and \"Degraded\"\n\t //
+ +patchMergeKey=type\n\t // +patchStrategy=merge\n\t //
+ +listType=map\n\t // +listMapKey=type\n\t Conditions
+ []metav1.Condition `json:\"conditions,omitempty\" patchStrategy:\"merge\"
+ patchMergeKey:\"type\" protobuf:\"bytes,1,rep,name=conditions\"`\n\n\n\t
+ \ // other fields\n\t}"
+ properties:
+ lastTransitionTime:
+ description: |-
+ lastTransitionTime is the last time the condition transitioned from one status to another.
+ This should be when the underlying condition changed. If that is not known, then using the time when the API field changed is acceptable.
+ format: date-time
+ type: string
+ message:
+ description: |-
+ message is a human readable message indicating details about the transition.
+ This may be an empty string.
+ maxLength: 32768
+ type: string
+ observedGeneration:
+ description: |-
+ observedGeneration represents the .metadata.generation that the condition was set based upon.
+ For instance, if .metadata.generation is currently 12, but the .status.conditions[x].observedGeneration is 9, the condition is out of date
+ with respect to the current state of the instance.
+ format: int64
+ minimum: 0
+ type: integer
+ reason:
+ description: |-
+ reason contains a programmatic identifier indicating the reason for the condition's last transition.
+ Producers of specific condition types may define expected values and meanings for this field,
+ and whether the values are considered a guaranteed API.
+ The value should be a CamelCase string.
+ This field may not be empty.
+ maxLength: 1024
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[A-Za-z]([A-Za-z0-9_,:]*[A-Za-z0-9_])?$
+ type: string
+ status:
+ description: status of the condition, one of True, False,
+ Unknown.
+ enum:
+ - "True"
+ - "False"
+ - Unknown
+ type: string
+ type:
+ description: |-
+ type of condition in CamelCase or in foo.example.com/CamelCase.
+ ---
+ Many .condition.type values are consistent across resources like Available, but because arbitrary conditions can be
+ useful (see .node.status.conditions), the ability to deconflict is important.
+ The regex it matches is (dns1123SubdomainFmt/)?(qualifiedNameFmt)
+ maxLength: 316
+ pattern: ^([a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*/)?(([A-Za-z0-9][-A-Za-z0-9_.]*)?[A-Za-z0-9])$
+ type: string
+ required:
+ - lastTransitionTime
+ - message
+ - reason
+ - status
+ - type
+ type: object
+ maxItems: 8
+ minItems: 1
+ type: array
+ x-kubernetes-list-map-keys:
+ - type
+ x-kubernetes-list-type: map
+ controllerName:
+ description: |-
+ ControllerName is a domain/path string that indicates the name of the
+ controller that wrote this status. This corresponds with the
+ controllerName field on GatewayClass.
+
+
+ Example: "example.net/gateway-controller".
+
+
+ The format of this field is DOMAIN "/" PATH, where DOMAIN and PATH are
+ valid Kubernetes names
+ (https://kubernetes.io/docs/concepts/overview/working-with-objects/names/#names).
+
+
+ Controllers MUST populate this field when writing status. Controllers should ensure that
+ entries to status populated with their ControllerName are cleaned up when they are no
+ longer necessary.
+ maxLength: 253
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*\/[A-Za-z0-9\/\-._~%!$&'()*+,;=:]+$
+ type: string
+ parentRef:
+ description: |-
+ ParentRef corresponds with a ParentRef in the spec that this
+ RouteParentStatus struct describes the status of.
+ properties:
+ group:
+ default: gateway.networking.k8s.io
+ description: |-
+ Group is the group of the referent.
+ When unspecified, "gateway.networking.k8s.io" is inferred.
+ To set the core API group (such as for a "Service" kind referent),
+ Group must be explicitly set to "" (empty string).
+
+
+ Support: Core
+ maxLength: 253
+ pattern: ^$|^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$
+ type: string
+ kind:
+ default: Gateway
+ description: |-
+ Kind is kind of the referent.
+
+
+ There are two kinds of parent resources with "Core" support:
+
+
+ * Gateway (Gateway conformance profile)
+ * Service (Mesh conformance profile, ClusterIP Services only)
+
+
+ Support for other resources is Implementation-Specific.
+ maxLength: 63
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[a-zA-Z]([-a-zA-Z0-9]*[a-zA-Z0-9])?$
+ type: string
+ name:
+ description: |-
+ Name is the name of the referent.
+
+
+ Support: Core
+ maxLength: 253
+ minLength: 1
+ type: string
+ namespace:
+ description: |-
+ Namespace is the namespace of the referent. When unspecified, this refers
+ to the local namespace of the Route.
+
+
+ Note that there are specific rules for ParentRefs which cross namespace
+ boundaries. Cross-namespace references are only valid if they are explicitly
+ allowed by something in the namespace they are referring to. For example:
+ Gateway has the AllowedRoutes field, and ReferenceGrant provides a
+ generic way to enable any other kind of cross-namespace reference.
+
+
+
+ ParentRefs from a Route to a Service in the same namespace are "producer"
+ routes, which apply default routing rules to inbound connections from
+ any namespace to the Service.
+
+
+ ParentRefs from a Route to a Service in a different namespace are
+ "consumer" routes, and these routing rules are only applied to outbound
+ connections originating from the same namespace as the Route, for which
+ the intended destination of the connections are a Service targeted as a
+ ParentRef of the Route.
+
+
+
+ Support: Core
+ maxLength: 63
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?$
+ type: string
+ port:
+ description: |-
+ Port is the network port this Route targets. It can be interpreted
+ differently based on the type of parent resource.
+
+
+ When the parent resource is a Gateway, this targets all listeners
+ listening on the specified port that also support this kind of Route(and
+ select this Route). It's not recommended to set `Port` unless the
+ networking behaviors specified in a Route must apply to a specific port
+ as opposed to a listener(s) whose port(s) may be changed. When both Port
+ and SectionName are specified, the name and port of the selected listener
+ must match both specified values.
+
+
+
+ When the parent resource is a Service, this targets a specific port in the
+ Service spec. When both Port (experimental) and SectionName are specified,
+ the name and port of the selected port must match both specified values.
+
+
+
+ Implementations MAY choose to support other parent resources.
+ Implementations supporting other types of parent resources MUST clearly
+ document how/if Port is interpreted.
+
+
+ For the purpose of status, an attachment is considered successful as
+ long as the parent resource accepts it partially. For example, Gateway
+ listeners can restrict which Routes can attach to them by Route kind,
+ namespace, or hostname. If 1 of 2 Gateway listeners accept attachment
+ from the referencing Route, the Route MUST be considered successfully
+ attached. If no Gateway listeners accept attachment from this Route,
+ the Route MUST be considered detached from the Gateway.
+
+
+ Support: Extended
+ format: int32
+ maximum: 65535
+ minimum: 1
+ type: integer
+ sectionName:
+ description: |-
+ SectionName is the name of a section within the target resource. In the
+ following resources, SectionName is interpreted as the following:
+
+
+ * Gateway: Listener name. When both Port (experimental) and SectionName
+ are specified, the name and port of the selected listener must match
+ both specified values.
+ * Service: Port name. When both Port (experimental) and SectionName
+ are specified, the name and port of the selected listener must match
+ both specified values.
+
+
+ Implementations MAY choose to support attaching Routes to other resources.
+ If that is the case, they MUST clearly document how SectionName is
+ interpreted.
+
+
+ When unspecified (empty string), this will reference the entire resource.
+ For the purpose of status, an attachment is considered successful if at
+ least one section in the parent resource accepts it. For example, Gateway
+ listeners can restrict which Routes can attach to them by Route kind,
+ namespace, or hostname. If 1 of 2 Gateway listeners accept attachment from
+ the referencing Route, the Route MUST be considered successfully
+ attached. If no Gateway listeners accept attachment from this Route, the
+ Route MUST be considered detached from the Gateway.
+
+
+ Support: Core
+ maxLength: 253
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$
+ type: string
+ required:
+ - name
+ type: object
+ required:
+ - controllerName
+ - parentRef
+ type: object
+ maxItems: 32
+ type: array
+ required:
+ - parents
+ type: object
+ type: object
+ served: true
+ storage: false
+status:
+ acceptedNames:
+ kind: ""
+ plural: ""
+ conditions: null
+ storedVersions: null
+---
+#
+# config/crd/experimental/gateway.networking.k8s.io_httproutes.yaml
+#
+apiVersion: apiextensions.k8s.io/v1
+kind: CustomResourceDefinition
+metadata:
+ annotations:
+ api-approved.kubernetes.io: https://github.com/kubernetes-sigs/gateway-api/pull/2997
+ gateway.networking.k8s.io/bundle-version: v1.1.0
+ gateway.networking.k8s.io/channel: experimental
+ creationTimestamp: null
+ name: httproutes.gateway.networking.k8s.io
+spec:
+ group: gateway.networking.k8s.io
+ names:
+ categories:
+ - gateway-api
+ kind: HTTPRoute
+ listKind: HTTPRouteList
+ plural: httproutes
+ singular: httproute
+ scope: Namespaced
+ versions:
+ - additionalPrinterColumns:
+ - jsonPath: .spec.hostnames
+ name: Hostnames
+ type: string
+ - jsonPath: .metadata.creationTimestamp
+ name: Age
+ type: date
+ name: v1
+ schema:
+ openAPIV3Schema:
+ description: |-
+ HTTPRoute provides a way to route HTTP requests. This includes the capability
+ to match requests by hostname, path, header, or query param. Filters can be
+ used to specify additional processing steps. Backends specify where matching
+ requests should be routed.
+ properties:
+ apiVersion:
+ description: |-
+ APIVersion defines the versioned schema of this representation of an object.
+ Servers should convert recognized schemas to the latest internal value, and
+ may reject unrecognized values.
+ More info: https://git.k8s.io/community/contributors/devel/sig-architecture/api-conventions.md#resources
+ type: string
+ kind:
+ description: |-
+ Kind is a string value representing the REST resource this object represents.
+ Servers may infer this from the endpoint the client submits requests to.
+ Cannot be updated.
+ In CamelCase.
+ More info: https://git.k8s.io/community/contributors/devel/sig-architecture/api-conventions.md#types-kinds
+ type: string
+ metadata:
+ type: object
+ spec:
+ description: Spec defines the desired state of HTTPRoute.
+ properties:
+ hostnames:
+ description: |-
+ Hostnames defines a set of hostnames that should match against the HTTP Host
+ header to select a HTTPRoute used to process the request. Implementations
+ MUST ignore any port value specified in the HTTP Host header while
+ performing a match and (absent of any applicable header modification
+ configuration) MUST forward this header unmodified to the backend.
+
+
+ Valid values for Hostnames are determined by RFC 1123 definition of a
+ hostname with 2 notable exceptions:
+
+
+ 1. IPs are not allowed.
+ 2. A hostname may be prefixed with a wildcard label (`*.`). The wildcard
+ label must appear by itself as the first label.
+
+
+ If a hostname is specified by both the Listener and HTTPRoute, there
+ must be at least one intersecting hostname for the HTTPRoute to be
+ attached to the Listener. For example:
+
+
+ * A Listener with `test.example.com` as the hostname matches HTTPRoutes
+ that have either not specified any hostnames, or have specified at
+ least one of `test.example.com` or `*.example.com`.
+ * A Listener with `*.example.com` as the hostname matches HTTPRoutes
+ that have either not specified any hostnames or have specified at least
+ one hostname that matches the Listener hostname. For example,
+ `*.example.com`, `test.example.com`, and `foo.test.example.com` would
+ all match. On the other hand, `example.com` and `test.example.net` would
+ not match.
+
+
+ Hostnames that are prefixed with a wildcard label (`*.`) are interpreted
+ as a suffix match. That means that a match for `*.example.com` would match
+ both `test.example.com`, and `foo.test.example.com`, but not `example.com`.
+
+
+ If both the Listener and HTTPRoute have specified hostnames, any
+ HTTPRoute hostnames that do not match the Listener hostname MUST be
+ ignored. For example, if a Listener specified `*.example.com`, and the
+ HTTPRoute specified `test.example.com` and `test.example.net`,
+ `test.example.net` must not be considered for a match.
+
+
+ If both the Listener and HTTPRoute have specified hostnames, and none
+ match with the criteria above, then the HTTPRoute is not accepted. The
+ implementation must raise an 'Accepted' Condition with a status of
+ `False` in the corresponding RouteParentStatus.
+
+
+ In the event that multiple HTTPRoutes specify intersecting hostnames (e.g.
+ overlapping wildcard matching and exact matching hostnames), precedence must
+ be given to rules from the HTTPRoute with the largest number of:
+
+
+ * Characters in a matching non-wildcard hostname.
+ * Characters in a matching hostname.
+
+
+ If ties exist across multiple Routes, the matching precedence rules for
+ HTTPRouteMatches takes over.
+
+
+ Support: Core
+ items:
+ description: |-
+ Hostname is the fully qualified domain name of a network host. This matches
+ the RFC 1123 definition of a hostname with 2 notable exceptions:
+
+
+ 1. IPs are not allowed.
+ 2. A hostname may be prefixed with a wildcard label (`*.`). The wildcard
+ label must appear by itself as the first label.
+
+
+ Hostname can be "precise" which is a domain name without the terminating
+ dot of a network host (e.g. "foo.example.com") or "wildcard", which is a
+ domain name prefixed with a single wildcard label (e.g. `*.example.com`).
+
+
+ Note that as per RFC1035 and RFC1123, a *label* must consist of lower case
+ alphanumeric characters or '-', and must start and end with an alphanumeric
+ character. No other punctuation is allowed.
+ maxLength: 253
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^(\*\.)?[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$
+ type: string
+ maxItems: 16
+ type: array
+ parentRefs:
+ description: |+
+ ParentRefs references the resources (usually Gateways) that a Route wants
+ to be attached to. Note that the referenced parent resource needs to
+ allow this for the attachment to be complete. For Gateways, that means
+ the Gateway needs to allow attachment from Routes of this kind and
+ namespace. For Services, that means the Service must either be in the same
+ namespace for a "producer" route, or the mesh implementation must support
+ and allow "consumer" routes for the referenced Service. ReferenceGrant is
+ not applicable for governing ParentRefs to Services - it is not possible to
+ create a "producer" route for a Service in a different namespace from the
+ Route.
+
+
+ There are two kinds of parent resources with "Core" support:
+
+
+ * Gateway (Gateway conformance profile)
+ * Service (Mesh conformance profile, ClusterIP Services only)
+
+
+ This API may be extended in the future to support additional kinds of parent
+ resources.
+
+
+ ParentRefs must be _distinct_. This means either that:
+
+
+ * They select different objects. If this is the case, then parentRef
+ entries are distinct. In terms of fields, this means that the
+ multi-part key defined by `group`, `kind`, `namespace`, and `name` must
+ be unique across all parentRef entries in the Route.
+ * They do not select different objects, but for each optional field used,
+ each ParentRef that selects the same object must set the same set of
+ optional fields to different values. If one ParentRef sets a
+ combination of optional fields, all must set the same combination.
+
+
+ Some examples:
+
+
+ * If one ParentRef sets `sectionName`, all ParentRefs referencing the
+ same object must also set `sectionName`.
+ * If one ParentRef sets `port`, all ParentRefs referencing the same
+ object must also set `port`.
+ * If one ParentRef sets `sectionName` and `port`, all ParentRefs
+ referencing the same object must also set `sectionName` and `port`.
+
+
+ It is possible to separately reference multiple distinct objects that may
+ be collapsed by an implementation. For example, some implementations may
+ choose to merge compatible Gateway Listeners together. If that is the
+ case, the list of routes attached to those resources should also be
+ merged.
+
+
+ Note that for ParentRefs that cross namespace boundaries, there are specific
+ rules. Cross-namespace references are only valid if they are explicitly
+ allowed by something in the namespace they are referring to. For example,
+ Gateway has the AllowedRoutes field, and ReferenceGrant provides a
+ generic way to enable other kinds of cross-namespace reference.
+
+
+
+ ParentRefs from a Route to a Service in the same namespace are "producer"
+ routes, which apply default routing rules to inbound connections from
+ any namespace to the Service.
+
+
+ ParentRefs from a Route to a Service in a different namespace are
+ "consumer" routes, and these routing rules are only applied to outbound
+ connections originating from the same namespace as the Route, for which
+ the intended destination of the connections are a Service targeted as a
+ ParentRef of the Route.
+
+
+
+
+
+
+ items:
+ description: |-
+ ParentReference identifies an API object (usually a Gateway) that can be considered
+ a parent of this resource (usually a route). There are two kinds of parent resources
+ with "Core" support:
+
+
+ * Gateway (Gateway conformance profile)
+ * Service (Mesh conformance profile, ClusterIP Services only)
+
+
+ This API may be extended in the future to support additional kinds of parent
+ resources.
+
+
+ The API object must be valid in the cluster; the Group and Kind must
+ be registered in the cluster for this reference to be valid.
+ properties:
+ group:
+ default: gateway.networking.k8s.io
+ description: |-
+ Group is the group of the referent.
+ When unspecified, "gateway.networking.k8s.io" is inferred.
+ To set the core API group (such as for a "Service" kind referent),
+ Group must be explicitly set to "" (empty string).
+
+
+ Support: Core
+ maxLength: 253
+ pattern: ^$|^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$
+ type: string
+ kind:
+ default: Gateway
+ description: |-
+ Kind is kind of the referent.
+
+
+ There are two kinds of parent resources with "Core" support:
+
+
+ * Gateway (Gateway conformance profile)
+ * Service (Mesh conformance profile, ClusterIP Services only)
+
+
+ Support for other resources is Implementation-Specific.
+ maxLength: 63
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[a-zA-Z]([-a-zA-Z0-9]*[a-zA-Z0-9])?$
+ type: string
+ name:
+ description: |-
+ Name is the name of the referent.
+
+
+ Support: Core
+ maxLength: 253
+ minLength: 1
+ type: string
+ namespace:
+ description: |-
+ Namespace is the namespace of the referent. When unspecified, this refers
+ to the local namespace of the Route.
+
+
+ Note that there are specific rules for ParentRefs which cross namespace
+ boundaries. Cross-namespace references are only valid if they are explicitly
+ allowed by something in the namespace they are referring to. For example:
+ Gateway has the AllowedRoutes field, and ReferenceGrant provides a
+ generic way to enable any other kind of cross-namespace reference.
+
+
+
+ ParentRefs from a Route to a Service in the same namespace are "producer"
+ routes, which apply default routing rules to inbound connections from
+ any namespace to the Service.
+
+
+ ParentRefs from a Route to a Service in a different namespace are
+ "consumer" routes, and these routing rules are only applied to outbound
+ connections originating from the same namespace as the Route, for which
+ the intended destination of the connections are a Service targeted as a
+ ParentRef of the Route.
+
+
+
+ Support: Core
+ maxLength: 63
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?$
+ type: string
+ port:
+ description: |-
+ Port is the network port this Route targets. It can be interpreted
+ differently based on the type of parent resource.
+
+
+ When the parent resource is a Gateway, this targets all listeners
+ listening on the specified port that also support this kind of Route(and
+ select this Route). It's not recommended to set `Port` unless the
+ networking behaviors specified in a Route must apply to a specific port
+ as opposed to a listener(s) whose port(s) may be changed. When both Port
+ and SectionName are specified, the name and port of the selected listener
+ must match both specified values.
+
+
+
+ When the parent resource is a Service, this targets a specific port in the
+ Service spec. When both Port (experimental) and SectionName are specified,
+ the name and port of the selected port must match both specified values.
+
+
+
+ Implementations MAY choose to support other parent resources.
+ Implementations supporting other types of parent resources MUST clearly
+ document how/if Port is interpreted.
+
+
+ For the purpose of status, an attachment is considered successful as
+ long as the parent resource accepts it partially. For example, Gateway
+ listeners can restrict which Routes can attach to them by Route kind,
+ namespace, or hostname. If 1 of 2 Gateway listeners accept attachment
+ from the referencing Route, the Route MUST be considered successfully
+ attached. If no Gateway listeners accept attachment from this Route,
+ the Route MUST be considered detached from the Gateway.
+
+
+ Support: Extended
+ format: int32
+ maximum: 65535
+ minimum: 1
+ type: integer
+ sectionName:
+ description: |-
+ SectionName is the name of a section within the target resource. In the
+ following resources, SectionName is interpreted as the following:
+
+
+ * Gateway: Listener name. When both Port (experimental) and SectionName
+ are specified, the name and port of the selected listener must match
+ both specified values.
+ * Service: Port name. When both Port (experimental) and SectionName
+ are specified, the name and port of the selected listener must match
+ both specified values.
+
+
+ Implementations MAY choose to support attaching Routes to other resources.
+ If that is the case, they MUST clearly document how SectionName is
+ interpreted.
+
+
+ When unspecified (empty string), this will reference the entire resource.
+ For the purpose of status, an attachment is considered successful if at
+ least one section in the parent resource accepts it. For example, Gateway
+ listeners can restrict which Routes can attach to them by Route kind,
+ namespace, or hostname. If 1 of 2 Gateway listeners accept attachment from
+ the referencing Route, the Route MUST be considered successfully
+ attached. If no Gateway listeners accept attachment from this Route, the
+ Route MUST be considered detached from the Gateway.
+
+
+ Support: Core
+ maxLength: 253
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$
+ type: string
+ required:
+ - name
+ type: object
+ maxItems: 32
+ type: array
+ x-kubernetes-validations:
+ - message: sectionName or port must be specified when parentRefs includes
+ 2 or more references to the same parent
+ rule: 'self.all(p1, self.all(p2, p1.group == p2.group && p1.kind
+ == p2.kind && p1.name == p2.name && (((!has(p1.__namespace__)
+ || p1.__namespace__ == '''') && (!has(p2.__namespace__) || p2.__namespace__
+ == '''')) || (has(p1.__namespace__) && has(p2.__namespace__) &&
+ p1.__namespace__ == p2.__namespace__)) ? ((!has(p1.sectionName)
+ || p1.sectionName == '''') == (!has(p2.sectionName) || p2.sectionName
+ == '''') && (!has(p1.port) || p1.port == 0) == (!has(p2.port)
+ || p2.port == 0)): true))'
+ - message: sectionName or port must be unique when parentRefs includes
+ 2 or more references to the same parent
+ rule: self.all(p1, self.exists_one(p2, p1.group == p2.group && p1.kind
+ == p2.kind && p1.name == p2.name && (((!has(p1.__namespace__)
+ || p1.__namespace__ == '') && (!has(p2.__namespace__) || p2.__namespace__
+ == '')) || (has(p1.__namespace__) && has(p2.__namespace__) &&
+ p1.__namespace__ == p2.__namespace__ )) && (((!has(p1.sectionName)
+ || p1.sectionName == '') && (!has(p2.sectionName) || p2.sectionName
+ == '')) || ( has(p1.sectionName) && has(p2.sectionName) && p1.sectionName
+ == p2.sectionName)) && (((!has(p1.port) || p1.port == 0) && (!has(p2.port)
+ || p2.port == 0)) || (has(p1.port) && has(p2.port) && p1.port
+ == p2.port))))
+ rules:
+ default:
+ - matches:
+ - path:
+ type: PathPrefix
+ value: /
+ description: Rules are a list of HTTP matchers, filters and actions.
+ items:
+ description: |-
+ HTTPRouteRule defines semantics for matching an HTTP request based on
+ conditions (matches), processing it (filters), and forwarding the request to
+ an API object (backendRefs).
+ properties:
+ backendRefs:
+ description: |-
+ BackendRefs defines the backend(s) where matching requests should be
+ sent.
+
+
+ Failure behavior here depends on how many BackendRefs are specified and
+ how many are invalid.
+
+
+ If *all* entries in BackendRefs are invalid, and there are also no filters
+ specified in this route rule, *all* traffic which matches this rule MUST
+ receive a 500 status code.
+
+
+ See the HTTPBackendRef definition for the rules about what makes a single
+ HTTPBackendRef invalid.
+
+
+ When a HTTPBackendRef is invalid, 500 status codes MUST be returned for
+ requests that would have otherwise been routed to an invalid backend. If
+ multiple backends are specified, and some are invalid, the proportion of
+ requests that would otherwise have been routed to an invalid backend
+ MUST receive a 500 status code.
+
+
+ For example, if two backends are specified with equal weights, and one is
+ invalid, 50 percent of traffic must receive a 500. Implementations may
+ choose how that 50 percent is determined.
+
+
+ Support: Core for Kubernetes Service
+
+
+ Support: Extended for Kubernetes ServiceImport
+
+
+ Support: Implementation-specific for any other resource
+
+
+ Support for weight: Core
+ items:
+ description: |-
+ HTTPBackendRef defines how a HTTPRoute forwards a HTTP request.
+
+
+ Note that when a namespace different than the local namespace is specified, a
+ ReferenceGrant object is required in the referent namespace to allow that
+ namespace's owner to accept the reference. See the ReferenceGrant
+ documentation for details.
+
+
+
+
+
+ When the BackendRef points to a Kubernetes Service, implementations SHOULD
+ honor the appProtocol field if it is set for the target Service Port.
+
+
+ Implementations supporting appProtocol SHOULD recognize the Kubernetes
+ Standard Application Protocols defined in KEP-3726.
+
+
+ If a Service appProtocol isn't specified, an implementation MAY infer the
+ backend protocol through its own means. Implementations MAY infer the
+ protocol from the Route type referring to the backend Service.
+
+
+ If a Route is not able to send traffic to the backend using the specified
+ protocol then the backend is considered invalid. Implementations MUST set the
+ "ResolvedRefs" condition to "False" with the "UnsupportedProtocol" reason.
+
+
+
+ properties:
+ filters:
+ description: |-
+ Filters defined at this level should be executed if and only if the
+ request is being forwarded to the backend defined here.
+
+
+ Support: Implementation-specific (For broader support of filters, use the
+ Filters field in HTTPRouteRule.)
+ items:
+ description: |-
+ HTTPRouteFilter defines processing steps that must be completed during the
+ request or response lifecycle. HTTPRouteFilters are meant as an extension
+ point to express processing that may be done in Gateway implementations. Some
+ examples include request or response modification, implementing
+ authentication strategies, rate-limiting, and traffic shaping. API
+ guarantee/conformance is defined based on the type of the filter.
+ properties:
+ extensionRef:
+ description: |-
+ ExtensionRef is an optional, implementation-specific extension to the
+ "filter" behavior. For example, resource "myroutefilter" in group
+ "networking.example.net"). ExtensionRef MUST NOT be used for core and
+ extended filters.
+
+
+ This filter can be used multiple times within the same rule.
+
+
+ Support: Implementation-specific
+ properties:
+ group:
+ description: |-
+ Group is the group of the referent. For example, "gateway.networking.k8s.io".
+ When unspecified or empty string, core API group is inferred.
+ maxLength: 253
+ pattern: ^$|^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$
+ type: string
+ kind:
+ description: Kind is kind of the referent. For
+ example "HTTPRoute" or "Service".
+ maxLength: 63
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[a-zA-Z]([-a-zA-Z0-9]*[a-zA-Z0-9])?$
+ type: string
+ name:
+ description: Name is the name of the referent.
+ maxLength: 253
+ minLength: 1
+ type: string
+ required:
+ - group
+ - kind
+ - name
+ type: object
+ requestHeaderModifier:
+ description: |-
+ RequestHeaderModifier defines a schema for a filter that modifies request
+ headers.
+
+
+ Support: Core
+ properties:
+ add:
+ description: |-
+ Add adds the given header(s) (name, value) to the request
+ before the action. It appends to any existing values associated
+ with the header name.
+
+
+ Input:
+ GET /foo HTTP/1.1
+ my-header: foo
+
+
+ Config:
+ add:
+ - name: "my-header"
+ value: "bar,baz"
+
+
+ Output:
+ GET /foo HTTP/1.1
+ my-header: foo,bar,baz
+ items:
+ description: HTTPHeader represents an HTTP
+ Header name and value as defined by RFC
+ 7230.
+ properties:
+ name:
+ description: |-
+ Name is the name of the HTTP Header to be matched. Name matching MUST be
+ case insensitive. (See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc7230#section-3.2).
+
+
+ If multiple entries specify equivalent header names, the first entry with
+ an equivalent name MUST be considered for a match. Subsequent entries
+ with an equivalent header name MUST be ignored. Due to the
+ case-insensitivity of header names, "foo" and "Foo" are considered
+ equivalent.
+ maxLength: 256
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[A-Za-z0-9!#$%&'*+\-.^_\x60|~]+$
+ type: string
+ value:
+ description: Value is the value of HTTP
+ Header to be matched.
+ maxLength: 4096
+ minLength: 1
+ type: string
+ required:
+ - name
+ - value
+ type: object
+ maxItems: 16
+ type: array
+ x-kubernetes-list-map-keys:
+ - name
+ x-kubernetes-list-type: map
+ remove:
+ description: |-
+ Remove the given header(s) from the HTTP request before the action. The
+ value of Remove is a list of HTTP header names. Note that the header
+ names are case-insensitive (see
+ https://datatracker.ietf.org/doc/html/rfc2616#section-4.2).
+
+
+ Input:
+ GET /foo HTTP/1.1
+ my-header1: foo
+ my-header2: bar
+ my-header3: baz
+
+
+ Config:
+ remove: ["my-header1", "my-header3"]
+
+
+ Output:
+ GET /foo HTTP/1.1
+ my-header2: bar
+ items:
+ type: string
+ maxItems: 16
+ type: array
+ x-kubernetes-list-type: set
+ set:
+ description: |-
+ Set overwrites the request with the given header (name, value)
+ before the action.
+
+
+ Input:
+ GET /foo HTTP/1.1
+ my-header: foo
+
+
+ Config:
+ set:
+ - name: "my-header"
+ value: "bar"
+
+
+ Output:
+ GET /foo HTTP/1.1
+ my-header: bar
+ items:
+ description: HTTPHeader represents an HTTP
+ Header name and value as defined by RFC
+ 7230.
+ properties:
+ name:
+ description: |-
+ Name is the name of the HTTP Header to be matched. Name matching MUST be
+ case insensitive. (See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc7230#section-3.2).
+
+
+ If multiple entries specify equivalent header names, the first entry with
+ an equivalent name MUST be considered for a match. Subsequent entries
+ with an equivalent header name MUST be ignored. Due to the
+ case-insensitivity of header names, "foo" and "Foo" are considered
+ equivalent.
+ maxLength: 256
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[A-Za-z0-9!#$%&'*+\-.^_\x60|~]+$
+ type: string
+ value:
+ description: Value is the value of HTTP
+ Header to be matched.
+ maxLength: 4096
+ minLength: 1
+ type: string
+ required:
+ - name
+ - value
+ type: object
+ maxItems: 16
+ type: array
+ x-kubernetes-list-map-keys:
+ - name
+ x-kubernetes-list-type: map
+ type: object
+ requestMirror:
+ description: |-
+ RequestMirror defines a schema for a filter that mirrors requests.
+ Requests are sent to the specified destination, but responses from
+ that destination are ignored.
+
+
+ This filter can be used multiple times within the same rule. Note that
+ not all implementations will be able to support mirroring to multiple
+ backends.
+
+
+ Support: Extended
+ properties:
+ backendRef:
+ description: |-
+ BackendRef references a resource where mirrored requests are sent.
+
+
+ Mirrored requests must be sent only to a single destination endpoint
+ within this BackendRef, irrespective of how many endpoints are present
+ within this BackendRef.
+
+
+ If the referent cannot be found, this BackendRef is invalid and must be
+ dropped from the Gateway. The controller must ensure the "ResolvedRefs"
+ condition on the Route status is set to `status: False` and not configure
+ this backend in the underlying implementation.
+
+
+ If there is a cross-namespace reference to an *existing* object
+ that is not allowed by a ReferenceGrant, the controller must ensure the
+ "ResolvedRefs" condition on the Route is set to `status: False`,
+ with the "RefNotPermitted" reason and not configure this backend in the
+ underlying implementation.
+
+
+ In either error case, the Message of the `ResolvedRefs` Condition
+ should be used to provide more detail about the problem.
+
+
+ Support: Extended for Kubernetes Service
+
+
+ Support: Implementation-specific for any other resource
+ properties:
+ group:
+ default: ""
+ description: |-
+ Group is the group of the referent. For example, "gateway.networking.k8s.io".
+ When unspecified or empty string, core API group is inferred.
+ maxLength: 253
+ pattern: ^$|^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$
+ type: string
+ kind:
+ default: Service
+ description: |-
+ Kind is the Kubernetes resource kind of the referent. For example
+ "Service".
+
+
+ Defaults to "Service" when not specified.
+
+
+ ExternalName services can refer to CNAME DNS records that may live
+ outside of the cluster and as such are difficult to reason about in
+ terms of conformance. They also may not be safe to forward to (see
+ CVE-2021-25740 for more information). Implementations SHOULD NOT
+ support ExternalName Services.
+
+
+ Support: Core (Services with a type other than ExternalName)
+
+
+ Support: Implementation-specific (Services with type ExternalName)
+ maxLength: 63
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[a-zA-Z]([-a-zA-Z0-9]*[a-zA-Z0-9])?$
+ type: string
+ name:
+ description: Name is the name of the referent.
+ maxLength: 253
+ minLength: 1
+ type: string
+ namespace:
+ description: |-
+ Namespace is the namespace of the backend. When unspecified, the local
+ namespace is inferred.
+
+
+ Note that when a namespace different than the local namespace is specified,
+ a ReferenceGrant object is required in the referent namespace to allow that
+ namespace's owner to accept the reference. See the ReferenceGrant
+ documentation for details.
+
+
+ Support: Core
+ maxLength: 63
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?$
+ type: string
+ port:
+ description: |-
+ Port specifies the destination port number to use for this resource.
+ Port is required when the referent is a Kubernetes Service. In this
+ case, the port number is the service port number, not the target port.
+ For other resources, destination port might be derived from the referent
+ resource or this field.
+ format: int32
+ maximum: 65535
+ minimum: 1
+ type: integer
+ required:
+ - name
+ type: object
+ x-kubernetes-validations:
+ - message: Must have port for Service reference
+ rule: '(size(self.group) == 0 && self.kind
+ == ''Service'') ? has(self.port) : true'
+ required:
+ - backendRef
+ type: object
+ requestRedirect:
+ description: |-
+ RequestRedirect defines a schema for a filter that responds to the
+ request with an HTTP redirection.
+
+
+ Support: Core
+ properties:
+ hostname:
+ description: |-
+ Hostname is the hostname to be used in the value of the `Location`
+ header in the response.
+ When empty, the hostname in the `Host` header of the request is used.
+
+
+ Support: Core
+ maxLength: 253
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$
+ type: string
+ path:
+ description: |-
+ Path defines parameters used to modify the path of the incoming request.
+ The modified path is then used to construct the `Location` header. When
+ empty, the request path is used as-is.
+
+
+ Support: Extended
+ properties:
+ replaceFullPath:
+ description: |-
+ ReplaceFullPath specifies the value with which to replace the full path
+ of a request during a rewrite or redirect.
+ maxLength: 1024
+ type: string
+ replacePrefixMatch:
+ description: |-
+ ReplacePrefixMatch specifies the value with which to replace the prefix
+ match of a request during a rewrite or redirect. For example, a request
+ to "/foo/bar" with a prefix match of "/foo" and a ReplacePrefixMatch
+ of "/xyz" would be modified to "/xyz/bar".
+
+
+ Note that this matches the behavior of the PathPrefix match type. This
+ matches full path elements. A path element refers to the list of labels
+ in the path split by the `/` separator. When specified, a trailing `/` is
+ ignored. For example, the paths `/abc`, `/abc/`, and `/abc/def` would all
+ match the prefix `/abc`, but the path `/abcd` would not.
+
+
+ ReplacePrefixMatch is only compatible with a `PathPrefix` HTTPRouteMatch.
+ Using any other HTTPRouteMatch type on the same HTTPRouteRule will result in
+ the implementation setting the Accepted Condition for the Route to `status: False`.
+
+
+ Request Path | Prefix Match | Replace Prefix | Modified Path
+ -------------|--------------|----------------|----------
+ /foo/bar | /foo | /xyz | /xyz/bar
+ /foo/bar | /foo | /xyz/ | /xyz/bar
+ /foo/bar | /foo/ | /xyz | /xyz/bar
+ /foo/bar | /foo/ | /xyz/ | /xyz/bar
+ /foo | /foo | /xyz | /xyz
+ /foo/ | /foo | /xyz | /xyz/
+ /foo/bar | /foo | | /bar
+ /foo/ | /foo | | /
+ /foo | /foo | | /
+ /foo/ | /foo | / | /
+ /foo | /foo | / | /
+ maxLength: 1024
+ type: string
+ type:
+ description: |-
+ Type defines the type of path modifier. Additional types may be
+ added in a future release of the API.
+
+
+ Note that values may be added to this enum, implementations
+ must ensure that unknown values will not cause a crash.
+
+
+ Unknown values here must result in the implementation setting the
+ Accepted Condition for the Route to `status: False`, with a
+ Reason of `UnsupportedValue`.
+ enum:
+ - ReplaceFullPath
+ - ReplacePrefixMatch
+ type: string
+ required:
+ - type
+ type: object
+ x-kubernetes-validations:
+ - message: replaceFullPath must be specified
+ when type is set to 'ReplaceFullPath'
+ rule: 'self.type == ''ReplaceFullPath'' ?
+ has(self.replaceFullPath) : true'
+ - message: type must be 'ReplaceFullPath' when
+ replaceFullPath is set
+ rule: 'has(self.replaceFullPath) ? self.type
+ == ''ReplaceFullPath'' : true'
+ - message: replacePrefixMatch must be specified
+ when type is set to 'ReplacePrefixMatch'
+ rule: 'self.type == ''ReplacePrefixMatch''
+ ? has(self.replacePrefixMatch) : true'
+ - message: type must be 'ReplacePrefixMatch'
+ when replacePrefixMatch is set
+ rule: 'has(self.replacePrefixMatch) ? self.type
+ == ''ReplacePrefixMatch'' : true'
+ port:
+ description: |-
+ Port is the port to be used in the value of the `Location`
+ header in the response.
+
+
+ If no port is specified, the redirect port MUST be derived using the
+ following rules:
+
+
+ * If redirect scheme is not-empty, the redirect port MUST be the well-known
+ port associated with the redirect scheme. Specifically "http" to port 80
+ and "https" to port 443. If the redirect scheme does not have a
+ well-known port, the listener port of the Gateway SHOULD be used.
+ * If redirect scheme is empty, the redirect port MUST be the Gateway
+ Listener port.
+
+
+ Implementations SHOULD NOT add the port number in the 'Location'
+ header in the following cases:
+
+
+ * A Location header that will use HTTP (whether that is determined via
+ the Listener protocol or the Scheme field) _and_ use port 80.
+ * A Location header that will use HTTPS (whether that is determined via
+ the Listener protocol or the Scheme field) _and_ use port 443.
+
+
+ Support: Extended
+ format: int32
+ maximum: 65535
+ minimum: 1
+ type: integer
+ scheme:
+ description: |-
+ Scheme is the scheme to be used in the value of the `Location` header in
+ the response. When empty, the scheme of the request is used.
+
+
+ Scheme redirects can affect the port of the redirect, for more information,
+ refer to the documentation for the port field of this filter.
+
+
+ Note that values may be added to this enum, implementations
+ must ensure that unknown values will not cause a crash.
+
+
+ Unknown values here must result in the implementation setting the
+ Accepted Condition for the Route to `status: False`, with a
+ Reason of `UnsupportedValue`.
+
+
+ Support: Extended
+ enum:
+ - http
+ - https
+ type: string
+ statusCode:
+ default: 302
+ description: |-
+ StatusCode is the HTTP status code to be used in response.
+
+
+ Note that values may be added to this enum, implementations
+ must ensure that unknown values will not cause a crash.
+
+
+ Unknown values here must result in the implementation setting the
+ Accepted Condition for the Route to `status: False`, with a
+ Reason of `UnsupportedValue`.
+
+
+ Support: Core
+ enum:
+ - 301
+ - 302
+ type: integer
+ type: object
+ responseHeaderModifier:
+ description: |-
+ ResponseHeaderModifier defines a schema for a filter that modifies response
+ headers.
+
+
+ Support: Extended
+ properties:
+ add:
+ description: |-
+ Add adds the given header(s) (name, value) to the request
+ before the action. It appends to any existing values associated
+ with the header name.
+
+
+ Input:
+ GET /foo HTTP/1.1
+ my-header: foo
+
+
+ Config:
+ add:
+ - name: "my-header"
+ value: "bar,baz"
+
+
+ Output:
+ GET /foo HTTP/1.1
+ my-header: foo,bar,baz
+ items:
+ description: HTTPHeader represents an HTTP
+ Header name and value as defined by RFC
+ 7230.
+ properties:
+ name:
+ description: |-
+ Name is the name of the HTTP Header to be matched. Name matching MUST be
+ case insensitive. (See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc7230#section-3.2).
+
+
+ If multiple entries specify equivalent header names, the first entry with
+ an equivalent name MUST be considered for a match. Subsequent entries
+ with an equivalent header name MUST be ignored. Due to the
+ case-insensitivity of header names, "foo" and "Foo" are considered
+ equivalent.
+ maxLength: 256
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[A-Za-z0-9!#$%&'*+\-.^_\x60|~]+$
+ type: string
+ value:
+ description: Value is the value of HTTP
+ Header to be matched.
+ maxLength: 4096
+ minLength: 1
+ type: string
+ required:
+ - name
+ - value
+ type: object
+ maxItems: 16
+ type: array
+ x-kubernetes-list-map-keys:
+ - name
+ x-kubernetes-list-type: map
+ remove:
+ description: |-
+ Remove the given header(s) from the HTTP request before the action. The
+ value of Remove is a list of HTTP header names. Note that the header
+ names are case-insensitive (see
+ https://datatracker.ietf.org/doc/html/rfc2616#section-4.2).
+
+
+ Input:
+ GET /foo HTTP/1.1
+ my-header1: foo
+ my-header2: bar
+ my-header3: baz
+
+
+ Config:
+ remove: ["my-header1", "my-header3"]
+
+
+ Output:
+ GET /foo HTTP/1.1
+ my-header2: bar
+ items:
+ type: string
+ maxItems: 16
+ type: array
+ x-kubernetes-list-type: set
+ set:
+ description: |-
+ Set overwrites the request with the given header (name, value)
+ before the action.
+
+
+ Input:
+ GET /foo HTTP/1.1
+ my-header: foo
+
+
+ Config:
+ set:
+ - name: "my-header"
+ value: "bar"
+
+
+ Output:
+ GET /foo HTTP/1.1
+ my-header: bar
+ items:
+ description: HTTPHeader represents an HTTP
+ Header name and value as defined by RFC
+ 7230.
+ properties:
+ name:
+ description: |-
+ Name is the name of the HTTP Header to be matched. Name matching MUST be
+ case insensitive. (See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc7230#section-3.2).
+
+
+ If multiple entries specify equivalent header names, the first entry with
+ an equivalent name MUST be considered for a match. Subsequent entries
+ with an equivalent header name MUST be ignored. Due to the
+ case-insensitivity of header names, "foo" and "Foo" are considered
+ equivalent.
+ maxLength: 256
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[A-Za-z0-9!#$%&'*+\-.^_\x60|~]+$
+ type: string
+ value:
+ description: Value is the value of HTTP
+ Header to be matched.
+ maxLength: 4096
+ minLength: 1
+ type: string
+ required:
+ - name
+ - value
+ type: object
+ maxItems: 16
+ type: array
+ x-kubernetes-list-map-keys:
+ - name
+ x-kubernetes-list-type: map
+ type: object
+ type:
+ description: |-
+ Type identifies the type of filter to apply. As with other API fields,
+ types are classified into three conformance levels:
+
+
+ - Core: Filter types and their corresponding configuration defined by
+ "Support: Core" in this package, e.g. "RequestHeaderModifier". All
+ implementations must support core filters.
+
+
+ - Extended: Filter types and their corresponding configuration defined by
+ "Support: Extended" in this package, e.g. "RequestMirror". Implementers
+ are encouraged to support extended filters.
+
+
+ - Implementation-specific: Filters that are defined and supported by
+ specific vendors.
+ In the future, filters showing convergence in behavior across multiple
+ implementations will be considered for inclusion in extended or core
+ conformance levels. Filter-specific configuration for such filters
+ is specified using the ExtensionRef field. `Type` should be set to
+ "ExtensionRef" for custom filters.
+
+
+ Implementers are encouraged to define custom implementation types to
+ extend the core API with implementation-specific behavior.
+
+
+ If a reference to a custom filter type cannot be resolved, the filter
+ MUST NOT be skipped. Instead, requests that would have been processed by
+ that filter MUST receive a HTTP error response.
+
+
+ Note that values may be added to this enum, implementations
+ must ensure that unknown values will not cause a crash.
+
+
+ Unknown values here must result in the implementation setting the
+ Accepted Condition for the Route to `status: False`, with a
+ Reason of `UnsupportedValue`.
+ enum:
+ - RequestHeaderModifier
+ - ResponseHeaderModifier
+ - RequestMirror
+ - RequestRedirect
+ - URLRewrite
+ - ExtensionRef
+ type: string
+ urlRewrite:
+ description: |-
+ URLRewrite defines a schema for a filter that modifies a request during forwarding.
+
+
+ Support: Extended
+ properties:
+ hostname:
+ description: |-
+ Hostname is the value to be used to replace the Host header value during
+ forwarding.
+
+
+ Support: Extended
+ maxLength: 253
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$
+ type: string
+ path:
+ description: |-
+ Path defines a path rewrite.
+
+
+ Support: Extended
+ properties:
+ replaceFullPath:
+ description: |-
+ ReplaceFullPath specifies the value with which to replace the full path
+ of a request during a rewrite or redirect.
+ maxLength: 1024
+ type: string
+ replacePrefixMatch:
+ description: |-
+ ReplacePrefixMatch specifies the value with which to replace the prefix
+ match of a request during a rewrite or redirect. For example, a request
+ to "/foo/bar" with a prefix match of "/foo" and a ReplacePrefixMatch
+ of "/xyz" would be modified to "/xyz/bar".
+
+
+ Note that this matches the behavior of the PathPrefix match type. This
+ matches full path elements. A path element refers to the list of labels
+ in the path split by the `/` separator. When specified, a trailing `/` is
+ ignored. For example, the paths `/abc`, `/abc/`, and `/abc/def` would all
+ match the prefix `/abc`, but the path `/abcd` would not.
+
+
+ ReplacePrefixMatch is only compatible with a `PathPrefix` HTTPRouteMatch.
+ Using any other HTTPRouteMatch type on the same HTTPRouteRule will result in
+ the implementation setting the Accepted Condition for the Route to `status: False`.
+
+
+ Request Path | Prefix Match | Replace Prefix | Modified Path
+ -------------|--------------|----------------|----------
+ /foo/bar | /foo | /xyz | /xyz/bar
+ /foo/bar | /foo | /xyz/ | /xyz/bar
+ /foo/bar | /foo/ | /xyz | /xyz/bar
+ /foo/bar | /foo/ | /xyz/ | /xyz/bar
+ /foo | /foo | /xyz | /xyz
+ /foo/ | /foo | /xyz | /xyz/
+ /foo/bar | /foo | | /bar
+ /foo/ | /foo | | /
+ /foo | /foo | | /
+ /foo/ | /foo | / | /
+ /foo | /foo | / | /
+ maxLength: 1024
+ type: string
+ type:
+ description: |-
+ Type defines the type of path modifier. Additional types may be
+ added in a future release of the API.
+
+
+ Note that values may be added to this enum, implementations
+ must ensure that unknown values will not cause a crash.
+
+
+ Unknown values here must result in the implementation setting the
+ Accepted Condition for the Route to `status: False`, with a
+ Reason of `UnsupportedValue`.
+ enum:
+ - ReplaceFullPath
+ - ReplacePrefixMatch
+ type: string
+ required:
+ - type
+ type: object
+ x-kubernetes-validations:
+ - message: replaceFullPath must be specified
+ when type is set to 'ReplaceFullPath'
+ rule: 'self.type == ''ReplaceFullPath'' ?
+ has(self.replaceFullPath) : true'
+ - message: type must be 'ReplaceFullPath' when
+ replaceFullPath is set
+ rule: 'has(self.replaceFullPath) ? self.type
+ == ''ReplaceFullPath'' : true'
+ - message: replacePrefixMatch must be specified
+ when type is set to 'ReplacePrefixMatch'
+ rule: 'self.type == ''ReplacePrefixMatch''
+ ? has(self.replacePrefixMatch) : true'
+ - message: type must be 'ReplacePrefixMatch'
+ when replacePrefixMatch is set
+ rule: 'has(self.replacePrefixMatch) ? self.type
+ == ''ReplacePrefixMatch'' : true'
+ type: object
+ required:
+ - type
+ type: object
+ x-kubernetes-validations:
+ - message: filter.requestHeaderModifier must be nil
+ if the filter.type is not RequestHeaderModifier
+ rule: '!(has(self.requestHeaderModifier) && self.type
+ != ''RequestHeaderModifier'')'
+ - message: filter.requestHeaderModifier must be specified
+ for RequestHeaderModifier filter.type
+ rule: '!(!has(self.requestHeaderModifier) && self.type
+ == ''RequestHeaderModifier'')'
+ - message: filter.responseHeaderModifier must be nil
+ if the filter.type is not ResponseHeaderModifier
+ rule: '!(has(self.responseHeaderModifier) && self.type
+ != ''ResponseHeaderModifier'')'
+ - message: filter.responseHeaderModifier must be specified
+ for ResponseHeaderModifier filter.type
+ rule: '!(!has(self.responseHeaderModifier) && self.type
+ == ''ResponseHeaderModifier'')'
+ - message: filter.requestMirror must be nil if the filter.type
+ is not RequestMirror
+ rule: '!(has(self.requestMirror) && self.type != ''RequestMirror'')'
+ - message: filter.requestMirror must be specified for
+ RequestMirror filter.type
+ rule: '!(!has(self.requestMirror) && self.type ==
+ ''RequestMirror'')'
+ - message: filter.requestRedirect must be nil if the
+ filter.type is not RequestRedirect
+ rule: '!(has(self.requestRedirect) && self.type !=
+ ''RequestRedirect'')'
+ - message: filter.requestRedirect must be specified
+ for RequestRedirect filter.type
+ rule: '!(!has(self.requestRedirect) && self.type ==
+ ''RequestRedirect'')'
+ - message: filter.urlRewrite must be nil if the filter.type
+ is not URLRewrite
+ rule: '!(has(self.urlRewrite) && self.type != ''URLRewrite'')'
+ - message: filter.urlRewrite must be specified for URLRewrite
+ filter.type
+ rule: '!(!has(self.urlRewrite) && self.type == ''URLRewrite'')'
+ - message: filter.extensionRef must be nil if the filter.type
+ is not ExtensionRef
+ rule: '!(has(self.extensionRef) && self.type != ''ExtensionRef'')'
+ - message: filter.extensionRef must be specified for
+ ExtensionRef filter.type
+ rule: '!(!has(self.extensionRef) && self.type == ''ExtensionRef'')'
+ maxItems: 16
+ type: array
+ x-kubernetes-validations:
+ - message: May specify either httpRouteFilterRequestRedirect
+ or httpRouteFilterRequestRewrite, but not both
+ rule: '!(self.exists(f, f.type == ''RequestRedirect'')
+ && self.exists(f, f.type == ''URLRewrite''))'
+ - message: May specify either httpRouteFilterRequestRedirect
+ or httpRouteFilterRequestRewrite, but not both
+ rule: '!(self.exists(f, f.type == ''RequestRedirect'')
+ && self.exists(f, f.type == ''URLRewrite''))'
+ - message: RequestHeaderModifier filter cannot be repeated
+ rule: self.filter(f, f.type == 'RequestHeaderModifier').size()
+ <= 1
+ - message: ResponseHeaderModifier filter cannot be repeated
+ rule: self.filter(f, f.type == 'ResponseHeaderModifier').size()
+ <= 1
+ - message: RequestRedirect filter cannot be repeated
+ rule: self.filter(f, f.type == 'RequestRedirect').size()
+ <= 1
+ - message: URLRewrite filter cannot be repeated
+ rule: self.filter(f, f.type == 'URLRewrite').size()
+ <= 1
+ group:
+ default: ""
+ description: |-
+ Group is the group of the referent. For example, "gateway.networking.k8s.io".
+ When unspecified or empty string, core API group is inferred.
+ maxLength: 253
+ pattern: ^$|^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$
+ type: string
+ kind:
+ default: Service
+ description: |-
+ Kind is the Kubernetes resource kind of the referent. For example
+ "Service".
+
+
+ Defaults to "Service" when not specified.
+
+
+ ExternalName services can refer to CNAME DNS records that may live
+ outside of the cluster and as such are difficult to reason about in
+ terms of conformance. They also may not be safe to forward to (see
+ CVE-2021-25740 for more information). Implementations SHOULD NOT
+ support ExternalName Services.
+
+
+ Support: Core (Services with a type other than ExternalName)
+
+
+ Support: Implementation-specific (Services with type ExternalName)
+ maxLength: 63
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[a-zA-Z]([-a-zA-Z0-9]*[a-zA-Z0-9])?$
+ type: string
+ name:
+ description: Name is the name of the referent.
+ maxLength: 253
+ minLength: 1
+ type: string
+ namespace:
+ description: |-
+ Namespace is the namespace of the backend. When unspecified, the local
+ namespace is inferred.
+
+
+ Note that when a namespace different than the local namespace is specified,
+ a ReferenceGrant object is required in the referent namespace to allow that
+ namespace's owner to accept the reference. See the ReferenceGrant
+ documentation for details.
+
+
+ Support: Core
+ maxLength: 63
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?$
+ type: string
+ port:
+ description: |-
+ Port specifies the destination port number to use for this resource.
+ Port is required when the referent is a Kubernetes Service. In this
+ case, the port number is the service port number, not the target port.
+ For other resources, destination port might be derived from the referent
+ resource or this field.
+ format: int32
+ maximum: 65535
+ minimum: 1
+ type: integer
+ weight:
+ default: 1
+ description: |-
+ Weight specifies the proportion of requests forwarded to the referenced
+ backend. This is computed as weight/(sum of all weights in this
+ BackendRefs list). For non-zero values, there may be some epsilon from
+ the exact proportion defined here depending on the precision an
+ implementation supports. Weight is not a percentage and the sum of
+ weights does not need to equal 100.
+
+
+ If only one backend is specified and it has a weight greater than 0, 100%
+ of the traffic is forwarded to that backend. If weight is set to 0, no
+ traffic should be forwarded for this entry. If unspecified, weight
+ defaults to 1.
+
+
+ Support for this field varies based on the context where used.
+ format: int32
+ maximum: 1000000
+ minimum: 0
+ type: integer
+ required:
+ - name
+ type: object
+ x-kubernetes-validations:
+ - message: Must have port for Service reference
+ rule: '(size(self.group) == 0 && self.kind == ''Service'')
+ ? has(self.port) : true'
+ maxItems: 16
+ type: array
+ filters:
+ description: |-
+ Filters define the filters that are applied to requests that match
+ this rule.
+
+
+ Wherever possible, implementations SHOULD implement filters in the order
+ they are specified.
+
+
+ Implementations MAY choose to implement this ordering strictly, rejecting
+ any combination or order of filters that can not be supported. If implementations
+ choose a strict interpretation of filter ordering, they MUST clearly document
+ that behavior.
+
+
+ To reject an invalid combination or order of filters, implementations SHOULD
+ consider the Route Rules with this configuration invalid. If all Route Rules
+ in a Route are invalid, the entire Route would be considered invalid. If only
+ a portion of Route Rules are invalid, implementations MUST set the
+ "PartiallyInvalid" condition for the Route.
+
+
+ Conformance-levels at this level are defined based on the type of filter:
+
+
+ - ALL core filters MUST be supported by all implementations.
+ - Implementers are encouraged to support extended filters.
+ - Implementation-specific custom filters have no API guarantees across
+ implementations.
+
+
+ Specifying the same filter multiple times is not supported unless explicitly
+ indicated in the filter.
+
+
+ All filters are expected to be compatible with each other except for the
+ URLRewrite and RequestRedirect filters, which may not be combined. If an
+ implementation can not support other combinations of filters, they must clearly
+ document that limitation. In cases where incompatible or unsupported
+ filters are specified and cause the `Accepted` condition to be set to status
+ `False`, implementations may use the `IncompatibleFilters` reason to specify
+ this configuration error.
+
+
+ Support: Core
+ items:
+ description: |-
+ HTTPRouteFilter defines processing steps that must be completed during the
+ request or response lifecycle. HTTPRouteFilters are meant as an extension
+ point to express processing that may be done in Gateway implementations. Some
+ examples include request or response modification, implementing
+ authentication strategies, rate-limiting, and traffic shaping. API
+ guarantee/conformance is defined based on the type of the filter.
+ properties:
+ extensionRef:
+ description: |-
+ ExtensionRef is an optional, implementation-specific extension to the
+ "filter" behavior. For example, resource "myroutefilter" in group
+ "networking.example.net"). ExtensionRef MUST NOT be used for core and
+ extended filters.
+
+
+ This filter can be used multiple times within the same rule.
+
+
+ Support: Implementation-specific
+ properties:
+ group:
+ description: |-
+ Group is the group of the referent. For example, "gateway.networking.k8s.io".
+ When unspecified or empty string, core API group is inferred.
+ maxLength: 253
+ pattern: ^$|^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$
+ type: string
+ kind:
+ description: Kind is kind of the referent. For example
+ "HTTPRoute" or "Service".
+ maxLength: 63
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[a-zA-Z]([-a-zA-Z0-9]*[a-zA-Z0-9])?$
+ type: string
+ name:
+ description: Name is the name of the referent.
+ maxLength: 253
+ minLength: 1
+ type: string
+ required:
+ - group
+ - kind
+ - name
+ type: object
+ requestHeaderModifier:
+ description: |-
+ RequestHeaderModifier defines a schema for a filter that modifies request
+ headers.
+
+
+ Support: Core
+ properties:
+ add:
+ description: |-
+ Add adds the given header(s) (name, value) to the request
+ before the action. It appends to any existing values associated
+ with the header name.
+
+
+ Input:
+ GET /foo HTTP/1.1
+ my-header: foo
+
+
+ Config:
+ add:
+ - name: "my-header"
+ value: "bar,baz"
+
+
+ Output:
+ GET /foo HTTP/1.1
+ my-header: foo,bar,baz
+ items:
+ description: HTTPHeader represents an HTTP Header
+ name and value as defined by RFC 7230.
+ properties:
+ name:
+ description: |-
+ Name is the name of the HTTP Header to be matched. Name matching MUST be
+ case insensitive. (See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc7230#section-3.2).
+
+
+ If multiple entries specify equivalent header names, the first entry with
+ an equivalent name MUST be considered for a match. Subsequent entries
+ with an equivalent header name MUST be ignored. Due to the
+ case-insensitivity of header names, "foo" and "Foo" are considered
+ equivalent.
+ maxLength: 256
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[A-Za-z0-9!#$%&'*+\-.^_\x60|~]+$
+ type: string
+ value:
+ description: Value is the value of HTTP Header
+ to be matched.
+ maxLength: 4096
+ minLength: 1
+ type: string
+ required:
+ - name
+ - value
+ type: object
+ maxItems: 16
+ type: array
+ x-kubernetes-list-map-keys:
+ - name
+ x-kubernetes-list-type: map
+ remove:
+ description: |-
+ Remove the given header(s) from the HTTP request before the action. The
+ value of Remove is a list of HTTP header names. Note that the header
+ names are case-insensitive (see
+ https://datatracker.ietf.org/doc/html/rfc2616#section-4.2).
+
+
+ Input:
+ GET /foo HTTP/1.1
+ my-header1: foo
+ my-header2: bar
+ my-header3: baz
+
+
+ Config:
+ remove: ["my-header1", "my-header3"]
+
+
+ Output:
+ GET /foo HTTP/1.1
+ my-header2: bar
+ items:
+ type: string
+ maxItems: 16
+ type: array
+ x-kubernetes-list-type: set
+ set:
+ description: |-
+ Set overwrites the request with the given header (name, value)
+ before the action.
+
+
+ Input:
+ GET /foo HTTP/1.1
+ my-header: foo
+
+
+ Config:
+ set:
+ - name: "my-header"
+ value: "bar"
+
+
+ Output:
+ GET /foo HTTP/1.1
+ my-header: bar
+ items:
+ description: HTTPHeader represents an HTTP Header
+ name and value as defined by RFC 7230.
+ properties:
+ name:
+ description: |-
+ Name is the name of the HTTP Header to be matched. Name matching MUST be
+ case insensitive. (See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc7230#section-3.2).
+
+
+ If multiple entries specify equivalent header names, the first entry with
+ an equivalent name MUST be considered for a match. Subsequent entries
+ with an equivalent header name MUST be ignored. Due to the
+ case-insensitivity of header names, "foo" and "Foo" are considered
+ equivalent.
+ maxLength: 256
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[A-Za-z0-9!#$%&'*+\-.^_\x60|~]+$
+ type: string
+ value:
+ description: Value is the value of HTTP Header
+ to be matched.
+ maxLength: 4096
+ minLength: 1
+ type: string
+ required:
+ - name
+ - value
+ type: object
+ maxItems: 16
+ type: array
+ x-kubernetes-list-map-keys:
+ - name
+ x-kubernetes-list-type: map
+ type: object
+ requestMirror:
+ description: |-
+ RequestMirror defines a schema for a filter that mirrors requests.
+ Requests are sent to the specified destination, but responses from
+ that destination are ignored.
+
+
+ This filter can be used multiple times within the same rule. Note that
+ not all implementations will be able to support mirroring to multiple
+ backends.
+
+
+ Support: Extended
+ properties:
+ backendRef:
+ description: |-
+ BackendRef references a resource where mirrored requests are sent.
+
+
+ Mirrored requests must be sent only to a single destination endpoint
+ within this BackendRef, irrespective of how many endpoints are present
+ within this BackendRef.
+
+
+ If the referent cannot be found, this BackendRef is invalid and must be
+ dropped from the Gateway. The controller must ensure the "ResolvedRefs"
+ condition on the Route status is set to `status: False` and not configure
+ this backend in the underlying implementation.
+
+
+ If there is a cross-namespace reference to an *existing* object
+ that is not allowed by a ReferenceGrant, the controller must ensure the
+ "ResolvedRefs" condition on the Route is set to `status: False`,
+ with the "RefNotPermitted" reason and not configure this backend in the
+ underlying implementation.
+
+
+ In either error case, the Message of the `ResolvedRefs` Condition
+ should be used to provide more detail about the problem.
+
+
+ Support: Extended for Kubernetes Service
+
+
+ Support: Implementation-specific for any other resource
+ properties:
+ group:
+ default: ""
+ description: |-
+ Group is the group of the referent. For example, "gateway.networking.k8s.io".
+ When unspecified or empty string, core API group is inferred.
+ maxLength: 253
+ pattern: ^$|^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$
+ type: string
+ kind:
+ default: Service
+ description: |-
+ Kind is the Kubernetes resource kind of the referent. For example
+ "Service".
+
+
+ Defaults to "Service" when not specified.
+
+
+ ExternalName services can refer to CNAME DNS records that may live
+ outside of the cluster and as such are difficult to reason about in
+ terms of conformance. They also may not be safe to forward to (see
+ CVE-2021-25740 for more information). Implementations SHOULD NOT
+ support ExternalName Services.
+
+
+ Support: Core (Services with a type other than ExternalName)
+
+
+ Support: Implementation-specific (Services with type ExternalName)
+ maxLength: 63
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[a-zA-Z]([-a-zA-Z0-9]*[a-zA-Z0-9])?$
+ type: string
+ name:
+ description: Name is the name of the referent.
+ maxLength: 253
+ minLength: 1
+ type: string
+ namespace:
+ description: |-
+ Namespace is the namespace of the backend. When unspecified, the local
+ namespace is inferred.
+
+
+ Note that when a namespace different than the local namespace is specified,
+ a ReferenceGrant object is required in the referent namespace to allow that
+ namespace's owner to accept the reference. See the ReferenceGrant
+ documentation for details.
+
+
+ Support: Core
+ maxLength: 63
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?$
+ type: string
+ port:
+ description: |-
+ Port specifies the destination port number to use for this resource.
+ Port is required when the referent is a Kubernetes Service. In this
+ case, the port number is the service port number, not the target port.
+ For other resources, destination port might be derived from the referent
+ resource or this field.
+ format: int32
+ maximum: 65535
+ minimum: 1
+ type: integer
+ required:
+ - name
+ type: object
+ x-kubernetes-validations:
+ - message: Must have port for Service reference
+ rule: '(size(self.group) == 0 && self.kind == ''Service'')
+ ? has(self.port) : true'
+ required:
+ - backendRef
+ type: object
+ requestRedirect:
+ description: |-
+ RequestRedirect defines a schema for a filter that responds to the
+ request with an HTTP redirection.
+
+
+ Support: Core
+ properties:
+ hostname:
+ description: |-
+ Hostname is the hostname to be used in the value of the `Location`
+ header in the response.
+ When empty, the hostname in the `Host` header of the request is used.
+
+
+ Support: Core
+ maxLength: 253
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$
+ type: string
+ path:
+ description: |-
+ Path defines parameters used to modify the path of the incoming request.
+ The modified path is then used to construct the `Location` header. When
+ empty, the request path is used as-is.
+
+
+ Support: Extended
+ properties:
+ replaceFullPath:
+ description: |-
+ ReplaceFullPath specifies the value with which to replace the full path
+ of a request during a rewrite or redirect.
+ maxLength: 1024
+ type: string
+ replacePrefixMatch:
+ description: |-
+ ReplacePrefixMatch specifies the value with which to replace the prefix
+ match of a request during a rewrite or redirect. For example, a request
+ to "/foo/bar" with a prefix match of "/foo" and a ReplacePrefixMatch
+ of "/xyz" would be modified to "/xyz/bar".
+
+
+ Note that this matches the behavior of the PathPrefix match type. This
+ matches full path elements. A path element refers to the list of labels
+ in the path split by the `/` separator. When specified, a trailing `/` is
+ ignored. For example, the paths `/abc`, `/abc/`, and `/abc/def` would all
+ match the prefix `/abc`, but the path `/abcd` would not.
+
+
+ ReplacePrefixMatch is only compatible with a `PathPrefix` HTTPRouteMatch.
+ Using any other HTTPRouteMatch type on the same HTTPRouteRule will result in
+ the implementation setting the Accepted Condition for the Route to `status: False`.
+
+
+ Request Path | Prefix Match | Replace Prefix | Modified Path
+ -------------|--------------|----------------|----------
+ /foo/bar | /foo | /xyz | /xyz/bar
+ /foo/bar | /foo | /xyz/ | /xyz/bar
+ /foo/bar | /foo/ | /xyz | /xyz/bar
+ /foo/bar | /foo/ | /xyz/ | /xyz/bar
+ /foo | /foo | /xyz | /xyz
+ /foo/ | /foo | /xyz | /xyz/
+ /foo/bar | /foo | | /bar
+ /foo/ | /foo | | /
+ /foo | /foo | | /
+ /foo/ | /foo | / | /
+ /foo | /foo | / | /
+ maxLength: 1024
+ type: string
+ type:
+ description: |-
+ Type defines the type of path modifier. Additional types may be
+ added in a future release of the API.
+
+
+ Note that values may be added to this enum, implementations
+ must ensure that unknown values will not cause a crash.
+
+
+ Unknown values here must result in the implementation setting the
+ Accepted Condition for the Route to `status: False`, with a
+ Reason of `UnsupportedValue`.
+ enum:
+ - ReplaceFullPath
+ - ReplacePrefixMatch
+ type: string
+ required:
+ - type
+ type: object
+ x-kubernetes-validations:
+ - message: replaceFullPath must be specified when
+ type is set to 'ReplaceFullPath'
+ rule: 'self.type == ''ReplaceFullPath'' ? has(self.replaceFullPath)
+ : true'
+ - message: type must be 'ReplaceFullPath' when replaceFullPath
+ is set
+ rule: 'has(self.replaceFullPath) ? self.type ==
+ ''ReplaceFullPath'' : true'
+ - message: replacePrefixMatch must be specified when
+ type is set to 'ReplacePrefixMatch'
+ rule: 'self.type == ''ReplacePrefixMatch'' ? has(self.replacePrefixMatch)
+ : true'
+ - message: type must be 'ReplacePrefixMatch' when
+ replacePrefixMatch is set
+ rule: 'has(self.replacePrefixMatch) ? self.type
+ == ''ReplacePrefixMatch'' : true'
+ port:
+ description: |-
+ Port is the port to be used in the value of the `Location`
+ header in the response.
+
+
+ If no port is specified, the redirect port MUST be derived using the
+ following rules:
+
+
+ * If redirect scheme is not-empty, the redirect port MUST be the well-known
+ port associated with the redirect scheme. Specifically "http" to port 80
+ and "https" to port 443. If the redirect scheme does not have a
+ well-known port, the listener port of the Gateway SHOULD be used.
+ * If redirect scheme is empty, the redirect port MUST be the Gateway
+ Listener port.
+
+
+ Implementations SHOULD NOT add the port number in the 'Location'
+ header in the following cases:
+
+
+ * A Location header that will use HTTP (whether that is determined via
+ the Listener protocol or the Scheme field) _and_ use port 80.
+ * A Location header that will use HTTPS (whether that is determined via
+ the Listener protocol or the Scheme field) _and_ use port 443.
+
+
+ Support: Extended
+ format: int32
+ maximum: 65535
+ minimum: 1
+ type: integer
+ scheme:
+ description: |-
+ Scheme is the scheme to be used in the value of the `Location` header in
+ the response. When empty, the scheme of the request is used.
+
+
+ Scheme redirects can affect the port of the redirect, for more information,
+ refer to the documentation for the port field of this filter.
+
+
+ Note that values may be added to this enum, implementations
+ must ensure that unknown values will not cause a crash.
+
+
+ Unknown values here must result in the implementation setting the
+ Accepted Condition for the Route to `status: False`, with a
+ Reason of `UnsupportedValue`.
+
+
+ Support: Extended
+ enum:
+ - http
+ - https
+ type: string
+ statusCode:
+ default: 302
+ description: |-
+ StatusCode is the HTTP status code to be used in response.
+
+
+ Note that values may be added to this enum, implementations
+ must ensure that unknown values will not cause a crash.
+
+
+ Unknown values here must result in the implementation setting the
+ Accepted Condition for the Route to `status: False`, with a
+ Reason of `UnsupportedValue`.
+
+
+ Support: Core
+ enum:
+ - 301
+ - 302
+ type: integer
+ type: object
+ responseHeaderModifier:
+ description: |-
+ ResponseHeaderModifier defines a schema for a filter that modifies response
+ headers.
+
+
+ Support: Extended
+ properties:
+ add:
+ description: |-
+ Add adds the given header(s) (name, value) to the request
+ before the action. It appends to any existing values associated
+ with the header name.
+
+
+ Input:
+ GET /foo HTTP/1.1
+ my-header: foo
+
+
+ Config:
+ add:
+ - name: "my-header"
+ value: "bar,baz"
+
+
+ Output:
+ GET /foo HTTP/1.1
+ my-header: foo,bar,baz
+ items:
+ description: HTTPHeader represents an HTTP Header
+ name and value as defined by RFC 7230.
+ properties:
+ name:
+ description: |-
+ Name is the name of the HTTP Header to be matched. Name matching MUST be
+ case insensitive. (See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc7230#section-3.2).
+
+
+ If multiple entries specify equivalent header names, the first entry with
+ an equivalent name MUST be considered for a match. Subsequent entries
+ with an equivalent header name MUST be ignored. Due to the
+ case-insensitivity of header names, "foo" and "Foo" are considered
+ equivalent.
+ maxLength: 256
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[A-Za-z0-9!#$%&'*+\-.^_\x60|~]+$
+ type: string
+ value:
+ description: Value is the value of HTTP Header
+ to be matched.
+ maxLength: 4096
+ minLength: 1
+ type: string
+ required:
+ - name
+ - value
+ type: object
+ maxItems: 16
+ type: array
+ x-kubernetes-list-map-keys:
+ - name
+ x-kubernetes-list-type: map
+ remove:
+ description: |-
+ Remove the given header(s) from the HTTP request before the action. The
+ value of Remove is a list of HTTP header names. Note that the header
+ names are case-insensitive (see
+ https://datatracker.ietf.org/doc/html/rfc2616#section-4.2).
+
+
+ Input:
+ GET /foo HTTP/1.1
+ my-header1: foo
+ my-header2: bar
+ my-header3: baz
+
+
+ Config:
+ remove: ["my-header1", "my-header3"]
+
+
+ Output:
+ GET /foo HTTP/1.1
+ my-header2: bar
+ items:
+ type: string
+ maxItems: 16
+ type: array
+ x-kubernetes-list-type: set
+ set:
+ description: |-
+ Set overwrites the request with the given header (name, value)
+ before the action.
+
+
+ Input:
+ GET /foo HTTP/1.1
+ my-header: foo
+
+
+ Config:
+ set:
+ - name: "my-header"
+ value: "bar"
+
+
+ Output:
+ GET /foo HTTP/1.1
+ my-header: bar
+ items:
+ description: HTTPHeader represents an HTTP Header
+ name and value as defined by RFC 7230.
+ properties:
+ name:
+ description: |-
+ Name is the name of the HTTP Header to be matched. Name matching MUST be
+ case insensitive. (See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc7230#section-3.2).
+
+
+ If multiple entries specify equivalent header names, the first entry with
+ an equivalent name MUST be considered for a match. Subsequent entries
+ with an equivalent header name MUST be ignored. Due to the
+ case-insensitivity of header names, "foo" and "Foo" are considered
+ equivalent.
+ maxLength: 256
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[A-Za-z0-9!#$%&'*+\-.^_\x60|~]+$
+ type: string
+ value:
+ description: Value is the value of HTTP Header
+ to be matched.
+ maxLength: 4096
+ minLength: 1
+ type: string
+ required:
+ - name
+ - value
+ type: object
+ maxItems: 16
+ type: array
+ x-kubernetes-list-map-keys:
+ - name
+ x-kubernetes-list-type: map
+ type: object
+ type:
+ description: |-
+ Type identifies the type of filter to apply. As with other API fields,
+ types are classified into three conformance levels:
+
+
+ - Core: Filter types and their corresponding configuration defined by
+ "Support: Core" in this package, e.g. "RequestHeaderModifier". All
+ implementations must support core filters.
+
+
+ - Extended: Filter types and their corresponding configuration defined by
+ "Support: Extended" in this package, e.g. "RequestMirror". Implementers
+ are encouraged to support extended filters.
+
+
+ - Implementation-specific: Filters that are defined and supported by
+ specific vendors.
+ In the future, filters showing convergence in behavior across multiple
+ implementations will be considered for inclusion in extended or core
+ conformance levels. Filter-specific configuration for such filters
+ is specified using the ExtensionRef field. `Type` should be set to
+ "ExtensionRef" for custom filters.
+
+
+ Implementers are encouraged to define custom implementation types to
+ extend the core API with implementation-specific behavior.
+
+
+ If a reference to a custom filter type cannot be resolved, the filter
+ MUST NOT be skipped. Instead, requests that would have been processed by
+ that filter MUST receive a HTTP error response.
+
+
+ Note that values may be added to this enum, implementations
+ must ensure that unknown values will not cause a crash.
+
+
+ Unknown values here must result in the implementation setting the
+ Accepted Condition for the Route to `status: False`, with a
+ Reason of `UnsupportedValue`.
+ enum:
+ - RequestHeaderModifier
+ - ResponseHeaderModifier
+ - RequestMirror
+ - RequestRedirect
+ - URLRewrite
+ - ExtensionRef
+ type: string
+ urlRewrite:
+ description: |-
+ URLRewrite defines a schema for a filter that modifies a request during forwarding.
+
+
+ Support: Extended
+ properties:
+ hostname:
+ description: |-
+ Hostname is the value to be used to replace the Host header value during
+ forwarding.
+
+
+ Support: Extended
+ maxLength: 253
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$
+ type: string
+ path:
+ description: |-
+ Path defines a path rewrite.
+
+
+ Support: Extended
+ properties:
+ replaceFullPath:
+ description: |-
+ ReplaceFullPath specifies the value with which to replace the full path
+ of a request during a rewrite or redirect.
+ maxLength: 1024
+ type: string
+ replacePrefixMatch:
+ description: |-
+ ReplacePrefixMatch specifies the value with which to replace the prefix
+ match of a request during a rewrite or redirect. For example, a request
+ to "/foo/bar" with a prefix match of "/foo" and a ReplacePrefixMatch
+ of "/xyz" would be modified to "/xyz/bar".
+
+
+ Note that this matches the behavior of the PathPrefix match type. This
+ matches full path elements. A path element refers to the list of labels
+ in the path split by the `/` separator. When specified, a trailing `/` is
+ ignored. For example, the paths `/abc`, `/abc/`, and `/abc/def` would all
+ match the prefix `/abc`, but the path `/abcd` would not.
+
+
+ ReplacePrefixMatch is only compatible with a `PathPrefix` HTTPRouteMatch.
+ Using any other HTTPRouteMatch type on the same HTTPRouteRule will result in
+ the implementation setting the Accepted Condition for the Route to `status: False`.
+
+
+ Request Path | Prefix Match | Replace Prefix | Modified Path
+ -------------|--------------|----------------|----------
+ /foo/bar | /foo | /xyz | /xyz/bar
+ /foo/bar | /foo | /xyz/ | /xyz/bar
+ /foo/bar | /foo/ | /xyz | /xyz/bar
+ /foo/bar | /foo/ | /xyz/ | /xyz/bar
+ /foo | /foo | /xyz | /xyz
+ /foo/ | /foo | /xyz | /xyz/
+ /foo/bar | /foo | | /bar
+ /foo/ | /foo | | /
+ /foo | /foo | | /
+ /foo/ | /foo | / | /
+ /foo | /foo | / | /
+ maxLength: 1024
+ type: string
+ type:
+ description: |-
+ Type defines the type of path modifier. Additional types may be
+ added in a future release of the API.
+
+
+ Note that values may be added to this enum, implementations
+ must ensure that unknown values will not cause a crash.
+
+
+ Unknown values here must result in the implementation setting the
+ Accepted Condition for the Route to `status: False`, with a
+ Reason of `UnsupportedValue`.
+ enum:
+ - ReplaceFullPath
+ - ReplacePrefixMatch
+ type: string
+ required:
+ - type
+ type: object
+ x-kubernetes-validations:
+ - message: replaceFullPath must be specified when
+ type is set to 'ReplaceFullPath'
+ rule: 'self.type == ''ReplaceFullPath'' ? has(self.replaceFullPath)
+ : true'
+ - message: type must be 'ReplaceFullPath' when replaceFullPath
+ is set
+ rule: 'has(self.replaceFullPath) ? self.type ==
+ ''ReplaceFullPath'' : true'
+ - message: replacePrefixMatch must be specified when
+ type is set to 'ReplacePrefixMatch'
+ rule: 'self.type == ''ReplacePrefixMatch'' ? has(self.replacePrefixMatch)
+ : true'
+ - message: type must be 'ReplacePrefixMatch' when
+ replacePrefixMatch is set
+ rule: 'has(self.replacePrefixMatch) ? self.type
+ == ''ReplacePrefixMatch'' : true'
+ type: object
+ required:
+ - type
+ type: object
+ x-kubernetes-validations:
+ - message: filter.requestHeaderModifier must be nil if the
+ filter.type is not RequestHeaderModifier
+ rule: '!(has(self.requestHeaderModifier) && self.type !=
+ ''RequestHeaderModifier'')'
+ - message: filter.requestHeaderModifier must be specified
+ for RequestHeaderModifier filter.type
+ rule: '!(!has(self.requestHeaderModifier) && self.type ==
+ ''RequestHeaderModifier'')'
+ - message: filter.responseHeaderModifier must be nil if the
+ filter.type is not ResponseHeaderModifier
+ rule: '!(has(self.responseHeaderModifier) && self.type !=
+ ''ResponseHeaderModifier'')'
+ - message: filter.responseHeaderModifier must be specified
+ for ResponseHeaderModifier filter.type
+ rule: '!(!has(self.responseHeaderModifier) && self.type
+ == ''ResponseHeaderModifier'')'
+ - message: filter.requestMirror must be nil if the filter.type
+ is not RequestMirror
+ rule: '!(has(self.requestMirror) && self.type != ''RequestMirror'')'
+ - message: filter.requestMirror must be specified for RequestMirror
+ filter.type
+ rule: '!(!has(self.requestMirror) && self.type == ''RequestMirror'')'
+ - message: filter.requestRedirect must be nil if the filter.type
+ is not RequestRedirect
+ rule: '!(has(self.requestRedirect) && self.type != ''RequestRedirect'')'
+ - message: filter.requestRedirect must be specified for RequestRedirect
+ filter.type
+ rule: '!(!has(self.requestRedirect) && self.type == ''RequestRedirect'')'
+ - message: filter.urlRewrite must be nil if the filter.type
+ is not URLRewrite
+ rule: '!(has(self.urlRewrite) && self.type != ''URLRewrite'')'
+ - message: filter.urlRewrite must be specified for URLRewrite
+ filter.type
+ rule: '!(!has(self.urlRewrite) && self.type == ''URLRewrite'')'
+ - message: filter.extensionRef must be nil if the filter.type
+ is not ExtensionRef
+ rule: '!(has(self.extensionRef) && self.type != ''ExtensionRef'')'
+ - message: filter.extensionRef must be specified for ExtensionRef
+ filter.type
+ rule: '!(!has(self.extensionRef) && self.type == ''ExtensionRef'')'
+ maxItems: 16
+ type: array
+ x-kubernetes-validations:
+ - message: May specify either httpRouteFilterRequestRedirect
+ or httpRouteFilterRequestRewrite, but not both
+ rule: '!(self.exists(f, f.type == ''RequestRedirect'') &&
+ self.exists(f, f.type == ''URLRewrite''))'
+ - message: RequestHeaderModifier filter cannot be repeated
+ rule: self.filter(f, f.type == 'RequestHeaderModifier').size()
+ <= 1
+ - message: ResponseHeaderModifier filter cannot be repeated
+ rule: self.filter(f, f.type == 'ResponseHeaderModifier').size()
+ <= 1
+ - message: RequestRedirect filter cannot be repeated
+ rule: self.filter(f, f.type == 'RequestRedirect').size() <=
+ 1
+ - message: URLRewrite filter cannot be repeated
+ rule: self.filter(f, f.type == 'URLRewrite').size() <= 1
+ matches:
+ default:
+ - path:
+ type: PathPrefix
+ value: /
+ description: |-
+ Matches define conditions used for matching the rule against incoming
+ HTTP requests. Each match is independent, i.e. this rule will be matched
+ if **any** one of the matches is satisfied.
+
+
+ For example, take the following matches configuration:
+
+
+ ```
+ matches:
+ - path:
+ value: "/foo"
+ headers:
+ - name: "version"
+ value: "v2"
+ - path:
+ value: "/v2/foo"
+ ```
+
+
+ For a request to match against this rule, a request must satisfy
+ EITHER of the two conditions:
+
+
+ - path prefixed with `/foo` AND contains the header `version: v2`
+ - path prefix of `/v2/foo`
+
+
+ See the documentation for HTTPRouteMatch on how to specify multiple
+ match conditions that should be ANDed together.
+
+
+ If no matches are specified, the default is a prefix
+ path match on "/", which has the effect of matching every
+ HTTP request.
+
+
+ Proxy or Load Balancer routing configuration generated from HTTPRoutes
+ MUST prioritize matches based on the following criteria, continuing on
+ ties. Across all rules specified on applicable Routes, precedence must be
+ given to the match having:
+
+
+ * "Exact" path match.
+ * "Prefix" path match with largest number of characters.
+ * Method match.
+ * Largest number of header matches.
+ * Largest number of query param matches.
+
+
+ Note: The precedence of RegularExpression path matches are implementation-specific.
+
+
+ If ties still exist across multiple Routes, matching precedence MUST be
+ determined in order of the following criteria, continuing on ties:
+
+
+ * The oldest Route based on creation timestamp.
+ * The Route appearing first in alphabetical order by
+ "{namespace}/{name}".
+
+
+ If ties still exist within an HTTPRoute, matching precedence MUST be granted
+ to the FIRST matching rule (in list order) with a match meeting the above
+ criteria.
+
+
+ When no rules matching a request have been successfully attached to the
+ parent a request is coming from, a HTTP 404 status code MUST be returned.
+ items:
+ description: "HTTPRouteMatch defines the predicate used to
+ match requests to a given\naction. Multiple match types
+ are ANDed together, i.e. the match will\nevaluate to true
+ only if all conditions are satisfied.\n\n\nFor example,
+ the match below will match a HTTP request only if its path\nstarts
+ with `/foo` AND it contains the `version: v1` header:\n\n\n```\nmatch:\n\n\n\tpath:\n\t
+ \ value: \"/foo\"\n\theaders:\n\t- name: \"version\"\n\t
+ \ value \"v1\"\n\n\n```"
+ properties:
+ headers:
+ description: |-
+ Headers specifies HTTP request header matchers. Multiple match values are
+ ANDed together, meaning, a request must match all the specified headers
+ to select the route.
+ items:
+ description: |-
+ HTTPHeaderMatch describes how to select a HTTP route by matching HTTP request
+ headers.
+ properties:
+ name:
+ description: |-
+ Name is the name of the HTTP Header to be matched. Name matching MUST be
+ case insensitive. (See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc7230#section-3.2).
+
+
+ If multiple entries specify equivalent header names, only the first
+ entry with an equivalent name MUST be considered for a match. Subsequent
+ entries with an equivalent header name MUST be ignored. Due to the
+ case-insensitivity of header names, "foo" and "Foo" are considered
+ equivalent.
+
+
+ When a header is repeated in an HTTP request, it is
+ implementation-specific behavior as to how this is represented.
+ Generally, proxies should follow the guidance from the RFC:
+ https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc7230.html#section-3.2.2 regarding
+ processing a repeated header, with special handling for "Set-Cookie".
+ maxLength: 256
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[A-Za-z0-9!#$%&'*+\-.^_\x60|~]+$
+ type: string
+ type:
+ default: Exact
+ description: |-
+ Type specifies how to match against the value of the header.
+
+
+ Support: Core (Exact)
+
+
+ Support: Implementation-specific (RegularExpression)
+
+
+ Since RegularExpression HeaderMatchType has implementation-specific
+ conformance, implementations can support POSIX, PCRE or any other dialects
+ of regular expressions. Please read the implementation's documentation to
+ determine the supported dialect.
+ enum:
+ - Exact
+ - RegularExpression
+ type: string
+ value:
+ description: Value is the value of HTTP Header to
+ be matched.
+ maxLength: 4096
+ minLength: 1
+ type: string
+ required:
+ - name
+ - value
+ type: object
+ maxItems: 16
+ type: array
+ x-kubernetes-list-map-keys:
+ - name
+ x-kubernetes-list-type: map
+ method:
+ description: |-
+ Method specifies HTTP method matcher.
+ When specified, this route will be matched only if the request has the
+ specified method.
+
+
+ Support: Extended
+ enum:
+ - GET
+ - HEAD
+ - POST
+ - PUT
+ - DELETE
+ - CONNECT
+ - OPTIONS
+ - TRACE
+ - PATCH
+ type: string
+ path:
+ default:
+ type: PathPrefix
+ value: /
+ description: |-
+ Path specifies a HTTP request path matcher. If this field is not
+ specified, a default prefix match on the "/" path is provided.
+ properties:
+ type:
+ default: PathPrefix
+ description: |-
+ Type specifies how to match against the path Value.
+
+
+ Support: Core (Exact, PathPrefix)
+
+
+ Support: Implementation-specific (RegularExpression)
+ enum:
+ - Exact
+ - PathPrefix
+ - RegularExpression
+ type: string
+ value:
+ default: /
+ description: Value of the HTTP path to match against.
+ maxLength: 1024
+ type: string
+ type: object
+ x-kubernetes-validations:
+ - message: value must be an absolute path and start with
+ '/' when type one of ['Exact', 'PathPrefix']
+ rule: '(self.type in [''Exact'',''PathPrefix'']) ? self.value.startsWith(''/'')
+ : true'
+ - message: must not contain '//' when type one of ['Exact',
+ 'PathPrefix']
+ rule: '(self.type in [''Exact'',''PathPrefix'']) ? !self.value.contains(''//'')
+ : true'
+ - message: must not contain '/./' when type one of ['Exact',
+ 'PathPrefix']
+ rule: '(self.type in [''Exact'',''PathPrefix'']) ? !self.value.contains(''/./'')
+ : true'
+ - message: must not contain '/../' when type one of ['Exact',
+ 'PathPrefix']
+ rule: '(self.type in [''Exact'',''PathPrefix'']) ? !self.value.contains(''/../'')
+ : true'
+ - message: must not contain '%2f' when type one of ['Exact',
+ 'PathPrefix']
+ rule: '(self.type in [''Exact'',''PathPrefix'']) ? !self.value.contains(''%2f'')
+ : true'
+ - message: must not contain '%2F' when type one of ['Exact',
+ 'PathPrefix']
+ rule: '(self.type in [''Exact'',''PathPrefix'']) ? !self.value.contains(''%2F'')
+ : true'
+ - message: must not contain '#' when type one of ['Exact',
+ 'PathPrefix']
+ rule: '(self.type in [''Exact'',''PathPrefix'']) ? !self.value.contains(''#'')
+ : true'
+ - message: must not end with '/..' when type one of ['Exact',
+ 'PathPrefix']
+ rule: '(self.type in [''Exact'',''PathPrefix'']) ? !self.value.endsWith(''/..'')
+ : true'
+ - message: must not end with '/.' when type one of ['Exact',
+ 'PathPrefix']
+ rule: '(self.type in [''Exact'',''PathPrefix'']) ? !self.value.endsWith(''/.'')
+ : true'
+ - message: type must be one of ['Exact', 'PathPrefix',
+ 'RegularExpression']
+ rule: self.type in ['Exact','PathPrefix'] || self.type
+ == 'RegularExpression'
+ - message: must only contain valid characters (matching
+ ^(?:[-A-Za-z0-9/._~!$&'()*+,;=:@]|[%][0-9a-fA-F]{2})+$)
+ for types ['Exact', 'PathPrefix']
+ rule: '(self.type in [''Exact'',''PathPrefix'']) ? self.value.matches(r"""^(?:[-A-Za-z0-9/._~!$&''()*+,;=:@]|[%][0-9a-fA-F]{2})+$""")
+ : true'
+ queryParams:
+ description: |-
+ QueryParams specifies HTTP query parameter matchers. Multiple match
+ values are ANDed together, meaning, a request must match all the
+ specified query parameters to select the route.
+
+
+ Support: Extended
+ items:
+ description: |-
+ HTTPQueryParamMatch describes how to select a HTTP route by matching HTTP
+ query parameters.
+ properties:
+ name:
+ description: |-
+ Name is the name of the HTTP query param to be matched. This must be an
+ exact string match. (See
+ https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc7230#section-2.7.3).
+
+
+ If multiple entries specify equivalent query param names, only the first
+ entry with an equivalent name MUST be considered for a match. Subsequent
+ entries with an equivalent query param name MUST be ignored.
+
+
+ If a query param is repeated in an HTTP request, the behavior is
+ purposely left undefined, since different data planes have different
+ capabilities. However, it is *recommended* that implementations should
+ match against the first value of the param if the data plane supports it,
+ as this behavior is expected in other load balancing contexts outside of
+ the Gateway API.
+
+
+ Users SHOULD NOT route traffic based on repeated query params to guard
+ themselves against potential differences in the implementations.
+ maxLength: 256
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[A-Za-z0-9!#$%&'*+\-.^_\x60|~]+$
+ type: string
+ type:
+ default: Exact
+ description: |-
+ Type specifies how to match against the value of the query parameter.
+
+
+ Support: Extended (Exact)
+
+
+ Support: Implementation-specific (RegularExpression)
+
+
+ Since RegularExpression QueryParamMatchType has Implementation-specific
+ conformance, implementations can support POSIX, PCRE or any other
+ dialects of regular expressions. Please read the implementation's
+ documentation to determine the supported dialect.
+ enum:
+ - Exact
+ - RegularExpression
+ type: string
+ value:
+ description: Value is the value of HTTP query param
+ to be matched.
+ maxLength: 1024
+ minLength: 1
+ type: string
+ required:
+ - name
+ - value
+ type: object
+ maxItems: 16
+ type: array
+ x-kubernetes-list-map-keys:
+ - name
+ x-kubernetes-list-type: map
+ type: object
+ maxItems: 8
+ type: array
+ sessionPersistence:
+ description: |+
+ SessionPersistence defines and configures session persistence
+ for the route rule.
+
+
+ Support: Extended
+
+
+ properties:
+ absoluteTimeout:
+ description: |-
+ AbsoluteTimeout defines the absolute timeout of the persistent
+ session. Once the AbsoluteTimeout duration has elapsed, the
+ session becomes invalid.
+
+
+ Support: Extended
+ pattern: ^([0-9]{1,5}(h|m|s|ms)){1,4}$
+ type: string
+ cookieConfig:
+ description: |-
+ CookieConfig provides configuration settings that are specific
+ to cookie-based session persistence.
+
+
+ Support: Core
+ properties:
+ lifetimeType:
+ default: Session
+ description: |-
+ LifetimeType specifies whether the cookie has a permanent or
+ session-based lifetime. A permanent cookie persists until its
+ specified expiry time, defined by the Expires or Max-Age cookie
+ attributes, while a session cookie is deleted when the current
+ session ends.
+
+
+ When set to "Permanent", AbsoluteTimeout indicates the
+ cookie's lifetime via the Expires or Max-Age cookie attributes
+ and is required.
+
+
+ When set to "Session", AbsoluteTimeout indicates the
+ absolute lifetime of the cookie tracked by the gateway and
+ is optional.
+
+
+ Support: Core for "Session" type
+
+
+ Support: Extended for "Permanent" type
+ enum:
+ - Permanent
+ - Session
+ type: string
+ type: object
+ idleTimeout:
+ description: |-
+ IdleTimeout defines the idle timeout of the persistent session.
+ Once the session has been idle for more than the specified
+ IdleTimeout duration, the session becomes invalid.
+
+
+ Support: Extended
+ pattern: ^([0-9]{1,5}(h|m|s|ms)){1,4}$
+ type: string
+ sessionName:
+ description: |-
+ SessionName defines the name of the persistent session token
+ which may be reflected in the cookie or the header. Users
+ should avoid reusing session names to prevent unintended
+ consequences, such as rejection or unpredictable behavior.
+
+
+ Support: Implementation-specific
+ maxLength: 128
+ type: string
+ type:
+ default: Cookie
+ description: |-
+ Type defines the type of session persistence such as through
+ the use a header or cookie. Defaults to cookie based session
+ persistence.
+
+
+ Support: Core for "Cookie" type
+
+
+ Support: Extended for "Header" type
+ enum:
+ - Cookie
+ - Header
+ type: string
+ type: object
+ x-kubernetes-validations:
+ - message: AbsoluteTimeout must be specified when cookie lifetimeType
+ is Permanent
+ rule: '!has(self.cookieConfig.lifetimeType) || self.cookieConfig.lifetimeType
+ != ''Permanent'' || has(self.absoluteTimeout)'
+ timeouts:
+ description: |+
+ Timeouts defines the timeouts that can be configured for an HTTP request.
+
+
+ Support: Extended
+
+
+ properties:
+ backendRequest:
+ description: |-
+ BackendRequest specifies a timeout for an individual request from the gateway
+ to a backend. This covers the time from when the request first starts being
+ sent from the gateway to when the full response has been received from the backend.
+
+
+ Setting a timeout to the zero duration (e.g. "0s") SHOULD disable the timeout
+ completely. Implementations that cannot completely disable the timeout MUST
+ instead interpret the zero duration as the longest possible value to which
+ the timeout can be set.
+
+
+ An entire client HTTP transaction with a gateway, covered by the Request timeout,
+ may result in more than one call from the gateway to the destination backend,
+ for example, if automatic retries are supported.
+
+
+ Because the Request timeout encompasses the BackendRequest timeout, the value of
+ BackendRequest must be <= the value of Request timeout.
+
+
+ Support: Extended
+ pattern: ^([0-9]{1,5}(h|m|s|ms)){1,4}$
+ type: string
+ request:
+ description: |-
+ Request specifies the maximum duration for a gateway to respond to an HTTP request.
+ If the gateway has not been able to respond before this deadline is met, the gateway
+ MUST return a timeout error.
+
+
+ For example, setting the `rules.timeouts.request` field to the value `10s` in an
+ `HTTPRoute` will cause a timeout if a client request is taking longer than 10 seconds
+ to complete.
+
+
+ Setting a timeout to the zero duration (e.g. "0s") SHOULD disable the timeout
+ completely. Implementations that cannot completely disable the timeout MUST
+ instead interpret the zero duration as the longest possible value to which
+ the timeout can be set.
+
+
+ This timeout is intended to cover as close to the whole request-response transaction
+ as possible although an implementation MAY choose to start the timeout after the entire
+ request stream has been received instead of immediately after the transaction is
+ initiated by the client.
+
+
+ When this field is unspecified, request timeout behavior is implementation-specific.
+
+
+ Support: Extended
+ pattern: ^([0-9]{1,5}(h|m|s|ms)){1,4}$
+ type: string
+ type: object
+ x-kubernetes-validations:
+ - message: backendRequest timeout cannot be longer than request
+ timeout
+ rule: '!(has(self.request) && has(self.backendRequest) &&
+ duration(self.request) != duration(''0s'') && duration(self.backendRequest)
+ > duration(self.request))'
+ type: object
+ x-kubernetes-validations:
+ - message: RequestRedirect filter must not be used together with
+ backendRefs
+ rule: '(has(self.backendRefs) && size(self.backendRefs) > 0) ?
+ (!has(self.filters) || self.filters.all(f, !has(f.requestRedirect))):
+ true'
+ - message: When using RequestRedirect filter with path.replacePrefixMatch,
+ exactly one PathPrefix match must be specified
+ rule: '(has(self.filters) && self.filters.exists_one(f, has(f.requestRedirect)
+ && has(f.requestRedirect.path) && f.requestRedirect.path.type
+ == ''ReplacePrefixMatch'' && has(f.requestRedirect.path.replacePrefixMatch)))
+ ? ((size(self.matches) != 1 || !has(self.matches[0].path) ||
+ self.matches[0].path.type != ''PathPrefix'') ? false : true)
+ : true'
+ - message: When using URLRewrite filter with path.replacePrefixMatch,
+ exactly one PathPrefix match must be specified
+ rule: '(has(self.filters) && self.filters.exists_one(f, has(f.urlRewrite)
+ && has(f.urlRewrite.path) && f.urlRewrite.path.type == ''ReplacePrefixMatch''
+ && has(f.urlRewrite.path.replacePrefixMatch))) ? ((size(self.matches)
+ != 1 || !has(self.matches[0].path) || self.matches[0].path.type
+ != ''PathPrefix'') ? false : true) : true'
+ - message: Within backendRefs, when using RequestRedirect filter
+ with path.replacePrefixMatch, exactly one PathPrefix match must
+ be specified
+ rule: '(has(self.backendRefs) && self.backendRefs.exists_one(b,
+ (has(b.filters) && b.filters.exists_one(f, has(f.requestRedirect)
+ && has(f.requestRedirect.path) && f.requestRedirect.path.type
+ == ''ReplacePrefixMatch'' && has(f.requestRedirect.path.replacePrefixMatch)))
+ )) ? ((size(self.matches) != 1 || !has(self.matches[0].path)
+ || self.matches[0].path.type != ''PathPrefix'') ? false : true)
+ : true'
+ - message: Within backendRefs, When using URLRewrite filter with
+ path.replacePrefixMatch, exactly one PathPrefix match must be
+ specified
+ rule: '(has(self.backendRefs) && self.backendRefs.exists_one(b,
+ (has(b.filters) && b.filters.exists_one(f, has(f.urlRewrite)
+ && has(f.urlRewrite.path) && f.urlRewrite.path.type == ''ReplacePrefixMatch''
+ && has(f.urlRewrite.path.replacePrefixMatch))) )) ? ((size(self.matches)
+ != 1 || !has(self.matches[0].path) || self.matches[0].path.type
+ != ''PathPrefix'') ? false : true) : true'
+ maxItems: 16
+ type: array
+ type: object
+ status:
+ description: Status defines the current state of HTTPRoute.
+ properties:
+ parents:
+ description: |-
+ Parents is a list of parent resources (usually Gateways) that are
+ associated with the route, and the status of the route with respect to
+ each parent. When this route attaches to a parent, the controller that
+ manages the parent must add an entry to this list when the controller
+ first sees the route and should update the entry as appropriate when the
+ route or gateway is modified.
+
+
+ Note that parent references that cannot be resolved by an implementation
+ of this API will not be added to this list. Implementations of this API
+ can only populate Route status for the Gateways/parent resources they are
+ responsible for.
+
+
+ A maximum of 32 Gateways will be represented in this list. An empty list
+ means the route has not been attached to any Gateway.
+ items:
+ description: |-
+ RouteParentStatus describes the status of a route with respect to an
+ associated Parent.
+ properties:
+ conditions:
+ description: |-
+ Conditions describes the status of the route with respect to the Gateway.
+ Note that the route's availability is also subject to the Gateway's own
+ status conditions and listener status.
+
+
+ If the Route's ParentRef specifies an existing Gateway that supports
+ Routes of this kind AND that Gateway's controller has sufficient access,
+ then that Gateway's controller MUST set the "Accepted" condition on the
+ Route, to indicate whether the route has been accepted or rejected by the
+ Gateway, and why.
+
+
+ A Route MUST be considered "Accepted" if at least one of the Route's
+ rules is implemented by the Gateway.
+
+
+ There are a number of cases where the "Accepted" condition may not be set
+ due to lack of controller visibility, that includes when:
+
+
+ * The Route refers to a non-existent parent.
+ * The Route is of a type that the controller does not support.
+ * The Route is in a namespace the controller does not have access to.
+ items:
+ description: "Condition contains details for one aspect of
+ the current state of this API Resource.\n---\nThis struct
+ is intended for direct use as an array at the field path
+ .status.conditions. For example,\n\n\n\ttype FooStatus
+ struct{\n\t // Represents the observations of a foo's
+ current state.\n\t // Known .status.conditions.type are:
+ \"Available\", \"Progressing\", and \"Degraded\"\n\t //
+ +patchMergeKey=type\n\t // +patchStrategy=merge\n\t //
+ +listType=map\n\t // +listMapKey=type\n\t Conditions
+ []metav1.Condition `json:\"conditions,omitempty\" patchStrategy:\"merge\"
+ patchMergeKey:\"type\" protobuf:\"bytes,1,rep,name=conditions\"`\n\n\n\t
+ \ // other fields\n\t}"
+ properties:
+ lastTransitionTime:
+ description: |-
+ lastTransitionTime is the last time the condition transitioned from one status to another.
+ This should be when the underlying condition changed. If that is not known, then using the time when the API field changed is acceptable.
+ format: date-time
+ type: string
+ message:
+ description: |-
+ message is a human readable message indicating details about the transition.
+ This may be an empty string.
+ maxLength: 32768
+ type: string
+ observedGeneration:
+ description: |-
+ observedGeneration represents the .metadata.generation that the condition was set based upon.
+ For instance, if .metadata.generation is currently 12, but the .status.conditions[x].observedGeneration is 9, the condition is out of date
+ with respect to the current state of the instance.
+ format: int64
+ minimum: 0
+ type: integer
+ reason:
+ description: |-
+ reason contains a programmatic identifier indicating the reason for the condition's last transition.
+ Producers of specific condition types may define expected values and meanings for this field,
+ and whether the values are considered a guaranteed API.
+ The value should be a CamelCase string.
+ This field may not be empty.
+ maxLength: 1024
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[A-Za-z]([A-Za-z0-9_,:]*[A-Za-z0-9_])?$
+ type: string
+ status:
+ description: status of the condition, one of True, False,
+ Unknown.
+ enum:
+ - "True"
+ - "False"
+ - Unknown
+ type: string
+ type:
+ description: |-
+ type of condition in CamelCase or in foo.example.com/CamelCase.
+ ---
+ Many .condition.type values are consistent across resources like Available, but because arbitrary conditions can be
+ useful (see .node.status.conditions), the ability to deconflict is important.
+ The regex it matches is (dns1123SubdomainFmt/)?(qualifiedNameFmt)
+ maxLength: 316
+ pattern: ^([a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*/)?(([A-Za-z0-9][-A-Za-z0-9_.]*)?[A-Za-z0-9])$
+ type: string
+ required:
+ - lastTransitionTime
+ - message
+ - reason
+ - status
+ - type
+ type: object
+ maxItems: 8
+ minItems: 1
+ type: array
+ x-kubernetes-list-map-keys:
+ - type
+ x-kubernetes-list-type: map
+ controllerName:
+ description: |-
+ ControllerName is a domain/path string that indicates the name of the
+ controller that wrote this status. This corresponds with the
+ controllerName field on GatewayClass.
+
+
+ Example: "example.net/gateway-controller".
+
+
+ The format of this field is DOMAIN "/" PATH, where DOMAIN and PATH are
+ valid Kubernetes names
+ (https://kubernetes.io/docs/concepts/overview/working-with-objects/names/#names).
+
+
+ Controllers MUST populate this field when writing status. Controllers should ensure that
+ entries to status populated with their ControllerName are cleaned up when they are no
+ longer necessary.
+ maxLength: 253
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*\/[A-Za-z0-9\/\-._~%!$&'()*+,;=:]+$
+ type: string
+ parentRef:
+ description: |-
+ ParentRef corresponds with a ParentRef in the spec that this
+ RouteParentStatus struct describes the status of.
+ properties:
+ group:
+ default: gateway.networking.k8s.io
+ description: |-
+ Group is the group of the referent.
+ When unspecified, "gateway.networking.k8s.io" is inferred.
+ To set the core API group (such as for a "Service" kind referent),
+ Group must be explicitly set to "" (empty string).
+
+
+ Support: Core
+ maxLength: 253
+ pattern: ^$|^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$
+ type: string
+ kind:
+ default: Gateway
+ description: |-
+ Kind is kind of the referent.
+
+
+ There are two kinds of parent resources with "Core" support:
+
+
+ * Gateway (Gateway conformance profile)
+ * Service (Mesh conformance profile, ClusterIP Services only)
+
+
+ Support for other resources is Implementation-Specific.
+ maxLength: 63
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[a-zA-Z]([-a-zA-Z0-9]*[a-zA-Z0-9])?$
+ type: string
+ name:
+ description: |-
+ Name is the name of the referent.
+
+
+ Support: Core
+ maxLength: 253
+ minLength: 1
+ type: string
+ namespace:
+ description: |-
+ Namespace is the namespace of the referent. When unspecified, this refers
+ to the local namespace of the Route.
+
+
+ Note that there are specific rules for ParentRefs which cross namespace
+ boundaries. Cross-namespace references are only valid if they are explicitly
+ allowed by something in the namespace they are referring to. For example:
+ Gateway has the AllowedRoutes field, and ReferenceGrant provides a
+ generic way to enable any other kind of cross-namespace reference.
+
+
+
+ ParentRefs from a Route to a Service in the same namespace are "producer"
+ routes, which apply default routing rules to inbound connections from
+ any namespace to the Service.
+
+
+ ParentRefs from a Route to a Service in a different namespace are
+ "consumer" routes, and these routing rules are only applied to outbound
+ connections originating from the same namespace as the Route, for which
+ the intended destination of the connections are a Service targeted as a
+ ParentRef of the Route.
+
+
+
+ Support: Core
+ maxLength: 63
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?$
+ type: string
+ port:
+ description: |-
+ Port is the network port this Route targets. It can be interpreted
+ differently based on the type of parent resource.
+
+
+ When the parent resource is a Gateway, this targets all listeners
+ listening on the specified port that also support this kind of Route(and
+ select this Route). It's not recommended to set `Port` unless the
+ networking behaviors specified in a Route must apply to a specific port
+ as opposed to a listener(s) whose port(s) may be changed. When both Port
+ and SectionName are specified, the name and port of the selected listener
+ must match both specified values.
+
+
+
+ When the parent resource is a Service, this targets a specific port in the
+ Service spec. When both Port (experimental) and SectionName are specified,
+ the name and port of the selected port must match both specified values.
+
+
+
+ Implementations MAY choose to support other parent resources.
+ Implementations supporting other types of parent resources MUST clearly
+ document how/if Port is interpreted.
+
+
+ For the purpose of status, an attachment is considered successful as
+ long as the parent resource accepts it partially. For example, Gateway
+ listeners can restrict which Routes can attach to them by Route kind,
+ namespace, or hostname. If 1 of 2 Gateway listeners accept attachment
+ from the referencing Route, the Route MUST be considered successfully
+ attached. If no Gateway listeners accept attachment from this Route,
+ the Route MUST be considered detached from the Gateway.
+
+
+ Support: Extended
+ format: int32
+ maximum: 65535
+ minimum: 1
+ type: integer
+ sectionName:
+ description: |-
+ SectionName is the name of a section within the target resource. In the
+ following resources, SectionName is interpreted as the following:
+
+
+ * Gateway: Listener name. When both Port (experimental) and SectionName
+ are specified, the name and port of the selected listener must match
+ both specified values.
+ * Service: Port name. When both Port (experimental) and SectionName
+ are specified, the name and port of the selected listener must match
+ both specified values.
+
+
+ Implementations MAY choose to support attaching Routes to other resources.
+ If that is the case, they MUST clearly document how SectionName is
+ interpreted.
+
+
+ When unspecified (empty string), this will reference the entire resource.
+ For the purpose of status, an attachment is considered successful if at
+ least one section in the parent resource accepts it. For example, Gateway
+ listeners can restrict which Routes can attach to them by Route kind,
+ namespace, or hostname. If 1 of 2 Gateway listeners accept attachment from
+ the referencing Route, the Route MUST be considered successfully
+ attached. If no Gateway listeners accept attachment from this Route, the
+ Route MUST be considered detached from the Gateway.
+
+
+ Support: Core
+ maxLength: 253
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$
+ type: string
+ required:
+ - name
+ type: object
+ required:
+ - controllerName
+ - parentRef
+ type: object
+ maxItems: 32
+ type: array
+ required:
+ - parents
+ type: object
+ required:
+ - spec
+ type: object
+ served: true
+ storage: true
+ subresources:
+ status: {}
+ - additionalPrinterColumns:
+ - jsonPath: .spec.hostnames
+ name: Hostnames
+ type: string
+ - jsonPath: .metadata.creationTimestamp
+ name: Age
+ type: date
+ name: v1beta1
+ schema:
+ openAPIV3Schema:
+ description: |-
+ HTTPRoute provides a way to route HTTP requests. This includes the capability
+ to match requests by hostname, path, header, or query param. Filters can be
+ used to specify additional processing steps. Backends specify where matching
+ requests should be routed.
+ properties:
+ apiVersion:
+ description: |-
+ APIVersion defines the versioned schema of this representation of an object.
+ Servers should convert recognized schemas to the latest internal value, and
+ may reject unrecognized values.
+ More info: https://git.k8s.io/community/contributors/devel/sig-architecture/api-conventions.md#resources
+ type: string
+ kind:
+ description: |-
+ Kind is a string value representing the REST resource this object represents.
+ Servers may infer this from the endpoint the client submits requests to.
+ Cannot be updated.
+ In CamelCase.
+ More info: https://git.k8s.io/community/contributors/devel/sig-architecture/api-conventions.md#types-kinds
+ type: string
+ metadata:
+ type: object
+ spec:
+ description: Spec defines the desired state of HTTPRoute.
+ properties:
+ hostnames:
+ description: |-
+ Hostnames defines a set of hostnames that should match against the HTTP Host
+ header to select a HTTPRoute used to process the request. Implementations
+ MUST ignore any port value specified in the HTTP Host header while
+ performing a match and (absent of any applicable header modification
+ configuration) MUST forward this header unmodified to the backend.
+
+
+ Valid values for Hostnames are determined by RFC 1123 definition of a
+ hostname with 2 notable exceptions:
+
+
+ 1. IPs are not allowed.
+ 2. A hostname may be prefixed with a wildcard label (`*.`). The wildcard
+ label must appear by itself as the first label.
+
+
+ If a hostname is specified by both the Listener and HTTPRoute, there
+ must be at least one intersecting hostname for the HTTPRoute to be
+ attached to the Listener. For example:
+
+
+ * A Listener with `test.example.com` as the hostname matches HTTPRoutes
+ that have either not specified any hostnames, or have specified at
+ least one of `test.example.com` or `*.example.com`.
+ * A Listener with `*.example.com` as the hostname matches HTTPRoutes
+ that have either not specified any hostnames or have specified at least
+ one hostname that matches the Listener hostname. For example,
+ `*.example.com`, `test.example.com`, and `foo.test.example.com` would
+ all match. On the other hand, `example.com` and `test.example.net` would
+ not match.
+
+
+ Hostnames that are prefixed with a wildcard label (`*.`) are interpreted
+ as a suffix match. That means that a match for `*.example.com` would match
+ both `test.example.com`, and `foo.test.example.com`, but not `example.com`.
+
+
+ If both the Listener and HTTPRoute have specified hostnames, any
+ HTTPRoute hostnames that do not match the Listener hostname MUST be
+ ignored. For example, if a Listener specified `*.example.com`, and the
+ HTTPRoute specified `test.example.com` and `test.example.net`,
+ `test.example.net` must not be considered for a match.
+
+
+ If both the Listener and HTTPRoute have specified hostnames, and none
+ match with the criteria above, then the HTTPRoute is not accepted. The
+ implementation must raise an 'Accepted' Condition with a status of
+ `False` in the corresponding RouteParentStatus.
+
+
+ In the event that multiple HTTPRoutes specify intersecting hostnames (e.g.
+ overlapping wildcard matching and exact matching hostnames), precedence must
+ be given to rules from the HTTPRoute with the largest number of:
+
+
+ * Characters in a matching non-wildcard hostname.
+ * Characters in a matching hostname.
+
+
+ If ties exist across multiple Routes, the matching precedence rules for
+ HTTPRouteMatches takes over.
+
+
+ Support: Core
+ items:
+ description: |-
+ Hostname is the fully qualified domain name of a network host. This matches
+ the RFC 1123 definition of a hostname with 2 notable exceptions:
+
+
+ 1. IPs are not allowed.
+ 2. A hostname may be prefixed with a wildcard label (`*.`). The wildcard
+ label must appear by itself as the first label.
+
+
+ Hostname can be "precise" which is a domain name without the terminating
+ dot of a network host (e.g. "foo.example.com") or "wildcard", which is a
+ domain name prefixed with a single wildcard label (e.g. `*.example.com`).
+
+
+ Note that as per RFC1035 and RFC1123, a *label* must consist of lower case
+ alphanumeric characters or '-', and must start and end with an alphanumeric
+ character. No other punctuation is allowed.
+ maxLength: 253
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^(\*\.)?[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$
+ type: string
+ maxItems: 16
+ type: array
+ parentRefs:
+ description: |+
+ ParentRefs references the resources (usually Gateways) that a Route wants
+ to be attached to. Note that the referenced parent resource needs to
+ allow this for the attachment to be complete. For Gateways, that means
+ the Gateway needs to allow attachment from Routes of this kind and
+ namespace. For Services, that means the Service must either be in the same
+ namespace for a "producer" route, or the mesh implementation must support
+ and allow "consumer" routes for the referenced Service. ReferenceGrant is
+ not applicable for governing ParentRefs to Services - it is not possible to
+ create a "producer" route for a Service in a different namespace from the
+ Route.
+
+
+ There are two kinds of parent resources with "Core" support:
+
+
+ * Gateway (Gateway conformance profile)
+ * Service (Mesh conformance profile, ClusterIP Services only)
+
+
+ This API may be extended in the future to support additional kinds of parent
+ resources.
+
+
+ ParentRefs must be _distinct_. This means either that:
+
+
+ * They select different objects. If this is the case, then parentRef
+ entries are distinct. In terms of fields, this means that the
+ multi-part key defined by `group`, `kind`, `namespace`, and `name` must
+ be unique across all parentRef entries in the Route.
+ * They do not select different objects, but for each optional field used,
+ each ParentRef that selects the same object must set the same set of
+ optional fields to different values. If one ParentRef sets a
+ combination of optional fields, all must set the same combination.
+
+
+ Some examples:
+
+
+ * If one ParentRef sets `sectionName`, all ParentRefs referencing the
+ same object must also set `sectionName`.
+ * If one ParentRef sets `port`, all ParentRefs referencing the same
+ object must also set `port`.
+ * If one ParentRef sets `sectionName` and `port`, all ParentRefs
+ referencing the same object must also set `sectionName` and `port`.
+
+
+ It is possible to separately reference multiple distinct objects that may
+ be collapsed by an implementation. For example, some implementations may
+ choose to merge compatible Gateway Listeners together. If that is the
+ case, the list of routes attached to those resources should also be
+ merged.
+
+
+ Note that for ParentRefs that cross namespace boundaries, there are specific
+ rules. Cross-namespace references are only valid if they are explicitly
+ allowed by something in the namespace they are referring to. For example,
+ Gateway has the AllowedRoutes field, and ReferenceGrant provides a
+ generic way to enable other kinds of cross-namespace reference.
+
+
+
+ ParentRefs from a Route to a Service in the same namespace are "producer"
+ routes, which apply default routing rules to inbound connections from
+ any namespace to the Service.
+
+
+ ParentRefs from a Route to a Service in a different namespace are
+ "consumer" routes, and these routing rules are only applied to outbound
+ connections originating from the same namespace as the Route, for which
+ the intended destination of the connections are a Service targeted as a
+ ParentRef of the Route.
+
+
+
+
+
+
+ items:
+ description: |-
+ ParentReference identifies an API object (usually a Gateway) that can be considered
+ a parent of this resource (usually a route). There are two kinds of parent resources
+ with "Core" support:
+
+
+ * Gateway (Gateway conformance profile)
+ * Service (Mesh conformance profile, ClusterIP Services only)
+
+
+ This API may be extended in the future to support additional kinds of parent
+ resources.
+
+
+ The API object must be valid in the cluster; the Group and Kind must
+ be registered in the cluster for this reference to be valid.
+ properties:
+ group:
+ default: gateway.networking.k8s.io
+ description: |-
+ Group is the group of the referent.
+ When unspecified, "gateway.networking.k8s.io" is inferred.
+ To set the core API group (such as for a "Service" kind referent),
+ Group must be explicitly set to "" (empty string).
+
+
+ Support: Core
+ maxLength: 253
+ pattern: ^$|^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$
+ type: string
+ kind:
+ default: Gateway
+ description: |-
+ Kind is kind of the referent.
+
+
+ There are two kinds of parent resources with "Core" support:
+
+
+ * Gateway (Gateway conformance profile)
+ * Service (Mesh conformance profile, ClusterIP Services only)
+
+
+ Support for other resources is Implementation-Specific.
+ maxLength: 63
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[a-zA-Z]([-a-zA-Z0-9]*[a-zA-Z0-9])?$
+ type: string
+ name:
+ description: |-
+ Name is the name of the referent.
+
+
+ Support: Core
+ maxLength: 253
+ minLength: 1
+ type: string
+ namespace:
+ description: |-
+ Namespace is the namespace of the referent. When unspecified, this refers
+ to the local namespace of the Route.
+
+
+ Note that there are specific rules for ParentRefs which cross namespace
+ boundaries. Cross-namespace references are only valid if they are explicitly
+ allowed by something in the namespace they are referring to. For example:
+ Gateway has the AllowedRoutes field, and ReferenceGrant provides a
+ generic way to enable any other kind of cross-namespace reference.
+
+
+
+ ParentRefs from a Route to a Service in the same namespace are "producer"
+ routes, which apply default routing rules to inbound connections from
+ any namespace to the Service.
+
+
+ ParentRefs from a Route to a Service in a different namespace are
+ "consumer" routes, and these routing rules are only applied to outbound
+ connections originating from the same namespace as the Route, for which
+ the intended destination of the connections are a Service targeted as a
+ ParentRef of the Route.
+
+
+
+ Support: Core
+ maxLength: 63
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?$
+ type: string
+ port:
+ description: |-
+ Port is the network port this Route targets. It can be interpreted
+ differently based on the type of parent resource.
+
+
+ When the parent resource is a Gateway, this targets all listeners
+ listening on the specified port that also support this kind of Route(and
+ select this Route). It's not recommended to set `Port` unless the
+ networking behaviors specified in a Route must apply to a specific port
+ as opposed to a listener(s) whose port(s) may be changed. When both Port
+ and SectionName are specified, the name and port of the selected listener
+ must match both specified values.
+
+
+
+ When the parent resource is a Service, this targets a specific port in the
+ Service spec. When both Port (experimental) and SectionName are specified,
+ the name and port of the selected port must match both specified values.
+
+
+
+ Implementations MAY choose to support other parent resources.
+ Implementations supporting other types of parent resources MUST clearly
+ document how/if Port is interpreted.
+
+
+ For the purpose of status, an attachment is considered successful as
+ long as the parent resource accepts it partially. For example, Gateway
+ listeners can restrict which Routes can attach to them by Route kind,
+ namespace, or hostname. If 1 of 2 Gateway listeners accept attachment
+ from the referencing Route, the Route MUST be considered successfully
+ attached. If no Gateway listeners accept attachment from this Route,
+ the Route MUST be considered detached from the Gateway.
+
+
+ Support: Extended
+ format: int32
+ maximum: 65535
+ minimum: 1
+ type: integer
+ sectionName:
+ description: |-
+ SectionName is the name of a section within the target resource. In the
+ following resources, SectionName is interpreted as the following:
+
+
+ * Gateway: Listener name. When both Port (experimental) and SectionName
+ are specified, the name and port of the selected listener must match
+ both specified values.
+ * Service: Port name. When both Port (experimental) and SectionName
+ are specified, the name and port of the selected listener must match
+ both specified values.
+
+
+ Implementations MAY choose to support attaching Routes to other resources.
+ If that is the case, they MUST clearly document how SectionName is
+ interpreted.
+
+
+ When unspecified (empty string), this will reference the entire resource.
+ For the purpose of status, an attachment is considered successful if at
+ least one section in the parent resource accepts it. For example, Gateway
+ listeners can restrict which Routes can attach to them by Route kind,
+ namespace, or hostname. If 1 of 2 Gateway listeners accept attachment from
+ the referencing Route, the Route MUST be considered successfully
+ attached. If no Gateway listeners accept attachment from this Route, the
+ Route MUST be considered detached from the Gateway.
+
+
+ Support: Core
+ maxLength: 253
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$
+ type: string
+ required:
+ - name
+ type: object
+ maxItems: 32
+ type: array
+ x-kubernetes-validations:
+ - message: sectionName or port must be specified when parentRefs includes
+ 2 or more references to the same parent
+ rule: 'self.all(p1, self.all(p2, p1.group == p2.group && p1.kind
+ == p2.kind && p1.name == p2.name && (((!has(p1.__namespace__)
+ || p1.__namespace__ == '''') && (!has(p2.__namespace__) || p2.__namespace__
+ == '''')) || (has(p1.__namespace__) && has(p2.__namespace__) &&
+ p1.__namespace__ == p2.__namespace__)) ? ((!has(p1.sectionName)
+ || p1.sectionName == '''') == (!has(p2.sectionName) || p2.sectionName
+ == '''') && (!has(p1.port) || p1.port == 0) == (!has(p2.port)
+ || p2.port == 0)): true))'
+ - message: sectionName or port must be unique when parentRefs includes
+ 2 or more references to the same parent
+ rule: self.all(p1, self.exists_one(p2, p1.group == p2.group && p1.kind
+ == p2.kind && p1.name == p2.name && (((!has(p1.__namespace__)
+ || p1.__namespace__ == '') && (!has(p2.__namespace__) || p2.__namespace__
+ == '')) || (has(p1.__namespace__) && has(p2.__namespace__) &&
+ p1.__namespace__ == p2.__namespace__ )) && (((!has(p1.sectionName)
+ || p1.sectionName == '') && (!has(p2.sectionName) || p2.sectionName
+ == '')) || ( has(p1.sectionName) && has(p2.sectionName) && p1.sectionName
+ == p2.sectionName)) && (((!has(p1.port) || p1.port == 0) && (!has(p2.port)
+ || p2.port == 0)) || (has(p1.port) && has(p2.port) && p1.port
+ == p2.port))))
+ rules:
+ default:
+ - matches:
+ - path:
+ type: PathPrefix
+ value: /
+ description: Rules are a list of HTTP matchers, filters and actions.
+ items:
+ description: |-
+ HTTPRouteRule defines semantics for matching an HTTP request based on
+ conditions (matches), processing it (filters), and forwarding the request to
+ an API object (backendRefs).
+ properties:
+ backendRefs:
+ description: |-
+ BackendRefs defines the backend(s) where matching requests should be
+ sent.
+
+
+ Failure behavior here depends on how many BackendRefs are specified and
+ how many are invalid.
+
+
+ If *all* entries in BackendRefs are invalid, and there are also no filters
+ specified in this route rule, *all* traffic which matches this rule MUST
+ receive a 500 status code.
+
+
+ See the HTTPBackendRef definition for the rules about what makes a single
+ HTTPBackendRef invalid.
+
+
+ When a HTTPBackendRef is invalid, 500 status codes MUST be returned for
+ requests that would have otherwise been routed to an invalid backend. If
+ multiple backends are specified, and some are invalid, the proportion of
+ requests that would otherwise have been routed to an invalid backend
+ MUST receive a 500 status code.
+
+
+ For example, if two backends are specified with equal weights, and one is
+ invalid, 50 percent of traffic must receive a 500. Implementations may
+ choose how that 50 percent is determined.
+
+
+ Support: Core for Kubernetes Service
+
+
+ Support: Extended for Kubernetes ServiceImport
+
+
+ Support: Implementation-specific for any other resource
+
+
+ Support for weight: Core
+ items:
+ description: |-
+ HTTPBackendRef defines how a HTTPRoute forwards a HTTP request.
+
+
+ Note that when a namespace different than the local namespace is specified, a
+ ReferenceGrant object is required in the referent namespace to allow that
+ namespace's owner to accept the reference. See the ReferenceGrant
+ documentation for details.
+
+
+
+
+
+ When the BackendRef points to a Kubernetes Service, implementations SHOULD
+ honor the appProtocol field if it is set for the target Service Port.
+
+
+ Implementations supporting appProtocol SHOULD recognize the Kubernetes
+ Standard Application Protocols defined in KEP-3726.
+
+
+ If a Service appProtocol isn't specified, an implementation MAY infer the
+ backend protocol through its own means. Implementations MAY infer the
+ protocol from the Route type referring to the backend Service.
+
+
+ If a Route is not able to send traffic to the backend using the specified
+ protocol then the backend is considered invalid. Implementations MUST set the
+ "ResolvedRefs" condition to "False" with the "UnsupportedProtocol" reason.
+
+
+
+ properties:
+ filters:
+ description: |-
+ Filters defined at this level should be executed if and only if the
+ request is being forwarded to the backend defined here.
+
+
+ Support: Implementation-specific (For broader support of filters, use the
+ Filters field in HTTPRouteRule.)
+ items:
+ description: |-
+ HTTPRouteFilter defines processing steps that must be completed during the
+ request or response lifecycle. HTTPRouteFilters are meant as an extension
+ point to express processing that may be done in Gateway implementations. Some
+ examples include request or response modification, implementing
+ authentication strategies, rate-limiting, and traffic shaping. API
+ guarantee/conformance is defined based on the type of the filter.
+ properties:
+ extensionRef:
+ description: |-
+ ExtensionRef is an optional, implementation-specific extension to the
+ "filter" behavior. For example, resource "myroutefilter" in group
+ "networking.example.net"). ExtensionRef MUST NOT be used for core and
+ extended filters.
+
+
+ This filter can be used multiple times within the same rule.
+
+
+ Support: Implementation-specific
+ properties:
+ group:
+ description: |-
+ Group is the group of the referent. For example, "gateway.networking.k8s.io".
+ When unspecified or empty string, core API group is inferred.
+ maxLength: 253
+ pattern: ^$|^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$
+ type: string
+ kind:
+ description: Kind is kind of the referent. For
+ example "HTTPRoute" or "Service".
+ maxLength: 63
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[a-zA-Z]([-a-zA-Z0-9]*[a-zA-Z0-9])?$
+ type: string
+ name:
+ description: Name is the name of the referent.
+ maxLength: 253
+ minLength: 1
+ type: string
+ required:
+ - group
+ - kind
+ - name
+ type: object
+ requestHeaderModifier:
+ description: |-
+ RequestHeaderModifier defines a schema for a filter that modifies request
+ headers.
+
+
+ Support: Core
+ properties:
+ add:
+ description: |-
+ Add adds the given header(s) (name, value) to the request
+ before the action. It appends to any existing values associated
+ with the header name.
+
+
+ Input:
+ GET /foo HTTP/1.1
+ my-header: foo
+
+
+ Config:
+ add:
+ - name: "my-header"
+ value: "bar,baz"
+
+
+ Output:
+ GET /foo HTTP/1.1
+ my-header: foo,bar,baz
+ items:
+ description: HTTPHeader represents an HTTP
+ Header name and value as defined by RFC
+ 7230.
+ properties:
+ name:
+ description: |-
+ Name is the name of the HTTP Header to be matched. Name matching MUST be
+ case insensitive. (See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc7230#section-3.2).
+
+
+ If multiple entries specify equivalent header names, the first entry with
+ an equivalent name MUST be considered for a match. Subsequent entries
+ with an equivalent header name MUST be ignored. Due to the
+ case-insensitivity of header names, "foo" and "Foo" are considered
+ equivalent.
+ maxLength: 256
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[A-Za-z0-9!#$%&'*+\-.^_\x60|~]+$
+ type: string
+ value:
+ description: Value is the value of HTTP
+ Header to be matched.
+ maxLength: 4096
+ minLength: 1
+ type: string
+ required:
+ - name
+ - value
+ type: object
+ maxItems: 16
+ type: array
+ x-kubernetes-list-map-keys:
+ - name
+ x-kubernetes-list-type: map
+ remove:
+ description: |-
+ Remove the given header(s) from the HTTP request before the action. The
+ value of Remove is a list of HTTP header names. Note that the header
+ names are case-insensitive (see
+ https://datatracker.ietf.org/doc/html/rfc2616#section-4.2).
+
+
+ Input:
+ GET /foo HTTP/1.1
+ my-header1: foo
+ my-header2: bar
+ my-header3: baz
+
+
+ Config:
+ remove: ["my-header1", "my-header3"]
+
+
+ Output:
+ GET /foo HTTP/1.1
+ my-header2: bar
+ items:
+ type: string
+ maxItems: 16
+ type: array
+ x-kubernetes-list-type: set
+ set:
+ description: |-
+ Set overwrites the request with the given header (name, value)
+ before the action.
+
+
+ Input:
+ GET /foo HTTP/1.1
+ my-header: foo
+
+
+ Config:
+ set:
+ - name: "my-header"
+ value: "bar"
+
+
+ Output:
+ GET /foo HTTP/1.1
+ my-header: bar
+ items:
+ description: HTTPHeader represents an HTTP
+ Header name and value as defined by RFC
+ 7230.
+ properties:
+ name:
+ description: |-
+ Name is the name of the HTTP Header to be matched. Name matching MUST be
+ case insensitive. (See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc7230#section-3.2).
+
+
+ If multiple entries specify equivalent header names, the first entry with
+ an equivalent name MUST be considered for a match. Subsequent entries
+ with an equivalent header name MUST be ignored. Due to the
+ case-insensitivity of header names, "foo" and "Foo" are considered
+ equivalent.
+ maxLength: 256
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[A-Za-z0-9!#$%&'*+\-.^_\x60|~]+$
+ type: string
+ value:
+ description: Value is the value of HTTP
+ Header to be matched.
+ maxLength: 4096
+ minLength: 1
+ type: string
+ required:
+ - name
+ - value
+ type: object
+ maxItems: 16
+ type: array
+ x-kubernetes-list-map-keys:
+ - name
+ x-kubernetes-list-type: map
+ type: object
+ requestMirror:
+ description: |-
+ RequestMirror defines a schema for a filter that mirrors requests.
+ Requests are sent to the specified destination, but responses from
+ that destination are ignored.
+
+
+ This filter can be used multiple times within the same rule. Note that
+ not all implementations will be able to support mirroring to multiple
+ backends.
+
+
+ Support: Extended
+ properties:
+ backendRef:
+ description: |-
+ BackendRef references a resource where mirrored requests are sent.
+
+
+ Mirrored requests must be sent only to a single destination endpoint
+ within this BackendRef, irrespective of how many endpoints are present
+ within this BackendRef.
+
+
+ If the referent cannot be found, this BackendRef is invalid and must be
+ dropped from the Gateway. The controller must ensure the "ResolvedRefs"
+ condition on the Route status is set to `status: False` and not configure
+ this backend in the underlying implementation.
+
+
+ If there is a cross-namespace reference to an *existing* object
+ that is not allowed by a ReferenceGrant, the controller must ensure the
+ "ResolvedRefs" condition on the Route is set to `status: False`,
+ with the "RefNotPermitted" reason and not configure this backend in the
+ underlying implementation.
+
+
+ In either error case, the Message of the `ResolvedRefs` Condition
+ should be used to provide more detail about the problem.
+
+
+ Support: Extended for Kubernetes Service
+
+
+ Support: Implementation-specific for any other resource
+ properties:
+ group:
+ default: ""
+ description: |-
+ Group is the group of the referent. For example, "gateway.networking.k8s.io".
+ When unspecified or empty string, core API group is inferred.
+ maxLength: 253
+ pattern: ^$|^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$
+ type: string
+ kind:
+ default: Service
+ description: |-
+ Kind is the Kubernetes resource kind of the referent. For example
+ "Service".
+
+
+ Defaults to "Service" when not specified.
+
+
+ ExternalName services can refer to CNAME DNS records that may live
+ outside of the cluster and as such are difficult to reason about in
+ terms of conformance. They also may not be safe to forward to (see
+ CVE-2021-25740 for more information). Implementations SHOULD NOT
+ support ExternalName Services.
+
+
+ Support: Core (Services with a type other than ExternalName)
+
+
+ Support: Implementation-specific (Services with type ExternalName)
+ maxLength: 63
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[a-zA-Z]([-a-zA-Z0-9]*[a-zA-Z0-9])?$
+ type: string
+ name:
+ description: Name is the name of the referent.
+ maxLength: 253
+ minLength: 1
+ type: string
+ namespace:
+ description: |-
+ Namespace is the namespace of the backend. When unspecified, the local
+ namespace is inferred.
+
+
+ Note that when a namespace different than the local namespace is specified,
+ a ReferenceGrant object is required in the referent namespace to allow that
+ namespace's owner to accept the reference. See the ReferenceGrant
+ documentation for details.
+
+
+ Support: Core
+ maxLength: 63
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?$
+ type: string
+ port:
+ description: |-
+ Port specifies the destination port number to use for this resource.
+ Port is required when the referent is a Kubernetes Service. In this
+ case, the port number is the service port number, not the target port.
+ For other resources, destination port might be derived from the referent
+ resource or this field.
+ format: int32
+ maximum: 65535
+ minimum: 1
+ type: integer
+ required:
+ - name
+ type: object
+ x-kubernetes-validations:
+ - message: Must have port for Service reference
+ rule: '(size(self.group) == 0 && self.kind
+ == ''Service'') ? has(self.port) : true'
+ required:
+ - backendRef
+ type: object
+ requestRedirect:
+ description: |-
+ RequestRedirect defines a schema for a filter that responds to the
+ request with an HTTP redirection.
+
+
+ Support: Core
+ properties:
+ hostname:
+ description: |-
+ Hostname is the hostname to be used in the value of the `Location`
+ header in the response.
+ When empty, the hostname in the `Host` header of the request is used.
+
+
+ Support: Core
+ maxLength: 253
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$
+ type: string
+ path:
+ description: |-
+ Path defines parameters used to modify the path of the incoming request.
+ The modified path is then used to construct the `Location` header. When
+ empty, the request path is used as-is.
+
+
+ Support: Extended
+ properties:
+ replaceFullPath:
+ description: |-
+ ReplaceFullPath specifies the value with which to replace the full path
+ of a request during a rewrite or redirect.
+ maxLength: 1024
+ type: string
+ replacePrefixMatch:
+ description: |-
+ ReplacePrefixMatch specifies the value with which to replace the prefix
+ match of a request during a rewrite or redirect. For example, a request
+ to "/foo/bar" with a prefix match of "/foo" and a ReplacePrefixMatch
+ of "/xyz" would be modified to "/xyz/bar".
+
+
+ Note that this matches the behavior of the PathPrefix match type. This
+ matches full path elements. A path element refers to the list of labels
+ in the path split by the `/` separator. When specified, a trailing `/` is
+ ignored. For example, the paths `/abc`, `/abc/`, and `/abc/def` would all
+ match the prefix `/abc`, but the path `/abcd` would not.
+
+
+ ReplacePrefixMatch is only compatible with a `PathPrefix` HTTPRouteMatch.
+ Using any other HTTPRouteMatch type on the same HTTPRouteRule will result in
+ the implementation setting the Accepted Condition for the Route to `status: False`.
+
+
+ Request Path | Prefix Match | Replace Prefix | Modified Path
+ -------------|--------------|----------------|----------
+ /foo/bar | /foo | /xyz | /xyz/bar
+ /foo/bar | /foo | /xyz/ | /xyz/bar
+ /foo/bar | /foo/ | /xyz | /xyz/bar
+ /foo/bar | /foo/ | /xyz/ | /xyz/bar
+ /foo | /foo | /xyz | /xyz
+ /foo/ | /foo | /xyz | /xyz/
+ /foo/bar | /foo | | /bar
+ /foo/ | /foo | | /
+ /foo | /foo | | /
+ /foo/ | /foo | / | /
+ /foo | /foo | / | /
+ maxLength: 1024
+ type: string
+ type:
+ description: |-
+ Type defines the type of path modifier. Additional types may be
+ added in a future release of the API.
+
+
+ Note that values may be added to this enum, implementations
+ must ensure that unknown values will not cause a crash.
+
+
+ Unknown values here must result in the implementation setting the
+ Accepted Condition for the Route to `status: False`, with a
+ Reason of `UnsupportedValue`.
+ enum:
+ - ReplaceFullPath
+ - ReplacePrefixMatch
+ type: string
+ required:
+ - type
+ type: object
+ x-kubernetes-validations:
+ - message: replaceFullPath must be specified
+ when type is set to 'ReplaceFullPath'
+ rule: 'self.type == ''ReplaceFullPath'' ?
+ has(self.replaceFullPath) : true'
+ - message: type must be 'ReplaceFullPath' when
+ replaceFullPath is set
+ rule: 'has(self.replaceFullPath) ? self.type
+ == ''ReplaceFullPath'' : true'
+ - message: replacePrefixMatch must be specified
+ when type is set to 'ReplacePrefixMatch'
+ rule: 'self.type == ''ReplacePrefixMatch''
+ ? has(self.replacePrefixMatch) : true'
+ - message: type must be 'ReplacePrefixMatch'
+ when replacePrefixMatch is set
+ rule: 'has(self.replacePrefixMatch) ? self.type
+ == ''ReplacePrefixMatch'' : true'
+ port:
+ description: |-
+ Port is the port to be used in the value of the `Location`
+ header in the response.
+
+
+ If no port is specified, the redirect port MUST be derived using the
+ following rules:
+
+
+ * If redirect scheme is not-empty, the redirect port MUST be the well-known
+ port associated with the redirect scheme. Specifically "http" to port 80
+ and "https" to port 443. If the redirect scheme does not have a
+ well-known port, the listener port of the Gateway SHOULD be used.
+ * If redirect scheme is empty, the redirect port MUST be the Gateway
+ Listener port.
+
+
+ Implementations SHOULD NOT add the port number in the 'Location'
+ header in the following cases:
+
+
+ * A Location header that will use HTTP (whether that is determined via
+ the Listener protocol or the Scheme field) _and_ use port 80.
+ * A Location header that will use HTTPS (whether that is determined via
+ the Listener protocol or the Scheme field) _and_ use port 443.
+
+
+ Support: Extended
+ format: int32
+ maximum: 65535
+ minimum: 1
+ type: integer
+ scheme:
+ description: |-
+ Scheme is the scheme to be used in the value of the `Location` header in
+ the response. When empty, the scheme of the request is used.
+
+
+ Scheme redirects can affect the port of the redirect, for more information,
+ refer to the documentation for the port field of this filter.
+
+
+ Note that values may be added to this enum, implementations
+ must ensure that unknown values will not cause a crash.
+
+
+ Unknown values here must result in the implementation setting the
+ Accepted Condition for the Route to `status: False`, with a
+ Reason of `UnsupportedValue`.
+
+
+ Support: Extended
+ enum:
+ - http
+ - https
+ type: string
+ statusCode:
+ default: 302
+ description: |-
+ StatusCode is the HTTP status code to be used in response.
+
+
+ Note that values may be added to this enum, implementations
+ must ensure that unknown values will not cause a crash.
+
+
+ Unknown values here must result in the implementation setting the
+ Accepted Condition for the Route to `status: False`, with a
+ Reason of `UnsupportedValue`.
+
+
+ Support: Core
+ enum:
+ - 301
+ - 302
+ type: integer
+ type: object
+ responseHeaderModifier:
+ description: |-
+ ResponseHeaderModifier defines a schema for a filter that modifies response
+ headers.
+
+
+ Support: Extended
+ properties:
+ add:
+ description: |-
+ Add adds the given header(s) (name, value) to the request
+ before the action. It appends to any existing values associated
+ with the header name.
+
+
+ Input:
+ GET /foo HTTP/1.1
+ my-header: foo
+
+
+ Config:
+ add:
+ - name: "my-header"
+ value: "bar,baz"
+
+
+ Output:
+ GET /foo HTTP/1.1
+ my-header: foo,bar,baz
+ items:
+ description: HTTPHeader represents an HTTP
+ Header name and value as defined by RFC
+ 7230.
+ properties:
+ name:
+ description: |-
+ Name is the name of the HTTP Header to be matched. Name matching MUST be
+ case insensitive. (See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc7230#section-3.2).
+
+
+ If multiple entries specify equivalent header names, the first entry with
+ an equivalent name MUST be considered for a match. Subsequent entries
+ with an equivalent header name MUST be ignored. Due to the
+ case-insensitivity of header names, "foo" and "Foo" are considered
+ equivalent.
+ maxLength: 256
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[A-Za-z0-9!#$%&'*+\-.^_\x60|~]+$
+ type: string
+ value:
+ description: Value is the value of HTTP
+ Header to be matched.
+ maxLength: 4096
+ minLength: 1
+ type: string
+ required:
+ - name
+ - value
+ type: object
+ maxItems: 16
+ type: array
+ x-kubernetes-list-map-keys:
+ - name
+ x-kubernetes-list-type: map
+ remove:
+ description: |-
+ Remove the given header(s) from the HTTP request before the action. The
+ value of Remove is a list of HTTP header names. Note that the header
+ names are case-insensitive (see
+ https://datatracker.ietf.org/doc/html/rfc2616#section-4.2).
+
+
+ Input:
+ GET /foo HTTP/1.1
+ my-header1: foo
+ my-header2: bar
+ my-header3: baz
+
+
+ Config:
+ remove: ["my-header1", "my-header3"]
+
+
+ Output:
+ GET /foo HTTP/1.1
+ my-header2: bar
+ items:
+ type: string
+ maxItems: 16
+ type: array
+ x-kubernetes-list-type: set
+ set:
+ description: |-
+ Set overwrites the request with the given header (name, value)
+ before the action.
+
+
+ Input:
+ GET /foo HTTP/1.1
+ my-header: foo
+
+
+ Config:
+ set:
+ - name: "my-header"
+ value: "bar"
+
+
+ Output:
+ GET /foo HTTP/1.1
+ my-header: bar
+ items:
+ description: HTTPHeader represents an HTTP
+ Header name and value as defined by RFC
+ 7230.
+ properties:
+ name:
+ description: |-
+ Name is the name of the HTTP Header to be matched. Name matching MUST be
+ case insensitive. (See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc7230#section-3.2).
+
+
+ If multiple entries specify equivalent header names, the first entry with
+ an equivalent name MUST be considered for a match. Subsequent entries
+ with an equivalent header name MUST be ignored. Due to the
+ case-insensitivity of header names, "foo" and "Foo" are considered
+ equivalent.
+ maxLength: 256
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[A-Za-z0-9!#$%&'*+\-.^_\x60|~]+$
+ type: string
+ value:
+ description: Value is the value of HTTP
+ Header to be matched.
+ maxLength: 4096
+ minLength: 1
+ type: string
+ required:
+ - name
+ - value
+ type: object
+ maxItems: 16
+ type: array
+ x-kubernetes-list-map-keys:
+ - name
+ x-kubernetes-list-type: map
+ type: object
+ type:
+ description: |-
+ Type identifies the type of filter to apply. As with other API fields,
+ types are classified into three conformance levels:
+
+
+ - Core: Filter types and their corresponding configuration defined by
+ "Support: Core" in this package, e.g. "RequestHeaderModifier". All
+ implementations must support core filters.
+
+
+ - Extended: Filter types and their corresponding configuration defined by
+ "Support: Extended" in this package, e.g. "RequestMirror". Implementers
+ are encouraged to support extended filters.
+
+
+ - Implementation-specific: Filters that are defined and supported by
+ specific vendors.
+ In the future, filters showing convergence in behavior across multiple
+ implementations will be considered for inclusion in extended or core
+ conformance levels. Filter-specific configuration for such filters
+ is specified using the ExtensionRef field. `Type` should be set to
+ "ExtensionRef" for custom filters.
+
+
+ Implementers are encouraged to define custom implementation types to
+ extend the core API with implementation-specific behavior.
+
+
+ If a reference to a custom filter type cannot be resolved, the filter
+ MUST NOT be skipped. Instead, requests that would have been processed by
+ that filter MUST receive a HTTP error response.
+
+
+ Note that values may be added to this enum, implementations
+ must ensure that unknown values will not cause a crash.
+
+
+ Unknown values here must result in the implementation setting the
+ Accepted Condition for the Route to `status: False`, with a
+ Reason of `UnsupportedValue`.
+ enum:
+ - RequestHeaderModifier
+ - ResponseHeaderModifier
+ - RequestMirror
+ - RequestRedirect
+ - URLRewrite
+ - ExtensionRef
+ type: string
+ urlRewrite:
+ description: |-
+ URLRewrite defines a schema for a filter that modifies a request during forwarding.
+
+
+ Support: Extended
+ properties:
+ hostname:
+ description: |-
+ Hostname is the value to be used to replace the Host header value during
+ forwarding.
+
+
+ Support: Extended
+ maxLength: 253
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$
+ type: string
+ path:
+ description: |-
+ Path defines a path rewrite.
+
+
+ Support: Extended
+ properties:
+ replaceFullPath:
+ description: |-
+ ReplaceFullPath specifies the value with which to replace the full path
+ of a request during a rewrite or redirect.
+ maxLength: 1024
+ type: string
+ replacePrefixMatch:
+ description: |-
+ ReplacePrefixMatch specifies the value with which to replace the prefix
+ match of a request during a rewrite or redirect. For example, a request
+ to "/foo/bar" with a prefix match of "/foo" and a ReplacePrefixMatch
+ of "/xyz" would be modified to "/xyz/bar".
+
+
+ Note that this matches the behavior of the PathPrefix match type. This
+ matches full path elements. A path element refers to the list of labels
+ in the path split by the `/` separator. When specified, a trailing `/` is
+ ignored. For example, the paths `/abc`, `/abc/`, and `/abc/def` would all
+ match the prefix `/abc`, but the path `/abcd` would not.
+
+
+ ReplacePrefixMatch is only compatible with a `PathPrefix` HTTPRouteMatch.
+ Using any other HTTPRouteMatch type on the same HTTPRouteRule will result in
+ the implementation setting the Accepted Condition for the Route to `status: False`.
+
+
+ Request Path | Prefix Match | Replace Prefix | Modified Path
+ -------------|--------------|----------------|----------
+ /foo/bar | /foo | /xyz | /xyz/bar
+ /foo/bar | /foo | /xyz/ | /xyz/bar
+ /foo/bar | /foo/ | /xyz | /xyz/bar
+ /foo/bar | /foo/ | /xyz/ | /xyz/bar
+ /foo | /foo | /xyz | /xyz
+ /foo/ | /foo | /xyz | /xyz/
+ /foo/bar | /foo | | /bar
+ /foo/ | /foo | | /
+ /foo | /foo | | /
+ /foo/ | /foo | / | /
+ /foo | /foo | / | /
+ maxLength: 1024
+ type: string
+ type:
+ description: |-
+ Type defines the type of path modifier. Additional types may be
+ added in a future release of the API.
+
+
+ Note that values may be added to this enum, implementations
+ must ensure that unknown values will not cause a crash.
+
+
+ Unknown values here must result in the implementation setting the
+ Accepted Condition for the Route to `status: False`, with a
+ Reason of `UnsupportedValue`.
+ enum:
+ - ReplaceFullPath
+ - ReplacePrefixMatch
+ type: string
+ required:
+ - type
+ type: object
+ x-kubernetes-validations:
+ - message: replaceFullPath must be specified
+ when type is set to 'ReplaceFullPath'
+ rule: 'self.type == ''ReplaceFullPath'' ?
+ has(self.replaceFullPath) : true'
+ - message: type must be 'ReplaceFullPath' when
+ replaceFullPath is set
+ rule: 'has(self.replaceFullPath) ? self.type
+ == ''ReplaceFullPath'' : true'
+ - message: replacePrefixMatch must be specified
+ when type is set to 'ReplacePrefixMatch'
+ rule: 'self.type == ''ReplacePrefixMatch''
+ ? has(self.replacePrefixMatch) : true'
+ - message: type must be 'ReplacePrefixMatch'
+ when replacePrefixMatch is set
+ rule: 'has(self.replacePrefixMatch) ? self.type
+ == ''ReplacePrefixMatch'' : true'
+ type: object
+ required:
+ - type
+ type: object
+ x-kubernetes-validations:
+ - message: filter.requestHeaderModifier must be nil
+ if the filter.type is not RequestHeaderModifier
+ rule: '!(has(self.requestHeaderModifier) && self.type
+ != ''RequestHeaderModifier'')'
+ - message: filter.requestHeaderModifier must be specified
+ for RequestHeaderModifier filter.type
+ rule: '!(!has(self.requestHeaderModifier) && self.type
+ == ''RequestHeaderModifier'')'
+ - message: filter.responseHeaderModifier must be nil
+ if the filter.type is not ResponseHeaderModifier
+ rule: '!(has(self.responseHeaderModifier) && self.type
+ != ''ResponseHeaderModifier'')'
+ - message: filter.responseHeaderModifier must be specified
+ for ResponseHeaderModifier filter.type
+ rule: '!(!has(self.responseHeaderModifier) && self.type
+ == ''ResponseHeaderModifier'')'
+ - message: filter.requestMirror must be nil if the filter.type
+ is not RequestMirror
+ rule: '!(has(self.requestMirror) && self.type != ''RequestMirror'')'
+ - message: filter.requestMirror must be specified for
+ RequestMirror filter.type
+ rule: '!(!has(self.requestMirror) && self.type ==
+ ''RequestMirror'')'
+ - message: filter.requestRedirect must be nil if the
+ filter.type is not RequestRedirect
+ rule: '!(has(self.requestRedirect) && self.type !=
+ ''RequestRedirect'')'
+ - message: filter.requestRedirect must be specified
+ for RequestRedirect filter.type
+ rule: '!(!has(self.requestRedirect) && self.type ==
+ ''RequestRedirect'')'
+ - message: filter.urlRewrite must be nil if the filter.type
+ is not URLRewrite
+ rule: '!(has(self.urlRewrite) && self.type != ''URLRewrite'')'
+ - message: filter.urlRewrite must be specified for URLRewrite
+ filter.type
+ rule: '!(!has(self.urlRewrite) && self.type == ''URLRewrite'')'
+ - message: filter.extensionRef must be nil if the filter.type
+ is not ExtensionRef
+ rule: '!(has(self.extensionRef) && self.type != ''ExtensionRef'')'
+ - message: filter.extensionRef must be specified for
+ ExtensionRef filter.type
+ rule: '!(!has(self.extensionRef) && self.type == ''ExtensionRef'')'
+ maxItems: 16
+ type: array
+ x-kubernetes-validations:
+ - message: May specify either httpRouteFilterRequestRedirect
+ or httpRouteFilterRequestRewrite, but not both
+ rule: '!(self.exists(f, f.type == ''RequestRedirect'')
+ && self.exists(f, f.type == ''URLRewrite''))'
+ - message: May specify either httpRouteFilterRequestRedirect
+ or httpRouteFilterRequestRewrite, but not both
+ rule: '!(self.exists(f, f.type == ''RequestRedirect'')
+ && self.exists(f, f.type == ''URLRewrite''))'
+ - message: RequestHeaderModifier filter cannot be repeated
+ rule: self.filter(f, f.type == 'RequestHeaderModifier').size()
+ <= 1
+ - message: ResponseHeaderModifier filter cannot be repeated
+ rule: self.filter(f, f.type == 'ResponseHeaderModifier').size()
+ <= 1
+ - message: RequestRedirect filter cannot be repeated
+ rule: self.filter(f, f.type == 'RequestRedirect').size()
+ <= 1
+ - message: URLRewrite filter cannot be repeated
+ rule: self.filter(f, f.type == 'URLRewrite').size()
+ <= 1
+ group:
+ default: ""
+ description: |-
+ Group is the group of the referent. For example, "gateway.networking.k8s.io".
+ When unspecified or empty string, core API group is inferred.
+ maxLength: 253
+ pattern: ^$|^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$
+ type: string
+ kind:
+ default: Service
+ description: |-
+ Kind is the Kubernetes resource kind of the referent. For example
+ "Service".
+
+
+ Defaults to "Service" when not specified.
+
+
+ ExternalName services can refer to CNAME DNS records that may live
+ outside of the cluster and as such are difficult to reason about in
+ terms of conformance. They also may not be safe to forward to (see
+ CVE-2021-25740 for more information). Implementations SHOULD NOT
+ support ExternalName Services.
+
+
+ Support: Core (Services with a type other than ExternalName)
+
+
+ Support: Implementation-specific (Services with type ExternalName)
+ maxLength: 63
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[a-zA-Z]([-a-zA-Z0-9]*[a-zA-Z0-9])?$
+ type: string
+ name:
+ description: Name is the name of the referent.
+ maxLength: 253
+ minLength: 1
+ type: string
+ namespace:
+ description: |-
+ Namespace is the namespace of the backend. When unspecified, the local
+ namespace is inferred.
+
+
+ Note that when a namespace different than the local namespace is specified,
+ a ReferenceGrant object is required in the referent namespace to allow that
+ namespace's owner to accept the reference. See the ReferenceGrant
+ documentation for details.
+
+
+ Support: Core
+ maxLength: 63
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?$
+ type: string
+ port:
+ description: |-
+ Port specifies the destination port number to use for this resource.
+ Port is required when the referent is a Kubernetes Service. In this
+ case, the port number is the service port number, not the target port.
+ For other resources, destination port might be derived from the referent
+ resource or this field.
+ format: int32
+ maximum: 65535
+ minimum: 1
+ type: integer
+ weight:
+ default: 1
+ description: |-
+ Weight specifies the proportion of requests forwarded to the referenced
+ backend. This is computed as weight/(sum of all weights in this
+ BackendRefs list). For non-zero values, there may be some epsilon from
+ the exact proportion defined here depending on the precision an
+ implementation supports. Weight is not a percentage and the sum of
+ weights does not need to equal 100.
+
+
+ If only one backend is specified and it has a weight greater than 0, 100%
+ of the traffic is forwarded to that backend. If weight is set to 0, no
+ traffic should be forwarded for this entry. If unspecified, weight
+ defaults to 1.
+
+
+ Support for this field varies based on the context where used.
+ format: int32
+ maximum: 1000000
+ minimum: 0
+ type: integer
+ required:
+ - name
+ type: object
+ x-kubernetes-validations:
+ - message: Must have port for Service reference
+ rule: '(size(self.group) == 0 && self.kind == ''Service'')
+ ? has(self.port) : true'
+ maxItems: 16
+ type: array
+ filters:
+ description: |-
+ Filters define the filters that are applied to requests that match
+ this rule.
+
+
+ Wherever possible, implementations SHOULD implement filters in the order
+ they are specified.
+
+
+ Implementations MAY choose to implement this ordering strictly, rejecting
+ any combination or order of filters that can not be supported. If implementations
+ choose a strict interpretation of filter ordering, they MUST clearly document
+ that behavior.
+
+
+ To reject an invalid combination or order of filters, implementations SHOULD
+ consider the Route Rules with this configuration invalid. If all Route Rules
+ in a Route are invalid, the entire Route would be considered invalid. If only
+ a portion of Route Rules are invalid, implementations MUST set the
+ "PartiallyInvalid" condition for the Route.
+
+
+ Conformance-levels at this level are defined based on the type of filter:
+
+
+ - ALL core filters MUST be supported by all implementations.
+ - Implementers are encouraged to support extended filters.
+ - Implementation-specific custom filters have no API guarantees across
+ implementations.
+
+
+ Specifying the same filter multiple times is not supported unless explicitly
+ indicated in the filter.
+
+
+ All filters are expected to be compatible with each other except for the
+ URLRewrite and RequestRedirect filters, which may not be combined. If an
+ implementation can not support other combinations of filters, they must clearly
+ document that limitation. In cases where incompatible or unsupported
+ filters are specified and cause the `Accepted` condition to be set to status
+ `False`, implementations may use the `IncompatibleFilters` reason to specify
+ this configuration error.
+
+
+ Support: Core
+ items:
+ description: |-
+ HTTPRouteFilter defines processing steps that must be completed during the
+ request or response lifecycle. HTTPRouteFilters are meant as an extension
+ point to express processing that may be done in Gateway implementations. Some
+ examples include request or response modification, implementing
+ authentication strategies, rate-limiting, and traffic shaping. API
+ guarantee/conformance is defined based on the type of the filter.
+ properties:
+ extensionRef:
+ description: |-
+ ExtensionRef is an optional, implementation-specific extension to the
+ "filter" behavior. For example, resource "myroutefilter" in group
+ "networking.example.net"). ExtensionRef MUST NOT be used for core and
+ extended filters.
+
+
+ This filter can be used multiple times within the same rule.
+
+
+ Support: Implementation-specific
+ properties:
+ group:
+ description: |-
+ Group is the group of the referent. For example, "gateway.networking.k8s.io".
+ When unspecified or empty string, core API group is inferred.
+ maxLength: 253
+ pattern: ^$|^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$
+ type: string
+ kind:
+ description: Kind is kind of the referent. For example
+ "HTTPRoute" or "Service".
+ maxLength: 63
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[a-zA-Z]([-a-zA-Z0-9]*[a-zA-Z0-9])?$
+ type: string
+ name:
+ description: Name is the name of the referent.
+ maxLength: 253
+ minLength: 1
+ type: string
+ required:
+ - group
+ - kind
+ - name
+ type: object
+ requestHeaderModifier:
+ description: |-
+ RequestHeaderModifier defines a schema for a filter that modifies request
+ headers.
+
+
+ Support: Core
+ properties:
+ add:
+ description: |-
+ Add adds the given header(s) (name, value) to the request
+ before the action. It appends to any existing values associated
+ with the header name.
+
+
+ Input:
+ GET /foo HTTP/1.1
+ my-header: foo
+
+
+ Config:
+ add:
+ - name: "my-header"
+ value: "bar,baz"
+
+
+ Output:
+ GET /foo HTTP/1.1
+ my-header: foo,bar,baz
+ items:
+ description: HTTPHeader represents an HTTP Header
+ name and value as defined by RFC 7230.
+ properties:
+ name:
+ description: |-
+ Name is the name of the HTTP Header to be matched. Name matching MUST be
+ case insensitive. (See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc7230#section-3.2).
+
+
+ If multiple entries specify equivalent header names, the first entry with
+ an equivalent name MUST be considered for a match. Subsequent entries
+ with an equivalent header name MUST be ignored. Due to the
+ case-insensitivity of header names, "foo" and "Foo" are considered
+ equivalent.
+ maxLength: 256
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[A-Za-z0-9!#$%&'*+\-.^_\x60|~]+$
+ type: string
+ value:
+ description: Value is the value of HTTP Header
+ to be matched.
+ maxLength: 4096
+ minLength: 1
+ type: string
+ required:
+ - name
+ - value
+ type: object
+ maxItems: 16
+ type: array
+ x-kubernetes-list-map-keys:
+ - name
+ x-kubernetes-list-type: map
+ remove:
+ description: |-
+ Remove the given header(s) from the HTTP request before the action. The
+ value of Remove is a list of HTTP header names. Note that the header
+ names are case-insensitive (see
+ https://datatracker.ietf.org/doc/html/rfc2616#section-4.2).
+
+
+ Input:
+ GET /foo HTTP/1.1
+ my-header1: foo
+ my-header2: bar
+ my-header3: baz
+
+
+ Config:
+ remove: ["my-header1", "my-header3"]
+
+
+ Output:
+ GET /foo HTTP/1.1
+ my-header2: bar
+ items:
+ type: string
+ maxItems: 16
+ type: array
+ x-kubernetes-list-type: set
+ set:
+ description: |-
+ Set overwrites the request with the given header (name, value)
+ before the action.
+
+
+ Input:
+ GET /foo HTTP/1.1
+ my-header: foo
+
+
+ Config:
+ set:
+ - name: "my-header"
+ value: "bar"
+
+
+ Output:
+ GET /foo HTTP/1.1
+ my-header: bar
+ items:
+ description: HTTPHeader represents an HTTP Header
+ name and value as defined by RFC 7230.
+ properties:
+ name:
+ description: |-
+ Name is the name of the HTTP Header to be matched. Name matching MUST be
+ case insensitive. (See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc7230#section-3.2).
+
+
+ If multiple entries specify equivalent header names, the first entry with
+ an equivalent name MUST be considered for a match. Subsequent entries
+ with an equivalent header name MUST be ignored. Due to the
+ case-insensitivity of header names, "foo" and "Foo" are considered
+ equivalent.
+ maxLength: 256
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[A-Za-z0-9!#$%&'*+\-.^_\x60|~]+$
+ type: string
+ value:
+ description: Value is the value of HTTP Header
+ to be matched.
+ maxLength: 4096
+ minLength: 1
+ type: string
+ required:
+ - name
+ - value
+ type: object
+ maxItems: 16
+ type: array
+ x-kubernetes-list-map-keys:
+ - name
+ x-kubernetes-list-type: map
+ type: object
+ requestMirror:
+ description: |-
+ RequestMirror defines a schema for a filter that mirrors requests.
+ Requests are sent to the specified destination, but responses from
+ that destination are ignored.
+
+
+ This filter can be used multiple times within the same rule. Note that
+ not all implementations will be able to support mirroring to multiple
+ backends.
+
+
+ Support: Extended
+ properties:
+ backendRef:
+ description: |-
+ BackendRef references a resource where mirrored requests are sent.
+
+
+ Mirrored requests must be sent only to a single destination endpoint
+ within this BackendRef, irrespective of how many endpoints are present
+ within this BackendRef.
+
+
+ If the referent cannot be found, this BackendRef is invalid and must be
+ dropped from the Gateway. The controller must ensure the "ResolvedRefs"
+ condition on the Route status is set to `status: False` and not configure
+ this backend in the underlying implementation.
+
+
+ If there is a cross-namespace reference to an *existing* object
+ that is not allowed by a ReferenceGrant, the controller must ensure the
+ "ResolvedRefs" condition on the Route is set to `status: False`,
+ with the "RefNotPermitted" reason and not configure this backend in the
+ underlying implementation.
+
+
+ In either error case, the Message of the `ResolvedRefs` Condition
+ should be used to provide more detail about the problem.
+
+
+ Support: Extended for Kubernetes Service
+
+
+ Support: Implementation-specific for any other resource
+ properties:
+ group:
+ default: ""
+ description: |-
+ Group is the group of the referent. For example, "gateway.networking.k8s.io".
+ When unspecified or empty string, core API group is inferred.
+ maxLength: 253
+ pattern: ^$|^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$
+ type: string
+ kind:
+ default: Service
+ description: |-
+ Kind is the Kubernetes resource kind of the referent. For example
+ "Service".
+
+
+ Defaults to "Service" when not specified.
+
+
+ ExternalName services can refer to CNAME DNS records that may live
+ outside of the cluster and as such are difficult to reason about in
+ terms of conformance. They also may not be safe to forward to (see
+ CVE-2021-25740 for more information). Implementations SHOULD NOT
+ support ExternalName Services.
+
+
+ Support: Core (Services with a type other than ExternalName)
+
+
+ Support: Implementation-specific (Services with type ExternalName)
+ maxLength: 63
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[a-zA-Z]([-a-zA-Z0-9]*[a-zA-Z0-9])?$
+ type: string
+ name:
+ description: Name is the name of the referent.
+ maxLength: 253
+ minLength: 1
+ type: string
+ namespace:
+ description: |-
+ Namespace is the namespace of the backend. When unspecified, the local
+ namespace is inferred.
+
+
+ Note that when a namespace different than the local namespace is specified,
+ a ReferenceGrant object is required in the referent namespace to allow that
+ namespace's owner to accept the reference. See the ReferenceGrant
+ documentation for details.
+
+
+ Support: Core
+ maxLength: 63
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?$
+ type: string
+ port:
+ description: |-
+ Port specifies the destination port number to use for this resource.
+ Port is required when the referent is a Kubernetes Service. In this
+ case, the port number is the service port number, not the target port.
+ For other resources, destination port might be derived from the referent
+ resource or this field.
+ format: int32
+ maximum: 65535
+ minimum: 1
+ type: integer
+ required:
+ - name
+ type: object
+ x-kubernetes-validations:
+ - message: Must have port for Service reference
+ rule: '(size(self.group) == 0 && self.kind == ''Service'')
+ ? has(self.port) : true'
+ required:
+ - backendRef
+ type: object
+ requestRedirect:
+ description: |-
+ RequestRedirect defines a schema for a filter that responds to the
+ request with an HTTP redirection.
+
+
+ Support: Core
+ properties:
+ hostname:
+ description: |-
+ Hostname is the hostname to be used in the value of the `Location`
+ header in the response.
+ When empty, the hostname in the `Host` header of the request is used.
+
+
+ Support: Core
+ maxLength: 253
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$
+ type: string
+ path:
+ description: |-
+ Path defines parameters used to modify the path of the incoming request.
+ The modified path is then used to construct the `Location` header. When
+ empty, the request path is used as-is.
+
+
+ Support: Extended
+ properties:
+ replaceFullPath:
+ description: |-
+ ReplaceFullPath specifies the value with which to replace the full path
+ of a request during a rewrite or redirect.
+ maxLength: 1024
+ type: string
+ replacePrefixMatch:
+ description: |-
+ ReplacePrefixMatch specifies the value with which to replace the prefix
+ match of a request during a rewrite or redirect. For example, a request
+ to "/foo/bar" with a prefix match of "/foo" and a ReplacePrefixMatch
+ of "/xyz" would be modified to "/xyz/bar".
+
+
+ Note that this matches the behavior of the PathPrefix match type. This
+ matches full path elements. A path element refers to the list of labels
+ in the path split by the `/` separator. When specified, a trailing `/` is
+ ignored. For example, the paths `/abc`, `/abc/`, and `/abc/def` would all
+ match the prefix `/abc`, but the path `/abcd` would not.
+
+
+ ReplacePrefixMatch is only compatible with a `PathPrefix` HTTPRouteMatch.
+ Using any other HTTPRouteMatch type on the same HTTPRouteRule will result in
+ the implementation setting the Accepted Condition for the Route to `status: False`.
+
+
+ Request Path | Prefix Match | Replace Prefix | Modified Path
+ -------------|--------------|----------------|----------
+ /foo/bar | /foo | /xyz | /xyz/bar
+ /foo/bar | /foo | /xyz/ | /xyz/bar
+ /foo/bar | /foo/ | /xyz | /xyz/bar
+ /foo/bar | /foo/ | /xyz/ | /xyz/bar
+ /foo | /foo | /xyz | /xyz
+ /foo/ | /foo | /xyz | /xyz/
+ /foo/bar | /foo | | /bar
+ /foo/ | /foo | | /
+ /foo | /foo | | /
+ /foo/ | /foo | / | /
+ /foo | /foo | / | /
+ maxLength: 1024
+ type: string
+ type:
+ description: |-
+ Type defines the type of path modifier. Additional types may be
+ added in a future release of the API.
+
+
+ Note that values may be added to this enum, implementations
+ must ensure that unknown values will not cause a crash.
+
+
+ Unknown values here must result in the implementation setting the
+ Accepted Condition for the Route to `status: False`, with a
+ Reason of `UnsupportedValue`.
+ enum:
+ - ReplaceFullPath
+ - ReplacePrefixMatch
+ type: string
+ required:
+ - type
+ type: object
+ x-kubernetes-validations:
+ - message: replaceFullPath must be specified when
+ type is set to 'ReplaceFullPath'
+ rule: 'self.type == ''ReplaceFullPath'' ? has(self.replaceFullPath)
+ : true'
+ - message: type must be 'ReplaceFullPath' when replaceFullPath
+ is set
+ rule: 'has(self.replaceFullPath) ? self.type ==
+ ''ReplaceFullPath'' : true'
+ - message: replacePrefixMatch must be specified when
+ type is set to 'ReplacePrefixMatch'
+ rule: 'self.type == ''ReplacePrefixMatch'' ? has(self.replacePrefixMatch)
+ : true'
+ - message: type must be 'ReplacePrefixMatch' when
+ replacePrefixMatch is set
+ rule: 'has(self.replacePrefixMatch) ? self.type
+ == ''ReplacePrefixMatch'' : true'
+ port:
+ description: |-
+ Port is the port to be used in the value of the `Location`
+ header in the response.
+
+
+ If no port is specified, the redirect port MUST be derived using the
+ following rules:
+
+
+ * If redirect scheme is not-empty, the redirect port MUST be the well-known
+ port associated with the redirect scheme. Specifically "http" to port 80
+ and "https" to port 443. If the redirect scheme does not have a
+ well-known port, the listener port of the Gateway SHOULD be used.
+ * If redirect scheme is empty, the redirect port MUST be the Gateway
+ Listener port.
+
+
+ Implementations SHOULD NOT add the port number in the 'Location'
+ header in the following cases:
+
+
+ * A Location header that will use HTTP (whether that is determined via
+ the Listener protocol or the Scheme field) _and_ use port 80.
+ * A Location header that will use HTTPS (whether that is determined via
+ the Listener protocol or the Scheme field) _and_ use port 443.
+
+
+ Support: Extended
+ format: int32
+ maximum: 65535
+ minimum: 1
+ type: integer
+ scheme:
+ description: |-
+ Scheme is the scheme to be used in the value of the `Location` header in
+ the response. When empty, the scheme of the request is used.
+
+
+ Scheme redirects can affect the port of the redirect, for more information,
+ refer to the documentation for the port field of this filter.
+
+
+ Note that values may be added to this enum, implementations
+ must ensure that unknown values will not cause a crash.
+
+
+ Unknown values here must result in the implementation setting the
+ Accepted Condition for the Route to `status: False`, with a
+ Reason of `UnsupportedValue`.
+
+
+ Support: Extended
+ enum:
+ - http
+ - https
+ type: string
+ statusCode:
+ default: 302
+ description: |-
+ StatusCode is the HTTP status code to be used in response.
+
+
+ Note that values may be added to this enum, implementations
+ must ensure that unknown values will not cause a crash.
+
+
+ Unknown values here must result in the implementation setting the
+ Accepted Condition for the Route to `status: False`, with a
+ Reason of `UnsupportedValue`.
+
+
+ Support: Core
+ enum:
+ - 301
+ - 302
+ type: integer
+ type: object
+ responseHeaderModifier:
+ description: |-
+ ResponseHeaderModifier defines a schema for a filter that modifies response
+ headers.
+
+
+ Support: Extended
+ properties:
+ add:
+ description: |-
+ Add adds the given header(s) (name, value) to the request
+ before the action. It appends to any existing values associated
+ with the header name.
+
+
+ Input:
+ GET /foo HTTP/1.1
+ my-header: foo
+
+
+ Config:
+ add:
+ - name: "my-header"
+ value: "bar,baz"
+
+
+ Output:
+ GET /foo HTTP/1.1
+ my-header: foo,bar,baz
+ items:
+ description: HTTPHeader represents an HTTP Header
+ name and value as defined by RFC 7230.
+ properties:
+ name:
+ description: |-
+ Name is the name of the HTTP Header to be matched. Name matching MUST be
+ case insensitive. (See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc7230#section-3.2).
+
+
+ If multiple entries specify equivalent header names, the first entry with
+ an equivalent name MUST be considered for a match. Subsequent entries
+ with an equivalent header name MUST be ignored. Due to the
+ case-insensitivity of header names, "foo" and "Foo" are considered
+ equivalent.
+ maxLength: 256
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[A-Za-z0-9!#$%&'*+\-.^_\x60|~]+$
+ type: string
+ value:
+ description: Value is the value of HTTP Header
+ to be matched.
+ maxLength: 4096
+ minLength: 1
+ type: string
+ required:
+ - name
+ - value
+ type: object
+ maxItems: 16
+ type: array
+ x-kubernetes-list-map-keys:
+ - name
+ x-kubernetes-list-type: map
+ remove:
+ description: |-
+ Remove the given header(s) from the HTTP request before the action. The
+ value of Remove is a list of HTTP header names. Note that the header
+ names are case-insensitive (see
+ https://datatracker.ietf.org/doc/html/rfc2616#section-4.2).
+
+
+ Input:
+ GET /foo HTTP/1.1
+ my-header1: foo
+ my-header2: bar
+ my-header3: baz
+
+
+ Config:
+ remove: ["my-header1", "my-header3"]
+
+
+ Output:
+ GET /foo HTTP/1.1
+ my-header2: bar
+ items:
+ type: string
+ maxItems: 16
+ type: array
+ x-kubernetes-list-type: set
+ set:
+ description: |-
+ Set overwrites the request with the given header (name, value)
+ before the action.
+
+
+ Input:
+ GET /foo HTTP/1.1
+ my-header: foo
+
+
+ Config:
+ set:
+ - name: "my-header"
+ value: "bar"
+
+
+ Output:
+ GET /foo HTTP/1.1
+ my-header: bar
+ items:
+ description: HTTPHeader represents an HTTP Header
+ name and value as defined by RFC 7230.
+ properties:
+ name:
+ description: |-
+ Name is the name of the HTTP Header to be matched. Name matching MUST be
+ case insensitive. (See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc7230#section-3.2).
+
+
+ If multiple entries specify equivalent header names, the first entry with
+ an equivalent name MUST be considered for a match. Subsequent entries
+ with an equivalent header name MUST be ignored. Due to the
+ case-insensitivity of header names, "foo" and "Foo" are considered
+ equivalent.
+ maxLength: 256
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[A-Za-z0-9!#$%&'*+\-.^_\x60|~]+$
+ type: string
+ value:
+ description: Value is the value of HTTP Header
+ to be matched.
+ maxLength: 4096
+ minLength: 1
+ type: string
+ required:
+ - name
+ - value
+ type: object
+ maxItems: 16
+ type: array
+ x-kubernetes-list-map-keys:
+ - name
+ x-kubernetes-list-type: map
+ type: object
+ type:
+ description: |-
+ Type identifies the type of filter to apply. As with other API fields,
+ types are classified into three conformance levels:
+
+
+ - Core: Filter types and their corresponding configuration defined by
+ "Support: Core" in this package, e.g. "RequestHeaderModifier". All
+ implementations must support core filters.
+
+
+ - Extended: Filter types and their corresponding configuration defined by
+ "Support: Extended" in this package, e.g. "RequestMirror". Implementers
+ are encouraged to support extended filters.
+
+
+ - Implementation-specific: Filters that are defined and supported by
+ specific vendors.
+ In the future, filters showing convergence in behavior across multiple
+ implementations will be considered for inclusion in extended or core
+ conformance levels. Filter-specific configuration for such filters
+ is specified using the ExtensionRef field. `Type` should be set to
+ "ExtensionRef" for custom filters.
+
+
+ Implementers are encouraged to define custom implementation types to
+ extend the core API with implementation-specific behavior.
+
+
+ If a reference to a custom filter type cannot be resolved, the filter
+ MUST NOT be skipped. Instead, requests that would have been processed by
+ that filter MUST receive a HTTP error response.
+
+
+ Note that values may be added to this enum, implementations
+ must ensure that unknown values will not cause a crash.
+
+
+ Unknown values here must result in the implementation setting the
+ Accepted Condition for the Route to `status: False`, with a
+ Reason of `UnsupportedValue`.
+ enum:
+ - RequestHeaderModifier
+ - ResponseHeaderModifier
+ - RequestMirror
+ - RequestRedirect
+ - URLRewrite
+ - ExtensionRef
+ type: string
+ urlRewrite:
+ description: |-
+ URLRewrite defines a schema for a filter that modifies a request during forwarding.
+
+
+ Support: Extended
+ properties:
+ hostname:
+ description: |-
+ Hostname is the value to be used to replace the Host header value during
+ forwarding.
+
+
+ Support: Extended
+ maxLength: 253
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$
+ type: string
+ path:
+ description: |-
+ Path defines a path rewrite.
+
+
+ Support: Extended
+ properties:
+ replaceFullPath:
+ description: |-
+ ReplaceFullPath specifies the value with which to replace the full path
+ of a request during a rewrite or redirect.
+ maxLength: 1024
+ type: string
+ replacePrefixMatch:
+ description: |-
+ ReplacePrefixMatch specifies the value with which to replace the prefix
+ match of a request during a rewrite or redirect. For example, a request
+ to "/foo/bar" with a prefix match of "/foo" and a ReplacePrefixMatch
+ of "/xyz" would be modified to "/xyz/bar".
+
+
+ Note that this matches the behavior of the PathPrefix match type. This
+ matches full path elements. A path element refers to the list of labels
+ in the path split by the `/` separator. When specified, a trailing `/` is
+ ignored. For example, the paths `/abc`, `/abc/`, and `/abc/def` would all
+ match the prefix `/abc`, but the path `/abcd` would not.
+
+
+ ReplacePrefixMatch is only compatible with a `PathPrefix` HTTPRouteMatch.
+ Using any other HTTPRouteMatch type on the same HTTPRouteRule will result in
+ the implementation setting the Accepted Condition for the Route to `status: False`.
+
+
+ Request Path | Prefix Match | Replace Prefix | Modified Path
+ -------------|--------------|----------------|----------
+ /foo/bar | /foo | /xyz | /xyz/bar
+ /foo/bar | /foo | /xyz/ | /xyz/bar
+ /foo/bar | /foo/ | /xyz | /xyz/bar
+ /foo/bar | /foo/ | /xyz/ | /xyz/bar
+ /foo | /foo | /xyz | /xyz
+ /foo/ | /foo | /xyz | /xyz/
+ /foo/bar | /foo | | /bar
+ /foo/ | /foo | | /
+ /foo | /foo | | /
+ /foo/ | /foo | / | /
+ /foo | /foo | / | /
+ maxLength: 1024
+ type: string
+ type:
+ description: |-
+ Type defines the type of path modifier. Additional types may be
+ added in a future release of the API.
+
+
+ Note that values may be added to this enum, implementations
+ must ensure that unknown values will not cause a crash.
+
+
+ Unknown values here must result in the implementation setting the
+ Accepted Condition for the Route to `status: False`, with a
+ Reason of `UnsupportedValue`.
+ enum:
+ - ReplaceFullPath
+ - ReplacePrefixMatch
+ type: string
+ required:
+ - type
+ type: object
+ x-kubernetes-validations:
+ - message: replaceFullPath must be specified when
+ type is set to 'ReplaceFullPath'
+ rule: 'self.type == ''ReplaceFullPath'' ? has(self.replaceFullPath)
+ : true'
+ - message: type must be 'ReplaceFullPath' when replaceFullPath
+ is set
+ rule: 'has(self.replaceFullPath) ? self.type ==
+ ''ReplaceFullPath'' : true'
+ - message: replacePrefixMatch must be specified when
+ type is set to 'ReplacePrefixMatch'
+ rule: 'self.type == ''ReplacePrefixMatch'' ? has(self.replacePrefixMatch)
+ : true'
+ - message: type must be 'ReplacePrefixMatch' when
+ replacePrefixMatch is set
+ rule: 'has(self.replacePrefixMatch) ? self.type
+ == ''ReplacePrefixMatch'' : true'
+ type: object
+ required:
+ - type
+ type: object
+ x-kubernetes-validations:
+ - message: filter.requestHeaderModifier must be nil if the
+ filter.type is not RequestHeaderModifier
+ rule: '!(has(self.requestHeaderModifier) && self.type !=
+ ''RequestHeaderModifier'')'
+ - message: filter.requestHeaderModifier must be specified
+ for RequestHeaderModifier filter.type
+ rule: '!(!has(self.requestHeaderModifier) && self.type ==
+ ''RequestHeaderModifier'')'
+ - message: filter.responseHeaderModifier must be nil if the
+ filter.type is not ResponseHeaderModifier
+ rule: '!(has(self.responseHeaderModifier) && self.type !=
+ ''ResponseHeaderModifier'')'
+ - message: filter.responseHeaderModifier must be specified
+ for ResponseHeaderModifier filter.type
+ rule: '!(!has(self.responseHeaderModifier) && self.type
+ == ''ResponseHeaderModifier'')'
+ - message: filter.requestMirror must be nil if the filter.type
+ is not RequestMirror
+ rule: '!(has(self.requestMirror) && self.type != ''RequestMirror'')'
+ - message: filter.requestMirror must be specified for RequestMirror
+ filter.type
+ rule: '!(!has(self.requestMirror) && self.type == ''RequestMirror'')'
+ - message: filter.requestRedirect must be nil if the filter.type
+ is not RequestRedirect
+ rule: '!(has(self.requestRedirect) && self.type != ''RequestRedirect'')'
+ - message: filter.requestRedirect must be specified for RequestRedirect
+ filter.type
+ rule: '!(!has(self.requestRedirect) && self.type == ''RequestRedirect'')'
+ - message: filter.urlRewrite must be nil if the filter.type
+ is not URLRewrite
+ rule: '!(has(self.urlRewrite) && self.type != ''URLRewrite'')'
+ - message: filter.urlRewrite must be specified for URLRewrite
+ filter.type
+ rule: '!(!has(self.urlRewrite) && self.type == ''URLRewrite'')'
+ - message: filter.extensionRef must be nil if the filter.type
+ is not ExtensionRef
+ rule: '!(has(self.extensionRef) && self.type != ''ExtensionRef'')'
+ - message: filter.extensionRef must be specified for ExtensionRef
+ filter.type
+ rule: '!(!has(self.extensionRef) && self.type == ''ExtensionRef'')'
+ maxItems: 16
+ type: array
+ x-kubernetes-validations:
+ - message: May specify either httpRouteFilterRequestRedirect
+ or httpRouteFilterRequestRewrite, but not both
+ rule: '!(self.exists(f, f.type == ''RequestRedirect'') &&
+ self.exists(f, f.type == ''URLRewrite''))'
+ - message: RequestHeaderModifier filter cannot be repeated
+ rule: self.filter(f, f.type == 'RequestHeaderModifier').size()
+ <= 1
+ - message: ResponseHeaderModifier filter cannot be repeated
+ rule: self.filter(f, f.type == 'ResponseHeaderModifier').size()
+ <= 1
+ - message: RequestRedirect filter cannot be repeated
+ rule: self.filter(f, f.type == 'RequestRedirect').size() <=
+ 1
+ - message: URLRewrite filter cannot be repeated
+ rule: self.filter(f, f.type == 'URLRewrite').size() <= 1
+ matches:
+ default:
+ - path:
+ type: PathPrefix
+ value: /
+ description: |-
+ Matches define conditions used for matching the rule against incoming
+ HTTP requests. Each match is independent, i.e. this rule will be matched
+ if **any** one of the matches is satisfied.
+
+
+ For example, take the following matches configuration:
+
+
+ ```
+ matches:
+ - path:
+ value: "/foo"
+ headers:
+ - name: "version"
+ value: "v2"
+ - path:
+ value: "/v2/foo"
+ ```
+
+
+ For a request to match against this rule, a request must satisfy
+ EITHER of the two conditions:
+
+
+ - path prefixed with `/foo` AND contains the header `version: v2`
+ - path prefix of `/v2/foo`
+
+
+ See the documentation for HTTPRouteMatch on how to specify multiple
+ match conditions that should be ANDed together.
+
+
+ If no matches are specified, the default is a prefix
+ path match on "/", which has the effect of matching every
+ HTTP request.
+
+
+ Proxy or Load Balancer routing configuration generated from HTTPRoutes
+ MUST prioritize matches based on the following criteria, continuing on
+ ties. Across all rules specified on applicable Routes, precedence must be
+ given to the match having:
+
+
+ * "Exact" path match.
+ * "Prefix" path match with largest number of characters.
+ * Method match.
+ * Largest number of header matches.
+ * Largest number of query param matches.
+
+
+ Note: The precedence of RegularExpression path matches are implementation-specific.
+
+
+ If ties still exist across multiple Routes, matching precedence MUST be
+ determined in order of the following criteria, continuing on ties:
+
+
+ * The oldest Route based on creation timestamp.
+ * The Route appearing first in alphabetical order by
+ "{namespace}/{name}".
+
+
+ If ties still exist within an HTTPRoute, matching precedence MUST be granted
+ to the FIRST matching rule (in list order) with a match meeting the above
+ criteria.
+
+
+ When no rules matching a request have been successfully attached to the
+ parent a request is coming from, a HTTP 404 status code MUST be returned.
+ items:
+ description: "HTTPRouteMatch defines the predicate used to
+ match requests to a given\naction. Multiple match types
+ are ANDed together, i.e. the match will\nevaluate to true
+ only if all conditions are satisfied.\n\n\nFor example,
+ the match below will match a HTTP request only if its path\nstarts
+ with `/foo` AND it contains the `version: v1` header:\n\n\n```\nmatch:\n\n\n\tpath:\n\t
+ \ value: \"/foo\"\n\theaders:\n\t- name: \"version\"\n\t
+ \ value \"v1\"\n\n\n```"
+ properties:
+ headers:
+ description: |-
+ Headers specifies HTTP request header matchers. Multiple match values are
+ ANDed together, meaning, a request must match all the specified headers
+ to select the route.
+ items:
+ description: |-
+ HTTPHeaderMatch describes how to select a HTTP route by matching HTTP request
+ headers.
+ properties:
+ name:
+ description: |-
+ Name is the name of the HTTP Header to be matched. Name matching MUST be
+ case insensitive. (See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc7230#section-3.2).
+
+
+ If multiple entries specify equivalent header names, only the first
+ entry with an equivalent name MUST be considered for a match. Subsequent
+ entries with an equivalent header name MUST be ignored. Due to the
+ case-insensitivity of header names, "foo" and "Foo" are considered
+ equivalent.
+
+
+ When a header is repeated in an HTTP request, it is
+ implementation-specific behavior as to how this is represented.
+ Generally, proxies should follow the guidance from the RFC:
+ https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc7230.html#section-3.2.2 regarding
+ processing a repeated header, with special handling for "Set-Cookie".
+ maxLength: 256
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[A-Za-z0-9!#$%&'*+\-.^_\x60|~]+$
+ type: string
+ type:
+ default: Exact
+ description: |-
+ Type specifies how to match against the value of the header.
+
+
+ Support: Core (Exact)
+
+
+ Support: Implementation-specific (RegularExpression)
+
+
+ Since RegularExpression HeaderMatchType has implementation-specific
+ conformance, implementations can support POSIX, PCRE or any other dialects
+ of regular expressions. Please read the implementation's documentation to
+ determine the supported dialect.
+ enum:
+ - Exact
+ - RegularExpression
+ type: string
+ value:
+ description: Value is the value of HTTP Header to
+ be matched.
+ maxLength: 4096
+ minLength: 1
+ type: string
+ required:
+ - name
+ - value
+ type: object
+ maxItems: 16
+ type: array
+ x-kubernetes-list-map-keys:
+ - name
+ x-kubernetes-list-type: map
+ method:
+ description: |-
+ Method specifies HTTP method matcher.
+ When specified, this route will be matched only if the request has the
+ specified method.
+
+
+ Support: Extended
+ enum:
+ - GET
+ - HEAD
+ - POST
+ - PUT
+ - DELETE
+ - CONNECT
+ - OPTIONS
+ - TRACE
+ - PATCH
+ type: string
+ path:
+ default:
+ type: PathPrefix
+ value: /
+ description: |-
+ Path specifies a HTTP request path matcher. If this field is not
+ specified, a default prefix match on the "/" path is provided.
+ properties:
+ type:
+ default: PathPrefix
+ description: |-
+ Type specifies how to match against the path Value.
+
+
+ Support: Core (Exact, PathPrefix)
+
+
+ Support: Implementation-specific (RegularExpression)
+ enum:
+ - Exact
+ - PathPrefix
+ - RegularExpression
+ type: string
+ value:
+ default: /
+ description: Value of the HTTP path to match against.
+ maxLength: 1024
+ type: string
+ type: object
+ x-kubernetes-validations:
+ - message: value must be an absolute path and start with
+ '/' when type one of ['Exact', 'PathPrefix']
+ rule: '(self.type in [''Exact'',''PathPrefix'']) ? self.value.startsWith(''/'')
+ : true'
+ - message: must not contain '//' when type one of ['Exact',
+ 'PathPrefix']
+ rule: '(self.type in [''Exact'',''PathPrefix'']) ? !self.value.contains(''//'')
+ : true'
+ - message: must not contain '/./' when type one of ['Exact',
+ 'PathPrefix']
+ rule: '(self.type in [''Exact'',''PathPrefix'']) ? !self.value.contains(''/./'')
+ : true'
+ - message: must not contain '/../' when type one of ['Exact',
+ 'PathPrefix']
+ rule: '(self.type in [''Exact'',''PathPrefix'']) ? !self.value.contains(''/../'')
+ : true'
+ - message: must not contain '%2f' when type one of ['Exact',
+ 'PathPrefix']
+ rule: '(self.type in [''Exact'',''PathPrefix'']) ? !self.value.contains(''%2f'')
+ : true'
+ - message: must not contain '%2F' when type one of ['Exact',
+ 'PathPrefix']
+ rule: '(self.type in [''Exact'',''PathPrefix'']) ? !self.value.contains(''%2F'')
+ : true'
+ - message: must not contain '#' when type one of ['Exact',
+ 'PathPrefix']
+ rule: '(self.type in [''Exact'',''PathPrefix'']) ? !self.value.contains(''#'')
+ : true'
+ - message: must not end with '/..' when type one of ['Exact',
+ 'PathPrefix']
+ rule: '(self.type in [''Exact'',''PathPrefix'']) ? !self.value.endsWith(''/..'')
+ : true'
+ - message: must not end with '/.' when type one of ['Exact',
+ 'PathPrefix']
+ rule: '(self.type in [''Exact'',''PathPrefix'']) ? !self.value.endsWith(''/.'')
+ : true'
+ - message: type must be one of ['Exact', 'PathPrefix',
+ 'RegularExpression']
+ rule: self.type in ['Exact','PathPrefix'] || self.type
+ == 'RegularExpression'
+ - message: must only contain valid characters (matching
+ ^(?:[-A-Za-z0-9/._~!$&'()*+,;=:@]|[%][0-9a-fA-F]{2})+$)
+ for types ['Exact', 'PathPrefix']
+ rule: '(self.type in [''Exact'',''PathPrefix'']) ? self.value.matches(r"""^(?:[-A-Za-z0-9/._~!$&''()*+,;=:@]|[%][0-9a-fA-F]{2})+$""")
+ : true'
+ queryParams:
+ description: |-
+ QueryParams specifies HTTP query parameter matchers. Multiple match
+ values are ANDed together, meaning, a request must match all the
+ specified query parameters to select the route.
+
+
+ Support: Extended
+ items:
+ description: |-
+ HTTPQueryParamMatch describes how to select a HTTP route by matching HTTP
+ query parameters.
+ properties:
+ name:
+ description: |-
+ Name is the name of the HTTP query param to be matched. This must be an
+ exact string match. (See
+ https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc7230#section-2.7.3).
+
+
+ If multiple entries specify equivalent query param names, only the first
+ entry with an equivalent name MUST be considered for a match. Subsequent
+ entries with an equivalent query param name MUST be ignored.
+
+
+ If a query param is repeated in an HTTP request, the behavior is
+ purposely left undefined, since different data planes have different
+ capabilities. However, it is *recommended* that implementations should
+ match against the first value of the param if the data plane supports it,
+ as this behavior is expected in other load balancing contexts outside of
+ the Gateway API.
+
+
+ Users SHOULD NOT route traffic based on repeated query params to guard
+ themselves against potential differences in the implementations.
+ maxLength: 256
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[A-Za-z0-9!#$%&'*+\-.^_\x60|~]+$
+ type: string
+ type:
+ default: Exact
+ description: |-
+ Type specifies how to match against the value of the query parameter.
+
+
+ Support: Extended (Exact)
+
+
+ Support: Implementation-specific (RegularExpression)
+
+
+ Since RegularExpression QueryParamMatchType has Implementation-specific
+ conformance, implementations can support POSIX, PCRE or any other
+ dialects of regular expressions. Please read the implementation's
+ documentation to determine the supported dialect.
+ enum:
+ - Exact
+ - RegularExpression
+ type: string
+ value:
+ description: Value is the value of HTTP query param
+ to be matched.
+ maxLength: 1024
+ minLength: 1
+ type: string
+ required:
+ - name
+ - value
+ type: object
+ maxItems: 16
+ type: array
+ x-kubernetes-list-map-keys:
+ - name
+ x-kubernetes-list-type: map
+ type: object
+ maxItems: 8
+ type: array
+ sessionPersistence:
+ description: |+
+ SessionPersistence defines and configures session persistence
+ for the route rule.
+
+
+ Support: Extended
+
+
+ properties:
+ absoluteTimeout:
+ description: |-
+ AbsoluteTimeout defines the absolute timeout of the persistent
+ session. Once the AbsoluteTimeout duration has elapsed, the
+ session becomes invalid.
+
+
+ Support: Extended
+ pattern: ^([0-9]{1,5}(h|m|s|ms)){1,4}$
+ type: string
+ cookieConfig:
+ description: |-
+ CookieConfig provides configuration settings that are specific
+ to cookie-based session persistence.
+
+
+ Support: Core
+ properties:
+ lifetimeType:
+ default: Session
+ description: |-
+ LifetimeType specifies whether the cookie has a permanent or
+ session-based lifetime. A permanent cookie persists until its
+ specified expiry time, defined by the Expires or Max-Age cookie
+ attributes, while a session cookie is deleted when the current
+ session ends.
+
+
+ When set to "Permanent", AbsoluteTimeout indicates the
+ cookie's lifetime via the Expires or Max-Age cookie attributes
+ and is required.
+
+
+ When set to "Session", AbsoluteTimeout indicates the
+ absolute lifetime of the cookie tracked by the gateway and
+ is optional.
+
+
+ Support: Core for "Session" type
+
+
+ Support: Extended for "Permanent" type
+ enum:
+ - Permanent
+ - Session
+ type: string
+ type: object
+ idleTimeout:
+ description: |-
+ IdleTimeout defines the idle timeout of the persistent session.
+ Once the session has been idle for more than the specified
+ IdleTimeout duration, the session becomes invalid.
+
+
+ Support: Extended
+ pattern: ^([0-9]{1,5}(h|m|s|ms)){1,4}$
+ type: string
+ sessionName:
+ description: |-
+ SessionName defines the name of the persistent session token
+ which may be reflected in the cookie or the header. Users
+ should avoid reusing session names to prevent unintended
+ consequences, such as rejection or unpredictable behavior.
+
+
+ Support: Implementation-specific
+ maxLength: 128
+ type: string
+ type:
+ default: Cookie
+ description: |-
+ Type defines the type of session persistence such as through
+ the use a header or cookie. Defaults to cookie based session
+ persistence.
+
+
+ Support: Core for "Cookie" type
+
+
+ Support: Extended for "Header" type
+ enum:
+ - Cookie
+ - Header
+ type: string
+ type: object
+ x-kubernetes-validations:
+ - message: AbsoluteTimeout must be specified when cookie lifetimeType
+ is Permanent
+ rule: '!has(self.cookieConfig.lifetimeType) || self.cookieConfig.lifetimeType
+ != ''Permanent'' || has(self.absoluteTimeout)'
+ timeouts:
+ description: |+
+ Timeouts defines the timeouts that can be configured for an HTTP request.
+
+
+ Support: Extended
+
+
+ properties:
+ backendRequest:
+ description: |-
+ BackendRequest specifies a timeout for an individual request from the gateway
+ to a backend. This covers the time from when the request first starts being
+ sent from the gateway to when the full response has been received from the backend.
+
+
+ Setting a timeout to the zero duration (e.g. "0s") SHOULD disable the timeout
+ completely. Implementations that cannot completely disable the timeout MUST
+ instead interpret the zero duration as the longest possible value to which
+ the timeout can be set.
+
+
+ An entire client HTTP transaction with a gateway, covered by the Request timeout,
+ may result in more than one call from the gateway to the destination backend,
+ for example, if automatic retries are supported.
+
+
+ Because the Request timeout encompasses the BackendRequest timeout, the value of
+ BackendRequest must be <= the value of Request timeout.
+
+
+ Support: Extended
+ pattern: ^([0-9]{1,5}(h|m|s|ms)){1,4}$
+ type: string
+ request:
+ description: |-
+ Request specifies the maximum duration for a gateway to respond to an HTTP request.
+ If the gateway has not been able to respond before this deadline is met, the gateway
+ MUST return a timeout error.
+
+
+ For example, setting the `rules.timeouts.request` field to the value `10s` in an
+ `HTTPRoute` will cause a timeout if a client request is taking longer than 10 seconds
+ to complete.
+
+
+ Setting a timeout to the zero duration (e.g. "0s") SHOULD disable the timeout
+ completely. Implementations that cannot completely disable the timeout MUST
+ instead interpret the zero duration as the longest possible value to which
+ the timeout can be set.
+
+
+ This timeout is intended to cover as close to the whole request-response transaction
+ as possible although an implementation MAY choose to start the timeout after the entire
+ request stream has been received instead of immediately after the transaction is
+ initiated by the client.
+
+
+ When this field is unspecified, request timeout behavior is implementation-specific.
+
+
+ Support: Extended
+ pattern: ^([0-9]{1,5}(h|m|s|ms)){1,4}$
+ type: string
+ type: object
+ x-kubernetes-validations:
+ - message: backendRequest timeout cannot be longer than request
+ timeout
+ rule: '!(has(self.request) && has(self.backendRequest) &&
+ duration(self.request) != duration(''0s'') && duration(self.backendRequest)
+ > duration(self.request))'
+ type: object
+ x-kubernetes-validations:
+ - message: RequestRedirect filter must not be used together with
+ backendRefs
+ rule: '(has(self.backendRefs) && size(self.backendRefs) > 0) ?
+ (!has(self.filters) || self.filters.all(f, !has(f.requestRedirect))):
+ true'
+ - message: When using RequestRedirect filter with path.replacePrefixMatch,
+ exactly one PathPrefix match must be specified
+ rule: '(has(self.filters) && self.filters.exists_one(f, has(f.requestRedirect)
+ && has(f.requestRedirect.path) && f.requestRedirect.path.type
+ == ''ReplacePrefixMatch'' && has(f.requestRedirect.path.replacePrefixMatch)))
+ ? ((size(self.matches) != 1 || !has(self.matches[0].path) ||
+ self.matches[0].path.type != ''PathPrefix'') ? false : true)
+ : true'
+ - message: When using URLRewrite filter with path.replacePrefixMatch,
+ exactly one PathPrefix match must be specified
+ rule: '(has(self.filters) && self.filters.exists_one(f, has(f.urlRewrite)
+ && has(f.urlRewrite.path) && f.urlRewrite.path.type == ''ReplacePrefixMatch''
+ && has(f.urlRewrite.path.replacePrefixMatch))) ? ((size(self.matches)
+ != 1 || !has(self.matches[0].path) || self.matches[0].path.type
+ != ''PathPrefix'') ? false : true) : true'
+ - message: Within backendRefs, when using RequestRedirect filter
+ with path.replacePrefixMatch, exactly one PathPrefix match must
+ be specified
+ rule: '(has(self.backendRefs) && self.backendRefs.exists_one(b,
+ (has(b.filters) && b.filters.exists_one(f, has(f.requestRedirect)
+ && has(f.requestRedirect.path) && f.requestRedirect.path.type
+ == ''ReplacePrefixMatch'' && has(f.requestRedirect.path.replacePrefixMatch)))
+ )) ? ((size(self.matches) != 1 || !has(self.matches[0].path)
+ || self.matches[0].path.type != ''PathPrefix'') ? false : true)
+ : true'
+ - message: Within backendRefs, When using URLRewrite filter with
+ path.replacePrefixMatch, exactly one PathPrefix match must be
+ specified
+ rule: '(has(self.backendRefs) && self.backendRefs.exists_one(b,
+ (has(b.filters) && b.filters.exists_one(f, has(f.urlRewrite)
+ && has(f.urlRewrite.path) && f.urlRewrite.path.type == ''ReplacePrefixMatch''
+ && has(f.urlRewrite.path.replacePrefixMatch))) )) ? ((size(self.matches)
+ != 1 || !has(self.matches[0].path) || self.matches[0].path.type
+ != ''PathPrefix'') ? false : true) : true'
+ maxItems: 16
+ type: array
+ type: object
+ status:
+ description: Status defines the current state of HTTPRoute.
+ properties:
+ parents:
+ description: |-
+ Parents is a list of parent resources (usually Gateways) that are
+ associated with the route, and the status of the route with respect to
+ each parent. When this route attaches to a parent, the controller that
+ manages the parent must add an entry to this list when the controller
+ first sees the route and should update the entry as appropriate when the
+ route or gateway is modified.
+
+
+ Note that parent references that cannot be resolved by an implementation
+ of this API will not be added to this list. Implementations of this API
+ can only populate Route status for the Gateways/parent resources they are
+ responsible for.
+
+
+ A maximum of 32 Gateways will be represented in this list. An empty list
+ means the route has not been attached to any Gateway.
+ items:
+ description: |-
+ RouteParentStatus describes the status of a route with respect to an
+ associated Parent.
+ properties:
+ conditions:
+ description: |-
+ Conditions describes the status of the route with respect to the Gateway.
+ Note that the route's availability is also subject to the Gateway's own
+ status conditions and listener status.
+
+
+ If the Route's ParentRef specifies an existing Gateway that supports
+ Routes of this kind AND that Gateway's controller has sufficient access,
+ then that Gateway's controller MUST set the "Accepted" condition on the
+ Route, to indicate whether the route has been accepted or rejected by the
+ Gateway, and why.
+
+
+ A Route MUST be considered "Accepted" if at least one of the Route's
+ rules is implemented by the Gateway.
+
+
+ There are a number of cases where the "Accepted" condition may not be set
+ due to lack of controller visibility, that includes when:
+
+
+ * The Route refers to a non-existent parent.
+ * The Route is of a type that the controller does not support.
+ * The Route is in a namespace the controller does not have access to.
+ items:
+ description: "Condition contains details for one aspect of
+ the current state of this API Resource.\n---\nThis struct
+ is intended for direct use as an array at the field path
+ .status.conditions. For example,\n\n\n\ttype FooStatus
+ struct{\n\t // Represents the observations of a foo's
+ current state.\n\t // Known .status.conditions.type are:
+ \"Available\", \"Progressing\", and \"Degraded\"\n\t //
+ +patchMergeKey=type\n\t // +patchStrategy=merge\n\t //
+ +listType=map\n\t // +listMapKey=type\n\t Conditions
+ []metav1.Condition `json:\"conditions,omitempty\" patchStrategy:\"merge\"
+ patchMergeKey:\"type\" protobuf:\"bytes,1,rep,name=conditions\"`\n\n\n\t
+ \ // other fields\n\t}"
+ properties:
+ lastTransitionTime:
+ description: |-
+ lastTransitionTime is the last time the condition transitioned from one status to another.
+ This should be when the underlying condition changed. If that is not known, then using the time when the API field changed is acceptable.
+ format: date-time
+ type: string
+ message:
+ description: |-
+ message is a human readable message indicating details about the transition.
+ This may be an empty string.
+ maxLength: 32768
+ type: string
+ observedGeneration:
+ description: |-
+ observedGeneration represents the .metadata.generation that the condition was set based upon.
+ For instance, if .metadata.generation is currently 12, but the .status.conditions[x].observedGeneration is 9, the condition is out of date
+ with respect to the current state of the instance.
+ format: int64
+ minimum: 0
+ type: integer
+ reason:
+ description: |-
+ reason contains a programmatic identifier indicating the reason for the condition's last transition.
+ Producers of specific condition types may define expected values and meanings for this field,
+ and whether the values are considered a guaranteed API.
+ The value should be a CamelCase string.
+ This field may not be empty.
+ maxLength: 1024
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[A-Za-z]([A-Za-z0-9_,:]*[A-Za-z0-9_])?$
+ type: string
+ status:
+ description: status of the condition, one of True, False,
+ Unknown.
+ enum:
+ - "True"
+ - "False"
+ - Unknown
+ type: string
+ type:
+ description: |-
+ type of condition in CamelCase or in foo.example.com/CamelCase.
+ ---
+ Many .condition.type values are consistent across resources like Available, but because arbitrary conditions can be
+ useful (see .node.status.conditions), the ability to deconflict is important.
+ The regex it matches is (dns1123SubdomainFmt/)?(qualifiedNameFmt)
+ maxLength: 316
+ pattern: ^([a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*/)?(([A-Za-z0-9][-A-Za-z0-9_.]*)?[A-Za-z0-9])$
+ type: string
+ required:
+ - lastTransitionTime
+ - message
+ - reason
+ - status
+ - type
+ type: object
+ maxItems: 8
+ minItems: 1
+ type: array
+ x-kubernetes-list-map-keys:
+ - type
+ x-kubernetes-list-type: map
+ controllerName:
+ description: |-
+ ControllerName is a domain/path string that indicates the name of the
+ controller that wrote this status. This corresponds with the
+ controllerName field on GatewayClass.
+
+
+ Example: "example.net/gateway-controller".
+
+
+ The format of this field is DOMAIN "/" PATH, where DOMAIN and PATH are
+ valid Kubernetes names
+ (https://kubernetes.io/docs/concepts/overview/working-with-objects/names/#names).
+
+
+ Controllers MUST populate this field when writing status. Controllers should ensure that
+ entries to status populated with their ControllerName are cleaned up when they are no
+ longer necessary.
+ maxLength: 253
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*\/[A-Za-z0-9\/\-._~%!$&'()*+,;=:]+$
+ type: string
+ parentRef:
+ description: |-
+ ParentRef corresponds with a ParentRef in the spec that this
+ RouteParentStatus struct describes the status of.
+ properties:
+ group:
+ default: gateway.networking.k8s.io
+ description: |-
+ Group is the group of the referent.
+ When unspecified, "gateway.networking.k8s.io" is inferred.
+ To set the core API group (such as for a "Service" kind referent),
+ Group must be explicitly set to "" (empty string).
+
+
+ Support: Core
+ maxLength: 253
+ pattern: ^$|^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$
+ type: string
+ kind:
+ default: Gateway
+ description: |-
+ Kind is kind of the referent.
+
+
+ There are two kinds of parent resources with "Core" support:
+
+
+ * Gateway (Gateway conformance profile)
+ * Service (Mesh conformance profile, ClusterIP Services only)
+
+
+ Support for other resources is Implementation-Specific.
+ maxLength: 63
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[a-zA-Z]([-a-zA-Z0-9]*[a-zA-Z0-9])?$
+ type: string
+ name:
+ description: |-
+ Name is the name of the referent.
+
+
+ Support: Core
+ maxLength: 253
+ minLength: 1
+ type: string
+ namespace:
+ description: |-
+ Namespace is the namespace of the referent. When unspecified, this refers
+ to the local namespace of the Route.
+
+
+ Note that there are specific rules for ParentRefs which cross namespace
+ boundaries. Cross-namespace references are only valid if they are explicitly
+ allowed by something in the namespace they are referring to. For example:
+ Gateway has the AllowedRoutes field, and ReferenceGrant provides a
+ generic way to enable any other kind of cross-namespace reference.
+
+
+
+ ParentRefs from a Route to a Service in the same namespace are "producer"
+ routes, which apply default routing rules to inbound connections from
+ any namespace to the Service.
+
+
+ ParentRefs from a Route to a Service in a different namespace are
+ "consumer" routes, and these routing rules are only applied to outbound
+ connections originating from the same namespace as the Route, for which
+ the intended destination of the connections are a Service targeted as a
+ ParentRef of the Route.
+
+
+
+ Support: Core
+ maxLength: 63
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?$
+ type: string
+ port:
+ description: |-
+ Port is the network port this Route targets. It can be interpreted
+ differently based on the type of parent resource.
+
+
+ When the parent resource is a Gateway, this targets all listeners
+ listening on the specified port that also support this kind of Route(and
+ select this Route). It's not recommended to set `Port` unless the
+ networking behaviors specified in a Route must apply to a specific port
+ as opposed to a listener(s) whose port(s) may be changed. When both Port
+ and SectionName are specified, the name and port of the selected listener
+ must match both specified values.
+
+
+
+ When the parent resource is a Service, this targets a specific port in the
+ Service spec. When both Port (experimental) and SectionName are specified,
+ the name and port of the selected port must match both specified values.
+
+
+
+ Implementations MAY choose to support other parent resources.
+ Implementations supporting other types of parent resources MUST clearly
+ document how/if Port is interpreted.
+
+
+ For the purpose of status, an attachment is considered successful as
+ long as the parent resource accepts it partially. For example, Gateway
+ listeners can restrict which Routes can attach to them by Route kind,
+ namespace, or hostname. If 1 of 2 Gateway listeners accept attachment
+ from the referencing Route, the Route MUST be considered successfully
+ attached. If no Gateway listeners accept attachment from this Route,
+ the Route MUST be considered detached from the Gateway.
+
+
+ Support: Extended
+ format: int32
+ maximum: 65535
+ minimum: 1
+ type: integer
+ sectionName:
+ description: |-
+ SectionName is the name of a section within the target resource. In the
+ following resources, SectionName is interpreted as the following:
+
+
+ * Gateway: Listener name. When both Port (experimental) and SectionName
+ are specified, the name and port of the selected listener must match
+ both specified values.
+ * Service: Port name. When both Port (experimental) and SectionName
+ are specified, the name and port of the selected listener must match
+ both specified values.
+
+
+ Implementations MAY choose to support attaching Routes to other resources.
+ If that is the case, they MUST clearly document how SectionName is
+ interpreted.
+
+
+ When unspecified (empty string), this will reference the entire resource.
+ For the purpose of status, an attachment is considered successful if at
+ least one section in the parent resource accepts it. For example, Gateway
+ listeners can restrict which Routes can attach to them by Route kind,
+ namespace, or hostname. If 1 of 2 Gateway listeners accept attachment from
+ the referencing Route, the Route MUST be considered successfully
+ attached. If no Gateway listeners accept attachment from this Route, the
+ Route MUST be considered detached from the Gateway.
+
+
+ Support: Core
+ maxLength: 253
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$
+ type: string
+ required:
+ - name
+ type: object
+ required:
+ - controllerName
+ - parentRef
+ type: object
+ maxItems: 32
+ type: array
+ required:
+ - parents
+ type: object
+ required:
+ - spec
+ type: object
+ served: true
+ storage: false
+ subresources:
+ status: {}
+status:
+ acceptedNames:
+ kind: ""
+ plural: ""
+ conditions: null
+ storedVersions: null
+---
+#
+# config/crd/experimental/gateway.networking.k8s.io_referencegrants.yaml
+#
+apiVersion: apiextensions.k8s.io/v1
+kind: CustomResourceDefinition
+metadata:
+ annotations:
+ api-approved.kubernetes.io: https://github.com/kubernetes-sigs/gateway-api/pull/2997
+ gateway.networking.k8s.io/bundle-version: v1.1.0
+ gateway.networking.k8s.io/channel: experimental
+ creationTimestamp: null
+ name: referencegrants.gateway.networking.k8s.io
+spec:
+ group: gateway.networking.k8s.io
+ names:
+ categories:
+ - gateway-api
+ kind: ReferenceGrant
+ listKind: ReferenceGrantList
+ plural: referencegrants
+ shortNames:
+ - refgrant
+ singular: referencegrant
+ scope: Namespaced
+ versions:
+ - additionalPrinterColumns:
+ - jsonPath: .metadata.creationTimestamp
+ name: Age
+ type: date
+ deprecated: true
+ deprecationWarning: The v1alpha2 version of ReferenceGrant has been deprecated
+ and will be removed in a future release of the API. Please upgrade to v1beta1.
+ name: v1alpha2
+ schema:
+ openAPIV3Schema:
+ description: |-
+ ReferenceGrant identifies kinds of resources in other namespaces that are
+ trusted to reference the specified kinds of resources in the same namespace
+ as the policy.
+
+
+ Each ReferenceGrant can be used to represent a unique trust relationship.
+ Additional Reference Grants can be used to add to the set of trusted
+ sources of inbound references for the namespace they are defined within.
+
+
+ A ReferenceGrant is required for all cross-namespace references in Gateway API
+ (with the exception of cross-namespace Route-Gateway attachment, which is
+ governed by the AllowedRoutes configuration on the Gateway, and cross-namespace
+ Service ParentRefs on a "consumer" mesh Route, which defines routing rules
+ applicable only to workloads in the Route namespace). ReferenceGrants allowing
+ a reference from a Route to a Service are only applicable to BackendRefs.
+
+
+ ReferenceGrant is a form of runtime verification allowing users to assert
+ which cross-namespace object references are permitted. Implementations that
+ support ReferenceGrant MUST NOT permit cross-namespace references which have
+ no grant, and MUST respond to the removal of a grant by revoking the access
+ that the grant allowed.
+ properties:
+ apiVersion:
+ description: |-
+ APIVersion defines the versioned schema of this representation of an object.
+ Servers should convert recognized schemas to the latest internal value, and
+ may reject unrecognized values.
+ More info: https://git.k8s.io/community/contributors/devel/sig-architecture/api-conventions.md#resources
+ type: string
+ kind:
+ description: |-
+ Kind is a string value representing the REST resource this object represents.
+ Servers may infer this from the endpoint the client submits requests to.
+ Cannot be updated.
+ In CamelCase.
+ More info: https://git.k8s.io/community/contributors/devel/sig-architecture/api-conventions.md#types-kinds
+ type: string
+ metadata:
+ type: object
+ spec:
+ description: Spec defines the desired state of ReferenceGrant.
+ properties:
+ from:
+ description: |-
+ From describes the trusted namespaces and kinds that can reference the
+ resources described in "To". Each entry in this list MUST be considered
+ to be an additional place that references can be valid from, or to put
+ this another way, entries MUST be combined using OR.
+
+
+ Support: Core
+ items:
+ description: ReferenceGrantFrom describes trusted namespaces and
+ kinds.
+ properties:
+ group:
+ description: |-
+ Group is the group of the referent.
+ When empty, the Kubernetes core API group is inferred.
+
+
+ Support: Core
+ maxLength: 253
+ pattern: ^$|^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$
+ type: string
+ kind:
+ description: |-
+ Kind is the kind of the referent. Although implementations may support
+ additional resources, the following types are part of the "Core"
+ support level for this field.
+
+
+ When used to permit a SecretObjectReference:
+
+
+ * Gateway
+
+
+ When used to permit a BackendObjectReference:
+
+
+ * GRPCRoute
+ * HTTPRoute
+ * TCPRoute
+ * TLSRoute
+ * UDPRoute
+ maxLength: 63
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[a-zA-Z]([-a-zA-Z0-9]*[a-zA-Z0-9])?$
+ type: string
+ namespace:
+ description: |-
+ Namespace is the namespace of the referent.
+
+
+ Support: Core
+ maxLength: 63
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?$
+ type: string
+ required:
+ - group
+ - kind
+ - namespace
+ type: object
+ maxItems: 16
+ minItems: 1
+ type: array
+ to:
+ description: |-
+ To describes the resources that may be referenced by the resources
+ described in "From". Each entry in this list MUST be considered to be an
+ additional place that references can be valid to, or to put this another
+ way, entries MUST be combined using OR.
+
+
+ Support: Core
+ items:
+ description: |-
+ ReferenceGrantTo describes what Kinds are allowed as targets of the
+ references.
+ properties:
+ group:
+ description: |-
+ Group is the group of the referent.
+ When empty, the Kubernetes core API group is inferred.
+
+
+ Support: Core
+ maxLength: 253
+ pattern: ^$|^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$
+ type: string
+ kind:
+ description: |-
+ Kind is the kind of the referent. Although implementations may support
+ additional resources, the following types are part of the "Core"
+ support level for this field:
+
+
+ * Secret when used to permit a SecretObjectReference
+ * Service when used to permit a BackendObjectReference
+ maxLength: 63
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[a-zA-Z]([-a-zA-Z0-9]*[a-zA-Z0-9])?$
+ type: string
+ name:
+ description: |-
+ Name is the name of the referent. When unspecified, this policy
+ refers to all resources of the specified Group and Kind in the local
+ namespace.
+ maxLength: 253
+ minLength: 1
+ type: string
+ required:
+ - group
+ - kind
+ type: object
+ maxItems: 16
+ minItems: 1
+ type: array
+ required:
+ - from
+ - to
+ type: object
+ type: object
+ served: true
+ storage: false
+ subresources: {}
+ - additionalPrinterColumns:
+ - jsonPath: .metadata.creationTimestamp
+ name: Age
+ type: date
+ name: v1beta1
+ schema:
+ openAPIV3Schema:
+ description: |-
+ ReferenceGrant identifies kinds of resources in other namespaces that are
+ trusted to reference the specified kinds of resources in the same namespace
+ as the policy.
+
+
+ Each ReferenceGrant can be used to represent a unique trust relationship.
+ Additional Reference Grants can be used to add to the set of trusted
+ sources of inbound references for the namespace they are defined within.
+
+
+ All cross-namespace references in Gateway API (with the exception of cross-namespace
+ Gateway-route attachment) require a ReferenceGrant.
+
+
+ ReferenceGrant is a form of runtime verification allowing users to assert
+ which cross-namespace object references are permitted. Implementations that
+ support ReferenceGrant MUST NOT permit cross-namespace references which have
+ no grant, and MUST respond to the removal of a grant by revoking the access
+ that the grant allowed.
+ properties:
+ apiVersion:
+ description: |-
+ APIVersion defines the versioned schema of this representation of an object.
+ Servers should convert recognized schemas to the latest internal value, and
+ may reject unrecognized values.
+ More info: https://git.k8s.io/community/contributors/devel/sig-architecture/api-conventions.md#resources
+ type: string
+ kind:
+ description: |-
+ Kind is a string value representing the REST resource this object represents.
+ Servers may infer this from the endpoint the client submits requests to.
+ Cannot be updated.
+ In CamelCase.
+ More info: https://git.k8s.io/community/contributors/devel/sig-architecture/api-conventions.md#types-kinds
+ type: string
+ metadata:
+ type: object
+ spec:
+ description: Spec defines the desired state of ReferenceGrant.
+ properties:
+ from:
+ description: |-
+ From describes the trusted namespaces and kinds that can reference the
+ resources described in "To". Each entry in this list MUST be considered
+ to be an additional place that references can be valid from, or to put
+ this another way, entries MUST be combined using OR.
+
+
+ Support: Core
+ items:
+ description: ReferenceGrantFrom describes trusted namespaces and
+ kinds.
+ properties:
+ group:
+ description: |-
+ Group is the group of the referent.
+ When empty, the Kubernetes core API group is inferred.
+
+
+ Support: Core
+ maxLength: 253
+ pattern: ^$|^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$
+ type: string
+ kind:
+ description: |-
+ Kind is the kind of the referent. Although implementations may support
+ additional resources, the following types are part of the "Core"
+ support level for this field.
+
+
+ When used to permit a SecretObjectReference:
+
+
+ * Gateway
+
+
+ When used to permit a BackendObjectReference:
+
+
+ * GRPCRoute
+ * HTTPRoute
+ * TCPRoute
+ * TLSRoute
+ * UDPRoute
+ maxLength: 63
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[a-zA-Z]([-a-zA-Z0-9]*[a-zA-Z0-9])?$
+ type: string
+ namespace:
+ description: |-
+ Namespace is the namespace of the referent.
+
+
+ Support: Core
+ maxLength: 63
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?$
+ type: string
+ required:
+ - group
+ - kind
+ - namespace
+ type: object
+ maxItems: 16
+ minItems: 1
+ type: array
+ to:
+ description: |-
+ To describes the resources that may be referenced by the resources
+ described in "From". Each entry in this list MUST be considered to be an
+ additional place that references can be valid to, or to put this another
+ way, entries MUST be combined using OR.
+
+
+ Support: Core
+ items:
+ description: |-
+ ReferenceGrantTo describes what Kinds are allowed as targets of the
+ references.
+ properties:
+ group:
+ description: |-
+ Group is the group of the referent.
+ When empty, the Kubernetes core API group is inferred.
+
+
+ Support: Core
+ maxLength: 253
+ pattern: ^$|^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$
+ type: string
+ kind:
+ description: |-
+ Kind is the kind of the referent. Although implementations may support
+ additional resources, the following types are part of the "Core"
+ support level for this field:
+
+
+ * Secret when used to permit a SecretObjectReference
+ * Service when used to permit a BackendObjectReference
+ maxLength: 63
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[a-zA-Z]([-a-zA-Z0-9]*[a-zA-Z0-9])?$
+ type: string
+ name:
+ description: |-
+ Name is the name of the referent. When unspecified, this policy
+ refers to all resources of the specified Group and Kind in the local
+ namespace.
+ maxLength: 253
+ minLength: 1
+ type: string
+ required:
+ - group
+ - kind
+ type: object
+ maxItems: 16
+ minItems: 1
+ type: array
+ required:
+ - from
+ - to
+ type: object
+ type: object
+ served: true
+ storage: true
+ subresources: {}
+status:
+ acceptedNames:
+ kind: ""
+ plural: ""
+ conditions: null
+ storedVersions: null
+---
+#
+# config/crd/experimental/gateway.networking.k8s.io_tcproutes.yaml
+#
+apiVersion: apiextensions.k8s.io/v1
+kind: CustomResourceDefinition
+metadata:
+ annotations:
+ api-approved.kubernetes.io: https://github.com/kubernetes-sigs/gateway-api/pull/2997
+ gateway.networking.k8s.io/bundle-version: v1.1.0
+ gateway.networking.k8s.io/channel: experimental
+ creationTimestamp: null
+ name: tcproutes.gateway.networking.k8s.io
+spec:
+ group: gateway.networking.k8s.io
+ names:
+ categories:
+ - gateway-api
+ kind: TCPRoute
+ listKind: TCPRouteList
+ plural: tcproutes
+ singular: tcproute
+ scope: Namespaced
+ versions:
+ - additionalPrinterColumns:
+ - jsonPath: .metadata.creationTimestamp
+ name: Age
+ type: date
+ name: v1alpha2
+ schema:
+ openAPIV3Schema:
+ description: |-
+ TCPRoute provides a way to route TCP requests. When combined with a Gateway
+ listener, it can be used to forward connections on the port specified by the
+ listener to a set of backends specified by the TCPRoute.
+ properties:
+ apiVersion:
+ description: |-
+ APIVersion defines the versioned schema of this representation of an object.
+ Servers should convert recognized schemas to the latest internal value, and
+ may reject unrecognized values.
+ More info: https://git.k8s.io/community/contributors/devel/sig-architecture/api-conventions.md#resources
+ type: string
+ kind:
+ description: |-
+ Kind is a string value representing the REST resource this object represents.
+ Servers may infer this from the endpoint the client submits requests to.
+ Cannot be updated.
+ In CamelCase.
+ More info: https://git.k8s.io/community/contributors/devel/sig-architecture/api-conventions.md#types-kinds
+ type: string
+ metadata:
+ type: object
+ spec:
+ description: Spec defines the desired state of TCPRoute.
+ properties:
+ parentRefs:
+ description: |+
+ ParentRefs references the resources (usually Gateways) that a Route wants
+ to be attached to. Note that the referenced parent resource needs to
+ allow this for the attachment to be complete. For Gateways, that means
+ the Gateway needs to allow attachment from Routes of this kind and
+ namespace. For Services, that means the Service must either be in the same
+ namespace for a "producer" route, or the mesh implementation must support
+ and allow "consumer" routes for the referenced Service. ReferenceGrant is
+ not applicable for governing ParentRefs to Services - it is not possible to
+ create a "producer" route for a Service in a different namespace from the
+ Route.
+
+
+ There are two kinds of parent resources with "Core" support:
+
+
+ * Gateway (Gateway conformance profile)
+ * Service (Mesh conformance profile, ClusterIP Services only)
+
+
+ This API may be extended in the future to support additional kinds of parent
+ resources.
+
+
+ ParentRefs must be _distinct_. This means either that:
+
+
+ * They select different objects. If this is the case, then parentRef
+ entries are distinct. In terms of fields, this means that the
+ multi-part key defined by `group`, `kind`, `namespace`, and `name` must
+ be unique across all parentRef entries in the Route.
+ * They do not select different objects, but for each optional field used,
+ each ParentRef that selects the same object must set the same set of
+ optional fields to different values. If one ParentRef sets a
+ combination of optional fields, all must set the same combination.
+
+
+ Some examples:
+
+
+ * If one ParentRef sets `sectionName`, all ParentRefs referencing the
+ same object must also set `sectionName`.
+ * If one ParentRef sets `port`, all ParentRefs referencing the same
+ object must also set `port`.
+ * If one ParentRef sets `sectionName` and `port`, all ParentRefs
+ referencing the same object must also set `sectionName` and `port`.
+
+
+ It is possible to separately reference multiple distinct objects that may
+ be collapsed by an implementation. For example, some implementations may
+ choose to merge compatible Gateway Listeners together. If that is the
+ case, the list of routes attached to those resources should also be
+ merged.
+
+
+ Note that for ParentRefs that cross namespace boundaries, there are specific
+ rules. Cross-namespace references are only valid if they are explicitly
+ allowed by something in the namespace they are referring to. For example,
+ Gateway has the AllowedRoutes field, and ReferenceGrant provides a
+ generic way to enable other kinds of cross-namespace reference.
+
+
+
+ ParentRefs from a Route to a Service in the same namespace are "producer"
+ routes, which apply default routing rules to inbound connections from
+ any namespace to the Service.
+
+
+ ParentRefs from a Route to a Service in a different namespace are
+ "consumer" routes, and these routing rules are only applied to outbound
+ connections originating from the same namespace as the Route, for which
+ the intended destination of the connections are a Service targeted as a
+ ParentRef of the Route.
+
+
+
+
+
+
+ items:
+ description: |-
+ ParentReference identifies an API object (usually a Gateway) that can be considered
+ a parent of this resource (usually a route). There are two kinds of parent resources
+ with "Core" support:
+
+
+ * Gateway (Gateway conformance profile)
+ * Service (Mesh conformance profile, ClusterIP Services only)
+
+
+ This API may be extended in the future to support additional kinds of parent
+ resources.
+
+
+ The API object must be valid in the cluster; the Group and Kind must
+ be registered in the cluster for this reference to be valid.
+ properties:
+ group:
+ default: gateway.networking.k8s.io
+ description: |-
+ Group is the group of the referent.
+ When unspecified, "gateway.networking.k8s.io" is inferred.
+ To set the core API group (such as for a "Service" kind referent),
+ Group must be explicitly set to "" (empty string).
+
+
+ Support: Core
+ maxLength: 253
+ pattern: ^$|^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$
+ type: string
+ kind:
+ default: Gateway
+ description: |-
+ Kind is kind of the referent.
+
+
+ There are two kinds of parent resources with "Core" support:
+
+
+ * Gateway (Gateway conformance profile)
+ * Service (Mesh conformance profile, ClusterIP Services only)
+
+
+ Support for other resources is Implementation-Specific.
+ maxLength: 63
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[a-zA-Z]([-a-zA-Z0-9]*[a-zA-Z0-9])?$
+ type: string
+ name:
+ description: |-
+ Name is the name of the referent.
+
+
+ Support: Core
+ maxLength: 253
+ minLength: 1
+ type: string
+ namespace:
+ description: |-
+ Namespace is the namespace of the referent. When unspecified, this refers
+ to the local namespace of the Route.
+
+
+ Note that there are specific rules for ParentRefs which cross namespace
+ boundaries. Cross-namespace references are only valid if they are explicitly
+ allowed by something in the namespace they are referring to. For example:
+ Gateway has the AllowedRoutes field, and ReferenceGrant provides a
+ generic way to enable any other kind of cross-namespace reference.
+
+
+
+ ParentRefs from a Route to a Service in the same namespace are "producer"
+ routes, which apply default routing rules to inbound connections from
+ any namespace to the Service.
+
+
+ ParentRefs from a Route to a Service in a different namespace are
+ "consumer" routes, and these routing rules are only applied to outbound
+ connections originating from the same namespace as the Route, for which
+ the intended destination of the connections are a Service targeted as a
+ ParentRef of the Route.
+
+
+
+ Support: Core
+ maxLength: 63
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?$
+ type: string
+ port:
+ description: |-
+ Port is the network port this Route targets. It can be interpreted
+ differently based on the type of parent resource.
+
+
+ When the parent resource is a Gateway, this targets all listeners
+ listening on the specified port that also support this kind of Route(and
+ select this Route). It's not recommended to set `Port` unless the
+ networking behaviors specified in a Route must apply to a specific port
+ as opposed to a listener(s) whose port(s) may be changed. When both Port
+ and SectionName are specified, the name and port of the selected listener
+ must match both specified values.
+
+
+
+ When the parent resource is a Service, this targets a specific port in the
+ Service spec. When both Port (experimental) and SectionName are specified,
+ the name and port of the selected port must match both specified values.
+
+
+
+ Implementations MAY choose to support other parent resources.
+ Implementations supporting other types of parent resources MUST clearly
+ document how/if Port is interpreted.
+
+
+ For the purpose of status, an attachment is considered successful as
+ long as the parent resource accepts it partially. For example, Gateway
+ listeners can restrict which Routes can attach to them by Route kind,
+ namespace, or hostname. If 1 of 2 Gateway listeners accept attachment
+ from the referencing Route, the Route MUST be considered successfully
+ attached. If no Gateway listeners accept attachment from this Route,
+ the Route MUST be considered detached from the Gateway.
+
+
+ Support: Extended
+ format: int32
+ maximum: 65535
+ minimum: 1
+ type: integer
+ sectionName:
+ description: |-
+ SectionName is the name of a section within the target resource. In the
+ following resources, SectionName is interpreted as the following:
+
+
+ * Gateway: Listener name. When both Port (experimental) and SectionName
+ are specified, the name and port of the selected listener must match
+ both specified values.
+ * Service: Port name. When both Port (experimental) and SectionName
+ are specified, the name and port of the selected listener must match
+ both specified values.
+
+
+ Implementations MAY choose to support attaching Routes to other resources.
+ If that is the case, they MUST clearly document how SectionName is
+ interpreted.
+
+
+ When unspecified (empty string), this will reference the entire resource.
+ For the purpose of status, an attachment is considered successful if at
+ least one section in the parent resource accepts it. For example, Gateway
+ listeners can restrict which Routes can attach to them by Route kind,
+ namespace, or hostname. If 1 of 2 Gateway listeners accept attachment from
+ the referencing Route, the Route MUST be considered successfully
+ attached. If no Gateway listeners accept attachment from this Route, the
+ Route MUST be considered detached from the Gateway.
+
+
+ Support: Core
+ maxLength: 253
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$
+ type: string
+ required:
+ - name
+ type: object
+ maxItems: 32
+ type: array
+ x-kubernetes-validations:
+ - message: sectionName or port must be specified when parentRefs includes
+ 2 or more references to the same parent
+ rule: 'self.all(p1, self.all(p2, p1.group == p2.group && p1.kind
+ == p2.kind && p1.name == p2.name && (((!has(p1.__namespace__)
+ || p1.__namespace__ == '''') && (!has(p2.__namespace__) || p2.__namespace__
+ == '''')) || (has(p1.__namespace__) && has(p2.__namespace__) &&
+ p1.__namespace__ == p2.__namespace__)) ? ((!has(p1.sectionName)
+ || p1.sectionName == '''') == (!has(p2.sectionName) || p2.sectionName
+ == '''') && (!has(p1.port) || p1.port == 0) == (!has(p2.port)
+ || p2.port == 0)): true))'
+ - message: sectionName or port must be unique when parentRefs includes
+ 2 or more references to the same parent
+ rule: self.all(p1, self.exists_one(p2, p1.group == p2.group && p1.kind
+ == p2.kind && p1.name == p2.name && (((!has(p1.__namespace__)
+ || p1.__namespace__ == '') && (!has(p2.__namespace__) || p2.__namespace__
+ == '')) || (has(p1.__namespace__) && has(p2.__namespace__) &&
+ p1.__namespace__ == p2.__namespace__ )) && (((!has(p1.sectionName)
+ || p1.sectionName == '') && (!has(p2.sectionName) || p2.sectionName
+ == '')) || ( has(p1.sectionName) && has(p2.sectionName) && p1.sectionName
+ == p2.sectionName)) && (((!has(p1.port) || p1.port == 0) && (!has(p2.port)
+ || p2.port == 0)) || (has(p1.port) && has(p2.port) && p1.port
+ == p2.port))))
+ rules:
+ description: Rules are a list of TCP matchers and actions.
+ items:
+ description: TCPRouteRule is the configuration for a given rule.
+ properties:
+ backendRefs:
+ description: |-
+ BackendRefs defines the backend(s) where matching requests should be
+ sent. If unspecified or invalid (refers to a non-existent resource or a
+ Service with no endpoints), the underlying implementation MUST actively
+ reject connection attempts to this backend. Connection rejections must
+ respect weight; if an invalid backend is requested to have 80% of
+ connections, then 80% of connections must be rejected instead.
+
+
+ Support: Core for Kubernetes Service
+
+
+ Support: Extended for Kubernetes ServiceImport
+
+
+ Support: Implementation-specific for any other resource
+
+
+ Support for weight: Extended
+ items:
+ description: |-
+ BackendRef defines how a Route should forward a request to a Kubernetes
+ resource.
+
+
+ Note that when a namespace different than the local namespace is specified, a
+ ReferenceGrant object is required in the referent namespace to allow that
+ namespace's owner to accept the reference. See the ReferenceGrant
+ documentation for details.
+
+
+
+
+
+ When the BackendRef points to a Kubernetes Service, implementations SHOULD
+ honor the appProtocol field if it is set for the target Service Port.
+
+
+ Implementations supporting appProtocol SHOULD recognize the Kubernetes
+ Standard Application Protocols defined in KEP-3726.
+
+
+ If a Service appProtocol isn't specified, an implementation MAY infer the
+ backend protocol through its own means. Implementations MAY infer the
+ protocol from the Route type referring to the backend Service.
+
+
+ If a Route is not able to send traffic to the backend using the specified
+ protocol then the backend is considered invalid. Implementations MUST set the
+ "ResolvedRefs" condition to "False" with the "UnsupportedProtocol" reason.
+
+
+
+
+
+ Note that when the BackendTLSPolicy object is enabled by the implementation,
+ there are some extra rules about validity to consider here. See the fields
+ where this struct is used for more information about the exact behavior.
+ properties:
+ group:
+ default: ""
+ description: |-
+ Group is the group of the referent. For example, "gateway.networking.k8s.io".
+ When unspecified or empty string, core API group is inferred.
+ maxLength: 253
+ pattern: ^$|^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$
+ type: string
+ kind:
+ default: Service
+ description: |-
+ Kind is the Kubernetes resource kind of the referent. For example
+ "Service".
+
+
+ Defaults to "Service" when not specified.
+
+
+ ExternalName services can refer to CNAME DNS records that may live
+ outside of the cluster and as such are difficult to reason about in
+ terms of conformance. They also may not be safe to forward to (see
+ CVE-2021-25740 for more information). Implementations SHOULD NOT
+ support ExternalName Services.
+
+
+ Support: Core (Services with a type other than ExternalName)
+
+
+ Support: Implementation-specific (Services with type ExternalName)
+ maxLength: 63
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[a-zA-Z]([-a-zA-Z0-9]*[a-zA-Z0-9])?$
+ type: string
+ name:
+ description: Name is the name of the referent.
+ maxLength: 253
+ minLength: 1
+ type: string
+ namespace:
+ description: |-
+ Namespace is the namespace of the backend. When unspecified, the local
+ namespace is inferred.
+
+
+ Note that when a namespace different than the local namespace is specified,
+ a ReferenceGrant object is required in the referent namespace to allow that
+ namespace's owner to accept the reference. See the ReferenceGrant
+ documentation for details.
+
+
+ Support: Core
+ maxLength: 63
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?$
+ type: string
+ port:
+ description: |-
+ Port specifies the destination port number to use for this resource.
+ Port is required when the referent is a Kubernetes Service. In this
+ case, the port number is the service port number, not the target port.
+ For other resources, destination port might be derived from the referent
+ resource or this field.
+ format: int32
+ maximum: 65535
+ minimum: 1
+ type: integer
+ weight:
+ default: 1
+ description: |-
+ Weight specifies the proportion of requests forwarded to the referenced
+ backend. This is computed as weight/(sum of all weights in this
+ BackendRefs list). For non-zero values, there may be some epsilon from
+ the exact proportion defined here depending on the precision an
+ implementation supports. Weight is not a percentage and the sum of
+ weights does not need to equal 100.
+
+
+ If only one backend is specified and it has a weight greater than 0, 100%
+ of the traffic is forwarded to that backend. If weight is set to 0, no
+ traffic should be forwarded for this entry. If unspecified, weight
+ defaults to 1.
+
+
+ Support for this field varies based on the context where used.
+ format: int32
+ maximum: 1000000
+ minimum: 0
+ type: integer
+ required:
+ - name
+ type: object
+ x-kubernetes-validations:
+ - message: Must have port for Service reference
+ rule: '(size(self.group) == 0 && self.kind == ''Service'')
+ ? has(self.port) : true'
+ maxItems: 16
+ minItems: 1
+ type: array
+ type: object
+ maxItems: 16
+ minItems: 1
+ type: array
+ required:
+ - rules
+ type: object
+ status:
+ description: Status defines the current state of TCPRoute.
+ properties:
+ parents:
+ description: |-
+ Parents is a list of parent resources (usually Gateways) that are
+ associated with the route, and the status of the route with respect to
+ each parent. When this route attaches to a parent, the controller that
+ manages the parent must add an entry to this list when the controller
+ first sees the route and should update the entry as appropriate when the
+ route or gateway is modified.
+
+
+ Note that parent references that cannot be resolved by an implementation
+ of this API will not be added to this list. Implementations of this API
+ can only populate Route status for the Gateways/parent resources they are
+ responsible for.
+
+
+ A maximum of 32 Gateways will be represented in this list. An empty list
+ means the route has not been attached to any Gateway.
+ items:
+ description: |-
+ RouteParentStatus describes the status of a route with respect to an
+ associated Parent.
+ properties:
+ conditions:
+ description: |-
+ Conditions describes the status of the route with respect to the Gateway.
+ Note that the route's availability is also subject to the Gateway's own
+ status conditions and listener status.
+
+
+ If the Route's ParentRef specifies an existing Gateway that supports
+ Routes of this kind AND that Gateway's controller has sufficient access,
+ then that Gateway's controller MUST set the "Accepted" condition on the
+ Route, to indicate whether the route has been accepted or rejected by the
+ Gateway, and why.
+
+
+ A Route MUST be considered "Accepted" if at least one of the Route's
+ rules is implemented by the Gateway.
+
+
+ There are a number of cases where the "Accepted" condition may not be set
+ due to lack of controller visibility, that includes when:
+
+
+ * The Route refers to a non-existent parent.
+ * The Route is of a type that the controller does not support.
+ * The Route is in a namespace the controller does not have access to.
+ items:
+ description: "Condition contains details for one aspect of
+ the current state of this API Resource.\n---\nThis struct
+ is intended for direct use as an array at the field path
+ .status.conditions. For example,\n\n\n\ttype FooStatus
+ struct{\n\t // Represents the observations of a foo's
+ current state.\n\t // Known .status.conditions.type are:
+ \"Available\", \"Progressing\", and \"Degraded\"\n\t //
+ +patchMergeKey=type\n\t // +patchStrategy=merge\n\t //
+ +listType=map\n\t // +listMapKey=type\n\t Conditions
+ []metav1.Condition `json:\"conditions,omitempty\" patchStrategy:\"merge\"
+ patchMergeKey:\"type\" protobuf:\"bytes,1,rep,name=conditions\"`\n\n\n\t
+ \ // other fields\n\t}"
+ properties:
+ lastTransitionTime:
+ description: |-
+ lastTransitionTime is the last time the condition transitioned from one status to another.
+ This should be when the underlying condition changed. If that is not known, then using the time when the API field changed is acceptable.
+ format: date-time
+ type: string
+ message:
+ description: |-
+ message is a human readable message indicating details about the transition.
+ This may be an empty string.
+ maxLength: 32768
+ type: string
+ observedGeneration:
+ description: |-
+ observedGeneration represents the .metadata.generation that the condition was set based upon.
+ For instance, if .metadata.generation is currently 12, but the .status.conditions[x].observedGeneration is 9, the condition is out of date
+ with respect to the current state of the instance.
+ format: int64
+ minimum: 0
+ type: integer
+ reason:
+ description: |-
+ reason contains a programmatic identifier indicating the reason for the condition's last transition.
+ Producers of specific condition types may define expected values and meanings for this field,
+ and whether the values are considered a guaranteed API.
+ The value should be a CamelCase string.
+ This field may not be empty.
+ maxLength: 1024
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[A-Za-z]([A-Za-z0-9_,:]*[A-Za-z0-9_])?$
+ type: string
+ status:
+ description: status of the condition, one of True, False,
+ Unknown.
+ enum:
+ - "True"
+ - "False"
+ - Unknown
+ type: string
+ type:
+ description: |-
+ type of condition in CamelCase or in foo.example.com/CamelCase.
+ ---
+ Many .condition.type values are consistent across resources like Available, but because arbitrary conditions can be
+ useful (see .node.status.conditions), the ability to deconflict is important.
+ The regex it matches is (dns1123SubdomainFmt/)?(qualifiedNameFmt)
+ maxLength: 316
+ pattern: ^([a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*/)?(([A-Za-z0-9][-A-Za-z0-9_.]*)?[A-Za-z0-9])$
+ type: string
+ required:
+ - lastTransitionTime
+ - message
+ - reason
+ - status
+ - type
+ type: object
+ maxItems: 8
+ minItems: 1
+ type: array
+ x-kubernetes-list-map-keys:
+ - type
+ x-kubernetes-list-type: map
+ controllerName:
+ description: |-
+ ControllerName is a domain/path string that indicates the name of the
+ controller that wrote this status. This corresponds with the
+ controllerName field on GatewayClass.
+
+
+ Example: "example.net/gateway-controller".
+
+
+ The format of this field is DOMAIN "/" PATH, where DOMAIN and PATH are
+ valid Kubernetes names
+ (https://kubernetes.io/docs/concepts/overview/working-with-objects/names/#names).
+
+
+ Controllers MUST populate this field when writing status. Controllers should ensure that
+ entries to status populated with their ControllerName are cleaned up when they are no
+ longer necessary.
+ maxLength: 253
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*\/[A-Za-z0-9\/\-._~%!$&'()*+,;=:]+$
+ type: string
+ parentRef:
+ description: |-
+ ParentRef corresponds with a ParentRef in the spec that this
+ RouteParentStatus struct describes the status of.
+ properties:
+ group:
+ default: gateway.networking.k8s.io
+ description: |-
+ Group is the group of the referent.
+ When unspecified, "gateway.networking.k8s.io" is inferred.
+ To set the core API group (such as for a "Service" kind referent),
+ Group must be explicitly set to "" (empty string).
+
+
+ Support: Core
+ maxLength: 253
+ pattern: ^$|^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$
+ type: string
+ kind:
+ default: Gateway
+ description: |-
+ Kind is kind of the referent.
+
+
+ There are two kinds of parent resources with "Core" support:
+
+
+ * Gateway (Gateway conformance profile)
+ * Service (Mesh conformance profile, ClusterIP Services only)
+
+
+ Support for other resources is Implementation-Specific.
+ maxLength: 63
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[a-zA-Z]([-a-zA-Z0-9]*[a-zA-Z0-9])?$
+ type: string
+ name:
+ description: |-
+ Name is the name of the referent.
+
+
+ Support: Core
+ maxLength: 253
+ minLength: 1
+ type: string
+ namespace:
+ description: |-
+ Namespace is the namespace of the referent. When unspecified, this refers
+ to the local namespace of the Route.
+
+
+ Note that there are specific rules for ParentRefs which cross namespace
+ boundaries. Cross-namespace references are only valid if they are explicitly
+ allowed by something in the namespace they are referring to. For example:
+ Gateway has the AllowedRoutes field, and ReferenceGrant provides a
+ generic way to enable any other kind of cross-namespace reference.
+
+
+
+ ParentRefs from a Route to a Service in the same namespace are "producer"
+ routes, which apply default routing rules to inbound connections from
+ any namespace to the Service.
+
+
+ ParentRefs from a Route to a Service in a different namespace are
+ "consumer" routes, and these routing rules are only applied to outbound
+ connections originating from the same namespace as the Route, for which
+ the intended destination of the connections are a Service targeted as a
+ ParentRef of the Route.
+
+
+
+ Support: Core
+ maxLength: 63
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?$
+ type: string
+ port:
+ description: |-
+ Port is the network port this Route targets. It can be interpreted
+ differently based on the type of parent resource.
+
+
+ When the parent resource is a Gateway, this targets all listeners
+ listening on the specified port that also support this kind of Route(and
+ select this Route). It's not recommended to set `Port` unless the
+ networking behaviors specified in a Route must apply to a specific port
+ as opposed to a listener(s) whose port(s) may be changed. When both Port
+ and SectionName are specified, the name and port of the selected listener
+ must match both specified values.
+
+
+
+ When the parent resource is a Service, this targets a specific port in the
+ Service spec. When both Port (experimental) and SectionName are specified,
+ the name and port of the selected port must match both specified values.
+
+
+
+ Implementations MAY choose to support other parent resources.
+ Implementations supporting other types of parent resources MUST clearly
+ document how/if Port is interpreted.
+
+
+ For the purpose of status, an attachment is considered successful as
+ long as the parent resource accepts it partially. For example, Gateway
+ listeners can restrict which Routes can attach to them by Route kind,
+ namespace, or hostname. If 1 of 2 Gateway listeners accept attachment
+ from the referencing Route, the Route MUST be considered successfully
+ attached. If no Gateway listeners accept attachment from this Route,
+ the Route MUST be considered detached from the Gateway.
+
+
+ Support: Extended
+ format: int32
+ maximum: 65535
+ minimum: 1
+ type: integer
+ sectionName:
+ description: |-
+ SectionName is the name of a section within the target resource. In the
+ following resources, SectionName is interpreted as the following:
+
+
+ * Gateway: Listener name. When both Port (experimental) and SectionName
+ are specified, the name and port of the selected listener must match
+ both specified values.
+ * Service: Port name. When both Port (experimental) and SectionName
+ are specified, the name and port of the selected listener must match
+ both specified values.
+
+
+ Implementations MAY choose to support attaching Routes to other resources.
+ If that is the case, they MUST clearly document how SectionName is
+ interpreted.
+
+
+ When unspecified (empty string), this will reference the entire resource.
+ For the purpose of status, an attachment is considered successful if at
+ least one section in the parent resource accepts it. For example, Gateway
+ listeners can restrict which Routes can attach to them by Route kind,
+ namespace, or hostname. If 1 of 2 Gateway listeners accept attachment from
+ the referencing Route, the Route MUST be considered successfully
+ attached. If no Gateway listeners accept attachment from this Route, the
+ Route MUST be considered detached from the Gateway.
+
+
+ Support: Core
+ maxLength: 253
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$
+ type: string
+ required:
+ - name
+ type: object
+ required:
+ - controllerName
+ - parentRef
+ type: object
+ maxItems: 32
+ type: array
+ required:
+ - parents
+ type: object
+ required:
+ - spec
+ type: object
+ served: true
+ storage: true
+ subresources:
+ status: {}
+status:
+ acceptedNames:
+ kind: ""
+ plural: ""
+ conditions: null
+ storedVersions: null
+---
+#
+# config/crd/experimental/gateway.networking.k8s.io_tlsroutes.yaml
+#
+apiVersion: apiextensions.k8s.io/v1
+kind: CustomResourceDefinition
+metadata:
+ annotations:
+ api-approved.kubernetes.io: https://github.com/kubernetes-sigs/gateway-api/pull/2997
+ gateway.networking.k8s.io/bundle-version: v1.1.0
+ gateway.networking.k8s.io/channel: experimental
+ creationTimestamp: null
+ name: tlsroutes.gateway.networking.k8s.io
+spec:
+ group: gateway.networking.k8s.io
+ names:
+ categories:
+ - gateway-api
+ kind: TLSRoute
+ listKind: TLSRouteList
+ plural: tlsroutes
+ singular: tlsroute
+ scope: Namespaced
+ versions:
+ - additionalPrinterColumns:
+ - jsonPath: .metadata.creationTimestamp
+ name: Age
+ type: date
+ name: v1alpha2
+ schema:
+ openAPIV3Schema:
+ description: |-
+ The TLSRoute resource is similar to TCPRoute, but can be configured
+ to match against TLS-specific metadata. This allows more flexibility
+ in matching streams for a given TLS listener.
+
+
+ If you need to forward traffic to a single target for a TLS listener, you
+ could choose to use a TCPRoute with a TLS listener.
+ properties:
+ apiVersion:
+ description: |-
+ APIVersion defines the versioned schema of this representation of an object.
+ Servers should convert recognized schemas to the latest internal value, and
+ may reject unrecognized values.
+ More info: https://git.k8s.io/community/contributors/devel/sig-architecture/api-conventions.md#resources
+ type: string
+ kind:
+ description: |-
+ Kind is a string value representing the REST resource this object represents.
+ Servers may infer this from the endpoint the client submits requests to.
+ Cannot be updated.
+ In CamelCase.
+ More info: https://git.k8s.io/community/contributors/devel/sig-architecture/api-conventions.md#types-kinds
+ type: string
+ metadata:
+ type: object
+ spec:
+ description: Spec defines the desired state of TLSRoute.
+ properties:
+ hostnames:
+ description: |-
+ Hostnames defines a set of SNI names that should match against the
+ SNI attribute of TLS ClientHello message in TLS handshake. This matches
+ the RFC 1123 definition of a hostname with 2 notable exceptions:
+
+
+ 1. IPs are not allowed in SNI names per RFC 6066.
+ 2. A hostname may be prefixed with a wildcard label (`*.`). The wildcard
+ label must appear by itself as the first label.
+
+
+ If a hostname is specified by both the Listener and TLSRoute, there
+ must be at least one intersecting hostname for the TLSRoute to be
+ attached to the Listener. For example:
+
+
+ * A Listener with `test.example.com` as the hostname matches TLSRoutes
+ that have either not specified any hostnames, or have specified at
+ least one of `test.example.com` or `*.example.com`.
+ * A Listener with `*.example.com` as the hostname matches TLSRoutes
+ that have either not specified any hostnames or have specified at least
+ one hostname that matches the Listener hostname. For example,
+ `test.example.com` and `*.example.com` would both match. On the other
+ hand, `example.com` and `test.example.net` would not match.
+
+
+ If both the Listener and TLSRoute have specified hostnames, any
+ TLSRoute hostnames that do not match the Listener hostname MUST be
+ ignored. For example, if a Listener specified `*.example.com`, and the
+ TLSRoute specified `test.example.com` and `test.example.net`,
+ `test.example.net` must not be considered for a match.
+
+
+ If both the Listener and TLSRoute have specified hostnames, and none
+ match with the criteria above, then the TLSRoute is not accepted. The
+ implementation must raise an 'Accepted' Condition with a status of
+ `False` in the corresponding RouteParentStatus.
+
+
+ Support: Core
+ items:
+ description: |-
+ Hostname is the fully qualified domain name of a network host. This matches
+ the RFC 1123 definition of a hostname with 2 notable exceptions:
+
+
+ 1. IPs are not allowed.
+ 2. A hostname may be prefixed with a wildcard label (`*.`). The wildcard
+ label must appear by itself as the first label.
+
+
+ Hostname can be "precise" which is a domain name without the terminating
+ dot of a network host (e.g. "foo.example.com") or "wildcard", which is a
+ domain name prefixed with a single wildcard label (e.g. `*.example.com`).
+
+
+ Note that as per RFC1035 and RFC1123, a *label* must consist of lower case
+ alphanumeric characters or '-', and must start and end with an alphanumeric
+ character. No other punctuation is allowed.
+ maxLength: 253
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^(\*\.)?[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$
+ type: string
+ maxItems: 16
+ type: array
+ parentRefs:
+ description: |+
+ ParentRefs references the resources (usually Gateways) that a Route wants
+ to be attached to. Note that the referenced parent resource needs to
+ allow this for the attachment to be complete. For Gateways, that means
+ the Gateway needs to allow attachment from Routes of this kind and
+ namespace. For Services, that means the Service must either be in the same
+ namespace for a "producer" route, or the mesh implementation must support
+ and allow "consumer" routes for the referenced Service. ReferenceGrant is
+ not applicable for governing ParentRefs to Services - it is not possible to
+ create a "producer" route for a Service in a different namespace from the
+ Route.
+
+
+ There are two kinds of parent resources with "Core" support:
+
+
+ * Gateway (Gateway conformance profile)
+ * Service (Mesh conformance profile, ClusterIP Services only)
+
+
+ This API may be extended in the future to support additional kinds of parent
+ resources.
+
+
+ ParentRefs must be _distinct_. This means either that:
+
+
+ * They select different objects. If this is the case, then parentRef
+ entries are distinct. In terms of fields, this means that the
+ multi-part key defined by `group`, `kind`, `namespace`, and `name` must
+ be unique across all parentRef entries in the Route.
+ * They do not select different objects, but for each optional field used,
+ each ParentRef that selects the same object must set the same set of
+ optional fields to different values. If one ParentRef sets a
+ combination of optional fields, all must set the same combination.
+
+
+ Some examples:
+
+
+ * If one ParentRef sets `sectionName`, all ParentRefs referencing the
+ same object must also set `sectionName`.
+ * If one ParentRef sets `port`, all ParentRefs referencing the same
+ object must also set `port`.
+ * If one ParentRef sets `sectionName` and `port`, all ParentRefs
+ referencing the same object must also set `sectionName` and `port`.
+
+
+ It is possible to separately reference multiple distinct objects that may
+ be collapsed by an implementation. For example, some implementations may
+ choose to merge compatible Gateway Listeners together. If that is the
+ case, the list of routes attached to those resources should also be
+ merged.
+
+
+ Note that for ParentRefs that cross namespace boundaries, there are specific
+ rules. Cross-namespace references are only valid if they are explicitly
+ allowed by something in the namespace they are referring to. For example,
+ Gateway has the AllowedRoutes field, and ReferenceGrant provides a
+ generic way to enable other kinds of cross-namespace reference.
+
+
+
+ ParentRefs from a Route to a Service in the same namespace are "producer"
+ routes, which apply default routing rules to inbound connections from
+ any namespace to the Service.
+
+
+ ParentRefs from a Route to a Service in a different namespace are
+ "consumer" routes, and these routing rules are only applied to outbound
+ connections originating from the same namespace as the Route, for which
+ the intended destination of the connections are a Service targeted as a
+ ParentRef of the Route.
+
+
+
+
+
+
+ items:
+ description: |-
+ ParentReference identifies an API object (usually a Gateway) that can be considered
+ a parent of this resource (usually a route). There are two kinds of parent resources
+ with "Core" support:
+
+
+ * Gateway (Gateway conformance profile)
+ * Service (Mesh conformance profile, ClusterIP Services only)
+
+
+ This API may be extended in the future to support additional kinds of parent
+ resources.
+
+
+ The API object must be valid in the cluster; the Group and Kind must
+ be registered in the cluster for this reference to be valid.
+ properties:
+ group:
+ default: gateway.networking.k8s.io
+ description: |-
+ Group is the group of the referent.
+ When unspecified, "gateway.networking.k8s.io" is inferred.
+ To set the core API group (such as for a "Service" kind referent),
+ Group must be explicitly set to "" (empty string).
+
+
+ Support: Core
+ maxLength: 253
+ pattern: ^$|^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$
+ type: string
+ kind:
+ default: Gateway
+ description: |-
+ Kind is kind of the referent.
+
+
+ There are two kinds of parent resources with "Core" support:
+
+
+ * Gateway (Gateway conformance profile)
+ * Service (Mesh conformance profile, ClusterIP Services only)
+
+
+ Support for other resources is Implementation-Specific.
+ maxLength: 63
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[a-zA-Z]([-a-zA-Z0-9]*[a-zA-Z0-9])?$
+ type: string
+ name:
+ description: |-
+ Name is the name of the referent.
+
+
+ Support: Core
+ maxLength: 253
+ minLength: 1
+ type: string
+ namespace:
+ description: |-
+ Namespace is the namespace of the referent. When unspecified, this refers
+ to the local namespace of the Route.
+
+
+ Note that there are specific rules for ParentRefs which cross namespace
+ boundaries. Cross-namespace references are only valid if they are explicitly
+ allowed by something in the namespace they are referring to. For example:
+ Gateway has the AllowedRoutes field, and ReferenceGrant provides a
+ generic way to enable any other kind of cross-namespace reference.
+
+
+
+ ParentRefs from a Route to a Service in the same namespace are "producer"
+ routes, which apply default routing rules to inbound connections from
+ any namespace to the Service.
+
+
+ ParentRefs from a Route to a Service in a different namespace are
+ "consumer" routes, and these routing rules are only applied to outbound
+ connections originating from the same namespace as the Route, for which
+ the intended destination of the connections are a Service targeted as a
+ ParentRef of the Route.
+
+
+
+ Support: Core
+ maxLength: 63
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?$
+ type: string
+ port:
+ description: |-
+ Port is the network port this Route targets. It can be interpreted
+ differently based on the type of parent resource.
+
+
+ When the parent resource is a Gateway, this targets all listeners
+ listening on the specified port that also support this kind of Route(and
+ select this Route). It's not recommended to set `Port` unless the
+ networking behaviors specified in a Route must apply to a specific port
+ as opposed to a listener(s) whose port(s) may be changed. When both Port
+ and SectionName are specified, the name and port of the selected listener
+ must match both specified values.
+
+
+
+ When the parent resource is a Service, this targets a specific port in the
+ Service spec. When both Port (experimental) and SectionName are specified,
+ the name and port of the selected port must match both specified values.
+
+
+
+ Implementations MAY choose to support other parent resources.
+ Implementations supporting other types of parent resources MUST clearly
+ document how/if Port is interpreted.
+
+
+ For the purpose of status, an attachment is considered successful as
+ long as the parent resource accepts it partially. For example, Gateway
+ listeners can restrict which Routes can attach to them by Route kind,
+ namespace, or hostname. If 1 of 2 Gateway listeners accept attachment
+ from the referencing Route, the Route MUST be considered successfully
+ attached. If no Gateway listeners accept attachment from this Route,
+ the Route MUST be considered detached from the Gateway.
+
+
+ Support: Extended
+ format: int32
+ maximum: 65535
+ minimum: 1
+ type: integer
+ sectionName:
+ description: |-
+ SectionName is the name of a section within the target resource. In the
+ following resources, SectionName is interpreted as the following:
+
+
+ * Gateway: Listener name. When both Port (experimental) and SectionName
+ are specified, the name and port of the selected listener must match
+ both specified values.
+ * Service: Port name. When both Port (experimental) and SectionName
+ are specified, the name and port of the selected listener must match
+ both specified values.
+
+
+ Implementations MAY choose to support attaching Routes to other resources.
+ If that is the case, they MUST clearly document how SectionName is
+ interpreted.
+
+
+ When unspecified (empty string), this will reference the entire resource.
+ For the purpose of status, an attachment is considered successful if at
+ least one section in the parent resource accepts it. For example, Gateway
+ listeners can restrict which Routes can attach to them by Route kind,
+ namespace, or hostname. If 1 of 2 Gateway listeners accept attachment from
+ the referencing Route, the Route MUST be considered successfully
+ attached. If no Gateway listeners accept attachment from this Route, the
+ Route MUST be considered detached from the Gateway.
+
+
+ Support: Core
+ maxLength: 253
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$
+ type: string
+ required:
+ - name
+ type: object
+ maxItems: 32
+ type: array
+ x-kubernetes-validations:
+ - message: sectionName or port must be specified when parentRefs includes
+ 2 or more references to the same parent
+ rule: 'self.all(p1, self.all(p2, p1.group == p2.group && p1.kind
+ == p2.kind && p1.name == p2.name && (((!has(p1.__namespace__)
+ || p1.__namespace__ == '''') && (!has(p2.__namespace__) || p2.__namespace__
+ == '''')) || (has(p1.__namespace__) && has(p2.__namespace__) &&
+ p1.__namespace__ == p2.__namespace__)) ? ((!has(p1.sectionName)
+ || p1.sectionName == '''') == (!has(p2.sectionName) || p2.sectionName
+ == '''') && (!has(p1.port) || p1.port == 0) == (!has(p2.port)
+ || p2.port == 0)): true))'
+ - message: sectionName or port must be unique when parentRefs includes
+ 2 or more references to the same parent
+ rule: self.all(p1, self.exists_one(p2, p1.group == p2.group && p1.kind
+ == p2.kind && p1.name == p2.name && (((!has(p1.__namespace__)
+ || p1.__namespace__ == '') && (!has(p2.__namespace__) || p2.__namespace__
+ == '')) || (has(p1.__namespace__) && has(p2.__namespace__) &&
+ p1.__namespace__ == p2.__namespace__ )) && (((!has(p1.sectionName)
+ || p1.sectionName == '') && (!has(p2.sectionName) || p2.sectionName
+ == '')) || ( has(p1.sectionName) && has(p2.sectionName) && p1.sectionName
+ == p2.sectionName)) && (((!has(p1.port) || p1.port == 0) && (!has(p2.port)
+ || p2.port == 0)) || (has(p1.port) && has(p2.port) && p1.port
+ == p2.port))))
+ rules:
+ description: Rules are a list of TLS matchers and actions.
+ items:
+ description: TLSRouteRule is the configuration for a given rule.
+ properties:
+ backendRefs:
+ description: |-
+ BackendRefs defines the backend(s) where matching requests should be
+ sent. If unspecified or invalid (refers to a non-existent resource or
+ a Service with no endpoints), the rule performs no forwarding; if no
+ filters are specified that would result in a response being sent, the
+ underlying implementation must actively reject request attempts to this
+ backend, by rejecting the connection or returning a 500 status code.
+ Request rejections must respect weight; if an invalid backend is
+ requested to have 80% of requests, then 80% of requests must be rejected
+ instead.
+
+
+ Support: Core for Kubernetes Service
+
+
+ Support: Extended for Kubernetes ServiceImport
+
+
+ Support: Implementation-specific for any other resource
+
+
+ Support for weight: Extended
+ items:
+ description: |-
+ BackendRef defines how a Route should forward a request to a Kubernetes
+ resource.
+
+
+ Note that when a namespace different than the local namespace is specified, a
+ ReferenceGrant object is required in the referent namespace to allow that
+ namespace's owner to accept the reference. See the ReferenceGrant
+ documentation for details.
+
+
+
+
+
+ When the BackendRef points to a Kubernetes Service, implementations SHOULD
+ honor the appProtocol field if it is set for the target Service Port.
+
+
+ Implementations supporting appProtocol SHOULD recognize the Kubernetes
+ Standard Application Protocols defined in KEP-3726.
+
+
+ If a Service appProtocol isn't specified, an implementation MAY infer the
+ backend protocol through its own means. Implementations MAY infer the
+ protocol from the Route type referring to the backend Service.
+
+
+ If a Route is not able to send traffic to the backend using the specified
+ protocol then the backend is considered invalid. Implementations MUST set the
+ "ResolvedRefs" condition to "False" with the "UnsupportedProtocol" reason.
+
+
+
+
+
+ Note that when the BackendTLSPolicy object is enabled by the implementation,
+ there are some extra rules about validity to consider here. See the fields
+ where this struct is used for more information about the exact behavior.
+ properties:
+ group:
+ default: ""
+ description: |-
+ Group is the group of the referent. For example, "gateway.networking.k8s.io".
+ When unspecified or empty string, core API group is inferred.
+ maxLength: 253
+ pattern: ^$|^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$
+ type: string
+ kind:
+ default: Service
+ description: |-
+ Kind is the Kubernetes resource kind of the referent. For example
+ "Service".
+
+
+ Defaults to "Service" when not specified.
+
+
+ ExternalName services can refer to CNAME DNS records that may live
+ outside of the cluster and as such are difficult to reason about in
+ terms of conformance. They also may not be safe to forward to (see
+ CVE-2021-25740 for more information). Implementations SHOULD NOT
+ support ExternalName Services.
+
+
+ Support: Core (Services with a type other than ExternalName)
+
+
+ Support: Implementation-specific (Services with type ExternalName)
+ maxLength: 63
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[a-zA-Z]([-a-zA-Z0-9]*[a-zA-Z0-9])?$
+ type: string
+ name:
+ description: Name is the name of the referent.
+ maxLength: 253
+ minLength: 1
+ type: string
+ namespace:
+ description: |-
+ Namespace is the namespace of the backend. When unspecified, the local
+ namespace is inferred.
+
+
+ Note that when a namespace different than the local namespace is specified,
+ a ReferenceGrant object is required in the referent namespace to allow that
+ namespace's owner to accept the reference. See the ReferenceGrant
+ documentation for details.
+
+
+ Support: Core
+ maxLength: 63
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?$
+ type: string
+ port:
+ description: |-
+ Port specifies the destination port number to use for this resource.
+ Port is required when the referent is a Kubernetes Service. In this
+ case, the port number is the service port number, not the target port.
+ For other resources, destination port might be derived from the referent
+ resource or this field.
+ format: int32
+ maximum: 65535
+ minimum: 1
+ type: integer
+ weight:
+ default: 1
+ description: |-
+ Weight specifies the proportion of requests forwarded to the referenced
+ backend. This is computed as weight/(sum of all weights in this
+ BackendRefs list). For non-zero values, there may be some epsilon from
+ the exact proportion defined here depending on the precision an
+ implementation supports. Weight is not a percentage and the sum of
+ weights does not need to equal 100.
+
+
+ If only one backend is specified and it has a weight greater than 0, 100%
+ of the traffic is forwarded to that backend. If weight is set to 0, no
+ traffic should be forwarded for this entry. If unspecified, weight
+ defaults to 1.
+
+
+ Support for this field varies based on the context where used.
+ format: int32
+ maximum: 1000000
+ minimum: 0
+ type: integer
+ required:
+ - name
+ type: object
+ x-kubernetes-validations:
+ - message: Must have port for Service reference
+ rule: '(size(self.group) == 0 && self.kind == ''Service'')
+ ? has(self.port) : true'
+ maxItems: 16
+ minItems: 1
+ type: array
+ type: object
+ maxItems: 16
+ minItems: 1
+ type: array
+ required:
+ - rules
+ type: object
+ status:
+ description: Status defines the current state of TLSRoute.
+ properties:
+ parents:
+ description: |-
+ Parents is a list of parent resources (usually Gateways) that are
+ associated with the route, and the status of the route with respect to
+ each parent. When this route attaches to a parent, the controller that
+ manages the parent must add an entry to this list when the controller
+ first sees the route and should update the entry as appropriate when the
+ route or gateway is modified.
+
+
+ Note that parent references that cannot be resolved by an implementation
+ of this API will not be added to this list. Implementations of this API
+ can only populate Route status for the Gateways/parent resources they are
+ responsible for.
+
+
+ A maximum of 32 Gateways will be represented in this list. An empty list
+ means the route has not been attached to any Gateway.
+ items:
+ description: |-
+ RouteParentStatus describes the status of a route with respect to an
+ associated Parent.
+ properties:
+ conditions:
+ description: |-
+ Conditions describes the status of the route with respect to the Gateway.
+ Note that the route's availability is also subject to the Gateway's own
+ status conditions and listener status.
+
+
+ If the Route's ParentRef specifies an existing Gateway that supports
+ Routes of this kind AND that Gateway's controller has sufficient access,
+ then that Gateway's controller MUST set the "Accepted" condition on the
+ Route, to indicate whether the route has been accepted or rejected by the
+ Gateway, and why.
+
+
+ A Route MUST be considered "Accepted" if at least one of the Route's
+ rules is implemented by the Gateway.
+
+
+ There are a number of cases where the "Accepted" condition may not be set
+ due to lack of controller visibility, that includes when:
+
+
+ * The Route refers to a non-existent parent.
+ * The Route is of a type that the controller does not support.
+ * The Route is in a namespace the controller does not have access to.
+ items:
+ description: "Condition contains details for one aspect of
+ the current state of this API Resource.\n---\nThis struct
+ is intended for direct use as an array at the field path
+ .status.conditions. For example,\n\n\n\ttype FooStatus
+ struct{\n\t // Represents the observations of a foo's
+ current state.\n\t // Known .status.conditions.type are:
+ \"Available\", \"Progressing\", and \"Degraded\"\n\t //
+ +patchMergeKey=type\n\t // +patchStrategy=merge\n\t //
+ +listType=map\n\t // +listMapKey=type\n\t Conditions
+ []metav1.Condition `json:\"conditions,omitempty\" patchStrategy:\"merge\"
+ patchMergeKey:\"type\" protobuf:\"bytes,1,rep,name=conditions\"`\n\n\n\t
+ \ // other fields\n\t}"
+ properties:
+ lastTransitionTime:
+ description: |-
+ lastTransitionTime is the last time the condition transitioned from one status to another.
+ This should be when the underlying condition changed. If that is not known, then using the time when the API field changed is acceptable.
+ format: date-time
+ type: string
+ message:
+ description: |-
+ message is a human readable message indicating details about the transition.
+ This may be an empty string.
+ maxLength: 32768
+ type: string
+ observedGeneration:
+ description: |-
+ observedGeneration represents the .metadata.generation that the condition was set based upon.
+ For instance, if .metadata.generation is currently 12, but the .status.conditions[x].observedGeneration is 9, the condition is out of date
+ with respect to the current state of the instance.
+ format: int64
+ minimum: 0
+ type: integer
+ reason:
+ description: |-
+ reason contains a programmatic identifier indicating the reason for the condition's last transition.
+ Producers of specific condition types may define expected values and meanings for this field,
+ and whether the values are considered a guaranteed API.
+ The value should be a CamelCase string.
+ This field may not be empty.
+ maxLength: 1024
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[A-Za-z]([A-Za-z0-9_,:]*[A-Za-z0-9_])?$
+ type: string
+ status:
+ description: status of the condition, one of True, False,
+ Unknown.
+ enum:
+ - "True"
+ - "False"
+ - Unknown
+ type: string
+ type:
+ description: |-
+ type of condition in CamelCase or in foo.example.com/CamelCase.
+ ---
+ Many .condition.type values are consistent across resources like Available, but because arbitrary conditions can be
+ useful (see .node.status.conditions), the ability to deconflict is important.
+ The regex it matches is (dns1123SubdomainFmt/)?(qualifiedNameFmt)
+ maxLength: 316
+ pattern: ^([a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*/)?(([A-Za-z0-9][-A-Za-z0-9_.]*)?[A-Za-z0-9])$
+ type: string
+ required:
+ - lastTransitionTime
+ - message
+ - reason
+ - status
+ - type
+ type: object
+ maxItems: 8
+ minItems: 1
+ type: array
+ x-kubernetes-list-map-keys:
+ - type
+ x-kubernetes-list-type: map
+ controllerName:
+ description: |-
+ ControllerName is a domain/path string that indicates the name of the
+ controller that wrote this status. This corresponds with the
+ controllerName field on GatewayClass.
+
+
+ Example: "example.net/gateway-controller".
+
+
+ The format of this field is DOMAIN "/" PATH, where DOMAIN and PATH are
+ valid Kubernetes names
+ (https://kubernetes.io/docs/concepts/overview/working-with-objects/names/#names).
+
+
+ Controllers MUST populate this field when writing status. Controllers should ensure that
+ entries to status populated with their ControllerName are cleaned up when they are no
+ longer necessary.
+ maxLength: 253
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*\/[A-Za-z0-9\/\-._~%!$&'()*+,;=:]+$
+ type: string
+ parentRef:
+ description: |-
+ ParentRef corresponds with a ParentRef in the spec that this
+ RouteParentStatus struct describes the status of.
+ properties:
+ group:
+ default: gateway.networking.k8s.io
+ description: |-
+ Group is the group of the referent.
+ When unspecified, "gateway.networking.k8s.io" is inferred.
+ To set the core API group (such as for a "Service" kind referent),
+ Group must be explicitly set to "" (empty string).
+
+
+ Support: Core
+ maxLength: 253
+ pattern: ^$|^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$
+ type: string
+ kind:
+ default: Gateway
+ description: |-
+ Kind is kind of the referent.
+
+
+ There are two kinds of parent resources with "Core" support:
+
+
+ * Gateway (Gateway conformance profile)
+ * Service (Mesh conformance profile, ClusterIP Services only)
+
+
+ Support for other resources is Implementation-Specific.
+ maxLength: 63
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[a-zA-Z]([-a-zA-Z0-9]*[a-zA-Z0-9])?$
+ type: string
+ name:
+ description: |-
+ Name is the name of the referent.
+
+
+ Support: Core
+ maxLength: 253
+ minLength: 1
+ type: string
+ namespace:
+ description: |-
+ Namespace is the namespace of the referent. When unspecified, this refers
+ to the local namespace of the Route.
+
+
+ Note that there are specific rules for ParentRefs which cross namespace
+ boundaries. Cross-namespace references are only valid if they are explicitly
+ allowed by something in the namespace they are referring to. For example:
+ Gateway has the AllowedRoutes field, and ReferenceGrant provides a
+ generic way to enable any other kind of cross-namespace reference.
+
+
+
+ ParentRefs from a Route to a Service in the same namespace are "producer"
+ routes, which apply default routing rules to inbound connections from
+ any namespace to the Service.
+
+
+ ParentRefs from a Route to a Service in a different namespace are
+ "consumer" routes, and these routing rules are only applied to outbound
+ connections originating from the same namespace as the Route, for which
+ the intended destination of the connections are a Service targeted as a
+ ParentRef of the Route.
+
+
+
+ Support: Core
+ maxLength: 63
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?$
+ type: string
+ port:
+ description: |-
+ Port is the network port this Route targets. It can be interpreted
+ differently based on the type of parent resource.
+
+
+ When the parent resource is a Gateway, this targets all listeners
+ listening on the specified port that also support this kind of Route(and
+ select this Route). It's not recommended to set `Port` unless the
+ networking behaviors specified in a Route must apply to a specific port
+ as opposed to a listener(s) whose port(s) may be changed. When both Port
+ and SectionName are specified, the name and port of the selected listener
+ must match both specified values.
+
+
+
+ When the parent resource is a Service, this targets a specific port in the
+ Service spec. When both Port (experimental) and SectionName are specified,
+ the name and port of the selected port must match both specified values.
+
+
+
+ Implementations MAY choose to support other parent resources.
+ Implementations supporting other types of parent resources MUST clearly
+ document how/if Port is interpreted.
+
+
+ For the purpose of status, an attachment is considered successful as
+ long as the parent resource accepts it partially. For example, Gateway
+ listeners can restrict which Routes can attach to them by Route kind,
+ namespace, or hostname. If 1 of 2 Gateway listeners accept attachment
+ from the referencing Route, the Route MUST be considered successfully
+ attached. If no Gateway listeners accept attachment from this Route,
+ the Route MUST be considered detached from the Gateway.
+
+
+ Support: Extended
+ format: int32
+ maximum: 65535
+ minimum: 1
+ type: integer
+ sectionName:
+ description: |-
+ SectionName is the name of a section within the target resource. In the
+ following resources, SectionName is interpreted as the following:
+
+
+ * Gateway: Listener name. When both Port (experimental) and SectionName
+ are specified, the name and port of the selected listener must match
+ both specified values.
+ * Service: Port name. When both Port (experimental) and SectionName
+ are specified, the name and port of the selected listener must match
+ both specified values.
+
+
+ Implementations MAY choose to support attaching Routes to other resources.
+ If that is the case, they MUST clearly document how SectionName is
+ interpreted.
+
+
+ When unspecified (empty string), this will reference the entire resource.
+ For the purpose of status, an attachment is considered successful if at
+ least one section in the parent resource accepts it. For example, Gateway
+ listeners can restrict which Routes can attach to them by Route kind,
+ namespace, or hostname. If 1 of 2 Gateway listeners accept attachment from
+ the referencing Route, the Route MUST be considered successfully
+ attached. If no Gateway listeners accept attachment from this Route, the
+ Route MUST be considered detached from the Gateway.
+
+
+ Support: Core
+ maxLength: 253
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$
+ type: string
+ required:
+ - name
+ type: object
+ required:
+ - controllerName
+ - parentRef
+ type: object
+ maxItems: 32
+ type: array
+ required:
+ - parents
+ type: object
+ required:
+ - spec
+ type: object
+ served: true
+ storage: true
+ subresources:
+ status: {}
+status:
+ acceptedNames:
+ kind: ""
+ plural: ""
+ conditions: null
+ storedVersions: null
+---
+#
+# config/crd/experimental/gateway.networking.k8s.io_udproutes.yaml
+#
+apiVersion: apiextensions.k8s.io/v1
+kind: CustomResourceDefinition
+metadata:
+ annotations:
+ api-approved.kubernetes.io: https://github.com/kubernetes-sigs/gateway-api/pull/2997
+ gateway.networking.k8s.io/bundle-version: v1.1.0
+ gateway.networking.k8s.io/channel: experimental
+ creationTimestamp: null
+ name: udproutes.gateway.networking.k8s.io
+spec:
+ group: gateway.networking.k8s.io
+ names:
+ categories:
+ - gateway-api
+ kind: UDPRoute
+ listKind: UDPRouteList
+ plural: udproutes
+ singular: udproute
+ scope: Namespaced
+ versions:
+ - additionalPrinterColumns:
+ - jsonPath: .metadata.creationTimestamp
+ name: Age
+ type: date
+ name: v1alpha2
+ schema:
+ openAPIV3Schema:
+ description: |-
+ UDPRoute provides a way to route UDP traffic. When combined with a Gateway
+ listener, it can be used to forward traffic on the port specified by the
+ listener to a set of backends specified by the UDPRoute.
+ properties:
+ apiVersion:
+ description: |-
+ APIVersion defines the versioned schema of this representation of an object.
+ Servers should convert recognized schemas to the latest internal value, and
+ may reject unrecognized values.
+ More info: https://git.k8s.io/community/contributors/devel/sig-architecture/api-conventions.md#resources
+ type: string
+ kind:
+ description: |-
+ Kind is a string value representing the REST resource this object represents.
+ Servers may infer this from the endpoint the client submits requests to.
+ Cannot be updated.
+ In CamelCase.
+ More info: https://git.k8s.io/community/contributors/devel/sig-architecture/api-conventions.md#types-kinds
+ type: string
+ metadata:
+ type: object
+ spec:
+ description: Spec defines the desired state of UDPRoute.
+ properties:
+ parentRefs:
+ description: |+
+ ParentRefs references the resources (usually Gateways) that a Route wants
+ to be attached to. Note that the referenced parent resource needs to
+ allow this for the attachment to be complete. For Gateways, that means
+ the Gateway needs to allow attachment from Routes of this kind and
+ namespace. For Services, that means the Service must either be in the same
+ namespace for a "producer" route, or the mesh implementation must support
+ and allow "consumer" routes for the referenced Service. ReferenceGrant is
+ not applicable for governing ParentRefs to Services - it is not possible to
+ create a "producer" route for a Service in a different namespace from the
+ Route.
+
+
+ There are two kinds of parent resources with "Core" support:
+
+
+ * Gateway (Gateway conformance profile)
+ * Service (Mesh conformance profile, ClusterIP Services only)
+
+
+ This API may be extended in the future to support additional kinds of parent
+ resources.
+
+
+ ParentRefs must be _distinct_. This means either that:
+
+
+ * They select different objects. If this is the case, then parentRef
+ entries are distinct. In terms of fields, this means that the
+ multi-part key defined by `group`, `kind`, `namespace`, and `name` must
+ be unique across all parentRef entries in the Route.
+ * They do not select different objects, but for each optional field used,
+ each ParentRef that selects the same object must set the same set of
+ optional fields to different values. If one ParentRef sets a
+ combination of optional fields, all must set the same combination.
+
+
+ Some examples:
+
+
+ * If one ParentRef sets `sectionName`, all ParentRefs referencing the
+ same object must also set `sectionName`.
+ * If one ParentRef sets `port`, all ParentRefs referencing the same
+ object must also set `port`.
+ * If one ParentRef sets `sectionName` and `port`, all ParentRefs
+ referencing the same object must also set `sectionName` and `port`.
+
+
+ It is possible to separately reference multiple distinct objects that may
+ be collapsed by an implementation. For example, some implementations may
+ choose to merge compatible Gateway Listeners together. If that is the
+ case, the list of routes attached to those resources should also be
+ merged.
+
+
+ Note that for ParentRefs that cross namespace boundaries, there are specific
+ rules. Cross-namespace references are only valid if they are explicitly
+ allowed by something in the namespace they are referring to. For example,
+ Gateway has the AllowedRoutes field, and ReferenceGrant provides a
+ generic way to enable other kinds of cross-namespace reference.
+
+
+
+ ParentRefs from a Route to a Service in the same namespace are "producer"
+ routes, which apply default routing rules to inbound connections from
+ any namespace to the Service.
+
+
+ ParentRefs from a Route to a Service in a different namespace are
+ "consumer" routes, and these routing rules are only applied to outbound
+ connections originating from the same namespace as the Route, for which
+ the intended destination of the connections are a Service targeted as a
+ ParentRef of the Route.
+
+
+
+
+
+
+ items:
+ description: |-
+ ParentReference identifies an API object (usually a Gateway) that can be considered
+ a parent of this resource (usually a route). There are two kinds of parent resources
+ with "Core" support:
+
+
+ * Gateway (Gateway conformance profile)
+ * Service (Mesh conformance profile, ClusterIP Services only)
+
+
+ This API may be extended in the future to support additional kinds of parent
+ resources.
+
+
+ The API object must be valid in the cluster; the Group and Kind must
+ be registered in the cluster for this reference to be valid.
+ properties:
+ group:
+ default: gateway.networking.k8s.io
+ description: |-
+ Group is the group of the referent.
+ When unspecified, "gateway.networking.k8s.io" is inferred.
+ To set the core API group (such as for a "Service" kind referent),
+ Group must be explicitly set to "" (empty string).
+
+
+ Support: Core
+ maxLength: 253
+ pattern: ^$|^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$
+ type: string
+ kind:
+ default: Gateway
+ description: |-
+ Kind is kind of the referent.
+
+
+ There are two kinds of parent resources with "Core" support:
+
+
+ * Gateway (Gateway conformance profile)
+ * Service (Mesh conformance profile, ClusterIP Services only)
+
+
+ Support for other resources is Implementation-Specific.
+ maxLength: 63
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[a-zA-Z]([-a-zA-Z0-9]*[a-zA-Z0-9])?$
+ type: string
+ name:
+ description: |-
+ Name is the name of the referent.
+
+
+ Support: Core
+ maxLength: 253
+ minLength: 1
+ type: string
+ namespace:
+ description: |-
+ Namespace is the namespace of the referent. When unspecified, this refers
+ to the local namespace of the Route.
+
+
+ Note that there are specific rules for ParentRefs which cross namespace
+ boundaries. Cross-namespace references are only valid if they are explicitly
+ allowed by something in the namespace they are referring to. For example:
+ Gateway has the AllowedRoutes field, and ReferenceGrant provides a
+ generic way to enable any other kind of cross-namespace reference.
+
+
+
+ ParentRefs from a Route to a Service in the same namespace are "producer"
+ routes, which apply default routing rules to inbound connections from
+ any namespace to the Service.
+
+
+ ParentRefs from a Route to a Service in a different namespace are
+ "consumer" routes, and these routing rules are only applied to outbound
+ connections originating from the same namespace as the Route, for which
+ the intended destination of the connections are a Service targeted as a
+ ParentRef of the Route.
+
+
+
+ Support: Core
+ maxLength: 63
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?$
+ type: string
+ port:
+ description: |-
+ Port is the network port this Route targets. It can be interpreted
+ differently based on the type of parent resource.
+
+
+ When the parent resource is a Gateway, this targets all listeners
+ listening on the specified port that also support this kind of Route(and
+ select this Route). It's not recommended to set `Port` unless the
+ networking behaviors specified in a Route must apply to a specific port
+ as opposed to a listener(s) whose port(s) may be changed. When both Port
+ and SectionName are specified, the name and port of the selected listener
+ must match both specified values.
+
+
+
+ When the parent resource is a Service, this targets a specific port in the
+ Service spec. When both Port (experimental) and SectionName are specified,
+ the name and port of the selected port must match both specified values.
+
+
+
+ Implementations MAY choose to support other parent resources.
+ Implementations supporting other types of parent resources MUST clearly
+ document how/if Port is interpreted.
+
+
+ For the purpose of status, an attachment is considered successful as
+ long as the parent resource accepts it partially. For example, Gateway
+ listeners can restrict which Routes can attach to them by Route kind,
+ namespace, or hostname. If 1 of 2 Gateway listeners accept attachment
+ from the referencing Route, the Route MUST be considered successfully
+ attached. If no Gateway listeners accept attachment from this Route,
+ the Route MUST be considered detached from the Gateway.
+
+
+ Support: Extended
+ format: int32
+ maximum: 65535
+ minimum: 1
+ type: integer
+ sectionName:
+ description: |-
+ SectionName is the name of a section within the target resource. In the
+ following resources, SectionName is interpreted as the following:
+
+
+ * Gateway: Listener name. When both Port (experimental) and SectionName
+ are specified, the name and port of the selected listener must match
+ both specified values.
+ * Service: Port name. When both Port (experimental) and SectionName
+ are specified, the name and port of the selected listener must match
+ both specified values.
+
+
+ Implementations MAY choose to support attaching Routes to other resources.
+ If that is the case, they MUST clearly document how SectionName is
+ interpreted.
+
+
+ When unspecified (empty string), this will reference the entire resource.
+ For the purpose of status, an attachment is considered successful if at
+ least one section in the parent resource accepts it. For example, Gateway
+ listeners can restrict which Routes can attach to them by Route kind,
+ namespace, or hostname. If 1 of 2 Gateway listeners accept attachment from
+ the referencing Route, the Route MUST be considered successfully
+ attached. If no Gateway listeners accept attachment from this Route, the
+ Route MUST be considered detached from the Gateway.
+
+
+ Support: Core
+ maxLength: 253
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$
+ type: string
+ required:
+ - name
+ type: object
+ maxItems: 32
+ type: array
+ x-kubernetes-validations:
+ - message: sectionName or port must be specified when parentRefs includes
+ 2 or more references to the same parent
+ rule: 'self.all(p1, self.all(p2, p1.group == p2.group && p1.kind
+ == p2.kind && p1.name == p2.name && (((!has(p1.__namespace__)
+ || p1.__namespace__ == '''') && (!has(p2.__namespace__) || p2.__namespace__
+ == '''')) || (has(p1.__namespace__) && has(p2.__namespace__) &&
+ p1.__namespace__ == p2.__namespace__)) ? ((!has(p1.sectionName)
+ || p1.sectionName == '''') == (!has(p2.sectionName) || p2.sectionName
+ == '''') && (!has(p1.port) || p1.port == 0) == (!has(p2.port)
+ || p2.port == 0)): true))'
+ - message: sectionName or port must be unique when parentRefs includes
+ 2 or more references to the same parent
+ rule: self.all(p1, self.exists_one(p2, p1.group == p2.group && p1.kind
+ == p2.kind && p1.name == p2.name && (((!has(p1.__namespace__)
+ || p1.__namespace__ == '') && (!has(p2.__namespace__) || p2.__namespace__
+ == '')) || (has(p1.__namespace__) && has(p2.__namespace__) &&
+ p1.__namespace__ == p2.__namespace__ )) && (((!has(p1.sectionName)
+ || p1.sectionName == '') && (!has(p2.sectionName) || p2.sectionName
+ == '')) || ( has(p1.sectionName) && has(p2.sectionName) && p1.sectionName
+ == p2.sectionName)) && (((!has(p1.port) || p1.port == 0) && (!has(p2.port)
+ || p2.port == 0)) || (has(p1.port) && has(p2.port) && p1.port
+ == p2.port))))
+ rules:
+ description: Rules are a list of UDP matchers and actions.
+ items:
+ description: UDPRouteRule is the configuration for a given rule.
+ properties:
+ backendRefs:
+ description: |-
+ BackendRefs defines the backend(s) where matching requests should be
+ sent. If unspecified or invalid (refers to a non-existent resource or a
+ Service with no endpoints), the underlying implementation MUST actively
+ reject connection attempts to this backend. Packet drops must
+ respect weight; if an invalid backend is requested to have 80% of
+ the packets, then 80% of packets must be dropped instead.
+
+
+ Support: Core for Kubernetes Service
+
+
+ Support: Extended for Kubernetes ServiceImport
+
+
+ Support: Implementation-specific for any other resource
+
+
+ Support for weight: Extended
+ items:
+ description: |-
+ BackendRef defines how a Route should forward a request to a Kubernetes
+ resource.
+
+
+ Note that when a namespace different than the local namespace is specified, a
+ ReferenceGrant object is required in the referent namespace to allow that
+ namespace's owner to accept the reference. See the ReferenceGrant
+ documentation for details.
+
+
+
+
+
+ When the BackendRef points to a Kubernetes Service, implementations SHOULD
+ honor the appProtocol field if it is set for the target Service Port.
+
+
+ Implementations supporting appProtocol SHOULD recognize the Kubernetes
+ Standard Application Protocols defined in KEP-3726.
+
+
+ If a Service appProtocol isn't specified, an implementation MAY infer the
+ backend protocol through its own means. Implementations MAY infer the
+ protocol from the Route type referring to the backend Service.
+
+
+ If a Route is not able to send traffic to the backend using the specified
+ protocol then the backend is considered invalid. Implementations MUST set the
+ "ResolvedRefs" condition to "False" with the "UnsupportedProtocol" reason.
+
+
+
+
+
+ Note that when the BackendTLSPolicy object is enabled by the implementation,
+ there are some extra rules about validity to consider here. See the fields
+ where this struct is used for more information about the exact behavior.
+ properties:
+ group:
+ default: ""
+ description: |-
+ Group is the group of the referent. For example, "gateway.networking.k8s.io".
+ When unspecified or empty string, core API group is inferred.
+ maxLength: 253
+ pattern: ^$|^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$
+ type: string
+ kind:
+ default: Service
+ description: |-
+ Kind is the Kubernetes resource kind of the referent. For example
+ "Service".
+
+
+ Defaults to "Service" when not specified.
+
+
+ ExternalName services can refer to CNAME DNS records that may live
+ outside of the cluster and as such are difficult to reason about in
+ terms of conformance. They also may not be safe to forward to (see
+ CVE-2021-25740 for more information). Implementations SHOULD NOT
+ support ExternalName Services.
+
+
+ Support: Core (Services with a type other than ExternalName)
+
+
+ Support: Implementation-specific (Services with type ExternalName)
+ maxLength: 63
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[a-zA-Z]([-a-zA-Z0-9]*[a-zA-Z0-9])?$
+ type: string
+ name:
+ description: Name is the name of the referent.
+ maxLength: 253
+ minLength: 1
+ type: string
+ namespace:
+ description: |-
+ Namespace is the namespace of the backend. When unspecified, the local
+ namespace is inferred.
+
+
+ Note that when a namespace different than the local namespace is specified,
+ a ReferenceGrant object is required in the referent namespace to allow that
+ namespace's owner to accept the reference. See the ReferenceGrant
+ documentation for details.
+
+
+ Support: Core
+ maxLength: 63
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?$
+ type: string
+ port:
+ description: |-
+ Port specifies the destination port number to use for this resource.
+ Port is required when the referent is a Kubernetes Service. In this
+ case, the port number is the service port number, not the target port.
+ For other resources, destination port might be derived from the referent
+ resource or this field.
+ format: int32
+ maximum: 65535
+ minimum: 1
+ type: integer
+ weight:
+ default: 1
+ description: |-
+ Weight specifies the proportion of requests forwarded to the referenced
+ backend. This is computed as weight/(sum of all weights in this
+ BackendRefs list). For non-zero values, there may be some epsilon from
+ the exact proportion defined here depending on the precision an
+ implementation supports. Weight is not a percentage and the sum of
+ weights does not need to equal 100.
+
+
+ If only one backend is specified and it has a weight greater than 0, 100%
+ of the traffic is forwarded to that backend. If weight is set to 0, no
+ traffic should be forwarded for this entry. If unspecified, weight
+ defaults to 1.
+
+
+ Support for this field varies based on the context where used.
+ format: int32
+ maximum: 1000000
+ minimum: 0
+ type: integer
+ required:
+ - name
+ type: object
+ x-kubernetes-validations:
+ - message: Must have port for Service reference
+ rule: '(size(self.group) == 0 && self.kind == ''Service'')
+ ? has(self.port) : true'
+ maxItems: 16
+ minItems: 1
+ type: array
+ type: object
+ maxItems: 16
+ minItems: 1
+ type: array
+ required:
+ - rules
+ type: object
+ status:
+ description: Status defines the current state of UDPRoute.
+ properties:
+ parents:
+ description: |-
+ Parents is a list of parent resources (usually Gateways) that are
+ associated with the route, and the status of the route with respect to
+ each parent. When this route attaches to a parent, the controller that
+ manages the parent must add an entry to this list when the controller
+ first sees the route and should update the entry as appropriate when the
+ route or gateway is modified.
+
+
+ Note that parent references that cannot be resolved by an implementation
+ of this API will not be added to this list. Implementations of this API
+ can only populate Route status for the Gateways/parent resources they are
+ responsible for.
+
+
+ A maximum of 32 Gateways will be represented in this list. An empty list
+ means the route has not been attached to any Gateway.
+ items:
+ description: |-
+ RouteParentStatus describes the status of a route with respect to an
+ associated Parent.
+ properties:
+ conditions:
+ description: |-
+ Conditions describes the status of the route with respect to the Gateway.
+ Note that the route's availability is also subject to the Gateway's own
+ status conditions and listener status.
+
+
+ If the Route's ParentRef specifies an existing Gateway that supports
+ Routes of this kind AND that Gateway's controller has sufficient access,
+ then that Gateway's controller MUST set the "Accepted" condition on the
+ Route, to indicate whether the route has been accepted or rejected by the
+ Gateway, and why.
+
+
+ A Route MUST be considered "Accepted" if at least one of the Route's
+ rules is implemented by the Gateway.
+
+
+ There are a number of cases where the "Accepted" condition may not be set
+ due to lack of controller visibility, that includes when:
+
+
+ * The Route refers to a non-existent parent.
+ * The Route is of a type that the controller does not support.
+ * The Route is in a namespace the controller does not have access to.
+ items:
+ description: "Condition contains details for one aspect of
+ the current state of this API Resource.\n---\nThis struct
+ is intended for direct use as an array at the field path
+ .status.conditions. For example,\n\n\n\ttype FooStatus
+ struct{\n\t // Represents the observations of a foo's
+ current state.\n\t // Known .status.conditions.type are:
+ \"Available\", \"Progressing\", and \"Degraded\"\n\t //
+ +patchMergeKey=type\n\t // +patchStrategy=merge\n\t //
+ +listType=map\n\t // +listMapKey=type\n\t Conditions
+ []metav1.Condition `json:\"conditions,omitempty\" patchStrategy:\"merge\"
+ patchMergeKey:\"type\" protobuf:\"bytes,1,rep,name=conditions\"`\n\n\n\t
+ \ // other fields\n\t}"
+ properties:
+ lastTransitionTime:
+ description: |-
+ lastTransitionTime is the last time the condition transitioned from one status to another.
+ This should be when the underlying condition changed. If that is not known, then using the time when the API field changed is acceptable.
+ format: date-time
+ type: string
+ message:
+ description: |-
+ message is a human readable message indicating details about the transition.
+ This may be an empty string.
+ maxLength: 32768
+ type: string
+ observedGeneration:
+ description: |-
+ observedGeneration represents the .metadata.generation that the condition was set based upon.
+ For instance, if .metadata.generation is currently 12, but the .status.conditions[x].observedGeneration is 9, the condition is out of date
+ with respect to the current state of the instance.
+ format: int64
+ minimum: 0
+ type: integer
+ reason:
+ description: |-
+ reason contains a programmatic identifier indicating the reason for the condition's last transition.
+ Producers of specific condition types may define expected values and meanings for this field,
+ and whether the values are considered a guaranteed API.
+ The value should be a CamelCase string.
+ This field may not be empty.
+ maxLength: 1024
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[A-Za-z]([A-Za-z0-9_,:]*[A-Za-z0-9_])?$
+ type: string
+ status:
+ description: status of the condition, one of True, False,
+ Unknown.
+ enum:
+ - "True"
+ - "False"
+ - Unknown
+ type: string
+ type:
+ description: |-
+ type of condition in CamelCase or in foo.example.com/CamelCase.
+ ---
+ Many .condition.type values are consistent across resources like Available, but because arbitrary conditions can be
+ useful (see .node.status.conditions), the ability to deconflict is important.
+ The regex it matches is (dns1123SubdomainFmt/)?(qualifiedNameFmt)
+ maxLength: 316
+ pattern: ^([a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*/)?(([A-Za-z0-9][-A-Za-z0-9_.]*)?[A-Za-z0-9])$
+ type: string
+ required:
+ - lastTransitionTime
+ - message
+ - reason
+ - status
+ - type
+ type: object
+ maxItems: 8
+ minItems: 1
+ type: array
+ x-kubernetes-list-map-keys:
+ - type
+ x-kubernetes-list-type: map
+ controllerName:
+ description: |-
+ ControllerName is a domain/path string that indicates the name of the
+ controller that wrote this status. This corresponds with the
+ controllerName field on GatewayClass.
+
+
+ Example: "example.net/gateway-controller".
+
+
+ The format of this field is DOMAIN "/" PATH, where DOMAIN and PATH are
+ valid Kubernetes names
+ (https://kubernetes.io/docs/concepts/overview/working-with-objects/names/#names).
+
+
+ Controllers MUST populate this field when writing status. Controllers should ensure that
+ entries to status populated with their ControllerName are cleaned up when they are no
+ longer necessary.
+ maxLength: 253
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*\/[A-Za-z0-9\/\-._~%!$&'()*+,;=:]+$
+ type: string
+ parentRef:
+ description: |-
+ ParentRef corresponds with a ParentRef in the spec that this
+ RouteParentStatus struct describes the status of.
+ properties:
+ group:
+ default: gateway.networking.k8s.io
+ description: |-
+ Group is the group of the referent.
+ When unspecified, "gateway.networking.k8s.io" is inferred.
+ To set the core API group (such as for a "Service" kind referent),
+ Group must be explicitly set to "" (empty string).
+
+
+ Support: Core
+ maxLength: 253
+ pattern: ^$|^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$
+ type: string
+ kind:
+ default: Gateway
+ description: |-
+ Kind is kind of the referent.
+
+
+ There are two kinds of parent resources with "Core" support:
+
+
+ * Gateway (Gateway conformance profile)
+ * Service (Mesh conformance profile, ClusterIP Services only)
+
+
+ Support for other resources is Implementation-Specific.
+ maxLength: 63
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[a-zA-Z]([-a-zA-Z0-9]*[a-zA-Z0-9])?$
+ type: string
+ name:
+ description: |-
+ Name is the name of the referent.
+
+
+ Support: Core
+ maxLength: 253
+ minLength: 1
+ type: string
+ namespace:
+ description: |-
+ Namespace is the namespace of the referent. When unspecified, this refers
+ to the local namespace of the Route.
+
+
+ Note that there are specific rules for ParentRefs which cross namespace
+ boundaries. Cross-namespace references are only valid if they are explicitly
+ allowed by something in the namespace they are referring to. For example:
+ Gateway has the AllowedRoutes field, and ReferenceGrant provides a
+ generic way to enable any other kind of cross-namespace reference.
+
+
+
+ ParentRefs from a Route to a Service in the same namespace are "producer"
+ routes, which apply default routing rules to inbound connections from
+ any namespace to the Service.
+
+
+ ParentRefs from a Route to a Service in a different namespace are
+ "consumer" routes, and these routing rules are only applied to outbound
+ connections originating from the same namespace as the Route, for which
+ the intended destination of the connections are a Service targeted as a
+ ParentRef of the Route.
+
+
+
+ Support: Core
+ maxLength: 63
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?$
+ type: string
+ port:
+ description: |-
+ Port is the network port this Route targets. It can be interpreted
+ differently based on the type of parent resource.
+
+
+ When the parent resource is a Gateway, this targets all listeners
+ listening on the specified port that also support this kind of Route(and
+ select this Route). It's not recommended to set `Port` unless the
+ networking behaviors specified in a Route must apply to a specific port
+ as opposed to a listener(s) whose port(s) may be changed. When both Port
+ and SectionName are specified, the name and port of the selected listener
+ must match both specified values.
+
+
+
+ When the parent resource is a Service, this targets a specific port in the
+ Service spec. When both Port (experimental) and SectionName are specified,
+ the name and port of the selected port must match both specified values.
+
+
+
+ Implementations MAY choose to support other parent resources.
+ Implementations supporting other types of parent resources MUST clearly
+ document how/if Port is interpreted.
+
+
+ For the purpose of status, an attachment is considered successful as
+ long as the parent resource accepts it partially. For example, Gateway
+ listeners can restrict which Routes can attach to them by Route kind,
+ namespace, or hostname. If 1 of 2 Gateway listeners accept attachment
+ from the referencing Route, the Route MUST be considered successfully
+ attached. If no Gateway listeners accept attachment from this Route,
+ the Route MUST be considered detached from the Gateway.
+
+
+ Support: Extended
+ format: int32
+ maximum: 65535
+ minimum: 1
+ type: integer
+ sectionName:
+ description: |-
+ SectionName is the name of a section within the target resource. In the
+ following resources, SectionName is interpreted as the following:
+
+
+ * Gateway: Listener name. When both Port (experimental) and SectionName
+ are specified, the name and port of the selected listener must match
+ both specified values.
+ * Service: Port name. When both Port (experimental) and SectionName
+ are specified, the name and port of the selected listener must match
+ both specified values.
+
+
+ Implementations MAY choose to support attaching Routes to other resources.
+ If that is the case, they MUST clearly document how SectionName is
+ interpreted.
+
+
+ When unspecified (empty string), this will reference the entire resource.
+ For the purpose of status, an attachment is considered successful if at
+ least one section in the parent resource accepts it. For example, Gateway
+ listeners can restrict which Routes can attach to them by Route kind,
+ namespace, or hostname. If 1 of 2 Gateway listeners accept attachment from
+ the referencing Route, the Route MUST be considered successfully
+ attached. If no Gateway listeners accept attachment from this Route, the
+ Route MUST be considered detached from the Gateway.
+
+
+ Support: Core
+ maxLength: 253
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$
+ type: string
+ required:
+ - name
+ type: object
+ required:
+ - controllerName
+ - parentRef
+ type: object
+ maxItems: 32
+ type: array
+ required:
+ - parents
+ type: object
+ required:
+ - spec
+ type: object
+ served: true
+ storage: true
+ subresources:
+ status: {}
+status:
+ acceptedNames:
+ kind: ""
+ plural: ""
+ conditions: null
+ storedVersions: null
diff --git a/roles/kubernetes-apps/gateway_api/templates/standard-install.yaml.j2 b/roles/kubernetes-apps/gateway_api/templates/standard-install.yaml.j2
new file mode 100644
index 000000000..fcb65e66f
--- /dev/null
+++ b/roles/kubernetes-apps/gateway_api/templates/standard-install.yaml.j2
@@ -0,0 +1,13478 @@
+# Copyright 2024 The Kubernetes Authors.
+#
+# Licensed under the Apache License, Version 2.0 (the "License");
+# you may not use this file except in compliance with the License.
+# You may obtain a copy of the License at
+#
+# http://www.apache.org/licenses/LICENSE-2.0
+#
+# Unless required by applicable law or agreed to in writing, software
+# distributed under the License is distributed on an "AS IS" BASIS,
+# WITHOUT WARRANTIES OR CONDITIONS OF ANY KIND, either express or implied.
+# See the License for the specific language governing permissions and
+# limitations under the License.
+
+#
+# Gateway API Standard channel install
+#
+---
+#
+# config/crd/standard/gateway.networking.k8s.io_gatewayclasses.yaml
+#
+apiVersion: apiextensions.k8s.io/v1
+kind: CustomResourceDefinition
+metadata:
+ annotations:
+ api-approved.kubernetes.io: https://github.com/kubernetes-sigs/gateway-api/pull/2997
+ gateway.networking.k8s.io/bundle-version: v1.1.0
+ gateway.networking.k8s.io/channel: standard
+ creationTimestamp: null
+ name: gatewayclasses.gateway.networking.k8s.io
+spec:
+ group: gateway.networking.k8s.io
+ names:
+ categories:
+ - gateway-api
+ kind: GatewayClass
+ listKind: GatewayClassList
+ plural: gatewayclasses
+ shortNames:
+ - gc
+ singular: gatewayclass
+ scope: Cluster
+ versions:
+ - additionalPrinterColumns:
+ - jsonPath: .spec.controllerName
+ name: Controller
+ type: string
+ - jsonPath: .status.conditions[?(@.type=="Accepted")].status
+ name: Accepted
+ type: string
+ - jsonPath: .metadata.creationTimestamp
+ name: Age
+ type: date
+ - jsonPath: .spec.description
+ name: Description
+ priority: 1
+ type: string
+ name: v1
+ schema:
+ openAPIV3Schema:
+ description: |-
+ GatewayClass describes a class of Gateways available to the user for creating
+ Gateway resources.
+
+
+ It is recommended that this resource be used as a template for Gateways. This
+ means that a Gateway is based on the state of the GatewayClass at the time it
+ was created and changes to the GatewayClass or associated parameters are not
+ propagated down to existing Gateways. This recommendation is intended to
+ limit the blast radius of changes to GatewayClass or associated parameters.
+ If implementations choose to propagate GatewayClass changes to existing
+ Gateways, that MUST be clearly documented by the implementation.
+
+
+ Whenever one or more Gateways are using a GatewayClass, implementations SHOULD
+ add the `gateway-exists-finalizer.gateway.networking.k8s.io` finalizer on the
+ associated GatewayClass. This ensures that a GatewayClass associated with a
+ Gateway is not deleted while in use.
+
+
+ GatewayClass is a Cluster level resource.
+ properties:
+ apiVersion:
+ description: |-
+ APIVersion defines the versioned schema of this representation of an object.
+ Servers should convert recognized schemas to the latest internal value, and
+ may reject unrecognized values.
+ More info: https://git.k8s.io/community/contributors/devel/sig-architecture/api-conventions.md#resources
+ type: string
+ kind:
+ description: |-
+ Kind is a string value representing the REST resource this object represents.
+ Servers may infer this from the endpoint the client submits requests to.
+ Cannot be updated.
+ In CamelCase.
+ More info: https://git.k8s.io/community/contributors/devel/sig-architecture/api-conventions.md#types-kinds
+ type: string
+ metadata:
+ type: object
+ spec:
+ description: Spec defines the desired state of GatewayClass.
+ properties:
+ controllerName:
+ description: |-
+ ControllerName is the name of the controller that is managing Gateways of
+ this class. The value of this field MUST be a domain prefixed path.
+
+
+ Example: "example.net/gateway-controller".
+
+
+ This field is not mutable and cannot be empty.
+
+
+ Support: Core
+ maxLength: 253
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*\/[A-Za-z0-9\/\-._~%!$&'()*+,;=:]+$
+ type: string
+ x-kubernetes-validations:
+ - message: Value is immutable
+ rule: self == oldSelf
+ description:
+ description: Description helps describe a GatewayClass with more details.
+ maxLength: 64
+ type: string
+ parametersRef:
+ description: |-
+ ParametersRef is a reference to a resource that contains the configuration
+ parameters corresponding to the GatewayClass. This is optional if the
+ controller does not require any additional configuration.
+
+
+ ParametersRef can reference a standard Kubernetes resource, i.e. ConfigMap,
+ or an implementation-specific custom resource. The resource can be
+ cluster-scoped or namespace-scoped.
+
+
+ If the referent cannot be found, the GatewayClass's "InvalidParameters"
+ status condition will be true.
+
+
+ A Gateway for this GatewayClass may provide its own `parametersRef`. When both are specified,
+ the merging behavior is implementation specific.
+ It is generally recommended that GatewayClass provides defaults that can be overridden by a Gateway.
+
+
+ Support: Implementation-specific
+ properties:
+ group:
+ description: Group is the group of the referent.
+ maxLength: 253
+ pattern: ^$|^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$
+ type: string
+ kind:
+ description: Kind is kind of the referent.
+ maxLength: 63
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[a-zA-Z]([-a-zA-Z0-9]*[a-zA-Z0-9])?$
+ type: string
+ name:
+ description: Name is the name of the referent.
+ maxLength: 253
+ minLength: 1
+ type: string
+ namespace:
+ description: |-
+ Namespace is the namespace of the referent.
+ This field is required when referring to a Namespace-scoped resource and
+ MUST be unset when referring to a Cluster-scoped resource.
+ maxLength: 63
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?$
+ type: string
+ required:
+ - group
+ - kind
+ - name
+ type: object
+ required:
+ - controllerName
+ type: object
+ status:
+ default:
+ conditions:
+ - lastTransitionTime: "1970-01-01T00:00:00Z"
+ message: Waiting for controller
+ reason: Waiting
+ status: Unknown
+ type: Accepted
+ description: |-
+ Status defines the current state of GatewayClass.
+
+
+ Implementations MUST populate status on all GatewayClass resources which
+ specify their controller name.
+ properties:
+ conditions:
+ default:
+ - lastTransitionTime: "1970-01-01T00:00:00Z"
+ message: Waiting for controller
+ reason: Pending
+ status: Unknown
+ type: Accepted
+ description: |-
+ Conditions is the current status from the controller for
+ this GatewayClass.
+
+
+ Controllers should prefer to publish conditions using values
+ of GatewayClassConditionType for the type of each Condition.
+ items:
+ description: "Condition contains details for one aspect of the current
+ state of this API Resource.\n---\nThis struct is intended for
+ direct use as an array at the field path .status.conditions. For
+ example,\n\n\n\ttype FooStatus struct{\n\t // Represents the
+ observations of a foo's current state.\n\t // Known .status.conditions.type
+ are: \"Available\", \"Progressing\", and \"Degraded\"\n\t //
+ +patchMergeKey=type\n\t // +patchStrategy=merge\n\t // +listType=map\n\t
+ \ // +listMapKey=type\n\t Conditions []metav1.Condition `json:\"conditions,omitempty\"
+ patchStrategy:\"merge\" patchMergeKey:\"type\" protobuf:\"bytes,1,rep,name=conditions\"`\n\n\n\t
+ \ // other fields\n\t}"
+ properties:
+ lastTransitionTime:
+ description: |-
+ lastTransitionTime is the last time the condition transitioned from one status to another.
+ This should be when the underlying condition changed. If that is not known, then using the time when the API field changed is acceptable.
+ format: date-time
+ type: string
+ message:
+ description: |-
+ message is a human readable message indicating details about the transition.
+ This may be an empty string.
+ maxLength: 32768
+ type: string
+ observedGeneration:
+ description: |-
+ observedGeneration represents the .metadata.generation that the condition was set based upon.
+ For instance, if .metadata.generation is currently 12, but the .status.conditions[x].observedGeneration is 9, the condition is out of date
+ with respect to the current state of the instance.
+ format: int64
+ minimum: 0
+ type: integer
+ reason:
+ description: |-
+ reason contains a programmatic identifier indicating the reason for the condition's last transition.
+ Producers of specific condition types may define expected values and meanings for this field,
+ and whether the values are considered a guaranteed API.
+ The value should be a CamelCase string.
+ This field may not be empty.
+ maxLength: 1024
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[A-Za-z]([A-Za-z0-9_,:]*[A-Za-z0-9_])?$
+ type: string
+ status:
+ description: status of the condition, one of True, False, Unknown.
+ enum:
+ - "True"
+ - "False"
+ - Unknown
+ type: string
+ type:
+ description: |-
+ type of condition in CamelCase or in foo.example.com/CamelCase.
+ ---
+ Many .condition.type values are consistent across resources like Available, but because arbitrary conditions can be
+ useful (see .node.status.conditions), the ability to deconflict is important.
+ The regex it matches is (dns1123SubdomainFmt/)?(qualifiedNameFmt)
+ maxLength: 316
+ pattern: ^([a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*/)?(([A-Za-z0-9][-A-Za-z0-9_.]*)?[A-Za-z0-9])$
+ type: string
+ required:
+ - lastTransitionTime
+ - message
+ - reason
+ - status
+ - type
+ type: object
+ maxItems: 8
+ type: array
+ x-kubernetes-list-map-keys:
+ - type
+ x-kubernetes-list-type: map
+ type: object
+ required:
+ - spec
+ type: object
+ served: true
+ storage: true
+ subresources:
+ status: {}
+ - additionalPrinterColumns:
+ - jsonPath: .spec.controllerName
+ name: Controller
+ type: string
+ - jsonPath: .status.conditions[?(@.type=="Accepted")].status
+ name: Accepted
+ type: string
+ - jsonPath: .metadata.creationTimestamp
+ name: Age
+ type: date
+ - jsonPath: .spec.description
+ name: Description
+ priority: 1
+ type: string
+ name: v1beta1
+ schema:
+ openAPIV3Schema:
+ description: |-
+ GatewayClass describes a class of Gateways available to the user for creating
+ Gateway resources.
+
+
+ It is recommended that this resource be used as a template for Gateways. This
+ means that a Gateway is based on the state of the GatewayClass at the time it
+ was created and changes to the GatewayClass or associated parameters are not
+ propagated down to existing Gateways. This recommendation is intended to
+ limit the blast radius of changes to GatewayClass or associated parameters.
+ If implementations choose to propagate GatewayClass changes to existing
+ Gateways, that MUST be clearly documented by the implementation.
+
+
+ Whenever one or more Gateways are using a GatewayClass, implementations SHOULD
+ add the `gateway-exists-finalizer.gateway.networking.k8s.io` finalizer on the
+ associated GatewayClass. This ensures that a GatewayClass associated with a
+ Gateway is not deleted while in use.
+
+
+ GatewayClass is a Cluster level resource.
+ properties:
+ apiVersion:
+ description: |-
+ APIVersion defines the versioned schema of this representation of an object.
+ Servers should convert recognized schemas to the latest internal value, and
+ may reject unrecognized values.
+ More info: https://git.k8s.io/community/contributors/devel/sig-architecture/api-conventions.md#resources
+ type: string
+ kind:
+ description: |-
+ Kind is a string value representing the REST resource this object represents.
+ Servers may infer this from the endpoint the client submits requests to.
+ Cannot be updated.
+ In CamelCase.
+ More info: https://git.k8s.io/community/contributors/devel/sig-architecture/api-conventions.md#types-kinds
+ type: string
+ metadata:
+ type: object
+ spec:
+ description: Spec defines the desired state of GatewayClass.
+ properties:
+ controllerName:
+ description: |-
+ ControllerName is the name of the controller that is managing Gateways of
+ this class. The value of this field MUST be a domain prefixed path.
+
+
+ Example: "example.net/gateway-controller".
+
+
+ This field is not mutable and cannot be empty.
+
+
+ Support: Core
+ maxLength: 253
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*\/[A-Za-z0-9\/\-._~%!$&'()*+,;=:]+$
+ type: string
+ x-kubernetes-validations:
+ - message: Value is immutable
+ rule: self == oldSelf
+ description:
+ description: Description helps describe a GatewayClass with more details.
+ maxLength: 64
+ type: string
+ parametersRef:
+ description: |-
+ ParametersRef is a reference to a resource that contains the configuration
+ parameters corresponding to the GatewayClass. This is optional if the
+ controller does not require any additional configuration.
+
+
+ ParametersRef can reference a standard Kubernetes resource, i.e. ConfigMap,
+ or an implementation-specific custom resource. The resource can be
+ cluster-scoped or namespace-scoped.
+
+
+ If the referent cannot be found, the GatewayClass's "InvalidParameters"
+ status condition will be true.
+
+
+ A Gateway for this GatewayClass may provide its own `parametersRef`. When both are specified,
+ the merging behavior is implementation specific.
+ It is generally recommended that GatewayClass provides defaults that can be overridden by a Gateway.
+
+
+ Support: Implementation-specific
+ properties:
+ group:
+ description: Group is the group of the referent.
+ maxLength: 253
+ pattern: ^$|^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$
+ type: string
+ kind:
+ description: Kind is kind of the referent.
+ maxLength: 63
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[a-zA-Z]([-a-zA-Z0-9]*[a-zA-Z0-9])?$
+ type: string
+ name:
+ description: Name is the name of the referent.
+ maxLength: 253
+ minLength: 1
+ type: string
+ namespace:
+ description: |-
+ Namespace is the namespace of the referent.
+ This field is required when referring to a Namespace-scoped resource and
+ MUST be unset when referring to a Cluster-scoped resource.
+ maxLength: 63
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?$
+ type: string
+ required:
+ - group
+ - kind
+ - name
+ type: object
+ required:
+ - controllerName
+ type: object
+ status:
+ default:
+ conditions:
+ - lastTransitionTime: "1970-01-01T00:00:00Z"
+ message: Waiting for controller
+ reason: Waiting
+ status: Unknown
+ type: Accepted
+ description: |-
+ Status defines the current state of GatewayClass.
+
+
+ Implementations MUST populate status on all GatewayClass resources which
+ specify their controller name.
+ properties:
+ conditions:
+ default:
+ - lastTransitionTime: "1970-01-01T00:00:00Z"
+ message: Waiting for controller
+ reason: Pending
+ status: Unknown
+ type: Accepted
+ description: |-
+ Conditions is the current status from the controller for
+ this GatewayClass.
+
+
+ Controllers should prefer to publish conditions using values
+ of GatewayClassConditionType for the type of each Condition.
+ items:
+ description: "Condition contains details for one aspect of the current
+ state of this API Resource.\n---\nThis struct is intended for
+ direct use as an array at the field path .status.conditions. For
+ example,\n\n\n\ttype FooStatus struct{\n\t // Represents the
+ observations of a foo's current state.\n\t // Known .status.conditions.type
+ are: \"Available\", \"Progressing\", and \"Degraded\"\n\t //
+ +patchMergeKey=type\n\t // +patchStrategy=merge\n\t // +listType=map\n\t
+ \ // +listMapKey=type\n\t Conditions []metav1.Condition `json:\"conditions,omitempty\"
+ patchStrategy:\"merge\" patchMergeKey:\"type\" protobuf:\"bytes,1,rep,name=conditions\"`\n\n\n\t
+ \ // other fields\n\t}"
+ properties:
+ lastTransitionTime:
+ description: |-
+ lastTransitionTime is the last time the condition transitioned from one status to another.
+ This should be when the underlying condition changed. If that is not known, then using the time when the API field changed is acceptable.
+ format: date-time
+ type: string
+ message:
+ description: |-
+ message is a human readable message indicating details about the transition.
+ This may be an empty string.
+ maxLength: 32768
+ type: string
+ observedGeneration:
+ description: |-
+ observedGeneration represents the .metadata.generation that the condition was set based upon.
+ For instance, if .metadata.generation is currently 12, but the .status.conditions[x].observedGeneration is 9, the condition is out of date
+ with respect to the current state of the instance.
+ format: int64
+ minimum: 0
+ type: integer
+ reason:
+ description: |-
+ reason contains a programmatic identifier indicating the reason for the condition's last transition.
+ Producers of specific condition types may define expected values and meanings for this field,
+ and whether the values are considered a guaranteed API.
+ The value should be a CamelCase string.
+ This field may not be empty.
+ maxLength: 1024
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[A-Za-z]([A-Za-z0-9_,:]*[A-Za-z0-9_])?$
+ type: string
+ status:
+ description: status of the condition, one of True, False, Unknown.
+ enum:
+ - "True"
+ - "False"
+ - Unknown
+ type: string
+ type:
+ description: |-
+ type of condition in CamelCase or in foo.example.com/CamelCase.
+ ---
+ Many .condition.type values are consistent across resources like Available, but because arbitrary conditions can be
+ useful (see .node.status.conditions), the ability to deconflict is important.
+ The regex it matches is (dns1123SubdomainFmt/)?(qualifiedNameFmt)
+ maxLength: 316
+ pattern: ^([a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*/)?(([A-Za-z0-9][-A-Za-z0-9_.]*)?[A-Za-z0-9])$
+ type: string
+ required:
+ - lastTransitionTime
+ - message
+ - reason
+ - status
+ - type
+ type: object
+ maxItems: 8
+ type: array
+ x-kubernetes-list-map-keys:
+ - type
+ x-kubernetes-list-type: map
+ type: object
+ required:
+ - spec
+ type: object
+ served: true
+ storage: false
+ subresources:
+ status: {}
+status:
+ acceptedNames:
+ kind: ""
+ plural: ""
+ conditions: null
+ storedVersions: null
+---
+#
+# config/crd/standard/gateway.networking.k8s.io_gateways.yaml
+#
+apiVersion: apiextensions.k8s.io/v1
+kind: CustomResourceDefinition
+metadata:
+ annotations:
+ api-approved.kubernetes.io: https://github.com/kubernetes-sigs/gateway-api/pull/2997
+ gateway.networking.k8s.io/bundle-version: v1.1.0
+ gateway.networking.k8s.io/channel: standard
+ creationTimestamp: null
+ name: gateways.gateway.networking.k8s.io
+spec:
+ group: gateway.networking.k8s.io
+ names:
+ categories:
+ - gateway-api
+ kind: Gateway
+ listKind: GatewayList
+ plural: gateways
+ shortNames:
+ - gtw
+ singular: gateway
+ scope: Namespaced
+ versions:
+ - additionalPrinterColumns:
+ - jsonPath: .spec.gatewayClassName
+ name: Class
+ type: string
+ - jsonPath: .status.addresses[*].value
+ name: Address
+ type: string
+ - jsonPath: .status.conditions[?(@.type=="Programmed")].status
+ name: Programmed
+ type: string
+ - jsonPath: .metadata.creationTimestamp
+ name: Age
+ type: date
+ name: v1
+ schema:
+ openAPIV3Schema:
+ description: |-
+ Gateway represents an instance of a service-traffic handling infrastructure
+ by binding Listeners to a set of IP addresses.
+ properties:
+ apiVersion:
+ description: |-
+ APIVersion defines the versioned schema of this representation of an object.
+ Servers should convert recognized schemas to the latest internal value, and
+ may reject unrecognized values.
+ More info: https://git.k8s.io/community/contributors/devel/sig-architecture/api-conventions.md#resources
+ type: string
+ kind:
+ description: |-
+ Kind is a string value representing the REST resource this object represents.
+ Servers may infer this from the endpoint the client submits requests to.
+ Cannot be updated.
+ In CamelCase.
+ More info: https://git.k8s.io/community/contributors/devel/sig-architecture/api-conventions.md#types-kinds
+ type: string
+ metadata:
+ type: object
+ spec:
+ description: Spec defines the desired state of Gateway.
+ properties:
+ addresses:
+ description: |+
+ Addresses requested for this Gateway. This is optional and behavior can
+ depend on the implementation. If a value is set in the spec and the
+ requested address is invalid or unavailable, the implementation MUST
+ indicate this in the associated entry in GatewayStatus.Addresses.
+
+
+ The Addresses field represents a request for the address(es) on the
+ "outside of the Gateway", that traffic bound for this Gateway will use.
+ This could be the IP address or hostname of an external load balancer or
+ other networking infrastructure, or some other address that traffic will
+ be sent to.
+
+
+ If no Addresses are specified, the implementation MAY schedule the
+ Gateway in an implementation-specific manner, assigning an appropriate
+ set of Addresses.
+
+
+ The implementation MUST bind all Listeners to every GatewayAddress that
+ it assigns to the Gateway and add a corresponding entry in
+ GatewayStatus.Addresses.
+
+
+ Support: Extended
+
+
+ items:
+ description: GatewayAddress describes an address that can be bound
+ to a Gateway.
+ oneOf:
+ - properties:
+ type:
+ enum:
+ - IPAddress
+ value:
+ anyOf:
+ - format: ipv4
+ - format: ipv6
+ - properties:
+ type:
+ not:
+ enum:
+ - IPAddress
+ properties:
+ type:
+ default: IPAddress
+ description: Type of the address.
+ maxLength: 253
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^Hostname|IPAddress|NamedAddress|[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*\/[A-Za-z0-9\/\-._~%!$&'()*+,;=:]+$
+ type: string
+ value:
+ description: |-
+ Value of the address. The validity of the values will depend
+ on the type and support by the controller.
+
+
+ Examples: `1.2.3.4`, `128::1`, `my-ip-address`.
+ maxLength: 253
+ minLength: 1
+ type: string
+ required:
+ - value
+ type: object
+ x-kubernetes-validations:
+ - message: Hostname value must only contain valid characters (matching
+ ^(\*\.)?[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$)
+ rule: 'self.type == ''Hostname'' ? self.value.matches(r"""^(\*\.)?[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$"""):
+ true'
+ maxItems: 16
+ type: array
+ x-kubernetes-validations:
+ - message: IPAddress values must be unique
+ rule: 'self.all(a1, a1.type == ''IPAddress'' ? self.exists_one(a2,
+ a2.type == a1.type && a2.value == a1.value) : true )'
+ - message: Hostname values must be unique
+ rule: 'self.all(a1, a1.type == ''Hostname'' ? self.exists_one(a2,
+ a2.type == a1.type && a2.value == a1.value) : true )'
+ gatewayClassName:
+ description: |-
+ GatewayClassName used for this Gateway. This is the name of a
+ GatewayClass resource.
+ maxLength: 253
+ minLength: 1
+ type: string
+ listeners:
+ description: |-
+ Listeners associated with this Gateway. Listeners define
+ logical endpoints that are bound on this Gateway's addresses.
+ At least one Listener MUST be specified.
+
+
+ Each Listener in a set of Listeners (for example, in a single Gateway)
+ MUST be _distinct_, in that a traffic flow MUST be able to be assigned to
+ exactly one listener. (This section uses "set of Listeners" rather than
+ "Listeners in a single Gateway" because implementations MAY merge configuration
+ from multiple Gateways onto a single data plane, and these rules _also_
+ apply in that case).
+
+
+ Practically, this means that each listener in a set MUST have a unique
+ combination of Port, Protocol, and, if supported by the protocol, Hostname.
+
+
+ Some combinations of port, protocol, and TLS settings are considered
+ Core support and MUST be supported by implementations based on their
+ targeted conformance profile:
+
+
+ HTTP Profile
+
+
+ 1. HTTPRoute, Port: 80, Protocol: HTTP
+ 2. HTTPRoute, Port: 443, Protocol: HTTPS, TLS Mode: Terminate, TLS keypair provided
+
+
+ TLS Profile
+
+
+ 1. TLSRoute, Port: 443, Protocol: TLS, TLS Mode: Passthrough
+
+
+ "Distinct" Listeners have the following property:
+
+
+ The implementation can match inbound requests to a single distinct
+ Listener. When multiple Listeners share values for fields (for
+ example, two Listeners with the same Port value), the implementation
+ can match requests to only one of the Listeners using other
+ Listener fields.
+
+
+ For example, the following Listener scenarios are distinct:
+
+
+ 1. Multiple Listeners with the same Port that all use the "HTTP"
+ Protocol that all have unique Hostname values.
+ 2. Multiple Listeners with the same Port that use either the "HTTPS" or
+ "TLS" Protocol that all have unique Hostname values.
+ 3. A mixture of "TCP" and "UDP" Protocol Listeners, where no Listener
+ with the same Protocol has the same Port value.
+
+
+ Some fields in the Listener struct have possible values that affect
+ whether the Listener is distinct. Hostname is particularly relevant
+ for HTTP or HTTPS protocols.
+
+
+ When using the Hostname value to select between same-Port, same-Protocol
+ Listeners, the Hostname value must be different on each Listener for the
+ Listener to be distinct.
+
+
+ When the Listeners are distinct based on Hostname, inbound request
+ hostnames MUST match from the most specific to least specific Hostname
+ values to choose the correct Listener and its associated set of Routes.
+
+
+ Exact matches must be processed before wildcard matches, and wildcard
+ matches must be processed before fallback (empty Hostname value)
+ matches. For example, `"foo.example.com"` takes precedence over
+ `"*.example.com"`, and `"*.example.com"` takes precedence over `""`.
+
+
+ Additionally, if there are multiple wildcard entries, more specific
+ wildcard entries must be processed before less specific wildcard entries.
+ For example, `"*.foo.example.com"` takes precedence over `"*.example.com"`.
+ The precise definition here is that the higher the number of dots in the
+ hostname to the right of the wildcard character, the higher the precedence.
+
+
+ The wildcard character will match any number of characters _and dots_ to
+ the left, however, so `"*.example.com"` will match both
+ `"foo.bar.example.com"` _and_ `"bar.example.com"`.
+
+
+ If a set of Listeners contains Listeners that are not distinct, then those
+ Listeners are Conflicted, and the implementation MUST set the "Conflicted"
+ condition in the Listener Status to "True".
+
+
+ Implementations MAY choose to accept a Gateway with some Conflicted
+ Listeners only if they only accept the partial Listener set that contains
+ no Conflicted Listeners. To put this another way, implementations may
+ accept a partial Listener set only if they throw out *all* the conflicting
+ Listeners. No picking one of the conflicting listeners as the winner.
+ This also means that the Gateway must have at least one non-conflicting
+ Listener in this case, otherwise it violates the requirement that at
+ least one Listener must be present.
+
+
+ The implementation MUST set a "ListenersNotValid" condition on the
+ Gateway Status when the Gateway contains Conflicted Listeners whether or
+ not they accept the Gateway. That Condition SHOULD clearly
+ indicate in the Message which Listeners are conflicted, and which are
+ Accepted. Additionally, the Listener status for those listeners SHOULD
+ indicate which Listeners are conflicted and not Accepted.
+
+
+ A Gateway's Listeners are considered "compatible" if:
+
+
+ 1. They are distinct.
+ 2. The implementation can serve them in compliance with the Addresses
+ requirement that all Listeners are available on all assigned
+ addresses.
+
+
+ Compatible combinations in Extended support are expected to vary across
+ implementations. A combination that is compatible for one implementation
+ may not be compatible for another.
+
+
+ For example, an implementation that cannot serve both TCP and UDP listeners
+ on the same address, or cannot mix HTTPS and generic TLS listens on the same port
+ would not consider those cases compatible, even though they are distinct.
+
+
+ Note that requests SHOULD match at most one Listener. For example, if
+ Listeners are defined for "foo.example.com" and "*.example.com", a
+ request to "foo.example.com" SHOULD only be routed using routes attached
+ to the "foo.example.com" Listener (and not the "*.example.com" Listener).
+ This concept is known as "Listener Isolation". Implementations that do
+ not support Listener Isolation MUST clearly document this.
+
+
+ Implementations MAY merge separate Gateways onto a single set of
+ Addresses if all Listeners across all Gateways are compatible.
+
+
+ Support: Core
+ items:
+ description: |-
+ Listener embodies the concept of a logical endpoint where a Gateway accepts
+ network connections.
+ properties:
+ allowedRoutes:
+ default:
+ namespaces:
+ from: Same
+ description: |-
+ AllowedRoutes defines the types of routes that MAY be attached to a
+ Listener and the trusted namespaces where those Route resources MAY be
+ present.
+
+
+ Although a client request may match multiple route rules, only one rule
+ may ultimately receive the request. Matching precedence MUST be
+ determined in order of the following criteria:
+
+
+ * The most specific match as defined by the Route type.
+ * The oldest Route based on creation timestamp. For example, a Route with
+ a creation timestamp of "2020-09-08 01:02:03" is given precedence over
+ a Route with a creation timestamp of "2020-09-08 01:02:04".
+ * If everything else is equivalent, the Route appearing first in
+ alphabetical order (namespace/name) should be given precedence. For
+ example, foo/bar is given precedence over foo/baz.
+
+
+ All valid rules within a Route attached to this Listener should be
+ implemented. Invalid Route rules can be ignored (sometimes that will mean
+ the full Route). If a Route rule transitions from valid to invalid,
+ support for that Route rule should be dropped to ensure consistency. For
+ example, even if a filter specified by a Route rule is invalid, the rest
+ of the rules within that Route should still be supported.
+
+
+ Support: Core
+ properties:
+ kinds:
+ description: |-
+ Kinds specifies the groups and kinds of Routes that are allowed to bind
+ to this Gateway Listener. When unspecified or empty, the kinds of Routes
+ selected are determined using the Listener protocol.
+
+
+ A RouteGroupKind MUST correspond to kinds of Routes that are compatible
+ with the application protocol specified in the Listener's Protocol field.
+ If an implementation does not support or recognize this resource type, it
+ MUST set the "ResolvedRefs" condition to False for this Listener with the
+ "InvalidRouteKinds" reason.
+
+
+ Support: Core
+ items:
+ description: RouteGroupKind indicates the group and kind
+ of a Route resource.
+ properties:
+ group:
+ default: gateway.networking.k8s.io
+ description: Group is the group of the Route.
+ maxLength: 253
+ pattern: ^$|^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$
+ type: string
+ kind:
+ description: Kind is the kind of the Route.
+ maxLength: 63
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[a-zA-Z]([-a-zA-Z0-9]*[a-zA-Z0-9])?$
+ type: string
+ required:
+ - kind
+ type: object
+ maxItems: 8
+ type: array
+ namespaces:
+ default:
+ from: Same
+ description: |-
+ Namespaces indicates namespaces from which Routes may be attached to this
+ Listener. This is restricted to the namespace of this Gateway by default.
+
+
+ Support: Core
+ properties:
+ from:
+ default: Same
+ description: |-
+ From indicates where Routes will be selected for this Gateway. Possible
+ values are:
+
+
+ * All: Routes in all namespaces may be used by this Gateway.
+ * Selector: Routes in namespaces selected by the selector may be used by
+ this Gateway.
+ * Same: Only Routes in the same namespace may be used by this Gateway.
+
+
+ Support: Core
+ enum:
+ - All
+ - Selector
+ - Same
+ type: string
+ selector:
+ description: |-
+ Selector must be specified when From is set to "Selector". In that case,
+ only Routes in Namespaces matching this Selector will be selected by this
+ Gateway. This field is ignored for other values of "From".
+
+
+ Support: Core
+ properties:
+ matchExpressions:
+ description: matchExpressions is a list of label
+ selector requirements. The requirements are ANDed.
+ items:
+ description: |-
+ A label selector requirement is a selector that contains values, a key, and an operator that
+ relates the key and values.
+ properties:
+ key:
+ description: key is the label key that the
+ selector applies to.
+ type: string
+ operator:
+ description: |-
+ operator represents a key's relationship to a set of values.
+ Valid operators are In, NotIn, Exists and DoesNotExist.
+ type: string
+ values:
+ description: |-
+ values is an array of string values. If the operator is In or NotIn,
+ the values array must be non-empty. If the operator is Exists or DoesNotExist,
+ the values array must be empty. This array is replaced during a strategic
+ merge patch.
+ items:
+ type: string
+ type: array
+ x-kubernetes-list-type: atomic
+ required:
+ - key
+ - operator
+ type: object
+ type: array
+ x-kubernetes-list-type: atomic
+ matchLabels:
+ additionalProperties:
+ type: string
+ description: |-
+ matchLabels is a map of {key,value} pairs. A single {key,value} in the matchLabels
+ map is equivalent to an element of matchExpressions, whose key field is "key", the
+ operator is "In", and the values array contains only "value". The requirements are ANDed.
+ type: object
+ type: object
+ x-kubernetes-map-type: atomic
+ type: object
+ type: object
+ hostname:
+ description: |-
+ Hostname specifies the virtual hostname to match for protocol types that
+ define this concept. When unspecified, all hostnames are matched. This
+ field is ignored for protocols that don't require hostname based
+ matching.
+
+
+ Implementations MUST apply Hostname matching appropriately for each of
+ the following protocols:
+
+
+ * TLS: The Listener Hostname MUST match the SNI.
+ * HTTP: The Listener Hostname MUST match the Host header of the request.
+ * HTTPS: The Listener Hostname SHOULD match at both the TLS and HTTP
+ protocol layers as described above. If an implementation does not
+ ensure that both the SNI and Host header match the Listener hostname,
+ it MUST clearly document that.
+
+
+ For HTTPRoute and TLSRoute resources, there is an interaction with the
+ `spec.hostnames` array. When both listener and route specify hostnames,
+ there MUST be an intersection between the values for a Route to be
+ accepted. For more information, refer to the Route specific Hostnames
+ documentation.
+
+
+ Hostnames that are prefixed with a wildcard label (`*.`) are interpreted
+ as a suffix match. That means that a match for `*.example.com` would match
+ both `test.example.com`, and `foo.test.example.com`, but not `example.com`.
+
+
+ Support: Core
+ maxLength: 253
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^(\*\.)?[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$
+ type: string
+ name:
+ description: |-
+ Name is the name of the Listener. This name MUST be unique within a
+ Gateway.
+
+
+ Support: Core
+ maxLength: 253
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$
+ type: string
+ port:
+ description: |-
+ Port is the network port. Multiple listeners may use the
+ same port, subject to the Listener compatibility rules.
+
+
+ Support: Core
+ format: int32
+ maximum: 65535
+ minimum: 1
+ type: integer
+ protocol:
+ description: |-
+ Protocol specifies the network protocol this listener expects to receive.
+
+
+ Support: Core
+ maxLength: 255
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[a-zA-Z0-9]([-a-zSA-Z0-9]*[a-zA-Z0-9])?$|[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*\/[A-Za-z0-9]+$
+ type: string
+ tls:
+ description: |-
+ TLS is the TLS configuration for the Listener. This field is required if
+ the Protocol field is "HTTPS" or "TLS". It is invalid to set this field
+ if the Protocol field is "HTTP", "TCP", or "UDP".
+
+
+ The association of SNIs to Certificate defined in GatewayTLSConfig is
+ defined based on the Hostname field for this listener.
+
+
+ The GatewayClass MUST use the longest matching SNI out of all
+ available certificates for any TLS handshake.
+
+
+ Support: Core
+ properties:
+ certificateRefs:
+ description: |-
+ CertificateRefs contains a series of references to Kubernetes objects that
+ contains TLS certificates and private keys. These certificates are used to
+ establish a TLS handshake for requests that match the hostname of the
+ associated listener.
+
+
+ A single CertificateRef to a Kubernetes Secret has "Core" support.
+ Implementations MAY choose to support attaching multiple certificates to
+ a Listener, but this behavior is implementation-specific.
+
+
+ References to a resource in different namespace are invalid UNLESS there
+ is a ReferenceGrant in the target namespace that allows the certificate
+ to be attached. If a ReferenceGrant does not allow this reference, the
+ "ResolvedRefs" condition MUST be set to False for this listener with the
+ "RefNotPermitted" reason.
+
+
+ This field is required to have at least one element when the mode is set
+ to "Terminate" (default) and is optional otherwise.
+
+
+ CertificateRefs can reference to standard Kubernetes resources, i.e.
+ Secret, or implementation-specific custom resources.
+
+
+ Support: Core - A single reference to a Kubernetes Secret of type kubernetes.io/tls
+
+
+ Support: Implementation-specific (More than one reference or other resource types)
+ items:
+ description: |-
+ SecretObjectReference identifies an API object including its namespace,
+ defaulting to Secret.
+
+
+ The API object must be valid in the cluster; the Group and Kind must
+ be registered in the cluster for this reference to be valid.
+
+
+ References to objects with invalid Group and Kind are not valid, and must
+ be rejected by the implementation, with appropriate Conditions set
+ on the containing object.
+ properties:
+ group:
+ default: ""
+ description: |-
+ Group is the group of the referent. For example, "gateway.networking.k8s.io".
+ When unspecified or empty string, core API group is inferred.
+ maxLength: 253
+ pattern: ^$|^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$
+ type: string
+ kind:
+ default: Secret
+ description: Kind is kind of the referent. For example
+ "Secret".
+ maxLength: 63
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[a-zA-Z]([-a-zA-Z0-9]*[a-zA-Z0-9])?$
+ type: string
+ name:
+ description: Name is the name of the referent.
+ maxLength: 253
+ minLength: 1
+ type: string
+ namespace:
+ description: |-
+ Namespace is the namespace of the referenced object. When unspecified, the local
+ namespace is inferred.
+
+
+ Note that when a namespace different than the local namespace is specified,
+ a ReferenceGrant object is required in the referent namespace to allow that
+ namespace's owner to accept the reference. See the ReferenceGrant
+ documentation for details.
+
+
+ Support: Core
+ maxLength: 63
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?$
+ type: string
+ required:
+ - name
+ type: object
+ maxItems: 64
+ type: array
+ mode:
+ default: Terminate
+ description: |-
+ Mode defines the TLS behavior for the TLS session initiated by the client.
+ There are two possible modes:
+
+
+ - Terminate: The TLS session between the downstream client and the
+ Gateway is terminated at the Gateway. This mode requires certificates
+ to be specified in some way, such as populating the certificateRefs
+ field.
+ - Passthrough: The TLS session is NOT terminated by the Gateway. This
+ implies that the Gateway can't decipher the TLS stream except for
+ the ClientHello message of the TLS protocol. The certificateRefs field
+ is ignored in this mode.
+
+
+ Support: Core
+ enum:
+ - Terminate
+ - Passthrough
+ type: string
+ options:
+ additionalProperties:
+ description: |-
+ AnnotationValue is the value of an annotation in Gateway API. This is used
+ for validation of maps such as TLS options. This roughly matches Kubernetes
+ annotation validation, although the length validation in that case is based
+ on the entire size of the annotations struct.
+ maxLength: 4096
+ minLength: 0
+ type: string
+ description: |-
+ Options are a list of key/value pairs to enable extended TLS
+ configuration for each implementation. For example, configuring the
+ minimum TLS version or supported cipher suites.
+
+
+ A set of common keys MAY be defined by the API in the future. To avoid
+ any ambiguity, implementation-specific definitions MUST use
+ domain-prefixed names, such as `example.com/my-custom-option`.
+ Un-prefixed names are reserved for key names defined by Gateway API.
+
+
+ Support: Implementation-specific
+ maxProperties: 16
+ type: object
+ type: object
+ x-kubernetes-validations:
+ - message: certificateRefs or options must be specified when
+ mode is Terminate
+ rule: 'self.mode == ''Terminate'' ? size(self.certificateRefs)
+ > 0 || size(self.options) > 0 : true'
+ required:
+ - name
+ - port
+ - protocol
+ type: object
+ maxItems: 64
+ minItems: 1
+ type: array
+ x-kubernetes-list-map-keys:
+ - name
+ x-kubernetes-list-type: map
+ x-kubernetes-validations:
+ - message: tls must not be specified for protocols ['HTTP', 'TCP',
+ 'UDP']
+ rule: 'self.all(l, l.protocol in [''HTTP'', ''TCP'', ''UDP''] ?
+ !has(l.tls) : true)'
+ - message: tls mode must be Terminate for protocol HTTPS
+ rule: 'self.all(l, (l.protocol == ''HTTPS'' && has(l.tls)) ? (l.tls.mode
+ == '''' || l.tls.mode == ''Terminate'') : true)'
+ - message: hostname must not be specified for protocols ['TCP', 'UDP']
+ rule: 'self.all(l, l.protocol in [''TCP'', ''UDP''] ? (!has(l.hostname)
+ || l.hostname == '''') : true)'
+ - message: Listener name must be unique within the Gateway
+ rule: self.all(l1, self.exists_one(l2, l1.name == l2.name))
+ - message: Combination of port, protocol and hostname must be unique
+ for each listener
+ rule: 'self.all(l1, self.exists_one(l2, l1.port == l2.port && l1.protocol
+ == l2.protocol && (has(l1.hostname) && has(l2.hostname) ? l1.hostname
+ == l2.hostname : !has(l1.hostname) && !has(l2.hostname))))'
+ required:
+ - gatewayClassName
+ - listeners
+ type: object
+ status:
+ default:
+ conditions:
+ - lastTransitionTime: "1970-01-01T00:00:00Z"
+ message: Waiting for controller
+ reason: Pending
+ status: Unknown
+ type: Accepted
+ - lastTransitionTime: "1970-01-01T00:00:00Z"
+ message: Waiting for controller
+ reason: Pending
+ status: Unknown
+ type: Programmed
+ description: Status defines the current state of Gateway.
+ properties:
+ addresses:
+ description: |+
+ Addresses lists the network addresses that have been bound to the
+ Gateway.
+
+
+ This list may differ from the addresses provided in the spec under some
+ conditions:
+
+
+ * no addresses are specified, all addresses are dynamically assigned
+ * a combination of specified and dynamic addresses are assigned
+ * a specified address was unusable (e.g. already in use)
+
+
+ items:
+ description: GatewayStatusAddress describes a network address that
+ is bound to a Gateway.
+ oneOf:
+ - properties:
+ type:
+ enum:
+ - IPAddress
+ value:
+ anyOf:
+ - format: ipv4
+ - format: ipv6
+ - properties:
+ type:
+ not:
+ enum:
+ - IPAddress
+ properties:
+ type:
+ default: IPAddress
+ description: Type of the address.
+ maxLength: 253
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^Hostname|IPAddress|NamedAddress|[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*\/[A-Za-z0-9\/\-._~%!$&'()*+,;=:]+$
+ type: string
+ value:
+ description: |-
+ Value of the address. The validity of the values will depend
+ on the type and support by the controller.
+
+
+ Examples: `1.2.3.4`, `128::1`, `my-ip-address`.
+ maxLength: 253
+ minLength: 1
+ type: string
+ required:
+ - value
+ type: object
+ x-kubernetes-validations:
+ - message: Hostname value must only contain valid characters (matching
+ ^(\*\.)?[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$)
+ rule: 'self.type == ''Hostname'' ? self.value.matches(r"""^(\*\.)?[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$"""):
+ true'
+ maxItems: 16
+ type: array
+ conditions:
+ default:
+ - lastTransitionTime: "1970-01-01T00:00:00Z"
+ message: Waiting for controller
+ reason: Pending
+ status: Unknown
+ type: Accepted
+ - lastTransitionTime: "1970-01-01T00:00:00Z"
+ message: Waiting for controller
+ reason: Pending
+ status: Unknown
+ type: Programmed
+ description: |-
+ Conditions describe the current conditions of the Gateway.
+
+
+ Implementations should prefer to express Gateway conditions
+ using the `GatewayConditionType` and `GatewayConditionReason`
+ constants so that operators and tools can converge on a common
+ vocabulary to describe Gateway state.
+
+
+ Known condition types are:
+
+
+ * "Accepted"
+ * "Programmed"
+ * "Ready"
+ items:
+ description: "Condition contains details for one aspect of the current
+ state of this API Resource.\n---\nThis struct is intended for
+ direct use as an array at the field path .status.conditions. For
+ example,\n\n\n\ttype FooStatus struct{\n\t // Represents the
+ observations of a foo's current state.\n\t // Known .status.conditions.type
+ are: \"Available\", \"Progressing\", and \"Degraded\"\n\t //
+ +patchMergeKey=type\n\t // +patchStrategy=merge\n\t // +listType=map\n\t
+ \ // +listMapKey=type\n\t Conditions []metav1.Condition `json:\"conditions,omitempty\"
+ patchStrategy:\"merge\" patchMergeKey:\"type\" protobuf:\"bytes,1,rep,name=conditions\"`\n\n\n\t
+ \ // other fields\n\t}"
+ properties:
+ lastTransitionTime:
+ description: |-
+ lastTransitionTime is the last time the condition transitioned from one status to another.
+ This should be when the underlying condition changed. If that is not known, then using the time when the API field changed is acceptable.
+ format: date-time
+ type: string
+ message:
+ description: |-
+ message is a human readable message indicating details about the transition.
+ This may be an empty string.
+ maxLength: 32768
+ type: string
+ observedGeneration:
+ description: |-
+ observedGeneration represents the .metadata.generation that the condition was set based upon.
+ For instance, if .metadata.generation is currently 12, but the .status.conditions[x].observedGeneration is 9, the condition is out of date
+ with respect to the current state of the instance.
+ format: int64
+ minimum: 0
+ type: integer
+ reason:
+ description: |-
+ reason contains a programmatic identifier indicating the reason for the condition's last transition.
+ Producers of specific condition types may define expected values and meanings for this field,
+ and whether the values are considered a guaranteed API.
+ The value should be a CamelCase string.
+ This field may not be empty.
+ maxLength: 1024
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[A-Za-z]([A-Za-z0-9_,:]*[A-Za-z0-9_])?$
+ type: string
+ status:
+ description: status of the condition, one of True, False, Unknown.
+ enum:
+ - "True"
+ - "False"
+ - Unknown
+ type: string
+ type:
+ description: |-
+ type of condition in CamelCase or in foo.example.com/CamelCase.
+ ---
+ Many .condition.type values are consistent across resources like Available, but because arbitrary conditions can be
+ useful (see .node.status.conditions), the ability to deconflict is important.
+ The regex it matches is (dns1123SubdomainFmt/)?(qualifiedNameFmt)
+ maxLength: 316
+ pattern: ^([a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*/)?(([A-Za-z0-9][-A-Za-z0-9_.]*)?[A-Za-z0-9])$
+ type: string
+ required:
+ - lastTransitionTime
+ - message
+ - reason
+ - status
+ - type
+ type: object
+ maxItems: 8
+ type: array
+ x-kubernetes-list-map-keys:
+ - type
+ x-kubernetes-list-type: map
+ listeners:
+ description: Listeners provide status for each unique listener port
+ defined in the Spec.
+ items:
+ description: ListenerStatus is the status associated with a Listener.
+ properties:
+ attachedRoutes:
+ description: |-
+ AttachedRoutes represents the total number of Routes that have been
+ successfully attached to this Listener.
+
+
+ Successful attachment of a Route to a Listener is based solely on the
+ combination of the AllowedRoutes field on the corresponding Listener
+ and the Route's ParentRefs field. A Route is successfully attached to
+ a Listener when it is selected by the Listener's AllowedRoutes field
+ AND the Route has a valid ParentRef selecting the whole Gateway
+ resource or a specific Listener as a parent resource (more detail on
+ attachment semantics can be found in the documentation on the various
+ Route kinds ParentRefs fields). Listener or Route status does not impact
+ successful attachment, i.e. the AttachedRoutes field count MUST be set
+ for Listeners with condition Accepted: false and MUST count successfully
+ attached Routes that may themselves have Accepted: false conditions.
+
+
+ Uses for this field include troubleshooting Route attachment and
+ measuring blast radius/impact of changes to a Listener.
+ format: int32
+ type: integer
+ conditions:
+ description: Conditions describe the current condition of this
+ listener.
+ items:
+ description: "Condition contains details for one aspect of
+ the current state of this API Resource.\n---\nThis struct
+ is intended for direct use as an array at the field path
+ .status.conditions. For example,\n\n\n\ttype FooStatus
+ struct{\n\t // Represents the observations of a foo's
+ current state.\n\t // Known .status.conditions.type are:
+ \"Available\", \"Progressing\", and \"Degraded\"\n\t //
+ +patchMergeKey=type\n\t // +patchStrategy=merge\n\t //
+ +listType=map\n\t // +listMapKey=type\n\t Conditions
+ []metav1.Condition `json:\"conditions,omitempty\" patchStrategy:\"merge\"
+ patchMergeKey:\"type\" protobuf:\"bytes,1,rep,name=conditions\"`\n\n\n\t
+ \ // other fields\n\t}"
+ properties:
+ lastTransitionTime:
+ description: |-
+ lastTransitionTime is the last time the condition transitioned from one status to another.
+ This should be when the underlying condition changed. If that is not known, then using the time when the API field changed is acceptable.
+ format: date-time
+ type: string
+ message:
+ description: |-
+ message is a human readable message indicating details about the transition.
+ This may be an empty string.
+ maxLength: 32768
+ type: string
+ observedGeneration:
+ description: |-
+ observedGeneration represents the .metadata.generation that the condition was set based upon.
+ For instance, if .metadata.generation is currently 12, but the .status.conditions[x].observedGeneration is 9, the condition is out of date
+ with respect to the current state of the instance.
+ format: int64
+ minimum: 0
+ type: integer
+ reason:
+ description: |-
+ reason contains a programmatic identifier indicating the reason for the condition's last transition.
+ Producers of specific condition types may define expected values and meanings for this field,
+ and whether the values are considered a guaranteed API.
+ The value should be a CamelCase string.
+ This field may not be empty.
+ maxLength: 1024
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[A-Za-z]([A-Za-z0-9_,:]*[A-Za-z0-9_])?$
+ type: string
+ status:
+ description: status of the condition, one of True, False,
+ Unknown.
+ enum:
+ - "True"
+ - "False"
+ - Unknown
+ type: string
+ type:
+ description: |-
+ type of condition in CamelCase or in foo.example.com/CamelCase.
+ ---
+ Many .condition.type values are consistent across resources like Available, but because arbitrary conditions can be
+ useful (see .node.status.conditions), the ability to deconflict is important.
+ The regex it matches is (dns1123SubdomainFmt/)?(qualifiedNameFmt)
+ maxLength: 316
+ pattern: ^([a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*/)?(([A-Za-z0-9][-A-Za-z0-9_.]*)?[A-Za-z0-9])$
+ type: string
+ required:
+ - lastTransitionTime
+ - message
+ - reason
+ - status
+ - type
+ type: object
+ maxItems: 8
+ type: array
+ x-kubernetes-list-map-keys:
+ - type
+ x-kubernetes-list-type: map
+ name:
+ description: Name is the name of the Listener that this status
+ corresponds to.
+ maxLength: 253
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$
+ type: string
+ supportedKinds:
+ description: |-
+ SupportedKinds is the list indicating the Kinds supported by this
+ listener. This MUST represent the kinds an implementation supports for
+ that Listener configuration.
+
+
+ If kinds are specified in Spec that are not supported, they MUST NOT
+ appear in this list and an implementation MUST set the "ResolvedRefs"
+ condition to "False" with the "InvalidRouteKinds" reason. If both valid
+ and invalid Route kinds are specified, the implementation MUST
+ reference the valid Route kinds that have been specified.
+ items:
+ description: RouteGroupKind indicates the group and kind of
+ a Route resource.
+ properties:
+ group:
+ default: gateway.networking.k8s.io
+ description: Group is the group of the Route.
+ maxLength: 253
+ pattern: ^$|^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$
+ type: string
+ kind:
+ description: Kind is the kind of the Route.
+ maxLength: 63
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[a-zA-Z]([-a-zA-Z0-9]*[a-zA-Z0-9])?$
+ type: string
+ required:
+ - kind
+ type: object
+ maxItems: 8
+ type: array
+ required:
+ - attachedRoutes
+ - conditions
+ - name
+ - supportedKinds
+ type: object
+ maxItems: 64
+ type: array
+ x-kubernetes-list-map-keys:
+ - name
+ x-kubernetes-list-type: map
+ type: object
+ required:
+ - spec
+ type: object
+ served: true
+ storage: true
+ subresources:
+ status: {}
+ - additionalPrinterColumns:
+ - jsonPath: .spec.gatewayClassName
+ name: Class
+ type: string
+ - jsonPath: .status.addresses[*].value
+ name: Address
+ type: string
+ - jsonPath: .status.conditions[?(@.type=="Programmed")].status
+ name: Programmed
+ type: string
+ - jsonPath: .metadata.creationTimestamp
+ name: Age
+ type: date
+ name: v1beta1
+ schema:
+ openAPIV3Schema:
+ description: |-
+ Gateway represents an instance of a service-traffic handling infrastructure
+ by binding Listeners to a set of IP addresses.
+ properties:
+ apiVersion:
+ description: |-
+ APIVersion defines the versioned schema of this representation of an object.
+ Servers should convert recognized schemas to the latest internal value, and
+ may reject unrecognized values.
+ More info: https://git.k8s.io/community/contributors/devel/sig-architecture/api-conventions.md#resources
+ type: string
+ kind:
+ description: |-
+ Kind is a string value representing the REST resource this object represents.
+ Servers may infer this from the endpoint the client submits requests to.
+ Cannot be updated.
+ In CamelCase.
+ More info: https://git.k8s.io/community/contributors/devel/sig-architecture/api-conventions.md#types-kinds
+ type: string
+ metadata:
+ type: object
+ spec:
+ description: Spec defines the desired state of Gateway.
+ properties:
+ addresses:
+ description: |+
+ Addresses requested for this Gateway. This is optional and behavior can
+ depend on the implementation. If a value is set in the spec and the
+ requested address is invalid or unavailable, the implementation MUST
+ indicate this in the associated entry in GatewayStatus.Addresses.
+
+
+ The Addresses field represents a request for the address(es) on the
+ "outside of the Gateway", that traffic bound for this Gateway will use.
+ This could be the IP address or hostname of an external load balancer or
+ other networking infrastructure, or some other address that traffic will
+ be sent to.
+
+
+ If no Addresses are specified, the implementation MAY schedule the
+ Gateway in an implementation-specific manner, assigning an appropriate
+ set of Addresses.
+
+
+ The implementation MUST bind all Listeners to every GatewayAddress that
+ it assigns to the Gateway and add a corresponding entry in
+ GatewayStatus.Addresses.
+
+
+ Support: Extended
+
+
+ items:
+ description: GatewayAddress describes an address that can be bound
+ to a Gateway.
+ oneOf:
+ - properties:
+ type:
+ enum:
+ - IPAddress
+ value:
+ anyOf:
+ - format: ipv4
+ - format: ipv6
+ - properties:
+ type:
+ not:
+ enum:
+ - IPAddress
+ properties:
+ type:
+ default: IPAddress
+ description: Type of the address.
+ maxLength: 253
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^Hostname|IPAddress|NamedAddress|[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*\/[A-Za-z0-9\/\-._~%!$&'()*+,;=:]+$
+ type: string
+ value:
+ description: |-
+ Value of the address. The validity of the values will depend
+ on the type and support by the controller.
+
+
+ Examples: `1.2.3.4`, `128::1`, `my-ip-address`.
+ maxLength: 253
+ minLength: 1
+ type: string
+ required:
+ - value
+ type: object
+ x-kubernetes-validations:
+ - message: Hostname value must only contain valid characters (matching
+ ^(\*\.)?[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$)
+ rule: 'self.type == ''Hostname'' ? self.value.matches(r"""^(\*\.)?[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$"""):
+ true'
+ maxItems: 16
+ type: array
+ x-kubernetes-validations:
+ - message: IPAddress values must be unique
+ rule: 'self.all(a1, a1.type == ''IPAddress'' ? self.exists_one(a2,
+ a2.type == a1.type && a2.value == a1.value) : true )'
+ - message: Hostname values must be unique
+ rule: 'self.all(a1, a1.type == ''Hostname'' ? self.exists_one(a2,
+ a2.type == a1.type && a2.value == a1.value) : true )'
+ gatewayClassName:
+ description: |-
+ GatewayClassName used for this Gateway. This is the name of a
+ GatewayClass resource.
+ maxLength: 253
+ minLength: 1
+ type: string
+ listeners:
+ description: |-
+ Listeners associated with this Gateway. Listeners define
+ logical endpoints that are bound on this Gateway's addresses.
+ At least one Listener MUST be specified.
+
+
+ Each Listener in a set of Listeners (for example, in a single Gateway)
+ MUST be _distinct_, in that a traffic flow MUST be able to be assigned to
+ exactly one listener. (This section uses "set of Listeners" rather than
+ "Listeners in a single Gateway" because implementations MAY merge configuration
+ from multiple Gateways onto a single data plane, and these rules _also_
+ apply in that case).
+
+
+ Practically, this means that each listener in a set MUST have a unique
+ combination of Port, Protocol, and, if supported by the protocol, Hostname.
+
+
+ Some combinations of port, protocol, and TLS settings are considered
+ Core support and MUST be supported by implementations based on their
+ targeted conformance profile:
+
+
+ HTTP Profile
+
+
+ 1. HTTPRoute, Port: 80, Protocol: HTTP
+ 2. HTTPRoute, Port: 443, Protocol: HTTPS, TLS Mode: Terminate, TLS keypair provided
+
+
+ TLS Profile
+
+
+ 1. TLSRoute, Port: 443, Protocol: TLS, TLS Mode: Passthrough
+
+
+ "Distinct" Listeners have the following property:
+
+
+ The implementation can match inbound requests to a single distinct
+ Listener. When multiple Listeners share values for fields (for
+ example, two Listeners with the same Port value), the implementation
+ can match requests to only one of the Listeners using other
+ Listener fields.
+
+
+ For example, the following Listener scenarios are distinct:
+
+
+ 1. Multiple Listeners with the same Port that all use the "HTTP"
+ Protocol that all have unique Hostname values.
+ 2. Multiple Listeners with the same Port that use either the "HTTPS" or
+ "TLS" Protocol that all have unique Hostname values.
+ 3. A mixture of "TCP" and "UDP" Protocol Listeners, where no Listener
+ with the same Protocol has the same Port value.
+
+
+ Some fields in the Listener struct have possible values that affect
+ whether the Listener is distinct. Hostname is particularly relevant
+ for HTTP or HTTPS protocols.
+
+
+ When using the Hostname value to select between same-Port, same-Protocol
+ Listeners, the Hostname value must be different on each Listener for the
+ Listener to be distinct.
+
+
+ When the Listeners are distinct based on Hostname, inbound request
+ hostnames MUST match from the most specific to least specific Hostname
+ values to choose the correct Listener and its associated set of Routes.
+
+
+ Exact matches must be processed before wildcard matches, and wildcard
+ matches must be processed before fallback (empty Hostname value)
+ matches. For example, `"foo.example.com"` takes precedence over
+ `"*.example.com"`, and `"*.example.com"` takes precedence over `""`.
+
+
+ Additionally, if there are multiple wildcard entries, more specific
+ wildcard entries must be processed before less specific wildcard entries.
+ For example, `"*.foo.example.com"` takes precedence over `"*.example.com"`.
+ The precise definition here is that the higher the number of dots in the
+ hostname to the right of the wildcard character, the higher the precedence.
+
+
+ The wildcard character will match any number of characters _and dots_ to
+ the left, however, so `"*.example.com"` will match both
+ `"foo.bar.example.com"` _and_ `"bar.example.com"`.
+
+
+ If a set of Listeners contains Listeners that are not distinct, then those
+ Listeners are Conflicted, and the implementation MUST set the "Conflicted"
+ condition in the Listener Status to "True".
+
+
+ Implementations MAY choose to accept a Gateway with some Conflicted
+ Listeners only if they only accept the partial Listener set that contains
+ no Conflicted Listeners. To put this another way, implementations may
+ accept a partial Listener set only if they throw out *all* the conflicting
+ Listeners. No picking one of the conflicting listeners as the winner.
+ This also means that the Gateway must have at least one non-conflicting
+ Listener in this case, otherwise it violates the requirement that at
+ least one Listener must be present.
+
+
+ The implementation MUST set a "ListenersNotValid" condition on the
+ Gateway Status when the Gateway contains Conflicted Listeners whether or
+ not they accept the Gateway. That Condition SHOULD clearly
+ indicate in the Message which Listeners are conflicted, and which are
+ Accepted. Additionally, the Listener status for those listeners SHOULD
+ indicate which Listeners are conflicted and not Accepted.
+
+
+ A Gateway's Listeners are considered "compatible" if:
+
+
+ 1. They are distinct.
+ 2. The implementation can serve them in compliance with the Addresses
+ requirement that all Listeners are available on all assigned
+ addresses.
+
+
+ Compatible combinations in Extended support are expected to vary across
+ implementations. A combination that is compatible for one implementation
+ may not be compatible for another.
+
+
+ For example, an implementation that cannot serve both TCP and UDP listeners
+ on the same address, or cannot mix HTTPS and generic TLS listens on the same port
+ would not consider those cases compatible, even though they are distinct.
+
+
+ Note that requests SHOULD match at most one Listener. For example, if
+ Listeners are defined for "foo.example.com" and "*.example.com", a
+ request to "foo.example.com" SHOULD only be routed using routes attached
+ to the "foo.example.com" Listener (and not the "*.example.com" Listener).
+ This concept is known as "Listener Isolation". Implementations that do
+ not support Listener Isolation MUST clearly document this.
+
+
+ Implementations MAY merge separate Gateways onto a single set of
+ Addresses if all Listeners across all Gateways are compatible.
+
+
+ Support: Core
+ items:
+ description: |-
+ Listener embodies the concept of a logical endpoint where a Gateway accepts
+ network connections.
+ properties:
+ allowedRoutes:
+ default:
+ namespaces:
+ from: Same
+ description: |-
+ AllowedRoutes defines the types of routes that MAY be attached to a
+ Listener and the trusted namespaces where those Route resources MAY be
+ present.
+
+
+ Although a client request may match multiple route rules, only one rule
+ may ultimately receive the request. Matching precedence MUST be
+ determined in order of the following criteria:
+
+
+ * The most specific match as defined by the Route type.
+ * The oldest Route based on creation timestamp. For example, a Route with
+ a creation timestamp of "2020-09-08 01:02:03" is given precedence over
+ a Route with a creation timestamp of "2020-09-08 01:02:04".
+ * If everything else is equivalent, the Route appearing first in
+ alphabetical order (namespace/name) should be given precedence. For
+ example, foo/bar is given precedence over foo/baz.
+
+
+ All valid rules within a Route attached to this Listener should be
+ implemented. Invalid Route rules can be ignored (sometimes that will mean
+ the full Route). If a Route rule transitions from valid to invalid,
+ support for that Route rule should be dropped to ensure consistency. For
+ example, even if a filter specified by a Route rule is invalid, the rest
+ of the rules within that Route should still be supported.
+
+
+ Support: Core
+ properties:
+ kinds:
+ description: |-
+ Kinds specifies the groups and kinds of Routes that are allowed to bind
+ to this Gateway Listener. When unspecified or empty, the kinds of Routes
+ selected are determined using the Listener protocol.
+
+
+ A RouteGroupKind MUST correspond to kinds of Routes that are compatible
+ with the application protocol specified in the Listener's Protocol field.
+ If an implementation does not support or recognize this resource type, it
+ MUST set the "ResolvedRefs" condition to False for this Listener with the
+ "InvalidRouteKinds" reason.
+
+
+ Support: Core
+ items:
+ description: RouteGroupKind indicates the group and kind
+ of a Route resource.
+ properties:
+ group:
+ default: gateway.networking.k8s.io
+ description: Group is the group of the Route.
+ maxLength: 253
+ pattern: ^$|^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$
+ type: string
+ kind:
+ description: Kind is the kind of the Route.
+ maxLength: 63
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[a-zA-Z]([-a-zA-Z0-9]*[a-zA-Z0-9])?$
+ type: string
+ required:
+ - kind
+ type: object
+ maxItems: 8
+ type: array
+ namespaces:
+ default:
+ from: Same
+ description: |-
+ Namespaces indicates namespaces from which Routes may be attached to this
+ Listener. This is restricted to the namespace of this Gateway by default.
+
+
+ Support: Core
+ properties:
+ from:
+ default: Same
+ description: |-
+ From indicates where Routes will be selected for this Gateway. Possible
+ values are:
+
+
+ * All: Routes in all namespaces may be used by this Gateway.
+ * Selector: Routes in namespaces selected by the selector may be used by
+ this Gateway.
+ * Same: Only Routes in the same namespace may be used by this Gateway.
+
+
+ Support: Core
+ enum:
+ - All
+ - Selector
+ - Same
+ type: string
+ selector:
+ description: |-
+ Selector must be specified when From is set to "Selector". In that case,
+ only Routes in Namespaces matching this Selector will be selected by this
+ Gateway. This field is ignored for other values of "From".
+
+
+ Support: Core
+ properties:
+ matchExpressions:
+ description: matchExpressions is a list of label
+ selector requirements. The requirements are ANDed.
+ items:
+ description: |-
+ A label selector requirement is a selector that contains values, a key, and an operator that
+ relates the key and values.
+ properties:
+ key:
+ description: key is the label key that the
+ selector applies to.
+ type: string
+ operator:
+ description: |-
+ operator represents a key's relationship to a set of values.
+ Valid operators are In, NotIn, Exists and DoesNotExist.
+ type: string
+ values:
+ description: |-
+ values is an array of string values. If the operator is In or NotIn,
+ the values array must be non-empty. If the operator is Exists or DoesNotExist,
+ the values array must be empty. This array is replaced during a strategic
+ merge patch.
+ items:
+ type: string
+ type: array
+ x-kubernetes-list-type: atomic
+ required:
+ - key
+ - operator
+ type: object
+ type: array
+ x-kubernetes-list-type: atomic
+ matchLabels:
+ additionalProperties:
+ type: string
+ description: |-
+ matchLabels is a map of {key,value} pairs. A single {key,value} in the matchLabels
+ map is equivalent to an element of matchExpressions, whose key field is "key", the
+ operator is "In", and the values array contains only "value". The requirements are ANDed.
+ type: object
+ type: object
+ x-kubernetes-map-type: atomic
+ type: object
+ type: object
+ hostname:
+ description: |-
+ Hostname specifies the virtual hostname to match for protocol types that
+ define this concept. When unspecified, all hostnames are matched. This
+ field is ignored for protocols that don't require hostname based
+ matching.
+
+
+ Implementations MUST apply Hostname matching appropriately for each of
+ the following protocols:
+
+
+ * TLS: The Listener Hostname MUST match the SNI.
+ * HTTP: The Listener Hostname MUST match the Host header of the request.
+ * HTTPS: The Listener Hostname SHOULD match at both the TLS and HTTP
+ protocol layers as described above. If an implementation does not
+ ensure that both the SNI and Host header match the Listener hostname,
+ it MUST clearly document that.
+
+
+ For HTTPRoute and TLSRoute resources, there is an interaction with the
+ `spec.hostnames` array. When both listener and route specify hostnames,
+ there MUST be an intersection between the values for a Route to be
+ accepted. For more information, refer to the Route specific Hostnames
+ documentation.
+
+
+ Hostnames that are prefixed with a wildcard label (`*.`) are interpreted
+ as a suffix match. That means that a match for `*.example.com` would match
+ both `test.example.com`, and `foo.test.example.com`, but not `example.com`.
+
+
+ Support: Core
+ maxLength: 253
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^(\*\.)?[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$
+ type: string
+ name:
+ description: |-
+ Name is the name of the Listener. This name MUST be unique within a
+ Gateway.
+
+
+ Support: Core
+ maxLength: 253
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$
+ type: string
+ port:
+ description: |-
+ Port is the network port. Multiple listeners may use the
+ same port, subject to the Listener compatibility rules.
+
+
+ Support: Core
+ format: int32
+ maximum: 65535
+ minimum: 1
+ type: integer
+ protocol:
+ description: |-
+ Protocol specifies the network protocol this listener expects to receive.
+
+
+ Support: Core
+ maxLength: 255
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[a-zA-Z0-9]([-a-zSA-Z0-9]*[a-zA-Z0-9])?$|[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*\/[A-Za-z0-9]+$
+ type: string
+ tls:
+ description: |-
+ TLS is the TLS configuration for the Listener. This field is required if
+ the Protocol field is "HTTPS" or "TLS". It is invalid to set this field
+ if the Protocol field is "HTTP", "TCP", or "UDP".
+
+
+ The association of SNIs to Certificate defined in GatewayTLSConfig is
+ defined based on the Hostname field for this listener.
+
+
+ The GatewayClass MUST use the longest matching SNI out of all
+ available certificates for any TLS handshake.
+
+
+ Support: Core
+ properties:
+ certificateRefs:
+ description: |-
+ CertificateRefs contains a series of references to Kubernetes objects that
+ contains TLS certificates and private keys. These certificates are used to
+ establish a TLS handshake for requests that match the hostname of the
+ associated listener.
+
+
+ A single CertificateRef to a Kubernetes Secret has "Core" support.
+ Implementations MAY choose to support attaching multiple certificates to
+ a Listener, but this behavior is implementation-specific.
+
+
+ References to a resource in different namespace are invalid UNLESS there
+ is a ReferenceGrant in the target namespace that allows the certificate
+ to be attached. If a ReferenceGrant does not allow this reference, the
+ "ResolvedRefs" condition MUST be set to False for this listener with the
+ "RefNotPermitted" reason.
+
+
+ This field is required to have at least one element when the mode is set
+ to "Terminate" (default) and is optional otherwise.
+
+
+ CertificateRefs can reference to standard Kubernetes resources, i.e.
+ Secret, or implementation-specific custom resources.
+
+
+ Support: Core - A single reference to a Kubernetes Secret of type kubernetes.io/tls
+
+
+ Support: Implementation-specific (More than one reference or other resource types)
+ items:
+ description: |-
+ SecretObjectReference identifies an API object including its namespace,
+ defaulting to Secret.
+
+
+ The API object must be valid in the cluster; the Group and Kind must
+ be registered in the cluster for this reference to be valid.
+
+
+ References to objects with invalid Group and Kind are not valid, and must
+ be rejected by the implementation, with appropriate Conditions set
+ on the containing object.
+ properties:
+ group:
+ default: ""
+ description: |-
+ Group is the group of the referent. For example, "gateway.networking.k8s.io".
+ When unspecified or empty string, core API group is inferred.
+ maxLength: 253
+ pattern: ^$|^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$
+ type: string
+ kind:
+ default: Secret
+ description: Kind is kind of the referent. For example
+ "Secret".
+ maxLength: 63
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[a-zA-Z]([-a-zA-Z0-9]*[a-zA-Z0-9])?$
+ type: string
+ name:
+ description: Name is the name of the referent.
+ maxLength: 253
+ minLength: 1
+ type: string
+ namespace:
+ description: |-
+ Namespace is the namespace of the referenced object. When unspecified, the local
+ namespace is inferred.
+
+
+ Note that when a namespace different than the local namespace is specified,
+ a ReferenceGrant object is required in the referent namespace to allow that
+ namespace's owner to accept the reference. See the ReferenceGrant
+ documentation for details.
+
+
+ Support: Core
+ maxLength: 63
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?$
+ type: string
+ required:
+ - name
+ type: object
+ maxItems: 64
+ type: array
+ mode:
+ default: Terminate
+ description: |-
+ Mode defines the TLS behavior for the TLS session initiated by the client.
+ There are two possible modes:
+
+
+ - Terminate: The TLS session between the downstream client and the
+ Gateway is terminated at the Gateway. This mode requires certificates
+ to be specified in some way, such as populating the certificateRefs
+ field.
+ - Passthrough: The TLS session is NOT terminated by the Gateway. This
+ implies that the Gateway can't decipher the TLS stream except for
+ the ClientHello message of the TLS protocol. The certificateRefs field
+ is ignored in this mode.
+
+
+ Support: Core
+ enum:
+ - Terminate
+ - Passthrough
+ type: string
+ options:
+ additionalProperties:
+ description: |-
+ AnnotationValue is the value of an annotation in Gateway API. This is used
+ for validation of maps such as TLS options. This roughly matches Kubernetes
+ annotation validation, although the length validation in that case is based
+ on the entire size of the annotations struct.
+ maxLength: 4096
+ minLength: 0
+ type: string
+ description: |-
+ Options are a list of key/value pairs to enable extended TLS
+ configuration for each implementation. For example, configuring the
+ minimum TLS version or supported cipher suites.
+
+
+ A set of common keys MAY be defined by the API in the future. To avoid
+ any ambiguity, implementation-specific definitions MUST use
+ domain-prefixed names, such as `example.com/my-custom-option`.
+ Un-prefixed names are reserved for key names defined by Gateway API.
+
+
+ Support: Implementation-specific
+ maxProperties: 16
+ type: object
+ type: object
+ x-kubernetes-validations:
+ - message: certificateRefs or options must be specified when
+ mode is Terminate
+ rule: 'self.mode == ''Terminate'' ? size(self.certificateRefs)
+ > 0 || size(self.options) > 0 : true'
+ required:
+ - name
+ - port
+ - protocol
+ type: object
+ maxItems: 64
+ minItems: 1
+ type: array
+ x-kubernetes-list-map-keys:
+ - name
+ x-kubernetes-list-type: map
+ x-kubernetes-validations:
+ - message: tls must not be specified for protocols ['HTTP', 'TCP',
+ 'UDP']
+ rule: 'self.all(l, l.protocol in [''HTTP'', ''TCP'', ''UDP''] ?
+ !has(l.tls) : true)'
+ - message: tls mode must be Terminate for protocol HTTPS
+ rule: 'self.all(l, (l.protocol == ''HTTPS'' && has(l.tls)) ? (l.tls.mode
+ == '''' || l.tls.mode == ''Terminate'') : true)'
+ - message: hostname must not be specified for protocols ['TCP', 'UDP']
+ rule: 'self.all(l, l.protocol in [''TCP'', ''UDP''] ? (!has(l.hostname)
+ || l.hostname == '''') : true)'
+ - message: Listener name must be unique within the Gateway
+ rule: self.all(l1, self.exists_one(l2, l1.name == l2.name))
+ - message: Combination of port, protocol and hostname must be unique
+ for each listener
+ rule: 'self.all(l1, self.exists_one(l2, l1.port == l2.port && l1.protocol
+ == l2.protocol && (has(l1.hostname) && has(l2.hostname) ? l1.hostname
+ == l2.hostname : !has(l1.hostname) && !has(l2.hostname))))'
+ required:
+ - gatewayClassName
+ - listeners
+ type: object
+ status:
+ default:
+ conditions:
+ - lastTransitionTime: "1970-01-01T00:00:00Z"
+ message: Waiting for controller
+ reason: Pending
+ status: Unknown
+ type: Accepted
+ - lastTransitionTime: "1970-01-01T00:00:00Z"
+ message: Waiting for controller
+ reason: Pending
+ status: Unknown
+ type: Programmed
+ description: Status defines the current state of Gateway.
+ properties:
+ addresses:
+ description: |+
+ Addresses lists the network addresses that have been bound to the
+ Gateway.
+
+
+ This list may differ from the addresses provided in the spec under some
+ conditions:
+
+
+ * no addresses are specified, all addresses are dynamically assigned
+ * a combination of specified and dynamic addresses are assigned
+ * a specified address was unusable (e.g. already in use)
+
+
+ items:
+ description: GatewayStatusAddress describes a network address that
+ is bound to a Gateway.
+ oneOf:
+ - properties:
+ type:
+ enum:
+ - IPAddress
+ value:
+ anyOf:
+ - format: ipv4
+ - format: ipv6
+ - properties:
+ type:
+ not:
+ enum:
+ - IPAddress
+ properties:
+ type:
+ default: IPAddress
+ description: Type of the address.
+ maxLength: 253
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^Hostname|IPAddress|NamedAddress|[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*\/[A-Za-z0-9\/\-._~%!$&'()*+,;=:]+$
+ type: string
+ value:
+ description: |-
+ Value of the address. The validity of the values will depend
+ on the type and support by the controller.
+
+
+ Examples: `1.2.3.4`, `128::1`, `my-ip-address`.
+ maxLength: 253
+ minLength: 1
+ type: string
+ required:
+ - value
+ type: object
+ x-kubernetes-validations:
+ - message: Hostname value must only contain valid characters (matching
+ ^(\*\.)?[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$)
+ rule: 'self.type == ''Hostname'' ? self.value.matches(r"""^(\*\.)?[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$"""):
+ true'
+ maxItems: 16
+ type: array
+ conditions:
+ default:
+ - lastTransitionTime: "1970-01-01T00:00:00Z"
+ message: Waiting for controller
+ reason: Pending
+ status: Unknown
+ type: Accepted
+ - lastTransitionTime: "1970-01-01T00:00:00Z"
+ message: Waiting for controller
+ reason: Pending
+ status: Unknown
+ type: Programmed
+ description: |-
+ Conditions describe the current conditions of the Gateway.
+
+
+ Implementations should prefer to express Gateway conditions
+ using the `GatewayConditionType` and `GatewayConditionReason`
+ constants so that operators and tools can converge on a common
+ vocabulary to describe Gateway state.
+
+
+ Known condition types are:
+
+
+ * "Accepted"
+ * "Programmed"
+ * "Ready"
+ items:
+ description: "Condition contains details for one aspect of the current
+ state of this API Resource.\n---\nThis struct is intended for
+ direct use as an array at the field path .status.conditions. For
+ example,\n\n\n\ttype FooStatus struct{\n\t // Represents the
+ observations of a foo's current state.\n\t // Known .status.conditions.type
+ are: \"Available\", \"Progressing\", and \"Degraded\"\n\t //
+ +patchMergeKey=type\n\t // +patchStrategy=merge\n\t // +listType=map\n\t
+ \ // +listMapKey=type\n\t Conditions []metav1.Condition `json:\"conditions,omitempty\"
+ patchStrategy:\"merge\" patchMergeKey:\"type\" protobuf:\"bytes,1,rep,name=conditions\"`\n\n\n\t
+ \ // other fields\n\t}"
+ properties:
+ lastTransitionTime:
+ description: |-
+ lastTransitionTime is the last time the condition transitioned from one status to another.
+ This should be when the underlying condition changed. If that is not known, then using the time when the API field changed is acceptable.
+ format: date-time
+ type: string
+ message:
+ description: |-
+ message is a human readable message indicating details about the transition.
+ This may be an empty string.
+ maxLength: 32768
+ type: string
+ observedGeneration:
+ description: |-
+ observedGeneration represents the .metadata.generation that the condition was set based upon.
+ For instance, if .metadata.generation is currently 12, but the .status.conditions[x].observedGeneration is 9, the condition is out of date
+ with respect to the current state of the instance.
+ format: int64
+ minimum: 0
+ type: integer
+ reason:
+ description: |-
+ reason contains a programmatic identifier indicating the reason for the condition's last transition.
+ Producers of specific condition types may define expected values and meanings for this field,
+ and whether the values are considered a guaranteed API.
+ The value should be a CamelCase string.
+ This field may not be empty.
+ maxLength: 1024
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[A-Za-z]([A-Za-z0-9_,:]*[A-Za-z0-9_])?$
+ type: string
+ status:
+ description: status of the condition, one of True, False, Unknown.
+ enum:
+ - "True"
+ - "False"
+ - Unknown
+ type: string
+ type:
+ description: |-
+ type of condition in CamelCase or in foo.example.com/CamelCase.
+ ---
+ Many .condition.type values are consistent across resources like Available, but because arbitrary conditions can be
+ useful (see .node.status.conditions), the ability to deconflict is important.
+ The regex it matches is (dns1123SubdomainFmt/)?(qualifiedNameFmt)
+ maxLength: 316
+ pattern: ^([a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*/)?(([A-Za-z0-9][-A-Za-z0-9_.]*)?[A-Za-z0-9])$
+ type: string
+ required:
+ - lastTransitionTime
+ - message
+ - reason
+ - status
+ - type
+ type: object
+ maxItems: 8
+ type: array
+ x-kubernetes-list-map-keys:
+ - type
+ x-kubernetes-list-type: map
+ listeners:
+ description: Listeners provide status for each unique listener port
+ defined in the Spec.
+ items:
+ description: ListenerStatus is the status associated with a Listener.
+ properties:
+ attachedRoutes:
+ description: |-
+ AttachedRoutes represents the total number of Routes that have been
+ successfully attached to this Listener.
+
+
+ Successful attachment of a Route to a Listener is based solely on the
+ combination of the AllowedRoutes field on the corresponding Listener
+ and the Route's ParentRefs field. A Route is successfully attached to
+ a Listener when it is selected by the Listener's AllowedRoutes field
+ AND the Route has a valid ParentRef selecting the whole Gateway
+ resource or a specific Listener as a parent resource (more detail on
+ attachment semantics can be found in the documentation on the various
+ Route kinds ParentRefs fields). Listener or Route status does not impact
+ successful attachment, i.e. the AttachedRoutes field count MUST be set
+ for Listeners with condition Accepted: false and MUST count successfully
+ attached Routes that may themselves have Accepted: false conditions.
+
+
+ Uses for this field include troubleshooting Route attachment and
+ measuring blast radius/impact of changes to a Listener.
+ format: int32
+ type: integer
+ conditions:
+ description: Conditions describe the current condition of this
+ listener.
+ items:
+ description: "Condition contains details for one aspect of
+ the current state of this API Resource.\n---\nThis struct
+ is intended for direct use as an array at the field path
+ .status.conditions. For example,\n\n\n\ttype FooStatus
+ struct{\n\t // Represents the observations of a foo's
+ current state.\n\t // Known .status.conditions.type are:
+ \"Available\", \"Progressing\", and \"Degraded\"\n\t //
+ +patchMergeKey=type\n\t // +patchStrategy=merge\n\t //
+ +listType=map\n\t // +listMapKey=type\n\t Conditions
+ []metav1.Condition `json:\"conditions,omitempty\" patchStrategy:\"merge\"
+ patchMergeKey:\"type\" protobuf:\"bytes,1,rep,name=conditions\"`\n\n\n\t
+ \ // other fields\n\t}"
+ properties:
+ lastTransitionTime:
+ description: |-
+ lastTransitionTime is the last time the condition transitioned from one status to another.
+ This should be when the underlying condition changed. If that is not known, then using the time when the API field changed is acceptable.
+ format: date-time
+ type: string
+ message:
+ description: |-
+ message is a human readable message indicating details about the transition.
+ This may be an empty string.
+ maxLength: 32768
+ type: string
+ observedGeneration:
+ description: |-
+ observedGeneration represents the .metadata.generation that the condition was set based upon.
+ For instance, if .metadata.generation is currently 12, but the .status.conditions[x].observedGeneration is 9, the condition is out of date
+ with respect to the current state of the instance.
+ format: int64
+ minimum: 0
+ type: integer
+ reason:
+ description: |-
+ reason contains a programmatic identifier indicating the reason for the condition's last transition.
+ Producers of specific condition types may define expected values and meanings for this field,
+ and whether the values are considered a guaranteed API.
+ The value should be a CamelCase string.
+ This field may not be empty.
+ maxLength: 1024
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[A-Za-z]([A-Za-z0-9_,:]*[A-Za-z0-9_])?$
+ type: string
+ status:
+ description: status of the condition, one of True, False,
+ Unknown.
+ enum:
+ - "True"
+ - "False"
+ - Unknown
+ type: string
+ type:
+ description: |-
+ type of condition in CamelCase or in foo.example.com/CamelCase.
+ ---
+ Many .condition.type values are consistent across resources like Available, but because arbitrary conditions can be
+ useful (see .node.status.conditions), the ability to deconflict is important.
+ The regex it matches is (dns1123SubdomainFmt/)?(qualifiedNameFmt)
+ maxLength: 316
+ pattern: ^([a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*/)?(([A-Za-z0-9][-A-Za-z0-9_.]*)?[A-Za-z0-9])$
+ type: string
+ required:
+ - lastTransitionTime
+ - message
+ - reason
+ - status
+ - type
+ type: object
+ maxItems: 8
+ type: array
+ x-kubernetes-list-map-keys:
+ - type
+ x-kubernetes-list-type: map
+ name:
+ description: Name is the name of the Listener that this status
+ corresponds to.
+ maxLength: 253
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$
+ type: string
+ supportedKinds:
+ description: |-
+ SupportedKinds is the list indicating the Kinds supported by this
+ listener. This MUST represent the kinds an implementation supports for
+ that Listener configuration.
+
+
+ If kinds are specified in Spec that are not supported, they MUST NOT
+ appear in this list and an implementation MUST set the "ResolvedRefs"
+ condition to "False" with the "InvalidRouteKinds" reason. If both valid
+ and invalid Route kinds are specified, the implementation MUST
+ reference the valid Route kinds that have been specified.
+ items:
+ description: RouteGroupKind indicates the group and kind of
+ a Route resource.
+ properties:
+ group:
+ default: gateway.networking.k8s.io
+ description: Group is the group of the Route.
+ maxLength: 253
+ pattern: ^$|^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$
+ type: string
+ kind:
+ description: Kind is the kind of the Route.
+ maxLength: 63
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[a-zA-Z]([-a-zA-Z0-9]*[a-zA-Z0-9])?$
+ type: string
+ required:
+ - kind
+ type: object
+ maxItems: 8
+ type: array
+ required:
+ - attachedRoutes
+ - conditions
+ - name
+ - supportedKinds
+ type: object
+ maxItems: 64
+ type: array
+ x-kubernetes-list-map-keys:
+ - name
+ x-kubernetes-list-type: map
+ type: object
+ required:
+ - spec
+ type: object
+ served: true
+ storage: false
+ subresources:
+ status: {}
+status:
+ acceptedNames:
+ kind: ""
+ plural: ""
+ conditions: null
+ storedVersions: null
+---
+#
+# config/crd/standard/gateway.networking.k8s.io_grpcroutes.yaml
+#
+apiVersion: apiextensions.k8s.io/v1
+kind: CustomResourceDefinition
+metadata:
+ annotations:
+ api-approved.kubernetes.io: https://github.com/kubernetes-sigs/gateway-api/pull/2997
+ gateway.networking.k8s.io/bundle-version: v1.1.0
+ gateway.networking.k8s.io/channel: standard
+ creationTimestamp: null
+ name: grpcroutes.gateway.networking.k8s.io
+spec:
+ group: gateway.networking.k8s.io
+ names:
+ categories:
+ - gateway-api
+ kind: GRPCRoute
+ listKind: GRPCRouteList
+ plural: grpcroutes
+ singular: grpcroute
+ scope: Namespaced
+ versions:
+ - additionalPrinterColumns:
+ - jsonPath: .spec.hostnames
+ name: Hostnames
+ type: string
+ - jsonPath: .metadata.creationTimestamp
+ name: Age
+ type: date
+ name: v1
+ schema:
+ openAPIV3Schema:
+ description: |-
+ GRPCRoute provides a way to route gRPC requests. This includes the capability
+ to match requests by hostname, gRPC service, gRPC method, or HTTP/2 header.
+ Filters can be used to specify additional processing steps. Backends specify
+ where matching requests will be routed.
+
+
+ GRPCRoute falls under extended support within the Gateway API. Within the
+ following specification, the word "MUST" indicates that an implementation
+ supporting GRPCRoute must conform to the indicated requirement, but an
+ implementation not supporting this route type need not follow the requirement
+ unless explicitly indicated.
+
+
+ Implementations supporting `GRPCRoute` with the `HTTPS` `ProtocolType` MUST
+ accept HTTP/2 connections without an initial upgrade from HTTP/1.1, i.e. via
+ ALPN. If the implementation does not support this, then it MUST set the
+ "Accepted" condition to "False" for the affected listener with a reason of
+ "UnsupportedProtocol". Implementations MAY also accept HTTP/2 connections
+ with an upgrade from HTTP/1.
+
+
+ Implementations supporting `GRPCRoute` with the `HTTP` `ProtocolType` MUST
+ support HTTP/2 over cleartext TCP (h2c,
+ https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc7540#section-3.1) without an initial
+ upgrade from HTTP/1.1, i.e. with prior knowledge
+ (https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc7540#section-3.4). If the implementation
+ does not support this, then it MUST set the "Accepted" condition to "False"
+ for the affected listener with a reason of "UnsupportedProtocol".
+ Implementations MAY also accept HTTP/2 connections with an upgrade from
+ HTTP/1, i.e. without prior knowledge.
+ properties:
+ apiVersion:
+ description: |-
+ APIVersion defines the versioned schema of this representation of an object.
+ Servers should convert recognized schemas to the latest internal value, and
+ may reject unrecognized values.
+ More info: https://git.k8s.io/community/contributors/devel/sig-architecture/api-conventions.md#resources
+ type: string
+ kind:
+ description: |-
+ Kind is a string value representing the REST resource this object represents.
+ Servers may infer this from the endpoint the client submits requests to.
+ Cannot be updated.
+ In CamelCase.
+ More info: https://git.k8s.io/community/contributors/devel/sig-architecture/api-conventions.md#types-kinds
+ type: string
+ metadata:
+ type: object
+ spec:
+ description: Spec defines the desired state of GRPCRoute.
+ properties:
+ hostnames:
+ description: |-
+ Hostnames defines a set of hostnames to match against the GRPC
+ Host header to select a GRPCRoute to process the request. This matches
+ the RFC 1123 definition of a hostname with 2 notable exceptions:
+
+
+ 1. IPs are not allowed.
+ 2. A hostname may be prefixed with a wildcard label (`*.`). The wildcard
+ label MUST appear by itself as the first label.
+
+
+ If a hostname is specified by both the Listener and GRPCRoute, there
+ MUST be at least one intersecting hostname for the GRPCRoute to be
+ attached to the Listener. For example:
+
+
+ * A Listener with `test.example.com` as the hostname matches GRPCRoutes
+ that have either not specified any hostnames, or have specified at
+ least one of `test.example.com` or `*.example.com`.
+ * A Listener with `*.example.com` as the hostname matches GRPCRoutes
+ that have either not specified any hostnames or have specified at least
+ one hostname that matches the Listener hostname. For example,
+ `test.example.com` and `*.example.com` would both match. On the other
+ hand, `example.com` and `test.example.net` would not match.
+
+
+ Hostnames that are prefixed with a wildcard label (`*.`) are interpreted
+ as a suffix match. That means that a match for `*.example.com` would match
+ both `test.example.com`, and `foo.test.example.com`, but not `example.com`.
+
+
+ If both the Listener and GRPCRoute have specified hostnames, any
+ GRPCRoute hostnames that do not match the Listener hostname MUST be
+ ignored. For example, if a Listener specified `*.example.com`, and the
+ GRPCRoute specified `test.example.com` and `test.example.net`,
+ `test.example.net` MUST NOT be considered for a match.
+
+
+ If both the Listener and GRPCRoute have specified hostnames, and none
+ match with the criteria above, then the GRPCRoute MUST NOT be accepted by
+ the implementation. The implementation MUST raise an 'Accepted' Condition
+ with a status of `False` in the corresponding RouteParentStatus.
+
+
+ If a Route (A) of type HTTPRoute or GRPCRoute is attached to a
+ Listener and that listener already has another Route (B) of the other
+ type attached and the intersection of the hostnames of A and B is
+ non-empty, then the implementation MUST accept exactly one of these two
+ routes, determined by the following criteria, in order:
+
+
+ * The oldest Route based on creation timestamp.
+ * The Route appearing first in alphabetical order by
+ "{namespace}/{name}".
+
+
+ The rejected Route MUST raise an 'Accepted' condition with a status of
+ 'False' in the corresponding RouteParentStatus.
+
+
+ Support: Core
+ items:
+ description: |-
+ Hostname is the fully qualified domain name of a network host. This matches
+ the RFC 1123 definition of a hostname with 2 notable exceptions:
+
+
+ 1. IPs are not allowed.
+ 2. A hostname may be prefixed with a wildcard label (`*.`). The wildcard
+ label must appear by itself as the first label.
+
+
+ Hostname can be "precise" which is a domain name without the terminating
+ dot of a network host (e.g. "foo.example.com") or "wildcard", which is a
+ domain name prefixed with a single wildcard label (e.g. `*.example.com`).
+
+
+ Note that as per RFC1035 and RFC1123, a *label* must consist of lower case
+ alphanumeric characters or '-', and must start and end with an alphanumeric
+ character. No other punctuation is allowed.
+ maxLength: 253
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^(\*\.)?[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$
+ type: string
+ maxItems: 16
+ type: array
+ parentRefs:
+ description: |+
+ ParentRefs references the resources (usually Gateways) that a Route wants
+ to be attached to. Note that the referenced parent resource needs to
+ allow this for the attachment to be complete. For Gateways, that means
+ the Gateway needs to allow attachment from Routes of this kind and
+ namespace. For Services, that means the Service must either be in the same
+ namespace for a "producer" route, or the mesh implementation must support
+ and allow "consumer" routes for the referenced Service. ReferenceGrant is
+ not applicable for governing ParentRefs to Services - it is not possible to
+ create a "producer" route for a Service in a different namespace from the
+ Route.
+
+
+ There are two kinds of parent resources with "Core" support:
+
+
+ * Gateway (Gateway conformance profile)
+ * Service (Mesh conformance profile, ClusterIP Services only)
+
+
+ This API may be extended in the future to support additional kinds of parent
+ resources.
+
+
+ ParentRefs must be _distinct_. This means either that:
+
+
+ * They select different objects. If this is the case, then parentRef
+ entries are distinct. In terms of fields, this means that the
+ multi-part key defined by `group`, `kind`, `namespace`, and `name` must
+ be unique across all parentRef entries in the Route.
+ * They do not select different objects, but for each optional field used,
+ each ParentRef that selects the same object must set the same set of
+ optional fields to different values. If one ParentRef sets a
+ combination of optional fields, all must set the same combination.
+
+
+ Some examples:
+
+
+ * If one ParentRef sets `sectionName`, all ParentRefs referencing the
+ same object must also set `sectionName`.
+ * If one ParentRef sets `port`, all ParentRefs referencing the same
+ object must also set `port`.
+ * If one ParentRef sets `sectionName` and `port`, all ParentRefs
+ referencing the same object must also set `sectionName` and `port`.
+
+
+ It is possible to separately reference multiple distinct objects that may
+ be collapsed by an implementation. For example, some implementations may
+ choose to merge compatible Gateway Listeners together. If that is the
+ case, the list of routes attached to those resources should also be
+ merged.
+
+
+ Note that for ParentRefs that cross namespace boundaries, there are specific
+ rules. Cross-namespace references are only valid if they are explicitly
+ allowed by something in the namespace they are referring to. For example,
+ Gateway has the AllowedRoutes field, and ReferenceGrant provides a
+ generic way to enable other kinds of cross-namespace reference.
+
+
+
+
+
+
+
+
+ items:
+ description: |-
+ ParentReference identifies an API object (usually a Gateway) that can be considered
+ a parent of this resource (usually a route). There are two kinds of parent resources
+ with "Core" support:
+
+
+ * Gateway (Gateway conformance profile)
+ * Service (Mesh conformance profile, ClusterIP Services only)
+
+
+ This API may be extended in the future to support additional kinds of parent
+ resources.
+
+
+ The API object must be valid in the cluster; the Group and Kind must
+ be registered in the cluster for this reference to be valid.
+ properties:
+ group:
+ default: gateway.networking.k8s.io
+ description: |-
+ Group is the group of the referent.
+ When unspecified, "gateway.networking.k8s.io" is inferred.
+ To set the core API group (such as for a "Service" kind referent),
+ Group must be explicitly set to "" (empty string).
+
+
+ Support: Core
+ maxLength: 253
+ pattern: ^$|^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$
+ type: string
+ kind:
+ default: Gateway
+ description: |-
+ Kind is kind of the referent.
+
+
+ There are two kinds of parent resources with "Core" support:
+
+
+ * Gateway (Gateway conformance profile)
+ * Service (Mesh conformance profile, ClusterIP Services only)
+
+
+ Support for other resources is Implementation-Specific.
+ maxLength: 63
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[a-zA-Z]([-a-zA-Z0-9]*[a-zA-Z0-9])?$
+ type: string
+ name:
+ description: |-
+ Name is the name of the referent.
+
+
+ Support: Core
+ maxLength: 253
+ minLength: 1
+ type: string
+ namespace:
+ description: |-
+ Namespace is the namespace of the referent. When unspecified, this refers
+ to the local namespace of the Route.
+
+
+ Note that there are specific rules for ParentRefs which cross namespace
+ boundaries. Cross-namespace references are only valid if they are explicitly
+ allowed by something in the namespace they are referring to. For example:
+ Gateway has the AllowedRoutes field, and ReferenceGrant provides a
+ generic way to enable any other kind of cross-namespace reference.
+
+
+
+
+
+ Support: Core
+ maxLength: 63
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?$
+ type: string
+ port:
+ description: |-
+ Port is the network port this Route targets. It can be interpreted
+ differently based on the type of parent resource.
+
+
+ When the parent resource is a Gateway, this targets all listeners
+ listening on the specified port that also support this kind of Route(and
+ select this Route). It's not recommended to set `Port` unless the
+ networking behaviors specified in a Route must apply to a specific port
+ as opposed to a listener(s) whose port(s) may be changed. When both Port
+ and SectionName are specified, the name and port of the selected listener
+ must match both specified values.
+
+
+
+
+
+ Implementations MAY choose to support other parent resources.
+ Implementations supporting other types of parent resources MUST clearly
+ document how/if Port is interpreted.
+
+
+ For the purpose of status, an attachment is considered successful as
+ long as the parent resource accepts it partially. For example, Gateway
+ listeners can restrict which Routes can attach to them by Route kind,
+ namespace, or hostname. If 1 of 2 Gateway listeners accept attachment
+ from the referencing Route, the Route MUST be considered successfully
+ attached. If no Gateway listeners accept attachment from this Route,
+ the Route MUST be considered detached from the Gateway.
+
+
+ Support: Extended
+ format: int32
+ maximum: 65535
+ minimum: 1
+ type: integer
+ sectionName:
+ description: |-
+ SectionName is the name of a section within the target resource. In the
+ following resources, SectionName is interpreted as the following:
+
+
+ * Gateway: Listener name. When both Port (experimental) and SectionName
+ are specified, the name and port of the selected listener must match
+ both specified values.
+ * Service: Port name. When both Port (experimental) and SectionName
+ are specified, the name and port of the selected listener must match
+ both specified values.
+
+
+ Implementations MAY choose to support attaching Routes to other resources.
+ If that is the case, they MUST clearly document how SectionName is
+ interpreted.
+
+
+ When unspecified (empty string), this will reference the entire resource.
+ For the purpose of status, an attachment is considered successful if at
+ least one section in the parent resource accepts it. For example, Gateway
+ listeners can restrict which Routes can attach to them by Route kind,
+ namespace, or hostname. If 1 of 2 Gateway listeners accept attachment from
+ the referencing Route, the Route MUST be considered successfully
+ attached. If no Gateway listeners accept attachment from this Route, the
+ Route MUST be considered detached from the Gateway.
+
+
+ Support: Core
+ maxLength: 253
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$
+ type: string
+ required:
+ - name
+ type: object
+ maxItems: 32
+ type: array
+ x-kubernetes-validations:
+ - message: sectionName must be specified when parentRefs includes
+ 2 or more references to the same parent
+ rule: 'self.all(p1, self.all(p2, p1.group == p2.group && p1.kind
+ == p2.kind && p1.name == p2.name && (((!has(p1.__namespace__)
+ || p1.__namespace__ == '''') && (!has(p2.__namespace__) || p2.__namespace__
+ == '''')) || (has(p1.__namespace__) && has(p2.__namespace__) &&
+ p1.__namespace__ == p2.__namespace__ )) ? ((!has(p1.sectionName)
+ || p1.sectionName == '''') == (!has(p2.sectionName) || p2.sectionName
+ == '''')) : true))'
+ - message: sectionName must be unique when parentRefs includes 2 or
+ more references to the same parent
+ rule: self.all(p1, self.exists_one(p2, p1.group == p2.group && p1.kind
+ == p2.kind && p1.name == p2.name && (((!has(p1.__namespace__)
+ || p1.__namespace__ == '') && (!has(p2.__namespace__) || p2.__namespace__
+ == '')) || (has(p1.__namespace__) && has(p2.__namespace__) &&
+ p1.__namespace__ == p2.__namespace__ )) && (((!has(p1.sectionName)
+ || p1.sectionName == '') && (!has(p2.sectionName) || p2.sectionName
+ == '')) || (has(p1.sectionName) && has(p2.sectionName) && p1.sectionName
+ == p2.sectionName))))
+ rules:
+ description: Rules are a list of GRPC matchers, filters and actions.
+ items:
+ description: |-
+ GRPCRouteRule defines the semantics for matching a gRPC request based on
+ conditions (matches), processing it (filters), and forwarding the request to
+ an API object (backendRefs).
+ properties:
+ backendRefs:
+ description: |-
+ BackendRefs defines the backend(s) where matching requests should be
+ sent.
+
+
+ Failure behavior here depends on how many BackendRefs are specified and
+ how many are invalid.
+
+
+ If *all* entries in BackendRefs are invalid, and there are also no filters
+ specified in this route rule, *all* traffic which matches this rule MUST
+ receive an `UNAVAILABLE` status.
+
+
+ See the GRPCBackendRef definition for the rules about what makes a single
+ GRPCBackendRef invalid.
+
+
+ When a GRPCBackendRef is invalid, `UNAVAILABLE` statuses MUST be returned for
+ requests that would have otherwise been routed to an invalid backend. If
+ multiple backends are specified, and some are invalid, the proportion of
+ requests that would otherwise have been routed to an invalid backend
+ MUST receive an `UNAVAILABLE` status.
+
+
+ For example, if two backends are specified with equal weights, and one is
+ invalid, 50 percent of traffic MUST receive an `UNAVAILABLE` status.
+ Implementations may choose how that 50 percent is determined.
+
+
+ Support: Core for Kubernetes Service
+
+
+ Support: Implementation-specific for any other resource
+
+
+ Support for weight: Core
+ items:
+ description: |-
+ GRPCBackendRef defines how a GRPCRoute forwards a gRPC request.
+
+
+ Note that when a namespace different than the local namespace is specified, a
+ ReferenceGrant object is required in the referent namespace to allow that
+ namespace's owner to accept the reference. See the ReferenceGrant
+ documentation for details.
+
+
+
+
+
+ When the BackendRef points to a Kubernetes Service, implementations SHOULD
+ honor the appProtocol field if it is set for the target Service Port.
+
+
+ Implementations supporting appProtocol SHOULD recognize the Kubernetes
+ Standard Application Protocols defined in KEP-3726.
+
+
+ If a Service appProtocol isn't specified, an implementation MAY infer the
+ backend protocol through its own means. Implementations MAY infer the
+ protocol from the Route type referring to the backend Service.
+
+
+ If a Route is not able to send traffic to the backend using the specified
+ protocol then the backend is considered invalid. Implementations MUST set the
+ "ResolvedRefs" condition to "False" with the "UnsupportedProtocol" reason.
+
+
+
+ properties:
+ filters:
+ description: |-
+ Filters defined at this level MUST be executed if and only if the
+ request is being forwarded to the backend defined here.
+
+
+ Support: Implementation-specific (For broader support of filters, use the
+ Filters field in GRPCRouteRule.)
+ items:
+ description: |-
+ GRPCRouteFilter defines processing steps that must be completed during the
+ request or response lifecycle. GRPCRouteFilters are meant as an extension
+ point to express processing that may be done in Gateway implementations. Some
+ examples include request or response modification, implementing
+ authentication strategies, rate-limiting, and traffic shaping. API
+ guarantee/conformance is defined based on the type of the filter.
+ properties:
+ extensionRef:
+ description: |-
+ ExtensionRef is an optional, implementation-specific extension to the
+ "filter" behavior. For example, resource "myroutefilter" in group
+ "networking.example.net"). ExtensionRef MUST NOT be used for core and
+ extended filters.
+
+
+ Support: Implementation-specific
+
+
+ This filter can be used multiple times within the same rule.
+ properties:
+ group:
+ description: |-
+ Group is the group of the referent. For example, "gateway.networking.k8s.io".
+ When unspecified or empty string, core API group is inferred.
+ maxLength: 253
+ pattern: ^$|^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$
+ type: string
+ kind:
+ description: Kind is kind of the referent. For
+ example "HTTPRoute" or "Service".
+ maxLength: 63
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[a-zA-Z]([-a-zA-Z0-9]*[a-zA-Z0-9])?$
+ type: string
+ name:
+ description: Name is the name of the referent.
+ maxLength: 253
+ minLength: 1
+ type: string
+ required:
+ - group
+ - kind
+ - name
+ type: object
+ requestHeaderModifier:
+ description: |-
+ RequestHeaderModifier defines a schema for a filter that modifies request
+ headers.
+
+
+ Support: Core
+ properties:
+ add:
+ description: |-
+ Add adds the given header(s) (name, value) to the request
+ before the action. It appends to any existing values associated
+ with the header name.
+
+
+ Input:
+ GET /foo HTTP/1.1
+ my-header: foo
+
+
+ Config:
+ add:
+ - name: "my-header"
+ value: "bar,baz"
+
+
+ Output:
+ GET /foo HTTP/1.1
+ my-header: foo,bar,baz
+ items:
+ description: HTTPHeader represents an HTTP
+ Header name and value as defined by RFC
+ 7230.
+ properties:
+ name:
+ description: |-
+ Name is the name of the HTTP Header to be matched. Name matching MUST be
+ case insensitive. (See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc7230#section-3.2).
+
+
+ If multiple entries specify equivalent header names, the first entry with
+ an equivalent name MUST be considered for a match. Subsequent entries
+ with an equivalent header name MUST be ignored. Due to the
+ case-insensitivity of header names, "foo" and "Foo" are considered
+ equivalent.
+ maxLength: 256
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[A-Za-z0-9!#$%&'*+\-.^_\x60|~]+$
+ type: string
+ value:
+ description: Value is the value of HTTP
+ Header to be matched.
+ maxLength: 4096
+ minLength: 1
+ type: string
+ required:
+ - name
+ - value
+ type: object
+ maxItems: 16
+ type: array
+ x-kubernetes-list-map-keys:
+ - name
+ x-kubernetes-list-type: map
+ remove:
+ description: |-
+ Remove the given header(s) from the HTTP request before the action. The
+ value of Remove is a list of HTTP header names. Note that the header
+ names are case-insensitive (see
+ https://datatracker.ietf.org/doc/html/rfc2616#section-4.2).
+
+
+ Input:
+ GET /foo HTTP/1.1
+ my-header1: foo
+ my-header2: bar
+ my-header3: baz
+
+
+ Config:
+ remove: ["my-header1", "my-header3"]
+
+
+ Output:
+ GET /foo HTTP/1.1
+ my-header2: bar
+ items:
+ type: string
+ maxItems: 16
+ type: array
+ x-kubernetes-list-type: set
+ set:
+ description: |-
+ Set overwrites the request with the given header (name, value)
+ before the action.
+
+
+ Input:
+ GET /foo HTTP/1.1
+ my-header: foo
+
+
+ Config:
+ set:
+ - name: "my-header"
+ value: "bar"
+
+
+ Output:
+ GET /foo HTTP/1.1
+ my-header: bar
+ items:
+ description: HTTPHeader represents an HTTP
+ Header name and value as defined by RFC
+ 7230.
+ properties:
+ name:
+ description: |-
+ Name is the name of the HTTP Header to be matched. Name matching MUST be
+ case insensitive. (See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc7230#section-3.2).
+
+
+ If multiple entries specify equivalent header names, the first entry with
+ an equivalent name MUST be considered for a match. Subsequent entries
+ with an equivalent header name MUST be ignored. Due to the
+ case-insensitivity of header names, "foo" and "Foo" are considered
+ equivalent.
+ maxLength: 256
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[A-Za-z0-9!#$%&'*+\-.^_\x60|~]+$
+ type: string
+ value:
+ description: Value is the value of HTTP
+ Header to be matched.
+ maxLength: 4096
+ minLength: 1
+ type: string
+ required:
+ - name
+ - value
+ type: object
+ maxItems: 16
+ type: array
+ x-kubernetes-list-map-keys:
+ - name
+ x-kubernetes-list-type: map
+ type: object
+ requestMirror:
+ description: |-
+ RequestMirror defines a schema for a filter that mirrors requests.
+ Requests are sent to the specified destination, but responses from
+ that destination are ignored.
+
+
+ This filter can be used multiple times within the same rule. Note that
+ not all implementations will be able to support mirroring to multiple
+ backends.
+
+
+ Support: Extended
+ properties:
+ backendRef:
+ description: |-
+ BackendRef references a resource where mirrored requests are sent.
+
+
+ Mirrored requests must be sent only to a single destination endpoint
+ within this BackendRef, irrespective of how many endpoints are present
+ within this BackendRef.
+
+
+ If the referent cannot be found, this BackendRef is invalid and must be
+ dropped from the Gateway. The controller must ensure the "ResolvedRefs"
+ condition on the Route status is set to `status: False` and not configure
+ this backend in the underlying implementation.
+
+
+ If there is a cross-namespace reference to an *existing* object
+ that is not allowed by a ReferenceGrant, the controller must ensure the
+ "ResolvedRefs" condition on the Route is set to `status: False`,
+ with the "RefNotPermitted" reason and not configure this backend in the
+ underlying implementation.
+
+
+ In either error case, the Message of the `ResolvedRefs` Condition
+ should be used to provide more detail about the problem.
+
+
+ Support: Extended for Kubernetes Service
+
+
+ Support: Implementation-specific for any other resource
+ properties:
+ group:
+ default: ""
+ description: |-
+ Group is the group of the referent. For example, "gateway.networking.k8s.io".
+ When unspecified or empty string, core API group is inferred.
+ maxLength: 253
+ pattern: ^$|^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$
+ type: string
+ kind:
+ default: Service
+ description: |-
+ Kind is the Kubernetes resource kind of the referent. For example
+ "Service".
+
+
+ Defaults to "Service" when not specified.
+
+
+ ExternalName services can refer to CNAME DNS records that may live
+ outside of the cluster and as such are difficult to reason about in
+ terms of conformance. They also may not be safe to forward to (see
+ CVE-2021-25740 for more information). Implementations SHOULD NOT
+ support ExternalName Services.
+
+
+ Support: Core (Services with a type other than ExternalName)
+
+
+ Support: Implementation-specific (Services with type ExternalName)
+ maxLength: 63
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[a-zA-Z]([-a-zA-Z0-9]*[a-zA-Z0-9])?$
+ type: string
+ name:
+ description: Name is the name of the referent.
+ maxLength: 253
+ minLength: 1
+ type: string
+ namespace:
+ description: |-
+ Namespace is the namespace of the backend. When unspecified, the local
+ namespace is inferred.
+
+
+ Note that when a namespace different than the local namespace is specified,
+ a ReferenceGrant object is required in the referent namespace to allow that
+ namespace's owner to accept the reference. See the ReferenceGrant
+ documentation for details.
+
+
+ Support: Core
+ maxLength: 63
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?$
+ type: string
+ port:
+ description: |-
+ Port specifies the destination port number to use for this resource.
+ Port is required when the referent is a Kubernetes Service. In this
+ case, the port number is the service port number, not the target port.
+ For other resources, destination port might be derived from the referent
+ resource or this field.
+ format: int32
+ maximum: 65535
+ minimum: 1
+ type: integer
+ required:
+ - name
+ type: object
+ x-kubernetes-validations:
+ - message: Must have port for Service reference
+ rule: '(size(self.group) == 0 && self.kind
+ == ''Service'') ? has(self.port) : true'
+ required:
+ - backendRef
+ type: object
+ responseHeaderModifier:
+ description: |-
+ ResponseHeaderModifier defines a schema for a filter that modifies response
+ headers.
+
+
+ Support: Extended
+ properties:
+ add:
+ description: |-
+ Add adds the given header(s) (name, value) to the request
+ before the action. It appends to any existing values associated
+ with the header name.
+
+
+ Input:
+ GET /foo HTTP/1.1
+ my-header: foo
+
+
+ Config:
+ add:
+ - name: "my-header"
+ value: "bar,baz"
+
+
+ Output:
+ GET /foo HTTP/1.1
+ my-header: foo,bar,baz
+ items:
+ description: HTTPHeader represents an HTTP
+ Header name and value as defined by RFC
+ 7230.
+ properties:
+ name:
+ description: |-
+ Name is the name of the HTTP Header to be matched. Name matching MUST be
+ case insensitive. (See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc7230#section-3.2).
+
+
+ If multiple entries specify equivalent header names, the first entry with
+ an equivalent name MUST be considered for a match. Subsequent entries
+ with an equivalent header name MUST be ignored. Due to the
+ case-insensitivity of header names, "foo" and "Foo" are considered
+ equivalent.
+ maxLength: 256
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[A-Za-z0-9!#$%&'*+\-.^_\x60|~]+$
+ type: string
+ value:
+ description: Value is the value of HTTP
+ Header to be matched.
+ maxLength: 4096
+ minLength: 1
+ type: string
+ required:
+ - name
+ - value
+ type: object
+ maxItems: 16
+ type: array
+ x-kubernetes-list-map-keys:
+ - name
+ x-kubernetes-list-type: map
+ remove:
+ description: |-
+ Remove the given header(s) from the HTTP request before the action. The
+ value of Remove is a list of HTTP header names. Note that the header
+ names are case-insensitive (see
+ https://datatracker.ietf.org/doc/html/rfc2616#section-4.2).
+
+
+ Input:
+ GET /foo HTTP/1.1
+ my-header1: foo
+ my-header2: bar
+ my-header3: baz
+
+
+ Config:
+ remove: ["my-header1", "my-header3"]
+
+
+ Output:
+ GET /foo HTTP/1.1
+ my-header2: bar
+ items:
+ type: string
+ maxItems: 16
+ type: array
+ x-kubernetes-list-type: set
+ set:
+ description: |-
+ Set overwrites the request with the given header (name, value)
+ before the action.
+
+
+ Input:
+ GET /foo HTTP/1.1
+ my-header: foo
+
+
+ Config:
+ set:
+ - name: "my-header"
+ value: "bar"
+
+
+ Output:
+ GET /foo HTTP/1.1
+ my-header: bar
+ items:
+ description: HTTPHeader represents an HTTP
+ Header name and value as defined by RFC
+ 7230.
+ properties:
+ name:
+ description: |-
+ Name is the name of the HTTP Header to be matched. Name matching MUST be
+ case insensitive. (See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc7230#section-3.2).
+
+
+ If multiple entries specify equivalent header names, the first entry with
+ an equivalent name MUST be considered for a match. Subsequent entries
+ with an equivalent header name MUST be ignored. Due to the
+ case-insensitivity of header names, "foo" and "Foo" are considered
+ equivalent.
+ maxLength: 256
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[A-Za-z0-9!#$%&'*+\-.^_\x60|~]+$
+ type: string
+ value:
+ description: Value is the value of HTTP
+ Header to be matched.
+ maxLength: 4096
+ minLength: 1
+ type: string
+ required:
+ - name
+ - value
+ type: object
+ maxItems: 16
+ type: array
+ x-kubernetes-list-map-keys:
+ - name
+ x-kubernetes-list-type: map
+ type: object
+ type:
+ description: |+
+ Type identifies the type of filter to apply. As with other API fields,
+ types are classified into three conformance levels:
+
+
+ - Core: Filter types and their corresponding configuration defined by
+ "Support: Core" in this package, e.g. "RequestHeaderModifier". All
+ implementations supporting GRPCRoute MUST support core filters.
+
+
+ - Extended: Filter types and their corresponding configuration defined by
+ "Support: Extended" in this package, e.g. "RequestMirror". Implementers
+ are encouraged to support extended filters.
+
+
+ - Implementation-specific: Filters that are defined and supported by specific vendors.
+ In the future, filters showing convergence in behavior across multiple
+ implementations will be considered for inclusion in extended or core
+ conformance levels. Filter-specific configuration for such filters
+ is specified using the ExtensionRef field. `Type` MUST be set to
+ "ExtensionRef" for custom filters.
+
+
+ Implementers are encouraged to define custom implementation types to
+ extend the core API with implementation-specific behavior.
+
+
+ If a reference to a custom filter type cannot be resolved, the filter
+ MUST NOT be skipped. Instead, requests that would have been processed by
+ that filter MUST receive a HTTP error response.
+
+
+ enum:
+ - ResponseHeaderModifier
+ - RequestHeaderModifier
+ - RequestMirror
+ - ExtensionRef
+ type: string
+ required:
+ - type
+ type: object
+ x-kubernetes-validations:
+ - message: filter.requestHeaderModifier must be nil
+ if the filter.type is not RequestHeaderModifier
+ rule: '!(has(self.requestHeaderModifier) && self.type
+ != ''RequestHeaderModifier'')'
+ - message: filter.requestHeaderModifier must be specified
+ for RequestHeaderModifier filter.type
+ rule: '!(!has(self.requestHeaderModifier) && self.type
+ == ''RequestHeaderModifier'')'
+ - message: filter.responseHeaderModifier must be nil
+ if the filter.type is not ResponseHeaderModifier
+ rule: '!(has(self.responseHeaderModifier) && self.type
+ != ''ResponseHeaderModifier'')'
+ - message: filter.responseHeaderModifier must be specified
+ for ResponseHeaderModifier filter.type
+ rule: '!(!has(self.responseHeaderModifier) && self.type
+ == ''ResponseHeaderModifier'')'
+ - message: filter.requestMirror must be nil if the filter.type
+ is not RequestMirror
+ rule: '!(has(self.requestMirror) && self.type != ''RequestMirror'')'
+ - message: filter.requestMirror must be specified for
+ RequestMirror filter.type
+ rule: '!(!has(self.requestMirror) && self.type ==
+ ''RequestMirror'')'
+ - message: filter.extensionRef must be nil if the filter.type
+ is not ExtensionRef
+ rule: '!(has(self.extensionRef) && self.type != ''ExtensionRef'')'
+ - message: filter.extensionRef must be specified for
+ ExtensionRef filter.type
+ rule: '!(!has(self.extensionRef) && self.type == ''ExtensionRef'')'
+ maxItems: 16
+ type: array
+ x-kubernetes-validations:
+ - message: RequestHeaderModifier filter cannot be repeated
+ rule: self.filter(f, f.type == 'RequestHeaderModifier').size()
+ <= 1
+ - message: ResponseHeaderModifier filter cannot be repeated
+ rule: self.filter(f, f.type == 'ResponseHeaderModifier').size()
+ <= 1
+ group:
+ default: ""
+ description: |-
+ Group is the group of the referent. For example, "gateway.networking.k8s.io".
+ When unspecified or empty string, core API group is inferred.
+ maxLength: 253
+ pattern: ^$|^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$
+ type: string
+ kind:
+ default: Service
+ description: |-
+ Kind is the Kubernetes resource kind of the referent. For example
+ "Service".
+
+
+ Defaults to "Service" when not specified.
+
+
+ ExternalName services can refer to CNAME DNS records that may live
+ outside of the cluster and as such are difficult to reason about in
+ terms of conformance. They also may not be safe to forward to (see
+ CVE-2021-25740 for more information). Implementations SHOULD NOT
+ support ExternalName Services.
+
+
+ Support: Core (Services with a type other than ExternalName)
+
+
+ Support: Implementation-specific (Services with type ExternalName)
+ maxLength: 63
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[a-zA-Z]([-a-zA-Z0-9]*[a-zA-Z0-9])?$
+ type: string
+ name:
+ description: Name is the name of the referent.
+ maxLength: 253
+ minLength: 1
+ type: string
+ namespace:
+ description: |-
+ Namespace is the namespace of the backend. When unspecified, the local
+ namespace is inferred.
+
+
+ Note that when a namespace different than the local namespace is specified,
+ a ReferenceGrant object is required in the referent namespace to allow that
+ namespace's owner to accept the reference. See the ReferenceGrant
+ documentation for details.
+
+
+ Support: Core
+ maxLength: 63
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?$
+ type: string
+ port:
+ description: |-
+ Port specifies the destination port number to use for this resource.
+ Port is required when the referent is a Kubernetes Service. In this
+ case, the port number is the service port number, not the target port.
+ For other resources, destination port might be derived from the referent
+ resource or this field.
+ format: int32
+ maximum: 65535
+ minimum: 1
+ type: integer
+ weight:
+ default: 1
+ description: |-
+ Weight specifies the proportion of requests forwarded to the referenced
+ backend. This is computed as weight/(sum of all weights in this
+ BackendRefs list). For non-zero values, there may be some epsilon from
+ the exact proportion defined here depending on the precision an
+ implementation supports. Weight is not a percentage and the sum of
+ weights does not need to equal 100.
+
+
+ If only one backend is specified and it has a weight greater than 0, 100%
+ of the traffic is forwarded to that backend. If weight is set to 0, no
+ traffic should be forwarded for this entry. If unspecified, weight
+ defaults to 1.
+
+
+ Support for this field varies based on the context where used.
+ format: int32
+ maximum: 1000000
+ minimum: 0
+ type: integer
+ required:
+ - name
+ type: object
+ x-kubernetes-validations:
+ - message: Must have port for Service reference
+ rule: '(size(self.group) == 0 && self.kind == ''Service'')
+ ? has(self.port) : true'
+ maxItems: 16
+ type: array
+ filters:
+ description: |-
+ Filters define the filters that are applied to requests that match
+ this rule.
+
+
+ The effects of ordering of multiple behaviors are currently unspecified.
+ This can change in the future based on feedback during the alpha stage.
+
+
+ Conformance-levels at this level are defined based on the type of filter:
+
+
+ - ALL core filters MUST be supported by all implementations that support
+ GRPCRoute.
+ - Implementers are encouraged to support extended filters.
+ - Implementation-specific custom filters have no API guarantees across
+ implementations.
+
+
+ Specifying the same filter multiple times is not supported unless explicitly
+ indicated in the filter.
+
+
+ If an implementation can not support a combination of filters, it must clearly
+ document that limitation. In cases where incompatible or unsupported
+ filters are specified and cause the `Accepted` condition to be set to status
+ `False`, implementations may use the `IncompatibleFilters` reason to specify
+ this configuration error.
+
+
+ Support: Core
+ items:
+ description: |-
+ GRPCRouteFilter defines processing steps that must be completed during the
+ request or response lifecycle. GRPCRouteFilters are meant as an extension
+ point to express processing that may be done in Gateway implementations. Some
+ examples include request or response modification, implementing
+ authentication strategies, rate-limiting, and traffic shaping. API
+ guarantee/conformance is defined based on the type of the filter.
+ properties:
+ extensionRef:
+ description: |-
+ ExtensionRef is an optional, implementation-specific extension to the
+ "filter" behavior. For example, resource "myroutefilter" in group
+ "networking.example.net"). ExtensionRef MUST NOT be used for core and
+ extended filters.
+
+
+ Support: Implementation-specific
+
+
+ This filter can be used multiple times within the same rule.
+ properties:
+ group:
+ description: |-
+ Group is the group of the referent. For example, "gateway.networking.k8s.io".
+ When unspecified or empty string, core API group is inferred.
+ maxLength: 253
+ pattern: ^$|^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$
+ type: string
+ kind:
+ description: Kind is kind of the referent. For example
+ "HTTPRoute" or "Service".
+ maxLength: 63
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[a-zA-Z]([-a-zA-Z0-9]*[a-zA-Z0-9])?$
+ type: string
+ name:
+ description: Name is the name of the referent.
+ maxLength: 253
+ minLength: 1
+ type: string
+ required:
+ - group
+ - kind
+ - name
+ type: object
+ requestHeaderModifier:
+ description: |-
+ RequestHeaderModifier defines a schema for a filter that modifies request
+ headers.
+
+
+ Support: Core
+ properties:
+ add:
+ description: |-
+ Add adds the given header(s) (name, value) to the request
+ before the action. It appends to any existing values associated
+ with the header name.
+
+
+ Input:
+ GET /foo HTTP/1.1
+ my-header: foo
+
+
+ Config:
+ add:
+ - name: "my-header"
+ value: "bar,baz"
+
+
+ Output:
+ GET /foo HTTP/1.1
+ my-header: foo,bar,baz
+ items:
+ description: HTTPHeader represents an HTTP Header
+ name and value as defined by RFC 7230.
+ properties:
+ name:
+ description: |-
+ Name is the name of the HTTP Header to be matched. Name matching MUST be
+ case insensitive. (See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc7230#section-3.2).
+
+
+ If multiple entries specify equivalent header names, the first entry with
+ an equivalent name MUST be considered for a match. Subsequent entries
+ with an equivalent header name MUST be ignored. Due to the
+ case-insensitivity of header names, "foo" and "Foo" are considered
+ equivalent.
+ maxLength: 256
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[A-Za-z0-9!#$%&'*+\-.^_\x60|~]+$
+ type: string
+ value:
+ description: Value is the value of HTTP Header
+ to be matched.
+ maxLength: 4096
+ minLength: 1
+ type: string
+ required:
+ - name
+ - value
+ type: object
+ maxItems: 16
+ type: array
+ x-kubernetes-list-map-keys:
+ - name
+ x-kubernetes-list-type: map
+ remove:
+ description: |-
+ Remove the given header(s) from the HTTP request before the action. The
+ value of Remove is a list of HTTP header names. Note that the header
+ names are case-insensitive (see
+ https://datatracker.ietf.org/doc/html/rfc2616#section-4.2).
+
+
+ Input:
+ GET /foo HTTP/1.1
+ my-header1: foo
+ my-header2: bar
+ my-header3: baz
+
+
+ Config:
+ remove: ["my-header1", "my-header3"]
+
+
+ Output:
+ GET /foo HTTP/1.1
+ my-header2: bar
+ items:
+ type: string
+ maxItems: 16
+ type: array
+ x-kubernetes-list-type: set
+ set:
+ description: |-
+ Set overwrites the request with the given header (name, value)
+ before the action.
+
+
+ Input:
+ GET /foo HTTP/1.1
+ my-header: foo
+
+
+ Config:
+ set:
+ - name: "my-header"
+ value: "bar"
+
+
+ Output:
+ GET /foo HTTP/1.1
+ my-header: bar
+ items:
+ description: HTTPHeader represents an HTTP Header
+ name and value as defined by RFC 7230.
+ properties:
+ name:
+ description: |-
+ Name is the name of the HTTP Header to be matched. Name matching MUST be
+ case insensitive. (See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc7230#section-3.2).
+
+
+ If multiple entries specify equivalent header names, the first entry with
+ an equivalent name MUST be considered for a match. Subsequent entries
+ with an equivalent header name MUST be ignored. Due to the
+ case-insensitivity of header names, "foo" and "Foo" are considered
+ equivalent.
+ maxLength: 256
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[A-Za-z0-9!#$%&'*+\-.^_\x60|~]+$
+ type: string
+ value:
+ description: Value is the value of HTTP Header
+ to be matched.
+ maxLength: 4096
+ minLength: 1
+ type: string
+ required:
+ - name
+ - value
+ type: object
+ maxItems: 16
+ type: array
+ x-kubernetes-list-map-keys:
+ - name
+ x-kubernetes-list-type: map
+ type: object
+ requestMirror:
+ description: |-
+ RequestMirror defines a schema for a filter that mirrors requests.
+ Requests are sent to the specified destination, but responses from
+ that destination are ignored.
+
+
+ This filter can be used multiple times within the same rule. Note that
+ not all implementations will be able to support mirroring to multiple
+ backends.
+
+
+ Support: Extended
+ properties:
+ backendRef:
+ description: |-
+ BackendRef references a resource where mirrored requests are sent.
+
+
+ Mirrored requests must be sent only to a single destination endpoint
+ within this BackendRef, irrespective of how many endpoints are present
+ within this BackendRef.
+
+
+ If the referent cannot be found, this BackendRef is invalid and must be
+ dropped from the Gateway. The controller must ensure the "ResolvedRefs"
+ condition on the Route status is set to `status: False` and not configure
+ this backend in the underlying implementation.
+
+
+ If there is a cross-namespace reference to an *existing* object
+ that is not allowed by a ReferenceGrant, the controller must ensure the
+ "ResolvedRefs" condition on the Route is set to `status: False`,
+ with the "RefNotPermitted" reason and not configure this backend in the
+ underlying implementation.
+
+
+ In either error case, the Message of the `ResolvedRefs` Condition
+ should be used to provide more detail about the problem.
+
+
+ Support: Extended for Kubernetes Service
+
+
+ Support: Implementation-specific for any other resource
+ properties:
+ group:
+ default: ""
+ description: |-
+ Group is the group of the referent. For example, "gateway.networking.k8s.io".
+ When unspecified or empty string, core API group is inferred.
+ maxLength: 253
+ pattern: ^$|^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$
+ type: string
+ kind:
+ default: Service
+ description: |-
+ Kind is the Kubernetes resource kind of the referent. For example
+ "Service".
+
+
+ Defaults to "Service" when not specified.
+
+
+ ExternalName services can refer to CNAME DNS records that may live
+ outside of the cluster and as such are difficult to reason about in
+ terms of conformance. They also may not be safe to forward to (see
+ CVE-2021-25740 for more information). Implementations SHOULD NOT
+ support ExternalName Services.
+
+
+ Support: Core (Services with a type other than ExternalName)
+
+
+ Support: Implementation-specific (Services with type ExternalName)
+ maxLength: 63
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[a-zA-Z]([-a-zA-Z0-9]*[a-zA-Z0-9])?$
+ type: string
+ name:
+ description: Name is the name of the referent.
+ maxLength: 253
+ minLength: 1
+ type: string
+ namespace:
+ description: |-
+ Namespace is the namespace of the backend. When unspecified, the local
+ namespace is inferred.
+
+
+ Note that when a namespace different than the local namespace is specified,
+ a ReferenceGrant object is required in the referent namespace to allow that
+ namespace's owner to accept the reference. See the ReferenceGrant
+ documentation for details.
+
+
+ Support: Core
+ maxLength: 63
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?$
+ type: string
+ port:
+ description: |-
+ Port specifies the destination port number to use for this resource.
+ Port is required when the referent is a Kubernetes Service. In this
+ case, the port number is the service port number, not the target port.
+ For other resources, destination port might be derived from the referent
+ resource or this field.
+ format: int32
+ maximum: 65535
+ minimum: 1
+ type: integer
+ required:
+ - name
+ type: object
+ x-kubernetes-validations:
+ - message: Must have port for Service reference
+ rule: '(size(self.group) == 0 && self.kind == ''Service'')
+ ? has(self.port) : true'
+ required:
+ - backendRef
+ type: object
+ responseHeaderModifier:
+ description: |-
+ ResponseHeaderModifier defines a schema for a filter that modifies response
+ headers.
+
+
+ Support: Extended
+ properties:
+ add:
+ description: |-
+ Add adds the given header(s) (name, value) to the request
+ before the action. It appends to any existing values associated
+ with the header name.
+
+
+ Input:
+ GET /foo HTTP/1.1
+ my-header: foo
+
+
+ Config:
+ add:
+ - name: "my-header"
+ value: "bar,baz"
+
+
+ Output:
+ GET /foo HTTP/1.1
+ my-header: foo,bar,baz
+ items:
+ description: HTTPHeader represents an HTTP Header
+ name and value as defined by RFC 7230.
+ properties:
+ name:
+ description: |-
+ Name is the name of the HTTP Header to be matched. Name matching MUST be
+ case insensitive. (See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc7230#section-3.2).
+
+
+ If multiple entries specify equivalent header names, the first entry with
+ an equivalent name MUST be considered for a match. Subsequent entries
+ with an equivalent header name MUST be ignored. Due to the
+ case-insensitivity of header names, "foo" and "Foo" are considered
+ equivalent.
+ maxLength: 256
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[A-Za-z0-9!#$%&'*+\-.^_\x60|~]+$
+ type: string
+ value:
+ description: Value is the value of HTTP Header
+ to be matched.
+ maxLength: 4096
+ minLength: 1
+ type: string
+ required:
+ - name
+ - value
+ type: object
+ maxItems: 16
+ type: array
+ x-kubernetes-list-map-keys:
+ - name
+ x-kubernetes-list-type: map
+ remove:
+ description: |-
+ Remove the given header(s) from the HTTP request before the action. The
+ value of Remove is a list of HTTP header names. Note that the header
+ names are case-insensitive (see
+ https://datatracker.ietf.org/doc/html/rfc2616#section-4.2).
+
+
+ Input:
+ GET /foo HTTP/1.1
+ my-header1: foo
+ my-header2: bar
+ my-header3: baz
+
+
+ Config:
+ remove: ["my-header1", "my-header3"]
+
+
+ Output:
+ GET /foo HTTP/1.1
+ my-header2: bar
+ items:
+ type: string
+ maxItems: 16
+ type: array
+ x-kubernetes-list-type: set
+ set:
+ description: |-
+ Set overwrites the request with the given header (name, value)
+ before the action.
+
+
+ Input:
+ GET /foo HTTP/1.1
+ my-header: foo
+
+
+ Config:
+ set:
+ - name: "my-header"
+ value: "bar"
+
+
+ Output:
+ GET /foo HTTP/1.1
+ my-header: bar
+ items:
+ description: HTTPHeader represents an HTTP Header
+ name and value as defined by RFC 7230.
+ properties:
+ name:
+ description: |-
+ Name is the name of the HTTP Header to be matched. Name matching MUST be
+ case insensitive. (See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc7230#section-3.2).
+
+
+ If multiple entries specify equivalent header names, the first entry with
+ an equivalent name MUST be considered for a match. Subsequent entries
+ with an equivalent header name MUST be ignored. Due to the
+ case-insensitivity of header names, "foo" and "Foo" are considered
+ equivalent.
+ maxLength: 256
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[A-Za-z0-9!#$%&'*+\-.^_\x60|~]+$
+ type: string
+ value:
+ description: Value is the value of HTTP Header
+ to be matched.
+ maxLength: 4096
+ minLength: 1
+ type: string
+ required:
+ - name
+ - value
+ type: object
+ maxItems: 16
+ type: array
+ x-kubernetes-list-map-keys:
+ - name
+ x-kubernetes-list-type: map
+ type: object
+ type:
+ description: |+
+ Type identifies the type of filter to apply. As with other API fields,
+ types are classified into three conformance levels:
+
+
+ - Core: Filter types and their corresponding configuration defined by
+ "Support: Core" in this package, e.g. "RequestHeaderModifier". All
+ implementations supporting GRPCRoute MUST support core filters.
+
+
+ - Extended: Filter types and their corresponding configuration defined by
+ "Support: Extended" in this package, e.g. "RequestMirror". Implementers
+ are encouraged to support extended filters.
+
+
+ - Implementation-specific: Filters that are defined and supported by specific vendors.
+ In the future, filters showing convergence in behavior across multiple
+ implementations will be considered for inclusion in extended or core
+ conformance levels. Filter-specific configuration for such filters
+ is specified using the ExtensionRef field. `Type` MUST be set to
+ "ExtensionRef" for custom filters.
+
+
+ Implementers are encouraged to define custom implementation types to
+ extend the core API with implementation-specific behavior.
+
+
+ If a reference to a custom filter type cannot be resolved, the filter
+ MUST NOT be skipped. Instead, requests that would have been processed by
+ that filter MUST receive a HTTP error response.
+
+
+ enum:
+ - ResponseHeaderModifier
+ - RequestHeaderModifier
+ - RequestMirror
+ - ExtensionRef
+ type: string
+ required:
+ - type
+ type: object
+ x-kubernetes-validations:
+ - message: filter.requestHeaderModifier must be nil if the
+ filter.type is not RequestHeaderModifier
+ rule: '!(has(self.requestHeaderModifier) && self.type !=
+ ''RequestHeaderModifier'')'
+ - message: filter.requestHeaderModifier must be specified
+ for RequestHeaderModifier filter.type
+ rule: '!(!has(self.requestHeaderModifier) && self.type ==
+ ''RequestHeaderModifier'')'
+ - message: filter.responseHeaderModifier must be nil if the
+ filter.type is not ResponseHeaderModifier
+ rule: '!(has(self.responseHeaderModifier) && self.type !=
+ ''ResponseHeaderModifier'')'
+ - message: filter.responseHeaderModifier must be specified
+ for ResponseHeaderModifier filter.type
+ rule: '!(!has(self.responseHeaderModifier) && self.type
+ == ''ResponseHeaderModifier'')'
+ - message: filter.requestMirror must be nil if the filter.type
+ is not RequestMirror
+ rule: '!(has(self.requestMirror) && self.type != ''RequestMirror'')'
+ - message: filter.requestMirror must be specified for RequestMirror
+ filter.type
+ rule: '!(!has(self.requestMirror) && self.type == ''RequestMirror'')'
+ - message: filter.extensionRef must be nil if the filter.type
+ is not ExtensionRef
+ rule: '!(has(self.extensionRef) && self.type != ''ExtensionRef'')'
+ - message: filter.extensionRef must be specified for ExtensionRef
+ filter.type
+ rule: '!(!has(self.extensionRef) && self.type == ''ExtensionRef'')'
+ maxItems: 16
+ type: array
+ x-kubernetes-validations:
+ - message: RequestHeaderModifier filter cannot be repeated
+ rule: self.filter(f, f.type == 'RequestHeaderModifier').size()
+ <= 1
+ - message: ResponseHeaderModifier filter cannot be repeated
+ rule: self.filter(f, f.type == 'ResponseHeaderModifier').size()
+ <= 1
+ matches:
+ description: |-
+ Matches define conditions used for matching the rule against incoming
+ gRPC requests. Each match is independent, i.e. this rule will be matched
+ if **any** one of the matches is satisfied.
+
+
+ For example, take the following matches configuration:
+
+
+ ```
+ matches:
+ - method:
+ service: foo.bar
+ headers:
+ values:
+ version: 2
+ - method:
+ service: foo.bar.v2
+ ```
+
+
+ For a request to match against this rule, it MUST satisfy
+ EITHER of the two conditions:
+
+
+ - service of foo.bar AND contains the header `version: 2`
+ - service of foo.bar.v2
+
+
+ See the documentation for GRPCRouteMatch on how to specify multiple
+ match conditions to be ANDed together.
+
+
+ If no matches are specified, the implementation MUST match every gRPC request.
+
+
+ Proxy or Load Balancer routing configuration generated from GRPCRoutes
+ MUST prioritize rules based on the following criteria, continuing on
+ ties. Merging MUST not be done between GRPCRoutes and HTTPRoutes.
+ Precedence MUST be given to the rule with the largest number of:
+
+
+ * Characters in a matching non-wildcard hostname.
+ * Characters in a matching hostname.
+ * Characters in a matching service.
+ * Characters in a matching method.
+ * Header matches.
+
+
+ If ties still exist across multiple Routes, matching precedence MUST be
+ determined in order of the following criteria, continuing on ties:
+
+
+ * The oldest Route based on creation timestamp.
+ * The Route appearing first in alphabetical order by
+ "{namespace}/{name}".
+
+
+ If ties still exist within the Route that has been given precedence,
+ matching precedence MUST be granted to the first matching rule meeting
+ the above criteria.
+ items:
+ description: |-
+ GRPCRouteMatch defines the predicate used to match requests to a given
+ action. Multiple match types are ANDed together, i.e. the match will
+ evaluate to true only if all conditions are satisfied.
+
+
+ For example, the match below will match a gRPC request only if its service
+ is `foo` AND it contains the `version: v1` header:
+
+
+ ```
+ matches:
+ - method:
+ type: Exact
+ service: "foo"
+ headers:
+ - name: "version"
+ value "v1"
+
+
+ ```
+ properties:
+ headers:
+ description: |-
+ Headers specifies gRPC request header matchers. Multiple match values are
+ ANDed together, meaning, a request MUST match all the specified headers
+ to select the route.
+ items:
+ description: |-
+ GRPCHeaderMatch describes how to select a gRPC route by matching gRPC request
+ headers.
+ properties:
+ name:
+ description: |-
+ Name is the name of the gRPC Header to be matched.
+
+
+ If multiple entries specify equivalent header names, only the first
+ entry with an equivalent name MUST be considered for a match. Subsequent
+ entries with an equivalent header name MUST be ignored. Due to the
+ case-insensitivity of header names, "foo" and "Foo" are considered
+ equivalent.
+ maxLength: 256
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[A-Za-z0-9!#$%&'*+\-.^_\x60|~]+$
+ type: string
+ type:
+ default: Exact
+ description: Type specifies how to match against
+ the value of the header.
+ enum:
+ - Exact
+ - RegularExpression
+ type: string
+ value:
+ description: Value is the value of the gRPC Header
+ to be matched.
+ maxLength: 4096
+ minLength: 1
+ type: string
+ required:
+ - name
+ - value
+ type: object
+ maxItems: 16
+ type: array
+ x-kubernetes-list-map-keys:
+ - name
+ x-kubernetes-list-type: map
+ method:
+ description: |-
+ Method specifies a gRPC request service/method matcher. If this field is
+ not specified, all services and methods will match.
+ properties:
+ method:
+ description: |-
+ Value of the method to match against. If left empty or omitted, will
+ match all services.
+
+
+ At least one of Service and Method MUST be a non-empty string.
+ maxLength: 1024
+ type: string
+ service:
+ description: |-
+ Value of the service to match against. If left empty or omitted, will
+ match any service.
+
+
+ At least one of Service and Method MUST be a non-empty string.
+ maxLength: 1024
+ type: string
+ type:
+ default: Exact
+ description: |-
+ Type specifies how to match against the service and/or method.
+ Support: Core (Exact with service and method specified)
+
+
+ Support: Implementation-specific (Exact with method specified but no service specified)
+
+
+ Support: Implementation-specific (RegularExpression)
+ enum:
+ - Exact
+ - RegularExpression
+ type: string
+ type: object
+ x-kubernetes-validations:
+ - message: One or both of 'service' or 'method' must be
+ specified
+ rule: 'has(self.type) ? has(self.service) || has(self.method)
+ : true'
+ - message: service must only contain valid characters
+ (matching ^(?i)\.?[a-z_][a-z_0-9]*(\.[a-z_][a-z_0-9]*)*$)
+ rule: '(!has(self.type) || self.type == ''Exact'') &&
+ has(self.service) ? self.service.matches(r"""^(?i)\.?[a-z_][a-z_0-9]*(\.[a-z_][a-z_0-9]*)*$"""):
+ true'
+ - message: method must only contain valid characters (matching
+ ^[A-Za-z_][A-Za-z_0-9]*$)
+ rule: '(!has(self.type) || self.type == ''Exact'') &&
+ has(self.method) ? self.method.matches(r"""^[A-Za-z_][A-Za-z_0-9]*$"""):
+ true'
+ type: object
+ maxItems: 8
+ type: array
+ type: object
+ maxItems: 16
+ type: array
+ type: object
+ status:
+ description: Status defines the current state of GRPCRoute.
+ properties:
+ parents:
+ description: |-
+ Parents is a list of parent resources (usually Gateways) that are
+ associated with the route, and the status of the route with respect to
+ each parent. When this route attaches to a parent, the controller that
+ manages the parent must add an entry to this list when the controller
+ first sees the route and should update the entry as appropriate when the
+ route or gateway is modified.
+
+
+ Note that parent references that cannot be resolved by an implementation
+ of this API will not be added to this list. Implementations of this API
+ can only populate Route status for the Gateways/parent resources they are
+ responsible for.
+
+
+ A maximum of 32 Gateways will be represented in this list. An empty list
+ means the route has not been attached to any Gateway.
+ items:
+ description: |-
+ RouteParentStatus describes the status of a route with respect to an
+ associated Parent.
+ properties:
+ conditions:
+ description: |-
+ Conditions describes the status of the route with respect to the Gateway.
+ Note that the route's availability is also subject to the Gateway's own
+ status conditions and listener status.
+
+
+ If the Route's ParentRef specifies an existing Gateway that supports
+ Routes of this kind AND that Gateway's controller has sufficient access,
+ then that Gateway's controller MUST set the "Accepted" condition on the
+ Route, to indicate whether the route has been accepted or rejected by the
+ Gateway, and why.
+
+
+ A Route MUST be considered "Accepted" if at least one of the Route's
+ rules is implemented by the Gateway.
+
+
+ There are a number of cases where the "Accepted" condition may not be set
+ due to lack of controller visibility, that includes when:
+
+
+ * The Route refers to a non-existent parent.
+ * The Route is of a type that the controller does not support.
+ * The Route is in a namespace the controller does not have access to.
+ items:
+ description: "Condition contains details for one aspect of
+ the current state of this API Resource.\n---\nThis struct
+ is intended for direct use as an array at the field path
+ .status.conditions. For example,\n\n\n\ttype FooStatus
+ struct{\n\t // Represents the observations of a foo's
+ current state.\n\t // Known .status.conditions.type are:
+ \"Available\", \"Progressing\", and \"Degraded\"\n\t //
+ +patchMergeKey=type\n\t // +patchStrategy=merge\n\t //
+ +listType=map\n\t // +listMapKey=type\n\t Conditions
+ []metav1.Condition `json:\"conditions,omitempty\" patchStrategy:\"merge\"
+ patchMergeKey:\"type\" protobuf:\"bytes,1,rep,name=conditions\"`\n\n\n\t
+ \ // other fields\n\t}"
+ properties:
+ lastTransitionTime:
+ description: |-
+ lastTransitionTime is the last time the condition transitioned from one status to another.
+ This should be when the underlying condition changed. If that is not known, then using the time when the API field changed is acceptable.
+ format: date-time
+ type: string
+ message:
+ description: |-
+ message is a human readable message indicating details about the transition.
+ This may be an empty string.
+ maxLength: 32768
+ type: string
+ observedGeneration:
+ description: |-
+ observedGeneration represents the .metadata.generation that the condition was set based upon.
+ For instance, if .metadata.generation is currently 12, but the .status.conditions[x].observedGeneration is 9, the condition is out of date
+ with respect to the current state of the instance.
+ format: int64
+ minimum: 0
+ type: integer
+ reason:
+ description: |-
+ reason contains a programmatic identifier indicating the reason for the condition's last transition.
+ Producers of specific condition types may define expected values and meanings for this field,
+ and whether the values are considered a guaranteed API.
+ The value should be a CamelCase string.
+ This field may not be empty.
+ maxLength: 1024
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[A-Za-z]([A-Za-z0-9_,:]*[A-Za-z0-9_])?$
+ type: string
+ status:
+ description: status of the condition, one of True, False,
+ Unknown.
+ enum:
+ - "True"
+ - "False"
+ - Unknown
+ type: string
+ type:
+ description: |-
+ type of condition in CamelCase or in foo.example.com/CamelCase.
+ ---
+ Many .condition.type values are consistent across resources like Available, but because arbitrary conditions can be
+ useful (see .node.status.conditions), the ability to deconflict is important.
+ The regex it matches is (dns1123SubdomainFmt/)?(qualifiedNameFmt)
+ maxLength: 316
+ pattern: ^([a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*/)?(([A-Za-z0-9][-A-Za-z0-9_.]*)?[A-Za-z0-9])$
+ type: string
+ required:
+ - lastTransitionTime
+ - message
+ - reason
+ - status
+ - type
+ type: object
+ maxItems: 8
+ minItems: 1
+ type: array
+ x-kubernetes-list-map-keys:
+ - type
+ x-kubernetes-list-type: map
+ controllerName:
+ description: |-
+ ControllerName is a domain/path string that indicates the name of the
+ controller that wrote this status. This corresponds with the
+ controllerName field on GatewayClass.
+
+
+ Example: "example.net/gateway-controller".
+
+
+ The format of this field is DOMAIN "/" PATH, where DOMAIN and PATH are
+ valid Kubernetes names
+ (https://kubernetes.io/docs/concepts/overview/working-with-objects/names/#names).
+
+
+ Controllers MUST populate this field when writing status. Controllers should ensure that
+ entries to status populated with their ControllerName are cleaned up when they are no
+ longer necessary.
+ maxLength: 253
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*\/[A-Za-z0-9\/\-._~%!$&'()*+,;=:]+$
+ type: string
+ parentRef:
+ description: |-
+ ParentRef corresponds with a ParentRef in the spec that this
+ RouteParentStatus struct describes the status of.
+ properties:
+ group:
+ default: gateway.networking.k8s.io
+ description: |-
+ Group is the group of the referent.
+ When unspecified, "gateway.networking.k8s.io" is inferred.
+ To set the core API group (such as for a "Service" kind referent),
+ Group must be explicitly set to "" (empty string).
+
+
+ Support: Core
+ maxLength: 253
+ pattern: ^$|^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$
+ type: string
+ kind:
+ default: Gateway
+ description: |-
+ Kind is kind of the referent.
+
+
+ There are two kinds of parent resources with "Core" support:
+
+
+ * Gateway (Gateway conformance profile)
+ * Service (Mesh conformance profile, ClusterIP Services only)
+
+
+ Support for other resources is Implementation-Specific.
+ maxLength: 63
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[a-zA-Z]([-a-zA-Z0-9]*[a-zA-Z0-9])?$
+ type: string
+ name:
+ description: |-
+ Name is the name of the referent.
+
+
+ Support: Core
+ maxLength: 253
+ minLength: 1
+ type: string
+ namespace:
+ description: |-
+ Namespace is the namespace of the referent. When unspecified, this refers
+ to the local namespace of the Route.
+
+
+ Note that there are specific rules for ParentRefs which cross namespace
+ boundaries. Cross-namespace references are only valid if they are explicitly
+ allowed by something in the namespace they are referring to. For example:
+ Gateway has the AllowedRoutes field, and ReferenceGrant provides a
+ generic way to enable any other kind of cross-namespace reference.
+
+
+
+
+
+ Support: Core
+ maxLength: 63
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?$
+ type: string
+ port:
+ description: |-
+ Port is the network port this Route targets. It can be interpreted
+ differently based on the type of parent resource.
+
+
+ When the parent resource is a Gateway, this targets all listeners
+ listening on the specified port that also support this kind of Route(and
+ select this Route). It's not recommended to set `Port` unless the
+ networking behaviors specified in a Route must apply to a specific port
+ as opposed to a listener(s) whose port(s) may be changed. When both Port
+ and SectionName are specified, the name and port of the selected listener
+ must match both specified values.
+
+
+
+
+
+ Implementations MAY choose to support other parent resources.
+ Implementations supporting other types of parent resources MUST clearly
+ document how/if Port is interpreted.
+
+
+ For the purpose of status, an attachment is considered successful as
+ long as the parent resource accepts it partially. For example, Gateway
+ listeners can restrict which Routes can attach to them by Route kind,
+ namespace, or hostname. If 1 of 2 Gateway listeners accept attachment
+ from the referencing Route, the Route MUST be considered successfully
+ attached. If no Gateway listeners accept attachment from this Route,
+ the Route MUST be considered detached from the Gateway.
+
+
+ Support: Extended
+ format: int32
+ maximum: 65535
+ minimum: 1
+ type: integer
+ sectionName:
+ description: |-
+ SectionName is the name of a section within the target resource. In the
+ following resources, SectionName is interpreted as the following:
+
+
+ * Gateway: Listener name. When both Port (experimental) and SectionName
+ are specified, the name and port of the selected listener must match
+ both specified values.
+ * Service: Port name. When both Port (experimental) and SectionName
+ are specified, the name and port of the selected listener must match
+ both specified values.
+
+
+ Implementations MAY choose to support attaching Routes to other resources.
+ If that is the case, they MUST clearly document how SectionName is
+ interpreted.
+
+
+ When unspecified (empty string), this will reference the entire resource.
+ For the purpose of status, an attachment is considered successful if at
+ least one section in the parent resource accepts it. For example, Gateway
+ listeners can restrict which Routes can attach to them by Route kind,
+ namespace, or hostname. If 1 of 2 Gateway listeners accept attachment from
+ the referencing Route, the Route MUST be considered successfully
+ attached. If no Gateway listeners accept attachment from this Route, the
+ Route MUST be considered detached from the Gateway.
+
+
+ Support: Core
+ maxLength: 253
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$
+ type: string
+ required:
+ - name
+ type: object
+ required:
+ - controllerName
+ - parentRef
+ type: object
+ maxItems: 32
+ type: array
+ required:
+ - parents
+ type: object
+ type: object
+ served: true
+ storage: true
+ subresources:
+ status: {}
+ - deprecated: true
+ deprecationWarning: The v1alpha2 version of GRPCRoute has been deprecated and
+ will be removed in a future release of the API. Please upgrade to v1.
+ name: v1alpha2
+ schema:
+ openAPIV3Schema:
+ description: |-
+ GRPCRoute provides a way to route gRPC requests. This includes the capability
+ to match requests by hostname, gRPC service, gRPC method, or HTTP/2 header.
+ Filters can be used to specify additional processing steps. Backends specify
+ where matching requests will be routed.
+
+
+ GRPCRoute falls under extended support within the Gateway API. Within the
+ following specification, the word "MUST" indicates that an implementation
+ supporting GRPCRoute must conform to the indicated requirement, but an
+ implementation not supporting this route type need not follow the requirement
+ unless explicitly indicated.
+
+
+ Implementations supporting `GRPCRoute` with the `HTTPS` `ProtocolType` MUST
+ accept HTTP/2 connections without an initial upgrade from HTTP/1.1, i.e. via
+ ALPN. If the implementation does not support this, then it MUST set the
+ "Accepted" condition to "False" for the affected listener with a reason of
+ "UnsupportedProtocol". Implementations MAY also accept HTTP/2 connections
+ with an upgrade from HTTP/1.
+
+
+ Implementations supporting `GRPCRoute` with the `HTTP` `ProtocolType` MUST
+ support HTTP/2 over cleartext TCP (h2c,
+ https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc7540#section-3.1) without an initial
+ upgrade from HTTP/1.1, i.e. with prior knowledge
+ (https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc7540#section-3.4). If the implementation
+ does not support this, then it MUST set the "Accepted" condition to "False"
+ for the affected listener with a reason of "UnsupportedProtocol".
+ Implementations MAY also accept HTTP/2 connections with an upgrade from
+ HTTP/1, i.e. without prior knowledge.
+ properties:
+ apiVersion:
+ description: |-
+ APIVersion defines the versioned schema of this representation of an object.
+ Servers should convert recognized schemas to the latest internal value, and
+ may reject unrecognized values.
+ More info: https://git.k8s.io/community/contributors/devel/sig-architecture/api-conventions.md#resources
+ type: string
+ kind:
+ description: |-
+ Kind is a string value representing the REST resource this object represents.
+ Servers may infer this from the endpoint the client submits requests to.
+ Cannot be updated.
+ In CamelCase.
+ More info: https://git.k8s.io/community/contributors/devel/sig-architecture/api-conventions.md#types-kinds
+ type: string
+ metadata:
+ type: object
+ spec:
+ description: Spec defines the desired state of GRPCRoute.
+ properties:
+ hostnames:
+ description: |-
+ Hostnames defines a set of hostnames to match against the GRPC
+ Host header to select a GRPCRoute to process the request. This matches
+ the RFC 1123 definition of a hostname with 2 notable exceptions:
+
+
+ 1. IPs are not allowed.
+ 2. A hostname may be prefixed with a wildcard label (`*.`). The wildcard
+ label MUST appear by itself as the first label.
+
+
+ If a hostname is specified by both the Listener and GRPCRoute, there
+ MUST be at least one intersecting hostname for the GRPCRoute to be
+ attached to the Listener. For example:
+
+
+ * A Listener with `test.example.com` as the hostname matches GRPCRoutes
+ that have either not specified any hostnames, or have specified at
+ least one of `test.example.com` or `*.example.com`.
+ * A Listener with `*.example.com` as the hostname matches GRPCRoutes
+ that have either not specified any hostnames or have specified at least
+ one hostname that matches the Listener hostname. For example,
+ `test.example.com` and `*.example.com` would both match. On the other
+ hand, `example.com` and `test.example.net` would not match.
+
+
+ Hostnames that are prefixed with a wildcard label (`*.`) are interpreted
+ as a suffix match. That means that a match for `*.example.com` would match
+ both `test.example.com`, and `foo.test.example.com`, but not `example.com`.
+
+
+ If both the Listener and GRPCRoute have specified hostnames, any
+ GRPCRoute hostnames that do not match the Listener hostname MUST be
+ ignored. For example, if a Listener specified `*.example.com`, and the
+ GRPCRoute specified `test.example.com` and `test.example.net`,
+ `test.example.net` MUST NOT be considered for a match.
+
+
+ If both the Listener and GRPCRoute have specified hostnames, and none
+ match with the criteria above, then the GRPCRoute MUST NOT be accepted by
+ the implementation. The implementation MUST raise an 'Accepted' Condition
+ with a status of `False` in the corresponding RouteParentStatus.
+
+
+ If a Route (A) of type HTTPRoute or GRPCRoute is attached to a
+ Listener and that listener already has another Route (B) of the other
+ type attached and the intersection of the hostnames of A and B is
+ non-empty, then the implementation MUST accept exactly one of these two
+ routes, determined by the following criteria, in order:
+
+
+ * The oldest Route based on creation timestamp.
+ * The Route appearing first in alphabetical order by
+ "{namespace}/{name}".
+
+
+ The rejected Route MUST raise an 'Accepted' condition with a status of
+ 'False' in the corresponding RouteParentStatus.
+
+
+ Support: Core
+ items:
+ description: |-
+ Hostname is the fully qualified domain name of a network host. This matches
+ the RFC 1123 definition of a hostname with 2 notable exceptions:
+
+
+ 1. IPs are not allowed.
+ 2. A hostname may be prefixed with a wildcard label (`*.`). The wildcard
+ label must appear by itself as the first label.
+
+
+ Hostname can be "precise" which is a domain name without the terminating
+ dot of a network host (e.g. "foo.example.com") or "wildcard", which is a
+ domain name prefixed with a single wildcard label (e.g. `*.example.com`).
+
+
+ Note that as per RFC1035 and RFC1123, a *label* must consist of lower case
+ alphanumeric characters or '-', and must start and end with an alphanumeric
+ character. No other punctuation is allowed.
+ maxLength: 253
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^(\*\.)?[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$
+ type: string
+ maxItems: 16
+ type: array
+ parentRefs:
+ description: |+
+ ParentRefs references the resources (usually Gateways) that a Route wants
+ to be attached to. Note that the referenced parent resource needs to
+ allow this for the attachment to be complete. For Gateways, that means
+ the Gateway needs to allow attachment from Routes of this kind and
+ namespace. For Services, that means the Service must either be in the same
+ namespace for a "producer" route, or the mesh implementation must support
+ and allow "consumer" routes for the referenced Service. ReferenceGrant is
+ not applicable for governing ParentRefs to Services - it is not possible to
+ create a "producer" route for a Service in a different namespace from the
+ Route.
+
+
+ There are two kinds of parent resources with "Core" support:
+
+
+ * Gateway (Gateway conformance profile)
+ * Service (Mesh conformance profile, ClusterIP Services only)
+
+
+ This API may be extended in the future to support additional kinds of parent
+ resources.
+
+
+ ParentRefs must be _distinct_. This means either that:
+
+
+ * They select different objects. If this is the case, then parentRef
+ entries are distinct. In terms of fields, this means that the
+ multi-part key defined by `group`, `kind`, `namespace`, and `name` must
+ be unique across all parentRef entries in the Route.
+ * They do not select different objects, but for each optional field used,
+ each ParentRef that selects the same object must set the same set of
+ optional fields to different values. If one ParentRef sets a
+ combination of optional fields, all must set the same combination.
+
+
+ Some examples:
+
+
+ * If one ParentRef sets `sectionName`, all ParentRefs referencing the
+ same object must also set `sectionName`.
+ * If one ParentRef sets `port`, all ParentRefs referencing the same
+ object must also set `port`.
+ * If one ParentRef sets `sectionName` and `port`, all ParentRefs
+ referencing the same object must also set `sectionName` and `port`.
+
+
+ It is possible to separately reference multiple distinct objects that may
+ be collapsed by an implementation. For example, some implementations may
+ choose to merge compatible Gateway Listeners together. If that is the
+ case, the list of routes attached to those resources should also be
+ merged.
+
+
+ Note that for ParentRefs that cross namespace boundaries, there are specific
+ rules. Cross-namespace references are only valid if they are explicitly
+ allowed by something in the namespace they are referring to. For example,
+ Gateway has the AllowedRoutes field, and ReferenceGrant provides a
+ generic way to enable other kinds of cross-namespace reference.
+
+
+
+
+
+
+
+
+ items:
+ description: |-
+ ParentReference identifies an API object (usually a Gateway) that can be considered
+ a parent of this resource (usually a route). There are two kinds of parent resources
+ with "Core" support:
+
+
+ * Gateway (Gateway conformance profile)
+ * Service (Mesh conformance profile, ClusterIP Services only)
+
+
+ This API may be extended in the future to support additional kinds of parent
+ resources.
+
+
+ The API object must be valid in the cluster; the Group and Kind must
+ be registered in the cluster for this reference to be valid.
+ properties:
+ group:
+ default: gateway.networking.k8s.io
+ description: |-
+ Group is the group of the referent.
+ When unspecified, "gateway.networking.k8s.io" is inferred.
+ To set the core API group (such as for a "Service" kind referent),
+ Group must be explicitly set to "" (empty string).
+
+
+ Support: Core
+ maxLength: 253
+ pattern: ^$|^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$
+ type: string
+ kind:
+ default: Gateway
+ description: |-
+ Kind is kind of the referent.
+
+
+ There are two kinds of parent resources with "Core" support:
+
+
+ * Gateway (Gateway conformance profile)
+ * Service (Mesh conformance profile, ClusterIP Services only)
+
+
+ Support for other resources is Implementation-Specific.
+ maxLength: 63
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[a-zA-Z]([-a-zA-Z0-9]*[a-zA-Z0-9])?$
+ type: string
+ name:
+ description: |-
+ Name is the name of the referent.
+
+
+ Support: Core
+ maxLength: 253
+ minLength: 1
+ type: string
+ namespace:
+ description: |-
+ Namespace is the namespace of the referent. When unspecified, this refers
+ to the local namespace of the Route.
+
+
+ Note that there are specific rules for ParentRefs which cross namespace
+ boundaries. Cross-namespace references are only valid if they are explicitly
+ allowed by something in the namespace they are referring to. For example:
+ Gateway has the AllowedRoutes field, and ReferenceGrant provides a
+ generic way to enable any other kind of cross-namespace reference.
+
+
+
+
+
+ Support: Core
+ maxLength: 63
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?$
+ type: string
+ port:
+ description: |-
+ Port is the network port this Route targets. It can be interpreted
+ differently based on the type of parent resource.
+
+
+ When the parent resource is a Gateway, this targets all listeners
+ listening on the specified port that also support this kind of Route(and
+ select this Route). It's not recommended to set `Port` unless the
+ networking behaviors specified in a Route must apply to a specific port
+ as opposed to a listener(s) whose port(s) may be changed. When both Port
+ and SectionName are specified, the name and port of the selected listener
+ must match both specified values.
+
+
+
+
+
+ Implementations MAY choose to support other parent resources.
+ Implementations supporting other types of parent resources MUST clearly
+ document how/if Port is interpreted.
+
+
+ For the purpose of status, an attachment is considered successful as
+ long as the parent resource accepts it partially. For example, Gateway
+ listeners can restrict which Routes can attach to them by Route kind,
+ namespace, or hostname. If 1 of 2 Gateway listeners accept attachment
+ from the referencing Route, the Route MUST be considered successfully
+ attached. If no Gateway listeners accept attachment from this Route,
+ the Route MUST be considered detached from the Gateway.
+
+
+ Support: Extended
+ format: int32
+ maximum: 65535
+ minimum: 1
+ type: integer
+ sectionName:
+ description: |-
+ SectionName is the name of a section within the target resource. In the
+ following resources, SectionName is interpreted as the following:
+
+
+ * Gateway: Listener name. When both Port (experimental) and SectionName
+ are specified, the name and port of the selected listener must match
+ both specified values.
+ * Service: Port name. When both Port (experimental) and SectionName
+ are specified, the name and port of the selected listener must match
+ both specified values.
+
+
+ Implementations MAY choose to support attaching Routes to other resources.
+ If that is the case, they MUST clearly document how SectionName is
+ interpreted.
+
+
+ When unspecified (empty string), this will reference the entire resource.
+ For the purpose of status, an attachment is considered successful if at
+ least one section in the parent resource accepts it. For example, Gateway
+ listeners can restrict which Routes can attach to them by Route kind,
+ namespace, or hostname. If 1 of 2 Gateway listeners accept attachment from
+ the referencing Route, the Route MUST be considered successfully
+ attached. If no Gateway listeners accept attachment from this Route, the
+ Route MUST be considered detached from the Gateway.
+
+
+ Support: Core
+ maxLength: 253
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$
+ type: string
+ required:
+ - name
+ type: object
+ maxItems: 32
+ type: array
+ x-kubernetes-validations:
+ - message: sectionName must be specified when parentRefs includes
+ 2 or more references to the same parent
+ rule: 'self.all(p1, self.all(p2, p1.group == p2.group && p1.kind
+ == p2.kind && p1.name == p2.name && (((!has(p1.__namespace__)
+ || p1.__namespace__ == '''') && (!has(p2.__namespace__) || p2.__namespace__
+ == '''')) || (has(p1.__namespace__) && has(p2.__namespace__) &&
+ p1.__namespace__ == p2.__namespace__ )) ? ((!has(p1.sectionName)
+ || p1.sectionName == '''') == (!has(p2.sectionName) || p2.sectionName
+ == '''')) : true))'
+ - message: sectionName must be unique when parentRefs includes 2 or
+ more references to the same parent
+ rule: self.all(p1, self.exists_one(p2, p1.group == p2.group && p1.kind
+ == p2.kind && p1.name == p2.name && (((!has(p1.__namespace__)
+ || p1.__namespace__ == '') && (!has(p2.__namespace__) || p2.__namespace__
+ == '')) || (has(p1.__namespace__) && has(p2.__namespace__) &&
+ p1.__namespace__ == p2.__namespace__ )) && (((!has(p1.sectionName)
+ || p1.sectionName == '') && (!has(p2.sectionName) || p2.sectionName
+ == '')) || (has(p1.sectionName) && has(p2.sectionName) && p1.sectionName
+ == p2.sectionName))))
+ rules:
+ description: Rules are a list of GRPC matchers, filters and actions.
+ items:
+ description: |-
+ GRPCRouteRule defines the semantics for matching a gRPC request based on
+ conditions (matches), processing it (filters), and forwarding the request to
+ an API object (backendRefs).
+ properties:
+ backendRefs:
+ description: |-
+ BackendRefs defines the backend(s) where matching requests should be
+ sent.
+
+
+ Failure behavior here depends on how many BackendRefs are specified and
+ how many are invalid.
+
+
+ If *all* entries in BackendRefs are invalid, and there are also no filters
+ specified in this route rule, *all* traffic which matches this rule MUST
+ receive an `UNAVAILABLE` status.
+
+
+ See the GRPCBackendRef definition for the rules about what makes a single
+ GRPCBackendRef invalid.
+
+
+ When a GRPCBackendRef is invalid, `UNAVAILABLE` statuses MUST be returned for
+ requests that would have otherwise been routed to an invalid backend. If
+ multiple backends are specified, and some are invalid, the proportion of
+ requests that would otherwise have been routed to an invalid backend
+ MUST receive an `UNAVAILABLE` status.
+
+
+ For example, if two backends are specified with equal weights, and one is
+ invalid, 50 percent of traffic MUST receive an `UNAVAILABLE` status.
+ Implementations may choose how that 50 percent is determined.
+
+
+ Support: Core for Kubernetes Service
+
+
+ Support: Implementation-specific for any other resource
+
+
+ Support for weight: Core
+ items:
+ description: |-
+ GRPCBackendRef defines how a GRPCRoute forwards a gRPC request.
+
+
+ Note that when a namespace different than the local namespace is specified, a
+ ReferenceGrant object is required in the referent namespace to allow that
+ namespace's owner to accept the reference. See the ReferenceGrant
+ documentation for details.
+
+
+
+
+
+ When the BackendRef points to a Kubernetes Service, implementations SHOULD
+ honor the appProtocol field if it is set for the target Service Port.
+
+
+ Implementations supporting appProtocol SHOULD recognize the Kubernetes
+ Standard Application Protocols defined in KEP-3726.
+
+
+ If a Service appProtocol isn't specified, an implementation MAY infer the
+ backend protocol through its own means. Implementations MAY infer the
+ protocol from the Route type referring to the backend Service.
+
+
+ If a Route is not able to send traffic to the backend using the specified
+ protocol then the backend is considered invalid. Implementations MUST set the
+ "ResolvedRefs" condition to "False" with the "UnsupportedProtocol" reason.
+
+
+
+ properties:
+ filters:
+ description: |-
+ Filters defined at this level MUST be executed if and only if the
+ request is being forwarded to the backend defined here.
+
+
+ Support: Implementation-specific (For broader support of filters, use the
+ Filters field in GRPCRouteRule.)
+ items:
+ description: |-
+ GRPCRouteFilter defines processing steps that must be completed during the
+ request or response lifecycle. GRPCRouteFilters are meant as an extension
+ point to express processing that may be done in Gateway implementations. Some
+ examples include request or response modification, implementing
+ authentication strategies, rate-limiting, and traffic shaping. API
+ guarantee/conformance is defined based on the type of the filter.
+ properties:
+ extensionRef:
+ description: |-
+ ExtensionRef is an optional, implementation-specific extension to the
+ "filter" behavior. For example, resource "myroutefilter" in group
+ "networking.example.net"). ExtensionRef MUST NOT be used for core and
+ extended filters.
+
+
+ Support: Implementation-specific
+
+
+ This filter can be used multiple times within the same rule.
+ properties:
+ group:
+ description: |-
+ Group is the group of the referent. For example, "gateway.networking.k8s.io".
+ When unspecified or empty string, core API group is inferred.
+ maxLength: 253
+ pattern: ^$|^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$
+ type: string
+ kind:
+ description: Kind is kind of the referent. For
+ example "HTTPRoute" or "Service".
+ maxLength: 63
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[a-zA-Z]([-a-zA-Z0-9]*[a-zA-Z0-9])?$
+ type: string
+ name:
+ description: Name is the name of the referent.
+ maxLength: 253
+ minLength: 1
+ type: string
+ required:
+ - group
+ - kind
+ - name
+ type: object
+ requestHeaderModifier:
+ description: |-
+ RequestHeaderModifier defines a schema for a filter that modifies request
+ headers.
+
+
+ Support: Core
+ properties:
+ add:
+ description: |-
+ Add adds the given header(s) (name, value) to the request
+ before the action. It appends to any existing values associated
+ with the header name.
+
+
+ Input:
+ GET /foo HTTP/1.1
+ my-header: foo
+
+
+ Config:
+ add:
+ - name: "my-header"
+ value: "bar,baz"
+
+
+ Output:
+ GET /foo HTTP/1.1
+ my-header: foo,bar,baz
+ items:
+ description: HTTPHeader represents an HTTP
+ Header name and value as defined by RFC
+ 7230.
+ properties:
+ name:
+ description: |-
+ Name is the name of the HTTP Header to be matched. Name matching MUST be
+ case insensitive. (See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc7230#section-3.2).
+
+
+ If multiple entries specify equivalent header names, the first entry with
+ an equivalent name MUST be considered for a match. Subsequent entries
+ with an equivalent header name MUST be ignored. Due to the
+ case-insensitivity of header names, "foo" and "Foo" are considered
+ equivalent.
+ maxLength: 256
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[A-Za-z0-9!#$%&'*+\-.^_\x60|~]+$
+ type: string
+ value:
+ description: Value is the value of HTTP
+ Header to be matched.
+ maxLength: 4096
+ minLength: 1
+ type: string
+ required:
+ - name
+ - value
+ type: object
+ maxItems: 16
+ type: array
+ x-kubernetes-list-map-keys:
+ - name
+ x-kubernetes-list-type: map
+ remove:
+ description: |-
+ Remove the given header(s) from the HTTP request before the action. The
+ value of Remove is a list of HTTP header names. Note that the header
+ names are case-insensitive (see
+ https://datatracker.ietf.org/doc/html/rfc2616#section-4.2).
+
+
+ Input:
+ GET /foo HTTP/1.1
+ my-header1: foo
+ my-header2: bar
+ my-header3: baz
+
+
+ Config:
+ remove: ["my-header1", "my-header3"]
+
+
+ Output:
+ GET /foo HTTP/1.1
+ my-header2: bar
+ items:
+ type: string
+ maxItems: 16
+ type: array
+ x-kubernetes-list-type: set
+ set:
+ description: |-
+ Set overwrites the request with the given header (name, value)
+ before the action.
+
+
+ Input:
+ GET /foo HTTP/1.1
+ my-header: foo
+
+
+ Config:
+ set:
+ - name: "my-header"
+ value: "bar"
+
+
+ Output:
+ GET /foo HTTP/1.1
+ my-header: bar
+ items:
+ description: HTTPHeader represents an HTTP
+ Header name and value as defined by RFC
+ 7230.
+ properties:
+ name:
+ description: |-
+ Name is the name of the HTTP Header to be matched. Name matching MUST be
+ case insensitive. (See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc7230#section-3.2).
+
+
+ If multiple entries specify equivalent header names, the first entry with
+ an equivalent name MUST be considered for a match. Subsequent entries
+ with an equivalent header name MUST be ignored. Due to the
+ case-insensitivity of header names, "foo" and "Foo" are considered
+ equivalent.
+ maxLength: 256
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[A-Za-z0-9!#$%&'*+\-.^_\x60|~]+$
+ type: string
+ value:
+ description: Value is the value of HTTP
+ Header to be matched.
+ maxLength: 4096
+ minLength: 1
+ type: string
+ required:
+ - name
+ - value
+ type: object
+ maxItems: 16
+ type: array
+ x-kubernetes-list-map-keys:
+ - name
+ x-kubernetes-list-type: map
+ type: object
+ requestMirror:
+ description: |-
+ RequestMirror defines a schema for a filter that mirrors requests.
+ Requests are sent to the specified destination, but responses from
+ that destination are ignored.
+
+
+ This filter can be used multiple times within the same rule. Note that
+ not all implementations will be able to support mirroring to multiple
+ backends.
+
+
+ Support: Extended
+ properties:
+ backendRef:
+ description: |-
+ BackendRef references a resource where mirrored requests are sent.
+
+
+ Mirrored requests must be sent only to a single destination endpoint
+ within this BackendRef, irrespective of how many endpoints are present
+ within this BackendRef.
+
+
+ If the referent cannot be found, this BackendRef is invalid and must be
+ dropped from the Gateway. The controller must ensure the "ResolvedRefs"
+ condition on the Route status is set to `status: False` and not configure
+ this backend in the underlying implementation.
+
+
+ If there is a cross-namespace reference to an *existing* object
+ that is not allowed by a ReferenceGrant, the controller must ensure the
+ "ResolvedRefs" condition on the Route is set to `status: False`,
+ with the "RefNotPermitted" reason and not configure this backend in the
+ underlying implementation.
+
+
+ In either error case, the Message of the `ResolvedRefs` Condition
+ should be used to provide more detail about the problem.
+
+
+ Support: Extended for Kubernetes Service
+
+
+ Support: Implementation-specific for any other resource
+ properties:
+ group:
+ default: ""
+ description: |-
+ Group is the group of the referent. For example, "gateway.networking.k8s.io".
+ When unspecified or empty string, core API group is inferred.
+ maxLength: 253
+ pattern: ^$|^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$
+ type: string
+ kind:
+ default: Service
+ description: |-
+ Kind is the Kubernetes resource kind of the referent. For example
+ "Service".
+
+
+ Defaults to "Service" when not specified.
+
+
+ ExternalName services can refer to CNAME DNS records that may live
+ outside of the cluster and as such are difficult to reason about in
+ terms of conformance. They also may not be safe to forward to (see
+ CVE-2021-25740 for more information). Implementations SHOULD NOT
+ support ExternalName Services.
+
+
+ Support: Core (Services with a type other than ExternalName)
+
+
+ Support: Implementation-specific (Services with type ExternalName)
+ maxLength: 63
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[a-zA-Z]([-a-zA-Z0-9]*[a-zA-Z0-9])?$
+ type: string
+ name:
+ description: Name is the name of the referent.
+ maxLength: 253
+ minLength: 1
+ type: string
+ namespace:
+ description: |-
+ Namespace is the namespace of the backend. When unspecified, the local
+ namespace is inferred.
+
+
+ Note that when a namespace different than the local namespace is specified,
+ a ReferenceGrant object is required in the referent namespace to allow that
+ namespace's owner to accept the reference. See the ReferenceGrant
+ documentation for details.
+
+
+ Support: Core
+ maxLength: 63
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?$
+ type: string
+ port:
+ description: |-
+ Port specifies the destination port number to use for this resource.
+ Port is required when the referent is a Kubernetes Service. In this
+ case, the port number is the service port number, not the target port.
+ For other resources, destination port might be derived from the referent
+ resource or this field.
+ format: int32
+ maximum: 65535
+ minimum: 1
+ type: integer
+ required:
+ - name
+ type: object
+ x-kubernetes-validations:
+ - message: Must have port for Service reference
+ rule: '(size(self.group) == 0 && self.kind
+ == ''Service'') ? has(self.port) : true'
+ required:
+ - backendRef
+ type: object
+ responseHeaderModifier:
+ description: |-
+ ResponseHeaderModifier defines a schema for a filter that modifies response
+ headers.
+
+
+ Support: Extended
+ properties:
+ add:
+ description: |-
+ Add adds the given header(s) (name, value) to the request
+ before the action. It appends to any existing values associated
+ with the header name.
+
+
+ Input:
+ GET /foo HTTP/1.1
+ my-header: foo
+
+
+ Config:
+ add:
+ - name: "my-header"
+ value: "bar,baz"
+
+
+ Output:
+ GET /foo HTTP/1.1
+ my-header: foo,bar,baz
+ items:
+ description: HTTPHeader represents an HTTP
+ Header name and value as defined by RFC
+ 7230.
+ properties:
+ name:
+ description: |-
+ Name is the name of the HTTP Header to be matched. Name matching MUST be
+ case insensitive. (See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc7230#section-3.2).
+
+
+ If multiple entries specify equivalent header names, the first entry with
+ an equivalent name MUST be considered for a match. Subsequent entries
+ with an equivalent header name MUST be ignored. Due to the
+ case-insensitivity of header names, "foo" and "Foo" are considered
+ equivalent.
+ maxLength: 256
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[A-Za-z0-9!#$%&'*+\-.^_\x60|~]+$
+ type: string
+ value:
+ description: Value is the value of HTTP
+ Header to be matched.
+ maxLength: 4096
+ minLength: 1
+ type: string
+ required:
+ - name
+ - value
+ type: object
+ maxItems: 16
+ type: array
+ x-kubernetes-list-map-keys:
+ - name
+ x-kubernetes-list-type: map
+ remove:
+ description: |-
+ Remove the given header(s) from the HTTP request before the action. The
+ value of Remove is a list of HTTP header names. Note that the header
+ names are case-insensitive (see
+ https://datatracker.ietf.org/doc/html/rfc2616#section-4.2).
+
+
+ Input:
+ GET /foo HTTP/1.1
+ my-header1: foo
+ my-header2: bar
+ my-header3: baz
+
+
+ Config:
+ remove: ["my-header1", "my-header3"]
+
+
+ Output:
+ GET /foo HTTP/1.1
+ my-header2: bar
+ items:
+ type: string
+ maxItems: 16
+ type: array
+ x-kubernetes-list-type: set
+ set:
+ description: |-
+ Set overwrites the request with the given header (name, value)
+ before the action.
+
+
+ Input:
+ GET /foo HTTP/1.1
+ my-header: foo
+
+
+ Config:
+ set:
+ - name: "my-header"
+ value: "bar"
+
+
+ Output:
+ GET /foo HTTP/1.1
+ my-header: bar
+ items:
+ description: HTTPHeader represents an HTTP
+ Header name and value as defined by RFC
+ 7230.
+ properties:
+ name:
+ description: |-
+ Name is the name of the HTTP Header to be matched. Name matching MUST be
+ case insensitive. (See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc7230#section-3.2).
+
+
+ If multiple entries specify equivalent header names, the first entry with
+ an equivalent name MUST be considered for a match. Subsequent entries
+ with an equivalent header name MUST be ignored. Due to the
+ case-insensitivity of header names, "foo" and "Foo" are considered
+ equivalent.
+ maxLength: 256
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[A-Za-z0-9!#$%&'*+\-.^_\x60|~]+$
+ type: string
+ value:
+ description: Value is the value of HTTP
+ Header to be matched.
+ maxLength: 4096
+ minLength: 1
+ type: string
+ required:
+ - name
+ - value
+ type: object
+ maxItems: 16
+ type: array
+ x-kubernetes-list-map-keys:
+ - name
+ x-kubernetes-list-type: map
+ type: object
+ type:
+ description: |+
+ Type identifies the type of filter to apply. As with other API fields,
+ types are classified into three conformance levels:
+
+
+ - Core: Filter types and their corresponding configuration defined by
+ "Support: Core" in this package, e.g. "RequestHeaderModifier". All
+ implementations supporting GRPCRoute MUST support core filters.
+
+
+ - Extended: Filter types and their corresponding configuration defined by
+ "Support: Extended" in this package, e.g. "RequestMirror". Implementers
+ are encouraged to support extended filters.
+
+
+ - Implementation-specific: Filters that are defined and supported by specific vendors.
+ In the future, filters showing convergence in behavior across multiple
+ implementations will be considered for inclusion in extended or core
+ conformance levels. Filter-specific configuration for such filters
+ is specified using the ExtensionRef field. `Type` MUST be set to
+ "ExtensionRef" for custom filters.
+
+
+ Implementers are encouraged to define custom implementation types to
+ extend the core API with implementation-specific behavior.
+
+
+ If a reference to a custom filter type cannot be resolved, the filter
+ MUST NOT be skipped. Instead, requests that would have been processed by
+ that filter MUST receive a HTTP error response.
+
+
+ enum:
+ - ResponseHeaderModifier
+ - RequestHeaderModifier
+ - RequestMirror
+ - ExtensionRef
+ type: string
+ required:
+ - type
+ type: object
+ x-kubernetes-validations:
+ - message: filter.requestHeaderModifier must be nil
+ if the filter.type is not RequestHeaderModifier
+ rule: '!(has(self.requestHeaderModifier) && self.type
+ != ''RequestHeaderModifier'')'
+ - message: filter.requestHeaderModifier must be specified
+ for RequestHeaderModifier filter.type
+ rule: '!(!has(self.requestHeaderModifier) && self.type
+ == ''RequestHeaderModifier'')'
+ - message: filter.responseHeaderModifier must be nil
+ if the filter.type is not ResponseHeaderModifier
+ rule: '!(has(self.responseHeaderModifier) && self.type
+ != ''ResponseHeaderModifier'')'
+ - message: filter.responseHeaderModifier must be specified
+ for ResponseHeaderModifier filter.type
+ rule: '!(!has(self.responseHeaderModifier) && self.type
+ == ''ResponseHeaderModifier'')'
+ - message: filter.requestMirror must be nil if the filter.type
+ is not RequestMirror
+ rule: '!(has(self.requestMirror) && self.type != ''RequestMirror'')'
+ - message: filter.requestMirror must be specified for
+ RequestMirror filter.type
+ rule: '!(!has(self.requestMirror) && self.type ==
+ ''RequestMirror'')'
+ - message: filter.extensionRef must be nil if the filter.type
+ is not ExtensionRef
+ rule: '!(has(self.extensionRef) && self.type != ''ExtensionRef'')'
+ - message: filter.extensionRef must be specified for
+ ExtensionRef filter.type
+ rule: '!(!has(self.extensionRef) && self.type == ''ExtensionRef'')'
+ maxItems: 16
+ type: array
+ x-kubernetes-validations:
+ - message: RequestHeaderModifier filter cannot be repeated
+ rule: self.filter(f, f.type == 'RequestHeaderModifier').size()
+ <= 1
+ - message: ResponseHeaderModifier filter cannot be repeated
+ rule: self.filter(f, f.type == 'ResponseHeaderModifier').size()
+ <= 1
+ group:
+ default: ""
+ description: |-
+ Group is the group of the referent. For example, "gateway.networking.k8s.io".
+ When unspecified or empty string, core API group is inferred.
+ maxLength: 253
+ pattern: ^$|^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$
+ type: string
+ kind:
+ default: Service
+ description: |-
+ Kind is the Kubernetes resource kind of the referent. For example
+ "Service".
+
+
+ Defaults to "Service" when not specified.
+
+
+ ExternalName services can refer to CNAME DNS records that may live
+ outside of the cluster and as such are difficult to reason about in
+ terms of conformance. They also may not be safe to forward to (see
+ CVE-2021-25740 for more information). Implementations SHOULD NOT
+ support ExternalName Services.
+
+
+ Support: Core (Services with a type other than ExternalName)
+
+
+ Support: Implementation-specific (Services with type ExternalName)
+ maxLength: 63
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[a-zA-Z]([-a-zA-Z0-9]*[a-zA-Z0-9])?$
+ type: string
+ name:
+ description: Name is the name of the referent.
+ maxLength: 253
+ minLength: 1
+ type: string
+ namespace:
+ description: |-
+ Namespace is the namespace of the backend. When unspecified, the local
+ namespace is inferred.
+
+
+ Note that when a namespace different than the local namespace is specified,
+ a ReferenceGrant object is required in the referent namespace to allow that
+ namespace's owner to accept the reference. See the ReferenceGrant
+ documentation for details.
+
+
+ Support: Core
+ maxLength: 63
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?$
+ type: string
+ port:
+ description: |-
+ Port specifies the destination port number to use for this resource.
+ Port is required when the referent is a Kubernetes Service. In this
+ case, the port number is the service port number, not the target port.
+ For other resources, destination port might be derived from the referent
+ resource or this field.
+ format: int32
+ maximum: 65535
+ minimum: 1
+ type: integer
+ weight:
+ default: 1
+ description: |-
+ Weight specifies the proportion of requests forwarded to the referenced
+ backend. This is computed as weight/(sum of all weights in this
+ BackendRefs list). For non-zero values, there may be some epsilon from
+ the exact proportion defined here depending on the precision an
+ implementation supports. Weight is not a percentage and the sum of
+ weights does not need to equal 100.
+
+
+ If only one backend is specified and it has a weight greater than 0, 100%
+ of the traffic is forwarded to that backend. If weight is set to 0, no
+ traffic should be forwarded for this entry. If unspecified, weight
+ defaults to 1.
+
+
+ Support for this field varies based on the context where used.
+ format: int32
+ maximum: 1000000
+ minimum: 0
+ type: integer
+ required:
+ - name
+ type: object
+ x-kubernetes-validations:
+ - message: Must have port for Service reference
+ rule: '(size(self.group) == 0 && self.kind == ''Service'')
+ ? has(self.port) : true'
+ maxItems: 16
+ type: array
+ filters:
+ description: |-
+ Filters define the filters that are applied to requests that match
+ this rule.
+
+
+ The effects of ordering of multiple behaviors are currently unspecified.
+ This can change in the future based on feedback during the alpha stage.
+
+
+ Conformance-levels at this level are defined based on the type of filter:
+
+
+ - ALL core filters MUST be supported by all implementations that support
+ GRPCRoute.
+ - Implementers are encouraged to support extended filters.
+ - Implementation-specific custom filters have no API guarantees across
+ implementations.
+
+
+ Specifying the same filter multiple times is not supported unless explicitly
+ indicated in the filter.
+
+
+ If an implementation can not support a combination of filters, it must clearly
+ document that limitation. In cases where incompatible or unsupported
+ filters are specified and cause the `Accepted` condition to be set to status
+ `False`, implementations may use the `IncompatibleFilters` reason to specify
+ this configuration error.
+
+
+ Support: Core
+ items:
+ description: |-
+ GRPCRouteFilter defines processing steps that must be completed during the
+ request or response lifecycle. GRPCRouteFilters are meant as an extension
+ point to express processing that may be done in Gateway implementations. Some
+ examples include request or response modification, implementing
+ authentication strategies, rate-limiting, and traffic shaping. API
+ guarantee/conformance is defined based on the type of the filter.
+ properties:
+ extensionRef:
+ description: |-
+ ExtensionRef is an optional, implementation-specific extension to the
+ "filter" behavior. For example, resource "myroutefilter" in group
+ "networking.example.net"). ExtensionRef MUST NOT be used for core and
+ extended filters.
+
+
+ Support: Implementation-specific
+
+
+ This filter can be used multiple times within the same rule.
+ properties:
+ group:
+ description: |-
+ Group is the group of the referent. For example, "gateway.networking.k8s.io".
+ When unspecified or empty string, core API group is inferred.
+ maxLength: 253
+ pattern: ^$|^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$
+ type: string
+ kind:
+ description: Kind is kind of the referent. For example
+ "HTTPRoute" or "Service".
+ maxLength: 63
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[a-zA-Z]([-a-zA-Z0-9]*[a-zA-Z0-9])?$
+ type: string
+ name:
+ description: Name is the name of the referent.
+ maxLength: 253
+ minLength: 1
+ type: string
+ required:
+ - group
+ - kind
+ - name
+ type: object
+ requestHeaderModifier:
+ description: |-
+ RequestHeaderModifier defines a schema for a filter that modifies request
+ headers.
+
+
+ Support: Core
+ properties:
+ add:
+ description: |-
+ Add adds the given header(s) (name, value) to the request
+ before the action. It appends to any existing values associated
+ with the header name.
+
+
+ Input:
+ GET /foo HTTP/1.1
+ my-header: foo
+
+
+ Config:
+ add:
+ - name: "my-header"
+ value: "bar,baz"
+
+
+ Output:
+ GET /foo HTTP/1.1
+ my-header: foo,bar,baz
+ items:
+ description: HTTPHeader represents an HTTP Header
+ name and value as defined by RFC 7230.
+ properties:
+ name:
+ description: |-
+ Name is the name of the HTTP Header to be matched. Name matching MUST be
+ case insensitive. (See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc7230#section-3.2).
+
+
+ If multiple entries specify equivalent header names, the first entry with
+ an equivalent name MUST be considered for a match. Subsequent entries
+ with an equivalent header name MUST be ignored. Due to the
+ case-insensitivity of header names, "foo" and "Foo" are considered
+ equivalent.
+ maxLength: 256
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[A-Za-z0-9!#$%&'*+\-.^_\x60|~]+$
+ type: string
+ value:
+ description: Value is the value of HTTP Header
+ to be matched.
+ maxLength: 4096
+ minLength: 1
+ type: string
+ required:
+ - name
+ - value
+ type: object
+ maxItems: 16
+ type: array
+ x-kubernetes-list-map-keys:
+ - name
+ x-kubernetes-list-type: map
+ remove:
+ description: |-
+ Remove the given header(s) from the HTTP request before the action. The
+ value of Remove is a list of HTTP header names. Note that the header
+ names are case-insensitive (see
+ https://datatracker.ietf.org/doc/html/rfc2616#section-4.2).
+
+
+ Input:
+ GET /foo HTTP/1.1
+ my-header1: foo
+ my-header2: bar
+ my-header3: baz
+
+
+ Config:
+ remove: ["my-header1", "my-header3"]
+
+
+ Output:
+ GET /foo HTTP/1.1
+ my-header2: bar
+ items:
+ type: string
+ maxItems: 16
+ type: array
+ x-kubernetes-list-type: set
+ set:
+ description: |-
+ Set overwrites the request with the given header (name, value)
+ before the action.
+
+
+ Input:
+ GET /foo HTTP/1.1
+ my-header: foo
+
+
+ Config:
+ set:
+ - name: "my-header"
+ value: "bar"
+
+
+ Output:
+ GET /foo HTTP/1.1
+ my-header: bar
+ items:
+ description: HTTPHeader represents an HTTP Header
+ name and value as defined by RFC 7230.
+ properties:
+ name:
+ description: |-
+ Name is the name of the HTTP Header to be matched. Name matching MUST be
+ case insensitive. (See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc7230#section-3.2).
+
+
+ If multiple entries specify equivalent header names, the first entry with
+ an equivalent name MUST be considered for a match. Subsequent entries
+ with an equivalent header name MUST be ignored. Due to the
+ case-insensitivity of header names, "foo" and "Foo" are considered
+ equivalent.
+ maxLength: 256
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[A-Za-z0-9!#$%&'*+\-.^_\x60|~]+$
+ type: string
+ value:
+ description: Value is the value of HTTP Header
+ to be matched.
+ maxLength: 4096
+ minLength: 1
+ type: string
+ required:
+ - name
+ - value
+ type: object
+ maxItems: 16
+ type: array
+ x-kubernetes-list-map-keys:
+ - name
+ x-kubernetes-list-type: map
+ type: object
+ requestMirror:
+ description: |-
+ RequestMirror defines a schema for a filter that mirrors requests.
+ Requests are sent to the specified destination, but responses from
+ that destination are ignored.
+
+
+ This filter can be used multiple times within the same rule. Note that
+ not all implementations will be able to support mirroring to multiple
+ backends.
+
+
+ Support: Extended
+ properties:
+ backendRef:
+ description: |-
+ BackendRef references a resource where mirrored requests are sent.
+
+
+ Mirrored requests must be sent only to a single destination endpoint
+ within this BackendRef, irrespective of how many endpoints are present
+ within this BackendRef.
+
+
+ If the referent cannot be found, this BackendRef is invalid and must be
+ dropped from the Gateway. The controller must ensure the "ResolvedRefs"
+ condition on the Route status is set to `status: False` and not configure
+ this backend in the underlying implementation.
+
+
+ If there is a cross-namespace reference to an *existing* object
+ that is not allowed by a ReferenceGrant, the controller must ensure the
+ "ResolvedRefs" condition on the Route is set to `status: False`,
+ with the "RefNotPermitted" reason and not configure this backend in the
+ underlying implementation.
+
+
+ In either error case, the Message of the `ResolvedRefs` Condition
+ should be used to provide more detail about the problem.
+
+
+ Support: Extended for Kubernetes Service
+
+
+ Support: Implementation-specific for any other resource
+ properties:
+ group:
+ default: ""
+ description: |-
+ Group is the group of the referent. For example, "gateway.networking.k8s.io".
+ When unspecified or empty string, core API group is inferred.
+ maxLength: 253
+ pattern: ^$|^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$
+ type: string
+ kind:
+ default: Service
+ description: |-
+ Kind is the Kubernetes resource kind of the referent. For example
+ "Service".
+
+
+ Defaults to "Service" when not specified.
+
+
+ ExternalName services can refer to CNAME DNS records that may live
+ outside of the cluster and as such are difficult to reason about in
+ terms of conformance. They also may not be safe to forward to (see
+ CVE-2021-25740 for more information). Implementations SHOULD NOT
+ support ExternalName Services.
+
+
+ Support: Core (Services with a type other than ExternalName)
+
+
+ Support: Implementation-specific (Services with type ExternalName)
+ maxLength: 63
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[a-zA-Z]([-a-zA-Z0-9]*[a-zA-Z0-9])?$
+ type: string
+ name:
+ description: Name is the name of the referent.
+ maxLength: 253
+ minLength: 1
+ type: string
+ namespace:
+ description: |-
+ Namespace is the namespace of the backend. When unspecified, the local
+ namespace is inferred.
+
+
+ Note that when a namespace different than the local namespace is specified,
+ a ReferenceGrant object is required in the referent namespace to allow that
+ namespace's owner to accept the reference. See the ReferenceGrant
+ documentation for details.
+
+
+ Support: Core
+ maxLength: 63
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?$
+ type: string
+ port:
+ description: |-
+ Port specifies the destination port number to use for this resource.
+ Port is required when the referent is a Kubernetes Service. In this
+ case, the port number is the service port number, not the target port.
+ For other resources, destination port might be derived from the referent
+ resource or this field.
+ format: int32
+ maximum: 65535
+ minimum: 1
+ type: integer
+ required:
+ - name
+ type: object
+ x-kubernetes-validations:
+ - message: Must have port for Service reference
+ rule: '(size(self.group) == 0 && self.kind == ''Service'')
+ ? has(self.port) : true'
+ required:
+ - backendRef
+ type: object
+ responseHeaderModifier:
+ description: |-
+ ResponseHeaderModifier defines a schema for a filter that modifies response
+ headers.
+
+
+ Support: Extended
+ properties:
+ add:
+ description: |-
+ Add adds the given header(s) (name, value) to the request
+ before the action. It appends to any existing values associated
+ with the header name.
+
+
+ Input:
+ GET /foo HTTP/1.1
+ my-header: foo
+
+
+ Config:
+ add:
+ - name: "my-header"
+ value: "bar,baz"
+
+
+ Output:
+ GET /foo HTTP/1.1
+ my-header: foo,bar,baz
+ items:
+ description: HTTPHeader represents an HTTP Header
+ name and value as defined by RFC 7230.
+ properties:
+ name:
+ description: |-
+ Name is the name of the HTTP Header to be matched. Name matching MUST be
+ case insensitive. (See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc7230#section-3.2).
+
+
+ If multiple entries specify equivalent header names, the first entry with
+ an equivalent name MUST be considered for a match. Subsequent entries
+ with an equivalent header name MUST be ignored. Due to the
+ case-insensitivity of header names, "foo" and "Foo" are considered
+ equivalent.
+ maxLength: 256
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[A-Za-z0-9!#$%&'*+\-.^_\x60|~]+$
+ type: string
+ value:
+ description: Value is the value of HTTP Header
+ to be matched.
+ maxLength: 4096
+ minLength: 1
+ type: string
+ required:
+ - name
+ - value
+ type: object
+ maxItems: 16
+ type: array
+ x-kubernetes-list-map-keys:
+ - name
+ x-kubernetes-list-type: map
+ remove:
+ description: |-
+ Remove the given header(s) from the HTTP request before the action. The
+ value of Remove is a list of HTTP header names. Note that the header
+ names are case-insensitive (see
+ https://datatracker.ietf.org/doc/html/rfc2616#section-4.2).
+
+
+ Input:
+ GET /foo HTTP/1.1
+ my-header1: foo
+ my-header2: bar
+ my-header3: baz
+
+
+ Config:
+ remove: ["my-header1", "my-header3"]
+
+
+ Output:
+ GET /foo HTTP/1.1
+ my-header2: bar
+ items:
+ type: string
+ maxItems: 16
+ type: array
+ x-kubernetes-list-type: set
+ set:
+ description: |-
+ Set overwrites the request with the given header (name, value)
+ before the action.
+
+
+ Input:
+ GET /foo HTTP/1.1
+ my-header: foo
+
+
+ Config:
+ set:
+ - name: "my-header"
+ value: "bar"
+
+
+ Output:
+ GET /foo HTTP/1.1
+ my-header: bar
+ items:
+ description: HTTPHeader represents an HTTP Header
+ name and value as defined by RFC 7230.
+ properties:
+ name:
+ description: |-
+ Name is the name of the HTTP Header to be matched. Name matching MUST be
+ case insensitive. (See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc7230#section-3.2).
+
+
+ If multiple entries specify equivalent header names, the first entry with
+ an equivalent name MUST be considered for a match. Subsequent entries
+ with an equivalent header name MUST be ignored. Due to the
+ case-insensitivity of header names, "foo" and "Foo" are considered
+ equivalent.
+ maxLength: 256
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[A-Za-z0-9!#$%&'*+\-.^_\x60|~]+$
+ type: string
+ value:
+ description: Value is the value of HTTP Header
+ to be matched.
+ maxLength: 4096
+ minLength: 1
+ type: string
+ required:
+ - name
+ - value
+ type: object
+ maxItems: 16
+ type: array
+ x-kubernetes-list-map-keys:
+ - name
+ x-kubernetes-list-type: map
+ type: object
+ type:
+ description: |+
+ Type identifies the type of filter to apply. As with other API fields,
+ types are classified into three conformance levels:
+
+
+ - Core: Filter types and their corresponding configuration defined by
+ "Support: Core" in this package, e.g. "RequestHeaderModifier". All
+ implementations supporting GRPCRoute MUST support core filters.
+
+
+ - Extended: Filter types and their corresponding configuration defined by
+ "Support: Extended" in this package, e.g. "RequestMirror". Implementers
+ are encouraged to support extended filters.
+
+
+ - Implementation-specific: Filters that are defined and supported by specific vendors.
+ In the future, filters showing convergence in behavior across multiple
+ implementations will be considered for inclusion in extended or core
+ conformance levels. Filter-specific configuration for such filters
+ is specified using the ExtensionRef field. `Type` MUST be set to
+ "ExtensionRef" for custom filters.
+
+
+ Implementers are encouraged to define custom implementation types to
+ extend the core API with implementation-specific behavior.
+
+
+ If a reference to a custom filter type cannot be resolved, the filter
+ MUST NOT be skipped. Instead, requests that would have been processed by
+ that filter MUST receive a HTTP error response.
+
+
+ enum:
+ - ResponseHeaderModifier
+ - RequestHeaderModifier
+ - RequestMirror
+ - ExtensionRef
+ type: string
+ required:
+ - type
+ type: object
+ x-kubernetes-validations:
+ - message: filter.requestHeaderModifier must be nil if the
+ filter.type is not RequestHeaderModifier
+ rule: '!(has(self.requestHeaderModifier) && self.type !=
+ ''RequestHeaderModifier'')'
+ - message: filter.requestHeaderModifier must be specified
+ for RequestHeaderModifier filter.type
+ rule: '!(!has(self.requestHeaderModifier) && self.type ==
+ ''RequestHeaderModifier'')'
+ - message: filter.responseHeaderModifier must be nil if the
+ filter.type is not ResponseHeaderModifier
+ rule: '!(has(self.responseHeaderModifier) && self.type !=
+ ''ResponseHeaderModifier'')'
+ - message: filter.responseHeaderModifier must be specified
+ for ResponseHeaderModifier filter.type
+ rule: '!(!has(self.responseHeaderModifier) && self.type
+ == ''ResponseHeaderModifier'')'
+ - message: filter.requestMirror must be nil if the filter.type
+ is not RequestMirror
+ rule: '!(has(self.requestMirror) && self.type != ''RequestMirror'')'
+ - message: filter.requestMirror must be specified for RequestMirror
+ filter.type
+ rule: '!(!has(self.requestMirror) && self.type == ''RequestMirror'')'
+ - message: filter.extensionRef must be nil if the filter.type
+ is not ExtensionRef
+ rule: '!(has(self.extensionRef) && self.type != ''ExtensionRef'')'
+ - message: filter.extensionRef must be specified for ExtensionRef
+ filter.type
+ rule: '!(!has(self.extensionRef) && self.type == ''ExtensionRef'')'
+ maxItems: 16
+ type: array
+ x-kubernetes-validations:
+ - message: RequestHeaderModifier filter cannot be repeated
+ rule: self.filter(f, f.type == 'RequestHeaderModifier').size()
+ <= 1
+ - message: ResponseHeaderModifier filter cannot be repeated
+ rule: self.filter(f, f.type == 'ResponseHeaderModifier').size()
+ <= 1
+ matches:
+ description: |-
+ Matches define conditions used for matching the rule against incoming
+ gRPC requests. Each match is independent, i.e. this rule will be matched
+ if **any** one of the matches is satisfied.
+
+
+ For example, take the following matches configuration:
+
+
+ ```
+ matches:
+ - method:
+ service: foo.bar
+ headers:
+ values:
+ version: 2
+ - method:
+ service: foo.bar.v2
+ ```
+
+
+ For a request to match against this rule, it MUST satisfy
+ EITHER of the two conditions:
+
+
+ - service of foo.bar AND contains the header `version: 2`
+ - service of foo.bar.v2
+
+
+ See the documentation for GRPCRouteMatch on how to specify multiple
+ match conditions to be ANDed together.
+
+
+ If no matches are specified, the implementation MUST match every gRPC request.
+
+
+ Proxy or Load Balancer routing configuration generated from GRPCRoutes
+ MUST prioritize rules based on the following criteria, continuing on
+ ties. Merging MUST not be done between GRPCRoutes and HTTPRoutes.
+ Precedence MUST be given to the rule with the largest number of:
+
+
+ * Characters in a matching non-wildcard hostname.
+ * Characters in a matching hostname.
+ * Characters in a matching service.
+ * Characters in a matching method.
+ * Header matches.
+
+
+ If ties still exist across multiple Routes, matching precedence MUST be
+ determined in order of the following criteria, continuing on ties:
+
+
+ * The oldest Route based on creation timestamp.
+ * The Route appearing first in alphabetical order by
+ "{namespace}/{name}".
+
+
+ If ties still exist within the Route that has been given precedence,
+ matching precedence MUST be granted to the first matching rule meeting
+ the above criteria.
+ items:
+ description: |-
+ GRPCRouteMatch defines the predicate used to match requests to a given
+ action. Multiple match types are ANDed together, i.e. the match will
+ evaluate to true only if all conditions are satisfied.
+
+
+ For example, the match below will match a gRPC request only if its service
+ is `foo` AND it contains the `version: v1` header:
+
+
+ ```
+ matches:
+ - method:
+ type: Exact
+ service: "foo"
+ headers:
+ - name: "version"
+ value "v1"
+
+
+ ```
+ properties:
+ headers:
+ description: |-
+ Headers specifies gRPC request header matchers. Multiple match values are
+ ANDed together, meaning, a request MUST match all the specified headers
+ to select the route.
+ items:
+ description: |-
+ GRPCHeaderMatch describes how to select a gRPC route by matching gRPC request
+ headers.
+ properties:
+ name:
+ description: |-
+ Name is the name of the gRPC Header to be matched.
+
+
+ If multiple entries specify equivalent header names, only the first
+ entry with an equivalent name MUST be considered for a match. Subsequent
+ entries with an equivalent header name MUST be ignored. Due to the
+ case-insensitivity of header names, "foo" and "Foo" are considered
+ equivalent.
+ maxLength: 256
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[A-Za-z0-9!#$%&'*+\-.^_\x60|~]+$
+ type: string
+ type:
+ default: Exact
+ description: Type specifies how to match against
+ the value of the header.
+ enum:
+ - Exact
+ - RegularExpression
+ type: string
+ value:
+ description: Value is the value of the gRPC Header
+ to be matched.
+ maxLength: 4096
+ minLength: 1
+ type: string
+ required:
+ - name
+ - value
+ type: object
+ maxItems: 16
+ type: array
+ x-kubernetes-list-map-keys:
+ - name
+ x-kubernetes-list-type: map
+ method:
+ description: |-
+ Method specifies a gRPC request service/method matcher. If this field is
+ not specified, all services and methods will match.
+ properties:
+ method:
+ description: |-
+ Value of the method to match against. If left empty or omitted, will
+ match all services.
+
+
+ At least one of Service and Method MUST be a non-empty string.
+ maxLength: 1024
+ type: string
+ service:
+ description: |-
+ Value of the service to match against. If left empty or omitted, will
+ match any service.
+
+
+ At least one of Service and Method MUST be a non-empty string.
+ maxLength: 1024
+ type: string
+ type:
+ default: Exact
+ description: |-
+ Type specifies how to match against the service and/or method.
+ Support: Core (Exact with service and method specified)
+
+
+ Support: Implementation-specific (Exact with method specified but no service specified)
+
+
+ Support: Implementation-specific (RegularExpression)
+ enum:
+ - Exact
+ - RegularExpression
+ type: string
+ type: object
+ x-kubernetes-validations:
+ - message: One or both of 'service' or 'method' must be
+ specified
+ rule: 'has(self.type) ? has(self.service) || has(self.method)
+ : true'
+ - message: service must only contain valid characters
+ (matching ^(?i)\.?[a-z_][a-z_0-9]*(\.[a-z_][a-z_0-9]*)*$)
+ rule: '(!has(self.type) || self.type == ''Exact'') &&
+ has(self.service) ? self.service.matches(r"""^(?i)\.?[a-z_][a-z_0-9]*(\.[a-z_][a-z_0-9]*)*$"""):
+ true'
+ - message: method must only contain valid characters (matching
+ ^[A-Za-z_][A-Za-z_0-9]*$)
+ rule: '(!has(self.type) || self.type == ''Exact'') &&
+ has(self.method) ? self.method.matches(r"""^[A-Za-z_][A-Za-z_0-9]*$"""):
+ true'
+ type: object
+ maxItems: 8
+ type: array
+ type: object
+ maxItems: 16
+ type: array
+ type: object
+ status:
+ description: Status defines the current state of GRPCRoute.
+ properties:
+ parents:
+ description: |-
+ Parents is a list of parent resources (usually Gateways) that are
+ associated with the route, and the status of the route with respect to
+ each parent. When this route attaches to a parent, the controller that
+ manages the parent must add an entry to this list when the controller
+ first sees the route and should update the entry as appropriate when the
+ route or gateway is modified.
+
+
+ Note that parent references that cannot be resolved by an implementation
+ of this API will not be added to this list. Implementations of this API
+ can only populate Route status for the Gateways/parent resources they are
+ responsible for.
+
+
+ A maximum of 32 Gateways will be represented in this list. An empty list
+ means the route has not been attached to any Gateway.
+ items:
+ description: |-
+ RouteParentStatus describes the status of a route with respect to an
+ associated Parent.
+ properties:
+ conditions:
+ description: |-
+ Conditions describes the status of the route with respect to the Gateway.
+ Note that the route's availability is also subject to the Gateway's own
+ status conditions and listener status.
+
+
+ If the Route's ParentRef specifies an existing Gateway that supports
+ Routes of this kind AND that Gateway's controller has sufficient access,
+ then that Gateway's controller MUST set the "Accepted" condition on the
+ Route, to indicate whether the route has been accepted or rejected by the
+ Gateway, and why.
+
+
+ A Route MUST be considered "Accepted" if at least one of the Route's
+ rules is implemented by the Gateway.
+
+
+ There are a number of cases where the "Accepted" condition may not be set
+ due to lack of controller visibility, that includes when:
+
+
+ * The Route refers to a non-existent parent.
+ * The Route is of a type that the controller does not support.
+ * The Route is in a namespace the controller does not have access to.
+ items:
+ description: "Condition contains details for one aspect of
+ the current state of this API Resource.\n---\nThis struct
+ is intended for direct use as an array at the field path
+ .status.conditions. For example,\n\n\n\ttype FooStatus
+ struct{\n\t // Represents the observations of a foo's
+ current state.\n\t // Known .status.conditions.type are:
+ \"Available\", \"Progressing\", and \"Degraded\"\n\t //
+ +patchMergeKey=type\n\t // +patchStrategy=merge\n\t //
+ +listType=map\n\t // +listMapKey=type\n\t Conditions
+ []metav1.Condition `json:\"conditions,omitempty\" patchStrategy:\"merge\"
+ patchMergeKey:\"type\" protobuf:\"bytes,1,rep,name=conditions\"`\n\n\n\t
+ \ // other fields\n\t}"
+ properties:
+ lastTransitionTime:
+ description: |-
+ lastTransitionTime is the last time the condition transitioned from one status to another.
+ This should be when the underlying condition changed. If that is not known, then using the time when the API field changed is acceptable.
+ format: date-time
+ type: string
+ message:
+ description: |-
+ message is a human readable message indicating details about the transition.
+ This may be an empty string.
+ maxLength: 32768
+ type: string
+ observedGeneration:
+ description: |-
+ observedGeneration represents the .metadata.generation that the condition was set based upon.
+ For instance, if .metadata.generation is currently 12, but the .status.conditions[x].observedGeneration is 9, the condition is out of date
+ with respect to the current state of the instance.
+ format: int64
+ minimum: 0
+ type: integer
+ reason:
+ description: |-
+ reason contains a programmatic identifier indicating the reason for the condition's last transition.
+ Producers of specific condition types may define expected values and meanings for this field,
+ and whether the values are considered a guaranteed API.
+ The value should be a CamelCase string.
+ This field may not be empty.
+ maxLength: 1024
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[A-Za-z]([A-Za-z0-9_,:]*[A-Za-z0-9_])?$
+ type: string
+ status:
+ description: status of the condition, one of True, False,
+ Unknown.
+ enum:
+ - "True"
+ - "False"
+ - Unknown
+ type: string
+ type:
+ description: |-
+ type of condition in CamelCase or in foo.example.com/CamelCase.
+ ---
+ Many .condition.type values are consistent across resources like Available, but because arbitrary conditions can be
+ useful (see .node.status.conditions), the ability to deconflict is important.
+ The regex it matches is (dns1123SubdomainFmt/)?(qualifiedNameFmt)
+ maxLength: 316
+ pattern: ^([a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*/)?(([A-Za-z0-9][-A-Za-z0-9_.]*)?[A-Za-z0-9])$
+ type: string
+ required:
+ - lastTransitionTime
+ - message
+ - reason
+ - status
+ - type
+ type: object
+ maxItems: 8
+ minItems: 1
+ type: array
+ x-kubernetes-list-map-keys:
+ - type
+ x-kubernetes-list-type: map
+ controllerName:
+ description: |-
+ ControllerName is a domain/path string that indicates the name of the
+ controller that wrote this status. This corresponds with the
+ controllerName field on GatewayClass.
+
+
+ Example: "example.net/gateway-controller".
+
+
+ The format of this field is DOMAIN "/" PATH, where DOMAIN and PATH are
+ valid Kubernetes names
+ (https://kubernetes.io/docs/concepts/overview/working-with-objects/names/#names).
+
+
+ Controllers MUST populate this field when writing status. Controllers should ensure that
+ entries to status populated with their ControllerName are cleaned up when they are no
+ longer necessary.
+ maxLength: 253
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*\/[A-Za-z0-9\/\-._~%!$&'()*+,;=:]+$
+ type: string
+ parentRef:
+ description: |-
+ ParentRef corresponds with a ParentRef in the spec that this
+ RouteParentStatus struct describes the status of.
+ properties:
+ group:
+ default: gateway.networking.k8s.io
+ description: |-
+ Group is the group of the referent.
+ When unspecified, "gateway.networking.k8s.io" is inferred.
+ To set the core API group (such as for a "Service" kind referent),
+ Group must be explicitly set to "" (empty string).
+
+
+ Support: Core
+ maxLength: 253
+ pattern: ^$|^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$
+ type: string
+ kind:
+ default: Gateway
+ description: |-
+ Kind is kind of the referent.
+
+
+ There are two kinds of parent resources with "Core" support:
+
+
+ * Gateway (Gateway conformance profile)
+ * Service (Mesh conformance profile, ClusterIP Services only)
+
+
+ Support for other resources is Implementation-Specific.
+ maxLength: 63
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[a-zA-Z]([-a-zA-Z0-9]*[a-zA-Z0-9])?$
+ type: string
+ name:
+ description: |-
+ Name is the name of the referent.
+
+
+ Support: Core
+ maxLength: 253
+ minLength: 1
+ type: string
+ namespace:
+ description: |-
+ Namespace is the namespace of the referent. When unspecified, this refers
+ to the local namespace of the Route.
+
+
+ Note that there are specific rules for ParentRefs which cross namespace
+ boundaries. Cross-namespace references are only valid if they are explicitly
+ allowed by something in the namespace they are referring to. For example:
+ Gateway has the AllowedRoutes field, and ReferenceGrant provides a
+ generic way to enable any other kind of cross-namespace reference.
+
+
+
+
+
+ Support: Core
+ maxLength: 63
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?$
+ type: string
+ port:
+ description: |-
+ Port is the network port this Route targets. It can be interpreted
+ differently based on the type of parent resource.
+
+
+ When the parent resource is a Gateway, this targets all listeners
+ listening on the specified port that also support this kind of Route(and
+ select this Route). It's not recommended to set `Port` unless the
+ networking behaviors specified in a Route must apply to a specific port
+ as opposed to a listener(s) whose port(s) may be changed. When both Port
+ and SectionName are specified, the name and port of the selected listener
+ must match both specified values.
+
+
+
+
+
+ Implementations MAY choose to support other parent resources.
+ Implementations supporting other types of parent resources MUST clearly
+ document how/if Port is interpreted.
+
+
+ For the purpose of status, an attachment is considered successful as
+ long as the parent resource accepts it partially. For example, Gateway
+ listeners can restrict which Routes can attach to them by Route kind,
+ namespace, or hostname. If 1 of 2 Gateway listeners accept attachment
+ from the referencing Route, the Route MUST be considered successfully
+ attached. If no Gateway listeners accept attachment from this Route,
+ the Route MUST be considered detached from the Gateway.
+
+
+ Support: Extended
+ format: int32
+ maximum: 65535
+ minimum: 1
+ type: integer
+ sectionName:
+ description: |-
+ SectionName is the name of a section within the target resource. In the
+ following resources, SectionName is interpreted as the following:
+
+
+ * Gateway: Listener name. When both Port (experimental) and SectionName
+ are specified, the name and port of the selected listener must match
+ both specified values.
+ * Service: Port name. When both Port (experimental) and SectionName
+ are specified, the name and port of the selected listener must match
+ both specified values.
+
+
+ Implementations MAY choose to support attaching Routes to other resources.
+ If that is the case, they MUST clearly document how SectionName is
+ interpreted.
+
+
+ When unspecified (empty string), this will reference the entire resource.
+ For the purpose of status, an attachment is considered successful if at
+ least one section in the parent resource accepts it. For example, Gateway
+ listeners can restrict which Routes can attach to them by Route kind,
+ namespace, or hostname. If 1 of 2 Gateway listeners accept attachment from
+ the referencing Route, the Route MUST be considered successfully
+ attached. If no Gateway listeners accept attachment from this Route, the
+ Route MUST be considered detached from the Gateway.
+
+
+ Support: Core
+ maxLength: 253
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$
+ type: string
+ required:
+ - name
+ type: object
+ required:
+ - controllerName
+ - parentRef
+ type: object
+ maxItems: 32
+ type: array
+ required:
+ - parents
+ type: object
+ type: object
+ served: false
+ storage: false
+status:
+ acceptedNames:
+ kind: ""
+ plural: ""
+ conditions: null
+ storedVersions: null
+---
+#
+# config/crd/standard/gateway.networking.k8s.io_httproutes.yaml
+#
+apiVersion: apiextensions.k8s.io/v1
+kind: CustomResourceDefinition
+metadata:
+ annotations:
+ api-approved.kubernetes.io: https://github.com/kubernetes-sigs/gateway-api/pull/2997
+ gateway.networking.k8s.io/bundle-version: v1.1.0
+ gateway.networking.k8s.io/channel: standard
+ creationTimestamp: null
+ name: httproutes.gateway.networking.k8s.io
+spec:
+ group: gateway.networking.k8s.io
+ names:
+ categories:
+ - gateway-api
+ kind: HTTPRoute
+ listKind: HTTPRouteList
+ plural: httproutes
+ singular: httproute
+ scope: Namespaced
+ versions:
+ - additionalPrinterColumns:
+ - jsonPath: .spec.hostnames
+ name: Hostnames
+ type: string
+ - jsonPath: .metadata.creationTimestamp
+ name: Age
+ type: date
+ name: v1
+ schema:
+ openAPIV3Schema:
+ description: |-
+ HTTPRoute provides a way to route HTTP requests. This includes the capability
+ to match requests by hostname, path, header, or query param. Filters can be
+ used to specify additional processing steps. Backends specify where matching
+ requests should be routed.
+ properties:
+ apiVersion:
+ description: |-
+ APIVersion defines the versioned schema of this representation of an object.
+ Servers should convert recognized schemas to the latest internal value, and
+ may reject unrecognized values.
+ More info: https://git.k8s.io/community/contributors/devel/sig-architecture/api-conventions.md#resources
+ type: string
+ kind:
+ description: |-
+ Kind is a string value representing the REST resource this object represents.
+ Servers may infer this from the endpoint the client submits requests to.
+ Cannot be updated.
+ In CamelCase.
+ More info: https://git.k8s.io/community/contributors/devel/sig-architecture/api-conventions.md#types-kinds
+ type: string
+ metadata:
+ type: object
+ spec:
+ description: Spec defines the desired state of HTTPRoute.
+ properties:
+ hostnames:
+ description: |-
+ Hostnames defines a set of hostnames that should match against the HTTP Host
+ header to select a HTTPRoute used to process the request. Implementations
+ MUST ignore any port value specified in the HTTP Host header while
+ performing a match and (absent of any applicable header modification
+ configuration) MUST forward this header unmodified to the backend.
+
+
+ Valid values for Hostnames are determined by RFC 1123 definition of a
+ hostname with 2 notable exceptions:
+
+
+ 1. IPs are not allowed.
+ 2. A hostname may be prefixed with a wildcard label (`*.`). The wildcard
+ label must appear by itself as the first label.
+
+
+ If a hostname is specified by both the Listener and HTTPRoute, there
+ must be at least one intersecting hostname for the HTTPRoute to be
+ attached to the Listener. For example:
+
+
+ * A Listener with `test.example.com` as the hostname matches HTTPRoutes
+ that have either not specified any hostnames, or have specified at
+ least one of `test.example.com` or `*.example.com`.
+ * A Listener with `*.example.com` as the hostname matches HTTPRoutes
+ that have either not specified any hostnames or have specified at least
+ one hostname that matches the Listener hostname. For example,
+ `*.example.com`, `test.example.com`, and `foo.test.example.com` would
+ all match. On the other hand, `example.com` and `test.example.net` would
+ not match.
+
+
+ Hostnames that are prefixed with a wildcard label (`*.`) are interpreted
+ as a suffix match. That means that a match for `*.example.com` would match
+ both `test.example.com`, and `foo.test.example.com`, but not `example.com`.
+
+
+ If both the Listener and HTTPRoute have specified hostnames, any
+ HTTPRoute hostnames that do not match the Listener hostname MUST be
+ ignored. For example, if a Listener specified `*.example.com`, and the
+ HTTPRoute specified `test.example.com` and `test.example.net`,
+ `test.example.net` must not be considered for a match.
+
+
+ If both the Listener and HTTPRoute have specified hostnames, and none
+ match with the criteria above, then the HTTPRoute is not accepted. The
+ implementation must raise an 'Accepted' Condition with a status of
+ `False` in the corresponding RouteParentStatus.
+
+
+ In the event that multiple HTTPRoutes specify intersecting hostnames (e.g.
+ overlapping wildcard matching and exact matching hostnames), precedence must
+ be given to rules from the HTTPRoute with the largest number of:
+
+
+ * Characters in a matching non-wildcard hostname.
+ * Characters in a matching hostname.
+
+
+ If ties exist across multiple Routes, the matching precedence rules for
+ HTTPRouteMatches takes over.
+
+
+ Support: Core
+ items:
+ description: |-
+ Hostname is the fully qualified domain name of a network host. This matches
+ the RFC 1123 definition of a hostname with 2 notable exceptions:
+
+
+ 1. IPs are not allowed.
+ 2. A hostname may be prefixed with a wildcard label (`*.`). The wildcard
+ label must appear by itself as the first label.
+
+
+ Hostname can be "precise" which is a domain name without the terminating
+ dot of a network host (e.g. "foo.example.com") or "wildcard", which is a
+ domain name prefixed with a single wildcard label (e.g. `*.example.com`).
+
+
+ Note that as per RFC1035 and RFC1123, a *label* must consist of lower case
+ alphanumeric characters or '-', and must start and end with an alphanumeric
+ character. No other punctuation is allowed.
+ maxLength: 253
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^(\*\.)?[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$
+ type: string
+ maxItems: 16
+ type: array
+ parentRefs:
+ description: |+
+ ParentRefs references the resources (usually Gateways) that a Route wants
+ to be attached to. Note that the referenced parent resource needs to
+ allow this for the attachment to be complete. For Gateways, that means
+ the Gateway needs to allow attachment from Routes of this kind and
+ namespace. For Services, that means the Service must either be in the same
+ namespace for a "producer" route, or the mesh implementation must support
+ and allow "consumer" routes for the referenced Service. ReferenceGrant is
+ not applicable for governing ParentRefs to Services - it is not possible to
+ create a "producer" route for a Service in a different namespace from the
+ Route.
+
+
+ There are two kinds of parent resources with "Core" support:
+
+
+ * Gateway (Gateway conformance profile)
+ * Service (Mesh conformance profile, ClusterIP Services only)
+
+
+ This API may be extended in the future to support additional kinds of parent
+ resources.
+
+
+ ParentRefs must be _distinct_. This means either that:
+
+
+ * They select different objects. If this is the case, then parentRef
+ entries are distinct. In terms of fields, this means that the
+ multi-part key defined by `group`, `kind`, `namespace`, and `name` must
+ be unique across all parentRef entries in the Route.
+ * They do not select different objects, but for each optional field used,
+ each ParentRef that selects the same object must set the same set of
+ optional fields to different values. If one ParentRef sets a
+ combination of optional fields, all must set the same combination.
+
+
+ Some examples:
+
+
+ * If one ParentRef sets `sectionName`, all ParentRefs referencing the
+ same object must also set `sectionName`.
+ * If one ParentRef sets `port`, all ParentRefs referencing the same
+ object must also set `port`.
+ * If one ParentRef sets `sectionName` and `port`, all ParentRefs
+ referencing the same object must also set `sectionName` and `port`.
+
+
+ It is possible to separately reference multiple distinct objects that may
+ be collapsed by an implementation. For example, some implementations may
+ choose to merge compatible Gateway Listeners together. If that is the
+ case, the list of routes attached to those resources should also be
+ merged.
+
+
+ Note that for ParentRefs that cross namespace boundaries, there are specific
+ rules. Cross-namespace references are only valid if they are explicitly
+ allowed by something in the namespace they are referring to. For example,
+ Gateway has the AllowedRoutes field, and ReferenceGrant provides a
+ generic way to enable other kinds of cross-namespace reference.
+
+
+
+
+
+
+
+
+ items:
+ description: |-
+ ParentReference identifies an API object (usually a Gateway) that can be considered
+ a parent of this resource (usually a route). There are two kinds of parent resources
+ with "Core" support:
+
+
+ * Gateway (Gateway conformance profile)
+ * Service (Mesh conformance profile, ClusterIP Services only)
+
+
+ This API may be extended in the future to support additional kinds of parent
+ resources.
+
+
+ The API object must be valid in the cluster; the Group and Kind must
+ be registered in the cluster for this reference to be valid.
+ properties:
+ group:
+ default: gateway.networking.k8s.io
+ description: |-
+ Group is the group of the referent.
+ When unspecified, "gateway.networking.k8s.io" is inferred.
+ To set the core API group (such as for a "Service" kind referent),
+ Group must be explicitly set to "" (empty string).
+
+
+ Support: Core
+ maxLength: 253
+ pattern: ^$|^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$
+ type: string
+ kind:
+ default: Gateway
+ description: |-
+ Kind is kind of the referent.
+
+
+ There are two kinds of parent resources with "Core" support:
+
+
+ * Gateway (Gateway conformance profile)
+ * Service (Mesh conformance profile, ClusterIP Services only)
+
+
+ Support for other resources is Implementation-Specific.
+ maxLength: 63
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[a-zA-Z]([-a-zA-Z0-9]*[a-zA-Z0-9])?$
+ type: string
+ name:
+ description: |-
+ Name is the name of the referent.
+
+
+ Support: Core
+ maxLength: 253
+ minLength: 1
+ type: string
+ namespace:
+ description: |-
+ Namespace is the namespace of the referent. When unspecified, this refers
+ to the local namespace of the Route.
+
+
+ Note that there are specific rules for ParentRefs which cross namespace
+ boundaries. Cross-namespace references are only valid if they are explicitly
+ allowed by something in the namespace they are referring to. For example:
+ Gateway has the AllowedRoutes field, and ReferenceGrant provides a
+ generic way to enable any other kind of cross-namespace reference.
+
+
+
+
+
+ Support: Core
+ maxLength: 63
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?$
+ type: string
+ port:
+ description: |-
+ Port is the network port this Route targets. It can be interpreted
+ differently based on the type of parent resource.
+
+
+ When the parent resource is a Gateway, this targets all listeners
+ listening on the specified port that also support this kind of Route(and
+ select this Route). It's not recommended to set `Port` unless the
+ networking behaviors specified in a Route must apply to a specific port
+ as opposed to a listener(s) whose port(s) may be changed. When both Port
+ and SectionName are specified, the name and port of the selected listener
+ must match both specified values.
+
+
+
+
+
+ Implementations MAY choose to support other parent resources.
+ Implementations supporting other types of parent resources MUST clearly
+ document how/if Port is interpreted.
+
+
+ For the purpose of status, an attachment is considered successful as
+ long as the parent resource accepts it partially. For example, Gateway
+ listeners can restrict which Routes can attach to them by Route kind,
+ namespace, or hostname. If 1 of 2 Gateway listeners accept attachment
+ from the referencing Route, the Route MUST be considered successfully
+ attached. If no Gateway listeners accept attachment from this Route,
+ the Route MUST be considered detached from the Gateway.
+
+
+ Support: Extended
+ format: int32
+ maximum: 65535
+ minimum: 1
+ type: integer
+ sectionName:
+ description: |-
+ SectionName is the name of a section within the target resource. In the
+ following resources, SectionName is interpreted as the following:
+
+
+ * Gateway: Listener name. When both Port (experimental) and SectionName
+ are specified, the name and port of the selected listener must match
+ both specified values.
+ * Service: Port name. When both Port (experimental) and SectionName
+ are specified, the name and port of the selected listener must match
+ both specified values.
+
+
+ Implementations MAY choose to support attaching Routes to other resources.
+ If that is the case, they MUST clearly document how SectionName is
+ interpreted.
+
+
+ When unspecified (empty string), this will reference the entire resource.
+ For the purpose of status, an attachment is considered successful if at
+ least one section in the parent resource accepts it. For example, Gateway
+ listeners can restrict which Routes can attach to them by Route kind,
+ namespace, or hostname. If 1 of 2 Gateway listeners accept attachment from
+ the referencing Route, the Route MUST be considered successfully
+ attached. If no Gateway listeners accept attachment from this Route, the
+ Route MUST be considered detached from the Gateway.
+
+
+ Support: Core
+ maxLength: 253
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$
+ type: string
+ required:
+ - name
+ type: object
+ maxItems: 32
+ type: array
+ x-kubernetes-validations:
+ - message: sectionName must be specified when parentRefs includes
+ 2 or more references to the same parent
+ rule: 'self.all(p1, self.all(p2, p1.group == p2.group && p1.kind
+ == p2.kind && p1.name == p2.name && (((!has(p1.__namespace__)
+ || p1.__namespace__ == '''') && (!has(p2.__namespace__) || p2.__namespace__
+ == '''')) || (has(p1.__namespace__) && has(p2.__namespace__) &&
+ p1.__namespace__ == p2.__namespace__ )) ? ((!has(p1.sectionName)
+ || p1.sectionName == '''') == (!has(p2.sectionName) || p2.sectionName
+ == '''')) : true))'
+ - message: sectionName must be unique when parentRefs includes 2 or
+ more references to the same parent
+ rule: self.all(p1, self.exists_one(p2, p1.group == p2.group && p1.kind
+ == p2.kind && p1.name == p2.name && (((!has(p1.__namespace__)
+ || p1.__namespace__ == '') && (!has(p2.__namespace__) || p2.__namespace__
+ == '')) || (has(p1.__namespace__) && has(p2.__namespace__) &&
+ p1.__namespace__ == p2.__namespace__ )) && (((!has(p1.sectionName)
+ || p1.sectionName == '') && (!has(p2.sectionName) || p2.sectionName
+ == '')) || (has(p1.sectionName) && has(p2.sectionName) && p1.sectionName
+ == p2.sectionName))))
+ rules:
+ default:
+ - matches:
+ - path:
+ type: PathPrefix
+ value: /
+ description: Rules are a list of HTTP matchers, filters and actions.
+ items:
+ description: |-
+ HTTPRouteRule defines semantics for matching an HTTP request based on
+ conditions (matches), processing it (filters), and forwarding the request to
+ an API object (backendRefs).
+ properties:
+ backendRefs:
+ description: |-
+ BackendRefs defines the backend(s) where matching requests should be
+ sent.
+
+
+ Failure behavior here depends on how many BackendRefs are specified and
+ how many are invalid.
+
+
+ If *all* entries in BackendRefs are invalid, and there are also no filters
+ specified in this route rule, *all* traffic which matches this rule MUST
+ receive a 500 status code.
+
+
+ See the HTTPBackendRef definition for the rules about what makes a single
+ HTTPBackendRef invalid.
+
+
+ When a HTTPBackendRef is invalid, 500 status codes MUST be returned for
+ requests that would have otherwise been routed to an invalid backend. If
+ multiple backends are specified, and some are invalid, the proportion of
+ requests that would otherwise have been routed to an invalid backend
+ MUST receive a 500 status code.
+
+
+ For example, if two backends are specified with equal weights, and one is
+ invalid, 50 percent of traffic must receive a 500. Implementations may
+ choose how that 50 percent is determined.
+
+
+ Support: Core for Kubernetes Service
+
+
+ Support: Extended for Kubernetes ServiceImport
+
+
+ Support: Implementation-specific for any other resource
+
+
+ Support for weight: Core
+ items:
+ description: |-
+ HTTPBackendRef defines how a HTTPRoute forwards a HTTP request.
+
+
+ Note that when a namespace different than the local namespace is specified, a
+ ReferenceGrant object is required in the referent namespace to allow that
+ namespace's owner to accept the reference. See the ReferenceGrant
+ documentation for details.
+
+
+
+
+
+ When the BackendRef points to a Kubernetes Service, implementations SHOULD
+ honor the appProtocol field if it is set for the target Service Port.
+
+
+ Implementations supporting appProtocol SHOULD recognize the Kubernetes
+ Standard Application Protocols defined in KEP-3726.
+
+
+ If a Service appProtocol isn't specified, an implementation MAY infer the
+ backend protocol through its own means. Implementations MAY infer the
+ protocol from the Route type referring to the backend Service.
+
+
+ If a Route is not able to send traffic to the backend using the specified
+ protocol then the backend is considered invalid. Implementations MUST set the
+ "ResolvedRefs" condition to "False" with the "UnsupportedProtocol" reason.
+
+
+
+ properties:
+ filters:
+ description: |-
+ Filters defined at this level should be executed if and only if the
+ request is being forwarded to the backend defined here.
+
+
+ Support: Implementation-specific (For broader support of filters, use the
+ Filters field in HTTPRouteRule.)
+ items:
+ description: |-
+ HTTPRouteFilter defines processing steps that must be completed during the
+ request or response lifecycle. HTTPRouteFilters are meant as an extension
+ point to express processing that may be done in Gateway implementations. Some
+ examples include request or response modification, implementing
+ authentication strategies, rate-limiting, and traffic shaping. API
+ guarantee/conformance is defined based on the type of the filter.
+ properties:
+ extensionRef:
+ description: |-
+ ExtensionRef is an optional, implementation-specific extension to the
+ "filter" behavior. For example, resource "myroutefilter" in group
+ "networking.example.net"). ExtensionRef MUST NOT be used for core and
+ extended filters.
+
+
+ This filter can be used multiple times within the same rule.
+
+
+ Support: Implementation-specific
+ properties:
+ group:
+ description: |-
+ Group is the group of the referent. For example, "gateway.networking.k8s.io".
+ When unspecified or empty string, core API group is inferred.
+ maxLength: 253
+ pattern: ^$|^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$
+ type: string
+ kind:
+ description: Kind is kind of the referent. For
+ example "HTTPRoute" or "Service".
+ maxLength: 63
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[a-zA-Z]([-a-zA-Z0-9]*[a-zA-Z0-9])?$
+ type: string
+ name:
+ description: Name is the name of the referent.
+ maxLength: 253
+ minLength: 1
+ type: string
+ required:
+ - group
+ - kind
+ - name
+ type: object
+ requestHeaderModifier:
+ description: |-
+ RequestHeaderModifier defines a schema for a filter that modifies request
+ headers.
+
+
+ Support: Core
+ properties:
+ add:
+ description: |-
+ Add adds the given header(s) (name, value) to the request
+ before the action. It appends to any existing values associated
+ with the header name.
+
+
+ Input:
+ GET /foo HTTP/1.1
+ my-header: foo
+
+
+ Config:
+ add:
+ - name: "my-header"
+ value: "bar,baz"
+
+
+ Output:
+ GET /foo HTTP/1.1
+ my-header: foo,bar,baz
+ items:
+ description: HTTPHeader represents an HTTP
+ Header name and value as defined by RFC
+ 7230.
+ properties:
+ name:
+ description: |-
+ Name is the name of the HTTP Header to be matched. Name matching MUST be
+ case insensitive. (See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc7230#section-3.2).
+
+
+ If multiple entries specify equivalent header names, the first entry with
+ an equivalent name MUST be considered for a match. Subsequent entries
+ with an equivalent header name MUST be ignored. Due to the
+ case-insensitivity of header names, "foo" and "Foo" are considered
+ equivalent.
+ maxLength: 256
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[A-Za-z0-9!#$%&'*+\-.^_\x60|~]+$
+ type: string
+ value:
+ description: Value is the value of HTTP
+ Header to be matched.
+ maxLength: 4096
+ minLength: 1
+ type: string
+ required:
+ - name
+ - value
+ type: object
+ maxItems: 16
+ type: array
+ x-kubernetes-list-map-keys:
+ - name
+ x-kubernetes-list-type: map
+ remove:
+ description: |-
+ Remove the given header(s) from the HTTP request before the action. The
+ value of Remove is a list of HTTP header names. Note that the header
+ names are case-insensitive (see
+ https://datatracker.ietf.org/doc/html/rfc2616#section-4.2).
+
+
+ Input:
+ GET /foo HTTP/1.1
+ my-header1: foo
+ my-header2: bar
+ my-header3: baz
+
+
+ Config:
+ remove: ["my-header1", "my-header3"]
+
+
+ Output:
+ GET /foo HTTP/1.1
+ my-header2: bar
+ items:
+ type: string
+ maxItems: 16
+ type: array
+ x-kubernetes-list-type: set
+ set:
+ description: |-
+ Set overwrites the request with the given header (name, value)
+ before the action.
+
+
+ Input:
+ GET /foo HTTP/1.1
+ my-header: foo
+
+
+ Config:
+ set:
+ - name: "my-header"
+ value: "bar"
+
+
+ Output:
+ GET /foo HTTP/1.1
+ my-header: bar
+ items:
+ description: HTTPHeader represents an HTTP
+ Header name and value as defined by RFC
+ 7230.
+ properties:
+ name:
+ description: |-
+ Name is the name of the HTTP Header to be matched. Name matching MUST be
+ case insensitive. (See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc7230#section-3.2).
+
+
+ If multiple entries specify equivalent header names, the first entry with
+ an equivalent name MUST be considered for a match. Subsequent entries
+ with an equivalent header name MUST be ignored. Due to the
+ case-insensitivity of header names, "foo" and "Foo" are considered
+ equivalent.
+ maxLength: 256
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[A-Za-z0-9!#$%&'*+\-.^_\x60|~]+$
+ type: string
+ value:
+ description: Value is the value of HTTP
+ Header to be matched.
+ maxLength: 4096
+ minLength: 1
+ type: string
+ required:
+ - name
+ - value
+ type: object
+ maxItems: 16
+ type: array
+ x-kubernetes-list-map-keys:
+ - name
+ x-kubernetes-list-type: map
+ type: object
+ requestMirror:
+ description: |-
+ RequestMirror defines a schema for a filter that mirrors requests.
+ Requests are sent to the specified destination, but responses from
+ that destination are ignored.
+
+
+ This filter can be used multiple times within the same rule. Note that
+ not all implementations will be able to support mirroring to multiple
+ backends.
+
+
+ Support: Extended
+ properties:
+ backendRef:
+ description: |-
+ BackendRef references a resource where mirrored requests are sent.
+
+
+ Mirrored requests must be sent only to a single destination endpoint
+ within this BackendRef, irrespective of how many endpoints are present
+ within this BackendRef.
+
+
+ If the referent cannot be found, this BackendRef is invalid and must be
+ dropped from the Gateway. The controller must ensure the "ResolvedRefs"
+ condition on the Route status is set to `status: False` and not configure
+ this backend in the underlying implementation.
+
+
+ If there is a cross-namespace reference to an *existing* object
+ that is not allowed by a ReferenceGrant, the controller must ensure the
+ "ResolvedRefs" condition on the Route is set to `status: False`,
+ with the "RefNotPermitted" reason and not configure this backend in the
+ underlying implementation.
+
+
+ In either error case, the Message of the `ResolvedRefs` Condition
+ should be used to provide more detail about the problem.
+
+
+ Support: Extended for Kubernetes Service
+
+
+ Support: Implementation-specific for any other resource
+ properties:
+ group:
+ default: ""
+ description: |-
+ Group is the group of the referent. For example, "gateway.networking.k8s.io".
+ When unspecified or empty string, core API group is inferred.
+ maxLength: 253
+ pattern: ^$|^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$
+ type: string
+ kind:
+ default: Service
+ description: |-
+ Kind is the Kubernetes resource kind of the referent. For example
+ "Service".
+
+
+ Defaults to "Service" when not specified.
+
+
+ ExternalName services can refer to CNAME DNS records that may live
+ outside of the cluster and as such are difficult to reason about in
+ terms of conformance. They also may not be safe to forward to (see
+ CVE-2021-25740 for more information). Implementations SHOULD NOT
+ support ExternalName Services.
+
+
+ Support: Core (Services with a type other than ExternalName)
+
+
+ Support: Implementation-specific (Services with type ExternalName)
+ maxLength: 63
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[a-zA-Z]([-a-zA-Z0-9]*[a-zA-Z0-9])?$
+ type: string
+ name:
+ description: Name is the name of the referent.
+ maxLength: 253
+ minLength: 1
+ type: string
+ namespace:
+ description: |-
+ Namespace is the namespace of the backend. When unspecified, the local
+ namespace is inferred.
+
+
+ Note that when a namespace different than the local namespace is specified,
+ a ReferenceGrant object is required in the referent namespace to allow that
+ namespace's owner to accept the reference. See the ReferenceGrant
+ documentation for details.
+
+
+ Support: Core
+ maxLength: 63
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?$
+ type: string
+ port:
+ description: |-
+ Port specifies the destination port number to use for this resource.
+ Port is required when the referent is a Kubernetes Service. In this
+ case, the port number is the service port number, not the target port.
+ For other resources, destination port might be derived from the referent
+ resource or this field.
+ format: int32
+ maximum: 65535
+ minimum: 1
+ type: integer
+ required:
+ - name
+ type: object
+ x-kubernetes-validations:
+ - message: Must have port for Service reference
+ rule: '(size(self.group) == 0 && self.kind
+ == ''Service'') ? has(self.port) : true'
+ required:
+ - backendRef
+ type: object
+ requestRedirect:
+ description: |-
+ RequestRedirect defines a schema for a filter that responds to the
+ request with an HTTP redirection.
+
+
+ Support: Core
+ properties:
+ hostname:
+ description: |-
+ Hostname is the hostname to be used in the value of the `Location`
+ header in the response.
+ When empty, the hostname in the `Host` header of the request is used.
+
+
+ Support: Core
+ maxLength: 253
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$
+ type: string
+ path:
+ description: |-
+ Path defines parameters used to modify the path of the incoming request.
+ The modified path is then used to construct the `Location` header. When
+ empty, the request path is used as-is.
+
+
+ Support: Extended
+ properties:
+ replaceFullPath:
+ description: |-
+ ReplaceFullPath specifies the value with which to replace the full path
+ of a request during a rewrite or redirect.
+ maxLength: 1024
+ type: string
+ replacePrefixMatch:
+ description: |-
+ ReplacePrefixMatch specifies the value with which to replace the prefix
+ match of a request during a rewrite or redirect. For example, a request
+ to "/foo/bar" with a prefix match of "/foo" and a ReplacePrefixMatch
+ of "/xyz" would be modified to "/xyz/bar".
+
+
+ Note that this matches the behavior of the PathPrefix match type. This
+ matches full path elements. A path element refers to the list of labels
+ in the path split by the `/` separator. When specified, a trailing `/` is
+ ignored. For example, the paths `/abc`, `/abc/`, and `/abc/def` would all
+ match the prefix `/abc`, but the path `/abcd` would not.
+
+
+ ReplacePrefixMatch is only compatible with a `PathPrefix` HTTPRouteMatch.
+ Using any other HTTPRouteMatch type on the same HTTPRouteRule will result in
+ the implementation setting the Accepted Condition for the Route to `status: False`.
+
+
+ Request Path | Prefix Match | Replace Prefix | Modified Path
+ -------------|--------------|----------------|----------
+ /foo/bar | /foo | /xyz | /xyz/bar
+ /foo/bar | /foo | /xyz/ | /xyz/bar
+ /foo/bar | /foo/ | /xyz | /xyz/bar
+ /foo/bar | /foo/ | /xyz/ | /xyz/bar
+ /foo | /foo | /xyz | /xyz
+ /foo/ | /foo | /xyz | /xyz/
+ /foo/bar | /foo | | /bar
+ /foo/ | /foo | | /
+ /foo | /foo | | /
+ /foo/ | /foo | / | /
+ /foo | /foo | / | /
+ maxLength: 1024
+ type: string
+ type:
+ description: |-
+ Type defines the type of path modifier. Additional types may be
+ added in a future release of the API.
+
+
+ Note that values may be added to this enum, implementations
+ must ensure that unknown values will not cause a crash.
+
+
+ Unknown values here must result in the implementation setting the
+ Accepted Condition for the Route to `status: False`, with a
+ Reason of `UnsupportedValue`.
+ enum:
+ - ReplaceFullPath
+ - ReplacePrefixMatch
+ type: string
+ required:
+ - type
+ type: object
+ x-kubernetes-validations:
+ - message: replaceFullPath must be specified
+ when type is set to 'ReplaceFullPath'
+ rule: 'self.type == ''ReplaceFullPath'' ?
+ has(self.replaceFullPath) : true'
+ - message: type must be 'ReplaceFullPath' when
+ replaceFullPath is set
+ rule: 'has(self.replaceFullPath) ? self.type
+ == ''ReplaceFullPath'' : true'
+ - message: replacePrefixMatch must be specified
+ when type is set to 'ReplacePrefixMatch'
+ rule: 'self.type == ''ReplacePrefixMatch''
+ ? has(self.replacePrefixMatch) : true'
+ - message: type must be 'ReplacePrefixMatch'
+ when replacePrefixMatch is set
+ rule: 'has(self.replacePrefixMatch) ? self.type
+ == ''ReplacePrefixMatch'' : true'
+ port:
+ description: |-
+ Port is the port to be used in the value of the `Location`
+ header in the response.
+
+
+ If no port is specified, the redirect port MUST be derived using the
+ following rules:
+
+
+ * If redirect scheme is not-empty, the redirect port MUST be the well-known
+ port associated with the redirect scheme. Specifically "http" to port 80
+ and "https" to port 443. If the redirect scheme does not have a
+ well-known port, the listener port of the Gateway SHOULD be used.
+ * If redirect scheme is empty, the redirect port MUST be the Gateway
+ Listener port.
+
+
+ Implementations SHOULD NOT add the port number in the 'Location'
+ header in the following cases:
+
+
+ * A Location header that will use HTTP (whether that is determined via
+ the Listener protocol or the Scheme field) _and_ use port 80.
+ * A Location header that will use HTTPS (whether that is determined via
+ the Listener protocol or the Scheme field) _and_ use port 443.
+
+
+ Support: Extended
+ format: int32
+ maximum: 65535
+ minimum: 1
+ type: integer
+ scheme:
+ description: |-
+ Scheme is the scheme to be used in the value of the `Location` header in
+ the response. When empty, the scheme of the request is used.
+
+
+ Scheme redirects can affect the port of the redirect, for more information,
+ refer to the documentation for the port field of this filter.
+
+
+ Note that values may be added to this enum, implementations
+ must ensure that unknown values will not cause a crash.
+
+
+ Unknown values here must result in the implementation setting the
+ Accepted Condition for the Route to `status: False`, with a
+ Reason of `UnsupportedValue`.
+
+
+ Support: Extended
+ enum:
+ - http
+ - https
+ type: string
+ statusCode:
+ default: 302
+ description: |-
+ StatusCode is the HTTP status code to be used in response.
+
+
+ Note that values may be added to this enum, implementations
+ must ensure that unknown values will not cause a crash.
+
+
+ Unknown values here must result in the implementation setting the
+ Accepted Condition for the Route to `status: False`, with a
+ Reason of `UnsupportedValue`.
+
+
+ Support: Core
+ enum:
+ - 301
+ - 302
+ type: integer
+ type: object
+ responseHeaderModifier:
+ description: |-
+ ResponseHeaderModifier defines a schema for a filter that modifies response
+ headers.
+
+
+ Support: Extended
+ properties:
+ add:
+ description: |-
+ Add adds the given header(s) (name, value) to the request
+ before the action. It appends to any existing values associated
+ with the header name.
+
+
+ Input:
+ GET /foo HTTP/1.1
+ my-header: foo
+
+
+ Config:
+ add:
+ - name: "my-header"
+ value: "bar,baz"
+
+
+ Output:
+ GET /foo HTTP/1.1
+ my-header: foo,bar,baz
+ items:
+ description: HTTPHeader represents an HTTP
+ Header name and value as defined by RFC
+ 7230.
+ properties:
+ name:
+ description: |-
+ Name is the name of the HTTP Header to be matched. Name matching MUST be
+ case insensitive. (See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc7230#section-3.2).
+
+
+ If multiple entries specify equivalent header names, the first entry with
+ an equivalent name MUST be considered for a match. Subsequent entries
+ with an equivalent header name MUST be ignored. Due to the
+ case-insensitivity of header names, "foo" and "Foo" are considered
+ equivalent.
+ maxLength: 256
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[A-Za-z0-9!#$%&'*+\-.^_\x60|~]+$
+ type: string
+ value:
+ description: Value is the value of HTTP
+ Header to be matched.
+ maxLength: 4096
+ minLength: 1
+ type: string
+ required:
+ - name
+ - value
+ type: object
+ maxItems: 16
+ type: array
+ x-kubernetes-list-map-keys:
+ - name
+ x-kubernetes-list-type: map
+ remove:
+ description: |-
+ Remove the given header(s) from the HTTP request before the action. The
+ value of Remove is a list of HTTP header names. Note that the header
+ names are case-insensitive (see
+ https://datatracker.ietf.org/doc/html/rfc2616#section-4.2).
+
+
+ Input:
+ GET /foo HTTP/1.1
+ my-header1: foo
+ my-header2: bar
+ my-header3: baz
+
+
+ Config:
+ remove: ["my-header1", "my-header3"]
+
+
+ Output:
+ GET /foo HTTP/1.1
+ my-header2: bar
+ items:
+ type: string
+ maxItems: 16
+ type: array
+ x-kubernetes-list-type: set
+ set:
+ description: |-
+ Set overwrites the request with the given header (name, value)
+ before the action.
+
+
+ Input:
+ GET /foo HTTP/1.1
+ my-header: foo
+
+
+ Config:
+ set:
+ - name: "my-header"
+ value: "bar"
+
+
+ Output:
+ GET /foo HTTP/1.1
+ my-header: bar
+ items:
+ description: HTTPHeader represents an HTTP
+ Header name and value as defined by RFC
+ 7230.
+ properties:
+ name:
+ description: |-
+ Name is the name of the HTTP Header to be matched. Name matching MUST be
+ case insensitive. (See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc7230#section-3.2).
+
+
+ If multiple entries specify equivalent header names, the first entry with
+ an equivalent name MUST be considered for a match. Subsequent entries
+ with an equivalent header name MUST be ignored. Due to the
+ case-insensitivity of header names, "foo" and "Foo" are considered
+ equivalent.
+ maxLength: 256
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[A-Za-z0-9!#$%&'*+\-.^_\x60|~]+$
+ type: string
+ value:
+ description: Value is the value of HTTP
+ Header to be matched.
+ maxLength: 4096
+ minLength: 1
+ type: string
+ required:
+ - name
+ - value
+ type: object
+ maxItems: 16
+ type: array
+ x-kubernetes-list-map-keys:
+ - name
+ x-kubernetes-list-type: map
+ type: object
+ type:
+ description: |-
+ Type identifies the type of filter to apply. As with other API fields,
+ types are classified into three conformance levels:
+
+
+ - Core: Filter types and their corresponding configuration defined by
+ "Support: Core" in this package, e.g. "RequestHeaderModifier". All
+ implementations must support core filters.
+
+
+ - Extended: Filter types and their corresponding configuration defined by
+ "Support: Extended" in this package, e.g. "RequestMirror". Implementers
+ are encouraged to support extended filters.
+
+
+ - Implementation-specific: Filters that are defined and supported by
+ specific vendors.
+ In the future, filters showing convergence in behavior across multiple
+ implementations will be considered for inclusion in extended or core
+ conformance levels. Filter-specific configuration for such filters
+ is specified using the ExtensionRef field. `Type` should be set to
+ "ExtensionRef" for custom filters.
+
+
+ Implementers are encouraged to define custom implementation types to
+ extend the core API with implementation-specific behavior.
+
+
+ If a reference to a custom filter type cannot be resolved, the filter
+ MUST NOT be skipped. Instead, requests that would have been processed by
+ that filter MUST receive a HTTP error response.
+
+
+ Note that values may be added to this enum, implementations
+ must ensure that unknown values will not cause a crash.
+
+
+ Unknown values here must result in the implementation setting the
+ Accepted Condition for the Route to `status: False`, with a
+ Reason of `UnsupportedValue`.
+ enum:
+ - RequestHeaderModifier
+ - ResponseHeaderModifier
+ - RequestMirror
+ - RequestRedirect
+ - URLRewrite
+ - ExtensionRef
+ type: string
+ urlRewrite:
+ description: |-
+ URLRewrite defines a schema for a filter that modifies a request during forwarding.
+
+
+ Support: Extended
+ properties:
+ hostname:
+ description: |-
+ Hostname is the value to be used to replace the Host header value during
+ forwarding.
+
+
+ Support: Extended
+ maxLength: 253
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$
+ type: string
+ path:
+ description: |-
+ Path defines a path rewrite.
+
+
+ Support: Extended
+ properties:
+ replaceFullPath:
+ description: |-
+ ReplaceFullPath specifies the value with which to replace the full path
+ of a request during a rewrite or redirect.
+ maxLength: 1024
+ type: string
+ replacePrefixMatch:
+ description: |-
+ ReplacePrefixMatch specifies the value with which to replace the prefix
+ match of a request during a rewrite or redirect. For example, a request
+ to "/foo/bar" with a prefix match of "/foo" and a ReplacePrefixMatch
+ of "/xyz" would be modified to "/xyz/bar".
+
+
+ Note that this matches the behavior of the PathPrefix match type. This
+ matches full path elements. A path element refers to the list of labels
+ in the path split by the `/` separator. When specified, a trailing `/` is
+ ignored. For example, the paths `/abc`, `/abc/`, and `/abc/def` would all
+ match the prefix `/abc`, but the path `/abcd` would not.
+
+
+ ReplacePrefixMatch is only compatible with a `PathPrefix` HTTPRouteMatch.
+ Using any other HTTPRouteMatch type on the same HTTPRouteRule will result in
+ the implementation setting the Accepted Condition for the Route to `status: False`.
+
+
+ Request Path | Prefix Match | Replace Prefix | Modified Path
+ -------------|--------------|----------------|----------
+ /foo/bar | /foo | /xyz | /xyz/bar
+ /foo/bar | /foo | /xyz/ | /xyz/bar
+ /foo/bar | /foo/ | /xyz | /xyz/bar
+ /foo/bar | /foo/ | /xyz/ | /xyz/bar
+ /foo | /foo | /xyz | /xyz
+ /foo/ | /foo | /xyz | /xyz/
+ /foo/bar | /foo | | /bar
+ /foo/ | /foo | | /
+ /foo | /foo | | /
+ /foo/ | /foo | / | /
+ /foo | /foo | / | /
+ maxLength: 1024
+ type: string
+ type:
+ description: |-
+ Type defines the type of path modifier. Additional types may be
+ added in a future release of the API.
+
+
+ Note that values may be added to this enum, implementations
+ must ensure that unknown values will not cause a crash.
+
+
+ Unknown values here must result in the implementation setting the
+ Accepted Condition for the Route to `status: False`, with a
+ Reason of `UnsupportedValue`.
+ enum:
+ - ReplaceFullPath
+ - ReplacePrefixMatch
+ type: string
+ required:
+ - type
+ type: object
+ x-kubernetes-validations:
+ - message: replaceFullPath must be specified
+ when type is set to 'ReplaceFullPath'
+ rule: 'self.type == ''ReplaceFullPath'' ?
+ has(self.replaceFullPath) : true'
+ - message: type must be 'ReplaceFullPath' when
+ replaceFullPath is set
+ rule: 'has(self.replaceFullPath) ? self.type
+ == ''ReplaceFullPath'' : true'
+ - message: replacePrefixMatch must be specified
+ when type is set to 'ReplacePrefixMatch'
+ rule: 'self.type == ''ReplacePrefixMatch''
+ ? has(self.replacePrefixMatch) : true'
+ - message: type must be 'ReplacePrefixMatch'
+ when replacePrefixMatch is set
+ rule: 'has(self.replacePrefixMatch) ? self.type
+ == ''ReplacePrefixMatch'' : true'
+ type: object
+ required:
+ - type
+ type: object
+ x-kubernetes-validations:
+ - message: filter.requestHeaderModifier must be nil
+ if the filter.type is not RequestHeaderModifier
+ rule: '!(has(self.requestHeaderModifier) && self.type
+ != ''RequestHeaderModifier'')'
+ - message: filter.requestHeaderModifier must be specified
+ for RequestHeaderModifier filter.type
+ rule: '!(!has(self.requestHeaderModifier) && self.type
+ == ''RequestHeaderModifier'')'
+ - message: filter.responseHeaderModifier must be nil
+ if the filter.type is not ResponseHeaderModifier
+ rule: '!(has(self.responseHeaderModifier) && self.type
+ != ''ResponseHeaderModifier'')'
+ - message: filter.responseHeaderModifier must be specified
+ for ResponseHeaderModifier filter.type
+ rule: '!(!has(self.responseHeaderModifier) && self.type
+ == ''ResponseHeaderModifier'')'
+ - message: filter.requestMirror must be nil if the filter.type
+ is not RequestMirror
+ rule: '!(has(self.requestMirror) && self.type != ''RequestMirror'')'
+ - message: filter.requestMirror must be specified for
+ RequestMirror filter.type
+ rule: '!(!has(self.requestMirror) && self.type ==
+ ''RequestMirror'')'
+ - message: filter.requestRedirect must be nil if the
+ filter.type is not RequestRedirect
+ rule: '!(has(self.requestRedirect) && self.type !=
+ ''RequestRedirect'')'
+ - message: filter.requestRedirect must be specified
+ for RequestRedirect filter.type
+ rule: '!(!has(self.requestRedirect) && self.type ==
+ ''RequestRedirect'')'
+ - message: filter.urlRewrite must be nil if the filter.type
+ is not URLRewrite
+ rule: '!(has(self.urlRewrite) && self.type != ''URLRewrite'')'
+ - message: filter.urlRewrite must be specified for URLRewrite
+ filter.type
+ rule: '!(!has(self.urlRewrite) && self.type == ''URLRewrite'')'
+ - message: filter.extensionRef must be nil if the filter.type
+ is not ExtensionRef
+ rule: '!(has(self.extensionRef) && self.type != ''ExtensionRef'')'
+ - message: filter.extensionRef must be specified for
+ ExtensionRef filter.type
+ rule: '!(!has(self.extensionRef) && self.type == ''ExtensionRef'')'
+ maxItems: 16
+ type: array
+ x-kubernetes-validations:
+ - message: May specify either httpRouteFilterRequestRedirect
+ or httpRouteFilterRequestRewrite, but not both
+ rule: '!(self.exists(f, f.type == ''RequestRedirect'')
+ && self.exists(f, f.type == ''URLRewrite''))'
+ - message: May specify either httpRouteFilterRequestRedirect
+ or httpRouteFilterRequestRewrite, but not both
+ rule: '!(self.exists(f, f.type == ''RequestRedirect'')
+ && self.exists(f, f.type == ''URLRewrite''))'
+ - message: RequestHeaderModifier filter cannot be repeated
+ rule: self.filter(f, f.type == 'RequestHeaderModifier').size()
+ <= 1
+ - message: ResponseHeaderModifier filter cannot be repeated
+ rule: self.filter(f, f.type == 'ResponseHeaderModifier').size()
+ <= 1
+ - message: RequestRedirect filter cannot be repeated
+ rule: self.filter(f, f.type == 'RequestRedirect').size()
+ <= 1
+ - message: URLRewrite filter cannot be repeated
+ rule: self.filter(f, f.type == 'URLRewrite').size()
+ <= 1
+ group:
+ default: ""
+ description: |-
+ Group is the group of the referent. For example, "gateway.networking.k8s.io".
+ When unspecified or empty string, core API group is inferred.
+ maxLength: 253
+ pattern: ^$|^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$
+ type: string
+ kind:
+ default: Service
+ description: |-
+ Kind is the Kubernetes resource kind of the referent. For example
+ "Service".
+
+
+ Defaults to "Service" when not specified.
+
+
+ ExternalName services can refer to CNAME DNS records that may live
+ outside of the cluster and as such are difficult to reason about in
+ terms of conformance. They also may not be safe to forward to (see
+ CVE-2021-25740 for more information). Implementations SHOULD NOT
+ support ExternalName Services.
+
+
+ Support: Core (Services with a type other than ExternalName)
+
+
+ Support: Implementation-specific (Services with type ExternalName)
+ maxLength: 63
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[a-zA-Z]([-a-zA-Z0-9]*[a-zA-Z0-9])?$
+ type: string
+ name:
+ description: Name is the name of the referent.
+ maxLength: 253
+ minLength: 1
+ type: string
+ namespace:
+ description: |-
+ Namespace is the namespace of the backend. When unspecified, the local
+ namespace is inferred.
+
+
+ Note that when a namespace different than the local namespace is specified,
+ a ReferenceGrant object is required in the referent namespace to allow that
+ namespace's owner to accept the reference. See the ReferenceGrant
+ documentation for details.
+
+
+ Support: Core
+ maxLength: 63
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?$
+ type: string
+ port:
+ description: |-
+ Port specifies the destination port number to use for this resource.
+ Port is required when the referent is a Kubernetes Service. In this
+ case, the port number is the service port number, not the target port.
+ For other resources, destination port might be derived from the referent
+ resource or this field.
+ format: int32
+ maximum: 65535
+ minimum: 1
+ type: integer
+ weight:
+ default: 1
+ description: |-
+ Weight specifies the proportion of requests forwarded to the referenced
+ backend. This is computed as weight/(sum of all weights in this
+ BackendRefs list). For non-zero values, there may be some epsilon from
+ the exact proportion defined here depending on the precision an
+ implementation supports. Weight is not a percentage and the sum of
+ weights does not need to equal 100.
+
+
+ If only one backend is specified and it has a weight greater than 0, 100%
+ of the traffic is forwarded to that backend. If weight is set to 0, no
+ traffic should be forwarded for this entry. If unspecified, weight
+ defaults to 1.
+
+
+ Support for this field varies based on the context where used.
+ format: int32
+ maximum: 1000000
+ minimum: 0
+ type: integer
+ required:
+ - name
+ type: object
+ x-kubernetes-validations:
+ - message: Must have port for Service reference
+ rule: '(size(self.group) == 0 && self.kind == ''Service'')
+ ? has(self.port) : true'
+ maxItems: 16
+ type: array
+ filters:
+ description: |-
+ Filters define the filters that are applied to requests that match
+ this rule.
+
+
+ Wherever possible, implementations SHOULD implement filters in the order
+ they are specified.
+
+
+ Implementations MAY choose to implement this ordering strictly, rejecting
+ any combination or order of filters that can not be supported. If implementations
+ choose a strict interpretation of filter ordering, they MUST clearly document
+ that behavior.
+
+
+ To reject an invalid combination or order of filters, implementations SHOULD
+ consider the Route Rules with this configuration invalid. If all Route Rules
+ in a Route are invalid, the entire Route would be considered invalid. If only
+ a portion of Route Rules are invalid, implementations MUST set the
+ "PartiallyInvalid" condition for the Route.
+
+
+ Conformance-levels at this level are defined based on the type of filter:
+
+
+ - ALL core filters MUST be supported by all implementations.
+ - Implementers are encouraged to support extended filters.
+ - Implementation-specific custom filters have no API guarantees across
+ implementations.
+
+
+ Specifying the same filter multiple times is not supported unless explicitly
+ indicated in the filter.
+
+
+ All filters are expected to be compatible with each other except for the
+ URLRewrite and RequestRedirect filters, which may not be combined. If an
+ implementation can not support other combinations of filters, they must clearly
+ document that limitation. In cases where incompatible or unsupported
+ filters are specified and cause the `Accepted` condition to be set to status
+ `False`, implementations may use the `IncompatibleFilters` reason to specify
+ this configuration error.
+
+
+ Support: Core
+ items:
+ description: |-
+ HTTPRouteFilter defines processing steps that must be completed during the
+ request or response lifecycle. HTTPRouteFilters are meant as an extension
+ point to express processing that may be done in Gateway implementations. Some
+ examples include request or response modification, implementing
+ authentication strategies, rate-limiting, and traffic shaping. API
+ guarantee/conformance is defined based on the type of the filter.
+ properties:
+ extensionRef:
+ description: |-
+ ExtensionRef is an optional, implementation-specific extension to the
+ "filter" behavior. For example, resource "myroutefilter" in group
+ "networking.example.net"). ExtensionRef MUST NOT be used for core and
+ extended filters.
+
+
+ This filter can be used multiple times within the same rule.
+
+
+ Support: Implementation-specific
+ properties:
+ group:
+ description: |-
+ Group is the group of the referent. For example, "gateway.networking.k8s.io".
+ When unspecified or empty string, core API group is inferred.
+ maxLength: 253
+ pattern: ^$|^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$
+ type: string
+ kind:
+ description: Kind is kind of the referent. For example
+ "HTTPRoute" or "Service".
+ maxLength: 63
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[a-zA-Z]([-a-zA-Z0-9]*[a-zA-Z0-9])?$
+ type: string
+ name:
+ description: Name is the name of the referent.
+ maxLength: 253
+ minLength: 1
+ type: string
+ required:
+ - group
+ - kind
+ - name
+ type: object
+ requestHeaderModifier:
+ description: |-
+ RequestHeaderModifier defines a schema for a filter that modifies request
+ headers.
+
+
+ Support: Core
+ properties:
+ add:
+ description: |-
+ Add adds the given header(s) (name, value) to the request
+ before the action. It appends to any existing values associated
+ with the header name.
+
+
+ Input:
+ GET /foo HTTP/1.1
+ my-header: foo
+
+
+ Config:
+ add:
+ - name: "my-header"
+ value: "bar,baz"
+
+
+ Output:
+ GET /foo HTTP/1.1
+ my-header: foo,bar,baz
+ items:
+ description: HTTPHeader represents an HTTP Header
+ name and value as defined by RFC 7230.
+ properties:
+ name:
+ description: |-
+ Name is the name of the HTTP Header to be matched. Name matching MUST be
+ case insensitive. (See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc7230#section-3.2).
+
+
+ If multiple entries specify equivalent header names, the first entry with
+ an equivalent name MUST be considered for a match. Subsequent entries
+ with an equivalent header name MUST be ignored. Due to the
+ case-insensitivity of header names, "foo" and "Foo" are considered
+ equivalent.
+ maxLength: 256
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[A-Za-z0-9!#$%&'*+\-.^_\x60|~]+$
+ type: string
+ value:
+ description: Value is the value of HTTP Header
+ to be matched.
+ maxLength: 4096
+ minLength: 1
+ type: string
+ required:
+ - name
+ - value
+ type: object
+ maxItems: 16
+ type: array
+ x-kubernetes-list-map-keys:
+ - name
+ x-kubernetes-list-type: map
+ remove:
+ description: |-
+ Remove the given header(s) from the HTTP request before the action. The
+ value of Remove is a list of HTTP header names. Note that the header
+ names are case-insensitive (see
+ https://datatracker.ietf.org/doc/html/rfc2616#section-4.2).
+
+
+ Input:
+ GET /foo HTTP/1.1
+ my-header1: foo
+ my-header2: bar
+ my-header3: baz
+
+
+ Config:
+ remove: ["my-header1", "my-header3"]
+
+
+ Output:
+ GET /foo HTTP/1.1
+ my-header2: bar
+ items:
+ type: string
+ maxItems: 16
+ type: array
+ x-kubernetes-list-type: set
+ set:
+ description: |-
+ Set overwrites the request with the given header (name, value)
+ before the action.
+
+
+ Input:
+ GET /foo HTTP/1.1
+ my-header: foo
+
+
+ Config:
+ set:
+ - name: "my-header"
+ value: "bar"
+
+
+ Output:
+ GET /foo HTTP/1.1
+ my-header: bar
+ items:
+ description: HTTPHeader represents an HTTP Header
+ name and value as defined by RFC 7230.
+ properties:
+ name:
+ description: |-
+ Name is the name of the HTTP Header to be matched. Name matching MUST be
+ case insensitive. (See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc7230#section-3.2).
+
+
+ If multiple entries specify equivalent header names, the first entry with
+ an equivalent name MUST be considered for a match. Subsequent entries
+ with an equivalent header name MUST be ignored. Due to the
+ case-insensitivity of header names, "foo" and "Foo" are considered
+ equivalent.
+ maxLength: 256
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[A-Za-z0-9!#$%&'*+\-.^_\x60|~]+$
+ type: string
+ value:
+ description: Value is the value of HTTP Header
+ to be matched.
+ maxLength: 4096
+ minLength: 1
+ type: string
+ required:
+ - name
+ - value
+ type: object
+ maxItems: 16
+ type: array
+ x-kubernetes-list-map-keys:
+ - name
+ x-kubernetes-list-type: map
+ type: object
+ requestMirror:
+ description: |-
+ RequestMirror defines a schema for a filter that mirrors requests.
+ Requests are sent to the specified destination, but responses from
+ that destination are ignored.
+
+
+ This filter can be used multiple times within the same rule. Note that
+ not all implementations will be able to support mirroring to multiple
+ backends.
+
+
+ Support: Extended
+ properties:
+ backendRef:
+ description: |-
+ BackendRef references a resource where mirrored requests are sent.
+
+
+ Mirrored requests must be sent only to a single destination endpoint
+ within this BackendRef, irrespective of how many endpoints are present
+ within this BackendRef.
+
+
+ If the referent cannot be found, this BackendRef is invalid and must be
+ dropped from the Gateway. The controller must ensure the "ResolvedRefs"
+ condition on the Route status is set to `status: False` and not configure
+ this backend in the underlying implementation.
+
+
+ If there is a cross-namespace reference to an *existing* object
+ that is not allowed by a ReferenceGrant, the controller must ensure the
+ "ResolvedRefs" condition on the Route is set to `status: False`,
+ with the "RefNotPermitted" reason and not configure this backend in the
+ underlying implementation.
+
+
+ In either error case, the Message of the `ResolvedRefs` Condition
+ should be used to provide more detail about the problem.
+
+
+ Support: Extended for Kubernetes Service
+
+
+ Support: Implementation-specific for any other resource
+ properties:
+ group:
+ default: ""
+ description: |-
+ Group is the group of the referent. For example, "gateway.networking.k8s.io".
+ When unspecified or empty string, core API group is inferred.
+ maxLength: 253
+ pattern: ^$|^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$
+ type: string
+ kind:
+ default: Service
+ description: |-
+ Kind is the Kubernetes resource kind of the referent. For example
+ "Service".
+
+
+ Defaults to "Service" when not specified.
+
+
+ ExternalName services can refer to CNAME DNS records that may live
+ outside of the cluster and as such are difficult to reason about in
+ terms of conformance. They also may not be safe to forward to (see
+ CVE-2021-25740 for more information). Implementations SHOULD NOT
+ support ExternalName Services.
+
+
+ Support: Core (Services with a type other than ExternalName)
+
+
+ Support: Implementation-specific (Services with type ExternalName)
+ maxLength: 63
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[a-zA-Z]([-a-zA-Z0-9]*[a-zA-Z0-9])?$
+ type: string
+ name:
+ description: Name is the name of the referent.
+ maxLength: 253
+ minLength: 1
+ type: string
+ namespace:
+ description: |-
+ Namespace is the namespace of the backend. When unspecified, the local
+ namespace is inferred.
+
+
+ Note that when a namespace different than the local namespace is specified,
+ a ReferenceGrant object is required in the referent namespace to allow that
+ namespace's owner to accept the reference. See the ReferenceGrant
+ documentation for details.
+
+
+ Support: Core
+ maxLength: 63
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?$
+ type: string
+ port:
+ description: |-
+ Port specifies the destination port number to use for this resource.
+ Port is required when the referent is a Kubernetes Service. In this
+ case, the port number is the service port number, not the target port.
+ For other resources, destination port might be derived from the referent
+ resource or this field.
+ format: int32
+ maximum: 65535
+ minimum: 1
+ type: integer
+ required:
+ - name
+ type: object
+ x-kubernetes-validations:
+ - message: Must have port for Service reference
+ rule: '(size(self.group) == 0 && self.kind == ''Service'')
+ ? has(self.port) : true'
+ required:
+ - backendRef
+ type: object
+ requestRedirect:
+ description: |-
+ RequestRedirect defines a schema for a filter that responds to the
+ request with an HTTP redirection.
+
+
+ Support: Core
+ properties:
+ hostname:
+ description: |-
+ Hostname is the hostname to be used in the value of the `Location`
+ header in the response.
+ When empty, the hostname in the `Host` header of the request is used.
+
+
+ Support: Core
+ maxLength: 253
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$
+ type: string
+ path:
+ description: |-
+ Path defines parameters used to modify the path of the incoming request.
+ The modified path is then used to construct the `Location` header. When
+ empty, the request path is used as-is.
+
+
+ Support: Extended
+ properties:
+ replaceFullPath:
+ description: |-
+ ReplaceFullPath specifies the value with which to replace the full path
+ of a request during a rewrite or redirect.
+ maxLength: 1024
+ type: string
+ replacePrefixMatch:
+ description: |-
+ ReplacePrefixMatch specifies the value with which to replace the prefix
+ match of a request during a rewrite or redirect. For example, a request
+ to "/foo/bar" with a prefix match of "/foo" and a ReplacePrefixMatch
+ of "/xyz" would be modified to "/xyz/bar".
+
+
+ Note that this matches the behavior of the PathPrefix match type. This
+ matches full path elements. A path element refers to the list of labels
+ in the path split by the `/` separator. When specified, a trailing `/` is
+ ignored. For example, the paths `/abc`, `/abc/`, and `/abc/def` would all
+ match the prefix `/abc`, but the path `/abcd` would not.
+
+
+ ReplacePrefixMatch is only compatible with a `PathPrefix` HTTPRouteMatch.
+ Using any other HTTPRouteMatch type on the same HTTPRouteRule will result in
+ the implementation setting the Accepted Condition for the Route to `status: False`.
+
+
+ Request Path | Prefix Match | Replace Prefix | Modified Path
+ -------------|--------------|----------------|----------
+ /foo/bar | /foo | /xyz | /xyz/bar
+ /foo/bar | /foo | /xyz/ | /xyz/bar
+ /foo/bar | /foo/ | /xyz | /xyz/bar
+ /foo/bar | /foo/ | /xyz/ | /xyz/bar
+ /foo | /foo | /xyz | /xyz
+ /foo/ | /foo | /xyz | /xyz/
+ /foo/bar | /foo | | /bar
+ /foo/ | /foo | | /
+ /foo | /foo | | /
+ /foo/ | /foo | / | /
+ /foo | /foo | / | /
+ maxLength: 1024
+ type: string
+ type:
+ description: |-
+ Type defines the type of path modifier. Additional types may be
+ added in a future release of the API.
+
+
+ Note that values may be added to this enum, implementations
+ must ensure that unknown values will not cause a crash.
+
+
+ Unknown values here must result in the implementation setting the
+ Accepted Condition for the Route to `status: False`, with a
+ Reason of `UnsupportedValue`.
+ enum:
+ - ReplaceFullPath
+ - ReplacePrefixMatch
+ type: string
+ required:
+ - type
+ type: object
+ x-kubernetes-validations:
+ - message: replaceFullPath must be specified when
+ type is set to 'ReplaceFullPath'
+ rule: 'self.type == ''ReplaceFullPath'' ? has(self.replaceFullPath)
+ : true'
+ - message: type must be 'ReplaceFullPath' when replaceFullPath
+ is set
+ rule: 'has(self.replaceFullPath) ? self.type ==
+ ''ReplaceFullPath'' : true'
+ - message: replacePrefixMatch must be specified when
+ type is set to 'ReplacePrefixMatch'
+ rule: 'self.type == ''ReplacePrefixMatch'' ? has(self.replacePrefixMatch)
+ : true'
+ - message: type must be 'ReplacePrefixMatch' when
+ replacePrefixMatch is set
+ rule: 'has(self.replacePrefixMatch) ? self.type
+ == ''ReplacePrefixMatch'' : true'
+ port:
+ description: |-
+ Port is the port to be used in the value of the `Location`
+ header in the response.
+
+
+ If no port is specified, the redirect port MUST be derived using the
+ following rules:
+
+
+ * If redirect scheme is not-empty, the redirect port MUST be the well-known
+ port associated with the redirect scheme. Specifically "http" to port 80
+ and "https" to port 443. If the redirect scheme does not have a
+ well-known port, the listener port of the Gateway SHOULD be used.
+ * If redirect scheme is empty, the redirect port MUST be the Gateway
+ Listener port.
+
+
+ Implementations SHOULD NOT add the port number in the 'Location'
+ header in the following cases:
+
+
+ * A Location header that will use HTTP (whether that is determined via
+ the Listener protocol or the Scheme field) _and_ use port 80.
+ * A Location header that will use HTTPS (whether that is determined via
+ the Listener protocol or the Scheme field) _and_ use port 443.
+
+
+ Support: Extended
+ format: int32
+ maximum: 65535
+ minimum: 1
+ type: integer
+ scheme:
+ description: |-
+ Scheme is the scheme to be used in the value of the `Location` header in
+ the response. When empty, the scheme of the request is used.
+
+
+ Scheme redirects can affect the port of the redirect, for more information,
+ refer to the documentation for the port field of this filter.
+
+
+ Note that values may be added to this enum, implementations
+ must ensure that unknown values will not cause a crash.
+
+
+ Unknown values here must result in the implementation setting the
+ Accepted Condition for the Route to `status: False`, with a
+ Reason of `UnsupportedValue`.
+
+
+ Support: Extended
+ enum:
+ - http
+ - https
+ type: string
+ statusCode:
+ default: 302
+ description: |-
+ StatusCode is the HTTP status code to be used in response.
+
+
+ Note that values may be added to this enum, implementations
+ must ensure that unknown values will not cause a crash.
+
+
+ Unknown values here must result in the implementation setting the
+ Accepted Condition for the Route to `status: False`, with a
+ Reason of `UnsupportedValue`.
+
+
+ Support: Core
+ enum:
+ - 301
+ - 302
+ type: integer
+ type: object
+ responseHeaderModifier:
+ description: |-
+ ResponseHeaderModifier defines a schema for a filter that modifies response
+ headers.
+
+
+ Support: Extended
+ properties:
+ add:
+ description: |-
+ Add adds the given header(s) (name, value) to the request
+ before the action. It appends to any existing values associated
+ with the header name.
+
+
+ Input:
+ GET /foo HTTP/1.1
+ my-header: foo
+
+
+ Config:
+ add:
+ - name: "my-header"
+ value: "bar,baz"
+
+
+ Output:
+ GET /foo HTTP/1.1
+ my-header: foo,bar,baz
+ items:
+ description: HTTPHeader represents an HTTP Header
+ name and value as defined by RFC 7230.
+ properties:
+ name:
+ description: |-
+ Name is the name of the HTTP Header to be matched. Name matching MUST be
+ case insensitive. (See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc7230#section-3.2).
+
+
+ If multiple entries specify equivalent header names, the first entry with
+ an equivalent name MUST be considered for a match. Subsequent entries
+ with an equivalent header name MUST be ignored. Due to the
+ case-insensitivity of header names, "foo" and "Foo" are considered
+ equivalent.
+ maxLength: 256
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[A-Za-z0-9!#$%&'*+\-.^_\x60|~]+$
+ type: string
+ value:
+ description: Value is the value of HTTP Header
+ to be matched.
+ maxLength: 4096
+ minLength: 1
+ type: string
+ required:
+ - name
+ - value
+ type: object
+ maxItems: 16
+ type: array
+ x-kubernetes-list-map-keys:
+ - name
+ x-kubernetes-list-type: map
+ remove:
+ description: |-
+ Remove the given header(s) from the HTTP request before the action. The
+ value of Remove is a list of HTTP header names. Note that the header
+ names are case-insensitive (see
+ https://datatracker.ietf.org/doc/html/rfc2616#section-4.2).
+
+
+ Input:
+ GET /foo HTTP/1.1
+ my-header1: foo
+ my-header2: bar
+ my-header3: baz
+
+
+ Config:
+ remove: ["my-header1", "my-header3"]
+
+
+ Output:
+ GET /foo HTTP/1.1
+ my-header2: bar
+ items:
+ type: string
+ maxItems: 16
+ type: array
+ x-kubernetes-list-type: set
+ set:
+ description: |-
+ Set overwrites the request with the given header (name, value)
+ before the action.
+
+
+ Input:
+ GET /foo HTTP/1.1
+ my-header: foo
+
+
+ Config:
+ set:
+ - name: "my-header"
+ value: "bar"
+
+
+ Output:
+ GET /foo HTTP/1.1
+ my-header: bar
+ items:
+ description: HTTPHeader represents an HTTP Header
+ name and value as defined by RFC 7230.
+ properties:
+ name:
+ description: |-
+ Name is the name of the HTTP Header to be matched. Name matching MUST be
+ case insensitive. (See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc7230#section-3.2).
+
+
+ If multiple entries specify equivalent header names, the first entry with
+ an equivalent name MUST be considered for a match. Subsequent entries
+ with an equivalent header name MUST be ignored. Due to the
+ case-insensitivity of header names, "foo" and "Foo" are considered
+ equivalent.
+ maxLength: 256
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[A-Za-z0-9!#$%&'*+\-.^_\x60|~]+$
+ type: string
+ value:
+ description: Value is the value of HTTP Header
+ to be matched.
+ maxLength: 4096
+ minLength: 1
+ type: string
+ required:
+ - name
+ - value
+ type: object
+ maxItems: 16
+ type: array
+ x-kubernetes-list-map-keys:
+ - name
+ x-kubernetes-list-type: map
+ type: object
+ type:
+ description: |-
+ Type identifies the type of filter to apply. As with other API fields,
+ types are classified into three conformance levels:
+
+
+ - Core: Filter types and their corresponding configuration defined by
+ "Support: Core" in this package, e.g. "RequestHeaderModifier". All
+ implementations must support core filters.
+
+
+ - Extended: Filter types and their corresponding configuration defined by
+ "Support: Extended" in this package, e.g. "RequestMirror". Implementers
+ are encouraged to support extended filters.
+
+
+ - Implementation-specific: Filters that are defined and supported by
+ specific vendors.
+ In the future, filters showing convergence in behavior across multiple
+ implementations will be considered for inclusion in extended or core
+ conformance levels. Filter-specific configuration for such filters
+ is specified using the ExtensionRef field. `Type` should be set to
+ "ExtensionRef" for custom filters.
+
+
+ Implementers are encouraged to define custom implementation types to
+ extend the core API with implementation-specific behavior.
+
+
+ If a reference to a custom filter type cannot be resolved, the filter
+ MUST NOT be skipped. Instead, requests that would have been processed by
+ that filter MUST receive a HTTP error response.
+
+
+ Note that values may be added to this enum, implementations
+ must ensure that unknown values will not cause a crash.
+
+
+ Unknown values here must result in the implementation setting the
+ Accepted Condition for the Route to `status: False`, with a
+ Reason of `UnsupportedValue`.
+ enum:
+ - RequestHeaderModifier
+ - ResponseHeaderModifier
+ - RequestMirror
+ - RequestRedirect
+ - URLRewrite
+ - ExtensionRef
+ type: string
+ urlRewrite:
+ description: |-
+ URLRewrite defines a schema for a filter that modifies a request during forwarding.
+
+
+ Support: Extended
+ properties:
+ hostname:
+ description: |-
+ Hostname is the value to be used to replace the Host header value during
+ forwarding.
+
+
+ Support: Extended
+ maxLength: 253
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$
+ type: string
+ path:
+ description: |-
+ Path defines a path rewrite.
+
+
+ Support: Extended
+ properties:
+ replaceFullPath:
+ description: |-
+ ReplaceFullPath specifies the value with which to replace the full path
+ of a request during a rewrite or redirect.
+ maxLength: 1024
+ type: string
+ replacePrefixMatch:
+ description: |-
+ ReplacePrefixMatch specifies the value with which to replace the prefix
+ match of a request during a rewrite or redirect. For example, a request
+ to "/foo/bar" with a prefix match of "/foo" and a ReplacePrefixMatch
+ of "/xyz" would be modified to "/xyz/bar".
+
+
+ Note that this matches the behavior of the PathPrefix match type. This
+ matches full path elements. A path element refers to the list of labels
+ in the path split by the `/` separator. When specified, a trailing `/` is
+ ignored. For example, the paths `/abc`, `/abc/`, and `/abc/def` would all
+ match the prefix `/abc`, but the path `/abcd` would not.
+
+
+ ReplacePrefixMatch is only compatible with a `PathPrefix` HTTPRouteMatch.
+ Using any other HTTPRouteMatch type on the same HTTPRouteRule will result in
+ the implementation setting the Accepted Condition for the Route to `status: False`.
+
+
+ Request Path | Prefix Match | Replace Prefix | Modified Path
+ -------------|--------------|----------------|----------
+ /foo/bar | /foo | /xyz | /xyz/bar
+ /foo/bar | /foo | /xyz/ | /xyz/bar
+ /foo/bar | /foo/ | /xyz | /xyz/bar
+ /foo/bar | /foo/ | /xyz/ | /xyz/bar
+ /foo | /foo | /xyz | /xyz
+ /foo/ | /foo | /xyz | /xyz/
+ /foo/bar | /foo | | /bar
+ /foo/ | /foo | | /
+ /foo | /foo | | /
+ /foo/ | /foo | / | /
+ /foo | /foo | / | /
+ maxLength: 1024
+ type: string
+ type:
+ description: |-
+ Type defines the type of path modifier. Additional types may be
+ added in a future release of the API.
+
+
+ Note that values may be added to this enum, implementations
+ must ensure that unknown values will not cause a crash.
+
+
+ Unknown values here must result in the implementation setting the
+ Accepted Condition for the Route to `status: False`, with a
+ Reason of `UnsupportedValue`.
+ enum:
+ - ReplaceFullPath
+ - ReplacePrefixMatch
+ type: string
+ required:
+ - type
+ type: object
+ x-kubernetes-validations:
+ - message: replaceFullPath must be specified when
+ type is set to 'ReplaceFullPath'
+ rule: 'self.type == ''ReplaceFullPath'' ? has(self.replaceFullPath)
+ : true'
+ - message: type must be 'ReplaceFullPath' when replaceFullPath
+ is set
+ rule: 'has(self.replaceFullPath) ? self.type ==
+ ''ReplaceFullPath'' : true'
+ - message: replacePrefixMatch must be specified when
+ type is set to 'ReplacePrefixMatch'
+ rule: 'self.type == ''ReplacePrefixMatch'' ? has(self.replacePrefixMatch)
+ : true'
+ - message: type must be 'ReplacePrefixMatch' when
+ replacePrefixMatch is set
+ rule: 'has(self.replacePrefixMatch) ? self.type
+ == ''ReplacePrefixMatch'' : true'
+ type: object
+ required:
+ - type
+ type: object
+ x-kubernetes-validations:
+ - message: filter.requestHeaderModifier must be nil if the
+ filter.type is not RequestHeaderModifier
+ rule: '!(has(self.requestHeaderModifier) && self.type !=
+ ''RequestHeaderModifier'')'
+ - message: filter.requestHeaderModifier must be specified
+ for RequestHeaderModifier filter.type
+ rule: '!(!has(self.requestHeaderModifier) && self.type ==
+ ''RequestHeaderModifier'')'
+ - message: filter.responseHeaderModifier must be nil if the
+ filter.type is not ResponseHeaderModifier
+ rule: '!(has(self.responseHeaderModifier) && self.type !=
+ ''ResponseHeaderModifier'')'
+ - message: filter.responseHeaderModifier must be specified
+ for ResponseHeaderModifier filter.type
+ rule: '!(!has(self.responseHeaderModifier) && self.type
+ == ''ResponseHeaderModifier'')'
+ - message: filter.requestMirror must be nil if the filter.type
+ is not RequestMirror
+ rule: '!(has(self.requestMirror) && self.type != ''RequestMirror'')'
+ - message: filter.requestMirror must be specified for RequestMirror
+ filter.type
+ rule: '!(!has(self.requestMirror) && self.type == ''RequestMirror'')'
+ - message: filter.requestRedirect must be nil if the filter.type
+ is not RequestRedirect
+ rule: '!(has(self.requestRedirect) && self.type != ''RequestRedirect'')'
+ - message: filter.requestRedirect must be specified for RequestRedirect
+ filter.type
+ rule: '!(!has(self.requestRedirect) && self.type == ''RequestRedirect'')'
+ - message: filter.urlRewrite must be nil if the filter.type
+ is not URLRewrite
+ rule: '!(has(self.urlRewrite) && self.type != ''URLRewrite'')'
+ - message: filter.urlRewrite must be specified for URLRewrite
+ filter.type
+ rule: '!(!has(self.urlRewrite) && self.type == ''URLRewrite'')'
+ - message: filter.extensionRef must be nil if the filter.type
+ is not ExtensionRef
+ rule: '!(has(self.extensionRef) && self.type != ''ExtensionRef'')'
+ - message: filter.extensionRef must be specified for ExtensionRef
+ filter.type
+ rule: '!(!has(self.extensionRef) && self.type == ''ExtensionRef'')'
+ maxItems: 16
+ type: array
+ x-kubernetes-validations:
+ - message: May specify either httpRouteFilterRequestRedirect
+ or httpRouteFilterRequestRewrite, but not both
+ rule: '!(self.exists(f, f.type == ''RequestRedirect'') &&
+ self.exists(f, f.type == ''URLRewrite''))'
+ - message: RequestHeaderModifier filter cannot be repeated
+ rule: self.filter(f, f.type == 'RequestHeaderModifier').size()
+ <= 1
+ - message: ResponseHeaderModifier filter cannot be repeated
+ rule: self.filter(f, f.type == 'ResponseHeaderModifier').size()
+ <= 1
+ - message: RequestRedirect filter cannot be repeated
+ rule: self.filter(f, f.type == 'RequestRedirect').size() <=
+ 1
+ - message: URLRewrite filter cannot be repeated
+ rule: self.filter(f, f.type == 'URLRewrite').size() <= 1
+ matches:
+ default:
+ - path:
+ type: PathPrefix
+ value: /
+ description: |-
+ Matches define conditions used for matching the rule against incoming
+ HTTP requests. Each match is independent, i.e. this rule will be matched
+ if **any** one of the matches is satisfied.
+
+
+ For example, take the following matches configuration:
+
+
+ ```
+ matches:
+ - path:
+ value: "/foo"
+ headers:
+ - name: "version"
+ value: "v2"
+ - path:
+ value: "/v2/foo"
+ ```
+
+
+ For a request to match against this rule, a request must satisfy
+ EITHER of the two conditions:
+
+
+ - path prefixed with `/foo` AND contains the header `version: v2`
+ - path prefix of `/v2/foo`
+
+
+ See the documentation for HTTPRouteMatch on how to specify multiple
+ match conditions that should be ANDed together.
+
+
+ If no matches are specified, the default is a prefix
+ path match on "/", which has the effect of matching every
+ HTTP request.
+
+
+ Proxy or Load Balancer routing configuration generated from HTTPRoutes
+ MUST prioritize matches based on the following criteria, continuing on
+ ties. Across all rules specified on applicable Routes, precedence must be
+ given to the match having:
+
+
+ * "Exact" path match.
+ * "Prefix" path match with largest number of characters.
+ * Method match.
+ * Largest number of header matches.
+ * Largest number of query param matches.
+
+
+ Note: The precedence of RegularExpression path matches are implementation-specific.
+
+
+ If ties still exist across multiple Routes, matching precedence MUST be
+ determined in order of the following criteria, continuing on ties:
+
+
+ * The oldest Route based on creation timestamp.
+ * The Route appearing first in alphabetical order by
+ "{namespace}/{name}".
+
+
+ If ties still exist within an HTTPRoute, matching precedence MUST be granted
+ to the FIRST matching rule (in list order) with a match meeting the above
+ criteria.
+
+
+ When no rules matching a request have been successfully attached to the
+ parent a request is coming from, a HTTP 404 status code MUST be returned.
+ items:
+ description: "HTTPRouteMatch defines the predicate used to
+ match requests to a given\naction. Multiple match types
+ are ANDed together, i.e. the match will\nevaluate to true
+ only if all conditions are satisfied.\n\n\nFor example,
+ the match below will match a HTTP request only if its path\nstarts
+ with `/foo` AND it contains the `version: v1` header:\n\n\n```\nmatch:\n\n\n\tpath:\n\t
+ \ value: \"/foo\"\n\theaders:\n\t- name: \"version\"\n\t
+ \ value \"v1\"\n\n\n```"
+ properties:
+ headers:
+ description: |-
+ Headers specifies HTTP request header matchers. Multiple match values are
+ ANDed together, meaning, a request must match all the specified headers
+ to select the route.
+ items:
+ description: |-
+ HTTPHeaderMatch describes how to select a HTTP route by matching HTTP request
+ headers.
+ properties:
+ name:
+ description: |-
+ Name is the name of the HTTP Header to be matched. Name matching MUST be
+ case insensitive. (See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc7230#section-3.2).
+
+
+ If multiple entries specify equivalent header names, only the first
+ entry with an equivalent name MUST be considered for a match. Subsequent
+ entries with an equivalent header name MUST be ignored. Due to the
+ case-insensitivity of header names, "foo" and "Foo" are considered
+ equivalent.
+
+
+ When a header is repeated in an HTTP request, it is
+ implementation-specific behavior as to how this is represented.
+ Generally, proxies should follow the guidance from the RFC:
+ https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc7230.html#section-3.2.2 regarding
+ processing a repeated header, with special handling for "Set-Cookie".
+ maxLength: 256
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[A-Za-z0-9!#$%&'*+\-.^_\x60|~]+$
+ type: string
+ type:
+ default: Exact
+ description: |-
+ Type specifies how to match against the value of the header.
+
+
+ Support: Core (Exact)
+
+
+ Support: Implementation-specific (RegularExpression)
+
+
+ Since RegularExpression HeaderMatchType has implementation-specific
+ conformance, implementations can support POSIX, PCRE or any other dialects
+ of regular expressions. Please read the implementation's documentation to
+ determine the supported dialect.
+ enum:
+ - Exact
+ - RegularExpression
+ type: string
+ value:
+ description: Value is the value of HTTP Header to
+ be matched.
+ maxLength: 4096
+ minLength: 1
+ type: string
+ required:
+ - name
+ - value
+ type: object
+ maxItems: 16
+ type: array
+ x-kubernetes-list-map-keys:
+ - name
+ x-kubernetes-list-type: map
+ method:
+ description: |-
+ Method specifies HTTP method matcher.
+ When specified, this route will be matched only if the request has the
+ specified method.
+
+
+ Support: Extended
+ enum:
+ - GET
+ - HEAD
+ - POST
+ - PUT
+ - DELETE
+ - CONNECT
+ - OPTIONS
+ - TRACE
+ - PATCH
+ type: string
+ path:
+ default:
+ type: PathPrefix
+ value: /
+ description: |-
+ Path specifies a HTTP request path matcher. If this field is not
+ specified, a default prefix match on the "/" path is provided.
+ properties:
+ type:
+ default: PathPrefix
+ description: |-
+ Type specifies how to match against the path Value.
+
+
+ Support: Core (Exact, PathPrefix)
+
+
+ Support: Implementation-specific (RegularExpression)
+ enum:
+ - Exact
+ - PathPrefix
+ - RegularExpression
+ type: string
+ value:
+ default: /
+ description: Value of the HTTP path to match against.
+ maxLength: 1024
+ type: string
+ type: object
+ x-kubernetes-validations:
+ - message: value must be an absolute path and start with
+ '/' when type one of ['Exact', 'PathPrefix']
+ rule: '(self.type in [''Exact'',''PathPrefix'']) ? self.value.startsWith(''/'')
+ : true'
+ - message: must not contain '//' when type one of ['Exact',
+ 'PathPrefix']
+ rule: '(self.type in [''Exact'',''PathPrefix'']) ? !self.value.contains(''//'')
+ : true'
+ - message: must not contain '/./' when type one of ['Exact',
+ 'PathPrefix']
+ rule: '(self.type in [''Exact'',''PathPrefix'']) ? !self.value.contains(''/./'')
+ : true'
+ - message: must not contain '/../' when type one of ['Exact',
+ 'PathPrefix']
+ rule: '(self.type in [''Exact'',''PathPrefix'']) ? !self.value.contains(''/../'')
+ : true'
+ - message: must not contain '%2f' when type one of ['Exact',
+ 'PathPrefix']
+ rule: '(self.type in [''Exact'',''PathPrefix'']) ? !self.value.contains(''%2f'')
+ : true'
+ - message: must not contain '%2F' when type one of ['Exact',
+ 'PathPrefix']
+ rule: '(self.type in [''Exact'',''PathPrefix'']) ? !self.value.contains(''%2F'')
+ : true'
+ - message: must not contain '#' when type one of ['Exact',
+ 'PathPrefix']
+ rule: '(self.type in [''Exact'',''PathPrefix'']) ? !self.value.contains(''#'')
+ : true'
+ - message: must not end with '/..' when type one of ['Exact',
+ 'PathPrefix']
+ rule: '(self.type in [''Exact'',''PathPrefix'']) ? !self.value.endsWith(''/..'')
+ : true'
+ - message: must not end with '/.' when type one of ['Exact',
+ 'PathPrefix']
+ rule: '(self.type in [''Exact'',''PathPrefix'']) ? !self.value.endsWith(''/.'')
+ : true'
+ - message: type must be one of ['Exact', 'PathPrefix',
+ 'RegularExpression']
+ rule: self.type in ['Exact','PathPrefix'] || self.type
+ == 'RegularExpression'
+ - message: must only contain valid characters (matching
+ ^(?:[-A-Za-z0-9/._~!$&'()*+,;=:@]|[%][0-9a-fA-F]{2})+$)
+ for types ['Exact', 'PathPrefix']
+ rule: '(self.type in [''Exact'',''PathPrefix'']) ? self.value.matches(r"""^(?:[-A-Za-z0-9/._~!$&''()*+,;=:@]|[%][0-9a-fA-F]{2})+$""")
+ : true'
+ queryParams:
+ description: |-
+ QueryParams specifies HTTP query parameter matchers. Multiple match
+ values are ANDed together, meaning, a request must match all the
+ specified query parameters to select the route.
+
+
+ Support: Extended
+ items:
+ description: |-
+ HTTPQueryParamMatch describes how to select a HTTP route by matching HTTP
+ query parameters.
+ properties:
+ name:
+ description: |-
+ Name is the name of the HTTP query param to be matched. This must be an
+ exact string match. (See
+ https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc7230#section-2.7.3).
+
+
+ If multiple entries specify equivalent query param names, only the first
+ entry with an equivalent name MUST be considered for a match. Subsequent
+ entries with an equivalent query param name MUST be ignored.
+
+
+ If a query param is repeated in an HTTP request, the behavior is
+ purposely left undefined, since different data planes have different
+ capabilities. However, it is *recommended* that implementations should
+ match against the first value of the param if the data plane supports it,
+ as this behavior is expected in other load balancing contexts outside of
+ the Gateway API.
+
+
+ Users SHOULD NOT route traffic based on repeated query params to guard
+ themselves against potential differences in the implementations.
+ maxLength: 256
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[A-Za-z0-9!#$%&'*+\-.^_\x60|~]+$
+ type: string
+ type:
+ default: Exact
+ description: |-
+ Type specifies how to match against the value of the query parameter.
+
+
+ Support: Extended (Exact)
+
+
+ Support: Implementation-specific (RegularExpression)
+
+
+ Since RegularExpression QueryParamMatchType has Implementation-specific
+ conformance, implementations can support POSIX, PCRE or any other
+ dialects of regular expressions. Please read the implementation's
+ documentation to determine the supported dialect.
+ enum:
+ - Exact
+ - RegularExpression
+ type: string
+ value:
+ description: Value is the value of HTTP query param
+ to be matched.
+ maxLength: 1024
+ minLength: 1
+ type: string
+ required:
+ - name
+ - value
+ type: object
+ maxItems: 16
+ type: array
+ x-kubernetes-list-map-keys:
+ - name
+ x-kubernetes-list-type: map
+ type: object
+ maxItems: 8
+ type: array
+ type: object
+ x-kubernetes-validations:
+ - message: RequestRedirect filter must not be used together with
+ backendRefs
+ rule: '(has(self.backendRefs) && size(self.backendRefs) > 0) ?
+ (!has(self.filters) || self.filters.all(f, !has(f.requestRedirect))):
+ true'
+ - message: When using RequestRedirect filter with path.replacePrefixMatch,
+ exactly one PathPrefix match must be specified
+ rule: '(has(self.filters) && self.filters.exists_one(f, has(f.requestRedirect)
+ && has(f.requestRedirect.path) && f.requestRedirect.path.type
+ == ''ReplacePrefixMatch'' && has(f.requestRedirect.path.replacePrefixMatch)))
+ ? ((size(self.matches) != 1 || !has(self.matches[0].path) ||
+ self.matches[0].path.type != ''PathPrefix'') ? false : true)
+ : true'
+ - message: When using URLRewrite filter with path.replacePrefixMatch,
+ exactly one PathPrefix match must be specified
+ rule: '(has(self.filters) && self.filters.exists_one(f, has(f.urlRewrite)
+ && has(f.urlRewrite.path) && f.urlRewrite.path.type == ''ReplacePrefixMatch''
+ && has(f.urlRewrite.path.replacePrefixMatch))) ? ((size(self.matches)
+ != 1 || !has(self.matches[0].path) || self.matches[0].path.type
+ != ''PathPrefix'') ? false : true) : true'
+ - message: Within backendRefs, when using RequestRedirect filter
+ with path.replacePrefixMatch, exactly one PathPrefix match must
+ be specified
+ rule: '(has(self.backendRefs) && self.backendRefs.exists_one(b,
+ (has(b.filters) && b.filters.exists_one(f, has(f.requestRedirect)
+ && has(f.requestRedirect.path) && f.requestRedirect.path.type
+ == ''ReplacePrefixMatch'' && has(f.requestRedirect.path.replacePrefixMatch)))
+ )) ? ((size(self.matches) != 1 || !has(self.matches[0].path)
+ || self.matches[0].path.type != ''PathPrefix'') ? false : true)
+ : true'
+ - message: Within backendRefs, When using URLRewrite filter with
+ path.replacePrefixMatch, exactly one PathPrefix match must be
+ specified
+ rule: '(has(self.backendRefs) && self.backendRefs.exists_one(b,
+ (has(b.filters) && b.filters.exists_one(f, has(f.urlRewrite)
+ && has(f.urlRewrite.path) && f.urlRewrite.path.type == ''ReplacePrefixMatch''
+ && has(f.urlRewrite.path.replacePrefixMatch))) )) ? ((size(self.matches)
+ != 1 || !has(self.matches[0].path) || self.matches[0].path.type
+ != ''PathPrefix'') ? false : true) : true'
+ maxItems: 16
+ type: array
+ type: object
+ status:
+ description: Status defines the current state of HTTPRoute.
+ properties:
+ parents:
+ description: |-
+ Parents is a list of parent resources (usually Gateways) that are
+ associated with the route, and the status of the route with respect to
+ each parent. When this route attaches to a parent, the controller that
+ manages the parent must add an entry to this list when the controller
+ first sees the route and should update the entry as appropriate when the
+ route or gateway is modified.
+
+
+ Note that parent references that cannot be resolved by an implementation
+ of this API will not be added to this list. Implementations of this API
+ can only populate Route status for the Gateways/parent resources they are
+ responsible for.
+
+
+ A maximum of 32 Gateways will be represented in this list. An empty list
+ means the route has not been attached to any Gateway.
+ items:
+ description: |-
+ RouteParentStatus describes the status of a route with respect to an
+ associated Parent.
+ properties:
+ conditions:
+ description: |-
+ Conditions describes the status of the route with respect to the Gateway.
+ Note that the route's availability is also subject to the Gateway's own
+ status conditions and listener status.
+
+
+ If the Route's ParentRef specifies an existing Gateway that supports
+ Routes of this kind AND that Gateway's controller has sufficient access,
+ then that Gateway's controller MUST set the "Accepted" condition on the
+ Route, to indicate whether the route has been accepted or rejected by the
+ Gateway, and why.
+
+
+ A Route MUST be considered "Accepted" if at least one of the Route's
+ rules is implemented by the Gateway.
+
+
+ There are a number of cases where the "Accepted" condition may not be set
+ due to lack of controller visibility, that includes when:
+
+
+ * The Route refers to a non-existent parent.
+ * The Route is of a type that the controller does not support.
+ * The Route is in a namespace the controller does not have access to.
+ items:
+ description: "Condition contains details for one aspect of
+ the current state of this API Resource.\n---\nThis struct
+ is intended for direct use as an array at the field path
+ .status.conditions. For example,\n\n\n\ttype FooStatus
+ struct{\n\t // Represents the observations of a foo's
+ current state.\n\t // Known .status.conditions.type are:
+ \"Available\", \"Progressing\", and \"Degraded\"\n\t //
+ +patchMergeKey=type\n\t // +patchStrategy=merge\n\t //
+ +listType=map\n\t // +listMapKey=type\n\t Conditions
+ []metav1.Condition `json:\"conditions,omitempty\" patchStrategy:\"merge\"
+ patchMergeKey:\"type\" protobuf:\"bytes,1,rep,name=conditions\"`\n\n\n\t
+ \ // other fields\n\t}"
+ properties:
+ lastTransitionTime:
+ description: |-
+ lastTransitionTime is the last time the condition transitioned from one status to another.
+ This should be when the underlying condition changed. If that is not known, then using the time when the API field changed is acceptable.
+ format: date-time
+ type: string
+ message:
+ description: |-
+ message is a human readable message indicating details about the transition.
+ This may be an empty string.
+ maxLength: 32768
+ type: string
+ observedGeneration:
+ description: |-
+ observedGeneration represents the .metadata.generation that the condition was set based upon.
+ For instance, if .metadata.generation is currently 12, but the .status.conditions[x].observedGeneration is 9, the condition is out of date
+ with respect to the current state of the instance.
+ format: int64
+ minimum: 0
+ type: integer
+ reason:
+ description: |-
+ reason contains a programmatic identifier indicating the reason for the condition's last transition.
+ Producers of specific condition types may define expected values and meanings for this field,
+ and whether the values are considered a guaranteed API.
+ The value should be a CamelCase string.
+ This field may not be empty.
+ maxLength: 1024
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[A-Za-z]([A-Za-z0-9_,:]*[A-Za-z0-9_])?$
+ type: string
+ status:
+ description: status of the condition, one of True, False,
+ Unknown.
+ enum:
+ - "True"
+ - "False"
+ - Unknown
+ type: string
+ type:
+ description: |-
+ type of condition in CamelCase or in foo.example.com/CamelCase.
+ ---
+ Many .condition.type values are consistent across resources like Available, but because arbitrary conditions can be
+ useful (see .node.status.conditions), the ability to deconflict is important.
+ The regex it matches is (dns1123SubdomainFmt/)?(qualifiedNameFmt)
+ maxLength: 316
+ pattern: ^([a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*/)?(([A-Za-z0-9][-A-Za-z0-9_.]*)?[A-Za-z0-9])$
+ type: string
+ required:
+ - lastTransitionTime
+ - message
+ - reason
+ - status
+ - type
+ type: object
+ maxItems: 8
+ minItems: 1
+ type: array
+ x-kubernetes-list-map-keys:
+ - type
+ x-kubernetes-list-type: map
+ controllerName:
+ description: |-
+ ControllerName is a domain/path string that indicates the name of the
+ controller that wrote this status. This corresponds with the
+ controllerName field on GatewayClass.
+
+
+ Example: "example.net/gateway-controller".
+
+
+ The format of this field is DOMAIN "/" PATH, where DOMAIN and PATH are
+ valid Kubernetes names
+ (https://kubernetes.io/docs/concepts/overview/working-with-objects/names/#names).
+
+
+ Controllers MUST populate this field when writing status. Controllers should ensure that
+ entries to status populated with their ControllerName are cleaned up when they are no
+ longer necessary.
+ maxLength: 253
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*\/[A-Za-z0-9\/\-._~%!$&'()*+,;=:]+$
+ type: string
+ parentRef:
+ description: |-
+ ParentRef corresponds with a ParentRef in the spec that this
+ RouteParentStatus struct describes the status of.
+ properties:
+ group:
+ default: gateway.networking.k8s.io
+ description: |-
+ Group is the group of the referent.
+ When unspecified, "gateway.networking.k8s.io" is inferred.
+ To set the core API group (such as for a "Service" kind referent),
+ Group must be explicitly set to "" (empty string).
+
+
+ Support: Core
+ maxLength: 253
+ pattern: ^$|^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$
+ type: string
+ kind:
+ default: Gateway
+ description: |-
+ Kind is kind of the referent.
+
+
+ There are two kinds of parent resources with "Core" support:
+
+
+ * Gateway (Gateway conformance profile)
+ * Service (Mesh conformance profile, ClusterIP Services only)
+
+
+ Support for other resources is Implementation-Specific.
+ maxLength: 63
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[a-zA-Z]([-a-zA-Z0-9]*[a-zA-Z0-9])?$
+ type: string
+ name:
+ description: |-
+ Name is the name of the referent.
+
+
+ Support: Core
+ maxLength: 253
+ minLength: 1
+ type: string
+ namespace:
+ description: |-
+ Namespace is the namespace of the referent. When unspecified, this refers
+ to the local namespace of the Route.
+
+
+ Note that there are specific rules for ParentRefs which cross namespace
+ boundaries. Cross-namespace references are only valid if they are explicitly
+ allowed by something in the namespace they are referring to. For example:
+ Gateway has the AllowedRoutes field, and ReferenceGrant provides a
+ generic way to enable any other kind of cross-namespace reference.
+
+
+
+
+
+ Support: Core
+ maxLength: 63
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?$
+ type: string
+ port:
+ description: |-
+ Port is the network port this Route targets. It can be interpreted
+ differently based on the type of parent resource.
+
+
+ When the parent resource is a Gateway, this targets all listeners
+ listening on the specified port that also support this kind of Route(and
+ select this Route). It's not recommended to set `Port` unless the
+ networking behaviors specified in a Route must apply to a specific port
+ as opposed to a listener(s) whose port(s) may be changed. When both Port
+ and SectionName are specified, the name and port of the selected listener
+ must match both specified values.
+
+
+
+
+
+ Implementations MAY choose to support other parent resources.
+ Implementations supporting other types of parent resources MUST clearly
+ document how/if Port is interpreted.
+
+
+ For the purpose of status, an attachment is considered successful as
+ long as the parent resource accepts it partially. For example, Gateway
+ listeners can restrict which Routes can attach to them by Route kind,
+ namespace, or hostname. If 1 of 2 Gateway listeners accept attachment
+ from the referencing Route, the Route MUST be considered successfully
+ attached. If no Gateway listeners accept attachment from this Route,
+ the Route MUST be considered detached from the Gateway.
+
+
+ Support: Extended
+ format: int32
+ maximum: 65535
+ minimum: 1
+ type: integer
+ sectionName:
+ description: |-
+ SectionName is the name of a section within the target resource. In the
+ following resources, SectionName is interpreted as the following:
+
+
+ * Gateway: Listener name. When both Port (experimental) and SectionName
+ are specified, the name and port of the selected listener must match
+ both specified values.
+ * Service: Port name. When both Port (experimental) and SectionName
+ are specified, the name and port of the selected listener must match
+ both specified values.
+
+
+ Implementations MAY choose to support attaching Routes to other resources.
+ If that is the case, they MUST clearly document how SectionName is
+ interpreted.
+
+
+ When unspecified (empty string), this will reference the entire resource.
+ For the purpose of status, an attachment is considered successful if at
+ least one section in the parent resource accepts it. For example, Gateway
+ listeners can restrict which Routes can attach to them by Route kind,
+ namespace, or hostname. If 1 of 2 Gateway listeners accept attachment from
+ the referencing Route, the Route MUST be considered successfully
+ attached. If no Gateway listeners accept attachment from this Route, the
+ Route MUST be considered detached from the Gateway.
+
+
+ Support: Core
+ maxLength: 253
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$
+ type: string
+ required:
+ - name
+ type: object
+ required:
+ - controllerName
+ - parentRef
+ type: object
+ maxItems: 32
+ type: array
+ required:
+ - parents
+ type: object
+ required:
+ - spec
+ type: object
+ served: true
+ storage: true
+ subresources:
+ status: {}
+ - additionalPrinterColumns:
+ - jsonPath: .spec.hostnames
+ name: Hostnames
+ type: string
+ - jsonPath: .metadata.creationTimestamp
+ name: Age
+ type: date
+ name: v1beta1
+ schema:
+ openAPIV3Schema:
+ description: |-
+ HTTPRoute provides a way to route HTTP requests. This includes the capability
+ to match requests by hostname, path, header, or query param. Filters can be
+ used to specify additional processing steps. Backends specify where matching
+ requests should be routed.
+ properties:
+ apiVersion:
+ description: |-
+ APIVersion defines the versioned schema of this representation of an object.
+ Servers should convert recognized schemas to the latest internal value, and
+ may reject unrecognized values.
+ More info: https://git.k8s.io/community/contributors/devel/sig-architecture/api-conventions.md#resources
+ type: string
+ kind:
+ description: |-
+ Kind is a string value representing the REST resource this object represents.
+ Servers may infer this from the endpoint the client submits requests to.
+ Cannot be updated.
+ In CamelCase.
+ More info: https://git.k8s.io/community/contributors/devel/sig-architecture/api-conventions.md#types-kinds
+ type: string
+ metadata:
+ type: object
+ spec:
+ description: Spec defines the desired state of HTTPRoute.
+ properties:
+ hostnames:
+ description: |-
+ Hostnames defines a set of hostnames that should match against the HTTP Host
+ header to select a HTTPRoute used to process the request. Implementations
+ MUST ignore any port value specified in the HTTP Host header while
+ performing a match and (absent of any applicable header modification
+ configuration) MUST forward this header unmodified to the backend.
+
+
+ Valid values for Hostnames are determined by RFC 1123 definition of a
+ hostname with 2 notable exceptions:
+
+
+ 1. IPs are not allowed.
+ 2. A hostname may be prefixed with a wildcard label (`*.`). The wildcard
+ label must appear by itself as the first label.
+
+
+ If a hostname is specified by both the Listener and HTTPRoute, there
+ must be at least one intersecting hostname for the HTTPRoute to be
+ attached to the Listener. For example:
+
+
+ * A Listener with `test.example.com` as the hostname matches HTTPRoutes
+ that have either not specified any hostnames, or have specified at
+ least one of `test.example.com` or `*.example.com`.
+ * A Listener with `*.example.com` as the hostname matches HTTPRoutes
+ that have either not specified any hostnames or have specified at least
+ one hostname that matches the Listener hostname. For example,
+ `*.example.com`, `test.example.com`, and `foo.test.example.com` would
+ all match. On the other hand, `example.com` and `test.example.net` would
+ not match.
+
+
+ Hostnames that are prefixed with a wildcard label (`*.`) are interpreted
+ as a suffix match. That means that a match for `*.example.com` would match
+ both `test.example.com`, and `foo.test.example.com`, but not `example.com`.
+
+
+ If both the Listener and HTTPRoute have specified hostnames, any
+ HTTPRoute hostnames that do not match the Listener hostname MUST be
+ ignored. For example, if a Listener specified `*.example.com`, and the
+ HTTPRoute specified `test.example.com` and `test.example.net`,
+ `test.example.net` must not be considered for a match.
+
+
+ If both the Listener and HTTPRoute have specified hostnames, and none
+ match with the criteria above, then the HTTPRoute is not accepted. The
+ implementation must raise an 'Accepted' Condition with a status of
+ `False` in the corresponding RouteParentStatus.
+
+
+ In the event that multiple HTTPRoutes specify intersecting hostnames (e.g.
+ overlapping wildcard matching and exact matching hostnames), precedence must
+ be given to rules from the HTTPRoute with the largest number of:
+
+
+ * Characters in a matching non-wildcard hostname.
+ * Characters in a matching hostname.
+
+
+ If ties exist across multiple Routes, the matching precedence rules for
+ HTTPRouteMatches takes over.
+
+
+ Support: Core
+ items:
+ description: |-
+ Hostname is the fully qualified domain name of a network host. This matches
+ the RFC 1123 definition of a hostname with 2 notable exceptions:
+
+
+ 1. IPs are not allowed.
+ 2. A hostname may be prefixed with a wildcard label (`*.`). The wildcard
+ label must appear by itself as the first label.
+
+
+ Hostname can be "precise" which is a domain name without the terminating
+ dot of a network host (e.g. "foo.example.com") or "wildcard", which is a
+ domain name prefixed with a single wildcard label (e.g. `*.example.com`).
+
+
+ Note that as per RFC1035 and RFC1123, a *label* must consist of lower case
+ alphanumeric characters or '-', and must start and end with an alphanumeric
+ character. No other punctuation is allowed.
+ maxLength: 253
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^(\*\.)?[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$
+ type: string
+ maxItems: 16
+ type: array
+ parentRefs:
+ description: |+
+ ParentRefs references the resources (usually Gateways) that a Route wants
+ to be attached to. Note that the referenced parent resource needs to
+ allow this for the attachment to be complete. For Gateways, that means
+ the Gateway needs to allow attachment from Routes of this kind and
+ namespace. For Services, that means the Service must either be in the same
+ namespace for a "producer" route, or the mesh implementation must support
+ and allow "consumer" routes for the referenced Service. ReferenceGrant is
+ not applicable for governing ParentRefs to Services - it is not possible to
+ create a "producer" route for a Service in a different namespace from the
+ Route.
+
+
+ There are two kinds of parent resources with "Core" support:
+
+
+ * Gateway (Gateway conformance profile)
+ * Service (Mesh conformance profile, ClusterIP Services only)
+
+
+ This API may be extended in the future to support additional kinds of parent
+ resources.
+
+
+ ParentRefs must be _distinct_. This means either that:
+
+
+ * They select different objects. If this is the case, then parentRef
+ entries are distinct. In terms of fields, this means that the
+ multi-part key defined by `group`, `kind`, `namespace`, and `name` must
+ be unique across all parentRef entries in the Route.
+ * They do not select different objects, but for each optional field used,
+ each ParentRef that selects the same object must set the same set of
+ optional fields to different values. If one ParentRef sets a
+ combination of optional fields, all must set the same combination.
+
+
+ Some examples:
+
+
+ * If one ParentRef sets `sectionName`, all ParentRefs referencing the
+ same object must also set `sectionName`.
+ * If one ParentRef sets `port`, all ParentRefs referencing the same
+ object must also set `port`.
+ * If one ParentRef sets `sectionName` and `port`, all ParentRefs
+ referencing the same object must also set `sectionName` and `port`.
+
+
+ It is possible to separately reference multiple distinct objects that may
+ be collapsed by an implementation. For example, some implementations may
+ choose to merge compatible Gateway Listeners together. If that is the
+ case, the list of routes attached to those resources should also be
+ merged.
+
+
+ Note that for ParentRefs that cross namespace boundaries, there are specific
+ rules. Cross-namespace references are only valid if they are explicitly
+ allowed by something in the namespace they are referring to. For example,
+ Gateway has the AllowedRoutes field, and ReferenceGrant provides a
+ generic way to enable other kinds of cross-namespace reference.
+
+
+
+
+
+
+
+
+ items:
+ description: |-
+ ParentReference identifies an API object (usually a Gateway) that can be considered
+ a parent of this resource (usually a route). There are two kinds of parent resources
+ with "Core" support:
+
+
+ * Gateway (Gateway conformance profile)
+ * Service (Mesh conformance profile, ClusterIP Services only)
+
+
+ This API may be extended in the future to support additional kinds of parent
+ resources.
+
+
+ The API object must be valid in the cluster; the Group and Kind must
+ be registered in the cluster for this reference to be valid.
+ properties:
+ group:
+ default: gateway.networking.k8s.io
+ description: |-
+ Group is the group of the referent.
+ When unspecified, "gateway.networking.k8s.io" is inferred.
+ To set the core API group (such as for a "Service" kind referent),
+ Group must be explicitly set to "" (empty string).
+
+
+ Support: Core
+ maxLength: 253
+ pattern: ^$|^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$
+ type: string
+ kind:
+ default: Gateway
+ description: |-
+ Kind is kind of the referent.
+
+
+ There are two kinds of parent resources with "Core" support:
+
+
+ * Gateway (Gateway conformance profile)
+ * Service (Mesh conformance profile, ClusterIP Services only)
+
+
+ Support for other resources is Implementation-Specific.
+ maxLength: 63
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[a-zA-Z]([-a-zA-Z0-9]*[a-zA-Z0-9])?$
+ type: string
+ name:
+ description: |-
+ Name is the name of the referent.
+
+
+ Support: Core
+ maxLength: 253
+ minLength: 1
+ type: string
+ namespace:
+ description: |-
+ Namespace is the namespace of the referent. When unspecified, this refers
+ to the local namespace of the Route.
+
+
+ Note that there are specific rules for ParentRefs which cross namespace
+ boundaries. Cross-namespace references are only valid if they are explicitly
+ allowed by something in the namespace they are referring to. For example:
+ Gateway has the AllowedRoutes field, and ReferenceGrant provides a
+ generic way to enable any other kind of cross-namespace reference.
+
+
+
+
+
+ Support: Core
+ maxLength: 63
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?$
+ type: string
+ port:
+ description: |-
+ Port is the network port this Route targets. It can be interpreted
+ differently based on the type of parent resource.
+
+
+ When the parent resource is a Gateway, this targets all listeners
+ listening on the specified port that also support this kind of Route(and
+ select this Route). It's not recommended to set `Port` unless the
+ networking behaviors specified in a Route must apply to a specific port
+ as opposed to a listener(s) whose port(s) may be changed. When both Port
+ and SectionName are specified, the name and port of the selected listener
+ must match both specified values.
+
+
+
+
+
+ Implementations MAY choose to support other parent resources.
+ Implementations supporting other types of parent resources MUST clearly
+ document how/if Port is interpreted.
+
+
+ For the purpose of status, an attachment is considered successful as
+ long as the parent resource accepts it partially. For example, Gateway
+ listeners can restrict which Routes can attach to them by Route kind,
+ namespace, or hostname. If 1 of 2 Gateway listeners accept attachment
+ from the referencing Route, the Route MUST be considered successfully
+ attached. If no Gateway listeners accept attachment from this Route,
+ the Route MUST be considered detached from the Gateway.
+
+
+ Support: Extended
+ format: int32
+ maximum: 65535
+ minimum: 1
+ type: integer
+ sectionName:
+ description: |-
+ SectionName is the name of a section within the target resource. In the
+ following resources, SectionName is interpreted as the following:
+
+
+ * Gateway: Listener name. When both Port (experimental) and SectionName
+ are specified, the name and port of the selected listener must match
+ both specified values.
+ * Service: Port name. When both Port (experimental) and SectionName
+ are specified, the name and port of the selected listener must match
+ both specified values.
+
+
+ Implementations MAY choose to support attaching Routes to other resources.
+ If that is the case, they MUST clearly document how SectionName is
+ interpreted.
+
+
+ When unspecified (empty string), this will reference the entire resource.
+ For the purpose of status, an attachment is considered successful if at
+ least one section in the parent resource accepts it. For example, Gateway
+ listeners can restrict which Routes can attach to them by Route kind,
+ namespace, or hostname. If 1 of 2 Gateway listeners accept attachment from
+ the referencing Route, the Route MUST be considered successfully
+ attached. If no Gateway listeners accept attachment from this Route, the
+ Route MUST be considered detached from the Gateway.
+
+
+ Support: Core
+ maxLength: 253
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$
+ type: string
+ required:
+ - name
+ type: object
+ maxItems: 32
+ type: array
+ x-kubernetes-validations:
+ - message: sectionName must be specified when parentRefs includes
+ 2 or more references to the same parent
+ rule: 'self.all(p1, self.all(p2, p1.group == p2.group && p1.kind
+ == p2.kind && p1.name == p2.name && (((!has(p1.__namespace__)
+ || p1.__namespace__ == '''') && (!has(p2.__namespace__) || p2.__namespace__
+ == '''')) || (has(p1.__namespace__) && has(p2.__namespace__) &&
+ p1.__namespace__ == p2.__namespace__ )) ? ((!has(p1.sectionName)
+ || p1.sectionName == '''') == (!has(p2.sectionName) || p2.sectionName
+ == '''')) : true))'
+ - message: sectionName must be unique when parentRefs includes 2 or
+ more references to the same parent
+ rule: self.all(p1, self.exists_one(p2, p1.group == p2.group && p1.kind
+ == p2.kind && p1.name == p2.name && (((!has(p1.__namespace__)
+ || p1.__namespace__ == '') && (!has(p2.__namespace__) || p2.__namespace__
+ == '')) || (has(p1.__namespace__) && has(p2.__namespace__) &&
+ p1.__namespace__ == p2.__namespace__ )) && (((!has(p1.sectionName)
+ || p1.sectionName == '') && (!has(p2.sectionName) || p2.sectionName
+ == '')) || (has(p1.sectionName) && has(p2.sectionName) && p1.sectionName
+ == p2.sectionName))))
+ rules:
+ default:
+ - matches:
+ - path:
+ type: PathPrefix
+ value: /
+ description: Rules are a list of HTTP matchers, filters and actions.
+ items:
+ description: |-
+ HTTPRouteRule defines semantics for matching an HTTP request based on
+ conditions (matches), processing it (filters), and forwarding the request to
+ an API object (backendRefs).
+ properties:
+ backendRefs:
+ description: |-
+ BackendRefs defines the backend(s) where matching requests should be
+ sent.
+
+
+ Failure behavior here depends on how many BackendRefs are specified and
+ how many are invalid.
+
+
+ If *all* entries in BackendRefs are invalid, and there are also no filters
+ specified in this route rule, *all* traffic which matches this rule MUST
+ receive a 500 status code.
+
+
+ See the HTTPBackendRef definition for the rules about what makes a single
+ HTTPBackendRef invalid.
+
+
+ When a HTTPBackendRef is invalid, 500 status codes MUST be returned for
+ requests that would have otherwise been routed to an invalid backend. If
+ multiple backends are specified, and some are invalid, the proportion of
+ requests that would otherwise have been routed to an invalid backend
+ MUST receive a 500 status code.
+
+
+ For example, if two backends are specified with equal weights, and one is
+ invalid, 50 percent of traffic must receive a 500. Implementations may
+ choose how that 50 percent is determined.
+
+
+ Support: Core for Kubernetes Service
+
+
+ Support: Extended for Kubernetes ServiceImport
+
+
+ Support: Implementation-specific for any other resource
+
+
+ Support for weight: Core
+ items:
+ description: |-
+ HTTPBackendRef defines how a HTTPRoute forwards a HTTP request.
+
+
+ Note that when a namespace different than the local namespace is specified, a
+ ReferenceGrant object is required in the referent namespace to allow that
+ namespace's owner to accept the reference. See the ReferenceGrant
+ documentation for details.
+
+
+
+
+
+ When the BackendRef points to a Kubernetes Service, implementations SHOULD
+ honor the appProtocol field if it is set for the target Service Port.
+
+
+ Implementations supporting appProtocol SHOULD recognize the Kubernetes
+ Standard Application Protocols defined in KEP-3726.
+
+
+ If a Service appProtocol isn't specified, an implementation MAY infer the
+ backend protocol through its own means. Implementations MAY infer the
+ protocol from the Route type referring to the backend Service.
+
+
+ If a Route is not able to send traffic to the backend using the specified
+ protocol then the backend is considered invalid. Implementations MUST set the
+ "ResolvedRefs" condition to "False" with the "UnsupportedProtocol" reason.
+
+
+
+ properties:
+ filters:
+ description: |-
+ Filters defined at this level should be executed if and only if the
+ request is being forwarded to the backend defined here.
+
+
+ Support: Implementation-specific (For broader support of filters, use the
+ Filters field in HTTPRouteRule.)
+ items:
+ description: |-
+ HTTPRouteFilter defines processing steps that must be completed during the
+ request or response lifecycle. HTTPRouteFilters are meant as an extension
+ point to express processing that may be done in Gateway implementations. Some
+ examples include request or response modification, implementing
+ authentication strategies, rate-limiting, and traffic shaping. API
+ guarantee/conformance is defined based on the type of the filter.
+ properties:
+ extensionRef:
+ description: |-
+ ExtensionRef is an optional, implementation-specific extension to the
+ "filter" behavior. For example, resource "myroutefilter" in group
+ "networking.example.net"). ExtensionRef MUST NOT be used for core and
+ extended filters.
+
+
+ This filter can be used multiple times within the same rule.
+
+
+ Support: Implementation-specific
+ properties:
+ group:
+ description: |-
+ Group is the group of the referent. For example, "gateway.networking.k8s.io".
+ When unspecified or empty string, core API group is inferred.
+ maxLength: 253
+ pattern: ^$|^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$
+ type: string
+ kind:
+ description: Kind is kind of the referent. For
+ example "HTTPRoute" or "Service".
+ maxLength: 63
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[a-zA-Z]([-a-zA-Z0-9]*[a-zA-Z0-9])?$
+ type: string
+ name:
+ description: Name is the name of the referent.
+ maxLength: 253
+ minLength: 1
+ type: string
+ required:
+ - group
+ - kind
+ - name
+ type: object
+ requestHeaderModifier:
+ description: |-
+ RequestHeaderModifier defines a schema for a filter that modifies request
+ headers.
+
+
+ Support: Core
+ properties:
+ add:
+ description: |-
+ Add adds the given header(s) (name, value) to the request
+ before the action. It appends to any existing values associated
+ with the header name.
+
+
+ Input:
+ GET /foo HTTP/1.1
+ my-header: foo
+
+
+ Config:
+ add:
+ - name: "my-header"
+ value: "bar,baz"
+
+
+ Output:
+ GET /foo HTTP/1.1
+ my-header: foo,bar,baz
+ items:
+ description: HTTPHeader represents an HTTP
+ Header name and value as defined by RFC
+ 7230.
+ properties:
+ name:
+ description: |-
+ Name is the name of the HTTP Header to be matched. Name matching MUST be
+ case insensitive. (See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc7230#section-3.2).
+
+
+ If multiple entries specify equivalent header names, the first entry with
+ an equivalent name MUST be considered for a match. Subsequent entries
+ with an equivalent header name MUST be ignored. Due to the
+ case-insensitivity of header names, "foo" and "Foo" are considered
+ equivalent.
+ maxLength: 256
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[A-Za-z0-9!#$%&'*+\-.^_\x60|~]+$
+ type: string
+ value:
+ description: Value is the value of HTTP
+ Header to be matched.
+ maxLength: 4096
+ minLength: 1
+ type: string
+ required:
+ - name
+ - value
+ type: object
+ maxItems: 16
+ type: array
+ x-kubernetes-list-map-keys:
+ - name
+ x-kubernetes-list-type: map
+ remove:
+ description: |-
+ Remove the given header(s) from the HTTP request before the action. The
+ value of Remove is a list of HTTP header names. Note that the header
+ names are case-insensitive (see
+ https://datatracker.ietf.org/doc/html/rfc2616#section-4.2).
+
+
+ Input:
+ GET /foo HTTP/1.1
+ my-header1: foo
+ my-header2: bar
+ my-header3: baz
+
+
+ Config:
+ remove: ["my-header1", "my-header3"]
+
+
+ Output:
+ GET /foo HTTP/1.1
+ my-header2: bar
+ items:
+ type: string
+ maxItems: 16
+ type: array
+ x-kubernetes-list-type: set
+ set:
+ description: |-
+ Set overwrites the request with the given header (name, value)
+ before the action.
+
+
+ Input:
+ GET /foo HTTP/1.1
+ my-header: foo
+
+
+ Config:
+ set:
+ - name: "my-header"
+ value: "bar"
+
+
+ Output:
+ GET /foo HTTP/1.1
+ my-header: bar
+ items:
+ description: HTTPHeader represents an HTTP
+ Header name and value as defined by RFC
+ 7230.
+ properties:
+ name:
+ description: |-
+ Name is the name of the HTTP Header to be matched. Name matching MUST be
+ case insensitive. (See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc7230#section-3.2).
+
+
+ If multiple entries specify equivalent header names, the first entry with
+ an equivalent name MUST be considered for a match. Subsequent entries
+ with an equivalent header name MUST be ignored. Due to the
+ case-insensitivity of header names, "foo" and "Foo" are considered
+ equivalent.
+ maxLength: 256
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[A-Za-z0-9!#$%&'*+\-.^_\x60|~]+$
+ type: string
+ value:
+ description: Value is the value of HTTP
+ Header to be matched.
+ maxLength: 4096
+ minLength: 1
+ type: string
+ required:
+ - name
+ - value
+ type: object
+ maxItems: 16
+ type: array
+ x-kubernetes-list-map-keys:
+ - name
+ x-kubernetes-list-type: map
+ type: object
+ requestMirror:
+ description: |-
+ RequestMirror defines a schema for a filter that mirrors requests.
+ Requests are sent to the specified destination, but responses from
+ that destination are ignored.
+
+
+ This filter can be used multiple times within the same rule. Note that
+ not all implementations will be able to support mirroring to multiple
+ backends.
+
+
+ Support: Extended
+ properties:
+ backendRef:
+ description: |-
+ BackendRef references a resource where mirrored requests are sent.
+
+
+ Mirrored requests must be sent only to a single destination endpoint
+ within this BackendRef, irrespective of how many endpoints are present
+ within this BackendRef.
+
+
+ If the referent cannot be found, this BackendRef is invalid and must be
+ dropped from the Gateway. The controller must ensure the "ResolvedRefs"
+ condition on the Route status is set to `status: False` and not configure
+ this backend in the underlying implementation.
+
+
+ If there is a cross-namespace reference to an *existing* object
+ that is not allowed by a ReferenceGrant, the controller must ensure the
+ "ResolvedRefs" condition on the Route is set to `status: False`,
+ with the "RefNotPermitted" reason and not configure this backend in the
+ underlying implementation.
+
+
+ In either error case, the Message of the `ResolvedRefs` Condition
+ should be used to provide more detail about the problem.
+
+
+ Support: Extended for Kubernetes Service
+
+
+ Support: Implementation-specific for any other resource
+ properties:
+ group:
+ default: ""
+ description: |-
+ Group is the group of the referent. For example, "gateway.networking.k8s.io".
+ When unspecified or empty string, core API group is inferred.
+ maxLength: 253
+ pattern: ^$|^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$
+ type: string
+ kind:
+ default: Service
+ description: |-
+ Kind is the Kubernetes resource kind of the referent. For example
+ "Service".
+
+
+ Defaults to "Service" when not specified.
+
+
+ ExternalName services can refer to CNAME DNS records that may live
+ outside of the cluster and as such are difficult to reason about in
+ terms of conformance. They also may not be safe to forward to (see
+ CVE-2021-25740 for more information). Implementations SHOULD NOT
+ support ExternalName Services.
+
+
+ Support: Core (Services with a type other than ExternalName)
+
+
+ Support: Implementation-specific (Services with type ExternalName)
+ maxLength: 63
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[a-zA-Z]([-a-zA-Z0-9]*[a-zA-Z0-9])?$
+ type: string
+ name:
+ description: Name is the name of the referent.
+ maxLength: 253
+ minLength: 1
+ type: string
+ namespace:
+ description: |-
+ Namespace is the namespace of the backend. When unspecified, the local
+ namespace is inferred.
+
+
+ Note that when a namespace different than the local namespace is specified,
+ a ReferenceGrant object is required in the referent namespace to allow that
+ namespace's owner to accept the reference. See the ReferenceGrant
+ documentation for details.
+
+
+ Support: Core
+ maxLength: 63
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?$
+ type: string
+ port:
+ description: |-
+ Port specifies the destination port number to use for this resource.
+ Port is required when the referent is a Kubernetes Service. In this
+ case, the port number is the service port number, not the target port.
+ For other resources, destination port might be derived from the referent
+ resource or this field.
+ format: int32
+ maximum: 65535
+ minimum: 1
+ type: integer
+ required:
+ - name
+ type: object
+ x-kubernetes-validations:
+ - message: Must have port for Service reference
+ rule: '(size(self.group) == 0 && self.kind
+ == ''Service'') ? has(self.port) : true'
+ required:
+ - backendRef
+ type: object
+ requestRedirect:
+ description: |-
+ RequestRedirect defines a schema for a filter that responds to the
+ request with an HTTP redirection.
+
+
+ Support: Core
+ properties:
+ hostname:
+ description: |-
+ Hostname is the hostname to be used in the value of the `Location`
+ header in the response.
+ When empty, the hostname in the `Host` header of the request is used.
+
+
+ Support: Core
+ maxLength: 253
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$
+ type: string
+ path:
+ description: |-
+ Path defines parameters used to modify the path of the incoming request.
+ The modified path is then used to construct the `Location` header. When
+ empty, the request path is used as-is.
+
+
+ Support: Extended
+ properties:
+ replaceFullPath:
+ description: |-
+ ReplaceFullPath specifies the value with which to replace the full path
+ of a request during a rewrite or redirect.
+ maxLength: 1024
+ type: string
+ replacePrefixMatch:
+ description: |-
+ ReplacePrefixMatch specifies the value with which to replace the prefix
+ match of a request during a rewrite or redirect. For example, a request
+ to "/foo/bar" with a prefix match of "/foo" and a ReplacePrefixMatch
+ of "/xyz" would be modified to "/xyz/bar".
+
+
+ Note that this matches the behavior of the PathPrefix match type. This
+ matches full path elements. A path element refers to the list of labels
+ in the path split by the `/` separator. When specified, a trailing `/` is
+ ignored. For example, the paths `/abc`, `/abc/`, and `/abc/def` would all
+ match the prefix `/abc`, but the path `/abcd` would not.
+
+
+ ReplacePrefixMatch is only compatible with a `PathPrefix` HTTPRouteMatch.
+ Using any other HTTPRouteMatch type on the same HTTPRouteRule will result in
+ the implementation setting the Accepted Condition for the Route to `status: False`.
+
+
+ Request Path | Prefix Match | Replace Prefix | Modified Path
+ -------------|--------------|----------------|----------
+ /foo/bar | /foo | /xyz | /xyz/bar
+ /foo/bar | /foo | /xyz/ | /xyz/bar
+ /foo/bar | /foo/ | /xyz | /xyz/bar
+ /foo/bar | /foo/ | /xyz/ | /xyz/bar
+ /foo | /foo | /xyz | /xyz
+ /foo/ | /foo | /xyz | /xyz/
+ /foo/bar | /foo | | /bar
+ /foo/ | /foo | | /
+ /foo | /foo | | /
+ /foo/ | /foo | / | /
+ /foo | /foo | / | /
+ maxLength: 1024
+ type: string
+ type:
+ description: |-
+ Type defines the type of path modifier. Additional types may be
+ added in a future release of the API.
+
+
+ Note that values may be added to this enum, implementations
+ must ensure that unknown values will not cause a crash.
+
+
+ Unknown values here must result in the implementation setting the
+ Accepted Condition for the Route to `status: False`, with a
+ Reason of `UnsupportedValue`.
+ enum:
+ - ReplaceFullPath
+ - ReplacePrefixMatch
+ type: string
+ required:
+ - type
+ type: object
+ x-kubernetes-validations:
+ - message: replaceFullPath must be specified
+ when type is set to 'ReplaceFullPath'
+ rule: 'self.type == ''ReplaceFullPath'' ?
+ has(self.replaceFullPath) : true'
+ - message: type must be 'ReplaceFullPath' when
+ replaceFullPath is set
+ rule: 'has(self.replaceFullPath) ? self.type
+ == ''ReplaceFullPath'' : true'
+ - message: replacePrefixMatch must be specified
+ when type is set to 'ReplacePrefixMatch'
+ rule: 'self.type == ''ReplacePrefixMatch''
+ ? has(self.replacePrefixMatch) : true'
+ - message: type must be 'ReplacePrefixMatch'
+ when replacePrefixMatch is set
+ rule: 'has(self.replacePrefixMatch) ? self.type
+ == ''ReplacePrefixMatch'' : true'
+ port:
+ description: |-
+ Port is the port to be used in the value of the `Location`
+ header in the response.
+
+
+ If no port is specified, the redirect port MUST be derived using the
+ following rules:
+
+
+ * If redirect scheme is not-empty, the redirect port MUST be the well-known
+ port associated with the redirect scheme. Specifically "http" to port 80
+ and "https" to port 443. If the redirect scheme does not have a
+ well-known port, the listener port of the Gateway SHOULD be used.
+ * If redirect scheme is empty, the redirect port MUST be the Gateway
+ Listener port.
+
+
+ Implementations SHOULD NOT add the port number in the 'Location'
+ header in the following cases:
+
+
+ * A Location header that will use HTTP (whether that is determined via
+ the Listener protocol or the Scheme field) _and_ use port 80.
+ * A Location header that will use HTTPS (whether that is determined via
+ the Listener protocol or the Scheme field) _and_ use port 443.
+
+
+ Support: Extended
+ format: int32
+ maximum: 65535
+ minimum: 1
+ type: integer
+ scheme:
+ description: |-
+ Scheme is the scheme to be used in the value of the `Location` header in
+ the response. When empty, the scheme of the request is used.
+
+
+ Scheme redirects can affect the port of the redirect, for more information,
+ refer to the documentation for the port field of this filter.
+
+
+ Note that values may be added to this enum, implementations
+ must ensure that unknown values will not cause a crash.
+
+
+ Unknown values here must result in the implementation setting the
+ Accepted Condition for the Route to `status: False`, with a
+ Reason of `UnsupportedValue`.
+
+
+ Support: Extended
+ enum:
+ - http
+ - https
+ type: string
+ statusCode:
+ default: 302
+ description: |-
+ StatusCode is the HTTP status code to be used in response.
+
+
+ Note that values may be added to this enum, implementations
+ must ensure that unknown values will not cause a crash.
+
+
+ Unknown values here must result in the implementation setting the
+ Accepted Condition for the Route to `status: False`, with a
+ Reason of `UnsupportedValue`.
+
+
+ Support: Core
+ enum:
+ - 301
+ - 302
+ type: integer
+ type: object
+ responseHeaderModifier:
+ description: |-
+ ResponseHeaderModifier defines a schema for a filter that modifies response
+ headers.
+
+
+ Support: Extended
+ properties:
+ add:
+ description: |-
+ Add adds the given header(s) (name, value) to the request
+ before the action. It appends to any existing values associated
+ with the header name.
+
+
+ Input:
+ GET /foo HTTP/1.1
+ my-header: foo
+
+
+ Config:
+ add:
+ - name: "my-header"
+ value: "bar,baz"
+
+
+ Output:
+ GET /foo HTTP/1.1
+ my-header: foo,bar,baz
+ items:
+ description: HTTPHeader represents an HTTP
+ Header name and value as defined by RFC
+ 7230.
+ properties:
+ name:
+ description: |-
+ Name is the name of the HTTP Header to be matched. Name matching MUST be
+ case insensitive. (See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc7230#section-3.2).
+
+
+ If multiple entries specify equivalent header names, the first entry with
+ an equivalent name MUST be considered for a match. Subsequent entries
+ with an equivalent header name MUST be ignored. Due to the
+ case-insensitivity of header names, "foo" and "Foo" are considered
+ equivalent.
+ maxLength: 256
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[A-Za-z0-9!#$%&'*+\-.^_\x60|~]+$
+ type: string
+ value:
+ description: Value is the value of HTTP
+ Header to be matched.
+ maxLength: 4096
+ minLength: 1
+ type: string
+ required:
+ - name
+ - value
+ type: object
+ maxItems: 16
+ type: array
+ x-kubernetes-list-map-keys:
+ - name
+ x-kubernetes-list-type: map
+ remove:
+ description: |-
+ Remove the given header(s) from the HTTP request before the action. The
+ value of Remove is a list of HTTP header names. Note that the header
+ names are case-insensitive (see
+ https://datatracker.ietf.org/doc/html/rfc2616#section-4.2).
+
+
+ Input:
+ GET /foo HTTP/1.1
+ my-header1: foo
+ my-header2: bar
+ my-header3: baz
+
+
+ Config:
+ remove: ["my-header1", "my-header3"]
+
+
+ Output:
+ GET /foo HTTP/1.1
+ my-header2: bar
+ items:
+ type: string
+ maxItems: 16
+ type: array
+ x-kubernetes-list-type: set
+ set:
+ description: |-
+ Set overwrites the request with the given header (name, value)
+ before the action.
+
+
+ Input:
+ GET /foo HTTP/1.1
+ my-header: foo
+
+
+ Config:
+ set:
+ - name: "my-header"
+ value: "bar"
+
+
+ Output:
+ GET /foo HTTP/1.1
+ my-header: bar
+ items:
+ description: HTTPHeader represents an HTTP
+ Header name and value as defined by RFC
+ 7230.
+ properties:
+ name:
+ description: |-
+ Name is the name of the HTTP Header to be matched. Name matching MUST be
+ case insensitive. (See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc7230#section-3.2).
+
+
+ If multiple entries specify equivalent header names, the first entry with
+ an equivalent name MUST be considered for a match. Subsequent entries
+ with an equivalent header name MUST be ignored. Due to the
+ case-insensitivity of header names, "foo" and "Foo" are considered
+ equivalent.
+ maxLength: 256
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[A-Za-z0-9!#$%&'*+\-.^_\x60|~]+$
+ type: string
+ value:
+ description: Value is the value of HTTP
+ Header to be matched.
+ maxLength: 4096
+ minLength: 1
+ type: string
+ required:
+ - name
+ - value
+ type: object
+ maxItems: 16
+ type: array
+ x-kubernetes-list-map-keys:
+ - name
+ x-kubernetes-list-type: map
+ type: object
+ type:
+ description: |-
+ Type identifies the type of filter to apply. As with other API fields,
+ types are classified into three conformance levels:
+
+
+ - Core: Filter types and their corresponding configuration defined by
+ "Support: Core" in this package, e.g. "RequestHeaderModifier". All
+ implementations must support core filters.
+
+
+ - Extended: Filter types and their corresponding configuration defined by
+ "Support: Extended" in this package, e.g. "RequestMirror". Implementers
+ are encouraged to support extended filters.
+
+
+ - Implementation-specific: Filters that are defined and supported by
+ specific vendors.
+ In the future, filters showing convergence in behavior across multiple
+ implementations will be considered for inclusion in extended or core
+ conformance levels. Filter-specific configuration for such filters
+ is specified using the ExtensionRef field. `Type` should be set to
+ "ExtensionRef" for custom filters.
+
+
+ Implementers are encouraged to define custom implementation types to
+ extend the core API with implementation-specific behavior.
+
+
+ If a reference to a custom filter type cannot be resolved, the filter
+ MUST NOT be skipped. Instead, requests that would have been processed by
+ that filter MUST receive a HTTP error response.
+
+
+ Note that values may be added to this enum, implementations
+ must ensure that unknown values will not cause a crash.
+
+
+ Unknown values here must result in the implementation setting the
+ Accepted Condition for the Route to `status: False`, with a
+ Reason of `UnsupportedValue`.
+ enum:
+ - RequestHeaderModifier
+ - ResponseHeaderModifier
+ - RequestMirror
+ - RequestRedirect
+ - URLRewrite
+ - ExtensionRef
+ type: string
+ urlRewrite:
+ description: |-
+ URLRewrite defines a schema for a filter that modifies a request during forwarding.
+
+
+ Support: Extended
+ properties:
+ hostname:
+ description: |-
+ Hostname is the value to be used to replace the Host header value during
+ forwarding.
+
+
+ Support: Extended
+ maxLength: 253
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$
+ type: string
+ path:
+ description: |-
+ Path defines a path rewrite.
+
+
+ Support: Extended
+ properties:
+ replaceFullPath:
+ description: |-
+ ReplaceFullPath specifies the value with which to replace the full path
+ of a request during a rewrite or redirect.
+ maxLength: 1024
+ type: string
+ replacePrefixMatch:
+ description: |-
+ ReplacePrefixMatch specifies the value with which to replace the prefix
+ match of a request during a rewrite or redirect. For example, a request
+ to "/foo/bar" with a prefix match of "/foo" and a ReplacePrefixMatch
+ of "/xyz" would be modified to "/xyz/bar".
+
+
+ Note that this matches the behavior of the PathPrefix match type. This
+ matches full path elements. A path element refers to the list of labels
+ in the path split by the `/` separator. When specified, a trailing `/` is
+ ignored. For example, the paths `/abc`, `/abc/`, and `/abc/def` would all
+ match the prefix `/abc`, but the path `/abcd` would not.
+
+
+ ReplacePrefixMatch is only compatible with a `PathPrefix` HTTPRouteMatch.
+ Using any other HTTPRouteMatch type on the same HTTPRouteRule will result in
+ the implementation setting the Accepted Condition for the Route to `status: False`.
+
+
+ Request Path | Prefix Match | Replace Prefix | Modified Path
+ -------------|--------------|----------------|----------
+ /foo/bar | /foo | /xyz | /xyz/bar
+ /foo/bar | /foo | /xyz/ | /xyz/bar
+ /foo/bar | /foo/ | /xyz | /xyz/bar
+ /foo/bar | /foo/ | /xyz/ | /xyz/bar
+ /foo | /foo | /xyz | /xyz
+ /foo/ | /foo | /xyz | /xyz/
+ /foo/bar | /foo | | /bar
+ /foo/ | /foo | | /
+ /foo | /foo | | /
+ /foo/ | /foo | / | /
+ /foo | /foo | / | /
+ maxLength: 1024
+ type: string
+ type:
+ description: |-
+ Type defines the type of path modifier. Additional types may be
+ added in a future release of the API.
+
+
+ Note that values may be added to this enum, implementations
+ must ensure that unknown values will not cause a crash.
+
+
+ Unknown values here must result in the implementation setting the
+ Accepted Condition for the Route to `status: False`, with a
+ Reason of `UnsupportedValue`.
+ enum:
+ - ReplaceFullPath
+ - ReplacePrefixMatch
+ type: string
+ required:
+ - type
+ type: object
+ x-kubernetes-validations:
+ - message: replaceFullPath must be specified
+ when type is set to 'ReplaceFullPath'
+ rule: 'self.type == ''ReplaceFullPath'' ?
+ has(self.replaceFullPath) : true'
+ - message: type must be 'ReplaceFullPath' when
+ replaceFullPath is set
+ rule: 'has(self.replaceFullPath) ? self.type
+ == ''ReplaceFullPath'' : true'
+ - message: replacePrefixMatch must be specified
+ when type is set to 'ReplacePrefixMatch'
+ rule: 'self.type == ''ReplacePrefixMatch''
+ ? has(self.replacePrefixMatch) : true'
+ - message: type must be 'ReplacePrefixMatch'
+ when replacePrefixMatch is set
+ rule: 'has(self.replacePrefixMatch) ? self.type
+ == ''ReplacePrefixMatch'' : true'
+ type: object
+ required:
+ - type
+ type: object
+ x-kubernetes-validations:
+ - message: filter.requestHeaderModifier must be nil
+ if the filter.type is not RequestHeaderModifier
+ rule: '!(has(self.requestHeaderModifier) && self.type
+ != ''RequestHeaderModifier'')'
+ - message: filter.requestHeaderModifier must be specified
+ for RequestHeaderModifier filter.type
+ rule: '!(!has(self.requestHeaderModifier) && self.type
+ == ''RequestHeaderModifier'')'
+ - message: filter.responseHeaderModifier must be nil
+ if the filter.type is not ResponseHeaderModifier
+ rule: '!(has(self.responseHeaderModifier) && self.type
+ != ''ResponseHeaderModifier'')'
+ - message: filter.responseHeaderModifier must be specified
+ for ResponseHeaderModifier filter.type
+ rule: '!(!has(self.responseHeaderModifier) && self.type
+ == ''ResponseHeaderModifier'')'
+ - message: filter.requestMirror must be nil if the filter.type
+ is not RequestMirror
+ rule: '!(has(self.requestMirror) && self.type != ''RequestMirror'')'
+ - message: filter.requestMirror must be specified for
+ RequestMirror filter.type
+ rule: '!(!has(self.requestMirror) && self.type ==
+ ''RequestMirror'')'
+ - message: filter.requestRedirect must be nil if the
+ filter.type is not RequestRedirect
+ rule: '!(has(self.requestRedirect) && self.type !=
+ ''RequestRedirect'')'
+ - message: filter.requestRedirect must be specified
+ for RequestRedirect filter.type
+ rule: '!(!has(self.requestRedirect) && self.type ==
+ ''RequestRedirect'')'
+ - message: filter.urlRewrite must be nil if the filter.type
+ is not URLRewrite
+ rule: '!(has(self.urlRewrite) && self.type != ''URLRewrite'')'
+ - message: filter.urlRewrite must be specified for URLRewrite
+ filter.type
+ rule: '!(!has(self.urlRewrite) && self.type == ''URLRewrite'')'
+ - message: filter.extensionRef must be nil if the filter.type
+ is not ExtensionRef
+ rule: '!(has(self.extensionRef) && self.type != ''ExtensionRef'')'
+ - message: filter.extensionRef must be specified for
+ ExtensionRef filter.type
+ rule: '!(!has(self.extensionRef) && self.type == ''ExtensionRef'')'
+ maxItems: 16
+ type: array
+ x-kubernetes-validations:
+ - message: May specify either httpRouteFilterRequestRedirect
+ or httpRouteFilterRequestRewrite, but not both
+ rule: '!(self.exists(f, f.type == ''RequestRedirect'')
+ && self.exists(f, f.type == ''URLRewrite''))'
+ - message: May specify either httpRouteFilterRequestRedirect
+ or httpRouteFilterRequestRewrite, but not both
+ rule: '!(self.exists(f, f.type == ''RequestRedirect'')
+ && self.exists(f, f.type == ''URLRewrite''))'
+ - message: RequestHeaderModifier filter cannot be repeated
+ rule: self.filter(f, f.type == 'RequestHeaderModifier').size()
+ <= 1
+ - message: ResponseHeaderModifier filter cannot be repeated
+ rule: self.filter(f, f.type == 'ResponseHeaderModifier').size()
+ <= 1
+ - message: RequestRedirect filter cannot be repeated
+ rule: self.filter(f, f.type == 'RequestRedirect').size()
+ <= 1
+ - message: URLRewrite filter cannot be repeated
+ rule: self.filter(f, f.type == 'URLRewrite').size()
+ <= 1
+ group:
+ default: ""
+ description: |-
+ Group is the group of the referent. For example, "gateway.networking.k8s.io".
+ When unspecified or empty string, core API group is inferred.
+ maxLength: 253
+ pattern: ^$|^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$
+ type: string
+ kind:
+ default: Service
+ description: |-
+ Kind is the Kubernetes resource kind of the referent. For example
+ "Service".
+
+
+ Defaults to "Service" when not specified.
+
+
+ ExternalName services can refer to CNAME DNS records that may live
+ outside of the cluster and as such are difficult to reason about in
+ terms of conformance. They also may not be safe to forward to (see
+ CVE-2021-25740 for more information). Implementations SHOULD NOT
+ support ExternalName Services.
+
+
+ Support: Core (Services with a type other than ExternalName)
+
+
+ Support: Implementation-specific (Services with type ExternalName)
+ maxLength: 63
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[a-zA-Z]([-a-zA-Z0-9]*[a-zA-Z0-9])?$
+ type: string
+ name:
+ description: Name is the name of the referent.
+ maxLength: 253
+ minLength: 1
+ type: string
+ namespace:
+ description: |-
+ Namespace is the namespace of the backend. When unspecified, the local
+ namespace is inferred.
+
+
+ Note that when a namespace different than the local namespace is specified,
+ a ReferenceGrant object is required in the referent namespace to allow that
+ namespace's owner to accept the reference. See the ReferenceGrant
+ documentation for details.
+
+
+ Support: Core
+ maxLength: 63
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?$
+ type: string
+ port:
+ description: |-
+ Port specifies the destination port number to use for this resource.
+ Port is required when the referent is a Kubernetes Service. In this
+ case, the port number is the service port number, not the target port.
+ For other resources, destination port might be derived from the referent
+ resource or this field.
+ format: int32
+ maximum: 65535
+ minimum: 1
+ type: integer
+ weight:
+ default: 1
+ description: |-
+ Weight specifies the proportion of requests forwarded to the referenced
+ backend. This is computed as weight/(sum of all weights in this
+ BackendRefs list). For non-zero values, there may be some epsilon from
+ the exact proportion defined here depending on the precision an
+ implementation supports. Weight is not a percentage and the sum of
+ weights does not need to equal 100.
+
+
+ If only one backend is specified and it has a weight greater than 0, 100%
+ of the traffic is forwarded to that backend. If weight is set to 0, no
+ traffic should be forwarded for this entry. If unspecified, weight
+ defaults to 1.
+
+
+ Support for this field varies based on the context where used.
+ format: int32
+ maximum: 1000000
+ minimum: 0
+ type: integer
+ required:
+ - name
+ type: object
+ x-kubernetes-validations:
+ - message: Must have port for Service reference
+ rule: '(size(self.group) == 0 && self.kind == ''Service'')
+ ? has(self.port) : true'
+ maxItems: 16
+ type: array
+ filters:
+ description: |-
+ Filters define the filters that are applied to requests that match
+ this rule.
+
+
+ Wherever possible, implementations SHOULD implement filters in the order
+ they are specified.
+
+
+ Implementations MAY choose to implement this ordering strictly, rejecting
+ any combination or order of filters that can not be supported. If implementations
+ choose a strict interpretation of filter ordering, they MUST clearly document
+ that behavior.
+
+
+ To reject an invalid combination or order of filters, implementations SHOULD
+ consider the Route Rules with this configuration invalid. If all Route Rules
+ in a Route are invalid, the entire Route would be considered invalid. If only
+ a portion of Route Rules are invalid, implementations MUST set the
+ "PartiallyInvalid" condition for the Route.
+
+
+ Conformance-levels at this level are defined based on the type of filter:
+
+
+ - ALL core filters MUST be supported by all implementations.
+ - Implementers are encouraged to support extended filters.
+ - Implementation-specific custom filters have no API guarantees across
+ implementations.
+
+
+ Specifying the same filter multiple times is not supported unless explicitly
+ indicated in the filter.
+
+
+ All filters are expected to be compatible with each other except for the
+ URLRewrite and RequestRedirect filters, which may not be combined. If an
+ implementation can not support other combinations of filters, they must clearly
+ document that limitation. In cases where incompatible or unsupported
+ filters are specified and cause the `Accepted` condition to be set to status
+ `False`, implementations may use the `IncompatibleFilters` reason to specify
+ this configuration error.
+
+
+ Support: Core
+ items:
+ description: |-
+ HTTPRouteFilter defines processing steps that must be completed during the
+ request or response lifecycle. HTTPRouteFilters are meant as an extension
+ point to express processing that may be done in Gateway implementations. Some
+ examples include request or response modification, implementing
+ authentication strategies, rate-limiting, and traffic shaping. API
+ guarantee/conformance is defined based on the type of the filter.
+ properties:
+ extensionRef:
+ description: |-
+ ExtensionRef is an optional, implementation-specific extension to the
+ "filter" behavior. For example, resource "myroutefilter" in group
+ "networking.example.net"). ExtensionRef MUST NOT be used for core and
+ extended filters.
+
+
+ This filter can be used multiple times within the same rule.
+
+
+ Support: Implementation-specific
+ properties:
+ group:
+ description: |-
+ Group is the group of the referent. For example, "gateway.networking.k8s.io".
+ When unspecified or empty string, core API group is inferred.
+ maxLength: 253
+ pattern: ^$|^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$
+ type: string
+ kind:
+ description: Kind is kind of the referent. For example
+ "HTTPRoute" or "Service".
+ maxLength: 63
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[a-zA-Z]([-a-zA-Z0-9]*[a-zA-Z0-9])?$
+ type: string
+ name:
+ description: Name is the name of the referent.
+ maxLength: 253
+ minLength: 1
+ type: string
+ required:
+ - group
+ - kind
+ - name
+ type: object
+ requestHeaderModifier:
+ description: |-
+ RequestHeaderModifier defines a schema for a filter that modifies request
+ headers.
+
+
+ Support: Core
+ properties:
+ add:
+ description: |-
+ Add adds the given header(s) (name, value) to the request
+ before the action. It appends to any existing values associated
+ with the header name.
+
+
+ Input:
+ GET /foo HTTP/1.1
+ my-header: foo
+
+
+ Config:
+ add:
+ - name: "my-header"
+ value: "bar,baz"
+
+
+ Output:
+ GET /foo HTTP/1.1
+ my-header: foo,bar,baz
+ items:
+ description: HTTPHeader represents an HTTP Header
+ name and value as defined by RFC 7230.
+ properties:
+ name:
+ description: |-
+ Name is the name of the HTTP Header to be matched. Name matching MUST be
+ case insensitive. (See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc7230#section-3.2).
+
+
+ If multiple entries specify equivalent header names, the first entry with
+ an equivalent name MUST be considered for a match. Subsequent entries
+ with an equivalent header name MUST be ignored. Due to the
+ case-insensitivity of header names, "foo" and "Foo" are considered
+ equivalent.
+ maxLength: 256
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[A-Za-z0-9!#$%&'*+\-.^_\x60|~]+$
+ type: string
+ value:
+ description: Value is the value of HTTP Header
+ to be matched.
+ maxLength: 4096
+ minLength: 1
+ type: string
+ required:
+ - name
+ - value
+ type: object
+ maxItems: 16
+ type: array
+ x-kubernetes-list-map-keys:
+ - name
+ x-kubernetes-list-type: map
+ remove:
+ description: |-
+ Remove the given header(s) from the HTTP request before the action. The
+ value of Remove is a list of HTTP header names. Note that the header
+ names are case-insensitive (see
+ https://datatracker.ietf.org/doc/html/rfc2616#section-4.2).
+
+
+ Input:
+ GET /foo HTTP/1.1
+ my-header1: foo
+ my-header2: bar
+ my-header3: baz
+
+
+ Config:
+ remove: ["my-header1", "my-header3"]
+
+
+ Output:
+ GET /foo HTTP/1.1
+ my-header2: bar
+ items:
+ type: string
+ maxItems: 16
+ type: array
+ x-kubernetes-list-type: set
+ set:
+ description: |-
+ Set overwrites the request with the given header (name, value)
+ before the action.
+
+
+ Input:
+ GET /foo HTTP/1.1
+ my-header: foo
+
+
+ Config:
+ set:
+ - name: "my-header"
+ value: "bar"
+
+
+ Output:
+ GET /foo HTTP/1.1
+ my-header: bar
+ items:
+ description: HTTPHeader represents an HTTP Header
+ name and value as defined by RFC 7230.
+ properties:
+ name:
+ description: |-
+ Name is the name of the HTTP Header to be matched. Name matching MUST be
+ case insensitive. (See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc7230#section-3.2).
+
+
+ If multiple entries specify equivalent header names, the first entry with
+ an equivalent name MUST be considered for a match. Subsequent entries
+ with an equivalent header name MUST be ignored. Due to the
+ case-insensitivity of header names, "foo" and "Foo" are considered
+ equivalent.
+ maxLength: 256
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[A-Za-z0-9!#$%&'*+\-.^_\x60|~]+$
+ type: string
+ value:
+ description: Value is the value of HTTP Header
+ to be matched.
+ maxLength: 4096
+ minLength: 1
+ type: string
+ required:
+ - name
+ - value
+ type: object
+ maxItems: 16
+ type: array
+ x-kubernetes-list-map-keys:
+ - name
+ x-kubernetes-list-type: map
+ type: object
+ requestMirror:
+ description: |-
+ RequestMirror defines a schema for a filter that mirrors requests.
+ Requests are sent to the specified destination, but responses from
+ that destination are ignored.
+
+
+ This filter can be used multiple times within the same rule. Note that
+ not all implementations will be able to support mirroring to multiple
+ backends.
+
+
+ Support: Extended
+ properties:
+ backendRef:
+ description: |-
+ BackendRef references a resource where mirrored requests are sent.
+
+
+ Mirrored requests must be sent only to a single destination endpoint
+ within this BackendRef, irrespective of how many endpoints are present
+ within this BackendRef.
+
+
+ If the referent cannot be found, this BackendRef is invalid and must be
+ dropped from the Gateway. The controller must ensure the "ResolvedRefs"
+ condition on the Route status is set to `status: False` and not configure
+ this backend in the underlying implementation.
+
+
+ If there is a cross-namespace reference to an *existing* object
+ that is not allowed by a ReferenceGrant, the controller must ensure the
+ "ResolvedRefs" condition on the Route is set to `status: False`,
+ with the "RefNotPermitted" reason and not configure this backend in the
+ underlying implementation.
+
+
+ In either error case, the Message of the `ResolvedRefs` Condition
+ should be used to provide more detail about the problem.
+
+
+ Support: Extended for Kubernetes Service
+
+
+ Support: Implementation-specific for any other resource
+ properties:
+ group:
+ default: ""
+ description: |-
+ Group is the group of the referent. For example, "gateway.networking.k8s.io".
+ When unspecified or empty string, core API group is inferred.
+ maxLength: 253
+ pattern: ^$|^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$
+ type: string
+ kind:
+ default: Service
+ description: |-
+ Kind is the Kubernetes resource kind of the referent. For example
+ "Service".
+
+
+ Defaults to "Service" when not specified.
+
+
+ ExternalName services can refer to CNAME DNS records that may live
+ outside of the cluster and as such are difficult to reason about in
+ terms of conformance. They also may not be safe to forward to (see
+ CVE-2021-25740 for more information). Implementations SHOULD NOT
+ support ExternalName Services.
+
+
+ Support: Core (Services with a type other than ExternalName)
+
+
+ Support: Implementation-specific (Services with type ExternalName)
+ maxLength: 63
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[a-zA-Z]([-a-zA-Z0-9]*[a-zA-Z0-9])?$
+ type: string
+ name:
+ description: Name is the name of the referent.
+ maxLength: 253
+ minLength: 1
+ type: string
+ namespace:
+ description: |-
+ Namespace is the namespace of the backend. When unspecified, the local
+ namespace is inferred.
+
+
+ Note that when a namespace different than the local namespace is specified,
+ a ReferenceGrant object is required in the referent namespace to allow that
+ namespace's owner to accept the reference. See the ReferenceGrant
+ documentation for details.
+
+
+ Support: Core
+ maxLength: 63
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?$
+ type: string
+ port:
+ description: |-
+ Port specifies the destination port number to use for this resource.
+ Port is required when the referent is a Kubernetes Service. In this
+ case, the port number is the service port number, not the target port.
+ For other resources, destination port might be derived from the referent
+ resource or this field.
+ format: int32
+ maximum: 65535
+ minimum: 1
+ type: integer
+ required:
+ - name
+ type: object
+ x-kubernetes-validations:
+ - message: Must have port for Service reference
+ rule: '(size(self.group) == 0 && self.kind == ''Service'')
+ ? has(self.port) : true'
+ required:
+ - backendRef
+ type: object
+ requestRedirect:
+ description: |-
+ RequestRedirect defines a schema for a filter that responds to the
+ request with an HTTP redirection.
+
+
+ Support: Core
+ properties:
+ hostname:
+ description: |-
+ Hostname is the hostname to be used in the value of the `Location`
+ header in the response.
+ When empty, the hostname in the `Host` header of the request is used.
+
+
+ Support: Core
+ maxLength: 253
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$
+ type: string
+ path:
+ description: |-
+ Path defines parameters used to modify the path of the incoming request.
+ The modified path is then used to construct the `Location` header. When
+ empty, the request path is used as-is.
+
+
+ Support: Extended
+ properties:
+ replaceFullPath:
+ description: |-
+ ReplaceFullPath specifies the value with which to replace the full path
+ of a request during a rewrite or redirect.
+ maxLength: 1024
+ type: string
+ replacePrefixMatch:
+ description: |-
+ ReplacePrefixMatch specifies the value with which to replace the prefix
+ match of a request during a rewrite or redirect. For example, a request
+ to "/foo/bar" with a prefix match of "/foo" and a ReplacePrefixMatch
+ of "/xyz" would be modified to "/xyz/bar".
+
+
+ Note that this matches the behavior of the PathPrefix match type. This
+ matches full path elements. A path element refers to the list of labels
+ in the path split by the `/` separator. When specified, a trailing `/` is
+ ignored. For example, the paths `/abc`, `/abc/`, and `/abc/def` would all
+ match the prefix `/abc`, but the path `/abcd` would not.
+
+
+ ReplacePrefixMatch is only compatible with a `PathPrefix` HTTPRouteMatch.
+ Using any other HTTPRouteMatch type on the same HTTPRouteRule will result in
+ the implementation setting the Accepted Condition for the Route to `status: False`.
+
+
+ Request Path | Prefix Match | Replace Prefix | Modified Path
+ -------------|--------------|----------------|----------
+ /foo/bar | /foo | /xyz | /xyz/bar
+ /foo/bar | /foo | /xyz/ | /xyz/bar
+ /foo/bar | /foo/ | /xyz | /xyz/bar
+ /foo/bar | /foo/ | /xyz/ | /xyz/bar
+ /foo | /foo | /xyz | /xyz
+ /foo/ | /foo | /xyz | /xyz/
+ /foo/bar | /foo | | /bar
+ /foo/ | /foo | | /
+ /foo | /foo | | /
+ /foo/ | /foo | / | /
+ /foo | /foo | / | /
+ maxLength: 1024
+ type: string
+ type:
+ description: |-
+ Type defines the type of path modifier. Additional types may be
+ added in a future release of the API.
+
+
+ Note that values may be added to this enum, implementations
+ must ensure that unknown values will not cause a crash.
+
+
+ Unknown values here must result in the implementation setting the
+ Accepted Condition for the Route to `status: False`, with a
+ Reason of `UnsupportedValue`.
+ enum:
+ - ReplaceFullPath
+ - ReplacePrefixMatch
+ type: string
+ required:
+ - type
+ type: object
+ x-kubernetes-validations:
+ - message: replaceFullPath must be specified when
+ type is set to 'ReplaceFullPath'
+ rule: 'self.type == ''ReplaceFullPath'' ? has(self.replaceFullPath)
+ : true'
+ - message: type must be 'ReplaceFullPath' when replaceFullPath
+ is set
+ rule: 'has(self.replaceFullPath) ? self.type ==
+ ''ReplaceFullPath'' : true'
+ - message: replacePrefixMatch must be specified when
+ type is set to 'ReplacePrefixMatch'
+ rule: 'self.type == ''ReplacePrefixMatch'' ? has(self.replacePrefixMatch)
+ : true'
+ - message: type must be 'ReplacePrefixMatch' when
+ replacePrefixMatch is set
+ rule: 'has(self.replacePrefixMatch) ? self.type
+ == ''ReplacePrefixMatch'' : true'
+ port:
+ description: |-
+ Port is the port to be used in the value of the `Location`
+ header in the response.
+
+
+ If no port is specified, the redirect port MUST be derived using the
+ following rules:
+
+
+ * If redirect scheme is not-empty, the redirect port MUST be the well-known
+ port associated with the redirect scheme. Specifically "http" to port 80
+ and "https" to port 443. If the redirect scheme does not have a
+ well-known port, the listener port of the Gateway SHOULD be used.
+ * If redirect scheme is empty, the redirect port MUST be the Gateway
+ Listener port.
+
+
+ Implementations SHOULD NOT add the port number in the 'Location'
+ header in the following cases:
+
+
+ * A Location header that will use HTTP (whether that is determined via
+ the Listener protocol or the Scheme field) _and_ use port 80.
+ * A Location header that will use HTTPS (whether that is determined via
+ the Listener protocol or the Scheme field) _and_ use port 443.
+
+
+ Support: Extended
+ format: int32
+ maximum: 65535
+ minimum: 1
+ type: integer
+ scheme:
+ description: |-
+ Scheme is the scheme to be used in the value of the `Location` header in
+ the response. When empty, the scheme of the request is used.
+
+
+ Scheme redirects can affect the port of the redirect, for more information,
+ refer to the documentation for the port field of this filter.
+
+
+ Note that values may be added to this enum, implementations
+ must ensure that unknown values will not cause a crash.
+
+
+ Unknown values here must result in the implementation setting the
+ Accepted Condition for the Route to `status: False`, with a
+ Reason of `UnsupportedValue`.
+
+
+ Support: Extended
+ enum:
+ - http
+ - https
+ type: string
+ statusCode:
+ default: 302
+ description: |-
+ StatusCode is the HTTP status code to be used in response.
+
+
+ Note that values may be added to this enum, implementations
+ must ensure that unknown values will not cause a crash.
+
+
+ Unknown values here must result in the implementation setting the
+ Accepted Condition for the Route to `status: False`, with a
+ Reason of `UnsupportedValue`.
+
+
+ Support: Core
+ enum:
+ - 301
+ - 302
+ type: integer
+ type: object
+ responseHeaderModifier:
+ description: |-
+ ResponseHeaderModifier defines a schema for a filter that modifies response
+ headers.
+
+
+ Support: Extended
+ properties:
+ add:
+ description: |-
+ Add adds the given header(s) (name, value) to the request
+ before the action. It appends to any existing values associated
+ with the header name.
+
+
+ Input:
+ GET /foo HTTP/1.1
+ my-header: foo
+
+
+ Config:
+ add:
+ - name: "my-header"
+ value: "bar,baz"
+
+
+ Output:
+ GET /foo HTTP/1.1
+ my-header: foo,bar,baz
+ items:
+ description: HTTPHeader represents an HTTP Header
+ name and value as defined by RFC 7230.
+ properties:
+ name:
+ description: |-
+ Name is the name of the HTTP Header to be matched. Name matching MUST be
+ case insensitive. (See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc7230#section-3.2).
+
+
+ If multiple entries specify equivalent header names, the first entry with
+ an equivalent name MUST be considered for a match. Subsequent entries
+ with an equivalent header name MUST be ignored. Due to the
+ case-insensitivity of header names, "foo" and "Foo" are considered
+ equivalent.
+ maxLength: 256
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[A-Za-z0-9!#$%&'*+\-.^_\x60|~]+$
+ type: string
+ value:
+ description: Value is the value of HTTP Header
+ to be matched.
+ maxLength: 4096
+ minLength: 1
+ type: string
+ required:
+ - name
+ - value
+ type: object
+ maxItems: 16
+ type: array
+ x-kubernetes-list-map-keys:
+ - name
+ x-kubernetes-list-type: map
+ remove:
+ description: |-
+ Remove the given header(s) from the HTTP request before the action. The
+ value of Remove is a list of HTTP header names. Note that the header
+ names are case-insensitive (see
+ https://datatracker.ietf.org/doc/html/rfc2616#section-4.2).
+
+
+ Input:
+ GET /foo HTTP/1.1
+ my-header1: foo
+ my-header2: bar
+ my-header3: baz
+
+
+ Config:
+ remove: ["my-header1", "my-header3"]
+
+
+ Output:
+ GET /foo HTTP/1.1
+ my-header2: bar
+ items:
+ type: string
+ maxItems: 16
+ type: array
+ x-kubernetes-list-type: set
+ set:
+ description: |-
+ Set overwrites the request with the given header (name, value)
+ before the action.
+
+
+ Input:
+ GET /foo HTTP/1.1
+ my-header: foo
+
+
+ Config:
+ set:
+ - name: "my-header"
+ value: "bar"
+
+
+ Output:
+ GET /foo HTTP/1.1
+ my-header: bar
+ items:
+ description: HTTPHeader represents an HTTP Header
+ name and value as defined by RFC 7230.
+ properties:
+ name:
+ description: |-
+ Name is the name of the HTTP Header to be matched. Name matching MUST be
+ case insensitive. (See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc7230#section-3.2).
+
+
+ If multiple entries specify equivalent header names, the first entry with
+ an equivalent name MUST be considered for a match. Subsequent entries
+ with an equivalent header name MUST be ignored. Due to the
+ case-insensitivity of header names, "foo" and "Foo" are considered
+ equivalent.
+ maxLength: 256
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[A-Za-z0-9!#$%&'*+\-.^_\x60|~]+$
+ type: string
+ value:
+ description: Value is the value of HTTP Header
+ to be matched.
+ maxLength: 4096
+ minLength: 1
+ type: string
+ required:
+ - name
+ - value
+ type: object
+ maxItems: 16
+ type: array
+ x-kubernetes-list-map-keys:
+ - name
+ x-kubernetes-list-type: map
+ type: object
+ type:
+ description: |-
+ Type identifies the type of filter to apply. As with other API fields,
+ types are classified into three conformance levels:
+
+
+ - Core: Filter types and their corresponding configuration defined by
+ "Support: Core" in this package, e.g. "RequestHeaderModifier". All
+ implementations must support core filters.
+
+
+ - Extended: Filter types and their corresponding configuration defined by
+ "Support: Extended" in this package, e.g. "RequestMirror". Implementers
+ are encouraged to support extended filters.
+
+
+ - Implementation-specific: Filters that are defined and supported by
+ specific vendors.
+ In the future, filters showing convergence in behavior across multiple
+ implementations will be considered for inclusion in extended or core
+ conformance levels. Filter-specific configuration for such filters
+ is specified using the ExtensionRef field. `Type` should be set to
+ "ExtensionRef" for custom filters.
+
+
+ Implementers are encouraged to define custom implementation types to
+ extend the core API with implementation-specific behavior.
+
+
+ If a reference to a custom filter type cannot be resolved, the filter
+ MUST NOT be skipped. Instead, requests that would have been processed by
+ that filter MUST receive a HTTP error response.
+
+
+ Note that values may be added to this enum, implementations
+ must ensure that unknown values will not cause a crash.
+
+
+ Unknown values here must result in the implementation setting the
+ Accepted Condition for the Route to `status: False`, with a
+ Reason of `UnsupportedValue`.
+ enum:
+ - RequestHeaderModifier
+ - ResponseHeaderModifier
+ - RequestMirror
+ - RequestRedirect
+ - URLRewrite
+ - ExtensionRef
+ type: string
+ urlRewrite:
+ description: |-
+ URLRewrite defines a schema for a filter that modifies a request during forwarding.
+
+
+ Support: Extended
+ properties:
+ hostname:
+ description: |-
+ Hostname is the value to be used to replace the Host header value during
+ forwarding.
+
+
+ Support: Extended
+ maxLength: 253
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$
+ type: string
+ path:
+ description: |-
+ Path defines a path rewrite.
+
+
+ Support: Extended
+ properties:
+ replaceFullPath:
+ description: |-
+ ReplaceFullPath specifies the value with which to replace the full path
+ of a request during a rewrite or redirect.
+ maxLength: 1024
+ type: string
+ replacePrefixMatch:
+ description: |-
+ ReplacePrefixMatch specifies the value with which to replace the prefix
+ match of a request during a rewrite or redirect. For example, a request
+ to "/foo/bar" with a prefix match of "/foo" and a ReplacePrefixMatch
+ of "/xyz" would be modified to "/xyz/bar".
+
+
+ Note that this matches the behavior of the PathPrefix match type. This
+ matches full path elements. A path element refers to the list of labels
+ in the path split by the `/` separator. When specified, a trailing `/` is
+ ignored. For example, the paths `/abc`, `/abc/`, and `/abc/def` would all
+ match the prefix `/abc`, but the path `/abcd` would not.
+
+
+ ReplacePrefixMatch is only compatible with a `PathPrefix` HTTPRouteMatch.
+ Using any other HTTPRouteMatch type on the same HTTPRouteRule will result in
+ the implementation setting the Accepted Condition for the Route to `status: False`.
+
+
+ Request Path | Prefix Match | Replace Prefix | Modified Path
+ -------------|--------------|----------------|----------
+ /foo/bar | /foo | /xyz | /xyz/bar
+ /foo/bar | /foo | /xyz/ | /xyz/bar
+ /foo/bar | /foo/ | /xyz | /xyz/bar
+ /foo/bar | /foo/ | /xyz/ | /xyz/bar
+ /foo | /foo | /xyz | /xyz
+ /foo/ | /foo | /xyz | /xyz/
+ /foo/bar | /foo | | /bar
+ /foo/ | /foo | | /
+ /foo | /foo | | /
+ /foo/ | /foo | / | /
+ /foo | /foo | / | /
+ maxLength: 1024
+ type: string
+ type:
+ description: |-
+ Type defines the type of path modifier. Additional types may be
+ added in a future release of the API.
+
+
+ Note that values may be added to this enum, implementations
+ must ensure that unknown values will not cause a crash.
+
+
+ Unknown values here must result in the implementation setting the
+ Accepted Condition for the Route to `status: False`, with a
+ Reason of `UnsupportedValue`.
+ enum:
+ - ReplaceFullPath
+ - ReplacePrefixMatch
+ type: string
+ required:
+ - type
+ type: object
+ x-kubernetes-validations:
+ - message: replaceFullPath must be specified when
+ type is set to 'ReplaceFullPath'
+ rule: 'self.type == ''ReplaceFullPath'' ? has(self.replaceFullPath)
+ : true'
+ - message: type must be 'ReplaceFullPath' when replaceFullPath
+ is set
+ rule: 'has(self.replaceFullPath) ? self.type ==
+ ''ReplaceFullPath'' : true'
+ - message: replacePrefixMatch must be specified when
+ type is set to 'ReplacePrefixMatch'
+ rule: 'self.type == ''ReplacePrefixMatch'' ? has(self.replacePrefixMatch)
+ : true'
+ - message: type must be 'ReplacePrefixMatch' when
+ replacePrefixMatch is set
+ rule: 'has(self.replacePrefixMatch) ? self.type
+ == ''ReplacePrefixMatch'' : true'
+ type: object
+ required:
+ - type
+ type: object
+ x-kubernetes-validations:
+ - message: filter.requestHeaderModifier must be nil if the
+ filter.type is not RequestHeaderModifier
+ rule: '!(has(self.requestHeaderModifier) && self.type !=
+ ''RequestHeaderModifier'')'
+ - message: filter.requestHeaderModifier must be specified
+ for RequestHeaderModifier filter.type
+ rule: '!(!has(self.requestHeaderModifier) && self.type ==
+ ''RequestHeaderModifier'')'
+ - message: filter.responseHeaderModifier must be nil if the
+ filter.type is not ResponseHeaderModifier
+ rule: '!(has(self.responseHeaderModifier) && self.type !=
+ ''ResponseHeaderModifier'')'
+ - message: filter.responseHeaderModifier must be specified
+ for ResponseHeaderModifier filter.type
+ rule: '!(!has(self.responseHeaderModifier) && self.type
+ == ''ResponseHeaderModifier'')'
+ - message: filter.requestMirror must be nil if the filter.type
+ is not RequestMirror
+ rule: '!(has(self.requestMirror) && self.type != ''RequestMirror'')'
+ - message: filter.requestMirror must be specified for RequestMirror
+ filter.type
+ rule: '!(!has(self.requestMirror) && self.type == ''RequestMirror'')'
+ - message: filter.requestRedirect must be nil if the filter.type
+ is not RequestRedirect
+ rule: '!(has(self.requestRedirect) && self.type != ''RequestRedirect'')'
+ - message: filter.requestRedirect must be specified for RequestRedirect
+ filter.type
+ rule: '!(!has(self.requestRedirect) && self.type == ''RequestRedirect'')'
+ - message: filter.urlRewrite must be nil if the filter.type
+ is not URLRewrite
+ rule: '!(has(self.urlRewrite) && self.type != ''URLRewrite'')'
+ - message: filter.urlRewrite must be specified for URLRewrite
+ filter.type
+ rule: '!(!has(self.urlRewrite) && self.type == ''URLRewrite'')'
+ - message: filter.extensionRef must be nil if the filter.type
+ is not ExtensionRef
+ rule: '!(has(self.extensionRef) && self.type != ''ExtensionRef'')'
+ - message: filter.extensionRef must be specified for ExtensionRef
+ filter.type
+ rule: '!(!has(self.extensionRef) && self.type == ''ExtensionRef'')'
+ maxItems: 16
+ type: array
+ x-kubernetes-validations:
+ - message: May specify either httpRouteFilterRequestRedirect
+ or httpRouteFilterRequestRewrite, but not both
+ rule: '!(self.exists(f, f.type == ''RequestRedirect'') &&
+ self.exists(f, f.type == ''URLRewrite''))'
+ - message: RequestHeaderModifier filter cannot be repeated
+ rule: self.filter(f, f.type == 'RequestHeaderModifier').size()
+ <= 1
+ - message: ResponseHeaderModifier filter cannot be repeated
+ rule: self.filter(f, f.type == 'ResponseHeaderModifier').size()
+ <= 1
+ - message: RequestRedirect filter cannot be repeated
+ rule: self.filter(f, f.type == 'RequestRedirect').size() <=
+ 1
+ - message: URLRewrite filter cannot be repeated
+ rule: self.filter(f, f.type == 'URLRewrite').size() <= 1
+ matches:
+ default:
+ - path:
+ type: PathPrefix
+ value: /
+ description: |-
+ Matches define conditions used for matching the rule against incoming
+ HTTP requests. Each match is independent, i.e. this rule will be matched
+ if **any** one of the matches is satisfied.
+
+
+ For example, take the following matches configuration:
+
+
+ ```
+ matches:
+ - path:
+ value: "/foo"
+ headers:
+ - name: "version"
+ value: "v2"
+ - path:
+ value: "/v2/foo"
+ ```
+
+
+ For a request to match against this rule, a request must satisfy
+ EITHER of the two conditions:
+
+
+ - path prefixed with `/foo` AND contains the header `version: v2`
+ - path prefix of `/v2/foo`
+
+
+ See the documentation for HTTPRouteMatch on how to specify multiple
+ match conditions that should be ANDed together.
+
+
+ If no matches are specified, the default is a prefix
+ path match on "/", which has the effect of matching every
+ HTTP request.
+
+
+ Proxy or Load Balancer routing configuration generated from HTTPRoutes
+ MUST prioritize matches based on the following criteria, continuing on
+ ties. Across all rules specified on applicable Routes, precedence must be
+ given to the match having:
+
+
+ * "Exact" path match.
+ * "Prefix" path match with largest number of characters.
+ * Method match.
+ * Largest number of header matches.
+ * Largest number of query param matches.
+
+
+ Note: The precedence of RegularExpression path matches are implementation-specific.
+
+
+ If ties still exist across multiple Routes, matching precedence MUST be
+ determined in order of the following criteria, continuing on ties:
+
+
+ * The oldest Route based on creation timestamp.
+ * The Route appearing first in alphabetical order by
+ "{namespace}/{name}".
+
+
+ If ties still exist within an HTTPRoute, matching precedence MUST be granted
+ to the FIRST matching rule (in list order) with a match meeting the above
+ criteria.
+
+
+ When no rules matching a request have been successfully attached to the
+ parent a request is coming from, a HTTP 404 status code MUST be returned.
+ items:
+ description: "HTTPRouteMatch defines the predicate used to
+ match requests to a given\naction. Multiple match types
+ are ANDed together, i.e. the match will\nevaluate to true
+ only if all conditions are satisfied.\n\n\nFor example,
+ the match below will match a HTTP request only if its path\nstarts
+ with `/foo` AND it contains the `version: v1` header:\n\n\n```\nmatch:\n\n\n\tpath:\n\t
+ \ value: \"/foo\"\n\theaders:\n\t- name: \"version\"\n\t
+ \ value \"v1\"\n\n\n```"
+ properties:
+ headers:
+ description: |-
+ Headers specifies HTTP request header matchers. Multiple match values are
+ ANDed together, meaning, a request must match all the specified headers
+ to select the route.
+ items:
+ description: |-
+ HTTPHeaderMatch describes how to select a HTTP route by matching HTTP request
+ headers.
+ properties:
+ name:
+ description: |-
+ Name is the name of the HTTP Header to be matched. Name matching MUST be
+ case insensitive. (See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc7230#section-3.2).
+
+
+ If multiple entries specify equivalent header names, only the first
+ entry with an equivalent name MUST be considered for a match. Subsequent
+ entries with an equivalent header name MUST be ignored. Due to the
+ case-insensitivity of header names, "foo" and "Foo" are considered
+ equivalent.
+
+
+ When a header is repeated in an HTTP request, it is
+ implementation-specific behavior as to how this is represented.
+ Generally, proxies should follow the guidance from the RFC:
+ https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc7230.html#section-3.2.2 regarding
+ processing a repeated header, with special handling for "Set-Cookie".
+ maxLength: 256
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[A-Za-z0-9!#$%&'*+\-.^_\x60|~]+$
+ type: string
+ type:
+ default: Exact
+ description: |-
+ Type specifies how to match against the value of the header.
+
+
+ Support: Core (Exact)
+
+
+ Support: Implementation-specific (RegularExpression)
+
+
+ Since RegularExpression HeaderMatchType has implementation-specific
+ conformance, implementations can support POSIX, PCRE or any other dialects
+ of regular expressions. Please read the implementation's documentation to
+ determine the supported dialect.
+ enum:
+ - Exact
+ - RegularExpression
+ type: string
+ value:
+ description: Value is the value of HTTP Header to
+ be matched.
+ maxLength: 4096
+ minLength: 1
+ type: string
+ required:
+ - name
+ - value
+ type: object
+ maxItems: 16
+ type: array
+ x-kubernetes-list-map-keys:
+ - name
+ x-kubernetes-list-type: map
+ method:
+ description: |-
+ Method specifies HTTP method matcher.
+ When specified, this route will be matched only if the request has the
+ specified method.
+
+
+ Support: Extended
+ enum:
+ - GET
+ - HEAD
+ - POST
+ - PUT
+ - DELETE
+ - CONNECT
+ - OPTIONS
+ - TRACE
+ - PATCH
+ type: string
+ path:
+ default:
+ type: PathPrefix
+ value: /
+ description: |-
+ Path specifies a HTTP request path matcher. If this field is not
+ specified, a default prefix match on the "/" path is provided.
+ properties:
+ type:
+ default: PathPrefix
+ description: |-
+ Type specifies how to match against the path Value.
+
+
+ Support: Core (Exact, PathPrefix)
+
+
+ Support: Implementation-specific (RegularExpression)
+ enum:
+ - Exact
+ - PathPrefix
+ - RegularExpression
+ type: string
+ value:
+ default: /
+ description: Value of the HTTP path to match against.
+ maxLength: 1024
+ type: string
+ type: object
+ x-kubernetes-validations:
+ - message: value must be an absolute path and start with
+ '/' when type one of ['Exact', 'PathPrefix']
+ rule: '(self.type in [''Exact'',''PathPrefix'']) ? self.value.startsWith(''/'')
+ : true'
+ - message: must not contain '//' when type one of ['Exact',
+ 'PathPrefix']
+ rule: '(self.type in [''Exact'',''PathPrefix'']) ? !self.value.contains(''//'')
+ : true'
+ - message: must not contain '/./' when type one of ['Exact',
+ 'PathPrefix']
+ rule: '(self.type in [''Exact'',''PathPrefix'']) ? !self.value.contains(''/./'')
+ : true'
+ - message: must not contain '/../' when type one of ['Exact',
+ 'PathPrefix']
+ rule: '(self.type in [''Exact'',''PathPrefix'']) ? !self.value.contains(''/../'')
+ : true'
+ - message: must not contain '%2f' when type one of ['Exact',
+ 'PathPrefix']
+ rule: '(self.type in [''Exact'',''PathPrefix'']) ? !self.value.contains(''%2f'')
+ : true'
+ - message: must not contain '%2F' when type one of ['Exact',
+ 'PathPrefix']
+ rule: '(self.type in [''Exact'',''PathPrefix'']) ? !self.value.contains(''%2F'')
+ : true'
+ - message: must not contain '#' when type one of ['Exact',
+ 'PathPrefix']
+ rule: '(self.type in [''Exact'',''PathPrefix'']) ? !self.value.contains(''#'')
+ : true'
+ - message: must not end with '/..' when type one of ['Exact',
+ 'PathPrefix']
+ rule: '(self.type in [''Exact'',''PathPrefix'']) ? !self.value.endsWith(''/..'')
+ : true'
+ - message: must not end with '/.' when type one of ['Exact',
+ 'PathPrefix']
+ rule: '(self.type in [''Exact'',''PathPrefix'']) ? !self.value.endsWith(''/.'')
+ : true'
+ - message: type must be one of ['Exact', 'PathPrefix',
+ 'RegularExpression']
+ rule: self.type in ['Exact','PathPrefix'] || self.type
+ == 'RegularExpression'
+ - message: must only contain valid characters (matching
+ ^(?:[-A-Za-z0-9/._~!$&'()*+,;=:@]|[%][0-9a-fA-F]{2})+$)
+ for types ['Exact', 'PathPrefix']
+ rule: '(self.type in [''Exact'',''PathPrefix'']) ? self.value.matches(r"""^(?:[-A-Za-z0-9/._~!$&''()*+,;=:@]|[%][0-9a-fA-F]{2})+$""")
+ : true'
+ queryParams:
+ description: |-
+ QueryParams specifies HTTP query parameter matchers. Multiple match
+ values are ANDed together, meaning, a request must match all the
+ specified query parameters to select the route.
+
+
+ Support: Extended
+ items:
+ description: |-
+ HTTPQueryParamMatch describes how to select a HTTP route by matching HTTP
+ query parameters.
+ properties:
+ name:
+ description: |-
+ Name is the name of the HTTP query param to be matched. This must be an
+ exact string match. (See
+ https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc7230#section-2.7.3).
+
+
+ If multiple entries specify equivalent query param names, only the first
+ entry with an equivalent name MUST be considered for a match. Subsequent
+ entries with an equivalent query param name MUST be ignored.
+
+
+ If a query param is repeated in an HTTP request, the behavior is
+ purposely left undefined, since different data planes have different
+ capabilities. However, it is *recommended* that implementations should
+ match against the first value of the param if the data plane supports it,
+ as this behavior is expected in other load balancing contexts outside of
+ the Gateway API.
+
+
+ Users SHOULD NOT route traffic based on repeated query params to guard
+ themselves against potential differences in the implementations.
+ maxLength: 256
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[A-Za-z0-9!#$%&'*+\-.^_\x60|~]+$
+ type: string
+ type:
+ default: Exact
+ description: |-
+ Type specifies how to match against the value of the query parameter.
+
+
+ Support: Extended (Exact)
+
+
+ Support: Implementation-specific (RegularExpression)
+
+
+ Since RegularExpression QueryParamMatchType has Implementation-specific
+ conformance, implementations can support POSIX, PCRE or any other
+ dialects of regular expressions. Please read the implementation's
+ documentation to determine the supported dialect.
+ enum:
+ - Exact
+ - RegularExpression
+ type: string
+ value:
+ description: Value is the value of HTTP query param
+ to be matched.
+ maxLength: 1024
+ minLength: 1
+ type: string
+ required:
+ - name
+ - value
+ type: object
+ maxItems: 16
+ type: array
+ x-kubernetes-list-map-keys:
+ - name
+ x-kubernetes-list-type: map
+ type: object
+ maxItems: 8
+ type: array
+ type: object
+ x-kubernetes-validations:
+ - message: RequestRedirect filter must not be used together with
+ backendRefs
+ rule: '(has(self.backendRefs) && size(self.backendRefs) > 0) ?
+ (!has(self.filters) || self.filters.all(f, !has(f.requestRedirect))):
+ true'
+ - message: When using RequestRedirect filter with path.replacePrefixMatch,
+ exactly one PathPrefix match must be specified
+ rule: '(has(self.filters) && self.filters.exists_one(f, has(f.requestRedirect)
+ && has(f.requestRedirect.path) && f.requestRedirect.path.type
+ == ''ReplacePrefixMatch'' && has(f.requestRedirect.path.replacePrefixMatch)))
+ ? ((size(self.matches) != 1 || !has(self.matches[0].path) ||
+ self.matches[0].path.type != ''PathPrefix'') ? false : true)
+ : true'
+ - message: When using URLRewrite filter with path.replacePrefixMatch,
+ exactly one PathPrefix match must be specified
+ rule: '(has(self.filters) && self.filters.exists_one(f, has(f.urlRewrite)
+ && has(f.urlRewrite.path) && f.urlRewrite.path.type == ''ReplacePrefixMatch''
+ && has(f.urlRewrite.path.replacePrefixMatch))) ? ((size(self.matches)
+ != 1 || !has(self.matches[0].path) || self.matches[0].path.type
+ != ''PathPrefix'') ? false : true) : true'
+ - message: Within backendRefs, when using RequestRedirect filter
+ with path.replacePrefixMatch, exactly one PathPrefix match must
+ be specified
+ rule: '(has(self.backendRefs) && self.backendRefs.exists_one(b,
+ (has(b.filters) && b.filters.exists_one(f, has(f.requestRedirect)
+ && has(f.requestRedirect.path) && f.requestRedirect.path.type
+ == ''ReplacePrefixMatch'' && has(f.requestRedirect.path.replacePrefixMatch)))
+ )) ? ((size(self.matches) != 1 || !has(self.matches[0].path)
+ || self.matches[0].path.type != ''PathPrefix'') ? false : true)
+ : true'
+ - message: Within backendRefs, When using URLRewrite filter with
+ path.replacePrefixMatch, exactly one PathPrefix match must be
+ specified
+ rule: '(has(self.backendRefs) && self.backendRefs.exists_one(b,
+ (has(b.filters) && b.filters.exists_one(f, has(f.urlRewrite)
+ && has(f.urlRewrite.path) && f.urlRewrite.path.type == ''ReplacePrefixMatch''
+ && has(f.urlRewrite.path.replacePrefixMatch))) )) ? ((size(self.matches)
+ != 1 || !has(self.matches[0].path) || self.matches[0].path.type
+ != ''PathPrefix'') ? false : true) : true'
+ maxItems: 16
+ type: array
+ type: object
+ status:
+ description: Status defines the current state of HTTPRoute.
+ properties:
+ parents:
+ description: |-
+ Parents is a list of parent resources (usually Gateways) that are
+ associated with the route, and the status of the route with respect to
+ each parent. When this route attaches to a parent, the controller that
+ manages the parent must add an entry to this list when the controller
+ first sees the route and should update the entry as appropriate when the
+ route or gateway is modified.
+
+
+ Note that parent references that cannot be resolved by an implementation
+ of this API will not be added to this list. Implementations of this API
+ can only populate Route status for the Gateways/parent resources they are
+ responsible for.
+
+
+ A maximum of 32 Gateways will be represented in this list. An empty list
+ means the route has not been attached to any Gateway.
+ items:
+ description: |-
+ RouteParentStatus describes the status of a route with respect to an
+ associated Parent.
+ properties:
+ conditions:
+ description: |-
+ Conditions describes the status of the route with respect to the Gateway.
+ Note that the route's availability is also subject to the Gateway's own
+ status conditions and listener status.
+
+
+ If the Route's ParentRef specifies an existing Gateway that supports
+ Routes of this kind AND that Gateway's controller has sufficient access,
+ then that Gateway's controller MUST set the "Accepted" condition on the
+ Route, to indicate whether the route has been accepted or rejected by the
+ Gateway, and why.
+
+
+ A Route MUST be considered "Accepted" if at least one of the Route's
+ rules is implemented by the Gateway.
+
+
+ There are a number of cases where the "Accepted" condition may not be set
+ due to lack of controller visibility, that includes when:
+
+
+ * The Route refers to a non-existent parent.
+ * The Route is of a type that the controller does not support.
+ * The Route is in a namespace the controller does not have access to.
+ items:
+ description: "Condition contains details for one aspect of
+ the current state of this API Resource.\n---\nThis struct
+ is intended for direct use as an array at the field path
+ .status.conditions. For example,\n\n\n\ttype FooStatus
+ struct{\n\t // Represents the observations of a foo's
+ current state.\n\t // Known .status.conditions.type are:
+ \"Available\", \"Progressing\", and \"Degraded\"\n\t //
+ +patchMergeKey=type\n\t // +patchStrategy=merge\n\t //
+ +listType=map\n\t // +listMapKey=type\n\t Conditions
+ []metav1.Condition `json:\"conditions,omitempty\" patchStrategy:\"merge\"
+ patchMergeKey:\"type\" protobuf:\"bytes,1,rep,name=conditions\"`\n\n\n\t
+ \ // other fields\n\t}"
+ properties:
+ lastTransitionTime:
+ description: |-
+ lastTransitionTime is the last time the condition transitioned from one status to another.
+ This should be when the underlying condition changed. If that is not known, then using the time when the API field changed is acceptable.
+ format: date-time
+ type: string
+ message:
+ description: |-
+ message is a human readable message indicating details about the transition.
+ This may be an empty string.
+ maxLength: 32768
+ type: string
+ observedGeneration:
+ description: |-
+ observedGeneration represents the .metadata.generation that the condition was set based upon.
+ For instance, if .metadata.generation is currently 12, but the .status.conditions[x].observedGeneration is 9, the condition is out of date
+ with respect to the current state of the instance.
+ format: int64
+ minimum: 0
+ type: integer
+ reason:
+ description: |-
+ reason contains a programmatic identifier indicating the reason for the condition's last transition.
+ Producers of specific condition types may define expected values and meanings for this field,
+ and whether the values are considered a guaranteed API.
+ The value should be a CamelCase string.
+ This field may not be empty.
+ maxLength: 1024
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[A-Za-z]([A-Za-z0-9_,:]*[A-Za-z0-9_])?$
+ type: string
+ status:
+ description: status of the condition, one of True, False,
+ Unknown.
+ enum:
+ - "True"
+ - "False"
+ - Unknown
+ type: string
+ type:
+ description: |-
+ type of condition in CamelCase or in foo.example.com/CamelCase.
+ ---
+ Many .condition.type values are consistent across resources like Available, but because arbitrary conditions can be
+ useful (see .node.status.conditions), the ability to deconflict is important.
+ The regex it matches is (dns1123SubdomainFmt/)?(qualifiedNameFmt)
+ maxLength: 316
+ pattern: ^([a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*/)?(([A-Za-z0-9][-A-Za-z0-9_.]*)?[A-Za-z0-9])$
+ type: string
+ required:
+ - lastTransitionTime
+ - message
+ - reason
+ - status
+ - type
+ type: object
+ maxItems: 8
+ minItems: 1
+ type: array
+ x-kubernetes-list-map-keys:
+ - type
+ x-kubernetes-list-type: map
+ controllerName:
+ description: |-
+ ControllerName is a domain/path string that indicates the name of the
+ controller that wrote this status. This corresponds with the
+ controllerName field on GatewayClass.
+
+
+ Example: "example.net/gateway-controller".
+
+
+ The format of this field is DOMAIN "/" PATH, where DOMAIN and PATH are
+ valid Kubernetes names
+ (https://kubernetes.io/docs/concepts/overview/working-with-objects/names/#names).
+
+
+ Controllers MUST populate this field when writing status. Controllers should ensure that
+ entries to status populated with their ControllerName are cleaned up when they are no
+ longer necessary.
+ maxLength: 253
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*\/[A-Za-z0-9\/\-._~%!$&'()*+,;=:]+$
+ type: string
+ parentRef:
+ description: |-
+ ParentRef corresponds with a ParentRef in the spec that this
+ RouteParentStatus struct describes the status of.
+ properties:
+ group:
+ default: gateway.networking.k8s.io
+ description: |-
+ Group is the group of the referent.
+ When unspecified, "gateway.networking.k8s.io" is inferred.
+ To set the core API group (such as for a "Service" kind referent),
+ Group must be explicitly set to "" (empty string).
+
+
+ Support: Core
+ maxLength: 253
+ pattern: ^$|^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$
+ type: string
+ kind:
+ default: Gateway
+ description: |-
+ Kind is kind of the referent.
+
+
+ There are two kinds of parent resources with "Core" support:
+
+
+ * Gateway (Gateway conformance profile)
+ * Service (Mesh conformance profile, ClusterIP Services only)
+
+
+ Support for other resources is Implementation-Specific.
+ maxLength: 63
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[a-zA-Z]([-a-zA-Z0-9]*[a-zA-Z0-9])?$
+ type: string
+ name:
+ description: |-
+ Name is the name of the referent.
+
+
+ Support: Core
+ maxLength: 253
+ minLength: 1
+ type: string
+ namespace:
+ description: |-
+ Namespace is the namespace of the referent. When unspecified, this refers
+ to the local namespace of the Route.
+
+
+ Note that there are specific rules for ParentRefs which cross namespace
+ boundaries. Cross-namespace references are only valid if they are explicitly
+ allowed by something in the namespace they are referring to. For example:
+ Gateway has the AllowedRoutes field, and ReferenceGrant provides a
+ generic way to enable any other kind of cross-namespace reference.
+
+
+
+
+
+ Support: Core
+ maxLength: 63
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?$
+ type: string
+ port:
+ description: |-
+ Port is the network port this Route targets. It can be interpreted
+ differently based on the type of parent resource.
+
+
+ When the parent resource is a Gateway, this targets all listeners
+ listening on the specified port that also support this kind of Route(and
+ select this Route). It's not recommended to set `Port` unless the
+ networking behaviors specified in a Route must apply to a specific port
+ as opposed to a listener(s) whose port(s) may be changed. When both Port
+ and SectionName are specified, the name and port of the selected listener
+ must match both specified values.
+
+
+
+
+
+ Implementations MAY choose to support other parent resources.
+ Implementations supporting other types of parent resources MUST clearly
+ document how/if Port is interpreted.
+
+
+ For the purpose of status, an attachment is considered successful as
+ long as the parent resource accepts it partially. For example, Gateway
+ listeners can restrict which Routes can attach to them by Route kind,
+ namespace, or hostname. If 1 of 2 Gateway listeners accept attachment
+ from the referencing Route, the Route MUST be considered successfully
+ attached. If no Gateway listeners accept attachment from this Route,
+ the Route MUST be considered detached from the Gateway.
+
+
+ Support: Extended
+ format: int32
+ maximum: 65535
+ minimum: 1
+ type: integer
+ sectionName:
+ description: |-
+ SectionName is the name of a section within the target resource. In the
+ following resources, SectionName is interpreted as the following:
+
+
+ * Gateway: Listener name. When both Port (experimental) and SectionName
+ are specified, the name and port of the selected listener must match
+ both specified values.
+ * Service: Port name. When both Port (experimental) and SectionName
+ are specified, the name and port of the selected listener must match
+ both specified values.
+
+
+ Implementations MAY choose to support attaching Routes to other resources.
+ If that is the case, they MUST clearly document how SectionName is
+ interpreted.
+
+
+ When unspecified (empty string), this will reference the entire resource.
+ For the purpose of status, an attachment is considered successful if at
+ least one section in the parent resource accepts it. For example, Gateway
+ listeners can restrict which Routes can attach to them by Route kind,
+ namespace, or hostname. If 1 of 2 Gateway listeners accept attachment from
+ the referencing Route, the Route MUST be considered successfully
+ attached. If no Gateway listeners accept attachment from this Route, the
+ Route MUST be considered detached from the Gateway.
+
+
+ Support: Core
+ maxLength: 253
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$
+ type: string
+ required:
+ - name
+ type: object
+ required:
+ - controllerName
+ - parentRef
+ type: object
+ maxItems: 32
+ type: array
+ required:
+ - parents
+ type: object
+ required:
+ - spec
+ type: object
+ served: true
+ storage: false
+ subresources:
+ status: {}
+status:
+ acceptedNames:
+ kind: ""
+ plural: ""
+ conditions: null
+ storedVersions: null
+---
+#
+# config/crd/standard/gateway.networking.k8s.io_referencegrants.yaml
+#
+apiVersion: apiextensions.k8s.io/v1
+kind: CustomResourceDefinition
+metadata:
+ annotations:
+ api-approved.kubernetes.io: https://github.com/kubernetes-sigs/gateway-api/pull/2997
+ gateway.networking.k8s.io/bundle-version: v1.1.0
+ gateway.networking.k8s.io/channel: standard
+ creationTimestamp: null
+ name: referencegrants.gateway.networking.k8s.io
+spec:
+ group: gateway.networking.k8s.io
+ names:
+ categories:
+ - gateway-api
+ kind: ReferenceGrant
+ listKind: ReferenceGrantList
+ plural: referencegrants
+ shortNames:
+ - refgrant
+ singular: referencegrant
+ scope: Namespaced
+ versions:
+ - additionalPrinterColumns:
+ - jsonPath: .metadata.creationTimestamp
+ name: Age
+ type: date
+ deprecated: true
+ deprecationWarning: The v1alpha2 version of ReferenceGrant has been deprecated
+ and will be removed in a future release of the API. Please upgrade to v1beta1.
+ name: v1alpha2
+ schema:
+ openAPIV3Schema:
+ description: |-
+ ReferenceGrant identifies kinds of resources in other namespaces that are
+ trusted to reference the specified kinds of resources in the same namespace
+ as the policy.
+
+
+ Each ReferenceGrant can be used to represent a unique trust relationship.
+ Additional Reference Grants can be used to add to the set of trusted
+ sources of inbound references for the namespace they are defined within.
+
+
+ A ReferenceGrant is required for all cross-namespace references in Gateway API
+ (with the exception of cross-namespace Route-Gateway attachment, which is
+ governed by the AllowedRoutes configuration on the Gateway, and cross-namespace
+ Service ParentRefs on a "consumer" mesh Route, which defines routing rules
+ applicable only to workloads in the Route namespace). ReferenceGrants allowing
+ a reference from a Route to a Service are only applicable to BackendRefs.
+
+
+ ReferenceGrant is a form of runtime verification allowing users to assert
+ which cross-namespace object references are permitted. Implementations that
+ support ReferenceGrant MUST NOT permit cross-namespace references which have
+ no grant, and MUST respond to the removal of a grant by revoking the access
+ that the grant allowed.
+ properties:
+ apiVersion:
+ description: |-
+ APIVersion defines the versioned schema of this representation of an object.
+ Servers should convert recognized schemas to the latest internal value, and
+ may reject unrecognized values.
+ More info: https://git.k8s.io/community/contributors/devel/sig-architecture/api-conventions.md#resources
+ type: string
+ kind:
+ description: |-
+ Kind is a string value representing the REST resource this object represents.
+ Servers may infer this from the endpoint the client submits requests to.
+ Cannot be updated.
+ In CamelCase.
+ More info: https://git.k8s.io/community/contributors/devel/sig-architecture/api-conventions.md#types-kinds
+ type: string
+ metadata:
+ type: object
+ spec:
+ description: Spec defines the desired state of ReferenceGrant.
+ properties:
+ from:
+ description: |-
+ From describes the trusted namespaces and kinds that can reference the
+ resources described in "To". Each entry in this list MUST be considered
+ to be an additional place that references can be valid from, or to put
+ this another way, entries MUST be combined using OR.
+
+
+ Support: Core
+ items:
+ description: ReferenceGrantFrom describes trusted namespaces and
+ kinds.
+ properties:
+ group:
+ description: |-
+ Group is the group of the referent.
+ When empty, the Kubernetes core API group is inferred.
+
+
+ Support: Core
+ maxLength: 253
+ pattern: ^$|^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$
+ type: string
+ kind:
+ description: |-
+ Kind is the kind of the referent. Although implementations may support
+ additional resources, the following types are part of the "Core"
+ support level for this field.
+
+
+ When used to permit a SecretObjectReference:
+
+
+ * Gateway
+
+
+ When used to permit a BackendObjectReference:
+
+
+ * GRPCRoute
+ * HTTPRoute
+ * TCPRoute
+ * TLSRoute
+ * UDPRoute
+ maxLength: 63
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[a-zA-Z]([-a-zA-Z0-9]*[a-zA-Z0-9])?$
+ type: string
+ namespace:
+ description: |-
+ Namespace is the namespace of the referent.
+
+
+ Support: Core
+ maxLength: 63
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?$
+ type: string
+ required:
+ - group
+ - kind
+ - namespace
+ type: object
+ maxItems: 16
+ minItems: 1
+ type: array
+ to:
+ description: |-
+ To describes the resources that may be referenced by the resources
+ described in "From". Each entry in this list MUST be considered to be an
+ additional place that references can be valid to, or to put this another
+ way, entries MUST be combined using OR.
+
+
+ Support: Core
+ items:
+ description: |-
+ ReferenceGrantTo describes what Kinds are allowed as targets of the
+ references.
+ properties:
+ group:
+ description: |-
+ Group is the group of the referent.
+ When empty, the Kubernetes core API group is inferred.
+
+
+ Support: Core
+ maxLength: 253
+ pattern: ^$|^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$
+ type: string
+ kind:
+ description: |-
+ Kind is the kind of the referent. Although implementations may support
+ additional resources, the following types are part of the "Core"
+ support level for this field:
+
+
+ * Secret when used to permit a SecretObjectReference
+ * Service when used to permit a BackendObjectReference
+ maxLength: 63
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[a-zA-Z]([-a-zA-Z0-9]*[a-zA-Z0-9])?$
+ type: string
+ name:
+ description: |-
+ Name is the name of the referent. When unspecified, this policy
+ refers to all resources of the specified Group and Kind in the local
+ namespace.
+ maxLength: 253
+ minLength: 1
+ type: string
+ required:
+ - group
+ - kind
+ type: object
+ maxItems: 16
+ minItems: 1
+ type: array
+ required:
+ - from
+ - to
+ type: object
+ type: object
+ served: false
+ storage: false
+ subresources: {}
+ - additionalPrinterColumns:
+ - jsonPath: .metadata.creationTimestamp
+ name: Age
+ type: date
+ name: v1beta1
+ schema:
+ openAPIV3Schema:
+ description: |-
+ ReferenceGrant identifies kinds of resources in other namespaces that are
+ trusted to reference the specified kinds of resources in the same namespace
+ as the policy.
+
+
+ Each ReferenceGrant can be used to represent a unique trust relationship.
+ Additional Reference Grants can be used to add to the set of trusted
+ sources of inbound references for the namespace they are defined within.
+
+
+ All cross-namespace references in Gateway API (with the exception of cross-namespace
+ Gateway-route attachment) require a ReferenceGrant.
+
+
+ ReferenceGrant is a form of runtime verification allowing users to assert
+ which cross-namespace object references are permitted. Implementations that
+ support ReferenceGrant MUST NOT permit cross-namespace references which have
+ no grant, and MUST respond to the removal of a grant by revoking the access
+ that the grant allowed.
+ properties:
+ apiVersion:
+ description: |-
+ APIVersion defines the versioned schema of this representation of an object.
+ Servers should convert recognized schemas to the latest internal value, and
+ may reject unrecognized values.
+ More info: https://git.k8s.io/community/contributors/devel/sig-architecture/api-conventions.md#resources
+ type: string
+ kind:
+ description: |-
+ Kind is a string value representing the REST resource this object represents.
+ Servers may infer this from the endpoint the client submits requests to.
+ Cannot be updated.
+ In CamelCase.
+ More info: https://git.k8s.io/community/contributors/devel/sig-architecture/api-conventions.md#types-kinds
+ type: string
+ metadata:
+ type: object
+ spec:
+ description: Spec defines the desired state of ReferenceGrant.
+ properties:
+ from:
+ description: |-
+ From describes the trusted namespaces and kinds that can reference the
+ resources described in "To". Each entry in this list MUST be considered
+ to be an additional place that references can be valid from, or to put
+ this another way, entries MUST be combined using OR.
+
+
+ Support: Core
+ items:
+ description: ReferenceGrantFrom describes trusted namespaces and
+ kinds.
+ properties:
+ group:
+ description: |-
+ Group is the group of the referent.
+ When empty, the Kubernetes core API group is inferred.
+
+
+ Support: Core
+ maxLength: 253
+ pattern: ^$|^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$
+ type: string
+ kind:
+ description: |-
+ Kind is the kind of the referent. Although implementations may support
+ additional resources, the following types are part of the "Core"
+ support level for this field.
+
+
+ When used to permit a SecretObjectReference:
+
+
+ * Gateway
+
+
+ When used to permit a BackendObjectReference:
+
+
+ * GRPCRoute
+ * HTTPRoute
+ * TCPRoute
+ * TLSRoute
+ * UDPRoute
+ maxLength: 63
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[a-zA-Z]([-a-zA-Z0-9]*[a-zA-Z0-9])?$
+ type: string
+ namespace:
+ description: |-
+ Namespace is the namespace of the referent.
+
+
+ Support: Core
+ maxLength: 63
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?$
+ type: string
+ required:
+ - group
+ - kind
+ - namespace
+ type: object
+ maxItems: 16
+ minItems: 1
+ type: array
+ to:
+ description: |-
+ To describes the resources that may be referenced by the resources
+ described in "From". Each entry in this list MUST be considered to be an
+ additional place that references can be valid to, or to put this another
+ way, entries MUST be combined using OR.
+
+
+ Support: Core
+ items:
+ description: |-
+ ReferenceGrantTo describes what Kinds are allowed as targets of the
+ references.
+ properties:
+ group:
+ description: |-
+ Group is the group of the referent.
+ When empty, the Kubernetes core API group is inferred.
+
+
+ Support: Core
+ maxLength: 253
+ pattern: ^$|^[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?(\.[a-z0-9]([-a-z0-9]*[a-z0-9])?)*$
+ type: string
+ kind:
+ description: |-
+ Kind is the kind of the referent. Although implementations may support
+ additional resources, the following types are part of the "Core"
+ support level for this field:
+
+
+ * Secret when used to permit a SecretObjectReference
+ * Service when used to permit a BackendObjectReference
+ maxLength: 63
+ minLength: 1
+ pattern: ^[a-zA-Z]([-a-zA-Z0-9]*[a-zA-Z0-9])?$
+ type: string
+ name:
+ description: |-
+ Name is the name of the referent. When unspecified, this policy
+ refers to all resources of the specified Group and Kind in the local
+ namespace.
+ maxLength: 253
+ minLength: 1
+ type: string
+ required:
+ - group
+ - kind
+ type: object
+ maxItems: 16
+ minItems: 1
+ type: array
+ required:
+ - from
+ - to
+ type: object
+ type: object
+ served: true
+ storage: true
+ subresources: {}
+status:
+ acceptedNames:
+ kind: ""
+ plural: ""
+ conditions: null
+ storedVersions: null
diff --git a/roles/kubernetes-apps/meta/main.yml b/roles/kubernetes-apps/meta/main.yml
index b02684d30..37bd10921 100644
--- a/roles/kubernetes-apps/meta/main.yml
+++ b/roles/kubernetes-apps/meta/main.yml
@@ -111,6 +111,13 @@ dependencies:
tags:
- oci
+ - role: kubernetes-apps/gateway_api
+ when:
+ - gateway_api_enabled
+ - inventory_hostname == groups['kube_control_plane'][0]
+ tags:
+ - gateway_api
+
- role: kubernetes-apps/metallb
when:
- metallb_enabled